| part1 audio starts here to the right  
      part 2shortcut   part 3shortcut 
      
      all/the rest of audiofiles 
      norsk utg./omtale/snakk 
      om boka 
      
      
      Teosofi: DEN HEMMELIGE LÆRE - SYNTESEN AV VITENSKAP, 
      RELIGION OG FILOSOFIVED H. P. BLAVATSKY oversatt til norsk av John Bruland 
        -
 
       speilbase 
      med disse samme over bøker også på link  her 
        
      
      
 
 
 |  | 
        
          
          
            
            AUTHOR'S NOTE It is far from my intentions to want to provide a 
            historical picture of Egypt. A person who is living in any given 
            place has not the faintest idea of the peculiarities of his country, 
            and he does not consider customs, language and religion from an 
            ethnographic point of view. He takes everything as a matter of 
            course. He is a human being and has his joys and sorrows, just like 
            every other human being, anywhere, any place, any time; for that 
            which is truly human is timeless and changeless. My concern here is 
            only with the human, not with ethnography and history. That is why I 
            have, in relating the story which follows here, intentionally used 
            modern terms. I have avoided using Egyptian sounding words to create 
            the illusion of an Egyptian atmosphere. The teachings of the High 
            Priest Ptahhotep are given in modern language so that 
            modern people may understand them. For religious symbols also, I 
            have chosen to use modern terms so that all may understand what 
            these symbols mean.  People of today understand us better if we say 'God' 
            than if we were to use the Egyptian term 'Ptah' for the same concept. 
            If we say 'Ptah' everyone immediately thinks, 'Oh yes, 
            Ptah, the Egyptian God'. No! Ptah was not an Egyptian 
            God. On the contrary, the Egyptians called the same God whom 
            we call God, by the name of Ptah. And to take another 
            example, their term for Satan was Seth. The words 
            God and Satan carry meanings for us today which we would 
            not get from the words Ptah or Seth. For people living 
            in our times, these latter terms, Ptah and Seth, are 
            empty, dry and meaningless. The term Logos and the expression
            creative principle have a meaning for us today which we would 
            not get from the term 'Horus Hawk'. Electricity was just as 
            much electricity thousands of years ago as it is today, and an atom 
            was an atom, simply by a different name. I make these comments here 
            so that my readers may be able to devote their attention to the 
            content of the story which follows here, without being halted 
            unnecessarily by what may appear to be an anachronism merely because 
            of the terms used—as for example when the Egyptian High Priest 
            speaks of a 'chain reaction'! I have intentionally avoided trying to 
            reproduce or imitate the ancient terminology for phenomena we now 
            know under names everyone is accustomed to using.
           
             FOREWORD The national rhythm of the Indian people is 
            religion. With every heartbeat the Indian feels himself a step 
            closer to the eternally glorious goal of the realization of God.  Whenever he hears the name of God on the lips of 
            someone passing by, his Sharp ear picks up the melody and he starts 
            to sing a paean of praise. Even though he may have neither food nor 
            a roof over his head—for often enough the arch of heaven is his 
            shelter—he still has God in his heart. He knows that in this arena 
            of life he has come uncounted times and gone again, through myriad 
            births, that he has enjoyed all the created world has to offer, and 
            that, as he knows the truth 'Everything here on earth passes away', 
            nothing more can satisfy him. His wish is now to find and reach that 
            source from which the stream of manifestations flows.  That is why, from early childhood he prays: 'I 
            meditate on the magnificence of the being that has created this 
            universe. May it illuminate my mind.'  The majesty and beauty of nature, reminding him of 
            that being, becomes an object of his adoration. Every holy writing, 
            of whatever religion, which breathes the breath of that being 
            becomes an object of his respect and admiration. And every one who 
            has found that being and speaks about the way to him becomes 
            an object of respect and admiration. I have the great fortune to sit 
            at the feet of an illumined soul: Elisabeth Haich is my teacher, my 
            guru. In her presence the delicate petals of my soul began to unfold. 
            Often a word from her opens my eyes, and sometimes an understanding 
            glance is enough to strengthen me in my conviction. A friendly 
            comment can sometimes drive away all my doubts. Every moment in the 
            presence of my teacher brings me new experiences and hastens my 
            progress. Very often when certain things have bothered me, I have 
            found help in the words of my guru: 'Don't live for the present; 
            don't allow transitory things to influence you. Live in eternity, 
            above time and space, above finite things. Then nothing can 
            influence you.'  In the presence of my teacher I enjoy absolute 
            independence of thought, for I have learned that it is wrong to want 
            to apply the thoughts of another person in one's own life. 'I don't 
            want you simply to follow me on the path I am following to reach the 
            goal,' she has told me. 'Go your own way, on the path you select for 
            yourself, corresponding to your own innermost inclinations. Don't 
            accept any statement because I made it. Even if it is true a hundred 
            times over, it still is not your truth, it still is not 
            your experience, and it will not belong to you. Bring truth into 
            being, and then it will belong to you. Regard the lives of those who 
            have achieved truth only as proof that the goal can be reached.'  At these words of my teacher's, I was seized by an 
            irresistible drive towards absolute independence, and this urge 
            freed me from the nefarious attitude of expecting help from outside. 
            I don't need a teacher that influences me, but a teacher who teaches 
            me not to allow myself to be influenced.  For many years I have had the great privilege of 
            hearing the profoundest truths explained in the simplest words. I 
            have yet to hear anyone else explain the revelations of the Bible as 
            clearly as Elisabeth Haich, and in a manner as applicable to our 
            daily living. I have travelled far, and in all my travels no priest 
            has been able to explain the true meaning of these revelations, even 
            though I have asked hundreds. How, after all, could he if he has not 
            reached 'the kingdom of Heaven within'? How could it be otherwise as 
            long as he has not experienced within himself the truth of the 
            sentence: 'Ye are the light of the world', as long as he does not 
            yet recognize: 'Ye are the living temple of the Holy Spirit'?  Hundreds and thousands have attended the weekly 
            lectures and meditation groups led by Elisabeth Haich. It has been 
            the wish of all of us to possess her teachings in book form.  Through the experience of each lecture our souls 
            thirsting for truth were enriched to an undreamed of extent. It is a 
            great joy for all of us to know that at last part of this knowledge 
            will now be available in the concentrated form of a book. This book 
            is an introduction to the high art of reaching and achieving the 
            divine in us and of learning to recognize this unknown creature 
            called man. We will discover the great truth: Self development is 
            revealing the perfection which has been in man from the very 
            beginning. Religion is the activation of the divine principle which 
            awaits its manifestation in man.  SELVARAJAN YESUDIAN, Zurich, April 1962  CONTENTS   
              
                | Author's Note |  |  
                | Foreword |  |  
                | Introduction |  |  
                | 1. Awakening |  |  
                | 2. Lion and Light |  |  
                | 3. My Parents are not 'My' Parents |  |  
                | 4. Sunrise is Different |  |  
                
                | 5. I want to get Away |  |  
                | 6. I long for Unity  |  |  
                | 7. The Red Man  |  |  8. My Future Appears  9. Struggles of Love   10. First Encounter with Death   11. First Visions of the Future   12. The Past Awakens  13. Second Encounter with Death  14. Darkness  15. Turning Point  16. Struggle for Light  17. I take My Vow   18. The Horizon Brightens  19. Visions  20. The Ayur-Vedas  21. There was Light  22. Past becomes Present   23. HE   24. Sons of God   25. Years of Preparation  26. The Tree of the Knowledge of Good and Evil
             27. The Twelve Sets of Twin Characteristics   28. The Lions  29. Telepathic Exercises   30. The Future and Sunrise   31. Bo-Ghar and the Staff of Life   32. Ptahhotep's Instruction:   33. The Form of the Pyramids: Satan   34. The Four Faces of God   35. The Epochs of the World  
              
                | 36. Final 
                Preparations |  |  
                | 37. The 
                Initiation |  |  
                | 38. As 
                a Priestess |  |  
                | 39. We 
                will meet Again |  |  
                | 40. The 
                Lion |  |  
                | 41. 
                Mist and Re-awakening |  |  
                | 42. 
                Roo-Kha and the Twelve Pills |  |  
                | 43. The 
                Young Priest appears |  |  
                | 44. Ima 
                and Bo-Ghar |  |  
                | 45. The 
                Challenges are Repeated |  |  
                | 46. 
                Conclusion |  |      ILLUSTRATIONS  The Divine Horus, Cairo Museum frontispiece 
            Pharaoh before Amon, Cairo Museum facing page 184  The four faces of Brahma, Angkor-Thom, Bayon, 
            Cambodia 185  Pharaoh Cephren, Cairo Museum 320 
           
               INTRODUCTION written by a disciple of the author  I am a seeker. I seek an explanation for life on 
            earth. I would like to know what sense there is in the fact that a 
            person is born, grows from a child to an adult through all kinds of 
            difficulties, marries, brings more children into the world, who also 
            grow up to adults through just as many difficulties, also marry, 
            also bring more children into the world, who then with advancing age 
            lose the skills they took so much trouble to learn, and finally die. 
            An unending chain, without beginning, without end! Constantly 
            children are being born. They learn, they work hard, they want fully 
            to develop both body and mind— and after a relatively short time 
            everything is over, and down under six feet of sod they become 
            fodder for worms. What is the sense in all of this? Going on and on 
            just to produce more and more generations of people?  And when certain people not only leave their 
            descendants behind them, but also the work of the mind and spirit, 
            why do they have the same kind of experience? Why do they grow old 
            and take their high gifts to the grave with them? A Michelangelo, a 
            Leonardo da Vinci, a Giordano Bruno, a Shakespeare, a Goethe, and 
            many many others—why were these titans born, if finally they had to 
            decay in the same way as the worm that fattened itself on their 
            bodies?  No! It is not possible for life on earth to be so 
            senseless! Behind this seemingly unending chain of birth and death 
            there must be a more profound meaning, even if it seems to be 
            inexplicable for a prejudiced mind. There must be a completely 
            satisfactory and sensible explanation—seen from the other side!
             How and where can I find this other side of 
            all things that definitely must exist? How and where can I find a 
            way to get acquainted with it? Whom should I ask for directions? 
            Where do I find a person initiated into this mystery, a person who 
            can tell me about this hidden truth?  For throughout all recorded time there have been 
            outstanding people on earth who spoke out with unshakable assurance 
            about the secret of life and even witnessed their conviction with 
            their life—initiates as they have been called. But where and from 
            whom have these 'initiates' received their initiation? And into 
            what were they initiated?  Socrates for example. Consider him taking the cup of 
            poison with divine calm, drinking it to the last drop, speaking 
            fearlessly and objectively, quietly and pleasantly about the effect 
            of the poison, reporting how under the influence of the poison first 
            his feet get cold and die, how the deathly cold gradually crawls up 
            from his feet towards his heart like a snake. He is aware that he is 
            about to die, he takes leave of his faithful students, and closes 
            his eyes. Such unshakable peace and calm in the face of death can 
            only come from sure knowledge. Where did Socrates get this 
            knowledge?  And where have various other titans living on earth 
            at different times got their knowledge about the secret of life and 
            death—their initiation? Even today there must be such 'initiates' 
            living on earth, and there must be some way to obtain initiation, 
            the really great initiation.  Life has taught me that the Bible is not a book of 
            fairy tales, but has been written by initiates to transmit hidden 
            truth to us in a secret language. And the Bible tells us: 'Seek and 
            ye shall find; knock and it shall be opened unto you.'  I obeyed! I began to seek. Everywhere I could. In 
            books, in old writings, among people who I thought might know 
            something about the initiation. At all times I kept my eyes and ears 
            open, and in my searches through books, old and new, as well as in 
            the teachings of people both living and dead, I kept trying to 
            discover hidden mosaic stones with which to piece together the 
            secret of the initiation.  And I found! At first on rare occasions; here and 
            there, with my inner ears, I heard the voice of truth speaking in a 
            book or in the words of a living person. And I always went further 
            in the direction indicated by this mysterious voice. Like the thread 
            of Ariadne, this secret voice always led me on. Sometimes I found 
            someone in my own home town who could give me valuable information 
            for my further search, and sometimes this voice led me far away into 
            strange lands, where I often found information that was in 
            remarkably close agreement with the words I had heard at home.  Thus my path led me to people with ever greater 
            knowledge who explained more and more to me about initiation and 
            about the meaning of life. Naturally I also met many ignorant people 
            and people with half knowledge who pretended to know. But I got so I 
            could recognize immediately when 'the hands were Esau's, but the 
            voice was Jacob's.' These poor charlatans, pretending to be 'initiates', 
            gave themselves away very fast. They were not even in harmony with 
            themselves and their own life, so how could they have taught me 
            anything about the deepest truth of life, about initiation? In such 
            cases I simply went on seeking someone with true knowledge, a true 
            initiate.  Whenever I found someone who could tell me more than 
            I already knew, I stayed there to learn as much as I possibly could 
            learn.  In this way I once came into the presence of an old 
            woman living in a retreat as if in a convent. She was surrounded by 
            countless seekers, like a lump of sugar to which long rows of ants 
            make a steady pilgrimage to get food.  She was working in very close spiritual association 
            with two very much younger men, one from India and the other from 
            the Occident, whom the old woman called 'son'.  The old woman was tall, of majestic stature and 
            bearing, but extremely simple and completely natural in her 
            movements. Her deep blue eyes were surprisingly big, and her long 
            dark brown eye lashes gave them a remarkable expression. Her eyes 
            were smiling, friendly, full of understanding, but so penetrating 
            that most people were embarrassed when she looked at them.  People felt that this woman could see right through 
            everybody, that she could clearly see their thoughts, the entire 
            structure of their souls. Very often while listening to her lectures 
            among a group of other persons, I felt a number of questions arising 
            within me. She kept on talking, but she smiled and then in her next 
            few sentences she made a point of answering my unspoken questions. A 
            number of other listeners of hers told me they had had the same 
            experience. I just could not cope with this woman. The more I 
            learned from her and the more my spiritual eyes were opened, the 
            greater she seemed to me and the more the field in which her 
            knowledge surpassed mine seemed to expand in every direction. The 
            longer I stayed with her, the less I felt I knew her. Every time I 
            saw her, she appeared to me a 'different person' until I got the 
            impression that this woman carried within her and could manifest the 
            whole range of human personality and consequently had no personality 
            herself at all. Because to be everything, simultaneously 
            means to be nothing.  'Mother,' I asked her once, 'who are you really?' 'Who?' 
            she asked in return, 'what is that who? There is only 
            one being that is, and every person, every animal, every 
            plant, and even every sun, every planet and every other heavenly 
            body is only an instrument for the manifestation of this one and 
            only being that is. How many "who's" would there be? The same
            self speaks through my mouth as through yours and through all 
            living creatures. The only difference is that not every living 
            creature knows perfectly its own self and consequently is not 
            able to manifest all characteristics of the self. But 
            anybody who knows the self completely and perfectly can 
            manifest all the characteristics that exist in the universe, because 
            all these characteristics are the various aspects of the one and 
            only being that is, the one and only self. The 
            external form which you see before you, thinking that it is 'I' is 
            only an instrument through which the self manifests that 
            particular aspect of itself that is necessary nt any given 
            time. So don't ask any more nonsense like "who" I am.'  'Mother,' I said, 'how have you come to know the "self" 
            so completely and perfectly as to be able to manifest all its 
            possible characteristics? I would like to be so far advanced too! 
            Tell me! Through what experiences have you come in order to become 
            such a versatile instrument for the manifestations of the one and 
            only being that is? Or have you always been on this level? 
            Were you born in this condition?'  'Born?' she echoed, 'I born? When have you ever seen 
            that an "I" was born? Have you ever seen an "I"? The "I" has
            never been and never will be born, only the body. The 
            true, divine self is perfection itself, so a development In it
            is not possible. Only the body must develop in order to be 
            able to manifest higher and higher vibrations and higher and higher 
            frequencies of the self. Even the most highly developed 
            instrument, the most highly developed body, must go through this 
            process, including mine, which by the way is still far from 
            perfection. Everything is only a phase of development. The creation 
            of a body is always a chain reaction—as such processes are called 
            nowadays—and whenever a chain reaction has made a beginning, it runs 
            through various  periods until it comes to an end. No material form 
            of manifestation can escape from this law. And parallel with the 
            development of the body, the condition of consciousness naturally 
            changes also.'  'That means that you have had to go through a period 
            of development too, doesn't it, Mother? Please tell me what it was 
            like! What kind of experiences did you have that caused you to grow 
            into your present condition of consciousness? Please tell me all 
            about it.'  'Why should I tell you about it?' she replied. 'Everyone 
            must achieve perfect recognition of self in his own way. What 
            good would it do you for me to tell you my way? You could not 
            follow my way. Events themselves are not important, only the 
            experiences and the lessons that you get from them. Just take it 
            easy. On your way you will learn the same lessons as I on mine. 
            There are innumerable pathways, but they all lead to the same goal.'
             'Mother, you are right. I see clearly that I would 
            not be able to make progress on your path. Nevertheless it would 
            help me very much if you would tell me how you have acquired your 
            experience, because I and all the others who would listen to your 
            story would be able to learn how one can profit from experiences.
            I am not curious about your story, but merely anxious to hear 
            how you began to seize upon and learn the lesson that is in every 
            event. Please tell me about the path you have followed, Mother. 
            It would be so valuable for us to learn your attitude towards life 
            and how you reacted toward your fate so as to develop your 
            spiritual horizon to such an ail-inclusively great extent. We could 
            learn a great deal from your story.'  The old woman looked at me for a long time. Finally 
            she said, 'So you are curious as to how I reacted'? And you 
            believe it will help you and others to hear about it? All right! 
            Perhaps it really will be a good thing to tell you about the 
            experiences that gradually opened my eyes to the inner laws of 
            life and the various relationships that bound together the 
            destinies of different people. Come back tomorrow. I will tell you 
            and a few others whose eyes are opened to the essential things in 
            life about the experiences that helped me find what people call 
            illumination. I will tell you how I experienced my initiation!'  The next day found me and a number of her most 
            advanced pupils sitting in front of the old woman. And she began to 
            tell us the story of her initiation.  That is how this book was written.
           
             AWAKENING Like a flash of lightning a pain went through my 
            body—and a moment later I landed on the floor.  Danger! Help! But not from this adult here beside me 
            who is now so shocked and wants to examine me—No! I don't want him 
            now! I love him, but in a moment of danger he is not the person I 
            want.  I ran back into the room towards a strange, 
            beautiful woman to whom we had just said good night. I knew that she 
            would help me in a completely understanding way. At other times, too, 
            I liked to be near her; I always liked the scent about her, and I 
            always found I was in perfect safety in her presence. Now, in my 
            panic, I ran to her in search of help. I whined as I showed her my 
            plump little hand that was hanging down like a limp rag, refusing to 
            obey me any more. The beautiful woman looked at my hand, threw aside 
            the dress on which she was sewing and cried out:  'Robert! Robert! Come quickly!'  A door opened, and the grown-up man about whom I 
            dimly knew that he lived with us and somehow belonged to us, came 
            in. For the first time I looked at him with real attention. He was a 
            tall man with a face like ivory; hair, beard and moustache as black 
            as ebony, eyes glowing black, and he always radiated so much force 
            and strength, that everybody around him was kept at a certain 
            distance. He cast one glance at my limp and useless hand and said, 
            'A doctor! Stefi, get a doctor immediately.'  Uncle Stefi ran away and the tall dark man asked us 
            what had happened. So we told him. After Grete and I had said good 
            night, Uncle Stefi took me on to his back and carried me that way 
            into the bedroom. There he let me slide off, but I slid too fast. To 
            keep me from falling, he suddenly grabbed my hand. In the same 
            moment I felt a violent stab of pain in my right wrist. Then when I 
            tried to raise my hand, it just hung limp.  'Yes,' said the tall adult, 'her wrist is sprained. 
            The worst part of it is that I am just leaving on a business trip 
            and cannot wait until the doctor comes. All night long I will be 
            sitting on pins and needles. Wire me as soon as the doctor is 
            through; tell me what he has done.'  He kissed us and mother and went away. I looked up 
            astonished to the strange beautiful woman who had always pointed to 
            herself and said 'Mother' and whom we therefore called mother.  Up to that moment I had been crying and bawling for 
            all I was worth. I was badly disappointed and frightened to find out 
            that the adults could not help me. They were not able to stop the 
            pain that was torturing me more and more; nor were they able to fix 
            my hand the way it was before. When I heard that the tall dark adult 
            was going to have to spend all night sitting on pins and needles, I 
            was so astonished and so concerned for him that I suddenly forgot 
            about crying and asked mother, 'Why is he going to have to sit on 
            pins and needles all night long?' At first mother gave me a look of 
            amazement and then began to laugh and said, 'Because father is all 
            excited about your hand'.  But what kind of an answer was that! Simply nonsense! 
            It didn't explain anything. The tall man we called 'father' was 
            completely in earnest when he said he was going to be sitting on 
            pins and needles—and now mother was laughing at me. Why? I had only 
            repeated what father had said. What did she mean by saying that 
            father was 'all excited' and why did that mean that he was going to 
            have to sit on pins and needles? Would that mean that he was going 
            to be dangerously pricked? Mother spent a lot of time sewing and she 
            had shown me how dangerous a needle can be; the point of a needle 
            can be very unpleasant. That hurts! That's why needles should 
            only be used for sewing. So what kind of nonsense was this, the 
            adults were giving me again—just because my hand was so helpless and 
            painful that I had to hold it with the other hand? Why did that mean 
            that father was going to spend the whole night sitting on pins and 
            needles, when after all they are only supposed to be used for sewing? 
            I was already pretty used to the fact that adults often talked 
            nonsense and did senseless things, but this was too much, and I 
            insisted on knowing more. But I did not get the chance to ask more 
            questions about this 'sitting on pins and needles' because Uncle 
            Stefi returned with the doctor.  The doctor was a tall, impressive, friendly man who 
            looked at me as if we had known each other a long time. He lifted me 
            up high and so took me out of the protective nearness of my mother. 
            That filled my heart with terrible fear; the movement caused a new 
            wave of torturing pain, and I began to bawl again for all I was 
            worth. The doctor set me on the table—I saw my little feet dangling 
            very close under my breast—and he shook his head as he laughed and 
            said, 'Oh how ugly this little girl is when she is crying!'  I was stunned. What? He says I am ugly when I am 
            crying? How does he know that? Up till now I always thought one 
            could see everything except me. Everything and everybody else, 
            the adults, the cook, Grete, the canary bird, my toys—in fact 
            everything round about me was visible, even my hands, my little 
            tummy, and my feet, but I myself could not be seen. I 
            was present, but yet not present, somewhere but invisible. I had 
            never yet seen myself, and I could not for the life of me 
            imagine how it could be possible to see this something, this 'I'. So 
            how could it be possible for this adult to see my desperation, my 
            pain, my crying: that is 'me'? Goodness! If he sees me, my amazed 
            and horrified condition, that must really be 'ugly'. For sheer 
            wonder and amazement, I stopped crying and looked at the doctor 
            quizzically.  Then all the adults began to laugh out loud, and 
            mother said, 'See how vain this little girl is! She is even 
            suppressing her pain in order not to appear ugly.'  There we were again. Here was another one of those 
            senseless remarks by adults. 'Vain'—what is that? How could I be 
            vain when I didn't even know what that was, and how could I 'appear' 
            when I did not even know that I was visible? Up to now I had always 
            thought that I was the person doing the seeing. I it 
            was who saw everything round about but I was in some way or 
            other outside of the visible. All this was going around in my 
            head, and I just wanted to ask another question when the doctor took 
            hold of my limp little hand and pulled it hard, so hard I wanted to 
            scream again—it hurt so terribly! —The crazy man is going to pull my 
            hand clean off! I thought—but then he twisted the little hand that 
            somehow or other was fastened on to me, because It hurt 'me' 
            terribly, and all of a sudden it was in its right place again.  'There we are,' said the doctor. 'Now the joint will 
            swell up a little bit, so for tonight we will bed it down on a 
            pillow, and pretty soon we can forget the whole matter.'  Then the adults went on talking about how vain I was, 
            saying that for pure vanity I had not even cried out when the doctor 
            was twisting my wrist back into place. Mother was particularly 
            impressed by this and that made me sad. I could see that the strange 
            beautiful woman whom I already loved very much just did not 
            understand me. And even though the doctor could see me, J was 
            certainly invisible to mother. Nevertheless she radiated a 
            wonderful love, and a little later, as I lay in my bed, with my hand 
            resting on a pillow, I was happy that her fine sweet face leaned 
            over me from time to time and smiled down at me encouragingly. She 
            radiated sweetness and warmth, and as long as she was near I did not 
            feel alone or abandoned. I knew that I could count on her; to a 
            certain extent she was in my power, and I had complete confidence in 
            her. Gradually I fell asleep. The night passed, and my hand again 
            became the obedient instrument, the faithful friend that, later on 
            in life was to bring me no much joy—so very much joy—and was to help 
            awaken me out of my unconscious state.  But the doctor was wrong! I never did forget the 
            matter, and through the law of association he has remained 
            permanently and indissolubly connected with my first awakening and 
            my first becoming conscious in this life. From now on my 
            consciousness—my memory—was constantly awake. From now on I observed 
            everything, everything around me as well as within me, with the 
            greatest attention and with uninterrupted concentration. From now on 
            I knew that I lived in a home where the tall, dark, and powerful 
            adult was unconditionally master. Mother called him 'Robert' and we 
            had to call him 'father'. The whole household revolved around him; 
            mother belonged to him body and soul. His power spread over all of 
            us, and later over many thousands of people, like a tent, like a 
            protective envelope. Everybody that belonged to father's sphere of 
            influence enjoyed help, security and prosperity.  audiofile part 2  
            
            http://galactic.no/rune/lydboker/nyeLydfiler/Elisabeth_Haich_Initiation/Elisabeth_Haich_Initiation_0003.mp3   
            starts here2   During the morning hours father was not at home so I 
            could be with mother. I was permitted to accompany her in the whole 
            apartment, even in the kitchen, and ofttimes when she sat quietly 
            embroidering a big tablecloth with brightly coloured threads, I was 
            permitted to sit beside her and amuse myself by 'embroidering' 
            various patterns according to my own imagination, using the same 
            brightly coloured threads. At midday father came home, and after 
            lunch Crete and I had to go to the children's room, something I did 
            not like at all. Grete was also a child of the house, like myself, 
            only—as I was told— she was three years older than I. At the time I 
            sprained my wrist she was four and a half and I one and a half.  The following summer we spent our vacation in a 
            village beside a great body of water. We lived in a little farmhouse 
            that was surrounded by a large garden and a big farm. Grete and I 
            were allowed to run around barefoot, and we were also permitted to 
            accompany a woman with a very brown and wrinkled face when she went 
            to the barn where there was a cow, a calf and a number of rabbits 
            with red eyes. That was all very thrilling. In the garden there were 
            gigantic yellow flowers, seemingly as high as trees, that always 
            turned in the direction of the sun. I liked them too, father came 
            only from time to time, and when he did people said, 'Today is 
            Sunday'. The rest of the time we were alone with mother and I could 
            spend the whole day with her. Every day we went down to the lake and 
            bathed and splashed happily in the water.  One day mother said, 'Tomorrow is Sunday, but today 
            is already a big day, and we are going to have a lot of fun, because 
            father is coming.' That definitely did not impress me as such a 
            happy event, because I was only very slightly interested in father 
            and I knew for sure that when he was with us mother's time was 
            always taken up with him. At such times I had to go for a walk with 
            Grete and with Sophie, the grown-up daughter of the wizened old 
            farmer's wife.  During the evening while we were waiting for father, 
            I suddenly heard our neighbours telling mother that the 'Train had 
            run off the track' and that was the reason why father had not yet 
            arrived. Mother was horror struck. She called Sophie, entrusted me 
            to her care, asking her to pay close attention to me and not to 
            leave me alone a moment. Then she hurried to the station. Grete was 
            allowed to accompany her, as Grete was 'three years older' and could 
            walk better than I could. I stayed alone with Sophie.  It was already dark, and for the first time I was 
            allowed to be up and outside in the garden at this time of day. It 
            was very thrilling, although I did feel a bit uneasy, as I was 
            accustomed to seeing everything in daylight, and now the world 
            around me was so unclear. I had a feeling of being near trees and 
            flowers, rather than of seeing them. And the poplar trees whispered 
            in such a mysterious way. But there was no more time for me to make 
            further observations about the garden and the flowers, because 
            suddenly something fearful happened: Sophie picked me up, crooked an 
            arm about me and carried me to the garden fence where a horrible 
            apparition rose up out of the darkness. It looked like a man but had 
            a fearful kind of bush of feathers on its head, its eyes sparkled in 
            the darkness like burning coals, on its jacket there were tiny 
            buttons, and over its shoulder it carried something I instinctively 
            felt to be terribly dangerous. Later I heard the name 'rifle'. I 
            found this sinister being very repugnant and hoped that Sophie would 
            take me away as fast as possible. But to my great amazement, Sophie 
            again did something completely senseless—true to form, of course. 
            Instead of running away, she went up very close to the fence and 
            allowed the horrible apparition to whisper something to her in a 
            terribly deep voice. Then the man—by this time I knew it was a man—put 
            his arms around her and held her tight. Since Sophie was holding me 
            in one arm, he was holding me tight too, much to my distaste and 
            great displeasure. But that wasn't all! He had a gigantic moustache, 
            and its two 'branches' stuck out from his face like sharp horns. 
            Next he pulled Sophie quite close to himself and acted as if he 
            wanted to bite her. I expected that Sophie, in the face of this 
            deportment, would finally run away. But no, with her free arm he 
            embraced the neck of the terrible apparition, and when he wanted to 
            bite—or eat—her, she did not turn her face away but held her mouth 
            to his, and both of them acted as if each were absolutely bent on 
            eating up the mouth of the other. All this time they were squeezing 
            me so hard I could scarcely breathe. I fought with all my strength 
            to keep this horrible apparition as far away as possible, struggling 
            to keep my nose free. His presence was unspeakably unpleasant. He 
            smelled of all kinds of things, and a certain kind of bitter smell 
            was particularly repugnant. But neither he nor Sophie paid the least 
            attention to me, squeezing my head so tightly that I heard the man's 
            heart beating, while both of them acted for all the world as if each 
            wanted to slip Into the mouth of the other. Gracious! these adults 
            and the funny things they do! As they hugged each other, I could not 
            for the life of me imagine what had got into the modest, quiet 
            little Sophie. She was like a strange person who paid no attention 
            to my struggles. And then, just as suddenly as it had appeared, the 
            horrible apparition released us and disappeared into the darkness. A 
            moment later I heard the comforting voices of mother and father, and 
            soon their happy faces appeared out of the darkness. All the 
            neighbours gathered round and asked father about the derailing of 
            the train. Sophie acted as if nothing had happened, not even 
            bothering to tell anybody what a horrible being had held her in its 
            arms only a few minutes earlier. She just stood there with her calm, 
            innocent face. That was another big surprise for me, but I had no 
            time to think about it, for father had brought us bonbons from the 
            city and I was extremely eager to find out whether I was going to 
            get as many as Grete.  I was satisfied; to each of us he had brought the 
            exact same bonbons. And now it was mother's turn to spoil my fun; 
            for just as I wanted to stick all the bonbons into my mouth at once, 
            she took them away and gave me just one, promising that I could have 
            another one the next day after lunch. Oh my! Someday when I'm grown 
            up, I'll eat as many bonbons as I want all at once!  But this time I had to give them up and go to bed. 
            As mother was putting me to bed, I asked her just before we said our 
            prayers (for afterwards I was not allowed to speak), 'Mother, what 
            is it that wears a bush of feathers on its head, carries something 
            strange on its shoulder, has buttons that shine in the dark, and 
            smells so terribly bad—Mother, what is it?'  Mother gave me a surprised look and said, 'Why, 
            darling, that's a soldier.'  'Mother,' I asked again, 'do soldiers eat people?' I 
            wanted to know whether he really wanted to eat Sophie, or what 
            else could he have wanted?  'No, no,' mother answered laughing, 'they take care 
            of good people; don't be afraid, he doesn't want to eat you.'  I wanted to tell her that it was Sophie he wanted to 
            eat, not me, but mother kissed me, covered me up and said, 'Now, 
            just go to sleep, dear, I have to go to father.'  I lay there alone with my thoughts, and went on 
            wondering for a long time. I just could not understand what the 
            soldier could have wanted from Sophie, and why Sophie let him hold 
            her so tight that I was forced into his unpleasant presence. What 
            did this all mean? Like everything I could not understand, the 
            matter upset me. But finally I fell asleep. Next day the sun shone 
            brightly, and after I had received my bonbon, we all went down to 
            the lake to bathe and splash. On the way we met the soldier. Then I 
            saw in daylight that he was a friendly adult who spoke cheerfully 
            with father. Only I could not understand why he acted as if he had 
            never seen me before in his life. He certainly must have known what 
            happened yesterday! But I was still afraid of his gigantic moustache 
            and did not dare ask any questions ... .  Dating from this same summer there is another memory 
            that I have carried with me through the years, arising from an 
            experience that made a profound impression upon me. One 
            afternoon—father was with us and the farmers were all sitting in 
            their good clothes in front of their houses, so I knew that it was 
            Sunday—we heard the village bells ring. But their ringing was not at 
            all of the usual kind. They rang as if they couldn't stop ringing. 
            They rang and rang. Their ringing put an end to the Sunday peace and 
            quiet for the whole village. In a few minutes everyone seemed to be 
            running past our house, all going in the same direction. Then father 
            and the son of the wizened old woman ran off too; everyone was 
            carrying buckets and axes. Mother and a few other women remained 
            behind with us children, and the woman kept repeating the same 
            words: 'Oh, my Heavenly Father, do not desert us, Oh, my Heavenly 
            Father, do not desert us!' Mother, too, was very serious as she 
            said: 'We must all of us pray together that father comes back to us 
            alive.'  I asked where he had gone and why. Mother said that 
            a fire had broken out in the village, and father had gone to help 
            fight it. We prayed, but I was very curious about what 'fire in the 
            village' meant. One woman vouchsafed the information that 'the 
            tongues of flame' could be seen from the edge of our garden. I 
            wanted to go to look, but mother did not allow me. Grete, however, 
            WAS allowed to go along with the son of the owner of the nearby 
            grocery store, to look at the fire, something I considered bitterly 
            unjust. Why should she be allowed, again and again, to do things I 
            was not allowed to do, just because she was three years older? If 
            fire is dangerous, then it's just as dangerous for her as for me, 
            even if she is 'three years older'! Oh, these three years! How many 
            more times will I have to hear that she is three years older, every 
            time she is allowed to do something and I am not, and every time I 
            refuse to recognize and tolerate her authority!  Late in the evening a few men came back past our 
            house, then more and more, all exhausted from their efforts and 
            talking about how father had saved several houses, how he had defied 
            death again and again by plunging into burning houses to save 
            children or animals, and how he had been an untiring leader whom all 
            the rest of the men had obeyed. With a steady stream of inspired 
            ideas and with his unshakable courage, he set an example that others 
            followed so that everyone performed extraordinarily well and the 
            fire was finally localized. Mother listened proudly, and when father 
            finally came home with the son of the wrinkled, old farmer's wife, 
            mother threw herself into father's arms. 'Oh, you dear, dear Robert, 
            how wonderful you are! Wonderful in every way!'  Father smiled silently. He was covered with soot, 
            and withdrew quickly to wash and get cleaned up.  To me it seemed a completely natural thing that 
            father was such an exceptional person. The concept 'Father' was 
            identical in my mind with that of the 'Great Master' who was above 
            everyone and whose will everyone had to follow. His word is law, and 
            obviously he is perfect. If it were not so, he would not be the 
            'Great Master'! In those days I was only very slightly interested in 
            father. He simply meant for me an unshakable feeling of security. He 
            was no problem for me, so I paid very little attention to him. Only 
            when the whole family was out walking—father, mother, Grete and 
            I—and with his powerful hand he took hold of mine to help me across 
            a street, I noticed that his hand seemed to radiate tremendous 
            strength and that his finger nails were always as clean as fresh 
            snow. So for me it was obvious that father wanted to wash himself 
            free of soot and grime immediately.  The summer passed, and we were back at home again. 
            Once I noticed that when mother was getting me ready for a walk, she 
            bundled me up in a heavy coat and fur cap. The air outside felt as 
            if it were biting my skin. People told me that it was 'cold'. My 
            nose and my feet did not like it. But there were white flakes 
            floating down out of the sky, and everywhere in the stores there 
            were Santa Clauses with white beards. And later there came a time 
            when mother put a straw hat on my head and helped me slip into a 
            light coat. The fields and gardens were alive with flowers, and we 
            were permitted to play with our ball and our hoop in the city park.
             This was a period in my life when I could have been 
            completely happy if my mother had not made my life bitter from time 
            to time by cutting my finger nails. I was even afraid in advance 
            when I sensed that the day for trimming my nails was nearing. The 
            skin under my finger nails was so sensitive that to touch anything 
            at all after my nails were cut, even the contact with the air 
            itself, caused me terrible suffering. After each trimming I would 
            run around the room screaming, with my fingers spread apart, not 
            allowing anything to touch me. I could not say that it was pain I 
            felt. No, it was not pain, but an unbearable feeling. When mother 
            noticed it for the first time, she did not know what was wrong with 
            me. She thought she had perhaps cut me without noticing it and 
            wanted to inspect my fingers. But I yelled when she merely touched 
            me, so loud that she was frightened and called our family doctor and 
            asked him what could be the matter with me. He explained to her that 
            my nerves were over-sensitive to a very unusual degree. He advised 
            my mother to bathe my hands in lukewarm water, each time she trimmed 
            my nails, letting me splash around in the water for a while. That 
            did help somewhat, but many years were to pass before my skin was 
            strong enough for me to cut my nails without undergoing this 
            unbearable sensation.  My dear, darling mother! With how much loving 
            understanding and tenderness you tried to overcome all the 
            difficulties caused by this over-sensitivity of mine. If you had not 
            surrounded with your tender love my sensitive nerves, I would have 
            died in early childhood. Only with your help was I able to grow up 
            in health, slowly and purposefully developing resistance. The warm 
            soft nest that you and our loving, generous father built for us 
            children enabled me to become a useful person. You helped me learn, 
            through consciously developed powers, to keep my sensitivity in 
            balance. I was just a child then and had not the slightest inkling 
            about my sensitivity. I merely observed everything and wanted to 
            know everything, while with regard to my health I merely followed 
            your advice. I had perfect confidence in you!
           
             LION AND LIGHT In this way a few winters and a few summers went by. 
            Once I heard that I was four years old. Grete was already going to 
            school, and I often listened with the greatest attention to what she 
            read out of her primer. She also had a children's newspaper and read 
            me stories from it too. When she was not at home, I pestered my 
            grandmother, the mother of my father, who some time before had come 
            to live with us, and I kept on teasing her to read something to me, 
            for I was always curious as to what was going to happen next in the 
            story. I never tired of listening to what happened to people. I was 
            full of curiosity about life. It was simply marvellous to think of 
            all the things that could happen! There was just nothing I liked 
            more than fairy tales!  My Aunt Adi, the sister of my mother, visited us 
            often and was always willing to fulfil my wish. She had a pretty 
            face. She was loving and as beautiful as a cat. Her warm brown eyes 
            sparkled joyously, and she possessed a peculiar scent about her, as 
            only people do who carry love within their hearts. I enjoyed 
            breathing this wonderful 'love scent' but encountered it only with a 
            very few people. When Aunt Adi came, we surged towards her joyously, 
            helped her out of her coat, and our first word was always, 'Aunt 
            Adi, tell us a story!'  And she told us the most wonderful stories. Without 
            tiring. She could go on telling one story after another, the most 
            interesting fairy tales I ever heard. When I was sick, Aunt Adi came 
            and told me stories until I forgot all about my illness. We just 
            would not let her stop. Whenever she wanted to, we immediately began 
            to ask her, 'Aunt Adi, what happened next ... what happened then?' 
            And we kept on plaguing and pestering her till she resumed her story 
            telling. When the time came for her to go home to her mother, to my 
            other grandmother who played the piano so beautifully, I was left 
            alone with Grete and watched how she read in her book of fairy 
            tales. The fairy tales in her children's newspaper and in her 
            picture books were not nearly as nice, of course, as the stories 
            Aunt Adi told us. But still they were fairy tales and I wanted to 
            know them. I began to spend long periods intently looking at the 
            books from which Grete had learned to read. I looked at the 
            different letters in them and wanted to read. But I did not know 
            what they meant.  One night I dreamt the same dream I had had many 
            nights before, so often that by this time the whole family knew 
            about it: I was running, running with all my might and main, with a 
            lion chasing me, ready to grab me and eat me up. I was running 
            desperately, gasping for breath, along a path leading to a little 
            house. In the open doorway there was a woman who did not 
            resemble my mother, but in this dream she was my mother, 
            awaiting me with outstretched arms. I knew that if I reached her, 
            the power of the lion over me would be at an end and I would be 
            saved. Now he was so close I could feel his hot breath on my neck 
            ... his shaggy mane is almost touching me ... soon he will catch me 
            ... I run with my last ounce of energy, then suddenly feel a blow, 
            with all the strength that is left in me I cry out, 'Mother!' ... 
            Then I reach her and fall exhausted in her arms. I am saved, the 
            lion disappears, and I awaken with terrible palpitations of the 
            heart, shaking with the frightfulness of the dream. Without a 
            moment's hesitation, I jump up, throw a blanket about my shoulders, 
            and run—barefoot and in my little nightie—into my parents' bedroom 
            and crawl into bed beside my mother, under her blankets. Oh this 
            wonderful, blessed feeling of peace and security that sweeps over me 
            like a welcome wave of warm water. Mother embraces me and asks, 'The 
            dream again ... the lion again?'  'Yes,' I answer, and in her blessed presence my 
            heart stops pounding. In a few minutes I am sleeping soundly.  The next morning I wake up in my mother's bed. She 
            is gone, but her nightgown is there beside me. I quickly bury my 
            little nose in it to inhale the precious scent of mother. Father is 
            lying in his bed near by and reading the paper. That means it must 
            be Sunday, I figure out silently for myself. Mother comes in and 
            begins to talk to father. Father lays down his paper, and as luck 
            would have it, right beside me. I pick it up and start to look 
            searchingly at the many mysterious black letters on the white paper. 
            What can they mean?  'Father,' I ask, 'please tell me what these letters 
            mean.'  'Look,' father answers, 'that is an L, that is an I, 
            that is a T, and then another T, that is an L, and this last letter 
            is an E.'  'And this one here?'  'That,' says father, 'is an A, and that a D, and 
            that an S.' While I look at all these letters, something suddenly 
            seems to open up in front of my eyes like the parting of a veil, and 
            just as suddenly a flash of light seems to flood my mind, a light 
            ... a light!!! The mysterious letters reveal their meaning, and I 
            find myself reading excitedly and joyously.  'Father!—Father! It says "Little Ads", doesn't it?'
             Mother stands stock-still for sheer surprise, then 
            comes over to me, picks me up in her arms and kisses me with joyous 
            excitement. 'Why you can read!'  Father congratulates me just as he would a grown up, 
            somewhat to my embarrassment. Then Grete comes in, all happy and 
            excited too, because I can read. Soon everybody in the house knows 
            the news, and Adi, when she comes at midday, gets to hear the news 
            as soon as she opens the door.  I can read! The black letters on the white paper are 
            no longer a mystery for me. I can understand them, I can read!
             And thus began a new epoch in my life. I read 
            everything I could get my hands on, I wanted to learn, learn 
            learn! I read everything that was readable: books of fairy 
            tales, children's newspapers, school books, calendars, newspapers 
            lying on father's desk, everything ... even a magazine that some man 
            had given our maid. In it I read about such things as 'kissing', 
            'love', 'secret rendezvous', and finally about 'killing', 'murder', 
            and 'corpses'. Then, when I asked mother to explain some of these 
            strange and somewhat frightening words, she snatched the magazine 
            out of my hands, crying 'For Heaven's sake, where on earth did you 
            get that?' Then she went into the kitchen and told the maid never, 
            never, never to give me such a magazine again. Why, what a pity! To 
            this very day I do not know what happened to the beautiful countess 
            who was kidnapped in her bed at night by a man in black who carried 
            her off on his galloping horse ...  So I had to face one of the sad facts of life. 
            Whenever I was absolutely fascinated by something, my mother did not 
            like it. Little by little I came to the conclusion that it was much 
            better not to discuss the really interesting things with adults, as 
            such discussions always came out wrong. The only exceptions I found 
            were the menservants in the house. In my very rare moments alone 
            with them, I asked them questions. Somehow, I felt that they were in 
            my power. And whenever they gave me information, they did not dare 
            talk to mother about it afterwards, as they would have been the 
            first to be scolded for it.
           
             MY PARENTS ARE NOT 'MY' PARENTS I WAS about five years old when one day at lunch 
            father spoke about his 'manager'. I was always interested in 
            everything the grown-ups talked about, and so I asked straight away, 
            'Father, who is this manager?'  'The Director is the top man in the office,' he 
            answered. 'All the others have to do what he says. He is in charge 
            of the whole office.'  'But father, you don't have to obey him, do you? He 
            is not higher than you, is he?'  'Yes he is,' father answered. 'I am not a manager 
            yet, and so I have to do what he says.' And father explained to me 
            what a director or a boss is.  No! I refused to believe my ears. A manager higher 
            than father? How was that possible? Up to that time I had taken it 
            absolutely as a matter of course that the word 'Father' meant 'the 
            Great Master' over everything. He commanded everyone in the whole 
            country and was responsible for all the treasures of the empire; his 
            word was law; no one would dare speak up against him; 'He' 
            was the only being whom father occasionally asked for advice; or 
            once in a while he would discuss the affairs of the country with 
            'Him'. But that was something entirely different! 'He' 
            was not what we called a per son. If father is over and above 
            all other people, how could he possibly have a manager superior to 
            him?  Now I looked at father with the greatest attention 
            for what was perhaps the first time. And while I looked at him and 
            observed him very thoroughly, it suddenly dawned on me that this 
            person whom I loved very much was not 'my father'.  Ever since I awakened to consciousness in these 
            surroundings, I have become accustomed to the fact that I am here, 
            that this beautiful, strange blonde woman is my mother, and this 
            tall, dark, powerful man is father. Yes, here he is father, 
            but he is not my father! In my home he is not my 
            father; only here where I am now! Actually he is just as strange as 
            the strange, beautiful woman —mother; only gradually have I become 
            accustomed to them. They are pleasant people, they love me, I am 
            important to them, and by this time I have definitely come to love 
            them. But they are not my mother and my father. I have come to call 
            them 'mother' and 'father' only out of habit!  Up to that time I had never thoroughly considered 
            the situation. I accepted things just as they were, as I felt happy 
            with these people. They gave me security, they enjoyed my presence, 
            and everything I did struck them as most remarkable, charming, and 
            delightful. Under these circumstances why shouldn't I have enjoyed 
            myself in their surroundings? Even with Grete I could sometimes play 
            quite well, whenever she forgot for a moment that she was above me 
            because she was 'three years older' than I was. Yes, everything was 
            all right this way. Uncle Stefi came often, played beautiful music 
            on our piano, and showed me all kinds of attractive things. He blew 
            soap bubbles for me, and with his pocket knife he made a little 
            rattle out of a nutshell. On another occasion he made me a little 
            pig out of dried prunes and toothpicks, and once he brought me a tin 
            box full of beautiful colours and a brush.  I was, allowed to paint 
            pretty, colourful flowers in a notebook which belonged only to 
            me. This time I didn't even have to share it with Grete! Aunt 
            Adi was charming with her many jokes and fairy stories. Grandmother 
            too—my mother's mother—was so gentle, so fine and always smiled at 
            me with such a loving expression. I loved her very much. When she 
            sat down at the piano, it was a holiday for me. She delighted me 
            with heavenly music, and I was absolutely enchanted as I listened. 
            Here I was in complete agreement with my dear, tender Mother: she 
            loved music more than anything else just as I did. My other 
            grandmother was a most interesting lady. She often told me about her 
            many travels in foreign countries, and numerous times she took me 
            with her to the National Museum. There I saw splendid things. 
            Wonderfully pretty, colourful, giant butterflies which, grandmother 
            told me, lived in dome distant part of the world—strangely enough I 
            knew them well—then a number of gigantic stuffed animals. At first I 
            was terribly frightened, but grandmother calmed me.  I also enjoyed it very much when my whole family 
            showed great surprise and delight at all the things I did as a 
            matter of course, and when our relatives spoke about my 'talents'. 
            When I was four years old, mother showed me how to 'crochet' with a 
            bent needle. Then I crocheted a little dress for my doll which 
            always sat alone in its little armchair because I didn't know what 
            to do with her. She was lifeless, and I was only attracted by what 
            was alive. When I was finished with it, the little dress caused such 
            a sensation in the family that I was really amazed. If mother can 
            crochet such beautiful lace, then why is it so remarkable for me to 
            be able to crochet? My colourful flowers I painted in my notebook 
            caused so much enthusiasm in the family that father gave me a little 
            piggy bank, and from then on whenever I had painted a beautiful 
            flower, he dropped a silver coin into my bank. Oh, that was all so 
            pleasant, so very pleasant ...  But now there came this terrible surprise!—That 
            father had a manager above him!  At that very moment it became completely clear to me 
            that I was here in this environment, and that I called 
            this here 'home', and yet that I was not at home here. 
            Here I was not in my home! That was my steadfast, unflinching 
            conviction.  If I had had, at that time, my present knowledge and 
            experience in psychology, I would have immediately analysed how I, a 
            child, could get such an idea. But I was still a child, experiencing 
            everything in a child's direct way, and I was completely convinced 
            that I had been dragged away from my home by force. I naturally did 
            not know where I had come from, because, in the meantime I had 
            forgotten all about it. a3  audiofile part 3  
            
            http://galactic.no/rune/lydboker/nyeLydfiler/Elisabeth_Haich_Initiation/  starts here3 
            
          
            Who could explain it to me? Only the two 
            people who called me their child! But I knew that if I were to ask 
            questions, they would only give me once again one of their 
            characteristic 'grown-up answers' that I would not be able to 
            understand. And once again the end of the story would be, 'wait 
            until you're grown up'. Oh, how I hated that! Wait until I'm grown 
            up? Why did I have to spend all this time in darkness, in ignorance? 
            I wanted to know everything now and not 'someday'!  So I brooded over this question until evening and 
            time for me to go to bed. Then mother came and sat down on the edge 
            of my bed and asked me, 'Why are you so quiet? Why haven't you 
            played with your doll again? And why have you wandered around our 
            whole apartment day-dreaming about something? Tell me what is the 
            matter with you. You can tell me everything, and you can ask me 
            anything you want to.'  Oh, now I loved her with all my heart and with all 
            my confidence. She was delicate, sweet and beautiful. I often found 
            out that she stood up for me when somebody had criticized me; I 
            could always run to her; with her I always found a safe haven. Now 
            we were together so trustingly, and I believed that I could discuss 
            everything with her. I put my arms around her neck and asked, 
            'Mother, where did you and father get me? Where did I come from?'
             At first I saw a little surprise in her eyes; she 
            was even a little taken aback, but then she smiled lovingly and 
            said, 'There is a great lake where all little children are swimming 
            around; when two people love each other and pray to God for a little 
            child, God allows his servant, a great stork, to fly to the lake and 
            fish out the little child that God has selected for these two 
            people, take the little child on his back and fly to them. Then he 
            takes the little child in his long bill and lays it down beside the 
            woman. So the little child gets his "earthly parents" and becomes an 
            earthly child.'  At first I listened with eager attention, but then I 
            clearly realized that she was 'telling' something like Aunt Adi did 
            in her fairy tales. No! That is not the truth! She just does not 
            want to tell me the truth about how and where she and 
            father found me. I was disappointed and looked into her eyes 
            enquiringly. Then she told me I should be a good girl and say my 
            prayers after her. A moment later she said good night and left. I 
            was all alone.  From now on it became clearer and clearer to me that 
            father and mother were not my true parents and that this country was 
            not my true home. I knew that mother did not know me; I knew that 
            she did not see me. I was a stranger to her, and all these 
            people around me seemed completely strange to me. We just did not 
            understand each other. When I talked to mother about things that 
            were perfectly obvious to me, she was often so surprised and amazed 
            that she would run to father and tell him about the strange things I 
            was saying. Father too was surprised. I saw that these things were 
            new for both of them, completely strange. Later they told all my 
            relatives about my remarks and observations, and then they all 
            laughed at me. 'What a strange child!' I heard again and again. But 
            I for my part did not find myself the least bit strange; on the 
            contrary the people around me seemed strange, and even though I 
            loved them I felt myself a total stranger among them. Everything 
            seemed too little and restricted and colourless. Way down deep in my 
            subconscious I felt the overpowering conviction that only 'He'
            could understand me perfectly and I would have been happy 
            to have been living in much larger rooms, much freer and among 
            people who at the very least were similar to myself,  This feeling that I was a stranger and alone has 
            never left me all my life long; on the contrary it became clearer 
            and clearer. I tried to find some kind of contact, but in vain. 
            Mother spoke beautifully about the love of children for each other. 
            'It is so beautiful to have a sister with whom you can discuss 
            everything and in whom you can have complete confidence,' she said. 
            I determined to create such a relationship with Grete, but she did 
            not keep my confidences. She looked down upon me because she was 
            'three years older' mid when I told her something in strict 
            confidence, she ran to mother right away and told her all my little 
            secrets. Thus all my efforts in my sister's direction were 
            completely one-sided. Finally I gave up trying to establish a 
            relationship of confidence with her, and we lived side by side and 
            yet apart, like two beings come together from two separate worlds. 
            Everybody was strange to me ... strange ... everybody.  Time ran past with seven league boots and soon I was 
            six years old. Then one fine day mother took me to school. I soon 
            found myself among many children, and the feeling that I was alone 
            and strange became even stronger within me. In my family everyone 
            loved me and I loved them too. Love reigned above all, and 
            everything else came afterwards. That is why even in this 
            environment I felt at home. I had gradually become accustomed to 
            these people. But the school children were completely strange to me. 
            They understood each other very well, but in their midst I was like 
            a little freak of nature.  They were constantly amazed at me and I at them. 
            They laughed at me and that hurt me deeply. They were always talking 
            about all the things they had and showing each other all kinds of 
            things—pens, pencils or erasers—and they all wanted to have 
            something to show that the others didn't have. To me that all seemed 
            terribly boring and ridiculous. I was fascinated by books, fairy 
            tales, music and museums. The other children's eyes just popped open 
            wide when I talked about these things, and they asked me very 
            strange questions. They played with dolls and balls and hoops, while 
            I played with a prism that made the most beautiful colours in the 
            sunlight, and with a magnet that had been given me by Uncle Toni, my 
            mother's other brother. That was so mysterious! The magnet attracted 
            all my mother's needles; then her scissors got magnetized, and 
            mother had to hold down all her pins and needles to keep them from 
            jumping over to her scissors ... yes, I wanted to know about the 
            power that lay hidden in the magnet. Finally I decided that the 
            magnet surely must love the pins and needles the way my mother loved 
            us children. After all, I jumped to throw my arms around her neck 
            just like pins did with the magnet. I found that all so wonderfully 
            interesting! But the other children laughed at me. I was alone ... 
            alone.  That winter I began to take piano lessons. Whenever 
            I played the different pieces of music, I had the feeling that 
            somehow or other inside the music there were the very same kinds of 
            shapes and figures as those which Uncle Toni made with cardboard. He 
            called them 'geometrical figures'. I played one piece that just 
            seemed to bounce out tiny little cubes. Then there was another one 
            that seemed to have little points all over it, and little balls 
            climbed up all these points. Whenever I went out with mother for a 
            walk in the city park, I was always awestruck by the fountain 
            because in its main jet I saw fairies and gnomes who. danced and 
            turned and jumped. And I saw that the dancing of the water in the 
            fountain was music too. I did not hear this music with my 
            ears, no, I saw it. I knew that it was music. For me 
            that was all perfectly obvious! But the other children at school 
            laughed at me whenever I talked about it, and said that I was 
            'stupid'. I did not know why.  But the first time I heard other 
            children playing music in our music school, I was simply astonished. 
            What?—couldn't they hear how they were hurting the geometric figures 
            in the music? The teacher said they were not playing in rhythm. It 
            was just as if their heart were not beating in rhythm. And couldn't 
            they hear when they were playing wrong? Oh, it was awful when they 
            hit the wrong notes—it hurt my ears so much I wanted to scream—and 
            they didn't even notice it! I looked at these children curiously and 
            thought to myself, 'Have they no ears? How is that possible? Are the 
            other children not like myself?' I thought that every child, and 
            indeed every person, could see and hear as I did. But little by 
            little I was to learn that most children, and most other people, 
            have very different eyes and ears from mine, and that for 
            this reason they regarded me as if I were a freak of nature.  And so I was alone—more and more alone.
           
             SUNRISE IS DIFFERENT In the spring I was very pale, and mealtimes were 
            constant agony for me. I had no appetite, not even for the best 
            foods, yet mother wanted to persuade me to eat. But when I could 
            not? My only interest in the soup was to play with the blobs of 
            grease on its surface, stirring them with my spoon and trying to 
            unite the little ones into one big one. First I would get two little 
            ones to merge and then stir in another one and another until there 
            was only one big blob of grease on top of the soup. My parents did 
            not appreciate my efforts, and a number of times father sent me away 
            from the table because I was disobedient, refusing to eat my soup 
            and spinach and turnips, and because I only wanted to play with my 
            food. When father saw that his punishment left me completely 
            unimpressed and that as soon as he had taken me to my room, I busied 
            myself with the books I loved so dearly, he decided, on the advice 
            of Our doctor, to take our whole family to the seaside for the 
            summer. As soon as our spring examinations were over, we set out on 
            our journey.  We travelled through the night; mother covered us 
            with blankets and saw to it that we were warm and comfortable. I 
            fell asleep, but the strange surroundings woke me well before 
            sunrise. Father and Grete were still sleeping, but mother was awake, 
            and I asked her to let me sit next to the window. I had heard so 
            often about the beauty of sunrise that I wanted to take advantage of 
            this opportunity to see it for myself.  I sat beside the window, poked my head behind the 
            curtain and looked out. The sky was still quite dark and just 
            beginning to get light, little by little turning a dull grey. Slowly 
            the sky became quite light and I saw how our train was roaring 
            through all kinds of changing landscapes—houses, trees, and fields 
            with people and horses and cows in them ... and still the sun was 
            not yet up! How can it be light when the sun isn't up yet? That was 
            a big surprise for me, but still it was true! Then, when the sky was 
            almost as bright as day, the sun appeared on the horizon ... finally 
            it came up, and with it, the sky turned a beautiful purple red, just 
            as I had been expecting it to do, so far in vain. But this colour 
            was much more pale—as if diluted—so different from what I had 
            expected. What a disappointment! Sunrise isn't like this!  Meanwhile the others in our compartment had 
            awakened, and father asked, 'How did you like the sunrise? Now 
            you've had a chance to see it for the first time in your life. Isn't 
            it beautiful?' He smiled at me.  'No, father,' I answered disappointed and angry. 'It 
            wasn't beautiful at all! Sunrise should not be like that! It was 
            boring, it took much too long and was all spoiled because the sky 
            got light much too early ... light, but still so colourless and ugly 
            ... before the sun finally came up. No! It wasn't pretty at all! 
            Sunrise is really very different! Quite different!' And I looked off 
            in another direction, angry and dissatisfied.  Father listened to me, as he so often did, with 
            patience and close attention. In his beautiful glowing black eyes I 
            saw his interest and his usual amused expression that told me he was 
            making fun of me but still full of love and understanding. 'You 
            don't say! Sunrise is supposed to be different? You're not satisfied 
            with the sunrise? Do you mean to say that you, little upstart, are 
            not satisfied with what nature does and you want to dictate how the 
            sun is supposed to rise? How do you think you know how the sun 
            should rise when you've never in all your life had an opportunity to 
            see a sunrise? Just tell me that!' He scrutinized me and waited for 
            my answer. Then I looked at him confidently and said, 'I do not know 
            how I know, and I don't know where I've seen a sunrise before, but I 
            do know that it's not supposed to be like this! The sun should rise 
            right up out of the dark sky, and all at once everything should turn 
            light and bright ... not such a dull, boring grey ... but all red 
            and reddish-purple so that the whole sky and everything on earth is 
            flooded with red. It's supposed to be much, much more beautiful, 
            more surprising and more uplifting. I know ... I remember?  'Hmm,' said father, 'you remember?' He smiled 
            condescendingly. 'Your imagination is working overtime!' Then he 
            took the cup of coffee mother proffered him, took a sip and turned 
            again to me: 'I'm really very sorry that you weren't satisfied with 
            the sunrise. The weather is perfectly clear today, and it just 
            couldn't have been more beautiful and more colourful. But I can't 
            help it, there's nothing I can do about it.'  I didn't answer. I was angry, not only about the 
            disappointing sunrise, but especially about the fact that 
            father—when I knew exactly and remembered, yes, remembered 
            clearly!—said that 'my imagination was working overtime'. 
            Imagination is something quite different, when I think out something 
            in my mind, that is imagination. But sunrise, the real sunrise, the 
            way it should be— I didn't think that out! That was something which 
            was living in me, engraved deeply in my memory, even more deeply 
            than yesterday and everything that happened then. I was angry 
            indeed! I was always angry when I felt helplessly unable to prove 
            something that I knew for sure. I looked defiantly off in the 
            distance until all of a sudden there was a rush for the corridor and 
            father called us, 'The ocean! Children, come here quickly. There's 
            the ocean.'  We rushed to the window in the corridor, and there 
            far below, was the sea— Oh, my dearly beloved sea!  The train roared along, high up on a mountain side, 
            and down below was the vast expanse of the sea. I was all excited 
            and happy, because I knew exactly that I was acquainted with the sea 
            and that I was not seeing it for the first time. I regarded it as a 
            matter of course, something perfectly obvious, not even bothering to 
            wonder how my feeling could be possible. I looked down at it without 
            saying a word, while in my heart a happy voice was singing: 'Oh, you 
            wonderful, wonderful sea! Beloved sea, always the same, 
            understanding everything, experiencing everything and surviving 
            everything! Oh, you dear friend, you who have listened so often to 
            me tell you of my pains and joys and sorrows ... listened so 
            understandingly ... and offered me the consolation of your infinity 
            and eternity ... your uplifting consolation surpasses everything 
            human! You are here—you are here again—you are always here, 
            unchanged, and I can look into your depths again, listen to your 
            waves as they tell about eternity ...'  Father touched my shoulder and asked, 'How do you 
            like the sea? Does it suit you, or should it be different too?'  'No, father,' I answered, 'the sea is just the way 
            it should be ... but the shore? Why is there a shore all around it? 
            The sea should be unending. We shouldn't be able to see the other 
            shore!'  'Yes,' said father, 'you'll see it's that way when 
            we get down lower. Right below us now is a big bay, and that's why 
            it looks as if the sea has shores all round it. When we get down 
            lower and closer you'll see only water, open water us far as the eye 
            can reach.'  I was greatly relieved. I was enthusiastic about the 
            magnificent view, and so was my sister. At last we had found 
            something about which we were in perfect agreement. She enjoyed the 
            sea as much as I did, and later when we went hunting for mussels and 
            crabs between the rocks, we were the best of friends in every 
            respect.  We were all very happy at this beach resort. Father 
            was in good spirits and that had a stimulating effect on all of us. 
            Mother was radiant as she could be with father all day long.  One day we went into a little church which stood 
            surrounded by Cyprus trees in a beautiful garden. Mother knelt down 
            and prayed long and fervently. Father stood beside her and looked 
            very grave. Grete knelt and prayed too. I wanted to be devout too, 
            but I could not. I did not kneel because I felt no til-sire to do 
            so. I never wanted to bend my knees before visible forms! Should I 
            kneel down because others were doing it? No, certainly not! Just 
            because I wanted to be a 'good girl'? God does not need that; God 
            can see that that would not be honest. No, I did not kneel; instead, 
            I watched how the other people were praying.  After a while, when I was already getting a little 
            bored, father touched mother's shoulder. She stood up and we all 
            went out. Outside, everything was drenched in sunshine. I jumped 
            about happily and felt much closer to God in the sunshine than I had 
            in the cold church!  That evening while mother was praying with me, I 
            asked her, 'Mother, why were you praying so fervently in church?'
             'I was praying,' she said, 'that if God is going to 
            send us another little child, it may be a little brother for you.'
             I was speechless. A little brother? Maybe he would 
            be a good friend?—  Fine! That would be splendid. Then I understood why 
            mother had knelt down and prayed so intently. For a child ... that 
            made sense!  The next winter I awoke once in the middle of the 
            night. From my parents' bedroom I heard strange sounds. It was the 
            crying of a babe in arms. A few moments later father appeared, fully 
            dressed, and asked, 'Are you awake?'  'Yes, father,' said Grete and I.  'Something wonderful has happened! God has sent you 
            both a little brother.'  Oh! That was very exciting, and I wanted to go and 
            look at my little brother immediately. But father said I should wait 
            patiently until morning; then he and mother would show me the child. 
            Father was very strange. He smiled sweetly and gently and spoke in 
            such hushed and tender tones that I did not dare to contradict him.
             The next morning my maternal grandmother came in, 
            helped me to get dressed, and we both went into my parents' bedroom. 
            There lay my mother, and on a cushion in her arm, a little child 
            with black hair. I looked at it attentively and then observed that 
            it had long and very fine tufts of hair on its ears, like a little 
            monkey. Because I was freshly washed, I was permitted to stroke its 
            little fist. Everybody looked at me, and everybody was so still and 
            grave and dignified.  From then on there were three of us children in the 
            family, and I was even more alone than before.
           
             I WANT TO GET AWAY It was about this time that I met Aunt Raphaela, my 
            father's sister. She was living with her husband, Uncle Ferdinand, 
            in another city. Now they came for a visit to see the newborn baby. 
            I was greatly impressed and full of admiration for this most 
            unusual, queenly beautiful woman. She was tall like father, with a 
            figure like a Greek goddess, with a classically beautiful, noble, 
            imperturbable radiant face crowned by hair as black as ebony. Her 
            eyes too were sparkling black like father's. Her movements were 
            majestic, dignified and yet full of charm. She was the perfect 
            incarnation of all that one could call beautiful and elegant. I 
            loved her from the first moment I saw her. She loved me too and 
            often took me along when she went out shopping. Her husband was a 
            very wise and loving man. We got along well from the moment we met. 
            I was delighted to hear that we were going to spend the summer in a 
            mountain resort very near where Uncle Ferdinand and Aunt Raphaela 
            lived with their children.  The summer was beautiful, and I was often permitted 
            to go for walks in the mountains with father and Uncle Ferdinand. 
            The forests and mountain meadows were glorious, and I revelled in 
            the beauty of climbing up to a mountain vantage point and looking 
            down on towns and villages with all their tiny houses. Yes, up 
            there I was happy!—but down below, within the family circle, my 
            happiness was much less complete. Grete was very different from me 
            and always wanted to play something else, while mother busied 
            herself with our little brother. She had no time to show me how to 
            make things with my little hands, or answer my unending stream of 
            questions. The feeling that I was alone grew and took on such 
            proportions that I gradually withdrew from the others and ceased 
            participating in all they did. But mother's view was simply that I 
            was disobedient.  One evening when we were about to go to bed, mother 
            scolded me for coming in so late from the garden and for not wanting 
            to go to bed. I frowned and said nothing. But when mother went on 
            scolding me and called me a disobedient child, I flew into a tantrum 
            and said, 'I see that you don't love me at all. The best thing for 
            me to do is to run away and leave you forever.'  Mother answered angrily, 'Go ahead and run away, 
            anywhere you want!'  I ran out of the house, down the steps, through the 
            big garden, out on to the broad pathway in the forest, and headed 
            straight for the mountain. Just the day previous, I had climbed this 
            mountain with father and Uncle Ferdinand. Rather far up on the 
            mountainside, we had seen a big cave known as the 'robber's cave'. I 
            wanted to spend the night there to figure out what I should do next. 
            In the darkness I did not see the footpath, and so I beat my way 
            through bushes and trees, branches and leaves as I made a beeline up 
            the hillside towards the 'robber's cave'. Suddenly, far behind me, I 
            heard my mother's voice. She was calling my name. I stood still for 
            a moment, then resumed my noisy climb through the bushes. Mother 
            called me several times in succession; then I heard her hurrying 
            after me. Probably she heard me breaking through the bushes. She 
            reached me, grabbed me by the shoulders, and asked excitedly, 
            'Aren't you afraid a dog will bite you? Have you gone completely 
            crazy?'  I did not answer. Why should I care about dogs? I 
            would be able to defend myself, but I wanted to get away! Away to my 
            own home, where I was really at home, away from these strange 
            people, away from these strange surroundings where no one understood 
            me. People were good to me, and full of love, they wanted the best 
            for me, but they were strange, they were different from me and 
            different from the people living where I was at home.  We walked home in silence, and I was fully expecting 
            to be severely punished. To my great surprise, however, neither 
            mother nor father said a word. As mother and I came into the room, 
            father looked at me somewhat curiously and a bit amused. My only 
            punishment was that mother put me to bed and went out without saying 
            good night.  The next day my parents acted as if nothing had 
            happened. Nevertheless, I could see clearly that mother was 
            frightened at my dare-devil attitude, while father recognized and 
            respected my courage. In his eyes, I had grown in stature. But for 
            my part, I felt neither daring nor courageous. I was just the way I 
            was.  And Grete, the always obedient, always well-behaved, 
            always well-dressed, looked down on me as if I were a criminal, 
            avoiding my glance with her eyes. And I looked at her with my heart 
            full of scorn because of her cowardly obedience!  The next winter I did not go back to school, because 
            I was still very pale and because it was extremely difficult for me 
            to get up early in the morning. A tutor came to our home and tried 
            to stuff all kinds of things into my head ... things that bored me 
            terribly. Geography! Why should I have to learn things about 
            countries that I didn't know? If I want to learn about these 
            countries, I will go there when I grow up, I thought, and so I won't 
            have to study about them any more. But as long as I do not know 
            them, why should anybody want to hammer into my head what these 
            countries look like? While my tutor was talking about Paraguay, 
            Nicaragua and Venezuela, I was listening to the gas hissing gently 
            in the lamp. And when he had finished his discourse about South 
            America, I asked him whether he also heard the hissing of the gas in 
            the lamp. He answered very sweetly that I should now be listening to 
            him, not to the lamp.  'But the lamp is much more interesting,' I said.  Later he went to my mother and they talked together 
            for a long time about this strange child that was much more 
            interested in why the gas hissed in the lamp than in geography. And 
            after my tutor had left, mother gave me a long and serious 'talking 
            to' to explain to me why I should study and learn.  'All right, all right, I'll be glad to study, but I 
            want to learn different things from what you want me to,' I said. 
            Mother remained adamant and said that I would have to take the 
            school exams. That's why I would have to study the subjects provided 
            in the school curriculum. I tried to explain to her that I found 
            these studies uninteresting, while mother tried to make it clear to 
            me that I still had to study; we just did not understand each other, 
            and I was fed up. I wanted to get away! I wanted to know the truth, 
            I wanted to get back to my true parents, I wanted to live among my 
            own people where I would not have to learn such things, where I 
            could do what I wanted, where I could play, not only boring finger 
            exercises, where I would have freedom— in a word— where I would be 
            at home.  Little by little I got into the habit of sitting on 
            an armchair in the dark bathroom, with my feet hanging down, and 
            pondering in this twilight what I should do. I wanted to get away 
            from here ... and go home ... to my true home! I did not dare tell 
            this to my mother, for I knew that she would be very angry; so I 
            thought it would probably be best if I explained my decision to her 
            in a letter that I could give her at an opportune moment.  Mother was very busy with my little brother. She was 
            an enthusiastic mother who never entrusted her children to 
            strangers. She nursed, bathed and cared for all her children 
            herself. For this reason I had plenty of opportunity to write my 
            letter to her in the children's room. I wrote very politely and yet 
            very simply that I knew very well I was not her own child, that she 
            and father were not my true parents, that they had probably found me 
            somewhere and brought me home with them, an act they had probably 
            regretted as they could not love me, and this was why I would like 
            to have them take me back as fast as possible to wherever they had 
            found me. I explained to her how terribly unhappy I was here and 
            that I would not want to stay here longer for anything in the world. 
            I went on to explain that this would probably be best for her too as 
            she would soon be free, once and for all, of all the care and worry 
            I had caused her. At the bottom of the letter I wrote 'I kiss your 
            hand' and my name. My letter was finished. But I did not dare 
            deliver it. So I waited for a favourable opportunity.  One fine afternoon some of mother's friends and 
            relatives were at our house for a visit. They chatted pleasantly, 
            admired us older children and our new little brother—we three were 
            all wearing our most beautiful clothes—then went into the 
            dining-room where the table was set and coffee and cakes were 
            waiting for them. In this circle of ladies, my mother was really 
            charming, sitting at the end of the table, as was her habit. She was 
            radiantly beautiful, gay and full of peace and I thought that this 
            at last was the moment to give her my letter. She would surely not 
            be angry now. I waited until all the ladies had drunk their coffee 
            and then stole up behind my mother's chair. While she was chatting 
            with her neighbour, I reached around her waist and dropped my letter 
            in her lap. Mother noticed me immediately when I slipped into the 
            room, because she did not like to have us children mixing with 
            adults. We were supposed to stay in the children's room and come out 
            only when we were called. Busy as she was with her guests, she was 
            not able right away to ask me what I wanted. When I slipped the 
            letter into her lap, she looked at me in wide-eyed surprise, put the 
            letter into her pocket and went on chatting with her guests as if 
            nothing had happened. I was very pleased to have picked such an 
            opportune moment!  But that evening after the guests had left and 
            father had come home, the storm broke. A storm that I had not 
            expected! Mother was really very frightened and unusually excited. 
            She gave father my letter and, all shaken and unstrung, said to him, 
            'This child is certainly quite insane; look what she has written 
            me'. Then turning to me she poured out her wrath, 'Just wait, young 
            lady, if we are not good parents for you we can be quite different. 
            Then you will have different parents, and believe me you will regret 
            it!'  Father read my letter with great interest, and I 
            noticed that he found it very entertaining. It was generally very 
            hard to upset father, and he was certainly not upset about my 
            letter. He looked at me quizzically and asked 'What do you mean by 
            saying you want to get back to your "true" parents? Who do you think 
            your "true" parents are? And where are they? You silly little 
            girl!'—and that was the end of the matter as far as father was 
            concerned.  On the other hand, mother was very excited, and for 
            days she talked with grandmother, Aunt Adi, and Uncle Stefi about my 
            letter, even showing it to my father's best friend, our family 
            doctor. Our doctor was a very profound and thoughtful man, highly 
            educated in the sciences, a friend and adviser to all the members of 
            our family in all matters affecting body and soul. Mother was very 
            bitter about my attitude and told him that, as he well knew, our 
            whole family was doing everything possible to make me happy and that 
            I was an ungrateful child, because in spite of all my family was 
            doing for me, I still wanted to run away and leave them.  'And where do you want to go, you crazy little 
            child, just tell me where you want to go?' she asked again and 
            again. But that was something I didn't know myself, a question I 
            would have liked to have mother and father answer for me! I 
            wanted to know about the place where they had found me, the place 
            from which they had brought me! Our family doctor, with his peaceful 
            blue eyes, looked at me searchingly and asked me very earnestly, 
            just as he would have asked a grown-up, 'What did you mean by that, 
            child, tell me frankly just what you meant.'  But I could not and would not talk any more about 
            it. I just wanted to go back, back to where I had come from, to 
            where they had brought me from! Where I was at home, where I would 
            again be among people like myself.  But I realized that I could not yet reach my goal. I 
            was going to have to stay here. I realized that these people knew 
            just as little, or perhaps even less, about my origin than I did. So 
            I could not expect to have them help me find the solution to this 
            puzzle. With my questions I had only offended and frightened them. I 
            realized that my letter had been a big disappointment to my mother, 
            and I didn't want that! I went back to the children's room where I 
            found Grete looking down to avoid meeting my glance ... to avoid 
            having to look at such a villainous little child. I felt as if I 
            were a criminal. No, the whole question was quite hopeless! I never 
            spoke about the matter again. Little by little the family forgot the 
            whole matter, and little by little there sank down upon my soul a 
            veil that kept getting thicker and thicker. I wanted to avoid 
            thinking any more about my true homeland, as it appeared quite 
            impossible to find out any details about it.  It was around this time—I was just seven—that father 
            one mealtime said something about the human being as the 'crown of 
            creation'.  'How do you mean that, father?' I asked.  'Just that man is the most perfectly developed 
            creature on earth. There is nothing higher.'  I was simply amazed. How can it be possible, I 
            thought, that father who has such a brilliant mind, who knows all 
            the answers, and who always comes out on top in any debate—doesn't 
            know that over and above the human being there are ... what should I 
            actually call them? ... titans or giants—not in physical size but in 
            knowledge and power—towering up above us human beings, guiding us 
            with their powers, and helping us forward on the pathway of our 
            development?  I glanced at father to see whether perhaps he did 
            not want to speak about these superior beings, or whether he 
            actually did not know anything about them. I observed his face and 
            saw that he was completely convinced as he spoke about Man as the 
            crowning achievement of nature. I did not dare ask any further 
            questions, as somehow or other it was deeply impressed upon me that
            'He' did not like to have me speak about secret things with 
            ignorant people. One must be able to keep silence.  But a moment later I started up as if shocked. 
            'He?'—who is this one whose very existence I take for 
            granted, believing as a matter of course that 'He' is always 
            with me, that 'He' always stands behind me ready to help? Who 
            is this 'He' to whom I look up so humbly, to whom I flee for 
            refuge whenever I feel alone or misunderstood ... from whom I can 
            always expect absolute love and understanding ... who never judges 
            or condemns me but always listens to me first, always taking me 
            seriously, always helping me onward and never ... never ... never
            deserting me. Who and where is 'He'? And as 
            I was seeking the answer to this question, there suddenly appeared 
            before my mind's eye two dark blue, all-loving, all-knowing, 
            almighty eyes, eyes as immensely deep and infinite as the canopy of 
            Heaven itself ...  I want to cry out His name, but the letters are 
            buried too deeply in my memory, my thinking is not clear enough to 
            draw them out of myself, up to the surface. Then suddenly I notice 
            that I am sitting at our family table, that mother is sitting at one 
            end of the table, with my little brother on her lap, as she spoons 
            bits of porridge into his open mouth ... and my vision disappears.
             All afternoon I sit at my little writing table, 
            trying to force my mind to bring forth out of the unconscious part 
            of myself the memories that are there, that I just cannot quite 
            grasp. Sometimes blurred and misty pictures rise up before me. I 
            want to seize them, but they disappear again immediately ...  But one thing did become clear for me: in all the 
            time that I have been conscious on this earth, I have always carried 
            within me the picture of someone whom, simply and in a very matter 
            of fact manner, I have called 'Him'. 
           
             I LONG FOR UNITY One day mother received an invitation to visit a 
            cousin who, with her husband and sons, had moved away to live in the 
            city. The whole family came out of the house to welcome us. The two 
            boys eyed us critically, and we two girls gave them a thorough 
            inspection, all in silence until our aunt sent us into the 
            children's room.  Suddenly we found ourselves in a little boy's world. 
            They had a train that ran on a track, a little printing press, and a 
            magic lantern. Everything impressed me greatly, but what excited me 
            most was the fact that the boys had many many books. All books by 
            Jules Verne! We had a grand time, and it was late in the evening 
            before we went home. Our two families got along together quite 
            harmoniously, and from then on we saw each other every week. These 
            afternoons were pleasant and enjoyable, and the boys were well 
            brought up and happy.  Under the influence of what I had once read in a 
            book, I was always seeking a kind of eternal unity in friendship', 
            but my girl friends in school made fun of me. They were not 
            interested in such 'stupid' things. Now I suggested to the boys that 
            we make a 'pact of eternal friendship'. They found it a splendid 
            idea. However, the younger boy, who had a strong will and was thus 
            inclined to be the ring-leader, said that we would each have to show 
            our signature. So each one of us was obliged to write his name on a 
            piece of paper. The two boys and Grete wrote their names with the 
            first letters very big and provided with all kinds of fancy twists; 
            the remaining letters they wrote as illegibly as possible, finishing 
            off with an impressive curlicue. I found all these embellishments 
            superfluous and wrote my name with simple, clearly legible letters.
             After looking at the signatures, the younger boy 
            turned to me with his voice full of scorn, 'What? You want to enter 
            a pact of eternal friendship, you want to be a member in an alliance 
            of friends and you don't even have a decent signature? You can't 
            join our friendship alliance until you have a decent signature!' 
            Whereupon the two boys and Grete formed their pact for 'everlasting 
            friendship in life and death'.  I was profoundly disappointed, defeated, dejected.
             No sooner had I reached home and hung up my hat and 
            coat, than I began to practise my 'signature'. I wrote my name a 
            thousand times, beginning the first letter with a gigantic curve and 
            scribbling off the remaining letters in a completely illegible 
            manner. I attempted to imitate the signature of our family doctor 
            who wrote such completely illegible prescriptions. Then I finished 
            my work of art with a long line that wove back and forth across the 
            page. It was artificial. It was anything but true and real. But the 
            next Saturday I was able to greet my two friends proudly; 'Now just 
            look at what I have ... Now I have a signature too!' With that, I 
            scribbled a most impressive signature on a piece of paper.  The two boys and Crete examined my work of art; then 
            the younger said, 'Good. Your signature is still too legible, 
            but we're going to accept it anyway and take you in as a member in 
            our alliance.'  I expected to be happy now that my wish was 
            fulfilled, but strangely enough I could not. No! Something was not 
            as it should be. And back home, standing before the mirror and 
            looking face to face at the 'invisible'—myself—I heard a voice 
            within me: 'Your signature was false. It was not your picture. Do 
            you believe that you can obtain true things through false
            things? True friendship with a false signature? People who 
            cannot accept your true signature cannot be your true friends ...'
             I turned away from the mirror sadly and went to bed. 
            I could no longer use the signature I had practised so long. I was 
            revolted by it. I knew that this 'eternal friendship in life and 
            death' was just as artificial a thing as my 'signature' and that 
            these two boys hadn't the vaguest idea about the kind of friendship 
            I was seeking—real, true, eternal friendship that stands over time 
            and space! And I was alone in my search for true friendship, my 
            search for true unity ... alone ... alone.
           
             THE RED MAN At the age of nine I was greatly shaken by an 
            experience which stands out starkly in my memory. My little brother, 
            whom I dearly loved, was just two. He fell sick, but our doctor 
            could not diagnose the cause of his suffering. I was in the room 
            where he was lying in bed, with mother sitting beside him. All of a 
            sudden, the child started up out of a sound sleep, wide-eyed with 
            fright as it stared in the direction of the door and called out, 
            'Mother, Mother, the Red Man ... the Red Man is coming to get me!' 
            The child waved his tiny hands as if he were fighting someone off, 
            and then screamed at the top of his lungs, 'Mother! Help! The Red 
            Man!' ... and fell over in a faint.  Mother sprang up, caught him in her arms, laid him 
            gently back into bed, and immediately sent for the doctor. While we 
            were waiting, I asked, 'Mother, who was this Red Man he saw?'  Mother answered, 'Nothing real, darling. He's just 
            seeing things ... hallucinations ... in his fever.'  When the doctor came, he found the child had 
            pneumonia.  Poor dear mother! Three weeks long she carried the 
            child day and night in her arms, not sleeping and not leaving him 
            alone for a moment. I was aghast as I watched the fearful struggle 
            my brother was making for his life and mother was making to save her 
            only son. It was perhaps the first time in my life I opened my heart 
            all the way for mother; and perhaps it was the first time in my life 
            I saw that, through and through, her heart was made of a fabric of 
            love. I too lived through this period in fear and trembling for the 
            life of my brother, and from this time on I felt I really belonged 
            to my family. When he finally returned to health, I took my full 
            part in the family rejoicing. At last I had begun to feel 'at home' 
            in this place.  But I did not forget the 'Red Man'. Mother tried to 
            reassure me in vain that it had not been something real. My brother 
            had seen him—something had caused him to see a red man—and that was 
            not supposed to be something real? What my brother had seen remained 
            an open question for me, one I pondered long and often. At that time 
            I could not dream that I would someday—many, many years later—find 
            the answer in India.  A year later we moved to another part of the city 
            where there were many trees and where the houses were surrounded by 
            beautiful gardens. From the windows of our new home we could look 
            out in every direction towards hills and mountains.  I went back to school, and once again the old story 
            began for me. The other girls in school were as amazed at me as I 
            was at them. They played with dolls, and that bored me stiff. And I 
            read books they thought were just as dull. The older I grew, the 
            more feverishly I read. Not only the books we children received, but 
            all the books in my father's library. There I found a set of volumes 
            which caused me to begin reading even more avidly than I had before. 
            The complete works of Shakespeare! I devoured one book after the 
            other. They made such a profound impression upon me that I just 
            could not stop reading. All day long I could think of nothing else. 
            I acted like a sleepwalker. At mealtimes I did not even hear what 
            people said to me. I was still reenacting the fate of the hero and 
            heroine of the particular tragedy or comedy I had just been reading. 
            First I read all the tragedies, one after the other, living in a 
            state of deep emotional turmoil. Then came all the comedies, which 
            kept me rocking back and forth on our sofa out of pure amusement.
             Along with Shakespeare, there was another set of 
            thick books entitled Ethnographical Research which meant much 
            to me. There I found descriptions of all kinds of rituals in the 
            field of superstition and black magic. In these volumes I read 
            things that were startlingly new and difficult to understand: 
            superstitions about love, recipes for brewing love potions, and 
            other obscure rites having to do with love and sex. After spending 
            quite a time reading some of the most fantastic things I fired some 
            questions at mother.  'Mother,' I asked, 'Can you make someone love you by 
            taking a yellow turnip, boring a hole through it from top to bottom, 
            spitting through the hole three times, then taking the turnip out at 
            midnight and throwing it over the house of the person you love? And 
            is it true that if you take a piece of a girl's nightdress, burn it 
            and bake the ashes in a cake, the person who eats the cake will fall 
            in love with the girl who owns the nightdress and do anything she 
            wants him to?'  Mother let me finish asking questions, while the 
            expression on her face changed from amazement to horror. Finally she 
            burst out, 'For goodness' sake! Where did you hear all this terrible 
            nonsense? Have you been talking to the washwoman? How often have I 
            forbidden you to talk over delicate questions with the cook or the 
            washwoman! Where have you heard all this fearful black magic 
            nonsense? Tell me right away!'  'Mother,' I answered, supremely certain of my 
            innocence. 'Don't get excited. These things cannot be so fearful if 
            a scientist spends his time investigating them. I read them in 
            scientific books, in the Ethnographical Research books, in 
            father's library.'  That was enough to set mother scurrying to father's 
            bookcase which she promptly locked, withdrawing the key and keeping 
            it. From then on I was allowed to read only what she gave me. In 
            order to obtain otherwise inaccessible information, I asked mother 
            from time to time to let me have a volume of the encyclopaedia in 
            which to read up on some plant or animal we were studying in school. 
            And I saw to it that this volume contained the particular word that 
            interested me much more than the plant or animal. Then I went into 
            the children's room and thoroughly studied the things I wanted to 
            know. Thus with mother's express permission—and assistance!—I read 
            item after item of prohibited information, while mother lived on in 
            blissful ignorance of the true objects of my attention. Even better, 
            mother herself had tipped me off to the fact that I could learn all 
            kinds of exciting things about superstition from our washwoman. As 
            fast as I possibly could I sought out opportunities for clandestine 
            conversation with her. Thus I came to hear some of the most horrible 
            stories about ghosts, superstitions, and witchcraft until I got into 
            such a state of fear that I no longer dared enter a dark room alone. 
            Then Uncle Stefi asked me once why I was afraid.  'Because I might see a ghost,' I said.  'Oh, so that's it! Want to know an easy way to 
            defend yourself? ... Just whistle real loud, and all the ghosts will 
            scamper away instantly,' he answered.  From then on I was constantly whistling, while at 
            the same time delving further into ghost stories. Thus, on the one 
            hand, I extended my knowledge about the lowest levels of mysticism, 
            and on the other, developed an above-average ability for whistling.
           
             MY FUTURE APPEARS We spent that summer on the great inland lake, where 
            we lived together with some of our relatives. This particular summer 
            stands out strongly in my memory because of events I had to think 
            back upon much, much later.  Mother was still very busy with my little brother, 
            and so I had a bit more freedom. In the company of a girl friend of 
            my own age, I was allowed to roam about the village and nearby park 
            and meadows. Mother thought I was going to my friend's house, while 
            her mother thought she was coming to mine. Instead, we rambled 
            around the village and its environs, trying to satisfy our girlish 
            curiosity. On the lakeshore there was a row of villas, and we 
            watched a gypsy boy go up to each villa in turn, play a few tunes on 
            his violin, and hold out his hand for money. It suddenly struck me 
            that my grandmother earned a lot of money by giving concerts, and I 
            wondered whether I too could earn some money. My little girl friend 
            always did blindly whatever I told her to do; so we two went up to 
            each villa, straight up to the porch or into the garden wherever the 
            people were sitting, and I recited a poem. The people were very 
            surprised, but when my friend made the rounds holding out a plate, 
            everybody dropped some coins in it, some more, some less. All of 
            them had a hearty laugh at our expense, and one lady asked whether 
            my mother knew what I was doing.  'No,' I answered, 'this is our private enterprise. 
            Mother doesn't know about it.'  'Just as I thought,' said the lady, 'why don't you 
            two children run along home now.'  The promising business venture came to an end that 
            very day. After we had divided the money between us, I went home and 
            told how I had earned some money, proudly displaying the many coins 
            of nickel and copper. Mother almost fainted.  'For goodness' sake!' she whooped, 'Where in the 
            world did you get such an idea? What will people think? You're 
            plunging us into shame!'  'Why?' I asked. 'Grandmother earns money with her 
            performances. The little gypsy boy earned money too. So what's so 
            shameful about my earning money reciting poetry?'  'Just try to understand, you stupid little ninny,' 
            my mother answered, 'that your father has a high position with a 
            nation-wide reputation, and you just cannot do such things!'  'What does father have to do with what I do? Father 
            is father, and I am I. I don't have a high position, so why 
            shouldn't I earn some money? Every job is decent if one just does it 
            decently. And I really recited very beautifully!' I ended my 
            argumentation proudly.  Mother snorted angrily, 'You just don't understand. 
            And as punishment for doing such things and for contradicting me, I 
            am not going to let you leave the garden!'  Thus I came to lose my liberty, but the episode had 
            further consequences. My great-uncle, who had rented the other half 
            of the villa for himself and his family, was a loving person blessed 
            with a magnificent sense of humour. When he heard that I had recited 
            poetry in the villas along the shore, he wanted to hear me too. Our 
            two families took all our meals together, and that evening my 
            great-uncle suggested that I recite something after supper. I had no 
            objections. The grown-ups all sat in a circle, while I stood in the 
            centre and started reciting some poems I had learned at school. My 
            great-uncle liked them and wanted to hear more.  'But I don't know any more,' I said.  'Then tell us something, anything you want.'  'Can I tell you a story out of the book I got as a 
            prize for my good exams?' I asked.  'Surely,' said my great-uncle, 'go ahead.'  I began to tell stories from The Vicar of 
            Wakefield. But I didn't content myself with just telling them, I 
            acted them out as if I were on stage. In this way I gave an animated 
            story about how the vicar of Wakefield led a holy life, how a young 
            man got acquainted with his daughter, Olivia, and finally ran off 
            with her. I hadn't the vaguest idea of what it meant to run off with 
            somebody that way, and sol didn't know why the vicar was so excited. 
            I was merely telling the story in the way I read it in the book. 
            Continuing with my improvised one-person drama, I told about the 
            lovers' tryst in the darkness and the sweet and tender words they 
            whispered to each other, how the vicar bellowed with rage and 
            reached for his gun, and finally how his gentle wife calmed him 
            down, by slipping a Bible into his hand ...  By this time the grown-ups were all doubled up with 
            laughter, and when I was ready to stop, my great-uncle insisted he 
            wanted to hear more about the vicar. There was nothing for me to do 
            but go on, and that made them laugh some more. They laughed as if I 
            had been telling the funniest stories in the world. And here I was 
            telling a tragedy!  When I was through, my great-uncle took me by the 
            hand and pulled me over to where he was sitting. 'Tell me where you 
            heard all these stories,' he asked.  'Yes,' echoed mother, 'that's just what I'd like to 
            know too!'  'From the book I got in school as a prize,' I 
            answered.  'Amazing!' said mother, somewhat vexed, but still 
            laughing, 'How can these people in school give such books to a 
            child?'  'Forget it, Lilian,' said my great-uncle, 'they 
            certainly didn't read the book themselves, and undoubtedly they 
            thought that a book about a vicar is bound to be full of holy and 
            harmless things. They didn't realize that Ministers of the Gospel 
            sometimes have daughters. Just relax, Lilian, and let her tell us 
            some more stories another time. What she's got in her head you can't 
            get out again anyway. And I haven't had such a good laugh in a long 
            time!'  From then on I had to give a performance every 
            evening. In addition to our family circle, my audience soon began to 
            include friends from the neighbourhood who came to hear me tell the 
            stories I had been reading in books. These included some of 
            Shakespeare's tragedies, and once again I could not understand what 
            there was in these profoundly tragic scenes that struck the 
            grown-ups as funny. Despite their hilarity I put on the scene in 
            which King Lear, alone and deserted, lets out his last dying 
            gasps—and the grown-ups were in stitches! ... In Richard III 
            I went through the scene in which everybody dies one after the 
            other, one in one way, the next in another, and I demonstrated 
            how;—by this time the grown-ups were practically splitting their 
            sides. How, I wondered, can people laugh at such tragic events where 
            so many people die? That's not funny! That's horrible, I thought, as 
            I went on with my act in deadly earnest.  How often—how very often—I was to think back in 
            later years about that little girl who was so serious and so 
            convinced of herself as she told stories and put on an act. My later 
            destiny in life had already come into evidence. Even at that early 
            age, I had become accustomed to bringing things forth out of my 
            inner world—beautiful, divine, true things—irrespective of whether 
            my audience understood my truths or not. I speak for the sake of 
            truth itself, and only one listener is important: God! 
             * * *  Summer went by, and we came home. That winter I 
            decided to stop wearing little-girl clothes and to dress as a clown. 
            I just could not get over the feeling that I was not the person I 
            was, and that I was really someone else. Even though I had stopped 
            talking about it, I had not got over this feeling. On the contrary, 
            it had merely worked its way deeper down inside me and was active in 
            my subconscious. I begged and kept on begging till my good-hearted 
            mother could not say 'No' any longer. With her own hands she made me 
            a real clown costume, a pretty one. She even bought me two colourful 
            clown caps, and from then on I went around in this attire. I derived 
            tremendous enjoyment from exercising on a trapeze and flying rings, 
            imitating at home everything I had seen in the circus. Hanging head 
            down and seeing the world upside down, I felt free.  At that time I did not yet know that psychologists 
            call the clown a 'person changing type'.  Along with my amateur circus acrobatics, I acquired 
            the habit of assuming strange and unusual body postures. At first my 
            parents were surprised and laughed at me; then soon our relatives 
            and friends were amused and entertained at the 'comical' positions 
            into which I put various parts of my body. Wherever I went, I was 
            asked to demonstrate these postures. I did them instinctively, 
            without thinking at all why I did them. I merely noticed that they 
            made me feel good, that in certain positions I could study better, 
            and that when I was tired I could feel surprisingly fresh again in 
            only a very few minutes by virtue of having sat in certain other 
            positions.  The rest of the family laughed about my 'crazy' 
            habit and mother gradually got used to seeing me in some impossible 
            position whenever she came into her room. At first she lectured me 
            about how a 'good girl' has to sit on a chair and must not stand on 
            her head or twist her legs into impossible positions or hang her 
            legs over her shoulders. In due course, however, she left me in 
            peace with this new idiosyncracy of mine.  For me these different body postures were a matter 
            of course. They were in my blood, I enjoyed them even without 
            thinking about them much, and I was only amazed, once again, that 
            the people around me were so surprised about something so obvious. 
            Once while our whole family was visiting Aunt Raphaela for several 
            weeks of summer holidays we had a visit from a gentleman who had 
            spent many years travelling in the Far East, and who—as Uncle 
            Ferdinand informed us—could tell all kinds of interesting stories 
            about these far-away places. We children were introduced to the man 
            and, as usual, our parents told him what we could do. Aunt Raphaela 
            laughingly told him about my remarkable habit of assuming strange, 
            leg-twisting postures which nobody else could imitate, except 
            perhaps an India rubber man.  I lay down on the floor, and as I was always 
            embarrassed when people were talking about me—feeling uncomfortable 
            about merely 'protruding' above ground—I assumed a position in which 
            I could completely conceal my head, giving spectators the illusion 
            of its having been cut off. The grown-ups laughed. Then I 
            demonstrated a few other 'difficult' postures that I enjoyed so 
            much. Our strange guest watched my performance for a while without 
            cracking a smile and finally burst out in astonishment, 'But this 
            child is doing typical Yoga exercises! Where did you learn 
            them, little girl?' He turned to me.  I did not know what the word 'Yoga' meant; so I 
            answered that no one had shown me these exercises and that I did 
            them just because I liked them and felt better afterwards. The man 
            refused to believe it, looking at me long and enquiringly, 
            and shaking his head.  The grown-ups' questions had already begun to bore 
            me; so when mother waved us off, we disappeared into the children's 
            room, and I promptly forgot the remarks made by our distinguished 
            visitor.  Only much, much later, when the memory suddenly came 
            to life and I began to understand many other things which had been 
            obscure and inscrutable in my life, I remembered the remarks of the 
            widely-travelled gentleman from the Far East ... . Then I understood 
            where I had learned these physical postures which I had practised as 
            a child and later as an adult ... postures our distinguished visitor 
            had called 'Yoga exercises'. Then I realized clearly that I had done 
            these exercises out of long-standing habit, because I had 
            been obliged to practise them daily in the temple year after year. 
            These exercises were a reflection of my past and at the same time 
            the shadow of events yet to come in my life; for much later, as an 
            adult, I taught these exercises to many people in order to further 
            their mental and physical development.
           
              STRUGGLES OF LOVE The years passed rapidly. As I grew my body began to 
            mature. I enjoyed reading books that dealt with love stories and 
            problems of love; so I delved deeper and deeper into my personality. 
            I looked forward into the future and determined to find a 
            noble-spirited husband who would understand me perfectly. In this 
            way I began to concern myself less with books and more and more with 
            young people, later with young men. The young men were also 
            interested in me. Mother tried in vain to bring me up as a modest 
            young lady. Even in my earliest years I had to realize that I 
            possessed a power of attraction. However, in my blindness, I 
            considered that this power which drew so many people towards me was 
            an attractiveness emanating from my person. We always have to pay 
            for our spiritual deficiencies, and because of my being blinded to 
            the truth at this age, I was later to have to pay the price of 
            almost becoming physically blind. I had yet to learn that my power 
            of attraction was not intended to serve my private life, but rather 
            to lead the people following me along the path of their salvation.
             At that time, however, my whole thinking centred 
            around my personality, and I believed I would find my highest 
            happiness in the love of man and wife. I thus went through many of 
            the experiences that are usual in this world. I was loved and fell 
            in love, but all my joys and sorrows were merely a prelude to my 
            later destiny.  A relationship with one man in particular dominated 
            the six years of my life from the age of thirteen until I was 
            nineteen, and looking at it in retrospect I would call this whole 
            experience a 'training school for the development of unusually 
            strong will-power'. My destiny knew that I was going to need this 
            weapon in life. When I was thirteen, I met a young man whose 
            brilliant traits made him stand out high above the average. His 
            character was made up of a purposeful and determined striving for 
            the highest and finest and most beautiful things in life, combined 
            with an almost pathologically acute egotism and desire for power. He 
            loved me, so he said, but he loved himself and wanted to make me his 
            obedient slave. He recognized very early that we both had the same 
            spiritual viewpoint and that art meant the same to me as it did to 
            him. This led him to believe that he had found in me a partner 
            worthy of himself. He hoped, in time, to make me over into his own 
            image—a highly cultured but absolutely obedient wife. He thought he 
            would do away completely with my independent thinking. He brought me 
            excellent books about art, the history of art, music, world history, 
            the best works of literature—both modern and classical—and he 
            insisted that I read these works in the original. Since I found 
            learning languages just for their own sake extremely boring, he took 
            the time to learn languages with me. Then he sought out the best 
            piano teacher for me. In short he did everything imaginable to help 
            me get an unusually good education. Mother saw in him a helpful 
            angel for my education, because languages were really hard for me. 
            The best tutors tried in vain to teach me; I refused to learn long 
            lists of words by heart. This young man brought me German, French, 
            and English newspapers, magazines, and theatrical works, then read 
            them with me, thus helping me to work my way into various languages. 
            That was very helpful and certainly all to the good, but along with 
            his helpfulness he kept trying consistently and purposefully to 
            force me under his domination. Shortly after we got acquainted, he 
            said that I was going to become his wife and he wanted me to 
            consider myself as his property. Everything I wanted to read 
            I had to show him first to get his permission. He refused to let me 
            make friends with anybody at all without his prior permission. Like 
            other young girls, I went to a dancing school with my sister. I was 
            passionately fond of dancing and equally fond of having a good time 
            with the other young people in the class. I also enjoyed 
            ice-skating. None of these things had any appeal for him. But I was 
            young and I wanted to dance and skate and have a good time with 
            other young people. This made him jealous—and to a degree far 
            surpassing anything one might consider normal. Worst of all, his 
            jealousy went hand in hand with an almost insatiable desire for 
            power.  At first I was flattered that a man who was so well 
            known and highly esteemed by so many people should have chosen a 
            little girl like me as his future wife. He was a brilliant talker, 
            and quite often I enjoyed conversations with him tremendously. I was 
            also pleased that he took the same profound and serious views of 
            friendship and love that I did. On the other hand, when I began to 
            feel he was systematically and consistently trying to force his will 
            upon me, more and more, like a band of steel, all his attentions 
            became annoying. A struggle began, a terrible struggle between the 
            invisible forces of two souls! The more he felt I was growing out of 
            his power, the more firmly he sought to hold me. When I was 
            seventeen, he wanted us to announce our engagement publicly. He sent 
            his father to visit mine. My father was not exactly delighted. A 
            long time afterwards, he told me he had never been impressed by my 
            fiance's aggressive approach, but he didn't want to interfere with 
            our free will. He respected everybody's right to make up his own 
            mind— including his own children—and so he gave his consent, even 
            though reluctantly. I hoped my fiance's jealousy would die down 
            after our betrothal. As time went on, however, and my body continued 
            to develop in form and charm, his jealousy knew no bounds, and he 
            often made terrible scenes.  After torturing me for hours, he often 
            went to the opposite extreme, asked me for forgiveness on his knees, 
            cried like a baby, begged for my love, and promised never to torture 
            me again. I found such scenes absolutely unbearable. Never before in 
            my young life had I experienced any such thing. My father possessed 
            tremendous power, a kind of power which he radiated about him 
            automatically and unintentionally. He never tried to force his will 
            upon others. He liked to leave everybody his freedom and never 
            expected others to follow and obey him blindly. At that time he was 
            holding a top-level position, and my little-girl wish had already 
            been fulfilled for quite a period—he no longer had a manager or 
            director supervising him. Even so, he was never domineering or 
            tyrannical towards his subordinates. He was like a tower of strength 
            for all around him, both at home and in his office. Hundreds of 
            subordinates and all our relatives sought his counsel. He was just, 
            generous, and always ready to help. No wonder I had grown up 
            thinking that all men were like him. At home I had never known such 
            things as egotism and unscrupulousness, and my sister and I had both 
            grown up in a healthy atmosphere of true, selfless, love. I could 
            not have known what sadism and masochism were any more than I could 
            have understood—let alone bear—all the quarrels I got involved in 
            with my fiance. I wanted to be free! Free!  For a long time, however, I could not resist his 
            will. An innate propensity towards faithfulness, together with an 
            understanding approach towards the weaknesses of other people, also 
            kept me for quite a time from taking action. But my will power 
            developed with the years, and all of a sudden I began to ask myself 
            why I should go on enduring this torture.  One day I told him I wanted to be free. He would not 
            hear of it. We struggled desperately, for his will still held me in 
            a grip of steel. The longer I struggled, the more my will power 
            developed, until finally it was greater than his. The moment finally 
            came when I had enough courage to tell him I no longer wanted to be 
            his wife. More stormy scenes followed, but their effect was 
            completely lost on me! I was sorry for him, but at the same time I 
            had lost all respect for him because of his behaviour, so 
            domineering and tyrannical on the one hand, and so extremely 
            cowardly on the other. In those days I did not know that these two 
            characteristics are very closely related, so closely in fact as to 
            be two complementary aspects of the same disease. On the other hand, 
            I felt him to be sick in his soul, and I wanted absolutely to be 
            free. With a last great effort I shook off his will.  I spoke to my parents. They were not surprised. And 
            one fine afternoon when I was nineteen I set out on a journey with 
            my cousin to his mother, my father's sister, beautiful Aunt 
            Raphaela.  I broke my engagement ...    
             FIRST ENCOUNTER WITH DEATH Ever since my childhood days, I had often become 
            pale and tired around springtime. In most cases, the best remedy was 
            to visit my Aunt Raphaela. She lived in the mountains with her 
            family, and the combination of the bracing mountain air and the 
            atmosphere of wisdom and religion these people lived in always cured 
            me very quickly. I felt very happy in these quiet and noble 
            surroundings and would come home, fresh and full of new energy and 
            vitality.  After my engagement had been dissolved, I went again 
            to see my aunt. At that time, she was already a widow and was living 
            with her daughter. She welcomed me with great affection, and I fully 
            enjoyed the long desired peace and tranquillity. I felt like a kite 
            with a broken string—soaring up into infinity. What a wonderful 
            spring it was! As usual, my aunt understood me perfectly. She 
            expressed her views upon my decision with great insight; afterwards, 
            she never mentioned the matter again. In her home I lived in 
            absolute freedom. She let me come and go as I liked. I could roam 
            through the hills and woods and enjoy nature to the full. During 
            this period when I felt completely happy in my freedom and looked 
            towards the future with confidence, I encountered death for the 
            first time in my life!  While hiking one day I came to a field of grain. As 
            my plans for marriage had recently been blasted, I stopped there and 
            tried to picture my future. First of all, I was going to be a 
            pianist, I told myself, like my grandmother. Then I'd get married to 
            a healthy, happy, normal husband and have children. Then the 
            children would grow up, and I might even have grandchildren. And 
            then what? Then I'd grow old. And then? ... Then one day I'd have to 
            die.  Death! That is the end, the aim, the 
            direction in which we all go. But why? Why all this trouble? Why 
            should I practise at my piano and become a great artist? Does it 
            really make any difference, whether these bones, covered with skin, 
            ever glide over the keys with great proficiency? If human beings 
            have to die anyway some day, does it matter what they have made out 
            of their lives? Whether they have been famous and brilliant or 
            unknown and unrecognized, whether they have been honest or 
            dishonest? Why struggle, toil, bear children, suffer and be happy, 
            joyful and sorrowful, when the ultimate end is death and 
            destruction? It would surely be much easier to die right away!  This thought was so terrible, so unbearable, that 
            the world around me became dark and void. I leaned against a tree 
            and gazed down into the valley, upon the town, the endless houses 
            with the many human beings who lived in them. From up here they 
            looked like tiny ants. All those beings lived, fought, struggled for 
            love and money, all of them had their problems, their cross to bear, 
            they took everything so desperately seriously ... But why? Why, when 
            life is but a fleeting moment, when death is waiting at the end, 
            solving all problems, terminating all suffering and all joy? What 
            are we running after? What do we attain? Death! Whether we 
            are happy or unhappy, a king or a beggar, the end for all of us is
            death!  Panic gripped me. No! I won't go through with it! I 
            cannot learn, love and live with this thought. Everything is 
            senseless! I would rather commit suicide right now so that I 
            won't have to die at the end of my life!  A devilish, sarcastic voice laughed in my ear: 'Ha 
            ha ha! That's really like you to be so stupid! You want to kill 
            yourself, so you won't have to die? Do you really think you can 
            escape death? You are here, here on earth in a body. You 
            cannot just flee from here without death! If you kill 
            yourself, the end, from which you wished to save yourself only a 
            moment ago, will be imminent. Instantaneous death! Not just "some 
            day" far away, but right here and now! Do you understand? As long as 
            you are here, in your body, you cannot get away unless you 
            die! You are a prisoner! Do you understand? A prisoner! Only through 
            the portals of death can you be released from your body, you cannot 
            escape death ... you cannot escape ... Ha ha ha!'  I tried to gather my scattered thoughts. Yes, it was 
            true, I was in a trap and suicide would not help matters. It would 
            only take me right into what I was anxious to avoid. So now what? In 
            any case I could take momentary comfort in the fact that I was still 
            very young, and that death was still probably far away. I was 
            healthy. All my ancestors had reached a great age. These facts gave 
            me new courage. By the time I get old, I thought, a lot can still 
            happen. The scientists, who constantly discover new things about 
            life, will some day certainly discover the secret of immortality.
            I clung to this thought, and gained the incentive and the energy 
            to go on living, working and wishing.  I was absolutely right! Immortality was discovered, 
            only I did not know at the time, that this 'discovering of 
            immortality' was really something I would have to do for myself 
            to find out that death does not exist, and that all human 
            beings—myself included—are and always will be immortal! For everyone 
            must discover immortality in himself and for himself. No other 
            person can pass this truth on to him. If somebody does not believe a 
            truth, even a perfectly obvious fact, it simply does not exist for 
            him no matter how many other people have discovered it already. 
            Every human being must recognize the fact that death is nothing but 
            life itself and that man not only does not have to die, but 
            is not even able to die! It is absolutely impossible!  At that time, I knew nothing of all this; to me, 
            death was a big, black wall against which I had cracked my head with 
            considerable force.  Nevertheless, I was young, and so I calmed down as 
            well as I could. I postponed the whole thing and decided, as far as 
            humanly possible, not to think about the problem of death. Such 
            thoughts would only weaken me, and I preferred to make plans for the 
            future.  In normal circumstances, I was used to doing 
            everything on my own and upon my own initiative. My father had never 
            concerned himself with the personal affairs of his children. His 
            profession occupied him to such an extent, that he had never had 
            time to interest himself in what went on in his family. We usually 
            only met at the family table where I never mentioned the scenes 
            which occurred between myself and my fiance. My mother loved me, as 
            she loved all her children, but she only began to understand me much 
            later on, when we said good-bye to each other for good. At that 
            time, she wanted me to become as efficient a housewife and mother as 
            she herself was. I myself regarded this as the central aim of my 
            life, but the way in which I wanted to achieve it was quite 
            different from the one she envisaged. The path of my life could be 
            only my own, and I could not accept the advice she gave me in 
            respect to my future. Mother wanted me to prepare myself for the 
            role of the gentle little mother, whereas I, with every drop of my 
            blood, sought fulfilment in music and art. I was therefore left 
            completely to my own devices and gradually got used to thinking and 
            acting independently as far as this was possible in the family 
            circle. I therefore tried to picture a future completely on my own, 
            without asking anyone for advice. I decided to continue my studies 
            at the music academy, and pass the final examinations so as to get a 
            diploma.  Father often said to us: 'Don't be blind to the 
            vagaries of fate just because everything is going well at present. 
            Earthly riches can be destroyed. Whatever knowledge you acquire is 
            yours to keep and cannot be taken away from you. Learn as much as 
            you can, and at least get a diploma of some sort. If things go well, 
            you can leave it in a drawer, but if you run into hard times, you 
            can earn your living with it!'  Oh my father, you wonderful, unselfish, wise man. 
            This piece of advice was the greatest treasure among all those you 
            ever passed on to me. At that time, none of us could imagine how we 
            could ever get into any difficulties and believed in secret that you 
            were just talking like a strict pedagogue. How often I remembered 
            this advice during the war when everything we owned was destroyed 
            and I was stranded with a gravely wounded, disabled husband. We were 
            saved by what I had learnt, by what I carried in me, what I
            knew, for all our outward possessions were lost. As I stood 
            there that day on the mountain, a young, inexperienced girl, 
            thinking about my future, I had no idea what fate held in store for 
            me. But I felt I had to follow your advice.  And so, when I got back home that summer and started 
            a fresh page of my life, the most important thing was to concentrate 
            all my energy on acquiring a piano teacher's diploma. Everything 
            else I left in the hands of destiny.
           
             FIRST VISIONS OF THE FUTURE During the six years I was engaged something 
            happened that was so surprising and so impressive it had an effect 
            on the direction all my later life was to take. Through it my 
            attention was guided towards a world lying hidden deep within the 
            human being: the unknown, unconscious world of the human self.  I was fifteen years old when I discovered that I was 
            sometimes able to see the future in dreams, very precisely, as if 
            what I was seeing were a faithful reproduction of reality. What 
            occurred then happened again later at various times and still 
            happens today always in the same manner: at first my dream runs 
            through all kinds of chaotic and irrelevant pictures. Then suddenly, 
            as if a curtain were pushed to one side, I see colourful, plastic 
            and logically connected pictures, with absolute clarity just as in 
            real life.  In that first clear dream of the future I saw, in my 
            parents' bathroom, a young man holding a newborn baby. The baby was 
            all blue, as if suffocated, and the young man was trying to get it 
            to breathe. A woman assistant stood beside him, ready to help. The 
            child was not breathing. The doctor held it first under ice-cold 
            water then under hot water. Then he held it head downward and swung 
            it to and fro. When it finally let out a cry, all of us round about 
            heaved a sigh of relief. From where he stood in the doorway father 
            now ran to mother's room, fell down on his knees beside her bed, 
            laid his head on the edge of the bed near mother and sobbed as I had 
            never seen this strong man sob before in all my life. Mother was 
            very pale, but she smiled tenderly and stroked father's black hair. 
            Father calmed down after a while, got up and went into the next room 
            where Aunt Raphaela and her daughter were waiting to be able to 
            visit mother. Curiously enough, in my dream I was able to look into 
            all rooms simultaneously, which of course would have been impossible 
            in reality. Another thing that struck me was that the young man, 
            after turning the baby over to his assistant, came out of the 
            bathroom, walking with a peculiar gliding gait. I also noticed his 
            pretty, curly, blond hair, and very distinctly I heard him say, 
            'Mother and child are out of danger but need absolute quiet. If 
            anybody comes to visit them, I cannot take the responsibility for 
            any infection that may occur during this present condition of 
            weakness.'  'Of course, doctor,' answered Aunt Raphaela, and I 
            saw how she very sensibly took her leave and went away with her 
            daughter. Then the picture blacked out, and I awoke.  The next morning I ran to mother and told her my 
            dream. Mother laughed and said, 'Please don't dream things like 
            that, I have enough children! And what is Aunt Raphaela doing in 
            this dream? She doesn't even live here. And who is the handsome 
            young man with the gliding gait and the curly blond hair? Your 
            dreaming like this about good-looking young men seems very 
            suspicious to me.'  'I don't know who he is, Mother, but I saw him just 
            that way in my dream.'  Later, at lunch time, we all discussed my strange 
            dream for a while, but by the next day nobody gave it another 
            thought.  Haifa year later mother felt very ill. She could not 
            eat and the doctors suspected she might have a duodenal ulcer. They 
            x-rayed her and made other examinations. The result ... no exact 
            diagnosis. Our doctor advised mother to see a famous gynaecologist. 
            After his examination, the old professor said, 'Congratulations! The 
            end of this great sickness will be a baptism.' He laughed gently.
             Mother came home in desperation. She was already 
            thirty-nine years old. Little by little she calmed down, however, 
            and six months later, exactly a year after my dream, when no one 
            could have believed that we would have another addition to the 
            family, the little baby arrived. The old professor recommended a 
            young doctor who had already gained a great reputation for his 
            skill. When the baby was born, it seemed to be dead of suffocation. 
            It was twenty long minutes before it took its first breath. Father 
            was so exhausted from the protracted worry that, when the danger was 
            over, he sank to his knees beside mother's bed and, strong man that 
            he was, sobbed like a baby. Aunt Raphaela and her daughter were 
            visiting us briefly en route to Italy. They spent two days with us, 
            and the child was born just as they were ready to go on. They waited 
            in the next room, and when father came in to say that all was safely 
            over, Aunt Raphaela asked whether she might see mother and child 
            before her departure. Then the young doctor came into the room. He 
            had curly blond hair and a peculiar gliding gait! He then said 
            exactly, word for word what I had heard him say in my vision. 
            Indeed, everything happened exactly as I had already experienced 
            it! It was as if I had seen part of a motion picture a long time 
            before the other events in the film and completely separate from 
            them.  From then on I often saw future events, as dream 
            pictures, with precise details. At first this experience always came 
            to me in dreams. Every time it was as if a curtain were being shoved 
            to one side. Later, however, I was able to enter this state 
            intentionally, by an act of will, without being asleep. But this 
            only came much later.  My new baby sister was almost like a granddaughter 
            in the family. Grete was then nineteen, I sixteen, and my brother 
            nine years old. She was everybody's little darling. But the 
            attention she received pushed us two older children pretty far into 
            the background, and we often found ourselves alone. For several 
            years, only our governess accompanied us when we went skating and to 
            concerts and parties. Mother was just as busy with our new little 
            sister as she had been nine years before when my brother was born. 
            No wonder that they had no time to bother about my affairs, even 
            when they noticed I was having disputes with my fiance. I had to 
            fight my battle alone, without help.    
             THE PAST AWAKENS When I left Aunt Raphaela's and returned home 
            following the breaking off of my engagement, summer had come. I was 
            nineteen years old and wanted to enjoy my freedom. At last I could 
            see other young people without having to risk a terrible scene from 
            my jealous fiance. On my return, I went straight to the local 
            tennis-courts. On the first day, I met a very attractive, 
            trim-looking young man. His bearing and manner were most charming. 
            He had a good-looking head on his shoulders, a well-built, slim, 
            muscular body and always turned up in faultless white tennis-slacks 
            and jersey. I took to him from the first moment, and he seemed to 
            like me too. On our third day, one of our team-mates rather 
            unhappily cracked her racket over the head of our ballboy. He began 
            to cry bitterly. The sympathetic young man threw his racket away, 
            ran up to the little boy, took him on to his lap, and started to 
            comfort him. He did not seem to mind the boy's dirtying his 
            immaculate tennis-clothes at all. He stroked his head, dried his 
            tears, and gave him some money. In a matter of moments the boy 
            started to smile through his tears and ran off to the counter to buy 
            some sweets.  My heart went out to him. Are there really such 
            young men, I thought, who have a little compassion? I began to love 
            him ...  In the following winter, I became engaged to him. We 
            loved one another deeply and passionately, and I could hardly wait 
            for the moment when I was to become his wife with body and soul, 
            with every part of my being.  My father wanted me to finish my studies before my 
            marriage, and I still had one year left to go at the music academy. 
            So we had to wait, and I continued to practise daily for four or 
            five hours, learn the laws of harmony, play chamber music, and do 
            everything I could towards passing the exams. My fiance spent every 
            evening at our house.  One evening, when he had left, I went to bed and 
            fell fast asleep. I slept, and, as usual, I dreamt of many things in 
            a chaotic and senseless manner. Suddenly, I began to hear a strange 
            sound which repeated itself in a rhythmical way, a kind of snapping 
            noise which became louder and louder, till I abruptly regained 
            consciousness and awoke.  I open my eyes and notice that the rhythmical sound 
            is coming from the whip of a slave-driver who is marching beside me 
            and cracking his whip to keep all the slaves who are pulling me in 
            step. I am reclining on something like a sledge on rails which 
            glides along slowly. I realize that I am being taken away from the 
            palace; a moment ago I heard the doors being closed.  I want to jump up, but find that I cannot. I am 
            unable to move a muscle, because I am wrapped up tightly from my 
            neck right down to my feet. I am lying there, as though hewn out of 
            a piece of marble, my hands crossed over my chest, my legs stretched 
            out side by side. From this position, I can only look straight ahead 
            or gaze upwards. Looking in the direction of my feet, in the 
            brilliant sunshine, I see the naked, perspiring backs of the men who 
            are pulling me on and on in continuous movement. Above and beyond 
            them, in the distance, a white stone building looms up, a black 
            cavity seeming to mark an entrance. In the gleaming white light, the 
            walls of the building stand out starkly against the dark blue sky. 
            As the slaves continue forward, the building seems to approach, and 
            the black cavity becomes larger and larger.  The sky above is so intensely blue it seems almost 
            black. Two large birds circle slowly overhead—storks or cranes?  The stone building suddenly appears to be very near; 
            the black cavity yawns wide ... yes ... it really is an opening. Now 
            I recognize it. We are in the City of the Dead! This is a tomb! 
            We arrive, the slaves enter and disappear into the darkness. Now the 
            cavity engulfs me ... and suddenly the world around me becomes black 
            after the blinding sunshine outside. Everything is gone ... I am in 
            complete darkness! A terrible fear grips me, and silently I search 
            for an answer to the question, 'How long—how long must I stay in 
            here, a prisoner?'  Clearly I hear a familiar voice, calmly and 
            imperturbably telling me its inexorable will:  'Three thousand years ...'  Terror grips me anew, and consciousness fades into 
            oblivion ...  * * *  Somebody was shaking me roughly. I looked up and saw 
            the eyes of my sister. She gripped me and stared at me in sheer 
            fright.  'For goodness' sake,' she said, 'what on earth is 
            wrong with you? You sit here with a vacant look in your eyes and 
            groan terribly, as though you were going to die. Are you feeling 
            ill? Shall I call mother?'  I felt I wanted to answer, but I could not utter a 
            single sound. The terrible experience I had just been through 
            paralysed every part of my body. I groaned and waved my hand to 
            reassure her that all was well. Then I stretched out again and tried 
            to think, but even that was impossible. I lay there, still 
            panic-stricken, and some minutes went by before my heart started to 
            beat normally again, before I began to calm down and realize who I 
            was and where I was. My sister stayed near me for a little while; 
            then noticing that I had regained my senses, she repeated her 
            questions, 'Can I do anything for you?'  At last I managed to croak: 'No thank you, I'm all 
            right.' * * *  Next day, I tried to collect my scattered thoughts 
            and review the position. What had I seen? What had I experienced 
            during the night? It looked like a vision of the future, but it 
            could hardly be my own future. In my visions of the future, I 
            always remain the same per son, but in this vision, I was someone 
            completely different! I gazed at myself in the mirror for a long 
            time and tried to understand how it was possible that one human 
            being can be two persons at the same time? For I am here, this I can 
            see in the mirror, yet there exists another picture of me, one I 
            saw in another mirror, an enormous silver mirror; at the time when I 
            was the other person!  I am the being, who is here, yet simultaneously I am 
            the other being, who was buried in a tomb. In only a few 
            minutes, I had the experience of being someone who knows exactly who 
            he is, where he belongs, in fact who lives his life consciously, as 
            does everybody, whether he reflects upon it or not. Suddenly I 
            grasped the memories of a life, a home, and realized, that, as a 
            child, I had searched for this home where I really belonged, and 
            that I knew the 'Great One', my father and husband, to be my 'real 
            father'. As the years had passed, I had become accustomed to my 
            present position ... to accepting the fact that my present father 
            and mother were my true parents. Somehow, however, the strange 
            feeling had never left me, and now I felt it very strongly. Yet it 
            was queer that many things which, when I had experienced them in the 
            past, had seemed quite normal, now struck me as being very abnormal. 
            The two concepts contrasted strongly with each other. To take an 
            example, I found it completely correct, in fact I was honoured to be 
            the daughter and the wife of my father, the Pharaoh. Yet now, when I 
            became conscious of the fact, I felt deeply shocked, for the moral 
            standards of my time were quite different. Yet at the time of my 
            ancient existence, this was looked upon as being quite normal, for 
            if the wife of a Pharaoh died, and he had no sisters, the accepted 
            procedure was to make his own daughter his wife. He could never have 
            placed a woman, who did not belong to the family, over his own 
            daughter, who was born in the family of a Pharaoh. And who else but 
            his daughter could have sat beside him as his queen and regal wife, 
            if not the next female member of the family in line of descent? It 
            would have been immoral to introduce a woman of lower heritage into 
            the family. I remembered many things, especially the temple where I 
            often went, yet many things remained blurred, such as the reason why 
            I was so rigorously bound down in my coffin. Why was I taken to a 
            tomb? And whom did that voice I remembered so well belong to?. Whom? 
            A barrier blocked this part of my past, and if I tried to recall 
            anything, something like an electric shock pushed me back. I could 
            not think in reverse!  As we were sitting at the family table next morning, 
            I said to my father: 'Father, in school we learnt that the pyramids 
            were the burial-places of the ancient kings. That's not true! Not 
            all the pyramids were graves, some were used for quite different 
            purposes. The dead were buried outside the city in a special burial 
            city. They were carried out of the town in coffins very similar to 
            sledges, where they were then immured in large buildings. The tombs 
            were closed with stone doors.'  My father gave me an astonished look and said: 'How 
            on earth can you know that, when all the scientists agree that the 
            pyramids were the tombs of the Pharaohs, yet never mention a City of 
            the Dead.'  'I'm quite sure, Father, that this is the way it 
            is,' I said, knowing what I had seen to be true.  'Well, tell us how you know,' he said, and everybody 
            gazed at me expectantly.  'I know it and yet I cannot explain it,' I said, and 
            told them of my vision. My father listened attentively and noticed 
            that even then I shivered with fright when I recalled my 
            experiences. Seeing that I was obviously telling something I had 
            taken part in, he replied 'In Hamlet, Shakespeare says: 
            "There are more things in heaven and earth, Horatio, than are dreamt 
            of in your philosophy." Nowadays people talk about inherited 
            memories, a thing I do not believe in. I'd like to know how the 
            history of a whole family, containing innumerable ancestors, can be 
            contained in one minute living cell? Scientists evolve great 
            theories which change every twenty years. I don't advise you to 
            worry about these things, and don't think about your dream—or your 
            vision—whatever you want to call it. It would simply disturb your 
            mental balance. Maybe you read something about the subject in some 
            paper?'  'No Father, I've never yet read or heard anything 
            about Egypt except what they taught us in school. It never 
            interested me. Yet in school, I learnt things which were completely 
            different from my experiences in my vision. I cannot explain what 
            this vision should mean, for I'm absolutely certain that the facts I 
            witnessed were correct in detail. I'm also certain that the person I 
            was in my dream existed, yet I cannot explain how I can be this 
            person in the present. Who was the other person? I don't understand. 
            Can it be possible, that human beings live more than once?'  'May I have some fruit?' my father said, turning to 
            my mother. The fruit was brought to the table, and the family talked 
            about other matters.  When I went to bed that night, I wondered whether 
            the dream would repeat itself. But it didn't. I waited for many 
            days, I even tried to dream myself back into this strange world. But 
            all to no avail, the dream didn't return.  As time passed, I ceased thinking about it. My 
            healthy attitude towards life drove me on with fresh vigour. I 
            practised at the piano, painted pictures, learnt my lessons and 
            spent each evening with my fiance. And so the year went by.    
             SECOND ENCOUNTER WITH DEATH At last it was my wedding day.  Looking back now, it seems as if it must have been a 
            dream. All decked out in a white dress with a train and wearing a 
            lace veil, I stepped into our living-room, saw how splendid my 
            fiance looked in his best Sunday suit, and laid my hand on his arm. 
            We were photographed, much to my annoyance, as the photographers 
            made me nervous. Then we went out and down the steps and got into a 
            carriage all decorated with flowers. We were followed by Grete and 
            my cousin wearing pink silk dresses and accompanied by the two boy 
            cousins with whom we had once formed our alliance of 'eternal 
            friendship'. Both of them were now gallant young officers.  Then came my brother, with his sad and serious face. 
            He was fourteen, and my little sister, pretty as a doll, was four. 
            She looked completely self-assured and quite superior among all the 
            adults. Then came a whole crowd of relatives including beautiful 
            Aunt Raphaela, dressed like a queen, then my fiance's mother, and 
            finally my own mother, radiantly young and beautiful, accompanied by 
            father, who in his top hat and tails, was truly a splendid sight, 
            enough to make any woman's heart beat faster. When he saw I was 
            amused at his top hat, he gave me a roguish look which clearly meant 
            he considered all these formalities just as ridiculous as I did. If 
            only he knew, I thought, how much I'm suffering in these arm-length 
            gloves! I would have just loved to rip them off, they were such an 
            obstacle to free movement. As I held my bouquet in my hands and 
            stood beside my fiance with a flower in his button hole, it seemed 
            to me that we were two sacrificial animals, gaily adorned with 
            flowers, forced by the tyranny of almighty 'custom' to go through 
            with all this fancy nonsense.  It would have suited me best if I had been able to 
            run away so that the crowd of old aunts, uncles, friends and strange 
            spectators could not look at us like two dolls in an exhibition. I 
            knew that they were all thinking of the one thing I regarded as the 
            supreme sacrament, the fulfilment of love. But with what a 
            difference of viewpoint! And I knew that some of the men present 
            were whispering stupid jokes to each other. But I could not escape, 
            and soon the long line of cars was under way towards the church. A 
            few moments later, we were inside, standing before the altar. I 
            tried to appear agitated and sentimental, but without success. I 
            felt just as matter of fact as ever. As patiently as I could, I 
            listened to the wise and beautiful things our friend and family 
            pastor was saying.  He looked at me and I could see in his eyes that he 
            was thinking how I had asked him not to make a long speech at our 
            wedding, as otherwise I would be forced to yawn big and loud out of 
            utter boredom. At the time mother was incensed about my boundless 
            impertinence, but at least I succeeded in prevailing on the pastor 
            to give a wise but short talk. Thank goodness! A long speech at a 
            wedding ceremony has never yet made a happy marriage! Soon the crowd 
            of friends and relatives were swarming about us, kissing us, and 
            embracing us for three-quarters of an hour, with the old uncles 
            taking full advantage of the opportunity to hug and kiss the young 
            bride from every side while I suffered their attentions with silent 
            disgust. Finally all of this was over too, and we only had to bear 
            up through the wedding banquet. At last the relatives and friends 
            took leave, and I changed my clothes to begin my honeymoon trip with 
            my 'husband'.  In becoming the wife of my beloved after this long 
            period of waiting, I experienced extreme happiness as I expected I 
            would. I had attained my goal; I had become his wife before God and 
            humanity. Between us there were no longer any 'forbidden' signs. I 
            loved him passionately, with my entire being, and he loved me in 
            just the same way. I experienced the highest fulfilment of love, in 
            body and soul.  And then everything collapsed around me.  I dashed my head even more violently against the 
            black wall I had struck once before: for the second time in my life 
            I encountered death. This time the meeting was much more serious.
             As long as I was waiting for happiness, there was a 
            fixed point in my future towards which I was moving. I had something 
            I was waiting and working for. But when the expected event 
            materialized, the future suddenly became empty. I fell into a 
            vacuum, for I did not know what I still had to wait for. What was 
            there in the future for me to look forward to? I had achieved 
            everything. Whatever else might come could only serve to fill out 
            the remaining time. The remaining time, remaining time? Till 
            when? And the answer was: until death!  I was forced to realize that no matter what else I 
            might do or attain in this life, or whatever my destiny might bring 
            me, I and all other people with me were moving only in one 
            direction—towards death!—without the slightest possibility of being 
            able to move in any other. Nobody can know in advance how long it 
            will take him to get there, but sooner or later we all fall into 
            this void.  I was obliged to realize that even our love could 
            not last forever, for the simple reason that sooner or later one of 
            us would have to die. Then happiness would be over. In the presence 
            of my husband when I looked into his bright, loving eyes, I felt as 
            if a cold hand were strangling me, and deep down within me I heard 
            the question: 'How long will you be able to see these beautiful 
            eyes? What will the future bring? Even though you may be ever so 
            happy and supposing that you will live a long life with him, even an 
            exceptionally long one, sooner or later the end will be the same, 
            namely, that he will either have to close your eyes or you will have 
            to close his! Then you will lose each other and have to say 
            good-bye. Time passes with amazing rapidity, and it won't matter 
            much whether the end comes after a short time or a long time. The 
            greatest happiness, the most beautiful love—everything— must some 
            day come to an end, and you will lose each other and everything that 
            has been beautiful and good ...'  I looked into my husband's loving eyes but heard 
            this voice. I knew that no matter how much I might try not to 
            hear it, I would still hear it anyway, I would not be able to 
            silence it, because it was right, it was speaking the truth!
             I have often noticed that people act as if 
            everything were permanent. They simply do not think of the future. 
            Most of them go through life as if they would never be obliged to 
            die and as if their loved ones were not mortal beings. They refuse 
            to realize that our being together here on earth is only a gift of 
            short duration as it will some day have to end! Sooner or 
            later one or the other dies, and then everything is over. People 
            refuse to think about it, but whether they think about it or not, 
            it is so! No one can deny it. But what is the sense of being 
            happy if destiny is, inexorably, going to take this gift away from 
            us some day? What's the good of being happy if we are obliged to be 
            even unhappier later? We struggle for happiness, and when we have 
            attained it we know in advance that we must lose it. The 
            greater the happiness, the greater the loss. In the days when I was 
            not yet so happy, I was actually much happier because I did not 
            yet have the possibility of losing my happiness! So it becomes 
            evident that only the person who was never happy is really and 
            permanently happy! What a terrible contradiction! And why is that 
            so? Because everything lasts only for a time, because nothing is 
            permanent, because everything dies, everything passes away, 
            everything must pass away!  Oh time! Oh mortality! How long will I have to 
            continue to suffer as a prisoner in your chains? How often will I 
            have to bang my head against your black impenetrable wall? You have 
            poisoned every happy moment of my life, because I always had to 
            realize, in the very moment I had something, it was already lost, 
            for it had to come to an end.  And now I am grateful to you, oh mortality I 
            Because you never, even for a moment, allowed me to enjoy passing, 
            temporal happiness, this constant suffering led me to find 
            the unending, infinite eternity, the eternal, divine being
            itself!  In those days, to be sure, I had not the faintest 
            inkling of all this. I did not know that this condition in which a 
            person feels as if he were in a desert, crying from the depths of 
            his soul for help, is the forerunner of salvation. Just as the Bible 
            tells us, 'I am the voice of one crying in the wilderness. I make 
            straight the path of the Lord. I baptize you with water; but after 
            me there will come one stronger than I, the latchet of whose shoes I 
            am not worthy to stoop down and unloose; He shall baptize you with 
            the Holy Spirit and with fire.'  During that period of my life I was still in the 
            desert, crying soundlessly for help, and shedding invisible tears. I 
            was being baptized by water—with tears— and did not know that the 
            time was soon at hand when I would get acquainted with eternal 
            being. For after this condition there comes He who says of 
            Himself, 'I am the resurrection and the life; whosoever 
            believeth on me, even though he die, yet shall he live'—and 
            who baptizes with the Holy Spirit and with fire ...  But he was not yet there, and I was still 
            experiencing the John the Baptist condition; I was crying in the 
            wilderness for help, for I was all alone with my desperation, as if 
            in a desert. I did not want to tell my husband anything about the 
            desperate state of mind I was in. He was completely happy and would 
            not have been able to understand me. If he had no such ideas and was
            still dreaming the dream of mortal people, why should I 
            awaken him and make him unhappy? I saw no solution at all for my 
            problem, as no one could have said that I was wrong. At best he 
            would have had to admit that everything is destined to pass away and 
            the one and only consolation is not to think about it. For my part, 
            however, I was not at all satisfied at the idea of overlooking 
            reality ... and even less satisfied by the fairy tales of religion 
            about 'the other side' and the 'other world'. These are figments of 
            the imagination intended to be a sedative to people. Whoever can 
            believe them is happy, but a thinking person insists on having 
            proof. Within myself I constantly bore a heavy spiritual burden 
            without being able to shake it off. Sooner or later, however, a 
            constant burden on the soul is bound to affect the body ...    
             DARKNESS In build and figure I resembled my father strongly. 
            I was as tall as he was, my hair, though not as black as his, was 
            nevertheless dark brown, and my skin was pale like his and not 
            reddish like my mother's. Only my eyes were dark blue instead of 
            black.  After my marriage, I became paler and slimmer than 
            ever. I could never get used to the idea of the passing of time and 
            the transitory aspect of human existence. As a consequence, I could 
            never feel completely free and happy. This constant pressure on my 
            soul was very bad for my well-being.  One evening I lay down with no bodily affliction 
            whatsoever. When I opened my eyes in the morning, I involuntarily 
            glanced at the ceiling. To my utter astonishment I saw a thick black 
            line that had never been there before. Completely taken aback, I sat 
            up suddenly to see what this queer black line was. As I did so, the 
            line seemed to jump up and sink back slowly again.  My heart nearly stood still. I realized that the 
            black line I saw lay in my eyes and not on the ceiling. I opened and 
            closed my eyes, then closed one and afterwards the other, 
            discovering that I could only see this line with my right eye.  I remembered hearing about an affliction of the eyes 
            called mouches volantes. One is said to see little black dots 
            dancing around, as though a lot of flies were buzzing around the 
            room. As I heard it, these nervous illnesses are not particularly 
            dangerous. I tried to find out whether I could see these mouches 
            volantes. I looked up, I looked down—the black line followed the 
            laws of gravity. It seemed to me as though a thick black thread were 
            tied to some spot above my head. The other end seemed to hang down 
            and moved along following the movement of my eye. It certainly was 
            no nervous delusion, it was real, it was there!  From that moment on, a painful journey began, a 
            journey which anybody will know who has been afflicted with a 
            disease not yet fathomed by the resources of science.  I travelled from one famous professor to another, 
            only to be told that my eye could not be healed, because the 
            symptoms were not those of an organic illness. One of the professors 
            said to me: 'It isn't an illness at all, therefore it can't be 
            cured. It's a condition occurring in old age which very rarely 
            occurs in somebody so young. It's like getting white hair at a very 
            young age through constant strain. How could you cure that? It can 
            stop if the person is relieved of the strain. But to cure it is 
            impossible. You can only cure illnesses; science knows of no 
            remedies for such complaints of the eye as you have. In the case of 
            old people, such an affliction is not dangerous, for it develops 
            very slowly. Nobody knows what happens in the case of young people. 
            From an organic point of view, your eyes are completely healthy, 
            only extremely sensitive.  All our tests have shown that your 
            eyesight is powerful beyond belief, eyes as strong as yours are very 
            rare. Your perceptive powers are equally great. Your susceptivity to 
            light is so strong that you can see how many fingers I am holding up 
            and can read very small print in practically complete darkness. Very 
            occasionally, sailors who can recognize objects at a great distance 
            have similar eyesight. They have the advantage of living in very 
            healthy sea air and are not under any constant nervous tension. 
            Furthermore, they have enough resistance to uphold a balance of 
            susceptivity. But you, my dear woman, live in a great city and are 
            not very resistant, as you are abnormally thin. Tell me, do you not 
            suffer under continuous mental strain?'  'No, Professor,' I said, 'I'm very happy.'  How could I have explained to him that I suffered 
            from fear of mere mortality? How could I have told him that I was 
            fighting against time which moves unflinchingly and transforms all 
            beings, all happiness, into destruction and death?  And even if I had told him, how could he have helped 
            me? Instead, I asked him something else: 'Can you tell me whether 
            this symptom will occur in the other eye as well?'  'How can I tell? I hope that the injections I am 
            prescribing will help you and will clear away the exudation. I also 
            hope that the other eye won't be affected. But I can't look into the 
            future and even less guarantee anything. My advice to you is to take 
            good care of yourself and eat heartily to build up your resistance. 
            Wear sunglasses in bright sunshine to protect your eyes, rest a lot, 
            and let's hope that things will turn out all right again.'  That was enough. I went to my parents together with 
            my husband, feeling as though somebody else had been through all 
            this instead of myself. I noticed how this somebody answered the 
            questions my parents asked, and I watched this somebody eat dinner; 
            everything had become so changed, so different. My family was very 
            upset, but tried not to show this to me and made a big effort to 
            seem happy and gay. My mother tried to console me: 'Rest assured, 
            everything will turn out all right again. Nobody in our family has 
            ever had any trouble with his eyes. Your eye will soon be normal 
            again. Don't think about itl'  Oh, how often have I heard those words from friends 
            who loved me and who tried to help or console me! 'Don't think about 
            it!' How can I possibly help thinking about something which keeps on 
            dancing about in front of my eyes? How can I forget the black thread 
            which hangs down in front of me wherever I look? When I glanced at 
            somebody, the black thread seemed to stick on his nose or his brow 
            or sink down slowly to his mouth. Later on when the black lines 
            increased, I saw everything through a dirty, jagged web. How could I 
            not think about it?  In the first days of my affliction, I felt as though 
            an immense rock had hit my head and completely flattened me. I could 
            not believe it: my eyes in great danger? It must be a bad 
            dream, which will soon pass when I wake up. Then I will be relieved 
            of this terrible nightmare ... and free again.  But I was never freed of this nightmare. I sat in 
            front of my mirror and looked at myself. A childlike face with large 
            dark blue eyes looked back at me. These eyes were supposed to show 
            signs of old age? But I'm young, I've only just started off in life! 
            I can't be old yet! When I was up on that mountain and encountered 
            death for the first time, I knew that everything was of purely 
            transitory value. Yet does time pass so quickly, so unexpectedly? At 
            the time, I calmed myself, knowing that death was a long way away. 
            Should death be coming to me so soon? Or can it be that certain 
            parts of the body grow older sooner than others, that a delicate 
            mechanism like the human eye perishes sooner than other 
            organisms?—and that the whole body might live longer than the eyes? 
            Blind? —terrible!—terrible!  No! I could not stand that! I wanted to run away ... 
            to flee ... but where? My stigma, the black line in my right eye, 
            accompanied me wherever I went. I could not get rid of it.  I fell into a state of dejection only those who have 
            experienced similar misfortunes can understand. How my heart bled 
            for the blind people I saw on the streets, how I felt for them! I 
            could not forget my despair for one minute, not for one single 
            instant. The dark blotches fluttered up and down in front of my eyes 
            and constantly changed their appearance. I never ceased watching 
            them. I got into the habit of carefully scrutinizing my eyes when I 
            woke up in the morning. Has it become worse?—Can I still read small 
            print with my right eye?—And if not—if I had to admit with 
            indescribable terror that my condition had worsened overnight, the 
            blood used to rush to my head, and with my heart pounding I 
            continued to examine myself to see how much worse it had become.  Oh Beethoven! In these days I learnt to understand 
            your despair when you lost your hearing! You knew the frame of mind, 
            the panic, which comes when one is overwhelmed by the feeling of not 
            being able to stand it any more, of wanting to flee, to escape from 
            terrible suffering. Yes, but where? My ill-luck will always be with 
            me; I cannot get rid of it, I am stricken forever!  My despair over the evanescence of life was not 
            enough, I now carried something like an eternal 'memento' around 
            with me to remind me of decay and death. I sometimes felt that those 
            black lines would drive me mad!  Never again could I really enjoy myself. My husband 
            did everything to make me forget the condition of my eyes. But 
            whatever he did, however much he pampered me with presents—I could 
            never be happy. Everywhere I looked I saw corruption and death, for 
            I always saw black lines. As the Carthusian monks, who are forced to 
            regard the two letters 'M' 'M' in the palms of their hands as a 
            reminder of the words Memento Mori, so did the black lines in 
            front of my eyes constantly remind me of blindness and death.  If my husband took me to a beautiful spot in the 
            country, I used to think:  'How long will I still be able to see the sunshine, 
            the mountains, the fields, the sky, in fact, the treasures of 
            nature?' If I saw a wonderful performance at the Opera, I thought: 
            'How long can I still delight in the delicate movements of graceful 
            ballet-dancers?' Deepest despair, brought forth by the cruelty of 
            reality, had taken hold of me, for my left eye was, if only very 
            slowly, yet definitely beginning to be affected as well. I was 
            therefore well on my way to becoming blind. I could not even cry 
            properly; I had never cried much, for I regarded crying as a 
            senseless means of expression, a form of self-pity which I 
            considered myself to be unworthy of. Now crying was strictly 
            forbidden, for it would have harmed my eyes very much. I bore my 
            despair without any exterior sign, and I never talked about it, for 
            I saw that if I were constantly to talk about my affliction, my 
            friends and acquaintances would suffer as much as I; and 
            consequently, as normal human beings usually try to rid themselves 
            of everything which seems unpleasant, they would drift away from me. 
            I did not want to become disagreeable and boring in my own troubles. 
            On the contrary, I was always gay and humorous, like a clown who 
            hides his deepest sorrows under a painted mask. Thus did I bear my 
            misery in silent suffering.  This blow also destroyed my artistic ambitions. 
            Besides playing the piano, I had made great progress in drawing and 
            painting and my teachers expected a lot in the future. Painting and 
            drawing had always given me much pleasure. This too now came to an 
            end. When I tried to paint, I saw lots of little black blobs on the 
            canvas. This made me very nervous, and I had to control myself so as 
            not to throw my brush away in anger. I lost my energy and my will to 
            paint. The thought of gaining a reputation and becoming famous only 
            to have to give everything up because of blindness disturbed me 
            profoundly. No! I preferred to give up my artistic career and to 
            continue playing the piano, for I could play blind as well.  I practised with my eyes closed. I walked around the 
            room blindfolded and tried to find various objects. I tried to dress 
            and comb my hair with my eyes closed, so as to be prepared when 
            complete darkness came. I also did this because closing my eyes was 
            the only way of escaping from those aggravating black lines which 
            kept on dancing in front of my eyes. It was my only hope ...  The salt injections were an equally trying ordeal. 
            Human reflexes are such that the eye closes immediately in the face 
            of possible danger. The eyelids shut instinctively when an object 
            approaches the eye. I had to conquer those reflexes and control 
            myself. I had to keep my eye open without movement and watch— 
            for if the eye is open, one is obliged to watch, whether one likes 
            or not—how the doctor pricked my eye with the needle. I had to go 
            through this procedure many times. I did not know at the time that 
            what I was learning, namely to control the natural instincts, 
            was in fact one of the most advanced Yoga exercises which 
            eventually brings about complete control over all bodily functions. 
            I was forced to do so by fate, and so gained a very powerful grip on 
            my nerves by pure chance. Yet when the doctor saw me to the door 
            after my first injection, I felt very weak and had to pull myself 
            together so as not to stumble and fall. The smile I tried to give 
            him did not come very easily; I felt as if the muscles around my 
            mouth had rusted. And for all my troubles, the injections did not 
            help at all.  I stopped going to professors and became more and 
            more pessimistic. The answer was always the same. 'It's no organic 
            illness; your eyes are completely healthy. It's the lens which is 
            filming over.' From day to day my eyesight became worse and worse. 
            What difference does it make if one goes blind with healthy or with 
            diseased eyes?—I had to accept the seemingly inevitable. I might 
            have given in. But I could not! How can somebody give up and accept 
            blindness as a normal state of affairs? Immutability and I were 
            fighting against each other. There was no question of my losing. I 
            could not give in, so I had to be destroyed ...  The night the black line appeared for the first 
            time, I my self was slain. I did not notice it straight away. 
            This amusing, vain, impertinent and sensual little being which 
            wanted to be a famous and celebrated artist and a beautiful woman 
            was destroyed. My hidden philosophy of life, which had been born up 
            on the mountain following my first encounter with death, now took 
            hold of me forcibly. Now I could not—and did not even want to—let 
            the voice, which repeatedly reminded me of the past, go by unheeded 
            ... And as I started to listen to this voice very attentively 
            instead of turning away from it, I began slowly to recognize a 
            familiar and dearly beloved voice: HIS voice ...
           
             TURNING POINT One afternoon, I came home from town. The houses in 
            our row stood in well-kept gardens, the sun was shining brightly, 
            flowers were blooming everywhere, birds were singing joyously, and I 
            recalled the words of Don Carlos: 'O, my queen, in spite of 
            everything life is so beautiful!'  'Yes,' I felt like adding, 'if only my eyes were to 
            retain their power of sight!' Suddenly I heard the voice in me, 
            asking me quite distinctly: 'Are you blind already? Can't you see 
            the world, the sky, the trees and the flowers any more?'  'I can,' I answered, looking around me, 'everything 
            is still quite clear,' and I remembered what my doctor had said to 
            me the last time I visited him to check up on my eyesight: 'The 
            right eye has become pretty dim and hazy, but you still perceive 
            more with the other eye than most average human beings with both 
            eyes.'  'Well, if your eyesight is still as good as that, 
            why do you behave so desperately, as though you had already gone 
            blind? Why give up hope? Let us assume that you were to go blind in 
            the second half of your life. If you start giving up hope now, while 
            you can still see quite adequately, your whole life will be 
            blighted by your desperation and your affliction! Quite apart from 
            the fact that you really don't know whether you are going blind or 
            not. Maybe you will die before you go completely blind; in this 
            case, you will have spent weeks, months and years of useless worry, 
            while all the time your eyesight was clear and normal apart from a 
            few annoying black blobs. What a waste of time to worry about events 
            which have not yet occurred! The future? Do you really know what the 
            future is? Events which have not yet come to pass! Why mar 
            your pleasure in life with things which do not exist? Your present 
            circumstances are not too bad. Enjoy life, your chances of recovery 
            will be much better so. Your depressions will only accelerate the 
            destructive process in your eyes. Live in the present, and remember:
            as soon as your spiritual blindness ceases, your corporeal eyes 
            will regain their functions.  Oh, how true were the words of this sacred voice! In 
            the moments of deepest despair, I felt that the black spots in my 
            eyes showed up my interior darkness, my spiritual 
            blindness. But how on earth is one to cure spiritual blindness? For 
            this was the hub of my problems, the fact that I felt completely 
            blind in the face of the secrets of life and death. I was enclosed 
            in darkness, for I sensed death everywhere and could not grasp the 
            meaning of life. I desired to become 'seeing', it was my greatest 
            wish—but how?  And the voice replied: 'Seek and ye shall find; 
            knock and it shall be opened unto you!'  I did not understand those words at the time, but I 
            wanted to obey them. I tried breathing deeply and calmly, and 
            concentrating on the present. It was very hard—the black spots 
            kept dancing in front of my eyes and reminding me of my misery—but I 
            tried again and again and reached the point where I felt happy and 
            content again; indeed, I felt I had to be happy, for my eyes would 
            benefit from my state of mind. I wanted to help myself. I had to be 
            happy, I had to enjoy myself! I began to think about future 
            occupations which would afford me constant pleasure. My husband was 
            very much engrossed in his job —he was a construction engineer—and I 
            rarely saw him except at meals. A thought flashed through my mind: a 
            baby! How long have I wished for a baby! What greater joy could I 
            expect? And I would not be alone all the time.  I opened my spirit to the anonymous being which was 
            waiting somewhere to become my child. And the being heard my 
            cry ...  During my pregnancy, the discharges slowly 
            disappeared from my eyes, and when my confinement came, I had 
            completely forgotten that I had ever had any trouble at all. My 
            memories of lying in the operating theatre of a sanatorium, and 
            waking up after an anaesthetic, completely exhausted, seem like a 
            long-forgotten dream. I find myself in a form of ecstasy, yet I hear 
            a sound which flashes through me like lightning and brings me back 
            to my senses. It is a cry ... not like the cry of a new-born child 
            but more like the roar of a lion! 'It's alive', the thought grips me 
            and a great feeling of gratitude overwhelms me. I open my eyes. A 
            face appears above me and I hear a voice saying: 'A boy, a 
            beautiful, healthy boy'—I catch sight of a little round head and a 
            fat, rosy body.  'Is that my child?' I ask myself as I gaze at it 
            expectantly! I feel that only its body is 'my child', 
            otherwise it is an independent being I know has come into being as
            'our child'.  Then for the first tune in its life, the baby lies 
            in a crib, swathed in human vestments, and gazes wide-eyed at the 
            world.  My mother and my father have already arrived, 
            waiting to welcome my child and myself after this terrible fight for 
            life. I am at the end of my tether, my heart is hardly beating after 
            my great loss of blood. But the child is alive!  After this strenuous experience, my convalescence 
            was very slow. For a long time, I felt very weak, very susceptible 
            to any form of light, the discharges reappeared and the vitreous 
            humour of my right eye became opaque again. Thick clouds of a sort 
            of fog covered my vision in this eye. Yet I never got around to 
            bothering seriously about my eyesight. There was my child, I spent 
            all my time in its presence, and when it smiled at me and embraced 
            me with its podgy little arms, the weight and pressure of my worries 
            seemed far away.  The years raced by. My little boy developed 
            magnificently and was admired by everyone for his big blue eyes 
            which radiated so much love and warmth. He was a very precocious 
            child. When he was four, a scene of my own childhood was re-enacted. 
            My child showed me a picture-book and asked me the meaning of 
            certain letters. I explained them in detail. The child regarded the 
            letters attentively and suddenly cried: 'Mother, that means "bull", 
            doesn't it?'  I took it on to my lap and kissed it again and 
            again. Then I explained all the other letters. It did not have to 
            learn them. It seemed as if it only had to recall them.  We spent the summer together in our family villa 
            near the lake. In fact, a whole series of wonderful summers! My 
            brother and my younger sister invited lots of friends who sometimes 
            stayed at our place for weeks on end. We played croquet, rowed and 
            swam, and in the evenings we used to play chamber music or play 
            games, or dance on the terrace. It was a healthy, happy life.  My eyes did not bother me very much during this 
            time. After the birth of my child I spent some months at the 
            seaside. The secret sources of energy of the sea completely renewed 
            me. I returned home in excellent health and very much more able to 
            stand light. I started drawing and painting again and even took up 
            wood carving. This artistic occupation afforded me great pleasure.
             On the surface everything seemed in order. 
            Nevertheless I was not happy! I did not know why. An inner 
            discontentment grew in me until I could not disregard it any more.
             One night, after I had experienced once again the 
            greatest fulfilment of earthly love and unity, instead of falling 
            peacefully asleep, I sat on the side of my bed for a long time 
            brooding over my problems in abject despair. I cried and I sobbed, 
            and in the darkness of that night, I began to examine myself cruelly 
            in order to find out why I was so unhappy and so discontented. I had 
            everything necessary to make a human being happy, from where could 
            my misery originate?  This question seemed to call forth the answer. From 
            the depths of my subconscious, the reasons began to ascend and gain 
            consciousness.  I was searching for a human being, who was my 
            other half, my complement. Love is the revelation of a power 
            which forces two complementary halves to unite. In fact, the 
            subconscious will to unite is commonly known as 'love'. I had 
            experienced this union, I had attained the supreme fulfilment of 
            body and soul and was not happy, and became more and more unhappy 
            after each occasion.  I sat there in the dark and questioned myself in 
            despair: Why can't I be happy? I desired an answer and reflected 
            intently. And then I realized that the joy of union was not what 
            I had expected! I had searched for some sort of fulfilment 
            subconsciously, and, having found nothing else, I believed 
            physical love to be this fulfilment. Having experienced it, I 
            had to admit that it was not what I had expected. After 
            experiencing the supreme form of physical unity, I was compelled to 
            see and realize I was looking for something else!  But what?  I was searching for fulfilment of an eternal 
            nature, a real union which remains! I was 
            searching for a union in which the identity of myself and that of my 
            lover became one and the same thing. I desired to participate in his 
            soul, his thoughts, his whole being! I wanted to become 
            him!  But I did not desire what physical unity had brought 
            me. This physical union is a desperate attempt to become one 
            being—every fibre and muscle is strained to the highest pitch—and in 
            the moment when both believe that they have achieved fulfilment, 
            they fall apart ... without ever attaining union.  In the darkness a picture of my childhood appeared 
            in front of me: I remembered sitting at the family table and trying 
            to bring together two little grease spots swimming on top of my bowl 
            of soup. Yes! In exactly the same way as I had tried to unite the 
            two grease spots, years ago, I now wanted to make one being out of 
            our two souls. Out of the two selves I wanted to create a single 
            one. But that is impossible! In love, each lover craves to come 
            together with the other. Yet their craving is merely a physical 
            desire, and they strain against each other in despair. Everybody can 
            observe how two lovers press their hearts together in their fervent 
            embrace; they seem to be compelled to unite their hearts, to be 
            united in their heart. But they fail! Why? Their bodies 
            stand between them. The resistance of the body prevents the 
            union. How strange that I should desire to become one single being 
            with my lover in body and that the body itself should bar my 
            way. Does my body desire this union? Can the body desire anything 
            which is impossible by reason of the very existence of the body? No! 
            The body cannot carry within itself a wish which cannot be fulfilled 
            by reason of its own presence. Who and what therefore 
            desires this supreme union? It can only be the immaterial spirit, 
            the self.  And why do I desire this union? Why do I want 
            something which is impossible? I want it because I know that only 
            through this complete concord, this supreme union, will I find 
            satisfaction, and only in this state of mind will I achieve final 
            happiness! This happiness I have been searching for since I began to 
            live. But why do I search for something which is impossible to 
            attain? I do it solely because I know, I feel certain, that somehow 
            it is possible, and that somehow this possibility exists—only I 
            don't know how. What impedes my progress towards my aim? The 
            body! The body stands between us!—Therefore, this possibility might 
            exist, but only in a bodiless condition. I long for this lost 
            unison. I once knew it, somewhere and somehow, but I have lost it. 
            Could it be possible that I lived in an immaterial state a long time 
            ago, and that, having been born into this body, I fell out of 
            this spiritual harmony? Is it possible that I once lived in a 
            world of complete unison, a world without corporeal elements, where 
            I lived in a bodiless condition?  Having got this far in the logical sequence of my 
            thoughts, I began to feel very afraid: a bodiless state? In a world 
            without corporeal elements? Therefore, in 'another world'? In the 
            'hereafter'? Could it be possible that this 'other world' really 
            exists? A world, in which I had never believed and which I had 
            always regarded as a necessary invention of a religious nature, used 
            to enforce a moral standard of living among primitive people with 
            promises of 'heaven' and warnings of 'hell'? It is my body alone 
            which exists in our earthly world? And my self, which is 
            cognizant of this impossible union of the flesh and which 
            desires to reinstitute it, does it belong to 'eternity'? If 
            that is so, all human beings originate in another world where this 
            unison is reality, and have fallen out of it into this 
            world—into the material body and an earthly world? ... Yet the 
            craving for our former happiness lies in us, in our soul, which 
            belongs to this 'other world'. And again and again we err by trying 
            to attain this happiness, this unity in our body and with the aid 
            of our inherent bodily sexuality. Yet it is the body which 
            itself impedes our success. Oh, now I realize what is meant by the 
            'fall from paradise'!  Therefore I can only reach the happiness I desire in 
            the other world—in paradise. As I cannot force this other world into 
            my own material world, I will strive to get to know this other world 
            where my eternal happiness resides. But how? Empty words are of no 
            use to mer—I want reality! I want concrete facts!  This night was the turning point of my life. I 
            realized that sex is the greatest of all frauds. Nature promises us 
            a wonderful event, the supreme heights of joy, the embodiment of 
            fulfilment, yet she robs us of our powers, and when we believe we 
            have reached the limits of fulfilment, we fall lower than ever 
            before. We lose a tremendous lot of energy and feel as poor as 
            beggars after the event. An old Latin proverb mentions that both 
            humans and animals feel depressed after physical union ...  I was looking for eternal, ever-present sublimity, 
            not what sex can give. What is left of sexual pleasure in the 
            morning? Nothing, except possibly great fatigue! And this state of 
            affairs is to repeat itself forever? What else is it but a 
            continuous struggle for unattainable unison? Never will a human 
            being achieve the fulfilment of his strivings, never can he delve 
            into true concord where he can stay forever. Formerly a certain 
            force existed—the power of attraction, which brought together two 
            beings in their search for each other. Later on, this force is 
            appeased, emptiness remains, and each is left alone, desperately 
            alone, eternally alone ...  I realized at last: This was not the aim of 
            my quest.  And if I was not looking for this, if sex had 
            deceived me, I would refuse to go on in this way! I would refuse to 
            let myself be deceived! Sex can satisfy only the body, but never the 
            soul, the self. Never could sexual satisfaction appease this desire!
             What now? I want to, I must find this happiness. I 
            must search for an answer to my questions. I cannot stand still, I 
            must go forward. But where to?  If happiness lies in the other world, I will search 
            for it in the other world!  And so I set out to find my happiness and fulfilment 
            where I hoped to discover it, in the other world ...    
             STRUGGLE FOR LIGHT I was trying to capture the world beyond, but I did 
            not know how to set about doing it. I felt like somebody who was 
            trying to conquer a jungle, but who did not know where to start, and 
            whose only instrument was a little axe with which to cut a path 
            through the undergrowth. He knows the jungle to be full of lurking 
            dangers, poisonous snakes and wild animals. He might well lose his 
            way and fall into some abyss. Yet his ignorance of these dangers 
            lends him the necessary courage to penetrate this jungle all the 
            same.  I did not know that my voyage of discovery into the 
            other world was going to be fraught with dangers, that unknown 
            forces from the regions of the subconscious would hurl themselves 
            upon me like wild animals, that will-o'the wisps would lead me down 
            false trails, and that abysses of madness were lurking on every 
            side. All I had was my little axe, my normal human common sense!  Where was I to begin? Religion talks about the life 
            beyond, yet all the priests I had talked to up to this moment had 
            either wanted me to believe all sorts of dogmas which they 
            themselves did not really understand, or they told me sentimental 
            stories about the kingdom of heaven which they themselves did not 
            believe, but which they deemed adequate to satisfy the 'little 
            woman'.  I preferred to find out what the world's great 
            philosophers thought of this tremendously important question, the 
            meaning of life and death. And as I had never heard of great 
            oriental philosophers, I began to study the works of European 
            thinkers.  First of all, I read the ancient Greek and Roman 
            works, translated into a language I could understand. I was 
            enraptured by Socrates, Plato, Pythagoras, Epictetus and Marcus 
            Aurelius. Under the influence of these great men, my mind matured 
            and I learnt very much from their teachings. Especially one little 
            sentence of Epictetus remained with me on my voyage like an eternal 
            flame and helped me to cross over from darkness into light:  'Things are never bad; it's the way you think 
            about them.'  From the moment I read that sentence, I tried to 
            change my complete frame of mind, my spiritual position—to think 
            differently about things!—Yet all these great truths could not 
            supply the answer to my great question concerning the great beyond.
             Later on I read the newer philosophers: Kant, 
            Schopenhauer, Nietzsche, Descartes, Pascal, Spinoza. None could 
            satisfy me. I felt that they had all gone as far as reason and 
            intellect could take them, but that they had not reached the 
            ultimate goal, union. In fact, they were less capable of 
            answering this question than the ancient philosophers. Among these 
            modern philosophers, Spinoza probably achieved the highest degree in 
            this quest, but I felt that the newest thinkers had somehow 
            entangled themselves in their own cerebral convolutions and come to 
            a dead-end. In spite of their philosophical systems, they had 
            remained discontented, disappointed and unhappy men. How indeed 
            could they have helped me find the great truths of the other world? 
            They themselves were ignorant of them and had searched for them as 
            desperately as I was doing. I wanted reality, not words.  One autumn day I stood at the window of our 
            apartment with my small son and watched the leaves of a 
            chestnut-tree floating slowly to earth. As I had so often done 
            before, I meditated upon the meaning of life and death. 'Death,' I 
            thought, 'death again and again!'  Suddenly I heard the voice in me speaking: 
            'Death?—Why do you persist in seeing but the one side of 
            truth? What do the trees and nature reveal in spring? Life!—again 
            and again!' Life and death alternate in an everlasting circle. Death 
            is but the other side of life ...'  In this moment I saw quite clearly, that as life 
            recedes from the tree and its leaves in autumn, the leaves become 
            lifeless, empty husks, fall off and die. But only empty husks! The 
            essence of life which has lived in the leaves now rests in the tree 
            and bursts forth again in spring, clothes itself anew with a 
            material form and becomes leaves again, repeating its eternal cycle. 
            The tree inhales and exhales life, and only the leaves change, only 
            the outer shell! Life remains eternal, for life is the eternal 
            being. And I saw even further: The fountain of eternal 
            existence—human beings call it 'God'—breathes life into man, 
            just as the Bible says that God breathed life into Adam's nostrils. 
            Then God inhales again, withdrawing his breath, so that the empty 
            husk falls: The body of man dies. Yet life does not cease at this 
            moment, it clothes itself with a new body, in an eternal cycle and 
            moves on, as everything in this world lives and moves in rhythm, 
            from the orbit of the planets to the breath and pulse of every 
            living creature.  Then, in a flash I suddenly remembered how, at the 
            age of six or seven when I first heard about death, I had stood 
            before the mirror, examining the picture of the invisible: my own 
            reflection. Even at that early age I simply could not understand 
            that I would some day have to die, that I would some day cease to 
            exist. I wanted to see where this 'I' was that was thinking these 
            things and did not want to die. I kept looking into the mirror, 
            moving closer and closer until my nose touched the glass. I looked 
            into my own eyes from as near as I could get. I wanted to see this 
            'I'! Even though there was a black hole in my eye, I couldn't see 
            'me'. The 'I'—myself—was invisible, just as I had always imagined it 
            to be ever since I first became conscious on this earth. Even in the 
            mirror I could not see me, only my face, my mask, and 
            the two black holes in my eyes out of which I was looking. I felt 
            very clearly that it was impossible for me not to exist!  'Good,' I asked myself as I stood before the mirror, 
            'but what will you be looking at the world through when these eyes 
            are some day closed?'  'Through two other eyes!' I answered without a 
            moment's hesitation. 'Here I will close these eyes, and in a new 
            body I will open two new eyes.'  'And what if there is a time delay between the two 
            bodies; what if you do not find a new body right away? What if you 
            have to wait a week, or perhaps months, years, even thousands of 
            years?'  'That just cannot be,' answered the little girl that 
            I was then, 'for when I fall asleep, I do not know, on awakening, 
            how long I have been asleep. In sleep there is no time, and in death 
            it will be the same as long as I am without a body. Whether I spend 
            a week in darkness and nothingness, or a thousand years, it's all 
            the same. I will feel as if I had just closed my eyes here and 
            opened them again there. In nothingness there is no time. But my 
            ceasing to exist just cannot be!' And then I left the mirror, 
            completely satisfied, to go on playing.  Now, as I stood before the window as an adult and 
            recognized the law of reincarnation in the chestnut tree, the memory 
            of this childhood experience flashed through my mind, and I was 
            astonished that a child could find this truth so naturally and 
            spontaneously with its little primitive understanding, without ever 
            having heard or read anything about re-incarnation. Now I would not 
            say that there is no time in 'darkness', but rather that in the 
            'unconscious' there is no 'time concept'.  Now I also understood how it was possible for me to 
            carry within me the blurred and hazy memories of a person I had been 
            long before. The vision of ancient Egypt was only old memories 
            bobbing up into consciousness.  My search for the other world and the life beyond 
            this one and my ideas about re-incarnation turned my attention to 
            spiritualism. Spiritualists claim to be able to establish contact 
            with spirits of the departed dead, and they also believe in 
            re-incarnation. However, I had a pronounced antipathy towards 
            spiritualism because at home I had heard my parents speak about it 
            in a rather disparaging way. Mother had a very dear old friend who 
            concerned herself with spiritualism. Mother told us that this friend 
            held spiritualistic seances and that during these experiments a 
            heavy massive oaken table would rise up in the air. Mother never 
            participated in these seances and never concerned herself with such 
            things at all, because she was convinced that such experiments were 
            harmful for the nerves. While I was reflecting about reincarnation, 
            I remembered that once as a young girl I had participated in such a 
            stance at the home of this elderly lady without my mother's 
            knowledge of it. That is, of course, if what we experienced then 
            could be called a 'seance'!  My mother's elderly friend loved her grandchildren 
            very much and often invited young people to lunch. I was often one 
            of the guests at these young people's luncheons. Once, several of us 
            stayed on after the others had left. The lady was of a gay and 
            sparkling nature and enjoyed talking with us youngsters. I was 
            fifteen, and the other children were about the same age. We were 
            curious and eager to hear the kind lady tell us about spiritualism.
             'If you wish,' she said, 'we can watch the table 
            move.' All of us young folks agreed immediately and began to wonder 
            what was going to happen next.  A table was brought in for the experiment. It was 
            not the heavy oaken table mother had talked about, but a little 
            table with only three legs. The lady set the table in the middle of 
            the room, and we youngsters stood around it, with the palms of our 
            hands on the top of the table and our fingers spread out in such a 
            way that the thumbs of each person's hands were touching each other 
            and their little fingers touching the little fingers of the persons 
            to the left and the right. The room was brightly lit. We youngsters 
            were in high spirits and thought it was just terribly funny when the 
            elderly lady called out in a loud voice, 'Is someone there?'  We looked at each other roguishly and could hardly 
            keep from bursting out laughing. But we did not want to offend the 
            dear old lady and tried hard to keep a straight face. We stood and 
            waited. All at once the little table began to shake as if some inner 
            force were trying to split the wood apart. Then the shaking became 
            stronger and stronger and suddenly the table leaned over to the side 
            so that one of its feet was in the air; then it fell back and stood 
            still.  'Yes,' said the lady, 'the table said "yes". When 
            the table raps once, it means "yes", when it raps twice it means 
            "no".'  'Wolfgang,' she said to her grandson, 'take paper 
            and pencil and write down the letters. A spirit is present.'  Wolfgang took a pencil and waited. Then the table 
            began to move, rapping and rapping again. We called off the letters 
            in the alphabet and whenever the table stopped at one of the letters 
            we had called, Wolfgang wrote down the letter.  I cannot explain why this all seemed so terribly 
            funny to us. We found it was comical to be calling out letters and 
            ludicrous that the old lady took everything so seriously. I could 
            not believe for a minute that the table was moving by itself. It was 
            surely Nicolas, the lady's other grandson. The rapping itself was 
            amusing enough, but what came afterwards made us burst out laughing 
            irresistibly, and this made the old lady shake her head at us. But 
            we just couldn't help laughing anyway, even if we did not want to. 
            The table suddenly began to tip over so far that its edge almost 
            touched the floor. I thought its feet were going to slip and it 
            would fall, but no, it came back again to an upright position and 
            then began to turn and twist and move around the room. We had to run 
            with it, and when the table began to rotate, we had to run around it 
            and follow it wherever it went in the room. Finally the table came 
            to rest in a corner and moved no more. The lady again called out, 
            'Is no one there?'  The table did not move.  'It was a waggish kind of spirit, because you were 
            all so hilarious,' she said, 'and now all spirits are gone. Wait a 
            moment, children, I'll have some coffee brought in.' With that she 
            disappeared into the kitchen. We youngsters were left alone. It was 
            my chance to ask Nicolas, 'It was you who moved the table,, wasn't 
            it?'  'I?' he echoed in astonishment, 'I thought it was 
            you, or Emmerich. But it certainly wasn't I. I only played the game 
            with the rest, but my fingertips were scarcely touching the table.'
             We all looked at Emmerich. He protested earnestly, 
            'No, I didn't move the table either.'  'Come on, all of you,' I said, 'let's get the table 
            to move again ourselves.'  All agreed and .we ran to the table, stood around 
            it, and began with our own hands to push it back and forth and get 
            it to move. To our great amazement this didn't work! The table was 
            motionless, just as a piece of wood is normally lifeless and 
            motionless, and when we pushed it harder and harder, it simply fell 
            over and lay on the floor. During the previous experiment, the table 
            had sometimes leaned over so far that its edge almost touched the 
            floor and then stood up again. But no matter how we tried, we 
            couldn't get it to do so again. Finally, after we had agreed to push 
            the table in the same direction, all of us together, one side would 
            rise after which the table simply fell. We could not hold it or get 
            it to stand upright again.  We looked at each other and suddenly fell silent. We 
            couldn't understand the whole affair. None of us felt like laughing 
            any more. The elderly lady's two grandsons admitted quietly that 
            they couldn't understand the matter either, but it was a fact that 
            when their Aunt Margaret was present even the gigantic oaken table, 
            which was so heavy that only four men together could carry it out of 
            the room, would rise up in the air. Obviously Aunt Margaret was not 
            lifting it.  On my way home, and for a long time afterwards, I 
            thought about the moving table and wondered how it worked. I did not 
            believe for a moment that a 'spirit' had moved it, but I had to 
            admit that an unknown force was there.  After this all happened I went on with my piano 
            practice, went skating, fought with my fiance, and the moving table 
            disappeared in the storehouse of my memory. Now it all came back to 
            me. I could see clearly that the dear old lady did not understand 
            much about spiritualism, but perhaps there were spiritualistic 
            groups who went into such matters very seriously. If I were to study 
            and investigate the whole matter thoroughly without prejudice, I 
            might perhaps learn something through spiritualism that would help 
            me on my path.  I obtained an introduction to the leader of the 
            largest and the most famous spiritualistic group in the country. He 
            began by giving me books to read which I could believe or not 
            believe. Theories cannot satisfy a seeker after truth. I wanted 
            practice and conviction. In one book I read about a very famous 
            medium who achieved his ability by sitting down at the same time 
            every day with paper and pencil, holding the pencil in his hand in 
            readiness to write, and waiting a solid hour. This he repeated 
            religiously day after day, week after week, and month after month. 
            After about six months, the pencil began to move and wrote various 
            words. In this manner, the medium wrote a number of books which were 
            very famous at the time. They did not interest me because they were 
            sermons full of sweetness and light and not as good as the sermons 
            one could hear in any church. Why, I thought, should one have to 
            call upon a 'spirit' for things like these, if indeed it really 
            was a spirit which moved the hand of the medium!  I, too, took pencil and paper, held the pencil over 
            the paper in readiness, and waited.  The first day nothing happened.  The second day the pencil began to shake so hard my 
            hand shook with it. Then it began to move stiffly, jerkily, back and 
            forth and wrote various abracadabras on the paper.  On the third day the pencil immediately began to 
            shake and soon wrote words one could clearly read. They looked as if 
            they had been written by an old person with a trembling hand. I 
            continued the experiment every day, and the pencil went on to write 
            longer and longer sentences. While the pencil was writing, I 
            observed my arm and my hand. Whence came the force that moved my 
            hand? If the pencil could write all by itself, I reflected, every 
            pencil lying around could stand up and start writing. Therefore, 
            without any doubt, the pencil was being moved by my arm, but 
            without my having wanted to do so and without my 
            having known before what it was going to write. Consequently the 
            force must be coming from a source outside my own consciousness, but 
            doubtless from me. It can be a force coming from my subconscious, 
            but for the present there is no proof that this force comes from a 
            strange being outside myself, or let us say, from a 'spirit'.  But who knows precisely what our 'subsconcious' 
            is?  I showed these writings to the leader of the 
            spiritualist group. With amazing assurance he said they were 
            typically mediumistic writings coming from a spirit. I was silent. I 
            am very cautious in making such claims. It was certain that the 
            force moving my arm did not come from my consciousness, for there 
            was no active will on my part to move the pencil. But this force 
            could still come from me, from my unconscious. The fact that 
            spiritualists believe that these forces come from spkits is 
            no proof that it really is so!  I continued the experiments and observed myself and 
            the pencil.  One Sunday afternoon my husband and I were sitting 
            together. He was reading a book, and I was busy with my wood 
            carving, and as I worked with my hands, I thought about my recent 
            experiments with pencil, paper and the strange writing. If it is 
            possible, I concluded, for my hand, my nerves or any as yet unknown 
            instrument within me to receive and manifest the thoughts of a 
            strange, disembodied being outside myself, then it must also be 
            possible, in exactly the same way, for me to receive and manifest 
            the thoughts of another person, separate from myself but dwelling in 
            a body. This would mean a step forward along my path.  I told my husband what I was thinking about and 
            asked whether he felt like making an experiment in thought 
            transmission with me. He agreed immediately, and he was as eager as 
            I to know whether we would succeed.  I did not know how such experiments are made, but I 
            imagined that, if I wanted to receive the thoughts of another 
            person, the most important thing for me to do would be to make 
            myself completely passive and empty of my own thoughts so they would 
            not intrude. Then with my right hand I held his left wrist, thinking 
            that it would help for us to have this sort of physical connection; 
            and relaxing all my muscles and trying to think of nothing, I 
            waited.  I imagined that for successful thought transference 
            my husband would think about something and his thought would, in 
            some way or other, appear in my mind. I was thus expecting a 
            thought that would not be coming from me. (At that time I had never 
            realized that we do not actually know the source of the thoughts we 
            believe to be our own!) To my great amazement something quite 
            different happened, something for which I was truly not prepared. As 
            I stood there with my husband and waited to receive a thought from 
            him, I felt very distinctly—and even 'saw'—that a stream of force 
            about three to four inches thick flowed out of his solar plexus 
            area, surrounding my body like a lasso, also at about the height of 
            the solar plexus.  I felt this flow of force as distinctly as if it had 
            been material—very fine, like a dense mist but nevertheless 
            material. After this flow of force surrounded me, it pulled me 
            unmistakably in a definite direction so that I had to take a step. 
            Then it pulled me on and on. Whenever I took a step in the wrong 
            direction, it very distinctly pulled me back into the right 
            direction. In this way we reached the window where the materialized 
            will of my husband left me standing. Then came a new surprise. My 
            left arm which was hanging down at my side as usual, suddenly rose 
            in the air, becoming weightless! Until then I had never 
            realized that my arms hung downward because of the gravitational 
            attraction of the earth. One hears about gravitation in school, but 
            I had never before been conscious of the fact that my own arm hung 
            downward because of this force.  There in front of the window, 
            however, I was able to experience for myself the fact that my arm 
            lost its weight and rose up in the air when the earth's 
            gravitational pull ceased. As my arm moved upward, it also raised 
            the curtain. I had not moved a single muscle, so it seemed. It was 
            as if a mass flowing out from my husband's solar plexus was 
            supporting my arm. Then this mass pushed my head forward until my 
            nose touched the window pane. At this moment, the mass left my 
            body—my arm and my head—and I was able to move again freely.  We looked at each other and were both very excited. 
            I was thrilled by the new experience, the fact that the human will 
            flows out of the solar plexus, literally reaching another person, 
            embracing him like an octopus, and even cancelling out the effect of 
            gravity. This 'material' seemed as if it consisted of myriads of 
            little droplets of mist, somewhat like the milky way appears in the 
            sky at night. It was as if these droplets of mist were all closely 
            related to each other and all flowing in one direction.  My husband was excited because he could not 
            understand how it was possible for me to carry out everything he was 
            thinking—going to the window, raising the curtain, and looking out 
            through the window pane—just as if I were an automaton. I told him 
            that there was a stream of force flowing out from his solar plexus 
            area and that I felt this stream as dearly as if it had been 
            material.  I told him also that it is only subjective when we 
            feel something to be matter. Force gives us the impression of 
            matter.  I recalled that once, several years previously, when 
            our child had a stomach ache and I put our electric heating pad on 
            his stomach, I found when stroking his face, that his skin, which 
            was normally as fine and soft as a rose petal, suddenly felt as 
            rough and coarse as a rasp. It felt as if I were stroking the face 
            of a man two days unshaven. We found out that the heating pad had 
            become a bit damp and some of the current was leaking into the 
            child's body. When I switched off the heating pad, our baby's skin 
            ceased to feel rough to the touch. Hence, to my hand, the electric 
            current felt just like coarse matter. When we consider this fact 
            which everyone can check for himself, we can decide whether we want 
            to compare this 'material' manifestation of the human will with a 
            form of matter or with electric current. The result is the same in 
            either case, for modern science knows that matter is nothing but a 
            form of energy, a vibration, and only gives us the impression of 
            being matter because it is impenetrable for us.  It was the custom for our whole family to get 
            together every Sunday evening; so I soon found myself telling the 
            assembled group about our experience of that afternoon. Everybody 
            immediately wanted to try some experiments too. First I stood up 
            with mother. Everyone else sat quiet as a mouse and tried to think 
            about nothing; for when I was in this ultra-receptive condition, I 
            was so sensitive to the thoughts of persons present that this would 
            have disturbed our thought transference experiment.  With mother I experienced something new again. The 
            current she emitted was weaker, much finer and smaller in diameter 
            than that of my husband. Then I made the same experiment with the 
            various uncles, aunts and other relatives who were gathered that 
            evening for supper at my parents' house. In these experiments I 
            learned that each individual emits a different kind of current. One 
            of my uncles who always found it difficult to make up his mind and 
            discipline his thoughts sent out a large, powerful stream of 
            thought, but the tiny particles of force in this current did not 
            flow in the same direction, but to and fro in a chaotic manner. The 
            effect was just as chaotic. It was a very difficult task for me, 
            too, to find out what he wanted. One of my aunts had a very thin, 
            but piercingly sharp flow of current which to me felt like a stiff, 
            hard wire, hurtful to the touch. We all knew her as a very 
            aggressive person. Each and every person present had a different 
            radiation of will.  This opened up a new world to me! I began to 
            understand many phenomena which I had previously only felt, or 
            suspected, or not noticed at all. All at once it was clear to me why 
            a person can be just as tired after a dispute or argument as if he 
            had been through a wrestling match. I also understood why being 
            together with other people sometimes is very tiring and sometimes 
            very refreshing and stimulating. I understood clearly and in an 
            almost physically palpable manner the real meaning of sympathy and 
            antipathy: emanations that give and those that absorb. The former 
            radiate strength, while the latter cling to a person like the arms 
            of an octopus, drawing out and absorbing his strength. This kind of 
            experiment with such people always made me so weak that my knees 
            would be trembling when the experiment was over; I would have to sit 
            down, completely exhausted, and wait a while to recover strength to 
            continue the experiments. On this particular evening, everyone in 
            the family—including the maid, the cook and my parents' other 
            servants—wanted to make an experiment in thought transference with 
            me.  During that period of my life I learned something 
            else, a fact which cannot be changed by any human decree, namely, 
            that cultured, self-disciplined people emit very different 
            radiations from those of coarse and uncouth people living only for 
            the satisfaction of their instincts. Naturally this is not a matter 
            of social or economic class! Many a simple, unlettered and untutored 
            person living near a forest or on a mountainside, alone and often 
            completely untouched by civilization, emits a higher and purer form 
            of vibrations than those of learned, highly educated and well-read 
            but completely egotistical persons. These radiations cannot be 
            hidden, falsified, counterfeited or 'explained away'. They reveal 
            immediately the kind of person one is dealing with.  I acquired another interesting bit of knowledge 
            through these experiments. Whenever someone wanted me to do 
            something that was against the code of conduct I had been taught to 
            accept, this latter stood like an insulating wall between the will 
            of the other person and myself, and it required tremendous effort on 
            my part to overcome this obstacle with an almost explosive 
            'breakthrough'.  These experiments always fatigued me greatly. Even 
            when I was experimenting with people who had a positive disposition, 
            I first had to empty my own mind and will in order to be receptive 
            to the will of the other, that is, to make the will of the other 
            person conscious within myself and guide the other person's 
            vibrations through my own nerves, suppressing as much as possible my 
            own radiations. This was actually the hardest part. Our nerves are 
            always adapted to our own vibrations; their power of 
            resistance is adjusted to our own vital current.  Every change in our mental or physical state 
            requires an effort from our nerves, irrespective of whether this 
            change is upward or downward. It always makes demands on our nerves. 
            Even when we experience such mental or spiritual changes within 
            ourselves, they can often be harmful, irrespective of whether they 
            are caused by a sudden shock, a passionate outburst, or even 
            excessive joy. Under these circumstances, it is understandable that 
            it can be tiring or deleterious to have to adapt our nerves to 
            completely strange vibrations, differing from our own not only in 
            frequency but even in their very nature. When the difference in 
            vibrations is very great, the result can be substantial damage, 
            over-excitement of the nerves, neuritis or other diseases of the 
            nerves.  This explains why many sensitive people always get 
            mysteriously sick in certain environments. It also explains the 
            great danger threatening every medium, namely the loss of his own 
            character. Unfortunately, this is what happens unavoidably in most 
            cases. The medium receives all kinds of vibrations but cannot digest 
            them or assimilate them; so he becomes chaotic, unreliable and 
            weak-willed himself! We should never play with these things! The 
            literature of this field contains masses of sad stories of different 
            mediums who finally degenerated into weak-willed automatons, 
            receiving any and all kinds of impressions, possessing no resistance 
            of their own, and finally being 'exposed' as lying, cheating frauds. 
            No wonder! As a direct result of their abilities as a medium, their 
            own will became weaker and weaker until they became a mere plaything 
            for the spectators around them.  I myself was witness to this kind of development. 
            One woman with unusually great ability as a medium was able 
            initially to perform prodigious feats. Later, however, she lost her 
            own character to an ever-increasing extent, getting to the point 
            where she had less and less resistance to put up against other 
            people's wishes and was always eager to perform an experiment. 
            Whenever the unknown power did not appear, she began to cheat in 
            order to satisfy the curious people around her. The story ended with 
            a gigantic scandal. As usual, the ignorant people triumphed, 
            claiming that all this woman's accomplishments were nothing but a 
            hoax from beginning to end. No! Her accomplishments were not all a 
            fraud by any means. On the other hand, precisely as a direct 
            result of her true ability as a medium, she became so weak-willed 
            and lacking in character that she finally ended up as a cheat. 
             I was able to observe these effects on myself. I did 
            not want to deceive myself; I wanted to learn the truth, and as time 
            went on I discovered the very pernicious effects of experiments of 
            this nature. I was conscious enough and had a sufficiently strong 
            will to overcome foreign vibrations and to become myself again after 
            each experiment. However, I found that having to resist the 
            influences of other persons made me very tired and nervous and this 
            led me to stop this activity. Later I gave up all spiritualistic 
            experiments completely. I know very well that many spiritualists 
            claim their work of manifesting is not tiring or injurious. I hope 
            they will pardon me for giving my plain, straightforward opinion, 
            based on many years of experiments, namely that those mediums who do 
            not feel tired after their experiments never receive the will of 
            another person or being, but merely produce manifestations 
            from their own unconscious; this despite their firm conviction 
            that their manifestations come from beings outside themselves.  My experiments convinced me that a person can 
            'receive' his own will from some unsuspected complex lying deep 
            in his own subconscious and manifest it just as he would the mil of 
            another being. This is the reason for most of the 
            self-deceptions which occur in this field. But it is impossible to 
            discuss such matters intelligently with ignorant people. They stick 
            to their fantastic belief in 'spirits', deceiving themselves and 
            whole hosts of undisciplined and gullible people. They have not the 
            vaguest idea about their own unconscious powers.  On the other hand, persons who are determined to 
            learn the truth and systematically to check and investigate all 
            phenomena can discover extremely interesting facts. We just 
            have to be careful when we use the word 'spirit'!  Let us just reflect for a moment. If a person's will 
            can cause the arm of another person to rise and thus conquer the 
            gravitational pull of the earth, how much more can it do? What 
            is the limit of its powers? As I began to learn these facts, I 
            understood a phenomenon known here in the West as 'levitation'—an 
            exercise still practised diligently, and carried out even today, in 
            the monasteries of Tibet. Without ever having heard of these Tibetan 
            exercises at that time, my experiments led me to the same 
            conclusions. The phenomenon is known in Europe too, and reliable 
            eye-witnesses have described how the great Teresa of Avila, John of 
            the Cross and Francis of Assisi all were observed to rise and float 
            in the air, not only once, but on numerous occasions and for hours 
            at a time. I know that this is possible; for a person's own 
            will power has the same effect as that of another person and can 
            overcome the earth's gravitational pull for a certain period of 
            time. It all depends on the size and strength of the will.  There were also times during my experiments when I 
            could not become conscious of another person's will. At such times 
            it was impossible for me to manifest what he was thinking. On such 
            occasions I felt as if the mass of his will were bearing down on me 
            like a giant weight. I found it hard to breathe, sighing and 
            groaning as if I were dying. I would then ask the person concerned 
            to concentrate better. As soon as I became conscious of his will and 
            carried it out, I was able to breathe easily and freely again and 
            the terrible pressure ceased! These experiments gave me the 
            conviction that in very many cases asthma is nothing else but the 
            invisible will of another person bearing down like a heavy weight 
            upon the diseased individual. On the other hand, this invisible, 
            unexecuted will can be that of the diseased person himself coming 
            forth from his unconscious and causing his sickness without his 
            knowing that his disease is indeed the result of his own will. 
             Our entire life consists of such invisible battles. 
            In some we are defeated, in others victorious.  These experiments and experiences were a splendid 
            school for me. They gave me an opportunity to look deep into the 
            unconscious and to get thoroughly acquainted with myself and with 
            other people. I became firmly convinced that it is possible to 
            receive the thoughts of another being. But at the same time I saw 
            how extremely difficult it is! I came to understand why the Tibetans 
            or the East Indians spend three days in the wilderness—miles away 
            from every human settlement—fasting, praying, and otherwise 
            preparing themselves before they seek to establish a connection with 
            the spirit of a departed person. Certainly not the way thousands of 
            so-called spiritualists, after their work in an office or in the 
            midst of a completely worldly life, gather together and believe they 
            can suddenly be in rapport with the world beyond.  They imagine that saying a quick little prayer will 
            protect them from danger. Have they ever been able to observe that 
            saying a prayer can keep a person who jumps into an abyss from 
            falling to his death? Experimenting ignorantly with spiritualism 
            represents just as great a danger as jumping into an abyss. Let us 
            be reasonable! Let us not forget that we have the power of reason in 
            order to check and test all our experiences. During the many years I 
            have spent in the most widely differing groups, I was forced to 
            observe how countless catas-trophies, nervous breakdowns, suicides, 
            and serious mental disorders resulted from the irresponsible games 
            people call spiritualism. Well-intentioned, honest but completely 
            ignorant and psychologically unschooled people hold seances! 
            Ignorant people call into being powers whose origin and nature is 
            completely unknown to them. Neither understanding these powers, nor 
            being able to control them, they are completely at their mercy. Only 
            people who are strong enough to resist all influences, have deep 
            psychological knowledge, extensive experience and an enormous 
            conscious will power and self control should concern themselves 
            and experiment with spiritualism.
           
             I TAKE MY VOW Little by little I realized that my circles of 
            spiritualist friends had nothing more to offer me. My experiences in 
            these circles, however, opened the door to the human soul, and I saw 
            in amazement how forlorn and lonely people are as they wander around 
            in the extreme darkness of ignorance. My own ability as a medium 
            enabled me to look into the enormous field of the subconscious. I 
            literally took myself apart in the most rigorous kind of 
            self-analysis, refusing to be blinded by uncertain and nebulous 
            theories. Hewing my way with my little axe, I went ahead in this 
            jungle, step by step. Spiritualism finally led me to the study of 
            psychology. I began to make a thorough study of the Western 
            science of psychology; for at that time I had not the slightest 
            inkling of the enormous psychological knowledge of the Orientals, 
            particularly the Indians and the Chinese.  Whenever we earnestly strive for something and 
            concentrate completely on attaining it, fate always helps us onward. 
            After a thorough theoretical training, I met the head physician of 
            the state mental hospital who helped me get systematic training and 
            practice. I was given permission to study the patients in every 
            section of the state asylum, including the wards reserved for raving 
            maniacs.  One evening at home I sat for a long time alone in 
            my room and tried to put my thoughts in order. What I had 
            experienced in the asylum was simply horrible! Terrible! Dante's 
            Inferno is tame compared to what I had seen. And how many sick 
            people are there on this earth who are suffering, either committed 
            to an asylum or walking about freely; and how many healthy people 
            are there who suffer themselves because they watch the torture these 
            other people go through. Little by little they get sick and go to 
            ruin. And how many mental cases are there who deceive ignorant 
            people simply because they behave normally and have no stamp on 
            their forehead to show they are mentally ill.  Sometimes they get high positions, marry an innocent 
            trusting husband or wife, and then plunge their relatives, their 
            surroundings and family, often an entire business firm—or even an 
            entire nation—into ruin.  Hell lay open before my very eyes, and in 
            desperation I stood on the brink of an unfathomable ocean of 
            suffering, desperate at the helplessness of mankind in the face of 
            this terrible misery.  Something must be done! Everybody must be informed 
            about the causes of mental disease. Healthy people everywhere must 
            work together with united efforts to fight this misery.  My preoccupation with the mentally ill opened the 
            door to the deepest secrets of a wide range of people's families, 
            and I was amazed to discover that there are many more mentally ill 
            than sane people living in the world. I saw the countless mental 
            abnormalities from which people suffer, and I saw that vast numbers 
            of people could be saved by proper treatment; their mental balance 
            could be restored by simple means, often merely by a change of 
            surroundings, thus restoring happiness to the families concerned.
             I sat and pondered about how much could be done if 
            every healthy person would devote himself to this work. With all my 
            strength I wanted to devote myself to overcoming this suffering ... 
            but how and where should I begin?  And where could I find some help?  As I sat there asking myself this question I 
            suddenly knew that somebody was in the room beside me. My 
            experiments with mental telepathy and spiritualistic seances had 
            trained my nerves to such a degree of sensitivity that even if I 
            were led into a room blindfolded, I could say immediately whether 
            the room was empty or occupied. And if the room was occupied I could 
            even tell something about the character of the person in it. I now 
            felt the familiar prickly feeling, like a fine electric current, 
            telling me that something or somebody was near. But this time I felt 
            the familiar radiation without knowing why it was familiar or where 
            I had met it before ... this majestic, completely pure, extremely 
            powerful radiation ... and again I heard the familiar voice inside 
            me: 'Where will you find some help? Inside yourself! Don't you see 
            this is just the trouble—everybody is waiting for help from outside, 
            and as everybody is expecting help and not giving it, 
            nobody gets help. But if everybody would give help, everybody 
            would receive it too. Then the whole world could be freed of 
            suffering!'  I answered the voice within: 'I don't know who you 
            are or even what kind of a force you are; I only hear your voice 
            that always tells me the truth. You see my thoughts, my inner being 
            which is invisible to people, so I don't need to tell you I want to 
            devote my whole life to overcoming the sufferings of others. Even 
            though I be only a grain of dust, with this one grain of dust I want 
            to increase the helping force. Nothing else in life can interest me 
            any more, nothing can make me really happy again as long as I 
            constantly carry the sufferings of others in my consciousness. I 
            want to be a co-worker in the salvation of the world!'  'Careful!' said the voice within me. 'Watch all 
            those big words! To be a coworker means duty and sacrifice. Then you 
            have to put an end to your imperfections! You must never forget 
            yourself for even a minute. You must always be on guard that you 
            don't do a single thing in contradiction to the eternal laws of 
            life. All the temptations you haven't been able to withstand so 
            far in your life will come back to haunt you again and woe to you if 
            you do not withstand them. No mortal can play with the divine 
            forces. You may never again use the powers you achieve as a 
            co-worker for your own personal ends. You may never have 
            personal feelings or consider anything from your own personal 
            standpoint. Be careful! It would be better to go on living your 
            personal life like other people than fail as a co-worker. I warn 
            you.'  'I am not afraid,' I answered. 'I am absolutely 
            through with my personal life and no longer have any more personal 
            wishes. After all I've been through and experienced, there can be no 
            more personal happiness for me. I'm not afraid of any temptations. I 
            will resist them because I have no more illusions. I want to be a 
            co-worker in the great task!'  For a while I heard nothing, merely felt infinitely 
            great love radiating towards me. Then I heard the voice within me 
            again: 'Your self-assurance is well known to me, my child, but don't 
            forget yourself this time ...'  I sat on the divan, rubbed my brow, looked 
            around—the room was empty. Who was that? Who is that?—Or what kind 
            of a power is it that speaks to me with a voice I know so well? How 
            do I know this voice? How does it know my 'self-assurance'? And when 
            had I ever not paid enough attention ... so as to merit the 
            admonition not to forget myself 'this time'?  But I got no further answer.      THE HORIZON BRIGHTENS  Days passed, weeks passed, months passed ... I 
            waited for a sign, something that would point the way towards what I 
            should do, towards my duty, towards my sacrifice ... in accord with 
            the voice of the invisible one who had spoken to me, but the voice 
            came no more ...  No matter how often I tried to enter the special 
            state of mind and spirit in which I would feel again the strange and 
            indescribable buzzing and tingling throughout my whole body, as if I 
            were bathing in soda water, no matter how often I tried to close off 
            my organs of sense, to get myself into a state of inner receptivity, 
            ready to hear the voice ... it was all to no avail.  I was perplexed. I was waiting and waiting for a 
            sign—in vain. On the other hand I did not want to waste time; so I 
            came to the conclusion that the best thing for me to do would be to 
            carry out my earthly duties as well as possible, hoping all the 
            while that my inner voice would sooner or later tell me what my duty 
            was to be as a co-worker in the great plan. I also felt that I would 
            have to free my soul of every selfish attitude if I wanted to see 
            the truth with perfect clarity, just as a window pane must be clean 
            in order for us to see the sunshine clearly through it. The first 
            step in this direction is to know what is really inside me. As soon 
            as I know my inner self throughly, I can cleanse and purify it.  I began to investigate the source and inner 
            motivation of all my thoughts, my words, my movements and deeds. 
            What kind of unconscious power is at work within me? Where do my 
            thoughts come from? What is it within me that wills me to say 
            one thing or another? Why do I want to do just this thing, 
            not something else? When I was happy about something, I investigated
            why I was happy about it. When I was depressed or angry, I 
            sought out the reasons for these feelings. When I felt attracted 
            toward another person or repelled by him, I immediately analysed 
            myself to discover the characteristics responsible for this feeling. 
             
             I kept myself under constant observation as to why I liked to do 
            some things and disliked doing others. When I was feeling talkative, 
            I sought to find the reasons and motives behind my loquaciousness; 
            when feeling reserved, I sought the reasons for my taciturnity. I 
            analysed every word that came out of my mouth to see whether it was 
            completely true, whether it could prove hurtful to no one. I 
            observed the effects of my words and my deeds on others around me. I 
            constantly tried to trade places in my imagination with the person 
            to whom I was speaking. What would I feel if he were 
            saying to me the words I was saying to him? Constantly, 
            uninterruptedly, I kept myself under observation.  This everlasting self-scrutiny brought me uncounted 
            riches. Little by little I became acquainted with the magical world 
            of the subconscious and super-conscious. I came to recognize the 
            various manifestations of one and the same force, from the 
            lowest urges on up to the highest spiritual self. I came to realize 
            that we have a free choice: we can identify ourselves with our 
            instincts or remain masters of them, that is to say, remain 
            ourselves! I learned that to be a free human being means to 
            control one's instincts and not become the slave of one's passions, 
            desires and wishes.  Along with my incessant self-analysis, I continued 
            to study psychology and philosophy, without neglecting my wood 
            carving or my music. Artistic work provides a wonderful opportunity 
            to turn inward spiritually and to ponder all kinds of questions.  Once an art critic was visiting us and saw my 
            furniture that I had carved myself. Over the bed I had hung a faun 
            playing a flute all carved out of wood. The critic asked me whether 
            I had first modelled this figure in clay. I told him I didn't even 
            know how to model in clay and that I had carved it straight out of 
            wood. 'I simply cut away all the wood that was superfluous,' I said.
             'Have you studied anatomy?' he asked further.  'No, I studied music and was not able to attend two 
            colleges at the same time.'  After scrutinizing my carvings a little while longer 
            he said, 'It's a shame you're not a sculptress!'  'Without training I would always be a dilettante, 
            and that's just what I wouldn't want to be. But I cannot register at 
            the art academy because I don't want to neglect my husband and 
            child.'  'All right,' he said, 'I'll talk to the Director of 
            the School of Manual Arts. He may perhaps make an exception and 
            permit you to attend the lessons in sculpture without taking all the 
            side courses. You don't need them anyway. I believe it should be 
            possible for you to attend the art school on special terms.'  In this way I was able first to attend art school 
            and later to receive training from one of the greatest master 
            sculptors of the time. The first time I reported to him, he came 
            very close to me, peered into my face intently, and said in a very 
            surprised tone, 'How interesting! You are the first living person I 
            have ever seen with Egyptian eyes. Did you know you have Egyptian 
            eyes?'  'No,' I replied, 'I don't even know what the 
            difference is between Egyptian eyes and ordinary eyes.'  'The openings of the eyes are slit longitudinally at 
            the side of the eye, and this makes the eyelids rest in a completely 
            different position from those of other races. When you look at a 
            picture, you can tell immediately by this characteristic whether the 
            picture is Egyptian or not. But I never dreamed I would find such 
            eyes in a living person. Present day Egyptians don't have eyes like 
            this any more. One only sees them in pictures, just as one can only 
            see the long, drawn-out Egyptian skull formation in pictures and 
            sculptured artifacts. But where did you get these eyes of yours?'
             I smiled politely and said, 'I just don't know, 
            Professor. Perhaps I am reverting to type.'  He smiled too, then started me on my work.  A year later he entered the studio where I was 
            working. He had several of them all near each other.  'From now on,' he said, 'I'm not accepting any more 
            tuition from you. If you have no studio of your own, you can work 
            here, but as an independent artist. You no longer need my guidance, 
            only practice in order to get better and better at expressing 
            yourself in this medium.'  I thanked him for his efforts and for his kind 
            offer. Since I had a large studio at home and had already held 
            several exhibits, I continued my work under my own roof. My 
            professor remained a good friend and dropped in from time to time to 
            see how my work was progressing.  The work made me happy—completely happy, even 
            ecstatic. Time, space and the world around me ceased to exist; I 
            felt no physical wishes, hunger or thirst—I even forgot myself 
            completely. I-noticed that a force flowed into my nerves while I was 
            concentrating on my work, and that this force exerted a healing 
            influence on mind and body. Many times when I was concentrating on 
            my work and thinking about nothing else, I suddenly recognized a 
            truth which had no relationship whatever with my work. In this way I 
            often received answers to philosophical, psychological or other 
            unsolved problems which had been occupying my mind. In such cases I 
            would stand motionless a moment, my modelling tool in my hand, while 
            my inward eye surveyed the new truth, the new discovery.  At such 
            moments I felt as if my head had just poked up through the ceiling 
            of one room and emerged above the floor in an upper room. It was a 
            wonderful feeling to look around with my inward eye in this newly 
            discovered upper room, inspecting all the hidden treasure lying 
            there. These brilliant flashes of inspiration began to come more and 
            more frequently, not only while I was modelling in clay or playing 
            the piano, but almost any time when I was concentrating on 
            something.  Once I experienced something very strange! This 
            time, however, it did not occur during my work, but in the late 
            evening just as I was about to drop off to sleep.  Our beds were next to each other, and we both had 
            the habit of reading for a a little while in bed before falling 
            asleep. On this particular evening we both of us read for a while. 
            Finally I got sleepy, said good night to my husband, turned off my 
            reading lamp, stretched, and closed my eyes to go to sleep. I closed 
            my eyes, but I still saw everything in the room! My eyes were 
            closed quite normally, but I was able to see everything—every 
            object—in the room, including my husband lying in his bed next to 
            mine and leafing through his book. I quickly opened my eyes again to 
            see whether my husband really was leafing through his book or 
            whether the whole phenomenon had been a projection from my own 
            imagination.  But his motions continued just as I had seen them with 
            my eyes closed! I closed my eyes again but still saw everything. 
            Thus surprised, I sat up in bed again, looked around the room with 
            my eyes closed, and still saw everything quite clearly! Only one 
            thing was very peculiar, namely, that I did not see things in three 
            dimensions, but flat and transparent—just as my eyelids seemed to be 
            transparent like a photographic negative, or like an X-ray picture, 
            but much clearer and more transparent. For example, I saw my sewing 
            machine through its wooden cover, the pictures on the wall in the 
            next room through the closed door, the clothes hanging in the 
            closet, and all my little possessions lying chaotically in my 
            writing desk. The whole picture was like an impression of all the 
            things lying one behind the other.  My husband watched for a while as I looked around 
            the room in various directions with my eyes closed.  'What are you doing?' he finally asked.  All excited, I answered that I was able to see 
            everything in the room with my eyes closed. He became curious and 
            tried several little experiments to find out whether I could see how 
            many fingers he was holding up, and similar things. I was not only 
            able to see his finger's, but even the bones and organs in his body. 
            It was really positively weird, but my sense of humour won the upper 
            hand and I burst out laughing at seeing him so transparent.  Finally we did fall asleep. As usual, I slept 
            peacefully, and the next morning I saw everything quite normally 
            again, and only when my eyes were open. And for quite a long time 
            afterwards, there was no recurrence of this strange phenomenon. I 
            went on with my sculpturing as if nothing had happened.  As I continued to work with my modelling tools, I 
            did not neglect my studies in psychology. More and more people came 
            to me to discuss their spiritual problems. In this way I kept on 
            gaining in practical experience.  Several years went by in this manner: steady work in 
            the wintertime, family life together on the lake shore amid the 
            beauties of nature in the summer.    
             VISIONS There came a period in my life in which I often had 
            visions while perfectly wide awake. Many of them had such a 
            tremendous effect on me and on my later life that I must mention the 
            most important of them.  Towards the end of every summer my husband and I 
            made a journey through various countries. Once, as we were on our 
            way back from Italy, we stopped over in the Dolomites for some 
            mountain climbing. Here I experienced one of the most profoundly 
            impressive visions of my life.  One evening after an exhausting day in the 
            mountains, we returned to our hotel and I lay down. The sun had 
            shone with such intense fierceness during our hiking that it had 
            seemed as if every single ray were a spear aimed straight at my back 
            and my heart. The gigantic reddish rock walls reflected the sunshine 
            in every direction, seeming to magnify it a thousandfold. The whole 
            atmosphere was demonic; everything was glowing with heat as if we 
            were walking in the antechamber of Hell. I was really happy when we 
            finally turned towards home, and the sun which had been burning like 
            a flame-thrower disappeared behind the horizon at last.  I went to bed early and stretched out, ready to fall 
            asleep. In this self-same instant I suddenly felt as if the ceiling 
            were falling in on me ... as if I were falling into a bottomless 
            abyss ... falling towards instant death. A doctor, summoned at the 
            desperate plea of my husband, found I was suffering from a heart 
            attack. He gave me an injection. The night dragged by, and when 
            morning came my pulse beat was still so weak that it was scarcely 
            discernible. Tortured with a feeling of annihilation, I learned to 
            know what it means to be afraid of death. As was my custom, I 
            observed myself closely, even under those circumstances, discovering 
            that fear of death is a physical condition. In my consciousness 
            there was peace and calm, no fear of death at all; yet I was 
            suffering from such terrible fear of death that I can scarcely find 
            words to express it. It was unbearable. I was no longer completely 
            in this world, and not yet in the next. I was hovering in 
            nothingness, suffering so horribly I thought I would rather die than 
            go on bearing this torture. I gave up the struggle, deciding to go 
            into death knowingly in order to escape from this fear of it.  However, just as I wanted to glide over with my 
            consciousness into this nothingness of which I had been so afraid, 
            the space around me suddenly expanded in all directions, and 
            infinity spread out before my astonished eyes. In this infinity, I 
            saw a long, long road winding onward, and at its end, beyond 
            everything material, standing in eternity, the majestic form of a 
            man made of blinding light, his arms stretched out in indescribable 
            love. He seemed infinitely far away from me, and his countenance 
            shone with such an intensely powerful light that it blinded me and I 
            could not see his features. Nevertheless, I recognized him as the 
            Saviour of the world.  On the road, oval beings that looked like eggs were 
            moving forward slowly. As they moved along together, they gave me 
            the impression of so many sheep, viewed from such an angle that only 
            their backs were visible, but not their feet. I stood at the 
            beginning of this road and had to show them the way. They jogged 
            past me slowly in a steady stream, moving in the direction of the 
            figure of light who awaited them with outstretched arms. Those who 
            reached him, entered into his light and disappeared, merging 
            with his resplendent glory. The whole long road was covered with a 
            seemingly endless stream of these oval beings which I recognized as
            human souls. I showed them the way and kept on pointing out 
            the direction to take, as more and ever more of these souls 
            approached.  I began to realize that I was not yet going to die, 
            because I still had this work to do, and that I could not die at all 
            until I had fulfilled this task. I realized, too, that I would be 
            doing this work for a very long time, until my sand in the great 
            cosmic hour-glass would run out and I myself would return to my 
            homeland of light where ever-radiant love would be awaiting me.  Infinite peace came over me, and my heart began to 
            function more normally, even though still weak. I glanced at my 
            husband who was observing me with a worried face. I could move my 
            tongue again a little, and I whispered to him that I was better. The 
            poor dear boy cried like a child out of pure joy that I could speak 
            again and that the light was coming back into my eyes.  After another day in bed, I had recovered 
            sufficiently to be able to travel again. A few days more and all was 
            back to normal.  During our summertime sojourns at the lake shore, I 
            was almost always more receptive to visions and in a state of 
            greater sensitivity for sending and receiving telepathic messages. 
            Once during our summer vacation we went to bed after a happy day. 
            The house became quiet, and I fell asleep beside my husband. I 
            dreamed all kinds of chaotic, apparently unrelated pictures, and 
            then in my dream I suddenly heard steps ... slow, dragging steps. 
            They caused me to realize that I had dozed off where I was sitting 
            at the top of a long flight of stairs. For a long time there had 
            been no one passing from whom I could beg anything. Now the sound of 
            someone approaching woke me. In a few moments I was quite awake, 
            with my eyes wide open. Then I saw that the slow, dragging steps 
            were those of a very old, broken man who had plodded along painfully 
            to the position I occupied and was now preparing to sit down at the 
            other side of this flight of stairs.  These stairs led from where we were, in an elevated 
            corner of the city, down into the centre of town below. In the 
            section around us, there were many state and municipal offices, so 
            thousands of people had to go up and down these steps every day. 
            Only now, at midday, is there a short intermission in the otherwise 
            steady stream of people. It's a good place for me to sit. The roof 
            at the entrance of the staircase protects me from rain, and my 
            revenue is good. I have my 'regular customers' who give me alms 
            every day on the way to their offices. But what an impertinence it 
            is for this old beggar to post himself here too! He's bound to do me 
            harm. People going by are not going to give to two beggars at once, 
            and so I am certain to lose half of my income.  I look at him impatiently and want to tell him to go 
            somewhere else to do his begging; this is my place and it's up to 
            him to clear out! I look at him and an uncertain feeling grips me. I 
            peer into his eyes and suddenly feel uneasy. I see that he too is 
            embarrassed. He makes a movement as if to run away, but it is too 
            late. I recognize him, and he recognizes me. O Father of mercy, it 
            is he! Here is the man I have been seeking all my life, the 
            man who abandoned me, the man I could never forget. And now he is 
            sitting opposite me, a beggar just like myself. O why, O why do we 
            have to meet again like this!  I look at him, his wrinkled old face, and his skin. 
            His lips hang loose and limp; his thin, matted hair and his beard 
            are neglected: his clothing consists of old, worn out rags. What has 
            become of the handsome, elegant young cavalier he was once? He looks 
            at me in pain and anguish, conscious of his debt ... ashamed. His 
            old, wrinkled face contorts. His weak and flabby lips droop 
            downward, and he begins to cry in silence. He reaches upward to wipe 
            away his tears, and so I see his hands covered with brittle skin, 
            cracked and full of wounds; his long, dirty finger nails; his stiff, 
            neglected, revolting, gouty fingers. Oh, these hands that were once 
            so beautiful, so elegant, so well cared for ... these hands I was 
            once so happy to kiss ...  Then I look at my hands ... O horrors! ... they are 
            just as old and neglected as his. When I raised them up, I see my 
            own fingers bent and knotted with gout, the skin of my hands cracked 
            and bloody in thousands of places. Since when have my hands become 
            so horrible, so revolting? I do not know! I have never thought of 
            observing myself. I have been living like a sleep walker. Now, as if 
            coming out of a stupor, I begin to remember. It is as if a heavy, 
            impenetrable fog covering my consciousness were now beginning to 
            roll back and give me a clear view. I survey my whole life, my 
            situation among people who treated me as if I were half animal, 
            without love, without pity. In my semi-conscious state, I put up 
            with everything, their many blows, their heartiessness, their 
            ridicule as they—the people on the farm—made fun of my imperfections 
            and my helplessness. How could I have thought about the way my hands 
            looked, or about my appearance in general? When I was young, I 
            sometimes wanted to be pretty to please him. In those days I 
            tied coloured ribbons in my hair, but after I lost him and the baby, 
            I didn't care about anything any more.  I never thought again at all about looking in a 
            mirror, and didn't care how my hands looked. I only cared what 
            people put in my outstretched, begging hands. Yes, now I can 
            suddenly remember clearly that many people, as they were reaching 
            over to put a coin in my hand, and I was grasping it eagerly, 
            quickly drew back their hand from mine and let the money fall in 
            order not to touch my fingers. Now I understand. Now I am disgusted 
            too when I look at my decrepit hands ... when I look at my dirty, 
            torn, stinking beggar's rags. I wonder what my face looks like? O, 
            if only he had not abandoned me so cruelly, neither of us would now 
            be in this terrible state of neglect, and I would not have lost the 
            child ... Why? Why did it all have to happen? And why must we meet 
            again in this way? Our lives are over! There is no way we can make 
            amends! It's all over ... too late! ... too late!  Unspeakable hopelessness comes over me and I plunge 
            into absolute despair. A terrible pain cuts through my whole being. 
            I feel my heart is breaking. A cramp holds my heart as in a vice. 
            Then everything blacks out before me ... everything disappears ... I 
            fall into an abyss of nothingness.  Someone is groaning, rasping and gasping ... I hear 
            it and want to see who it is ... slowly it gets light around me, and 
            then my glance comes to rest on my husband's terrified face. 
            Suddenly I realize that I am the one who is struggling to breathe. I 
            am sitting up in bed, and he is shaking me desperately. When he sees 
            that I recognize him, he breathes a sigh of relief and asks in a 
            half-terrified voice:  'What's the matter with you? Are you all right 
            again? I was frightened stiff. I woke up because of your groaning. 
            You were sitting up in bed with your eyes wide open, but you didn't 
            recognize me. You were looking right through me, right off into 
            space ... didn't even see me. What's the matter with you? For 
            Heaven's sake tell me what's the matter!'  I look at him, open my mouth to reply, but cannot 
            bring forth a single sound. My throat is still clamped shut out of 
            sheer horror. Little by little I recover my senses enough to form 
            words he can hear and understand: 'Not now—I cannot speak 
            now—tomorrow.'  My husband stops asking questions, and I fall back 
            on my pillows. He holds my hand in his as he observes me carefully. 
            Then, seeing I have calmed down again, he puts out the light.  The next morning as we sat together in the garden, I 
            told him my vision of the previous night.  I was a beggar woman who remembered her whole life, 
            and I am—or was once—this beggar woman. I remember 
            everything clearly that I once experienced when I was this woman. It 
            was my own life which suddenly awakened to consciousness.  'I was an abandoned servant girl,' I went on telling 
            my husband, 'living on a large country estate. I had no father, and 
            had no memory of ever having had either father or mother. Among the 
            many people around me as I grew up, there was a coachman who took 
            care of the horses, men servants who cut wood and fed the hunting 
            dogs, the cook who worked in the big kitchen and many other girls 
            working in the kitchen, the courtyard and the house. This is where I 
            have grown up, and this is all I know as home. Ever since I can 
            remember, people have been pushing me around, and I have had to work 
            at whatever jobs they gave me to do. After I grew up, I also had to 
            help in the big house where our master and his family lived. It was 
            a huge house with many rooms, and I learnt from the chambermaids 
            that the rooms and their furnishings were all very beautiful. I was 
            never allowed to enter them because I had no shoes, and only 
            servants with shoes were allowed inside. I was an outside maid. All 
            the rooms opened on to a very, very long corridor, and it was my job 
            to keep this corridor clean. I carried over huge buckets of water 
            from the well.  Then, kneeling down, I scrubbed the big coloured 
            tiles with a brush. I still see these tiles quite close to my face 
            as I bend over them and rub, rub, rub, move back a row and then rub 
            some more. Now and again I pour out water on to the floor and go on 
            rubbing, row by row ... endlessly! And when I finally do finish, I 
            have to wash the corridor on the floor above. Days go by ... months 
            and years, and I go on washing and scrubbing these same stone 
            floors. I am contented and seldom think about anything beyond the 
            work I have to do. I like to wash these tile floors. They are 
            colourful, and I like colourful things. In return for my work I can 
            eat in the kitchen and sleep in a little room over the stable behind 
            the house. In the courtyard I often see carriages which do not 
            belong to our master. They belong to his guests who have already 
            alighted at the front door. The coachmen drive their carriages into 
            the courtyard, unhitch the horses, walk them around in a circle 
            until they are cooled off, then lead them into the stable for the 
            night. Many guests come for hunting and then my corridors are full 
            of mud. The many men walk around with muddy boots, and I have to get 
            up at the crack of dawn to wash my corridors so they will be clean 
            when my master and his guests get up.  'One day when I happen to be in the courtyard, a 
            wonderfully handsome young man comes out of the house, crosses the 
            courtyard and enters the stable to look after his horse. He has his 
            horse saddled, mounts and rides away. As if struck by magic, I look 
            up at him. He is so marvellously handsome, and once he even looks 
            around at me! I idolize him as if he were a God, and later during 
            that very same night when he visits me in my little room, I allow 
            him with joyous abandon to do with me whatever he wishes. His face 
            shines through the mists which obscure my mind ... for long and 
            rapturous minutes I am in his arms ...  'As he often came for hunting, my life was made up 
            of happy days when he was there and long days of waiting for him to 
            return.  'In a year's time our baby came. The cook helped me 
            when I sought assistance and collapsed in front of her door. I did 
            not know what was happening. But after I had endured terrible 
            suffering and they laid the baby in my arms, I felt warmth in my 
            heart for it. For the first time in my life I was really happy. 
            Somebody needed me; for somebody I meant everything! The cook 
            spoke with her mistress, who came, looked at me and the child, and 
            gave her consent for the child to remain with me. I will work, I 
            promised, harder than ever before, if only I can keep my child ...
             'When he, the father of my child, came back to our 
            house again for a visit and came up to my little room to see me 
            again, as was his custom, I proudly showed him the child and asked 
            him to allow me to work in his house, on his estate, so that I could 
            serve him. At first he shrank back horrified and then went on to say 
            it was not at all sure that he was the father. "Who knows", he said, 
            "what servant around here may be the father!" In vain I tried to 
            explain to him that no man had ever touched me, that I had defended 
            myself like a wild animal, and that I had allowed only him to do as 
            he wished with me. In vain I pleaded with him to allow me to work in 
            his vicinity, promising not to molest or disturb him if only I could 
            be near him. For a while he listened. Then as I knelt before him, my 
            arms around his knees, he pushed me away and ran out into the night. 
            I never saw him again. Whether or not he ever came back to the 
            house, I do not know. In any case, he never entered our courtyard 
            again. In vain I waited year after year. He disappeared out of my 
            life. But the baby was there! It meant everything to me. It filled 
            my every waking thought. It meant more to me than life itself!  'I scrubbed the coloured tiles in the corridor and 
            thought of my baby ... I drew water from the well and thought of my 
            baby. I hurried through my work even harder and faster, so that I 
            could be with the child. It was a girl, pretty and intelligent like 
            her father. She always did the opposite of what I told her, brooking 
            no opposition. The more I became her slave, the less loving she was 
            to me. When she was still quite small, she was rude and 
            disrespectful towards me. Nothing I said or did pleased her, and 
            what she liked best was to leave me and run around the countryside 
            alone. Sometimes she went so far that she came back only the next 
            day. I was in desperation and, when work was over, went out into the 
            night to try to find her. When she came back the next day, the light 
            came back into my life and everything was all right again.  'One day my child left me and did not come back. I 
            waited in desperation, searched throughout the surrounding 
            region—waited and hunted—but to no avail, my daughter was gone. The 
            sun went out of my life, my world was suddenly empty; I had nothing 
            more to live for and was absolutely unable to work. After a time I 
            could bear it no longer and went away to search for my child. I 
            never returned. I travelled from town to town and village to village 
            asking people whether they had seen my child. Years went by, and I 
            was still searching. Searching without hope, going on and on out of 
            pure habit, driven by inner unrest. People gave me food to eat, and 
            as my clothes began to wear thin and get torn, they would give me 
            old worn out odds and ends of clothing. I kept on going from place 
            to place, on and on ...  'Once in my wanderings I met the cook I had worked 
            with on the country estate. In the meantime she had married and was 
            living with her husband in this city where I met her. She took me 
            home, gave me some supper and told me that the father of my child 
            ...'  Here my husband suddenly seized my hand and 
            interrupted my story. White as a sheet and with trembling voice, he 
            said, 'Wait, wait! I'll go on with the story. I know what happened.
            I remember what happened then! While you were talking, 
            everything suddenly became clear to me. I recognized myself and I 
            know I was this man who abandoned you. I know I was terribly 
            frivolous then and lacking in responsibility. I lived only to amuse 
            myself and threw my money around with both hands until the day came 
            when I lost everything.  'My family property was auctioned off, and I was 
            obliged to leave my land and my manor. At first I turned to the 
            friends who had spent time drinking and gambling with me and 
            otherwise helping me squander my inheritance. But after a few weeks 
            they made it obvious that my presence in their homes was 
            superfluous. This experience was repeated with other so-called 
            friends until I was completely disgusted at myself and at them. 
            About that time, a real friend advised me to go to work. I wanted to 
            make a fresh start and sincerely tried to get work, but nobody took 
            me and my search for work seriously. I did not know how to 
            work, or what I should do. And so I sank lower and lower. Finally I 
            got a fixed idea that my tragic lot was God's punishment for having 
            so despicably abandoned you and our child. I went to see my friend 
            in whose home you had worked. I had no mission other than to find 
            out what had happened to you both, but when I came you were gone, 
            and no one knew where. As time went on, I found fewer and fewer 
            friends willing to lend me money.  'When the time came that none of my erstwhile 
            friends would take me in and give me a "loan" and as I was getting 
            on in years, I began to ask complete strangers for help. So little 
            by little I became a beggar, roaming the country, travelling from 
            place to place, and spending the night wherever good-hearted people 
            would allow me to sleep in their barn or stable. Physically as well 
            as financially I fell further and further into ruin. With hunger 
            plaguing me more and more as I got on in years, I finally reached 
            the point where I had no pride or self respect any more at all and 
            began to beg publicly on busy street corners. Thus it came about 
            that we finally met as beggars.'  I listened eagerly to everything he told me, for it 
            was exactly as I knew it to be. I knew from the very beginning that 
            my husband was the old beggar, and I was amazed that he too 
            remembered this previous existence in as much detail as I. The 
            events he recalled tallied exactly with what the cook told me when I 
            visited her, namely that he had squandered his inheritance and 
            estate, and that one time—much later—he had come by the manor where 
            I had worked in the hope of finding me. There was nothing left of 
            the dashing young cavalier he had once been. Through sheer neglect 
            and lack of honest effort, he had already become a human derelict, 
            roaming the countryside and looking for hand-outs. After I had met 
            the cook, I went back to our old manor to ask whether anyone knew 
            his address. But there was no one who knew where he had gone or 
            where he could be found. As I got on in years, I found it harder and 
            harder to travel. Finally I settled in the city and made my living 
            by begging near the stairs. It was there we finally met again and 
            there I passed my last hours. For when I recognized him and realized 
            that my whole life had been wasted and that there was no way of 
            making amends because it was too late ... too late ... our child was 
            lost and my life was over ... I died right there sitting on the 
            corner stone. My memories stopped there ...  For a long time we looked at each other speechless, 
            scarcely believing that such a thing could happen to two intelligent 
            people in this modern world. What we had just experienced cannot be 
            explained by any of the current theories of heredity or psychology.
            We knew that everything had really and truly happened just that 
            way! There was no imagination involved!  The experience of having remembered this earlier 
            meeting shook us both to the depths of our being. For a long time we 
            sat beside each other in complete silence, while our thoughts spun 
            around in circles. Finally my husband said, 'I never before wondered 
            why, since my early youth, I have strictly avoided drinking, cards 
            and other games of chance, dancing and all other forms of social 
            life. This despite the fact that it is very much in my nature to 
            enjoy drinking, dancing and entertainment. Now I realize how, after 
            squandering my inheritance in riotous living and being obliged to 
            live in abject misery, the idea was hammered home deeper and deeper 
            into my consciousness that I must never again drink, never again 
            gamble, never again be careless and happy-go-lucky.  'Since then I have learnt to recognize the value of 
            money. And I have come to realize that the worth of a human being 
            begins when he is able to make a living for himself and his family.
            All of these views now lie anchored deep in my subconscious 
            because of what I learned and came to realize in that incarnation. 
            That's why, in my present life, I was so anxious to study—just study 
            throughout all the years of my youth. The subconscious knowledge and 
            recognition of these facts was what gave me strength to resist and 
            say "no" when the boys I went to college with set out to amuse 
            themselves. I was always afraid that something terrible would happen 
            to me if I allowed myself to get caught up in their parties and 
            social life. Now I realize that I was only afraid of the misery 
            which resulted from my devil-may-care way of living in that previous 
            existence. My profound antipathy towards drinking and gambling and 
            my realization that I must never indulge in such a way of life were 
            rooted deep down in my subconscious.'  'Yes,' I replied, 'and after having been completely 
            idle in that life, you are now diligent to a fault, thinking only of 
            your work.'  'That's right. In the second half of that existence 
            of mine I wanted to work but I hadn't learned a trade and 
            didn't know what work meant. When I asked for work, people refused 
            to take me seriously ... wouldn't even trust me to do a job. Later 
            during my vagabond years, strangers took pity on me and gave me 
            work—cutting wood, loading carts, gathering grapes, beating 
            carpets—and while I did these menial tasks with unskilled hands 
            unused to work, I began to feel the great and overpowering desire to 
            learn something useful ... to be rich in skill and knowledge. And so 
            in this life I have learned everything I possibly could, and I 
            intend to continue learning until the end of my days!'  When he spoke the words 'till the end of my days' I 
            felt as if an iron hand were contracting about my heart. Where will 
            my child and I be at the end of his days? I became stiff with fear 
            ... it is a law of nature: when we strike our hand against a 
            wall, the wall strikes back without intending to! It isn't the wall 
            which really strikes back, but our own blow bounces back. In any 
            case, whatever we hit always gives back the same blow we gave it.
            No, I don't want to think through this premonition clear to the 
            end. We will not leave him ... no ... no ... no!  Then I thought about the relationship between my 
            past life and my present one. What was the reason for this weakness 
            of mine, for my having lived in this mental fog? And why, without 
            any transition, was I now blessed with talents and skills? I could 
            find no explanation.  For days we were under the impression of this 
            tremendous experience, but soon we found ourselves going swimming 
            and boating with our neighbour friends; so our memories from a 
            previous existence soon began to pale. We were both of us much too 
            business-like to bother our heads about the long distant past. My 
            husband was soon obliged to leave anyway as his holidays were over. 
            I stayed on with the other members of my family and their children.
             The entire region of the great lake was of volcanic 
            origin, and the local radiations probably affected me so greatly 
            that I often had visions there.  I am inclined by nature to be very matter-of-fact, 
            and always try to find a natural reason for everything I experience. 
            I was never inclined to believe in ghosts or demons, and when people 
            told me stories about nocturnal manifestations or appearances that 
            were supposed to be almost nightly events in one old castle or 
            another, I just smiled condescendingly in the manner of the 
            inexperienced, thinking to myself that these persons were letting 
            their imagination run away with them. The very last thing I would 
            have 'imagined' is that I myself would have such experiences. 
            Moreover, it is characteristic of visions that one never succeeds in 
            having them through an act of will. On the other hand, they can come 
            quite suddenly and unexpectedly when one's mind is fully occupied 
            with other things.  That very same summer after my husband had returned 
            to his work in the city, we were all retiring to rest after a happy 
            day. I entered my room where my little son was already fast asleep. 
            I lay down, extinguished the candle—in this remote place there was 
            no electricity—and went to sleep.  I do not know how long I had been sleeping when I 
            suddenly awoke, aware of a noise in the room. It sounded as if 
            someone were groping around in the darkness. I reached for the box 
            of matches, quickly lit my candle ... and a moment later was lunging 
            towards a horrible apparition which was already carrying my 
            child in its arm and trying to escape. It was a female form, similar 
            to pictures one sees of witches, and when I surprised her with my 
            light, she was trying to glide out of the room on a cord or wire 
            which led from our beds through the window. I lunged at her, seized 
            my child and tried to take it away from her. She hung on tight, and 
            a terrible struggle began. The witch had already moved up a bit on 
            the wire. It seemed almost as if in some way or other she were 
            connected to it, as if there were a flow of force from it to give 
            her strength. But she could not get away because I clung desperately 
            to my child. Each of us was holding my boy's body in a grip of 
            steel, pulling him to and fro as we struggled. Somehow I felt 
            intuitively that she could only hold on to my child for a short 
            time, and if she could not succeed in wrenching him from me within 
            this short time, she would have to fly away empty handed. So this 
            violent struggle continued until suddenly and quite unexpectedly she 
            relinquished the child, glided out of the window on the wire, and 
            disappeared in the darkness ...  And I ...? I was kneeling in my bed; my son was 
            lying beside me, resting in absolute peace, snugly covered, and 
            sound asleep. But the candle was burning on my night table. Had I 
            been dreaming? Had I forgotten to extinguish the candle before 
            falling asleep? No, the match was still glowing beside it, proving 
            that I had only just lit the candle. The entire scene must have 
            taken place within the space of a few moments. If it were not so, 
            the match would not have been still warm. No, I had not been 
            dreaming!  I extinguished the candle, lay back in bed, and 
            tried to quiet my galloping heartbeat. What was that? A witch? Are 
            there such things? What is a witch? Why do painters everywhere 
            always paint the same kind of witches, and where does this figure 
            come from? How does it come about that there are such things as 
            witches in the first place, and why do people claim that witches 
            ride on broomsticks? If witches are really only a figment of the 
            imagination, why do drawings and sketches of them look just about 
            the same the world over—showing them with long, pointed, drooping 
            noses, hunched backs, and broomsticks in their hands? Why isn't a 
            witch ever shown with a club foot? Because people say the devil has 
            a club foot. But how do they know for sure that the devil has a 
            club foot and a witch does not? Who has ever seen a devil and a 
            witch? Now I have some idea about why witches are drawn with 
            broomsticks in their hands. The witch I had seen was holding on to 
            this wire, and when she flew out of the window on it, I could easily 
            have imagined her to be riding on a broomstick. I can understand 
            that uneducated villagers who know nothing about currents of force 
            think a witch is holding on to a broomstick and flying away on it. 
             The witch was the personified servant of the 'evil one'. I simply 
            knew it. She was reality, a fact! Had the whole scene been merely a 
            projection, an illusion? Naturally, I knew it had been. But what 
            caused it? Where did it come from? And why just such a picture? 
            For me that was reality and the interesting question was why 
            everyone who sees such an illusion, or projection, or whatever we 
            may choose to call it, sees it in the same form. Why do we all carry 
            this picture in our subconscious, if it really does come from our 
            subconscious? It could of course be answered that I had seen 
            pictures of witches and this was a projection of pictures I had 
            seen. But such was not the case! For even though the witch was very 
            similar to the usual pictures one sees, I noticed to my great 
            surprise that her appearance did not coincide with them in all 
            details.  And where did this strange wire or rope come from? I 
            had never seen such a thing in any of the pictures and yet it was 
            there. Moreover, after my experiments in the transmission of will 
            from one person to another, I had quite a different opinion about 
            this wire. I could understand it in terms of a flow of force, 
            perhaps even a flow of will. But where did it come from? And from 
            whom? And if a flow of force can be seen as a physical form, is not 
            the witch herself perhaps merely a form built up of forces radiating 
            from a source or from different sources? And what are we human 
            beings? Where does the human form come from? Are we not also visible 
            forms made up of various flows of force? What is 'reality'?  Only 
            what can be touched and grasped? Are not we human beings, too, 
            merely projections? And do we not merely believe that we are 
            actually formed? Are not love, hate, hope, desperation, good and 
            evil realities too? Do not people suffer or rejoice because of these 
            intangible, invisible forces which are not any less 'actual' than 
            the tangible 'realities'? Naturally I know the physical form of my 
            child—the 'real child'—as people would say—was lying peacefully in 
            bed during my struggle with the apparition. And I am equally 
            convinced that the entire struggle occurred only between forces
            and not between 'bodies', but does that make this 
            struggle any less real? Was not perhaps the apparition of the witch 
            and the child even much more real than the child's material form 
            lying in bed? What is a material form? Only the resultant outward 
            cover of forces which build up the material body. Hence the force is 
            the cause, the material body only the effect. Which is more 
            important and more real?  For a long time I went on asking myself these and 
            similar questions about the experiences I had had. For me it was 
            perfectly real. I had enough proof that I had not fallen asleep. And 
            even had this been the case, it is perfectly possible to experience 
            complete reality in a dream!  Several nights later, after all the family had gone 
            to bed, and the house had quieted down for the night, I too went to 
            bed. It had been an exceptionally hot day, and my room was close and 
            sultry, so I not only left my window open, but also the door from my 
            room into the hall outside. Thus from my bed I could see the 
            staircase leading up to the rooms above.  As I lay there, I reviewed the whole day in my mind. 
            What had I done well? what not so well? What should I have said or 
            done, and what should I not have said or done? Then I went 
            over in my mind what I wanted to cook the next day, for the 
            housekeeping was my task. Thus my thoughts were occupied with quite 
            everyday, matter-of-fact things. Suddenly I noticed that two 
            peculiar forms were approaching from the house door trying slowly 
            and stealthily to cross in front of mine. They were both full-size 
            human forms, absolutely black like shadows. I did not see them as 
            three-dimensional figures. Instead, I had the impression that the 
            only reason I could see them at all was because they were absorbing 
            all the light in the place they happened to be. To express the 
            matter in different terms, I did not really see these beings 
            themselves but the hole they made in the rays of light where they 
            were. In scientific terms, they were causing complete interference 
            with the light rays, and I could only be aware of their presence by 
            virtue of the fact that there were no light rays at all where these 
            two beings stood.  Otherwise, they were invisible. It is difficult to 
            find an expression adequate to describe this phenomenon. In a 
            twinkling I understood why farmers use the word 'shadow' in talking 
            about ghosts or spooky apparitions. Actually these two figures were 
            'shadows', but not shadows made by anything else. On the contrary, 
            they were shadows solely because of the complete absence of light. I 
            had never dreamed that there could be such complete blackness. Later 
            it occurred to me that the astronomers know of such a 'black hole' 
            in the skies. Caused by a complete absence of light, it is known as 
            the 'horse's head 'because of its peculiar shape. They cannot 
            explain it in other terms than as interference in light rays. 
            Something swallows up and destroys the light radiating from the 
            universe, and we see only a huge shadow. The two figures I saw were 
            made of the same absence of light.  On their shoulders they carried a pole from which 
            something utterly and indescribably horrible was hanging. It 
            resembled an octopus, except that it had no organic and organized 
            form. It hung down from this pole like an amorphous mass of raw 
            dough, constantly expanding and then contracting. It was a 
            loathsome, greenish, pussy, decaying mass in which—somehow or other 
            I knew sicknesses, misfortune, catastrophes and death were lurking. 
            I knew that this monster was concentrated 'evil' itself! It turned 
            and stretched on the pole with intentional wickedness, and I 
            realized it was looking for new opportunities and victims on which 
            to wreak its fearful power. I saw the shadowy figures moving towards 
            my sister's room. Horrified, I knew I must prevent this satanic 
            source of power from causing any harm. Sitting bolt upright in bed, I screamed at the top of my lungs, 
            'Grete!—Grete!'  Even as I screamed, the two shadowy figures 
            disappeared instantaneously, while the demon shrank in size and 
            rolled up into a greenish phosphorescent sphere about the size of a 
            football, then rolled with gliding and jumping movements up the 
            steps. In a voice filled with Hellish laughter, of which I was 
            perfectly aware although I could not hear it with my physical ears, 
            it screamed scornfully at me, 'So you think you can catch me! Ha ha 
            ha ha ha!' With that, it slipped through the open window and 
            disappeared in the darkness.  I sprang out of my bed and ran out into the hallway 
            to see what it was. Everywhere there was absolute silence!  Almost at the same moment my brother opened his door 
            upstairs, came out to the banister, looked down and asked, 'Who is 
            down there?'  I lighted a candle and answered, 'It is I. Why have 
            you come out of your room?'  'I woke up suddenly,' he said, 'as if in a 
            nightmare, with a feeling that some terrible danger was in the 
            house. I came out of my room to have a look around ... and you're up 
            too. What's the matter?'  While he was speaking, my two sisters came from 
            their rooms, and then the servants, all wondering why I had 
            screamed. I told them everything. Then we searched the house. We 
            found the door locked and everything in its proper place. I asked my 
            brother to try to move the window above the stairs to see whether 
            perhaps a draft of air could have moved it in such a way as to cause 
            it to reflect the full moon. Perhaps this was the reason for my 
            having seen a greenish phosphorescent ball? But the moon was on the 
            other side of the house, and it was quite impossible for me to have 
            seen a reflection of it from my bed.  Having found nothing, we all had no choice but to go 
            back to bed. For a long time I kept hearing the fiendish taunt, 'So 
            you think you will catch me?— Ha ha ha ha!'  A few days later my little son complained about a 
            tummy ache. I felt sure the pains were caused by appendicitis. I 
            left with him the very same day to go back to the city and have him 
            examined by one of my father's friends who had become a famous 
            surgeon and director of a large hospital. He found there actually 
            was an irritation of the appendix, but said that we could wait until 
            autumn to operate. So we drove back to the lake shore where my 
            little son was able to play with his young friends until we left the 
            resort at the end of the summer.  In looking back, I would like best to be able to 
            skip the period which followed in order not to have to re-experience 
            all the events of the time in my memory. Nevertheless I find I am 
            obliged to recount the broad lines to make the later events of my life understandable.  The child was operated on and the operation was 
            successful. A week later he was allowed to come home. During the 
            time he was in the hospital, my sister's little daughter took sick 
            with a very strange and persistent throat infection. Once during a 
            visit I saw she had a red skin rash under the compress around her 
            neck. On the assumption that the rash might have been caused by the 
            wet compress, her skin was then treated with a powder, and by the 
            next day the rash had disappeared. By the time my son was discharged 
            from the hospital, his little cousin was up, and the two were soon 
            playing together all day long. But there was something about my 
            son's appearance I did not like. He was pale, tired and lacking in 
            energy. Worst of all, instead of gathering strength, he became 
            weaker and more depressed with each passing day. A week later, when 
            I took his temperature, I was shocked to find he was running a high 
            fever. He began to cry bitterly and seemed to be getting worse 
            moment by moment. Singularly enough, his body was covered with a 
            rash which looked exactly like the one his little cousin had had on 
            her neck. We called the most famous child specialist in the area. 
            After his examination he asked whether anyone in the family had had 
            scarlet fever.  'No,' I replied, 'no one.'  'Are you sure no one had a persistent throat 
            infection?'  The ground began to teeter under my feet.  'Yes,' I said, 'his little cousin had a sore throat 
            for a long time and a similar skin rash on her neck.'  The professor smiled. 'Yes, that was scarlet fever. 
            Your son's resistance was still low and he caught a severe 
            infection. We'll have to vaccinate him immediately. Are you 
            going to take care of the child?' he asked me.  'Yes.'  'Have you had scarlet fever?'  'No, and I won't get it now either. I am immune to 
            all infectious diseases.'  'I can only assume the responsibility,' said the 
            professor, 'if we vaccinate you too.'  I knew from experience that I could not endure serum 
            of any kind, and I tried to convince him that he should not 
            vaccinate me. All in vain. We were both vaccinated with a serum 
            which was quite new at the time and scarcely tested. I felt like an 
            ox being brought to the slaughterhouse! I was obliged knowingly to 
            permit myself to be poisoned.  'You can take my word, it will not harm you!' These 
            words were to ring in my ears for a long time to come. Later as I 
            lay helplessly sick and poisoned, a hair's breadth away from death I 
            wished many times I could call in this well-intentioned doctor so he 
            could see why a physician should sometimes listen to his patient and 
            not merely treat him like a number. The serum was a slow, insidious 
            poison ...  First we had to fight desperately for the boy's 
            life. Six long weeks I sat at his bedside while his fever raged at 
            104° and 105°. The effect of the long protracted fever and the 
            reaction of the serum were so strong that his heartbeat often failed 
            him. A young doctor moved in with us to be ready any minute, day or 
            night, with an injection to start the heart beating again. There we 
            were, three of us in an isolated apartment, fighting for the boy's 
            life.  'So you think you can catch me?—Me?—Ha ha ha ha!' 
            Again and again I heard the hellish voice in my ears while for long 
            days and nights I held the child in my arms, refusing to give it up. 
            I got him back from the witch: His appendix was already out. But the 
            battle with the greenish phosphorescent monster was not over yet.
             My son became weaker and weaker as his fever 
            mounted. The professor vaccinated him with a new dose of serum. For 
            some days the fever abated, but then the left side of the boy's 
            throat began to swell. The doctors said the infection had settled in 
            a gland, and they watched the swelling to see whether they would 
            have to operate. It grew bigger with each passing day so the boy's 
            head was leaning far off to one side. Our struggle grew more and 
            more desperate as his fever kept on rising. The child was in 
            constant delirium. For five long weeks we had scarcely been able to 
            get more than an hour or two of sleep in a day. The child rolled to 
            and fro in the bed, quieting down a bit whenever I held him in my 
            arms. The last five days I was sitting beside his bed constantly, 
            holding his poor little body in my arms and waiting ... listening to 
            his heavy breathing and waiting ... for five endlessly long days and 
            nights I waited ...  I had never believed it possible for a human being 
            to go so long without sleep. After five days and five nights, I was 
            still holding the child in my arms. During those long hours I 
            recalled often having heard mothers complain about their children's 
            ingratitude: 'Is that why I took care of him?—Is that why I made 
            such sacrifices and sat at his bedside when he was sick?—etc, etc.'
            In so doing, I realized that a mother does not take care of her 
            child for its sake, but for her own sake! There are many women 
            who imagine themselves to be good and devoted mothers because they 
            take care of their children. No! by such a criterion I was not a 
            good mother, for I was nursing my child and doing everything in my 
            power to save its life—for my sake! I shuddered at the 
            thought of losing the child. No, it was not that I loved the 
            child; it was for love of myself, that I wanted to save 
            it. It was so important to me. I was spiritually so closely 
            tied to my child that I couldn't even bear the thought that it might 
            disappear from my life. I sat there holding my boy in my arms, 
            realizing full well that I was doing it for myself and that I 
            wanted to keep the child for myself. I held him close in my 
            arms and tried to give him some of my own vital force so that he 
            would remain with me. Yes, I knew that an invisible force 
            radiates from the solar plexus of each human being, a force which 
            can grow to giant strength when the person concerned really wants 
            something with all his heart. It can even conquer the gravitational 
            pull of the earth. Now I wanted to increase the power of 
            gravitation; I wanted to keep my child here on earth.  I sat there with my child, trying to concentrate all 
            my thoughts on giving him strength to overcome the terrible 
            sickness. Nevertheless I could not pray God to keep my child alive. 
            'Things are never bad,' I remembered the words of Epictetus, 'it's 
            only the way you think about them.' From my standpoint it 
            would have been the greatest catastrophe to lose the child. But I 
            must not pray to the greatest power, the Creator, for personal, 
            subjective things; for He knows what is good and why, and I 
            must not want to keep my child for shortsighted, human reasons. And 
            the child? For him too it is certainly best for God's will to be 
            done, whatever that may be. So as I sat there with my boy in my 
            arms, my little human-maternal self was trembling for fear of losing 
            the child, but I was praying constantly, 'Thy will be done ... Thy 
            will be done ...'  I repeated it hundreds of times in those long hours, 
            while my body was getting stiffer and stiffer, until it finally 
            began to rebel. My back was so numb I couldn't feel it any more. I 
            tried to change my position ever so slightly, but the child noticed 
            my movement at once, tightened his grip on me and cried out, 'Stay 
            here, stay here, hold me tight! If you stay here and hold me tight, 
            I'll forgive you for all the wrong you've done me!' My mind began 
            reeling ... what wrong have I done that he could forgive me for?  Up to that time I had thought I was doing everything 
            a mother should do for her child. From the moment of its birth, this 
            child took first place in all my thoughts. In every way I could, I 
            wanted to make it happy. What secret wound was it now nursing? What 
            wrong had I done for which I needed its forgiveness?  I tried to find out. 'My little darling,' I said, 
            'be quiet. I'm here with you now and holding you tight. But what are 
            you going to forgive me for?'  He answered, 'I don't know, just hold me tight and 
            I'll forgive you for everything ...'  I looked over at the young doctor who said quietly, 
            'He's talking in a delirium —pay no attention to his words.'  'Yes, yes, he is delirious ...'—but I already knew 
            enough about psychology to know that the boy's words were coming 
            forth from some great depth. I thought about them for a long, long 
            time, wondering how I had wronged this human soul ... what great 
            debt I might owe it ...  Until one day everything became clear ...  On the evening of the fifth day we had gone without 
            sleep, the child left me free again for a few minutes. With the 
            young doctor's help, I got up, stiff in every joint, and went about 
            like an automaton doing the things I needed to do. But my spirit Was 
            in such abysmal darkness as if all the devils of Hell were plunging 
            after us. I was afraid I was going to crack up. I needed to find 
            some kind of new strength to bear my burden. In such moments a 
            person gives up all his arrogance and reaches out for help wherever 
            he hopes to find it. The Bible! The book lay on the night table and 
            I reached for it like a drowning man. I opened it without thinking, 
            and my eyes fell on the following passage in the old testament: Tear 
            not, Your enemies shoot their invisible arrows upon you only as long 
            as the Lord allows. But when their time comes, ye shall be free of 
            all evil.' .  The effect of these words was indescribable. I felt 
            as if a mountain of weight had fallen from me ... after six weeks of 
            endless darkness—light ... at last, light ... light!  The telephone rang. It was mother. 'How is our 
            little one doing?' she asked. 'Mother, the child's going to get 
            well!' I shrieked into the telephone. 'Has the fever gone down?'  'No, it's still up to 104, but God has sent me a 
            message ...'—and I told her what I had read in the Bible. 'May God 
            grant it so,' said mother.  I had to hang up immediately, because the child was 
            crying for me. I ran to him, and in the very next moment the 
            horrible swelling opened up. In the last few days it had become as 
            big as a large ball. It burst internally into his throat and mouth, 
            and a horrible greenish mass of pus came pouring out over his lips. 
            I couldn't help remembering the green ball ... it was the 
            same colour.  The doctors had been waiting for the swelling on the 
            outside of the boy's neck to get soft so they could cut, but on the 
            outside it was still so hard they did not dare. Now nature had taken 
            a hand herself and freed the child. A few moments later he lay down 
            again and fell into a deep sleep. He slept as if he were dead. The 
            whole night long we kept watch. His pulse became stronger, his 
            breathing slower, and his forehead was no longer wet with 
            perspiration ... He was sleeping peacefully. After the long weeks of 
            unending vigil, I lay down myself and tried to go to sleep. But with 
            no success. My nerves had forgotten what sleep was.  The child slept soundly until 11 o'clock the next 
            morning. Father telephoned often: 'How's the boy? Still asleep? 
            How's his pulse?'  'Yes, father, the fever's gone and he's sleeping 
            soundly ... a healthy sleep.'  Finally he opened his eyes and asked for milk. Like 
            a dry sponge soaking up liquid, he drank four glasses one after 
            another. Then he asked for his playthings.  The next day was Christmas. My husband, my parents, 
            and my brother and sister came by that afternoon to bring a little 
            Christmas tree and armloads of toys for the boy. I set him in an 
            armchair and pulled him into the middle room so that our family 
            could wave to him through the grill work in front of the door of the 
            house. The boy was still thin beyond recognition and weak ... but 
            alive! We all cried for joy. The evil had been forced to yield ... 
            its time on the great cosmic clock had run out. I was so moved I 
            could not speak. I felt as if I were dreaming. I was the very 
            picture of gratitude. My wish and God's will had been identical in 
            this case ... He gave me back my boy!  My son recovered slowly, the young doctor bade us 
            farewell, and the day finally came when our youngster could get up. 
            He had to learn to walk all over again. But he became stronger from 
            day to day, and by the end of two months he was well enough to go 
            back to school. I could sleep once more and wanted to return to my 
            sculpturing. I felt so strange, however, just as if I were a little 
            bit tipsy, and the world about me looked as if I were seeing it 
            through water. Everything seemed to get hazier and hazier ... 
            farther and farther away from me.  The serum with which I had been vaccinated had been 
            prepared from hormones of stallions. As I later heard, the new, 
            scarcely tested preparation affected women as if it were a 
            completely foreign substance—a poison—in their blood. The papers 
            were full of the scandal. Most of the women who had been vaccinated 
            showed early symptoms of neurosis. Then, as their bodies tried to 
            get rid of their poisoned blood, they suffered from incessant 
            haemorrhages. There was no way to help them, and many died. As a 
            consequence, there were masses of lawsuits.  I felt worse and worse from day to day. Things 
            around me looked more and more as though I were seeing them through 
            water. A strange feeling overcame me, and I didn't know myself any 
            more. I was able to walk straight, but I always felt dizzy. This odd 
            feeling that I was looking at the world through some strange liquid 
            grew stronger from day to day.  One day I had an attack. Instead of a regular pulse 
            beat, there was only a flutter. Unable to walk, eat or speak, I lay 
            in bed with an ice pack over my heart still seeing the world as if 
            it were swimming around me. It would take us too far afield if I 
            were to describe how I suffered. Suffice it to say, I wandered 
            through the various departments of Hell ... for months!  By summertime I was somewhat recovered, and on our 
            doctor's advice, we all went to the lake. Perhaps the change of air 
            was good for me. I lay on the terrace of our family villa, trying to 
            calm and control my dancing nerves. Hundreds and thousands of times 
            I repeated the word 'caaaaalm' ...'caaaaalm' ...'caaaaalm' ... 
            Slowly my condition improved and sometimes I was even able to sleep 
            at night.  One day I noticed my son was not playing with the 
            other children on the beach. On the contrary, he was hanging around 
            my sofa and being suspiciously quiet about it. With a sudden shock, 
            I began to hope he was not falling ill again. I do not like it when 
            children are suspiciously quiet.  'What is the matter with you?' I asked him. 'Why 
            aren't you playing with the other children?'  The boy leaned against the back of my sofa, looked 
            at me attentively and answered, 'Mummy, is it possible that I have 
            lived before?'  His question amazed me. 'Where did you get that 
            idea?' I asked in return.  'I was in the garden and saw a big black beetle. 
            When I poked him a bit with a twig, he turned over on his back and 
            lay still as if dead. I was curious to see what he would do, so I 
            watched him and waited. I kept on watching him for a long time, 
            perhaps it was even half an hour. Then all of a sudden, the beetle 
            righted himself and ran away. It was then I had a very strong 
            feeling I had lived before. It only seemed as if I had died and 
            people thought I was dead, but then I got up and went on just like 
            the beetle, and here I am now alive again. That means I never died 
            at all! And I'm asking you for another reason, Mummy. Every day when 
            I wake up in the morning, before I open my eyes, I always have a 
            feeling as if I had to jump right up and go hunting to find food for 
            my wife and my children. And only when I open my eyes and look 
            around my room, I realize that I'm a little boy and your son. But 
            Mummy, my wife and my children and everybody there are not like the 
            people here, but they're ... all ... all black and quite naked.' An 
            embarrassed smile spread across my son's face.  I listened to him with ever-growing interest, but I 
            did not want him to notice my surprise. I let him finish talking. 
            Then I asked, 'So you were the father of several children ... but 
            where did you live?'  The child took paper and pencil, and with a sure and 
            steady hand he drew a round hut with a very special opening in the 
            roof for the smoke. He could never have seen a hut like that in our 
            country. Before the hut he sketched in a naked woman with long 
            hanging breasts. Beside the hut there was a body of water with 
            waves, and in the distance palm trees. 'We lived in huts like this,' 
            he said, showing me the drawing. 'We built them ourselves, just as 
            each of us built himself a boat by hollowing out a log. There was a 
            big river there, but we couldn't go in deep as we do here in the 
            lake, because some kind of a monster was living there in the water. 
            I don't remember what kind, only that it bit off people's legs, and 
            that's why we didn't go into the water.  'Now you can understand why I always screamed and 
            howled last year when you tried to take me out into the water. I was 
            afraid that something under the water was going to bite off my legs. 
            Even now, whenever I go bathing, I have that same feeling. Only I 
            know by now that there's nothing dangerous in the water here. And 
            remember last year, when I wanted to row, Mummy? It was just after 
            we had bought the big family boat. At first you wouldn't let me, 
            because you said I would have to learn how. But I just knew I could 
            because I remembered how well I was able to get around in my dugout 
            canoe ... as well as if it were a part of me. While sitting in it, I 
            could even flip over into the water and come up again on the other 
            side.  'Remember I kept begging so long, you finally got 
            impatient and said I could try but I would see I could not row. 
            Remember? And remember how surprised you all were when I did 
            row, and with only one oar. I was too small to handle both 
            oars—my arms were too short—but I was able to move our big boat 
            around safely among the other boats and all the bathers. Oh boy, 
            with my dugout canoe —there where I was living—I could do anything! 
            You should have seen me then! And the trees were not like the ones 
            here.'  With his stubby finger he pointed to the drawing. 
            'They were like this one. and there were all kinds of other plants 
            there. See, that's me hunting for a big bird, and that's my hat 
            beside me.'  Everything he drew made up a perfect tropical 
            landscape with palm trees and other tropical plants. The figure 
            supposedly representing him was a typical negro. Only his hat was 
            suspicious. It looked exactly like a modern man's felt hat. Not 
            wanting either to disturb him or excite his imagination, I 
            questioned him very cautiously. He had never seen naked women, 
            except perhaps as works of art, and these latter never have hanging 
            breasts; so I asked him, 'Why have you drawn your wife with such 
            long, ugly, hanging breasts?'  The child looked up at me in amazement at such a 
            question, then answered without hesitation and very 
            matter-of-factly, 'Because she had breasts like that! And they're 
            not ugly! She was very beautiful!' he added proudly. This reply 
            convinced me that my boy had not heard these things in some way or 
            another from others. He had never been to the cinema and had never 
            had any books about Africa. Where could he have picked up the idea 
            that a woman with long, hanging breasts is beautiful? Our ideal of 
            beauty is quite different. Finally I asked him, 'What is the last 
            thing you remember?'  'I was hunting when a tiger approached. I threw my 
            spear, but that didn't stop him. With my spear in his breast he 
            jumped on me. I don't know what happened after that.'  'Good, that's all very interesting. Naturally it's 
            possible that you have lived before and all of that really happened. 
            But now you're here. Don't think about the past any more; think 
            about the present. You can tell me all about things like this, but 
            don't tell other people about your memories.'  'Yes, Mummy,' said the boy, 'I already know that, 
            because grown-ups think we kids are crazy. They always make fun of 
            us. But what do you think happened to my wife and children?'  'I cannot tell you that. But don't forget that 
            everything passes away. Only love remains eternal, and so love will 
            lead you to them again in this life.'  'Oh, that's fine!' said the boy, and he ran off to 
            resume his playing with the other children. I took his drawings and 
            put them into the diary I had been keeping since he was born ...  I never asked the boy any more about these memories. 
            I did not want his imagination to be stimulated, nor did I want him 
            to lose himself in these memories.  Why should I? I knew that he had not been able to 
            see or read any books about Africa. I knew every step he took and 
            what he was doing. And it really was surprising to recall that, 
            although he was generally quite brave and even inclined to be a bit 
            of a daredevil, when we had first taken him out to bathe in the 
            lake, he had fought and kicked and struggled most savagely, 
            screaming at the top of his lungs as if we were trying to kill him. 
            I had had to explain to him that he could come along with the rest 
            of us without fear and that nothing was going to happen to him. It 
            was only then he let me carry him into the water, but I had to 
            promise to watch out for him and not leave him alone. The next day 
            the very same thing happened. He refused to go into the water alone, 
            kicking and screaming as he had done the day before. Again I had to 
            carry him in my arms. Little by little he conquered his fear, and he 
            finally became a little duck, happily splashing, rowing and sailing 
            on the lake all day long. Our conversation made me remember how, 
            when he was very small—around four or five—he and-his little cousin 
            would paint pictures together. While the faces his little cousin 
            painted were always pink, his were always dark brown. When I once 
            tried to show him why he should not paint the faces so dark, he made 
            no reply, but merely went on painting chocolate coloured faces.  We spoke no more about his memories. Now and again 
            he made some comment which showed me that these things were still 
            alive within him. Several years later, when he was about thirteen, 
            one of the neighbours came running into our garden, calling for me 
            to come out to the street. My son, he said, had climbed up to the 
            top of a very high poplar tree, so high that he certainly would not 
            be able to come down without falling. There were a number of trees, 
            all of them about sixty to seventy feet high. I peered upward into 
            the branches to try to see which tree my boy was in. Finally I 
            yelled up to find out where he was and he promptly yelled back to 
            ask what I wanted.  'Come down immediately!'  'Why?'  'We're not discussing why now,' I called back. 'You 
            come right down here!' Without saying a word, he started to descend, 
            climbing skilfully but cautiously with complete assurance, like a 
            little monkey. Finally he jumped down from the lowest branch and, 
            with controlled annoyance, asked, 'Why did I have to come down?'  'Because it's absolutely senseless for you to climb 
            up so high. It's positively shameful when other people have to tell 
            me what you're doing. What's the good of such dare-devil stunts? 
            What in the world were you doing up there?'  'I've made myself a nest where I can eat a meal of 
            boiled corn. It tastes much better up there, and I get such a 
            wonderful view. I can look out over everything.'  'Well don't do it any more. What sense can there 
            possibly be in doing anything so dangerous? Build yourself a nest 
            down here!'  The boy looked away for a moment angrily, then said, 
            'O.K. I'm not supposed to climb up there any more because you think 
            it's dangerous. But who do you think looked after me when I was 
            living in the jungle and climbed around the trees which were a lot 
            higher so that I could watch the animals? Where were you then?'  'I don't know where I was then, but now I'm here and 
            you have to obey!' I answered emphatically. He wasn't pleased at 
            all, but as I gave him plenty of freedom in other respects, he soon 
            found other occupations and the matter was forgotten.  Some time later he came home from school in complete 
            exasperation. 'Ridiculous!' he exploded. 'The priest was trying to 
            make us believe that people live only once. But I know that people 
            live more than once! I know it! But it's best not to try to talk to 
            grown-ups. A fellow just has to keep his mouth shut!'  The impressions of this life had probably displaced 
            the memories in his consciousness, and for a long time he made no 
            further mention of these matters; When he was about fifteen, he 
            asked us to buy him a big jazz drum. Together we went to the best 
            music shop in town, and he picked out the biggest drum in sight with 
            all its trappings. Then the miraculous experience we had had when he 
            first tried to row was repeated again. As soon as he had the drum in 
            the house, he took the two drum sticks, sat down beside it and 
            started playing the most difficult rhythms and the most 
            impossible syncopations, all with a perfectly sure hand and 
            complete self-confidence. He played ecstatically, his eyes beaming 
            and tears rolling down his cheeks. He said nothing about how he came 
            to be able to play a drum. Only once, as he was playing a very 
            peculiar rhythm, he remarked, 'Hear that Mum? That's how we used to 
            signal each other and pass on messages across tremendous distances.' 
            And he went on drumming like one possessed.  He was never interested in reading stories about 
            negro life. 'Why should I?' he asked. 'I know better than books can 
            tell me what life was like there. Why should I care what white 
            people have written about it? And when I read real true 
            descriptions, I always start to cry, even when I try not to ...'  Even as a grown-up young officer in the air force, 
            seeing a negro cinema-film always moved him to tears. Sitting there 
            in the darkness, he would cry like a baby—although silently—with big 
            salty tears streaming down his cheeks.  Where had he learnt to play the drum? How hard it is 
            I learnt myself when I once tried it. How does a city child come to 
            want to own a drum? And why should a happy, up-to-date young man 
            burst into tears when he plays a drum or sees negro films?  Years later Paul Brunton paid us a visit when he was 
            returning to Europe from India. I told him about my son's memories. 
            He asked to see the drawings. After examining them attentively, he 
            said, 'This kind of hut is typical of a particular tribe living on 
            the banks of the Zambesi in Central Africa. He has drawn it 
            correctly in every detail.'  'Yes, but this hat isn't an African native's hat? It 
            looks just like a civilized man's hat made of felt,' I said.  Brunton smiled. 'No, you're mistaken. The child is 
            right. The hat is indeed typical of this tribe. Only it's not made 
            of felt, but of bulrushes plaited together. His hunting weapon is 
            correctly drawn too. And the monster that bites off people's legs is 
            a crocodile, of course. There are many of them there. But tell me 
            how you came to attract a negro as your child?' he asked finally.
             'I don't know how to answer that one,' I replied. 
            Then we both smiled and talked about other things.  This all happened several years later. My son's 
            first memories came that summer at the lake shore when the little 
            black beetle attracted his attention and he stopped playing to watch 
            it for a long, long time. Without knowing it, he used an Indian 
            method to achieve great concentration. Indian yogis do it by staring 
            for a long time at a black spot on the wall, or at a crystal ball. 
            Unknowingly, the child did the same, for the little black beetle was 
            like a black spot, and the boy probably fell into a trance quite 
            unintentionally. Thus the memory of a previous incarnation came to 
            life within him.  The summer went by and my condition improved. My 
            consciousness was clear again, and I no longer saw the world in such 
            a hazy fashion. The burning sensation in my blood also stopped. But 
            in the autumn, after our return to the city, I began to have the 
            same symptoms as the many women who had died from their horse serum 
            vaccinations. I had to go back to bed again, suffering from terrible 
            cramps and pains. I never would have believed that a human being can 
            endure such torture without dying. I completely lost control of my 
            body, just as if my nerves had been quite paralysed. When I wanted 
            to raise my hand, my hand did not budge. It was a terrifying 
            condition. And in my sleepless nights, I heard an ugly repugnant 
            voice drowning out the roaring in my ears: 'So you think you can 
            catch me?—Ha ha ha ...'  The doctors consulted each other again and advised 
            an operation.  That same evening we had a telephone call from one 
            of my husband's boyhood friends with whom we had kept in close 
            touch. He had just returned from a sojourn of many years in India. 
            The next day he came by to pay us a visit. Seeing me in such 
            miserable shape, he said, 'You know while I was in India I spent a 
            lot of time learning yoga under a great master. If you follow my 
            advice and do as I say, you will get well again. Under no 
            circumstances should you submit to an operation.'  I promised to do whatever he told me to.  He then showed me a few simple breathing exercises 
            which I could do as I lay there in bed only half alive. He told me I 
            should practice them often during the day, and in doing them I was 
            to guide and control my consciousness, I followed his 
            instructions to the letter.  Within a few days' time my condition was 
            considerably better. The pains were abating, and all my other 
            symptoms showed a surprising change for the better.  Within two weeks I was so much improved that I could 
            even stand up for a few minutes at a time. I became my self again! 
            I still felt minor disturbances, but our friend showed me some more 
            yoga exercises, and I kept on improving. By the time spring came 
            around, I was strong enough to travel to the seashore to spend a few 
            months convalescing. That blessed climate, combined with the salt 
            water bathing and yoga exercises, gave me back my health. During my 
            last four weeks there, my husband was with me and I experienced the 
            most beautiful period of my personal life. Only one who has 
            been hopelessly sick and then recovered knows what it means to be 
            well again!  Oh, thou unknown strength and power people call 
            God! I thank thee that thou hast given me back my 
            health; that thou hast permitted me to escape from Hell; that thou 
            hast enabled me to avoid becoming a burden upon my loved ones ... 
            enabled me to become a useful working human being again!  The sun had never been so beautiful, nor the sky so 
            blue, nor the sea so sparkling as that summer.  When autumn came, we went home, and soon I was back 
            at work in my studio.  One evening we all went to the cinema together. The 
            programme consisted of a number of Walt Disney films, and we got an 
            immense amount of fun out of watching Mickey Mouse, Pluto and Donald 
            Duck. Then came a film in which all three of these animals teamed up 
            and founded a firm to drive the ghosts and spooks out of haunted 
            houses. They advertised their service in the newspaper, and their 
            advertisement came to the attention of one of a number of ghosts who 
            were living together in an old castle. He straightway summoned all 
            the other ghosts and spooks and goblins, and indignantly read the 
            notice to them. Incensed at the idea that even ghosts would no 
            longer be able to live in peace, they all consulted together and 
            decided they would teach the people in this new firm a lesson. One 
            of them called up the firm and asked to have a man sent over.   Then 
            the head ghost assigned a specific task to each of the many spooks 
            assembled. One was to hide behind the door, another under the bed, 
            another inside the mirror so that anyone looking at it would see a 
            ghost instead of himself—all with the idea of giving the people in 
            Mickey & Co. such a terrible scare they would be glad to give up 
            their plan. When the jobs were all assigned, the chief spook gave a 
            signal and all his cronies disappeared by simply rolling up into 
            greenish phosphorescent balls which rolled away, gliding and 
            hopping, and disappeared in different directions, laughing 
            fiendishly at the idea that earthly creatures should think of trying 
            to catch them!  I became stiff with amazement! My younger 
            sister and brother began to call out, 'Look, look! Esther's green 
            ball! Just look at that! ...' They were so excited and so loud in 
            their comments, I thought for a little while the ushers were going 
            to throw us out of the house. They could not have known—no one could 
            have!—that the entire scene, as the chief spook himself rolled up 
            into a greenish ball, laughed fiendishly and hopped away, was just 
            exactly the way I had seen it long, long before!  I was thoroughly shaken. Could it really be that 
            other people saw these manifestations too? I did not doubt for a 
            moment that Walt Disney had actually seen such a greenish ball! Or 
            how could he have come to invent—out of pure imagination—a sequence 
            matching with exquisite precision exactly what I had seen long, long 
            before? It was absolutely too much to suppose that this was pure 
            coincidence. But that was not all!  A few weeks later I received a book entitled, 
            Aram Magic and Mysticism. It was a large collection of authentic 
            documents. After reading about a number of phenomena, I came to the 
            following quotation: ' ... how should this somebody come through a 
            door that was locked and bolted? Knowing full well that the door was 
            firmly locked, I thought: "Nobody can get in here!" Even if the door 
            knob is turned and the door made a noise. But what was that? There 
            was a rustling sound in the room, a rapping sound in the wardrobe. 
            It came over to my bed and made its presence known by rapping on my 
            bedstead, then went past my bed and tinkled on the glass of the lamp 
            on my night table." (page 458) And a bit further on: 'I saw nothing, 
            and I did not particularly try to see anything. Only the person in 
            the next room claims to have seen, on the floor of my room, a 
            light about the size of the full moon. He claims to have seen 
            clearly how this rolling ball of light appeared in the doorway and 
            disappeared behind the wall.' (page 459)  I could scarcely believe my eyes. Was I meeting this 
            full-moon-like ball of light again? Apparently this ball of light is 
            not such a rare thing. How strange! With a little reflection, we can 
            find an analogous example in electricity: the ball of lightning. 
            This ball also seems to roll through the air. There are reports 
            recording how such balls of lightning have bounced into a room 
            through a window, rolled across the room and out of another open 
            window without doing any damage. As long as the lightning stays 
            rolled up in a ball, there is no danger, but when it emerges from 
            this spherical form, it destroys everything in its path. In this 
            latter case, a ball of lightning is a thousand times more dangerous 
            than ordinary lightning. What then is this greenish phosphorescent 
            ball which can do such catastrophic damage, if not a ball of 
            lightning, only on another plane?  Handed down to us from incredibly ancient times, 
            there is this saying attributed to an outstandingly great initiate, 
            Hermes Trismegistos, who was said to know all the secrets of Heaven 
            and Earth: 'As above, so below; as below, so above.'  What a remarkable parallel phenomenon: This green 
            ball and the ball of lightning!    
             THE AYUR-VEDAS I was working again every day in my studio.  Once while I was working, I was suddenly overcome by 
            unbearable restlessness. I felt as if I were really doing 
            nothing. Time was rushing by madly with giant strides. Days were 
            going by, each like the one before, and I was doing nothing. 
            Nothing? How come I am doing nothing?—I asked myself. I am working 
            all day long, studying and reading a whole library of books. When I 
            am tired, I play the piano. Why should I feel I am doing nothing? I 
            thought back about the last few years and heard an answer within me: 
            'You've done nothing, absolutely nothing, to alleviate the 
            sufferings of others. Being a wife, a mother, a sculptress—all these 
            things are purely personal matters.' That was true, but what could I 
            have done? For several years I had been waiting for higher powers to 
            give me an order about what I should do. I had never once heard the 
            voice. How am I to know what kind of 'work' I am to do?—I asked 
            myself. When I think back, now as I am telling this, and call up to 
            mind the person I was then, I simply have to smile. How naive is the 
            human being, the unknowing person! How could anyone be a co-worker 
            in the 'great plan' if he has not yet reached the goal himself? If 
            he has not been able to conquer himself?  But every person who awakens and sees the goal of 
            life goes through the growing pains of wanting to save humanity 
            instead of first saving himself! The higher powers actually do 
            see to it that every neophyte is cured of this naive idea. At that 
            time, however, I was not yet cured and was bent on making people 
            happy. Ever since I had taken my vow, I never forgot for a moment 
            that that's what I was living for. Various temptations which might 
            have been real temptations for other people or for me early in my 
            life, no longer presented any problems. There were men enough who 
            wanted to satisfy their desire for pleasure. They said they 'loved'
            me. I saw quite clearly, however, that they did not even 
            notice me, the being I am in reality. They simply wanted 
            physical love; how could that have interested me after I had once 
            looked into nature's trap? Such desires were not even flattering for 
            my vanity. On the contrary, I found it degrading that men, again and 
            again, coveted my body.  When the conversation was ranging over profound 
            philosophical themes, the man with whom I was talking and who 
            claimed to be a friend, was enthusiastic about my 'intelligence', 
            but at the first opportunity he wanted to kiss me. Did he perhaps 
            want to kiss my intelligence?  Another was enthusiastic about my musical ability. 
            When I played the piano for a group of friends, he said he was a 
            music worshipper. Kissing my hand, he looked deep into my eyes ... 
            but with what sensuality. I was already acquainted with such 'music 
            worship' and laughed at him. How boring, how boring!  I really was attracted by music, philosophy and 
            psychology, in fact by all kinds of art and science, but I had to 
            learn again and again that most philosophers, psychologists, 
            astronomers, scientists, artists, just like other men, considered 
            sex much more interesting! The poor boys! What will they have left 
            when they some day lose their masculinity! Emptiness, their own 
            terrible emptiness! And these men wanted to convince me that I was 
            wasting my life because I did not want to taste sexual pleasures at 
            every opportunity. How debasing! Can men only see sex? Can 
            they not simply be human beings over and above the level of sex? 
            Like children who play together for the fun of playing and 
            not because the game concerns sex in any way.  Many people go in for music, art, theatre and 
            psychology only in order to be able to conquer new partners one 
            after the other. The Bible says: 'If ye are not like unto little 
            children, verily I say unto you, ye shall not enter into the Kingdom 
            of Heaven.' The tremendous depth of this wonderful saying became 
            really apparent to me when I saw the unrest and dissatisfaction of 
            the people who live only for sex. And these poor, empty people, when 
            they noticed my indifference, thought I was inhibiting my natural 
            urges or simply pretending. I always analysed myself very strictly, 
            and I never had a thought which would have attracted me to a man. I 
            loved my husband just as much as ever, but no longer as a woman 
            loving a man, but as one human being loving another! It was no 
            temptation, no struggle, and no 'victory' over my desires, for I 
            simply had no desire for a man. Ever since the night when I had 
            clearly recognized the deceit of physical love, I had no longer felt 
            myself to be a woman. In that night I became a human being, a
            self, and the self has no desire for sex! The 'self' is 
            without sex! The self is not a half of something seeking its 
            complementary half; the self is a complete whole!  And when a person recognizes this truth, the body 
            follows!  As I cogitated on these things there in my studio, I 
            suddenly had the same feeling I had had years before when practising 
            thought transmission and when unable to pick up and carry out 
            another's thought. I felt such a weight on my chest that I could 
            scarcely breathe.  Putting down my modelling tools, I tried to 
            concentrate. Then, just as I had felt it years before, I felt the 
            strange prickling sensation throughout my whole body, and again I 
            heard the well-known voice which had been silent for so long, the 
            blessed voice: 'Why are you neglecting your spiritual abilities?'
             'How shall I not neglect them? What can I do 
            about them?' I asked back.  'You know very well that merely being born with a 
            talent for music, sculpture or other arts does not mean by any 
            manner of means that a person is an artist. He must develop his 
            talent, and to do that he must practise, practise, and practise some 
            more! Talent without diligence and diligence without talent is 
            not art. But if you combine your talent with diligence, that
            is real art! You have talents which you simply allow to lie 
            idle: the ability to express the spirit. Practise, practise, 
            practise ... and you will become an artist in the kingly art which 
            stands above all other art: in the artless art!'  My heart began to beat fast. For years I had been 
            waiting for an inner order as to what I should do. I had never 
            received an answer. There was nothing else for me to do but keep on 
            working and fulfilling the daily duties that life demanded of me. I 
            learned psychology and sculpturing. These two studies supplemented 
            each other wonderfully. When I was working on a bust, I delved deep 
            into the psychology of my model. I found all people simply 
            fascinating, and the more profoundly I was able to penetrate into 
            their psychology the better my heads turned out.  I began to realize 
            that a portrait and psychological analysis are one and the same kind 
            of work! In making a bust of a person, I had to be simultaneously 
            giving him psychological advice, and everyone whom I have ever 
            modelled has remained spiritually very close to me. My monumental 
            works and large compositions were also a great source of pleasure to 
            me. The concentration opened ever-new doors to ever-new vistas of 
            truth. But in the depths of my soul, I was sorry not to be hearing 
            'the voice' any more. I was as dry as sawdust, feeling that I had 
            lost contact with some power coming from a very high source.  Now this source was re-established and 'the voice' 
            was telling me that I should practise the artless art. How 
            should I practise it? Is there such a thing as an appropriate form 
            of exercise? If there is, I never heard of it ...  Once again and very clearly I heard the voice within 
            me: 'Seek!'  'Seek? Where? And how?' I asked.  There was no answer.  That evening we were invited over to the home of our 
            friend who, when I was dying, had saved my life by teaching me yoga 
            exercises and how to guide my consciousness.  We were a jolly group. The men freshened up their 
            schoolday memories, and I amused myself by looking at our friend's 
            library. One book in particular attracted me very much, and I asked 
            whether I might take it home.  'Of course,' said our friend. I took the book and 
            sat down to talk with the men. I asked our friend to tell us how and 
            where he had learned these yoga exercises, with which he had healed 
            me. He told us that he had once been invited by an Indian Maharaja 
            to go tiger hunting. During the hunt, his horse suddenly shied and 
            threw him out of the saddle in such a very unfortunate way that he 
            fell on his back and was not able to get up. He was carried back to 
            his room. The Maharaja visited him and asked him which of his two 
            physicians he should send, the English or the Indian.  Our friend asked for the English physician. The 
            latter prescribed various sedatives and pain-killing drugs, and 
            advised him to stay in bed. Days went by, weeks went by, and he was 
            still lying helpless, unable to get up, unable even to move his neck 
            or back. At the end of six weeks, he was still getting worse.  The Maharaja came to visit him again. 'You asked for 
            the English physician,' he said, 'and I sent him to you. He has been 
            treating you for six weeks, but your condition has only been getting 
            worse. I suggest you ask the advice of my Indian physician, my 
            Ayurvedic practitioner. He could help you.'  Our friend asked the Maharaja to send him at once.
             'What is an Ayurvedic practitioner?' I asked.  'It is a person who is initiated into and acquainted 
            with the Ayur-Veda,' our friend replied. 'The Vedas are the holy 
            books of the Indians, the highest philosophy on earth. They are made 
            up of various parts. The Ayur-Veda is the science of health. It 
            contains all the secrets of the human body, diseases, methods of 
            healing and maintenance of health. As early as five to six thousand 
            years ago, these initiates had developed operative techniques for 
            replacing injured organs of the body with healthy organs removed 
            from corpses. They were able to, perform the most unbelievable 
            operations. They were able to replace a blind eye with a healthy 
            one, both in animals and humans, and they were even able to replace 
            an entire leg. They also knew that diseases were caused by myriads 
            of tiny invisible creatures which today we call bacteria. They also 
            regarded bacteria as the cells of the invisible body of a demonic 
            spirit, whereas Western scientists with the exception of a few 
            initiates like Paracelsus, have never made an attempt at research in 
            this field. The evil spirit takes possession of one or more persons, 
            invades the person with his body, and when this person's vibrations 
            coincide with those of the evil spirit, he becomes sick. However, 
            there are always persons whose vibrations are different from those 
            of the demon. These persons do not become sick. In the terms of 
            Western science, they are immune.  'In the holy books of India, all these disease 
            spirits are thoroughly described as to their appearance and even 
            shown in coloured pictures. They are horrible figures, each with its 
            characteristic appearance and colour. The demon of the plague, for 
            example, is a black monster and you will recall that the plague is 
            also called "The Black Death". The spirit of another equally fatal 
            disease is a yellow demon and the disease he causes is known as 
            yellow fever. The spirit of leprosy has a lion-like head, and you 
            perhaps know that lepers can be recognized from quite a distance by 
            the lion-like appearance of their faces. Through the face of the 
            leper, one can see and recognize the lion face of the spirit by 
            which he is possessed. Pneumonia is caused by a gigantic red demon 
            represented as consisting of fire and flame. And so it goes, each 
            disease is ascribed to a person's being possessed by a certain 
            specific demon.'  'Just a moment,' I interrupted. 'What did you say? 
            Pneumonia comes from a gigantic red demon? How interesting ...' And 
            a childhood memory suddenly came to light again before my eyes. 
            Again I saw my little brother jumping up hi bed, looking off in one 
            direction of the room with his eyes bulging, and screaming at the 
            top of his lungs, 'Mother, Mother, the red man is coming to get me! 
            Mother, help! ...' And I can still see how he waved his little hands 
            as if trying to ward off an invisible enemy. Then he fainted and 
            mother said, 'What he sees is nothing real; he's having an 
            hallucination ...' But I saw at the time it happened that this 'red 
            man' represented reality for the child. Apparently it was an 
            objective reality, as the Indians already knew several thousand 
            years ago! For reality is not only what we can grasp with our hands 
            and see with our eyes!  I told him about this experience I had had as a 
            child, but our friend was not surprised.  'The sick often see these demons at the moment they 
            become possessed by them. Sometimes later too, during the sickness 
            when they are fighting with the demon. Whenever they mention this, 
            however, people merely say they have fever and are seeing things. No 
            one ever seems to consider the origin of these pictures in the 
            imagination of the diseased, as the persons have never thought 
            about such things: nor why per sons suffering from the same 
            disease always see the same pictures without ever having spoken 
            to each other, or even having met and known each other.'  Then our friend went on with his story about the 
            Maharaja's Ayurvedic physician. He was a rather young Indian, 
            friendly and well bred, who later became a close friend with whom he 
            was still corresponding. After investigating his nervous reflexes, 
            the young Indian physician went away and brought back pills, 
            ordering him to take three a day. On parting, the young Indian 
            doctor smiled and said, 'In three days you'll be riding again.'  Our friend sighed in disbelief.  The next morning he was able to move his head. Then 
            the Indian physician came again, gave him some more pills and had 
            him do a few breathing exercises combined with guidance of 
            consciousness. The next afternoon he was able to sit up and felt a 
            prickling sensation in his spinal column as if new vital force were 
            flowing into it.  On the second day he was able to get up, walked a 
            few steps in the room, ate his lunch with a ravenous appetite, and 
            later went down to the garden.  On the third day, after waking up fresh and full of 
            pep, he went out for a ride.  As the friendship between the two men grew, he once 
            asked the Indian physician what he had given him to heal him so 
            miraculously.  'Our science is handed down from father to son,' 
            said the Indian. 'When a son is initiated into this science, he must 
            first make a solemn vow that he will never, under any circumstances, 
            betray these secrets. No one has ever yet broken this oath. I cannot 
            tell you the secret of these pills, but I can tell you a few things 
            about our science. The pills I gave you represent a chemical 
            compound consisting mainly of gold. This gold compound, however, is 
            not merely so much inert matter. On the contrary, we might even call 
            it "living gold". In its preparation, it was kept at a constant 
            moderate temperature in a hermetically sealed crucible for several 
            weeks.  'Through this process special properties connected 
            with life are developed in the gold. You know that if you keep an 
            egg at a constant temperature of 104° for twenty-one days, it will 
            hatch out in a living chick. On the other hand, if you subject the 
            egg to a temperature of 212° for ten minutes, the egg will harden 
            but never become a chicken. That is just exactly what happens with 
            this gold preparation. The constant temperature over several weeks' 
            time develops in the gold a form of energy with the same vibrations 
            as our "vital energy". This energy stands far above atomic energy. 
            It has taken millions of years for gold to develop from the ordinary 
            coarse matter of the earth through an exceedingly slow process.  If 
            we develop this process further, we can transform the gold into 
            another material charged with the very highest form of energy. Just 
            as one can magnetize a piece of ordinary iron, we can also develop 
            ordinary gold into magnetic or "living gold". The magnetism of the 
            gold, however, represents a much higher energy than the magnetism 
            found in iron. It has the same vibrations as our own vital energy. 
            In fact, it is life itself and has a miraculous effect on all 
            living creatures. Man may be likened to a living magnet charged with 
            this very highest form of energy.  'Just as a magnet loses its charge in time, but can 
            be re-magnetized by passing an electric current around it, in the 
            same way human beings can be recharged with this energy. The seat of 
            this vital energy is the marrow in the spinal column. In your fall 
            from your horse, this very delicate organ was injured and the 
            tension of your vital energy fell abruptly. Your organism was unable 
            to recover, because the healing centres themselves were injured. 
            These pills recharged your nerve centres, natural processes were set 
            in motion, and now you are well. That's all there is to it. See what 
            these pills do for the Maharaja. In spite of his very advanced age, 
            he wants to keep on demonstrating his many powers every day with his 
            favourite wife. With the help of these gold pills, he still retains 
            the powers of a young man. Unaided nature is no longer able to 
            supply his body with this energy, but this preparation sets his 
            nerve centres in motion, and that is sufficient to recharge his 
            sexual organs daily.'  Our friend asked the Indian physician, 'Why do you 
            keep your knowledge so secret? Why can't all humanity enjoy the 
            blessing of your science? Why don't you teach it to the English 
            doctors who are here?'  For a while the Indian physician looked off into the 
            distance. Then he said: 'Just as an egg needs to be fertilized for 
            the life within it to be changed from a latent state into an active 
            state, in the same way the preparation of this gold compound 
            requires a source of power to transform certain latent forces within 
            the gold molecules into active ones, thus changing the inert gold 
            into an active, vital material.  'This source of power is a human being himself.
            The power of reproduction can not only be manifested by the 
            body, but also on another plane as energy. A hypnotist, for example, 
            manifests his power of reproduction on a spiritual plane and can 
            penetrate the mind of another person, causing certain forces to 
            change from a latent state to an active state, just as a sperm cell 
            from his body is able to unite with an ovum to set in motion a 
            process of life within the latter. In order to set in motion a 
            certain process in various materials, in this case gold, a person 
            needs the radiation of his own vital energy. However, if he expends 
            this energy through his sexual organs, he automatically puts into a 
            latent state the very nerve centres he needs to radiate vital energy 
            in its original, basic form. These nerves open and close 
            automatically. A person can either channel this energy into his 
            sexual organs or into other, higher nerve centres, but he cannot 
            simultaneously channel it into both!  'You can easily understand that when a father 
            initiates his son into this science, the son, along with his oath of 
            silence, must take a vow of complete continence. That's why the son 
            can only be initiated when he is already married and has several 
            sons of his own, in order that there be no interruption in the chain 
            of knowledge. But just show me a Western physician who would be 
            willing to live a life of complete continence for the sake of this 
            knowledge! On the contrary, it has been our experience that the 
            majority of your physicians want to use their knowledge to earn as 
            much money as possible in order to be able to satisfy their animal 
            instincts to the maximum extent.  'Many Western physicians have visited us and tried 
            all kinds of persuasion to get us to part with our secrets. We saw 
            that with these secrets they merely wanted to earn piles of money, 
            satisfy their vanity, or become famous. It is a sad fact that the 
            foreign power in this country even went to the extent of torturing 
            several of our Ayurvedic physicians in a fruitless effort to get 
            them to reveal their secrets. Ever since then, foreigners in India 
            do not meet any Ayurvedic physicians, simply because none of the 
            latter will admit that he is one or that he possesses any special 
            knowledge. We were forced to wear masks and become "mysterious 
            orientals". We had to pay a high price to learn this lesson.  'Nevertheless I can tell you this much: All through 
            the years there have been foreign physicians who for high-minded, 
            truly humanitarian reasons sought to acquire our knowledge and were 
            willing to take the oath of Brahmacharya (continence). These doctors 
            have received initiation and are working with us. On the other hand, 
            they keep their knowledge just as secret as we do. When humanity has 
            progressed to such a point that the majority of doctors are willing 
            to forego their sexual lusts in order to be able to heal, Indian 
            Ayurvedic physicians will be willing to reveal this secret knowledge 
            to them. At present, however, people in the West use all of their 
            inventions to harm each other. Take dynamite, for example, and 
            aeroplanes. What have they done with these things? Made them into 
            new weapons! What would they do if they knew the secret of cosmic 
            energy and of the still higher vital energy? They'd merely figure 
            out new ways to kill each other off and earn still more money! War 
            is business! and what's this business for? Why do people run after 
            more and more money? In order to indulge their sexual pleasures, 
            lusts and perversities to a greater extent. You ask why we do not 
            reveal our secrets! The answer is that foreign doctors really do not 
            want them. When they hear that they would have to give up their 
            lusts in order to acquire this knowledge, they lose interest right 
            away. They simply cannot believe that by paying such a cheap price 
            they could learn the secret of all life. It's much easier for them 
            not to bother to make a single attempt, but merely to poke ridicule 
            at Orientals.  'Most of the foreigners who come to our country 
            think that the highest happiness on earth is the satisfaction of 
            their sexual desire. How could they ever know anything about the 
            tremendous power that a spiritual person possesses if they never 
            make an attempt themselves to attain it? This power cannot be 
            acquired through either money or might. The price is renunciation! 
            But the people who have paid this price have quickly discovered that 
            they really did not need to give up anything. They find, on 
            the contrary, that they have discovered immortal happiness in the 
            place of mortal ... a permanent state of pleasure instead of a 
            transitory one. No one can make a better bargain! But we do not 
            discuss these things. These secrets cannot be understood with the 
            intellect alone.  'Spirit cannot be understood, it can only be 
            experienced. One can only be spirit. We are content to let 
            others travel the path of the intellect. They have already 
            accomplished much and will still accomplish more. But the "highest 
            truth" will always remain hidden for the person who merely follows 
            his intellect and never learns the bliss of pure being to 
            which the path of renunciation leads. People in the West have made 
            the Oriental yogi a comic book character. Is it any wonder that the 
            initiates do not reveal their secrets but merely withdraw and remain 
            unreachable for Western people?  'I have told you all of this because I can see that 
            you're not interested in our sciences purely out of curiosity, but 
            rather because of deep spiritual desire. You seek the truth. You 
            seek God! We are ready and glad to help such people. I'll give you a 
            bit of advice: If you want to make faster progress and plunge deeper 
            into the secrets of human life, practise yoga!'  The Indian doctor went on to explain that for many 
            thousands of years the Orientals have been discovering and 
            perfecting various methods by which people can reach the goal of 
            happiness, a goal everyone carries in his heart regardless of how 
            ignorant he may be or how low his individual state of consciousness. 
            Right here on earth people can reach this fulfilment, this 
            salvation, this state of eternal bliss—or as Orientals call it, 
            Nirvana. The door is open for every person when he finds the key.
             This key is yoga!  Our friend's Indian doctor went on to explain that 
            every human act or activity which is done with concentration is 
            actually yoga, as the only way we have of reaching the great goal is 
            through concentration. In studying yoga systematically, however, we 
            learn techniques for developing and improving our powers of 
            concentration, and these are methods which have been perfected 
            through thousands of years. There are various paths in yoga: 
            physical, mental, and spiritual exercises in concentration. These 
            exercises develop the highest abilities of the human being, opening 
            up his spiritual eyes, his spiritual ears, and teaching him to be 
            master of himself ... master of creative forces ... master of the 
            forces of fate. The pathway to happiness is opened up, or to express 
            it another way, the path to self-realization—to God! The 
            highest and at the same time the most difficult yoga path is that of 
            Raja Yoga. Raja means 'king', and if we translate the term 
            literally, we find that this yoga path is known as 'regal yoga' or 
            'majestic yoga'. It is the shortest path, but at the same time the 
            steepest and bumpiest. It is the pathway Jesus taught in the Bible. 
            With patience and perseverance, however, one reaches the goal.  My husband's schoolboy friend went on with his 
            story: 'The Indian physician showed me the basic exercises of Yoga, 
            the ones I snowed you. But later he told me how to get into touch 
            with one of the greatest living yogis. I went to him. He was a man 
            over eighty years old, but he did not look to be over forty. He was 
            a Hatha Yogi. These yogis know all the secrets of the body. They are 
            able to maintain their bodies in constant and perfect health for 
            several hundred years if they want to. The Indians claim that in the 
            mountains there are yogis living today who are seven hundred and 
            eight hundred years old.'  My husband began to laugh: 'Now I'll tell one! Seven 
            hundred years old? Not bad at all, but at that point you woke up, 
            right?'  'See,' our friend answered quite seriously, 'you are 
            a true Occidental. Just because there are some things you haven't 
            heard about, this doesn't mean by any manner of means that they 
            don't exist. The Orientals know much more about the science of man 
            than we in the West, but they have learnt to keep quiet. From the 
            time the first Occidentals arrived in the Orient, they have done all 
            kinds of things that have made the Orientals keep silent. Even 
            today they can still keep their secrets. I saw things in India 
            that taught me to be very cautious about laughing other people out 
            of court.'  'O.K., O.K.,' my husband answered, 'I believe too 
            that there must be some way of living longer when we think that even 
            here in the West the human life span is constantly being lengthened 
            in spite of all we do to shorten it with nicotine, alcohol and wrong 
            living habits. Fifty or sixty years ago the average life span was 
            thirty-five years, whereas now it's around sixty. Makes one wonder 
            what the limit is! Medical science is progressing with giant 
            strides. Who knows how far we'll go?'  'See—your real conviction is not cynical at all. But 
            here in the West we don't dare admit what we believe just because it 
            isn't considered the thing to do. To talk about things we don't 
            understand we always try to affect a superior, cynical manner. I 
            have great respect for what our scientists know, but they act as if 
            they knew all the secrets of life, whereas they are completely 
            ignorant about death. The Orientals have discovered the secret of 
            life and death, but their one and only weapon against the cynicism 
            of the West is silence. No wonder. Here's an example.  An Indian 
            showed me a cigarette lighter. It was a little figure of Buddha 
            sitting in the so-called lotus posture, a cheap lighter such as one 
            could get at any bazaar. He told me, "An Oriental would never use 
            the figure of Christ for a cigarette lighter, because we feel 
            respect for the sacred symbols of other religions, just as for our 
            own. We know that one and the same God stands above and 
            behind all the various sacred symbols!" So saying, he gently put 
            down the Buddha cigarette lighter on his household altar. As a 
            Westerner, I felt deeply ashamed, and I often wonder when we in the 
            West will wake up and have enough sense not to go on constantly 
            insulting Orientals by such offences against tact, respect, and good 
            taste. Just think, too, about all our Western films that deal with 
            the Orient. Orientals see these films too, and I'm sure you can 
            guess what they think about them. But they are silent ...'  I asked our friend, 'Are there books about yoga?'
             'The most beautiful and the most sacred book of the 
            Indians is the Bhagavad Gita. In it you can read the most 
            beautiful description of the spiritual path to self-development 
            through Raja Yoga. That's what I would recommend to you.'  I had heard enough.  That very evening I wanted to begin reading the book 
            our friend had loaned me. I lay down comfortably in bed, took the 
            book and opened it.  To my great surprise, I saw it was not the book I 
            had chosen! I turned it around and looked at the title on the back. 
            How strange! I had read the title while browsing through our 
            friend's books, and I now remembered distinctly that I had taken out 
            the book I wanted. Could I have made a mistake and pulled out the 
            book next to it? Apparently. But now that I had this book, I wanted 
            at least to look at it. It immediately awakened my interest. On the 
            outside it looked like a modern book. But inside it contained a 
            very, very old manuscript. The paper was yellow and brown with age, 
            full of traces of worms. Both the dark black ink as well as the 
            writing showed that the book was very old indeed. The more I read, 
            the more surprised and excited I became ... until finally my hands 
            fairly trembled with the enforced suspense as I devoured page after 
            page.  The manuscript told about a secret spiritual order 
            that was as old as the earth itself. Without any external, visible 
            form of 'membership', the order was constantly taking in neophytes 
            who came in contact with it without actually knowing anything about 
            it. This 'coming into contact' occurred when a person reached such a 
            state of development that he completely gave up his own person and 
            dedicated his entire life to alleviating the sufferings of others. 
            Whenever a person has reached this decision, a member of the secret 
            order gets in spiritual touch with him, or rather the individual who 
            has decided to give up his person and thus has reached universal 
            love has reached a stage in his development such that he 
            automatically responds to the vibrations flowing among the members 
            of this secret spiritual fraternity. First he hears within himself 
            the voice of the spiritual leader and guide, warning him about the 
            difficulties, dangers and consequences of his decision. If he still 
            sticks to his decision, this 'order' which exists to help humanity 
            climb up out of chaos, accepts him as a member.  At first he is on probation without actually knowing 
            it. This probationary period begins immediately and for seven 
            long years the neophyte is left completely on his own. During 
            this time he has no contact with the order, no matter how much he 
            may desire and seek it. But the various tests he must pass come one 
            after the other. Seven of them relate to the human virtues: becoming 
            free of sensuality, vanity, anger, covetousness, envy, sensitivity— 
            then on the other side, th6 ability to withstand outside influences.
             If he passes all of these tests in spite of being 
            entirely on his own, and if he sticks by his decision, he is 
            considered ready to begin his work and is definitely accepted within 
            the order. On the very same day, he learns about his acceptance 
            through an 'apparent' coincidence. From then on he receives thorough 
            training and, simultaneously, specific tasks. At first these tasks 
            are easy, and as he performs them satisfactorily, they become 
            progressively more difficult. The tasks are very different. Some 
            neophytes must work in public, others behind the scenes. Some roam 
            the countryside as beggars, others are very rich. In either case 
            they must fulfil their duties. Some work as assistants of famous 
            discoverers, others as writers or lecturers. Some hold positions of 
            great worldly power, while others may hold down jobs as workmen in 
            huge factories. It can even happen that two members of the order 
            appear to be working against each other. Such persons are not 
            permitted to reveal in any way at all that they belong together and 
            are in contact with each other. Sometimes they are celebrated and 
            enjoy tremendous popularity; at other times they may live in abject 
            misery and be subjected to privations and degradations. They must 
            fulfil all their tasks in a completely free and impersonal manner, 
            simply as servants within the great plan. And as they perform their 
            tasks, they must bear full responsibility for their each and 
            every act! They receive their assignments, but they must figure 
            out themselves how to carry them out in complete awareness of the 
            responsibility they bear for everything they do. The higher they 
            rise, the greater their responsibility.  Anyone who refuses to bear the responsibility for 
            his acts and his work, and tries to unload this responsibility on 
            another member of the order, anyone who does not recognize his 
            work as his own, personally chosen task but tries to make it appear 
            that he is acting on the instructions of the order or as a spiritual 
            tool of a member of the order—such a person is a traitor and 
            instantly loses all contact with the order. He does not know, 
            however, that he has lost contact, and it is possible for him to go 
            on for years believing himself to be a co-worker within the order. 
            Such persons are used by the order to test other people and find out 
            whether they accept and follow false prophets or whether they have 
            progressed far enough in thinking independently and reaching their 
            own decisions so that they weigh every word they hear and only 
            accept it after it has passed examination. Those who follow false 
            prophets are still blind, allowing themselves to be led by blind, 
            and both fall by the wayside.  Membership of the order is restricted to persons who 
            are completely self-reliant and able to resist influence. They must 
            not be people who do good or avoid doing evil merely 
            out of a spirit of obedience or because they expect to be rewarded 
            and 'go to Heaven', or because they fear punishment and want to 
            avoid going to Hell. On the contrary, the order's members must be 
            persons who always— in life and death—follow their own deepest 
            conviction and act accordingly! This is because the members 
            hear the order's messages in their own hearts, as their own 
            profoundest convictions!  I read these lines with ever mounting excitement. 
            Renounce earthly pleasures? How I remembered the night when I sobbed 
            so desperately in bed! ... Can one renounce them any more 
            definitively than I did then? Sincere and deep desire to alleviate 
            the sufferings of others? God alone knows how earnest was the vow I 
            took that time in my room, thinking intently about the terrible 
            sufferings of the mentally ill and the incessant, unremitting pains 
            and troubles of all people all over the world! Now I remembered the 
            warnings I so clearly heard then, and the awesome feeling of being 
            alone, the desperate feeling of being completely abandoned for many 
            long years! How many years since that time? Seven years! Yes, 
            exactly seven! And today, this curious coincidence with the book. 
            Coincidence? No! It was a message ... a message!  I was shaken to the depths of my being by this 
            experience! As was my custom, I examined the whole matter again with 
            my mind and intellect, for I never stopped using my intellect as a 
            means of testing and checking. But what could my intellect say now? 
            I knew best that all this was so. What else could my 
            intellect do but simply recognize the facts? Even the most sceptical 
            intellect would be silenced in the face of so many coincidences! No, 
            I could not doubt it: I had been accepted!  I was overcome by a feeling of inexpressible 
            happiness and gratitude. I felt the grace of God, his blessing, deep 
            humility, and a profound sense of awe. In this condition, I have 
            remained ever since.    
             THERE WAS LIGHT It was strikingly noticeable that from this time on 
            more and more people— men and women, old and young—came to me for 
            advice on how to find their paths to happiness. More and more 
            'seekers' came to me for help. I felt, however, that I was still in 
            extreme darkness. How should I be able to help others? How should I 
            be able to heal the many wounds in the souls of people about me if I 
            myself had not yet solved the puzzle of life and death?  The most important thing was for me to escape from 
            my own darkness. I 'searched' in whatever direction my inner voice 
            advised me, and tried to make progress through reading good books. I 
            found a book describing the secret exercises of Raja Yoga, that is, 
            the path to the self. I wanted to begin these exercises immediately, 
            for I had reached the point where I knew that reading is only 
            necessary in order to know what one must do! If we want to 
            reach the goal— the self—we must bring what we know into 
            actuality! I wanted reality, not only beautiful descriptions and 
            theories. On the other hand, spiritual yoga demands the strictest 
            asceticism.  I spoke with my husband. He was always my best 
            friend and knew how vitally important it was for me to find the 
            answer to the three great questions: Whence, whither, why? He 
            gave his consent to my ascetic exercises.  My father had bought an estate in the mountains. 
            There in the forest we had a little house into which I now moved all 
            alone. At that time my son was away from home, studying, and 
            returned only for holidays, while my husband was constantly 
            travelling and saw me only at weekends.  The large terrace in front of the house offered a 
            glorious view off into the valley where the vast plains began. It 
            was almost like looking off into infinity. At the foot of the 
            mountain a wide river wove its way slowly and majestically out into 
            the distance. On the farther shore, roads and highways formed the 
            veins and arteries of a giant body and the cars travelling about 
            seemed like tiny cells within the gigantic bloodstream. Everything 
            was diminutive, the villages with their little doll houses, and the 
            tiny, busy ant-like people.  The other window looked out into the forest where 
            one could walk for hours and hours in the awesome silence. Pheasants 
            often ventured up to the house, and deer frequently came quite 
            close. At night one could hear them trotting by. Doors and windows 
            were heavily barred against wild boar and other dangerous animals.
             Here I lived quite alone. Every morning I found my 
            day's supply of fresh milk on the terrace, then went downstairs to 
            the wood cellar, chopped my day's supply, and built a fire in my 
            stove. Then I began my exercises. This forest house was an ideal 
            place to practise yoga. The entire region was famous for its 
            awe-inspiring atmosphere. The peace and quiet in the forest and the 
            primeval purity of nature round about were so great that every one 
            who came by tended to rise up in spirit in contemplation and 
            meditation—even without yoga exercises. Everyone who visited this 
            sylvan retreat became more sensitive to higher vibrations. Their 
            latent organs of psychic sense developed. While living here I was 
            able to perform without exertion the most difficult exercises in 
            concentration and meditation.  For something to study I took a collection of old 
            figures of the Rosicrucians dating from the sixteenth and 
            seventeenth centuries. It was truly a treasure chest of the greatest 
            wisdom. When I had finished my concentration exercises lasting 
            several hours, I meditated on these wonderful symbolic 
            representations of profoundest truth, and step by step the hidden 
            secrets of this book revealed themselves to my marvelling spiritual 
            eyes. Another subject I studied while here in reclusion in the 
            forest was Oriental philosophy, primarily the Vedas and the 
            Upanishads.  The long exercises in concentration and meditation 
            helped me to penetrate, step by step, into the profoundest regions 
            of my psyche. With these exercises I set forces in motion which kept 
            on working during the time I devoted to everyday activities, and 
            even during the time I was sleeping. Sometimes as I wandered through 
            the forest there arose within me pictures of places I knew well 
            without being able to identify them, for I had never seen them in 
            this life. While I was awake, and even in my dreams at night, I saw 
            people whom I also knew, and in some cases knew very well, but whom 
            I had never seen in this life. Their clothing and their names were 
            strange, and their language in which we communicated in my dreams 
            was quite different from any language I had ever heard in this life.
             Whenever I sat down to meditate and turned my 
            attention inwards, I was aware of a greenish-blue phosphorescent 
            light within me ... a light which seemed to come from the invisible 
            eyes of a great and wonderful spirit being. An indescribable kind of 
            strength, love and goodness radiated to me from these eyes. With a 
            sense of absolute confidence I plunged into this source of loving 
            power. I felt myself in security, and without any trace of fear. I 
            delved deeper and ever deeper into the unknown world of the 
            unconscious.  Then once, quite unexpectedly, the light drove away 
            the darkness, which had been hiding both the past and the truth, and 
            everything became clear.  When I had seated myself to practice meditation, the 
            phosphorescent light appeared before my inner eye as usual. Then I 
            felt with even greater clarity than ever before that the source of 
            light lay in the eyes of a powerful being whom I knew well. Little 
            by little they became so clear that I no longer merely felt—I 
            knew—that they were looking at me. I felt their glance, their 
            brilliance, their power, their light and their love shining upon me, 
            and in the next moment, as an effect of this glance, the last 
            remnant of cloudy haze in my consciousness disappeared, and before 
            me there stood, as if emerging from darkness, a majestic figure with 
            two dark blue, infinitely deep eyes, His figure, His 
            face and His eyes: —HE!  22
           
            PAST BECOMES PRESENT He stood there and looked at me calmly. This 
            radiant glance with its heavenly peace gave me strength to bear the 
            soul-shaking experience and the infinite joy of seeing Him 
            again. His noble face was unmoving, but His eyes were smiling at me, 
            and I knew that He was happy that I had at last come fully 
            awake and was seeing Him again. For He has always seen 
            me. His eyes have always been able to penetrate the mists covering 
            my consciousness. He saw all my struggles, all my pains and 
            sorrows, and He has never once abandoned me. On the contrary,
            He has helped me to wake up and become conscious.  The memory seized me powerfully, and the hazy 
            pictures I had been carrying inside myself without being able to 
            bring them into conscious focus suddenly became sharp and clear. New 
            pictures emerged into my consciousness, new memories which had been 
            lying hidden and buried in the depths of my subconscious. Now, 
            fitting together like the stones in a mosaic, they formed the 
            perfect picture of a past life in a land beside the great river, the 
            Nile, in the land of the Pyramids ...  The memory pictures came ever more alive, while the 
            impressions of my present life gradually paled, turning over their 
            place to the re-awakened consciousness of a person I once was. The 
            environment in which I sat, the simple little room in the house in 
            the forest ... the beautiful view out over the river in the valley 
            ... disappeared bit by bit. And He too was nowhere to be 
            seen. The room opened and spread out about me. I found myself in a 
            great hall, in my own chamber, and I became aware of a fat and 
            lovable woman smiling at me joyously ...  Yes of course! Today is my sixteenth birthday, and I 
            am just putting on my festive robes. I am to wear them at the great 
            reception in which my father is to present me to the representatives 
            of the country as his wife, successor to the Queen who died an early 
            death.  In a great oval silver plate which has been hammered 
            and polished with loving care and high art, I see my own figure, my 
            own picture, and I watch my dear old Menu as she dresses me.  My mother died while I was still very young, and I 
            have only a vague memory of how pale she was ... and how fine. In 
            the treasure chest of my precious recollections, I still see her 
            great, sad eyes as she took her last long, long look at me before 
            she died. This last, long, loving glance created a contact between 
            us which I still feel within me, and today when I am to be presented 
            to the country as her representative, I feel this contact even 
            deeper, even stronger.  Now fully robed and ready I stand before my mirror 
            and look at my image. I like it! I see a fine, delicate, slender 
            person in a beautiful robe ... scintillating, silken with golden 
            hems. The golden sash about her waist enhances her slender-ness, her 
            broad collar emphasizes her shoulders and the kerchief around her 
            head accentuates the self-confident and superior expression in her 
            face. I am vain; I like what I see in the mirror. And dear, old, 
            warm-hearted Menu, who considers me the most perfect being on earth, 
            can hardly see through the tears of joy welling up in her eyes.  The two oldest representatives of the country come 
            and lead me down the long corridor into the great reception hall. 
            With slow, ceremonious steps, they lead me between the rows of 
            people of rank to the 'Great House'—to the Pharaoh—to my father who 
            is now to be my husband. He sits on a golden throne like an image of 
            God. It is not without reason that his name, Phar-ao, means 
            'Great House'. His person is the outer integument, the 'house' of 
            God. God dwells in him, manifests himself in him, radiates through 
            him. The power of his glance is so penetrating that people who are 
            not completely true are compelled to look aside. He is sitting there 
            looking straight at me, through me! I look back at him fearlessly, 
            engaging his glance with mine. I know the tremendous power radiating 
            from his eyes is the power of love. He sees everything. He sees that 
            I am vain, just as he sees all my other imperfections, but he 
            understands everything. He is love itself, he is my father!  A magnificent lion, his lion, sits motionless beside 
            the throne. Majestic and dignified, it is a symbol of the supreme 
            power of the Pharaoh. I arrive at the steps to the throne and stand 
            still. The Pharaoh rises, comes down, turns to the magnificent jewel 
            box the Chamberlain holds out to him, lifts out the most beautiful 
            creation of the goldsmith's craftsmanship: a golden shoulder collar. 
            Picking it up lovingly, he lays it over my shoulders. Then he takes 
            the golden hoop that ends with the head of a serpent and fastens it 
            firmly on to the white silken cloth over my forehead. It is the 
            symbol of the members of the ruling race, the Sons of God. It is the 
            symbol of the initiates ...  Then taking my right hand, the Pharaoh leads me up 
            to the throne. We turn to the representatives of the country and the 
            people of rank, and he presents me to them as the representative of 
            the Queen, as his wife. We seat ourselves, I to his left, somewhat 
            ahead of him. Now the people of rank with their wives, the eldest 
            among them first, pass by us slowly, and bow low with outstretched 
            arms, first before the Pharaoh and then before me. We sit 
            motionless. Only our eyes make contact with each and all as they 
            move by. I think of the fact that I now manifest the spirit of my 
            dear mother, and this makes me aware of my duty and responsibility.
             The people of rank pass by and I see their souls 
            reflected in their eyes. In some there is real love and respect, in 
            others envy, curiosity or cowardly servility. The Supreme 
            Chamberlain, Roo-Kha, also bows before me. As he has so often done 
            before when I have met him in the palace, he gives me a glance that 
            is somewhat cynical, impertinent, and flatteringly intimate all at 
            the same time.  I answer his impertinence with a cold stare, and the 
            procession marches slowly onward. Then I see friends of mine, old 
            and young, some of them former playmates, their faces full of 
            genuine love. I meet their glances with mine, and this union 
            enriches us. Slowly, ceremoniously, all the people pass by us, 
            silently, but united in spirit.  The lengthy procession finally comes to an end. The 
            Pharaoh stands up and reaches me his hand. Slowly we descend the 
            steps, and, walking between the rows of statesmen and people of 
            rank, leave the room. Leading me into his chamber, my father seats 
            himself, waves me to a seat, and looks at me smilingly for a while 
            in silence. I can see that I am pleasing to him. From head to foot 
            his glance moves over my figure with satisfaction. Then, looking me 
            happily in the eye, he says, 'From now on we'll see each other 
            often, for you will take your mother's place and fulfil her duties 
            before the public. For many years we have been preparing you for 
            this task, and you know your duties. I want you to have a happy 
            memory of this day of days, so you may make a wish. You've known for 
            some time that I was going to ask you what you wanted, so tell me 
            now. What is it?'  Yes I was prepared, and like other young women, I 
            could have had a number of wishes. I could have asked for beautiful 
            jewellery, for I knew I could wear the great festive jewels only on 
            occasions of high ceremony. Or I could have wished to travel, or 
            asked for a young trained lion, or for something else of the sort. 
            But I didn't want any of these things!  'Father,' I said, 'what is the significance of the 
            ornament I am wearing on my head?'  The Pharaoh looks at my forehead, then into my eyes, 
            then answers, 'The golden snake is the symbol of the ruling race, 
            the Sons of God.'  'Yes, father, but it is also the symbol of 
            initiation. I am not worthy to wear it because I haven't been 
            initiated. I want to be initiated! That's the wish I want you to 
            fulfil for me!'  Father becomes very earnest. 'Ask for something 
            else, my child,' he says.  'You are still very young and not yet mature enough 
            to receive initiation. Tender young sprouts must not be exposed to 
            hot sunshine; otherwise they burn up and can never blossom. Wait 
            till you've acquired the necessary experiences in earthly, physical 
            life. To be initiated now would make your later problems much, much 
            harder for you to solve. Why cause yourself unnecessary troubles? 
            Take my advice and wish for something else.'  'Father,' I answered, 'there's nothing else I want. 
            The things other young people like just bore me stiff. Above and 
            beyond all earthly joys I see the wishes of the body. I like 
            beautiful jewels very much, but even gold is a form of matter which 
            is made precious through a manifestation of the spirit, through the 
            work of the artisan. Naturally I enjoy beautiful scenery and new 
            sights when I'm travelling, but I can never forget that this is all 
            creation, not the creator. I should like to experience the 
            highest truth in its reality. I want to learn to know God, the 
            creator himself! Father, you know that what we call life 
            is only an unreal dream. Here everything slips out of our hand, we 
            can never be definitely happy about anything, everything is merely a 
            transition between past and future. But I want to experience the 
            eternal present which will never become the past and which was 
            never the future. And I want to find that condition or "place" which 
            was never "there" before I reached it, becomes "here" 
            when I reach it and turns into "there" again when I go on. I 
            want to experience the eternal present in time and space. 
            Father, I want the highest reality—I want initiation!'  Even as he listens to me, father becomes sadder and 
            sadder. 'Your spiritual awakening has come earlier than it should 
            have,' he says. 'All I can do is to go to my brother Ptahhotep, the 
            High Priest of the Temple and the Head of our race. I will speak 
            with him, and he will take you under his guidance. May God's eternal 
            light illumine your pathway.'  He lays his hand upon my head and blesses me. I 
            should like to throw myself upon his breast to thank him for 
            granting my wish, but my heavy golden collar holds me back and keeps 
            me from making any sudden motions. Father, who can read a person's 
            every thought, sees that I wanted to express my joy through this 
            sudden outburst. 'In one way you are still a big child,' he says 
            kindly, 'and in others you are grown up and mature. You'll have to 
            practise great self-control if you want to be initiated.'  I answer with a laugh, 'I already have self control 
            Father, when I want it.'  'Yes, I believe you, but do you always want it?' he 
            asks with a smile.  'It's boring to always exercise self control, 
            Father.'  'That's just the trouble,' he replies with a loving 
            nod. 'There's danger in your finding self control boring. Just 
            remember, if, even for a second, you do not keep your will directed 
            towards your favourite lion and if he attacks you in this weak 
            moment, you're lost. The low self is just as much an animal in its 
            nature as a lion is. We must keep both of them under constant 
            control; then they serve us with their gigantic strength. Always pay 
            attention!'  We take leave of each other. He escorts me to the 
            door and turns me over to the two elders waiting in the antechamber. 
            Oh, what a nuisance these ceremonies are. Why do I have to walk in 
            such a slow and dignified manner between these two old men, just to 
            get back to my own room? I'd like to run down the long corridor and 
            burst into my room where my Menu will be waiting for me full of 
            excitement and curiosity. But no! I have to walk ... with 
            dignity and majesty ... so the beautiful golden collar on my 
            shoulders will not slip off askew. Finally we reach my door 
            where—with dignity and majesty—I take leave of the two elders. I 
            walk in and stop inside the doorway so that Menu can admire me in my 
            glittering gold ornaments. She is truly beside herself at the sight 
            of my beauty and my majestic movements and because, as she expresses 
            it, I look so much like my mother.  Then I tell her, 'Do you see how ignorant you are, 
            Menu? I can't look like anybody else, and I don't like to have you 
            say things like that. My nose or my mouth can perhaps resemble my 
            mother's, but I? Can you ever really see me, the real
            me, my self? You see only my body, the dwelling place of my 
            self, but you never see my self. How then can I look 
            like somebody else?'  'Oh ho,' says Menu, 'if I can't see you, how 
            come you are so beautiful? Just tell me that! If I can't 
            see you, then what I do see here in front of me and what I 
            consider so beautiful is not really you but merely the 
            dwelling place of yourself, so you are not beautiful at all! 
            Then don't stand there looking so proud and majestic!'  At this we both burst out laughing. Despite her 
            limited intellect, Menu can often give me such a wise and witty 
            answer that I am ashamed of myself. Yes, she has discovered my 
            weakness, my vanity. Then with infinite tenderness she removes my 
            golden collar and the ornamental band from my head, laying them with 
            tender care in the jewel chest, because the Chancellor, Roo-Kha, is 
            waiting outside with the two ornament bearers to carry these 
            precious works of gold back to the treasure chamber to await the 
            next high ceremony in court. He enters my antechamber and bows 
            before me. This man annoys me, because I see he is not bowing out of 
            respect for me, but because he must. He gives me another 
            saucily intimate look, while I do my best to look as dignified and 
            regal as possible. Then at last I am alone with Menu.  Menu became my nurse when my mother died. She was 
            and still is my bodily servant, and I am much more intimate with her 
            than with the ranking ladies of the court who have taken on the duty 
            of bringing me up and educating me. From the bottom of her heart. 
            Menu loves me with such infinite affection that I could do with her 
            whatever I wanted. She has always been absolutely delighted with 
            everything I've ever said or done, and I have never had a wish that 
            she would not fulfil blindly if it was within her power to do so. 
            She was always close to me, or somewhere near by, and now that I 
            have to take on public duties beside my father, she has started to 
            worry that I might keep her more and more at a distance. But I love 
            her with a boundless confidence because I know and can, read in 
            people's eyes that no one else in my father's court loves me so 
            sincerely, so unreservedly, so completely uncalculatingly as Menu.
             I saw my father only seldom during my childhood. He 
            was and is a 'great man' in our country. For he came to the earth 
            with the duty of guiding and governing people in their earthly 
            life. He dedicated his life to the task of showing the sons of 
            men how to govern a country in such a way that all its inhabitants 
            can develop happily. This task gave him so much to do that he had 
            very little time left for me. Every day he spent a few minutes in 
            the garden where I was playing with the children of the Royal 
            family, or he arranged for me to visit him for a few minutes in his 
            chamber.  When I was still quite small, he would pick me up in 
            his arms or crouch down beside me on the floor for a while. Then he 
            would look at me with endless love, bless me and go away. He always 
            spoke to me just as if he were speaking to an adult. In our race, 
            known as 'the Sons of God', it is not considered important at all 
            whether we have been on earth for a long time or only a short time, 
            or whether a spirit is living here on earth in a still undeveloped 
            body—as a child— or in a developed body—as an adult. This question 
            of size and age is only considered important among the sons of men, 
            who are so closely tied to their bodies and identify themselves with 
            their physical instrument to such an extent that they completely 
            forget their true nature as spirit independent of time and place. 
            The sons of men believe that someone can actually be 'small' or 
            'large'.  But the members of our race, the Sons of God, even 
            keep their spiritual consciousness when they are born into their 
            bodies. They never forget that only the body can be 'a child' or 'an 
            adult' and that the spirit is and always remains the same. It is 
            neither 'big' nor 'small', neither 'young' nor 'old', for spirit is 
            independent of the world of time and space! This is why my 
            relationship with my father was never disturbed at all by the fact 
            that we were of different ages and seldom saw each other. As I grew 
            older, father sometimes took me along on his walks, and when I would 
            get tired, he would pick me up and carry me in his mighty arms as he 
            went on talking about all the secrets of nature. I found such 
            discourses of his extremely fascinating, and I once said to him, 
            'Father, I'd like to know so much about everything, just like you 
            do!'  'When you are initiated,' he answered, 
            'all the secrets of Heaven and earth will be known to you.'' I 
            never forgot these words of his, and I waited patiently for the time 
            when I too would be initiated.  Although I was always living among strange people, I 
            never felt alone because of this. I knew my father understood me 
            completely, and even though we were not near each other physically, 
            I was united with him in spirit, I belonged to him. And in the same 
            way I was united with my mother. She was no longer living in the 
            body, yet I was indissolubly united with her in spirit. It is 
            astounding to realize how little the unity of the spirit depends on 
            physical togetherness! My dear Menu, for example, is almost always 
            with me, scarcely leaving me alone for a moment, and still I 
            am not with her. She can love me but not understand me. She hardly 
            thinks for herself any more, and scarcely lives except for me; she 
            lives in me and is completely in my power, even though I do not 
            exploit this situation. Father told me once that one should never 
            abuse the power arising from superiority of the mind.  Right now Menu is as happy as if my father had 
            presented her to the court as his wife, as if she were 
            so beautiful, and as if she had been given my ornaments as a 
            representative of the queen. Oh, my dear old Menu! And now, 
            naturally enough, she asks me what wish I asked my father to grant.
             'Initiation of course!' I reply.  'What?' Menu cries out in horror. 'Initiation? You 
            don't mean to say you want to leave the court and join the neophytes 
            in the temple? Why didn't you ask for beautiful jewels? Or to have 
            Imhotep, the artist, make a statue of you? —Or anything else, except 
            initiation!'  'Why get so excited?' I ask in reply. 'The one and 
            only thing I want is initiation, and that's all. And how could 
            anything make me happy that is not in me, not myself, 
            but hanging outside on my body so that I don't even see it? I now 
            even own the jewels with which people will some day adorn my body, 
            after I have left it, when they put it into a tomb, so that people 
            may know that I belong to the race of the Sons of God. I have these 
            jewels right now, but still don't feel happier in any way than 
            before. And for the same reason people will immortalize my outward 
            form. Why should I wish for such things? Who cares what the sons of 
            men will say a few thousand years from now about the statues of my 
            outward form? The only thing which can make me happy is what is in 
            me, what is identical with me, but not things outside myself. 
            The only thing that can make me truly happy is an inward experience 
            through which, in spite of my earthly body, I can earn the ultimate 
            truth in life. I want to be initiated!'  Menu groans in desperation, as if I had asked for 
            death itself: 'Oh, I know, no one can talk to you. When you have 
            your mind set on something, it just has to happen. But I feel 
            initiation is going to bring you into great danger. Don't wish for 
            that! Wish for something else, please! What did the Pharaoh say to 
            your idea?'  'He has given his permission for me to see his 
            brother, Ptahhotep, and now  please stop groaning. Don't spoil the whole day for 
            me!'  23  HE  That evening, I leave the palace with Menu. Wearing 
            heavy veils, we walk through the long colonnade from the palace to 
            the temple, on our way to the High Priest, my father's brother, the 
            son of God, Ptahhotep. Ptahhotep is the highest of all 
            priests. At the same time, however, he is the highest physician and 
            architect, because he knows and masters all the secrets of nature. 
            He has come to earth with the duty and the task of leading the sons 
            of men in their spiritual life and initiating them in the 
            sciences. He stands above father because he never identified himself 
            with his body, whereas father married and thus anchored himself more 
            firmly in the material plane.  Without talking, we make our way to the temple. Menu 
            has learned to keep silent when I am withdrawn in thought. A 
            neophyte awaiting us before the temple takes me inside. Menu remains 
            in the antechamber. At the end of another long colonnade, Ptahhotep 
            awaits me in a little reception room. The neophyte remains outside.
             There HE sits, the representative of God. 
             I see Him for the first time close to, and 
            his eyes overpower me. Oh, these eyes! Dark blue, such a deep dark 
            blue that they look almost black. They are so dark because they are 
            bottomless, as endlessly deep as the vault of heaven itself. When 
            one looks into the eyes of the sons of men, one easily sees the 
            bottom. In their eyes, one sees their soul, their whole character. 
            One sees individual eyes. Ptahhotep's eyes are completely 
            different. These eyes have no bottom at all, and looking at them is 
            like looking into the infinity of the sky on a starry night. In 
            these eyes there is nothing personal, nothing individual, only an 
            endless depth where eternity is at home. The whole world, all 
            creation lies within these eyes. I have recognized myself in these 
            eyes, and from the very first moment felt absolute confidence 
            because I know these eyes know me and contain me within 
            themselves. I know I am in Him, and He is in me 
            and loves me as Himself because I actually am He and
            He and I are a complete unity. He is Love 
            incarnate, and I feel this infinite love penetrating me, glowing 
            within me.  Moved to the depths of my being, I fall to my knees 
            before Him.  Ptahhotep holds out his hand, raises me to my feet, 
            and says, 'My little daughter, never bend your knees before a 
            visible form. Do not humble within yourself the divinity that 
            every living being carries within itself. The same God manifests 
            himself through you, through me and through the entire created 
            world. God alone is the only one before whom you can fall to 
            your knees. Now rise and tell me why you've come.'  'Father of my Soul,' I say as I arise, 'I want 
            initiation.'  Ptahhotep asks, 'Do you know what initiation is? 
            What does it mean to you when you say you want to be initiated?'  'I don't know exactly what it consists of, but I 
            want to be omniscient. I feel like a prisoner in my body, as if I 
            were feeling my way around in darkness, completely at the mercy of 
            invisible forces I do not know and therefore cannot control. I want 
            to be able to see everything clearly, I want to be all-knowing like 
            you and father and the other initiates.'  Ptahhotep answers, 'Initiation means becoming 
            conscious. You are now conscious to a degree corresponding to 
            the resistance of your nerves and body. When a person becomes 
            conscious to a higher spiritual degree, he automatically guides 
            higher, stronger, more penetrating powers into his body. For this 
            reason, he must also raise the level of resistance of his nerves and 
            body. To achieve the supreme, divinely creative degree of 
            consciousness, while at the same time increasing the resistance of 
            the nerves to the supreme degree in order to be able to endure this 
            divine condition without harm to the body—that's what initiation 
            means. Initiation also entails omnipotence and omniscience.'  'I understand, Father of my Soul, and that is just 
            exactly what I am longing for.'  Ptahhotep looks at me silently for a time, and I 
            feel his glance going completely through every fibre of my being.
             Finally he says, 'You will be initiated, but not 
            now. You are not ready for it yet in every respect. You have not yet 
            learned to control the divinely creative power within your body.
            And if you make yourself conscious of this power on the 
            spiritual plane before having learned to control it in its physical 
            manifestation, this would mean a very great danger for you.'  'What kind of danger, Father of my Soul?'  'There would be the danger of your possibly burning 
            your nerve-centres. If you achieve the highest level of spiritual 
            consciousness and thus acquire control over this power you could do 
            yourself great harm by guiding this power into your lower nerve 
            centres. In this case your consciousness would sink lower than the 
            level at which it was born in this life. You have no experience yet 
            in the guidance of this power. The awakening of consciousness must 
            begin on the lowest level in the scale of manifestations, because 
            then you will only be guiding into your body power corresponding to 
            the level of your development, i.e. power your nerves can bear 
            without harm. In this way the nerves have strong enough resistance 
            to carry the forces conducted into them.'  'Father of my Soul,' I reply, 'what does it mean 
            to conduct divine power into the body and to experience this 
            power in the body? How can I learn to know and control this power in 
            its physical manifestation? If that's how initiation begins and I 
            must first go through this experience then I'd like to do it 
            immediately so that I can prepare myself for the higher initiation.'
             Up to now Ptahhotep's divinely noble face has been 
            as motionless as an alabaster statue, with only his eyes glowing 
            brightly. But now at these words of mine the calm features of his 
            face break out into a smile, while his eyes radiate even more light 
            and more understanding.  'Immediately?' he echoes. 'That is not possible, my 
            child. To become conscious of divinely creative forces on the lowest 
            level of the scale of manifestations means to experience physical 
            love. You must wait until some young man appeals to you, until 
            his positive manly radiation awakens your heart and makes it glow 
            with negative feminine power. You must come to know this power of 
            love, for unless you have this experience behind you, you cannot 
            control it. It would always represent a constant temptation, 
            involving the great danger of your falling to a much lower level of 
            consciousness than the one you're on now.'  'Father of my Soul, I will never fall prey to 
            physical love! Love is not a temptation for me, and I am not afraid 
            of this danger because it really isn't a danger for me! Permit me, 
            please, to be initiated.'  Ptahhotep turns quite serious again and says, 'My 
            child, you only think that love could not be a danger for you 
            because you do not know this tremendous force. To be courageous in 
            the face of a danger we do not know is neither courage nor 
            power, but only ignorance and weakness! Because of your lack of 
            experience you do not know the temptation of love, and you believe 
            you are able to face this force. But don't forget that love is 
            also the manifestation of divine creative force and is therefore as 
            strong as God himself! You cannot destroy this creative force; you 
            could only transform it. But if you don't know this force, you 
            can't know how it can be transformed. Be a good girl now and go home 
            and wait till your destiny brings you this experience. When you have 
            found out what love means in its full reality, when you have 
            experienced it and clearly know what this force is, then you 
            can come back and I will give you your initiation.'  At this I threw myself on my knees before Him,
            embraced his feet and begged him desperately, 'No, no, don't 
            send me away, don't deny me initiation! I will resist all 
            temptations of love, I will not vacillate, I beg of you, give me 
            initiation!'  Ptahhotep smiles again and strokes my hair. I feel 
            tremendous power flowing through his hand and into my head like a 
            strong current.  'Truly,' he says, 'I am not accustomed to this type 
            of behaviour. Do you think, my child, that when I tell you I won't 
            initiate you and you throw yourself on your knees before me, this 
            will make me change my mind? One of the requirements of initiation 
            is absolute self control. Child, child, you still have a long way to 
            go on the path of self control. And your self assurance is not in 
            equilibrium with your experiences. First gain the necessary 
            experience, then you can come back.'  I see that he has nothing more to say. I stand up 
            and take leave of him, 'Father of my Soul, I'll go now, but you're 
            not going to abandon me, are you? May I come back to you again some 
            other time?'  Ptahhotep answers with ineffable love: 'I know that 
            you have been alone very much ever since your early childhood and 
            you still are. It just had to be that way so you could develop your 
            self reliance. But you are never alone and you must feel that, 
            really. You arc united with us by the eternal band of the highest 
            laws of affinity and association. I am always with you even when you 
            do not know it. I knew before you did that you were coming to me 
            today with this request, and I also know what will follow. But 
            there are laws which even we must obey. You belong to us.'  I bow low before him to receive his benediction. 
            Then I go.  Waiting for me in the ante-chamber Menu asks,  'How was it? What did the Son of God tell you? 
            Please tell me everything! Right away! I just couldn't understand 
            what was keeping you so long. Please, please, tell me! Are you going 
            to be initiated?'  'The Son of God will not give it to me. He says I 
            haven't had any experience in earthly life.  'Thank God!' says Menu, beaming with joy, 'Didn't I 
            tell you it wouldn't be good for you to be initiated? I knew it!'
             'Yes, yes, Menu you know everything better, but just 
            leave me in peace now. I want to put some order in my thinking ...'
             And we walk on silently back to the palace.  All night long and all the next day I can think only 
            of Ptahhotep, the representative of God. I have known that on the 
            basis of my ancestry I belong to the Sons of God, but it was a great 
            experience to hear from him that he is the guardian of my soul. 
            He is the visible representative of God here on earth, and I 
            know I could speak as openly to him about my most secret 
            thoughts as in my own innermost prayers to God. His eyes saw right 
            through me, his glance illumined the hiddenmost corners of my soul, 
            and that made me happy. It is so wonderful to know that I belong to 
            a living being who understands me without words and who can never be 
            angry with me because he sees everything from above, just as God 
            Himself does.  I don't need to explain to him what I mean, or why I 
            want to do something or achieve something, as I am accustomed to 
            have to do with my tutors. Ptahhotep sees the most secret motives 
            behind my thoughts and my deeds, even those I am not conscious of 
            myself. I don't even need to say a word to him; it is enough when I 
            merely stand before him. He sees me! His spirit is open for 
            me, and I feel I am in constant contact with him. I even felt it 
            before I met him. I felt a force as strong as steel was guiding me, 
            and now I know this force was—and is—his radiation. I know that he 
            even sees me when I am not with him. Even now I feel his eyes upon 
            me; whatever I do or think is not hidden before him. And in this 
            case he can also see that I cannot take no for an answer on the 
            question of my being initiated. No! I can't see why I should first 
            have to have experiences in love behind me. I'll never fall in love. 
            Men only interest me to the extent that I expect them to notice and 
            admire my beauty. Since they all do that, it's quite enough for me; 
            for vanity is only at work in me when I am in the company of others. 
            When I am alone, there is only one wish that fills my whole soul— 
            initiation. I cannot and will not wait until I have had the 
            experience of falling in love, because I never will.  And so that evening, accompanied by a very worried 
            Menu, I go again to Ptahhotep to ask him once more for my 
            initiation.  Once again Menu waits in the ante-chamber, while the 
            neophyte takes me to the garden where Ptahhotep is sitting under the 
            palm trees. I bow before him. He returns my greeting, looks at me 
            with his shining eyes—I feel he's looking into me—and waits. 
            I stand and say nothing. Why should I speak when he knows anyway 
            what I want. He reads my thoughts.  He lets me stand.  Finally he gets up, lays his hands on my shoulders 
            and asks, 'Why have you come?'  'Father of my Soul,' I reply, 'why do you ask when 
            you already know anyway? I am unhappy because you refuse to initiate 
            me. I have no other wishes, no other thoughts—only initiation. 
            Please give me initiation.'  Ptahhotep strokes my hair lovingly and says quite 
            earnestly, almost sadly, 'I gave you your answer yesterday, just be 
            calm and have patience! Remember what I told you yesterday about 
            creative power, and live your life as other young people do. Occupy 
            yourself with your flowers and with your animals, go and play with 
            other young people, enjoy yourself and for the time being don't 
            think about initiation.'  'Father,' I reply in agitation, 'I can think only 
            about initiation. Whatever I do guides my thoughts directly back to 
            initiation. When I look at my flowers, or when I watch my turtles 
            crawling back and forth and living their life as wisely as if they 
            had an intellect, I run into secrets and mysteries to which I would 
            like to know the answers. I would like to know everything, 
            understand everything, I'd like to be initiated!'  'If the turtles had an intellect,' says Ptahhotep 
            smiling, 'they wouldn't lead such a wise life. And now you don't 
            want to be wise because you have an intellect, but because you have 
            too much intellect. But now just try with your excellent intellect 
            to understand that you're still too young to be initiated. 
            Come back again when you have your earthly experiences behind you. 
            Then I will give you your initiation.'  Oh my! It's not so easy to deal with Ptahhotep as 
            with my dear old Menu. Ptahhotep is hard, and all my strength 
            bounces off him like arrows off a stone wall. Again I bow low before 
            him and go. But outside I answer Menu's questions in a spirit of 
            rage and desperation, rage because Ptahhotep thinks I am too young, 
            and desperation because I stand powerless in the face of time rising 
            up before me like an impenetrable wall, as invincible as Ptahhotep 
            himself.  All that night I can't sleep again, and all the next 
            day I pace back and forth in my room, as restless and unhappy as the 
            trained lions in the lion's court. Through being born into my body, 
            my consciousness has been dulled and deadened; I feel as if I were 
            in perpetual darkness. I want to see clearly even though I am 
            imprisoned in the body. I want to know. I want to be initiated! Why 
            should I wait? If love is a matter of indifference to me now, it 
            will still be when I am initiated and omniscient. I already know 
            that physical love is only a necessity of nature to carry on the 
            race. Why should it be dangerous for me not to know this from 
            experience? I have my intellect and my consciousness and they will 
            protect me from this danger. I won't fall into nature's trap, the 
            trap of love. I'll be able to resist this temptation all right ...
             In this manner I brood all day long. By the time 
            evening comes again, I just can't stand it any longer. I take my 
            veil and go again with Menu through the long colonnade to the 
            temple, to Ptahhotep. I want to tell him that I'm not afraid of this 
            temptation, that I'll be strong enough, that he can initiate me.  Oh how blind I was! How foolish! As if Ptahhotep had 
            not seen the future clearly. As if he had not known how everything 
            was going to turn out. But even he must obey the divine law 
            and watch patiently, as I run headlong into my undoing ... watch 
            patiently as I plunge head over heels into an abyss, only to have to 
            climb out later by my own strength.  He receives me again in his little reception 
            room. I enter, bow, and tell him with all the determination I can 
            muster, 'Father of my Soul, I wanted to obey you, but I cannot. I 
            long so much for knowledge that I've come back again. I cannot see 
            why I should wait when I'm absolutely sure I have enough strength to 
            withstand the temptations of physical love. I am strong enough. I 
            have self control. Please give me the initiation.'  At this Ptahhotep closes his shining eyes and 
            remains motionless a long time. I wait with inward impatience, but 
            outwardly without moving a muscle in order not to disturb him.
            Finally, Ptahhotep opens his eyes. He stands up, comes over to 
            me, takes up my hands in his, and says, 'Three times you have asked 
            to be initiated. Three times, despite my refusal. It is a law that 
            when a member of the tribe of the Sons of God asks three times to be 
            initiated, we cannot refuse him any longer. It is a sign that 
            initiation is necessary for him, regardless of the danger he may 
            risk as a result of it. I will speak to your physical father. We 
            will need to discuss how you can carry on your duties during the 
            time of initiation. Other neophytes normally live in the temple 
            during this time, but with you we will have to make an exception 
            because you have to fulfil the duties of the wife of the Pharaoh. 
            Now go in peace.'  I feel like throwing myself about his neck to thank 
            him for giving me his permission to be initiated, but I prefer to 
            show him I can control myself. I stand motionless, and my eyes 
            express my joy. Ptahhotep smiles at me and says, 'What you've done 
            in thought, you've already done, don't ever forget it!'  'Oh, Father, if you already regard me as having done 
            it, then I will really!' And with that I throw myself into his arms 
            and kiss his noble face, right and left. 'I thank you, I thank you! 
            How wonderful! I'm going to be initiated! Initiated!'  'Yes I can see you have tremendous self control,' 
            says Ptahhotep.  'Only now, Father,' I answer with a joyous laugh, 
            'only now! After all, you're not only the high priest, but my own 
            blood uncle. So I can kiss you, can't I? But when I'm initiated, you 
            will see how serious I am and how much self control I have!'  'Yes, I know,' says Ptahhotep, embracing me 
            lovingly. Then he strokes my head again and leads me to the door. We 
            take leave of each other.  Dancing and skipping—practically walking on air—I go 
            back to the palace with Menu. I am infinitely happy. But Menu, from 
            the moment she hears that I am to be initiated in the temple, cries 
            and wrings her hands continually as if I were dying. Her 
            lamentations spoil the fun for me, and I feel as if surrounded by 
            invisible shadows. Finally, at bedtime, when she starts again to 
            talk about her gloomy forebodings, my patience is at an end. 'Look, 
            Menu,' I tell her, 'you know they wanted to take you away from me 
            after my sixteenth birthday when I was presented to the country as 
            the Pharaoh's wife; you know that according to the rules I should be 
            surrounded by ladies of the court. It took me a hard fight to get 
            the Pharaoh to agree to your staying on with me and to my being 
            accompanied by ladies of the court only on high state occasions, the 
            way things have been in the past. But if you act this way, I surely 
            will have you sent away and take on the ladies of the court. To be 
            sure, most of them are terribly boring, but at least they don't 
            interfere in my private affairs.'  Menu, poor old fat Menu! She is so frightened at my 
            words that she stops crying immediately, sits down on the floor 
            beside my bed and looks at me silently but with so much love, so 
            much care and solicitude that I can't help bursting out laughing. 
            Throwing my arms about her, I tell her, 'Just calm down, Menu, I'm 
            not going to send you away. Never. I love you. You're the only 
            person who really and truly loves me with all your heart. I'll 
            always want you with me. Just calm your fears. The initiation will 
            not harm me, only help me! Ptahhotep will take care of me. He will 
            be with me always!'  Then in leaving Menu says, 'I hope the initiation 
            really won't harm you, but I am always afraid when I see the big 
            flashes of lightning and hear the thunder coming out of the 
            pyramids. I hope you won't have anything to do with that.'  'No, no, Menu, now be a good girl and go to bed,' I 
            tell her, and Menu leaves.  But for a little while I ponder over her parting 
            remark. Lightning and thunder coming out of the pyramid? Yes, it's 
            true! Ever since I was a little girl, I have known that lightning 
            and thunder have struck out of the pyramid occasionally and after 
            that it would rain. It was always as much a matter of course as life 
            itself, and I never gave it a second thought. But now when I am 
            initiated in the temple, I will probably learn the secret behind 
            this phenomenon too.  Then with a great and wonderful feeling of 
            expectation, I fall asleep.  24
           
            SONS OF GOD The next day the Pharaoh summons me. I am to see him 
            after his audience.  At the appointed hour the controller of the royal 
            household comes and escorts me to father.  'Come, my child,' says he, 'I want to tell you what 
            Ptahhotep and I have agreed upon about your initiation.'  'Did he come to see you?'  'No,' says father and looks at me quizzically.  'Did you go to see him?' I ask again.  'No again,' he answers and smiles.  'Father,' I tell him, 'for a long time I've wanted 
            to ask you how you discuss things with Ptahhotep without going to 
            see him or his coming to see you. I've often noticed that you've 
            told me something about Ptahhotep as if the two of you had been 
            together in a long consultation. And yet you had not left the palace 
            and he had not come to see you. How was it possible, Father?'  Ever since my childhood father has been accustomed 
            to my questions, and he now answers me as patiently as ever:  'You have a mirror, and you have seen your head in 
            this mirror, haven't you?'  'Yes, Father, I see my head every day when Menu does 
            my hair.'  'And what have you noticed?' asks father.  'That I have a much longer head than the sons of men 
            in general. But you too, and Ptahhotep and most of the people in our 
            race—the Sons of God, as people call us—have the same longer head 
            form. It's noticeable even in spite of the kerchief or head-gear or 
            ornaments the person might be wearing. How is it, Father? Why is the 
            shape of our heads different from that of the heads of the sons of 
            men?'  'Look, my child, for you to understand many of the 
            things here on earth, you must first know something about the 
            earth's development.  'Just like all the celestial bodies in the universe 
            and like all the forms of life on these celestial bodies, our earth 
            is subject to the laws of constant change. The divinely creative 
            forces radiate from the eternal infinite original source and in 
            constantly expanding waves they penetrate the plane of matter. That 
            is to say, matter is formed from these forces. This process reaches 
            its highest point in ultra-matter, then automatically reverses 
            itself. The process of spiritualization begins again and the matter 
            is transformed into force. But this process takes aeons of time! The 
            changes are going on regularly but so subtly and slowly that they 
            cannot be noticed or observed in the course of a human life. On the 
            other hand, some changes, which require thousands of years of slow 
            and unnoticed preparation, occur suddenly and visibly when the 
            proper time has come. Right now we are living in such a period of 
            transition in which changes are noticeable. One of these phenomena 
            is evident in the fact that various races of people with roundish 
            skulls are led and governed by rulers who are spiritually greatly 
            superior to them and who are even different from them physically. 
            They have a more graceful figure and an elongated cranium.  'Once there lived on earth a race of people very 
            different from the races living today. They manifested completely 
            the law of spirit and not the law of matter like the races of people 
            living today. These people were conscious on the divine plane 
            and manifested God here on earth without any admixture of the 
            self-seeking characteristics of the body. In their divine purity, 
            these people deserved the name "the Sons of God".  'Their entire life was based on spirituality, love, 
            and selflessness. And they had no physical appetites, urges and 
            passions to cast shadows on the spirit. The members of this high 
            race possessed all the secrets of nature, and as they were perfectly 
            acquainted with their own powers and kept these powers completely 
            under the control of the spirit, they were also able to control and 
            guide nature with all of its tremendous forces. Their knowledge was 
            boundless. They did not need to earn their bread with physical toil 
            and instead of earning their livelihoods with the sweat of their 
            brow, they put the forces of nature to work.  'They knew all the laws of nature, the mysteries of 
            matter, the powers of the mind, and the secrets of their own being. 
            They also knew the secret connected with the transformation of 
            force into matter and of matter into force. They constructed 
            devices and tools with which they could store up, set in motion, and 
            utilize not only the forces of nature but also their own spiritual 
            forces. They lived happily and peaceably as the dominant race in a 
            great part of the earth.  'At the same time, however, other creatures similar 
            to the Sons of God were also living on earth, but with much more 
            material bodies and on a much lower plane of development. Obtuse in 
            spirit, their consciousness was completely identified with the body. 
            They lived in primeval jungles, struggling with nature, each other, 
            and animals. These creatures were the ancestors of present-day man.
            The race of the sons of men you see in our country represent a 
            cross between these two races.  'As I said a moment ago, the law of constant motion 
            and change is at work throughout the universe. The earth is now 
            going through a period in which the process of materialization is 
            advancing. This means that the divinely creative power is moving 
            farther and farther on into matter, and the power on earth is 
            gradually falling more and more into the hands of ever more material 
            races of people who were once under the guidance of higher, more 
            spiritual races. Little by little the higher race is dying out. They 
            are withdrawing from the plane of matter to the spiritual plane and 
            they will leave humanity alone for a period of time—as time is 
            reckoned on earth, many, many thousands of years—so that humanity 
            may, without visible guidance, climb upward with its own power.  'And so it has come about that this animal-like 
            material race of cave men is experimenting in accordance with divine 
            laws, growing mightier and more powerful until the time comes for it 
            to begin ruling the earth. Before leaving the earth, however, the 
            higher race had to implant its special powers in the lower race. 
            Through the operation of the laws of heredity, this will enable the 
            lower race—after a long, long process of development—to arise out 
            of matter again. This is why many sons of the divine race made 
            the great sacrifice of begetting children with the daughters of 
            primitive man. Through this first crossing of the races there have 
            developed new individual types and, gradually, new races of people.
             'The divine power of the Sons of God and the mighty 
            physical powers of the daughters of men have produced different 
            types of descendants. On the one hand, physical, and on the other, 
            spiritual giants. There have also been physical titans who, from 
            their mother's ancestry, have inherited primitive, undeveloped 
            brains. In these persons, the spiritual power of their fathers, 
            working on the material plane, created tremendously strong bodies. 
            With their gigantic physical strength, these individuals have 
            overcome weaker persons and, because of the animal appetites of 
            their nature, they have become tyrants greatly to be feared.  'But there have also been spiritual titans who have 
            manifested their inherited creative power through the higher centres 
            of the brain, rather than on the lower physical plane. These 
            spiritual giants were assigned the task of leading and teaching for 
            a time, the lower, animal-like, body-conscious race of humans, as 
            well as the hybrid race which later rose through the inter-breeding 
            I have already mentioned. These spiritual giants have the task of 
            teaching the people of these two races wisdom, sciences and arts as 
            the basis of a higher civilization, and of giving them a good 
            example of divinely universal love, unselfishness and spiritual 
            greatness. That is why there are some countries today where 
            despotism and tyranny are dominant while others are ruled with love 
            and wisdom. This will gradually disappear and humanity will know the 
            great initiates and their secret sciences only through historical 
            records, tradition and legend. However, even in the darkest period 
            of human development, by virtue of the laws of heredity, there will 
            be the possibility that a son of God may be born in a human body in 
            order to show humanity the way out of darkness and misery.'  'Father,' I ask, 'is our country the country of the 
            Sons of God?'  'No, my child. The continent which once was the home 
            of the Sons of God has been completely destroyed. Gradually there 
            were fewer and fewer descendants of the divine race. They left their 
            mortal frames behind them and did not reincarnate themselves. 
            Finally there were only a few left in various parts of the earth to 
            transmit dominion to the human beings who were constantly growing in 
            power. Because of the inter-breeding of the two races, however, 
            there arose some individuals with a knowledge of magic acquired from 
            their fathers and the animal-like, physically oriented selfishness 
            of their mothers. These were able to infiltrate into the temple, and 
            by virtue of their spiritual powers, they received initiation. 
            However, they degraded their knowledge to black magic and made 
            selfish use of their own powers and the natural forces they 
            controlled with the instruments and equipment of the temple.  'The Sons of God who were then still living in this 
            part of the earth saw what was coming. They knew that these powers 
            mercilessly destroy anyone who uses them wrongly, that is, with 
            satanic selfishness instead of with divine unselfishness. They knew 
            the black magicians were headed straight for perdition and their 
            blind avarice would cause general destruction. So the last Sons of 
            God built huge ships, closed on all sides and even insulated against 
            the forces which penetrate and dissolve matter. Then they secretly 
            took aboard a few of their instruments, their families and their 
            domestic animals; and closing all openings, they sailed away from 
            the part of the earth that was to be destroyed. Some sailed north, 
            some east, some south, while some, sailing westward, arrived here 
            where we are now.  'The black magicians soon lost control over their 
            instruments. It should have been their task to conduct the highest 
            cosmic divine forces into these instruments and store them there, 
            because the only source of this power on earth is the human being 
            himself. But the more selfish these people became, the more a 
            change took place in the current with which they charged these 
            instruments for later use. One day, when the Sons of God in their 
            insulated ships had already sailed away to a sufficient distance, 
            the tragedy occurred. One of the black magicians unintentionally 
            conducted into his own body a force which dissolves matter, that is, 
            changes it into another form of energy. When this process has once 
            been set in motion, the matter which has been transformed into 
            energy goes on and on, acting as a destructive force, until it has 
            dematerialized everything. In this way the whole continent was 
            destroyed. Finally the new forces thus created slowed down and 
            eventually halted the process of disintegration.  'The entire dematerialized continent was transformed 
            into energy of radiation, at first rising up to the upper reaches of 
            the earth's atmosphere, then returning transformed into the 
            primordial form of all matter. After further transformation 
            processes, the whole gigantic mass fell to earth again in what 
            appeared to be an unending downpour of water, mud and sand.  'The waters of the oceans rolled over the gigantic 
            cleavage in the body of the earth. The land masses of the other 
            hemisphere, split asunder by the cataclysmic shake-up, moved farther 
            and farther apart in order to restore equilibrium throughout the 
            earth, until they finally occupied their present positions. Part of 
            the destroyed continent now lies in our country as a mighty desert 
            of sand, and there is a danger that winds may carry abroad these 
            mountains of sand and cover up fertile, inhabited areas.  'The Sons of God in their ships had special 
            instruments and equipment to stabilize their vessels and keep them 
            horizontal at all times. Thus they survived the catastrophes and 
            finally landed. In every part of the earth where they set foot they 
            began a new civilization.  'With their knowledge, wisdom and love they won the 
            hearts of the natives. They became rulers. They were worshipped, 
            revered as Gods or demi-Gods. Their first acts were to construct 
            suitable buildings for their secret instruments in order to insulate 
            them completely from the world outside and provide adequate 
            protection against the powerful, penetrating energy stored up in 
            their instruments. These buildings, which we call pyramids, can now 
            be seen in all the various parts of the earth where the Sons of God 
            fled with the instruments they salvaged.'  Profoundly impressed, I listened to the story of 
            these tremendous events. It cleared up many things I had not 
            understood before—but not everything. 'How did the Sons of God bring 
            these mighty blocks of stone and set them in place, one upon the 
            other?' I asked.  'Do you remember, my child,' the Pharaoh replied, 
            'that I told you the Sons of God did not need to work with physical 
            force because they caused the forces of nature to work for them? We 
            still possess some of these instruments with which we can control 
            the gravitational force of the earth at will, neutralizing it or 
            amplifying it, depending on the result we wish to achieve. In 
            this way we can make an object weightless or, inversely, even 
            heavier than it normally is. When a huge block of stone has been 
            made weightless in this way, even a child could push it about with 
            its little finger or raise it to any desired height. Ships were 
            piled high with these gigantic blocks of stone without being 
            overloaded, because the blocks had been subjected in advance to the 
            proper form of radiation and so made weightless. All the gigantic 
            edifices, here and in other parts of the world, which human power 
            would never have been able to build were erected by the Sons of God 
            in this way.  'Wherever the Sons of God disembarked from their 
            ships, they created a high civilization. Wherever they are still 
            ruling, they are leading the people in unselfish love and making a 
            sacrifice for their benefit ... the sacrifice of remaining here on 
            earth for a time in order to teach them and propagate spiritual 
            powers. There was once a time when the ruler, the Pharaoh, was 
            simultaneously the high priest. In one and the same person, he was 
            the earthly and spiritual leader of the people. Later, however, as 
            the country grew greater through culture and wealth, the Sons of God 
            divided up the tasks, and ever since then one of them has fulfilled 
            the duties of worldly government, while the eldest, the leader of 
            the race, has been the spiritual leader of the people. The Pharaoh 
            rules the country. The high priest fulfils his duties in the temple. 
            He is the guardian of knowledge in every field. Since all knowledge 
            comes from a single source, it is he who gives the initiation into 
            the sciences, into the arts, and also the great initiation in the 
            temple into the "artless art" of the spirit.  'Now you know why the people we are ruling and 
            teaching have differently shaped heads from those of the descendants 
            of the Sons of God who are now the reigning family. Those of us who 
            have this elongated skull make relatively little use of our 
            intellects because we are able to experience truth directly with 
            our inner sight. Our forehead is not heavily arched, because in 
            our heads the brain centres having to do with the power of thinking 
            are only developed to the point necessary for us to perceive and 
            consciously experience external impressions. On the contrary, in the 
            rear part of our cranium we possess fully developed brain centres, 
            the physical instruments of spiritual revelation. These brain 
            centres enable us to be conscious on the divine plane and give us 
            those superior qualities and characteristics which distinguish us 
            from the sons of men. Human beings, in their consciousness, live 
            in time and space. We, although we too inhabit earthly bodies, 
            enjoy the perfect spiritual freedom, in freedom from time and 
            space. Through the power of the divine consciousness and with 
            the help of these brain centres, we are able to move freely in time 
            and space.  'This means that we are able to shift our 
            consciousness into the past or into the future at will. In other 
            words, we are able to experience the past and the future as 
            present. And with the same ease we can free ourselves from the 
            hindrance of space and move our consciousness to any place we wish. 
            In this condition there is no "here" and no "there", 
            but only omnipresence. For past and future—here and there—are 
            only different aspects, different projections of the one and only 
            reality, the eternal omnipresent Being: GOD.  'The blood of both races is flowing in your veins. 
            You inherited characteristics of our race, but also of the hybrid 
            race from your mother's side. In you the higher organs are beginning 
            to function, unfortunately much too early for you to have had time 
            for earthly experiences or for you to have conquered your partially 
            earthly nature. You are unsatisfied because you feel imprisoned in 
            time and space, caught between "here" and "there". The spirit within 
            you is beginning to awaken and long for its divine freedom. You have 
            asked three times to be initiated and you will be. Then you will 
            learn to make conscious use of all the higher organs which are not 
            yet fully active within yourself. You will also acquire the ability 
            to establish contact at any time with similar beings in order to be 
            able to exchange thoughts with them.  'I am thus able to establish spiritual contact at 
            any time with my brother Ptahhotep or with any of the other 
            descendants of the race of the Sons of God still living on earth. 
            Through a complete union of our consciousnesses, we are able to 
            exchange our thoughts on any given subject much better than if we 
            were talking together on the earthly plane with the help of larynx, 
            tongue and ears. With our consciousness we can seek each other out 
            at any time, but we feel immediately if the other is occupied and 
            concentrating on something else. In such a case we disturb each 
            other only if we have something very important to communicate, 
            otherwise we withdraw. But you can easily understand why only 
            persons who have achieved perfect unselfishness can have such 
            abilities. If self-centred sons of men also had them, they would 
            create such chaos that all the finer, higher organs would be ruined 
            in the general confusion.  'For the most part we "meet" through uniting our 
            consciousnesses in this way in the evening after our daily duties 
            are done, and in this union we see each other's thoughts. 
            Thus in a matter of moments we are able to agree on things which 
            would take long discussion in the three dimensional world.  'After we have thought over our worldly tasks, we 
            shift over with our consciousness into the dimensionless state of 
            all-consciousness, in order to draw new vital energy from the 
            eternal, divine, original source. In this condition we are one with 
            all living creatures, with the entire universe, identical 
            with it in the divine, primordial union, one with life 
            itself, with the eternal being, hence with the essence of 
            every manifestation—with you too and with all other people. Only 
            these beings who with their consciousness are still living in three 
            dimensions are not aware of this union. On the other hand, every 
            creature awakens from sleep with renewed vital energy, whether or 
            not it knows that this energy comes from the divine original source.
             'And so you are going to be initiated. This means 
            you are starting on a long, long journey. You will have to travel 
            this path on earth even after Ptahhotep and I have left the 
            three-dimensional world and only remain in spirit in the sphere of 
            the earth. I have different tasks from Ptahhotep. Your spiritual and 
            intellectual guidance is in his hands. In the eternal union, 
            however, we will always be together. It would have been better if 
            you had had more patience. But you are as you are, and the way 
            you are will also determine your fate and your future. We cannot 
            interfere. The power which comes from union will always accompany 
            you and help you through the most difficult times.  'Since you have the duty of representing the wife of 
            the Pharaoh beside me, you will not be able to dwell in the temple 
            as other neophytes do during the period of preparation for 
            initiation. You will go there every morning for instruction. During 
            the day, you will do your exercises there with the other neophytes 
            and when evening comes you will return to the palace. At palace 
            ceremonies you will come in time to fulfil your duties at my side. 
            So you can report to Ptahhotep tomorrow morning.'  But I still have a question and so remain standing.
             Father looks at me quizzically. 'Father,' I ask, 
            'you have told me that the Sons of God, in order to propagate their 
            spiritual powers, took wives from among the daughters of men. Didn't 
            the daughters of the Sons of God also take husbands from among the 
            sons of men? Why have only the Sons of God begotten children with 
            the daughters of men?—And not the daughters of God too with the sons 
            of men?'  Father looks deep into my eyes and says, 'Engrave 
            this answer of mine upon the tablets of your memory. If you 
            understand this truth really well, we may perhaps be able to set the 
            rudder of your fate on a different course: If you pour out a drop 
            from a glass of red wine into a glass of white wine, the red wine in 
            the glass remains pure red wine as it was before. The white wine, is 
            no longer pure white wine, but a mixture of both. And if you then 
            pour out some of the white wine, what you pour out is actually a 
            mixture of red and white wine. Do you understand, my child?'  'Yes, Father, I understand. You mean that the blood 
            of a pure bred Son of God still remains pure if he begets children 
            with a daughter of the sons of men. But the blood of a pure bred 
            daughter of God would become mixed blood if she were to marry one of 
            the sons of men. From then on she would be mixed and so would her 
            children.'  'Remember this truth every moment of your life,' 
            says father. Then he arises, I bow before him, and he blesses me. 
            Preserving the unity of the soul in my heart, I leave the room.  25
           
            YEARS OF PREPARATION Accompanied by Menu, I go to the temple.  How often will I be going through this long 
            colonnade between palace and temple? How often and for how many 
            years!—until I myself have become the path, so that with my eyes 
            closed my feet would carry me to the temple.  Today I enter the temple for the first time as a 
            neophyte. Just because I would like to hurry, I hold myself in check 
            and walk with ceremonial slowness. I am determined to enjoy to the 
            very last drop the pleasure of beginning my initiation. I am 
            withdrawn within myself, deep in thought. Fully conscious of all the 
            things my father told me yesterday, I go forward to my future duties 
            as an initiate.  At the entrance the same neophyte as before is 
            awaiting me. Menu takes her leave. At first she embraces me, kisses 
            me and holds me tight as if we were never to see each other again. 
            Then she calms herself and bows before me in the way she believes 
            she should. I embrace her and feel that my mother is also kissing me 
            through Menu's lips.  The neophyte accompanies me to Ptahhotep who is 
            waiting in his little reception room. How often—how often—will I be 
            standing thus before him! How often will his eyes rest upon 
            me, or pierce me through and through with their peace, assurance and 
            strength!  'My dear child,' he begins, 'initiation, as I have 
            already explained to you, means to become conscious on the highest 
            level, the divine plane. To be able to do this requires long 
            physical training and spiritual preparation. One first must 
            strengthen the nerves to enable them to bear these high vibrations 
            without harm, without death.  'To become conscious on a given plane means to 
            conduct the vibrations characteristic of this plane into the nerves 
            and through the nerves into the body. From the time a body is born, 
            that is, from the time a "self" dwells in it, the body develops a 
            power of resistance corresponding to the average degree of 
            consciousness of the spirit dwelling in it.  'The degree of consciousness of a living creature 
            fluctuates up and down, depending on its emotional condition, within 
            the limits of an octave of vibrations. These fluctuations, however, 
            must not exceed the limits of elasticity of the nerves; for if they 
            do, injuries and sicknesses of a more or less serious nature occur, 
            even death. The vibration belonging to creative vital energy is 
            absolutely lethal for creatures whose consciousness has not yet 
            reached this level. It would burn out the nerves and nervous 
            centres. For this reason, vital energy from the spinal column, where 
            it has its seat, is transformed into a low vibration corresponding 
            to the degree of consciousness of the person concerned and only this 
            transformed vital current is conducted into the body.  'Thus animals, for example, are animated by a much 
            lower life vibration than primitive man; and primitive man with his 
            beast-like selfish nature, is animated by lower vibrations of vital 
            energy than a person who is spiritually developed. If one were to 
            conduct the vital energy of a highly developed human being into an 
            animal or a much less developed human, the animal or "lower-level" 
            human would die instantly because of the contact with the more 
            powerful vibrations.  'The great initiation means consciously 
            experiencing the vital energy and creative vibrations of eternal
            being, experiencing these vibrations on every plane of 
            development and in their original frequency, without transformation, 
            and simultaneously conducting these vibrations into the nerves and 
            the body. This naturally requires a corresponding amount of 
            resistance which can be obtained through physical and spiritual 
            training. That means that one must slowly and cautiously prepare and 
            awaken the appropriate nerve centres and learn to control them. 
            Initially you will receive this physical and spiritual training from 
            Mentuptah, the leader of the school of neophytes. In your 
            concentration exercises, Ima'—and Ptahhotep points to the neophyte 
            who brought me here—'will help you. When you have passed your 
            preparatory tests given you by Mentuptah and Ima, you will receive 
            further training and your initiation under my guidance. Now Ima will 
            take you to the neophyte school and give you everything you need for 
            the beginning. If you want to speak to me during your training, you 
            can arrange to see me any evening. May God guide your further 
            steps.'  After Ptahhotep's benediction, I bow and follow Ima 
            to the school of neophytes.  Ima takes me to a little cell, one of many built in 
            the temple wall. He gives me a plain white linen robe and a pair of 
            plain sandals, saying that this cell belongs to me.  When I come out—having exchanged my silken robe and 
            golden sandals for the simple clothing—I am a neophyte exactly like 
            Ima. He leads me on through a long colonnade, and through the great 
            door we step out into the temple garden. The garden is magnificent: 
            a large rectangular plot of green grass bordered by palms makes an 
            excellent place for exercise. As we go on, I see the neophytes at 
            work behind the park-like part of the garden, near the vegetable 
            plots and the orchards. All the neophytes wear the same kind of 
            clothing as mine, but none of them is as young as I.  Ima takes me to Mentuptah, the head of the school of 
            neophytes. He is a friendly person with soft, loving eyes. He 
            explains my daily duties to me. The neophytes are divided up in 
            groups. All groups are under Mentuptah's guidance, but each 
            individual group also works under the leadership of an advanced 
            neophyte, a candidate for priesthood. Ima leads the group to which I 
            am assigned. He is a tall, slender but very powerful young man. I 
            noticed his crystal-pure radiance when he first took me to 
            Ptahhotep. He has passed most of his preparatory tests and the time 
            is close at hand for him to be initiated. Ima is a candidate for the 
            priesthood. In his appearance he doesn't give the impression of a 
            man so much as of an androgynous being standing above and beyond 
            sex. As much above and beyond it as an archangel. He radiates all 
            the keenness of a sharp sword. His angelically beautiful face bears 
            the signs of supreme intelligence and powers of concentration. Above 
            his eyebrows there are two well developed mounds, the signs of 
            wisdom. His mouth is well formed, beautiful, full of energy, but 
            with soft corners, delicately chiselled, revealing his tender love 
            for every living creature. I love him from the very first moment, 
            feeling complete confidence in him as I would in a dearly beloved 
            brother. I am happy that he is the one who is to prepare me for my 
            tests!  Ima introduces me to the other neophytes. They have 
            all chosen the priesthood as their calling in life, but only those 
            who pass all their tests and receive initiation will become priests 
            or priestesses. There are many who never make it. Nevertheless, if 
            they wish to do so, they can spend the rest of their lives in the 
            service of the temple, working in the garden and tending the 
            animals. The neophytes who pass their preparatory examinations 
            receive ever new and progressively more difficult tasks and 
            assignments parallel with their degree of advancement.  The group under Ima's guidance is one made up 
            entirely of spiritually well-developed neophytes. On their father's 
            side, most of them are descended from the Sons of God, just as I am, 
            and they can be recognized even from a distance by the elongated 
            shape of their heads. I am assigned to this group and feel good in 
            their pure atmosphere.  Every morning at sunrise we have to assemble in the 
            garden. We begin with physical exercises. The exercises involve 
            strong concentration. We assume various body postures and, while 
            doing breathing exercises, must guide our consciousness into 
            different parts of the body. Through long and patient practice in 
            this way we can make the entire body completely conscious, move at 
            will, control and guide the smallest parts of the body and all 
            internal organs. Patiently and persistently we thus develop the body 
            into an excellent instrument.  When we have finished these exercises, we go into 
            the great room of the temple for training of mind and soul. In these 
            exercises, Mentuptah dictates to us various inter-related dream 
            pictures which we must experience as intensively as if they were 
            real. With these dream pictures we intentionally produce different 
            emotional states within ourselves and learn how to control them. 
            With these exercises Mentuptah takes us through all the different 
            spheres of the underworld and overworld, through the seven Hells and 
            the seven Heavens, teaching us to keep our presence of mind no 
            matter what may happen so that even in the most difficult situations 
            we can instantly decide what to do.  As soon as we have completely mastered this kind of 
            exercise, we go a step further. We have to experience different 
            emotional states on command, without dream pictures, but with 
            the same intensity as if we really had a reason. We begin 
            these exercises at the lowest negative condition, moving up step by 
            step until we reach the highest positive condition. To take an 
            example, we begin by experiencing the deepest state of dejection, 
            moving up gradually through indifference, then on higher and higher, 
            through joy and on up to the highest state of happiness.  When after long practice we get proficient at this 
            exercise, we are obliged to practise faster changeovers from one 
            emotional state to another until we can experience them all, one 
            after the other, as easily and positively as a musician draws forth 
            a whole gamut of tone from his instrument, from the lowest to the 
            highest. When we achieve proficiency at running quickly through the 
            whole scale of human emotions—from darkest desperation to the 
            highest bliss—we take the next step. This consists of experiencing 
            opposite emotional states, one after the other, with no time lost 
            for transition, shifting from deep sadness immediately to the 
            highest hilarity. Or, to take another example, from fear immediately 
            to self-assured courage.  We are only permitted to do these exercises under 
            the direction of our teacher. They represent a great strain for our 
            nerves. It takes us a long time to reach the point of being able, 
            with the aid of the dream pictures, to experience the emotional 
            states as vividly as if they were external events in our lives. It 
            takes us still longer to be able to experience the full scale of 
            emotional states from the lowest to the highest. Only when we can 
            bring our nerves to complete rest after these exercises, keeping 
            them in a well-rested condition throughout the day, are we permitted 
            to practise the most difficult exercises of experiencing 
            diametrically opposite emotions without a time of transition. The 
            aim of these exercises is to make us independent of both external 
            events and our own personal moods, thus enabling us to determine our 
            own moods ourselves and maintain our emotional equilibrium no matter 
            what happens. We are taught constant inner watchfulness and presence 
            of mind.  People believe that there always has to be a reason 
            for their being joyous or happy. Through the exercises with the 
            dream pictures we first imagine we have a reason for being in one 
            mood or another. Thus we learn to control the reasons themselves! 
            As we do not actually have a reason, however, we have to imagine 
            one ourselves.  Then comes the next step of experiencing an 
            emotional state by itself, without a reason, without having 
            previously imagined a situation such as would call forth the mood to 
            be experienced.  After long practice, when we have become quite 
            skilful at these exercises, we discover we have always imagined 
            we had a reason for being 'sad' or 'joyous', 'depressed' or 
            'exuberant' etc. Through these exercises we thus become convinced 
            that events and occurrences in our lives must not have any effect 
            on us. We discover that every state of consciousness arises—and can 
            only arise—within ourselves. One and the same event can provoke 
            one person to laughter, another to tears, while a third remains 
            completely indifferent; all because each is merely projecting 
            outwardly his own inward attitude, and it is only this inward 
            attitude which provokes our response, not the external events 
            themselves.  As a final result, the pupil must attain the ability 
            to keep his emotional composure imperturbable and unshakeable at all 
            times, never losing it under any circumstances. These exercises also 
            teach us that whatever happens on earth is only a transitory 
            dream picture projected in time and space by ourselves. We only need 
            to take it seriously in so far as it adds to our experience. 
             But it takes a long, long time to reach this degree 
            of ability! We have to keep ourselves under the strictest 
            observation, must never forget ourselves for a moment, must always 
            be conscious and aware, always analysing every feeling, every 
            thought, to determine in what stratum of the self it has originated. 
            And all this is not something one can learn to do from one day to 
            the next!  In addition to this long spiritual training, we also 
            have to practise purely mental concentration exercises. These are 
            assigned to me by Ima. After the group exercises he takes me to a 
            quiet corner of the garden and explains what concentration means. I 
            must not allow my thoughts to roam around aimlessly. On the 
            contrary, I must command myself to concentrate only on one 
            prescribed concept. I must pull my thoughts together into a 
            single point, giving them a centripetal rather than centrifugal 
            direction. Ima gives me a sentence on which to concentrate. When I 
            have succeeded in concentrating on it, I am to go and tell him. Then 
            he leaves me alone.  The sentence is 'I always manifest divinity'.  I sit down and start to concentrate on this 
            sentence. I repeat mentally: 'I always manifest divinity,' once, 
            twice, ten times, a hundred times ... I think of nothing else: 'I 
            always manifest divinity ... I always manifest divinity ... I always 
            manifest divinity ...'  After an hour I go to Ima and tell him, 'I can't 
            concentrate on that sentence. It's impossible.'  'Impossible?' he asks, 'Why should it be 
            impossible?'  'You told me that concentration means directing all 
            forces, all thoughts to a single point, drawing and holding together 
            all the forces of the intellect and of consciousness. But when I 
            concentrate on a sentence, I cannot draw together all the 
            forces of my intellect into one single point. A sentence 
            consists of several words. These words follow each other both in 
            time and space. That means I can't simultaneously think these 
            words in a given point but only one after another in time 
            and space! And when I have thought the sentence through to the end, 
            I have to jump back again to the beginning and think it through to 
            the end again. That's why concentration in this way is impossible. 
            Either I have to jump back from the end to the beginning after each 
            sentence, like this  
             or, if I imagine a sentence in a circular form, my 
            concentration results in running around in a circle,  
             'But that is not concentration!'  Ima listens attentively. Then, quite pleased, he 
            says, 'You have practised right! You've discovered it's impossible 
            to concentrate on words. The fact that you finally imagined 
            the words to be in the form of a circle shows that you were making a 
            real effort at concentration. But no matter how close you pull the 
            words together, they still form a circle and you can never get them 
            into the centre. You have found out that no matter how much force 
            you exert on them in the direction of the centre, the words resist 
            this force so you cannot draw them into the centre. This principle 
            of resistance towards being drawn into the centre is one we use in 
            building bridges. We build an arch of stones, just as you have built 
            a circle out of words, and the bridge doesn't fall into the water 
            because the stones exert pressure on each other and the stones do 
            not yield to the pressure. Because of the power of their resistance, 
            the stones hold the whole bridge together. But if your concentration 
            aims to get to the centre, it is prevented from doing so by the 
            resistance of the words, and the concentration is impossible. The 
            same happens if you try to concentrate on one word. A word consists 
            of letters which can never be drawn together completely in a single 
            point.'  'So what must I do?'  'For your next exercise try to concentrate on a 
            single letter. Take the letter "o", for example,' says Ima, and 
            leaves me alone.  I try it. Sitting in the grass again, I concentrate 
            on the 'o' ... mentally I repeat the letter 'o', saying 'o', 'o', 
            'o', 'o', 'o' ... and still thinking of nothing but 'o', 'o', V, 'o' 
            'o' 'o' 'o' 'o' ... until all of a sudden I make a new discovery. I 
            go back to Ima and tell him laughingly, 'I've already finished'.  'Well,' he asks, 'what have you found out?'  'That the "o" I was concentrating on all of a sudden 
            turned into a pipe. A long "o"-shaped tunnel in which I was 
            constantly moving forward. But that isn't perfect concentration 
            either!'  'Good,' says Ima. 'That means you've already reached 
            the fourth dimension. Now try again with a sentence "I always 
            manifest divinity" and try again to concentrate on that. How would 
            you solve the problem now?'  'What should I do?' I ask.  'What would you do?' asks Ima in his turn.  I consider the problem for a while and then say, 
            'The words are the clothing, the material manifestation of the 
            meaning. If I want to get into the centre, I must give up the words 
            that hinder me and concentrate only on the meaning of the sentence, 
            without words, without form. Is that right?'  Ima smiles and says, 'Let's see how you succeed. Go 
            and try. Then come back.'  I go back and concentrate on the meaning of the 
            sentence 'I always manifest divinity ...' ... only on the meaning 
            ...  Then I go back to Ima. He is just finishing a 
            discussion with another neophyte. Seeing that I am waiting for him, 
            he gives me a roguish glance as if he already knew how I had got on 
            with my concentration exercise. 'Well?' he asks.  'Ima, it's so strange! As I tried to concentrate 
            only on the meaning of the sentence, I couldn't think of it any 
            more, and the whole inner process moved out of my head into my 
            breast, so that I wasn't thinking it any more, but feeling and 
            experiencing it! The moment I concentrated on the meaning of this 
            sentence, without words, I myself became this meaning! But 
            then the sentence has to read differently, not "I always manifest 
            divinity", but much more accurately, "I am divinity which is 
            always manifesting itself!" '  As I speak, Ima looks at me with a growing smile and 
            growing pleasure. 'You have concentrated very well,' he says. 'Very 
            well! You've discovered that concentration cannot be a permanent 
            condition, but only a transition between the projected world and 
            being. When you concentrate your thoughts on something, you 
            can't stop with just thinking, because concentration leads you
            back to yourself, and you become the very thing you're 
            concentrating on. From thinking you progress through 
            concentration into a state of being! Thinking ceases completely 
            and the thinker becomes identical with what he is thinking. To 
            think something means to project a thought outwardly by means of 
            the intellect, as if by means of a mirror, hence to step out of 
            oneself. Through concentration we draw the projection back 
            again, and what is thought becomes identical again with the
            thinker, with the person himself. The two factors are 
            joined in a perfect unity. That which is created goes back into 
            the creator!  'Go on practising and you will experience this 
            process with ever greater clarity. Here's a new exercise. You like 
            to sit under this palm tree. Concentrate on it.' And with that Ima 
            leaves.  I sit down again and look at the palm tree, keeping 
            my thoughts centred on this tree, nothing else ... Hours go by and 
            evening conies. I have to go home. Menu is waiting for me outside 
            and we go home together.  The next morning I am back in the temple garden, and 
            after our group exercises I take my place again under the palm tree, 
            concentrating on it.  When I began this exercise, all kinds of extraneous 
            thoughts disturbed me. I suddenly remembered what Menu had told me 
            the evening before—I noticed a bird up in the fronds—then a gnat was 
            humming about my ears—then I remembered Chancellor Roo-Kha's 
            impertinences and felt angry. But I chased away all foreign thoughts 
            as they arose in me and concentrated only on the palm tree.  Now I am getting along better. Thoughts can no 
            longer reach me and really disturb me. Previously I was still in 
            the world of thoughts—among the thoughts. My thoughts were able 
            to push me to and fro. But I did not let myself be pushed around. I 
            stayed put just where I was, with the palm tree, gliding slowly and 
            almost imperceptibly further and further into myself where thoughts 
            could no longer follow and disturb me. Now and again a thought bobs 
            up, creeping through my intellect like a tired traveller. From my 
            secure position I observe this stray, straggling, tired thought, but 
            I don't bother about it ... I think of the palm tree ... slowly the 
            palm tree fills my entire being.  Days go by, perhaps weeks too, I don't know. I don't 
            know anything more that's going on in my outer world, as I am 
            concentrating on the palm tree with all my attention. Then all of a 
            sudden I have the odd feeling that I am no longer looking at the 
            tree from the outside, but from the inside. To be sure I 
            still perceive its outward form with my eyes, but I begin, to an 
            ever-increasing extent, to see and experience the inner being,
            the animating creative principle of the palm ... to see it, 
            to experience it, TO BE IT!  And finally there comes a moment in which I am 
            suddenly conscious of the fact that the palm is no longer outside 
            myself—no!—it never was outside—it was only a false conception on my 
            part—the palm tree is in me and I in it—I my self am the palm 
            tree!  I do not know how long I have been thus absorbed 
            within myself. I don't even know what time means. 'There' in 
            the condition I am in the concept of time is unknown. Neither can I 
            explain what this 'there' is. But all at once some power draws me 
            back, slowly, into my personal consciousness, and I notice that Ima 
            is standing before me. My eyes meet his gentle glance. He sits down 
            near me in the soft grass, waits patiently till I come back to my 
            senses, then looks at me questioningly.  I make one or two attempts to speak, but I don't 
            succeed right away. Speech seems to have become completely 
            superfluous.  Finally my activity reawakens and my will functions 
            again. The nerves of my larynx set my vocal chords in motion, and I 
            can produce sounds again.  'Oh Ima,' I say earnestly, softly, and surprised at 
            the sound of my own voice, "I have become the palm tree—or 
            better, I've discovered that the palm tree was always I! Only 
            I didn't realize it!'  Ima nods his angelically beautiful head and beams 
            with joy. 'You're making wonderful progress! I'm so glad—so glad! 
            You're making faster progress than anyone has ever made in so short 
            a time. If you pass all your other preparatory tests just as fast, 
            you'll soon be ready for initiation!'  Joyously we look at each other in silence. As I look 
            into his eyes, I feel even more deeply how pure a being Ima is and 
            what tremendous strength he radiates. The air is purer wherever he 
            is.  Then he offers me his hand and we get up. It's time 
            for me to go home. After I have retired for the night and am already 
            lying on my bed, Menu kneels beside me on the floor and asks, 'What 
            are you doing now in the temple?' 'We do exercises.' 'Tell me what 
            kind of exercises?'  In all seriousness I answer, 'Well, my last exercise 
            was to think so long about a palm tree that I finally discovered I 
            myself am the palm tree!'  Menu looks at me in amazement. 'What have you 
            discovered?—What are you?' she asks. 'The palm tree,' I repeat. 
            'You, the palm tree?' she asks wide-eyed.  'Yes, yes, Menu, but leave me in peace, I want to go 
            to sleep.' Then Menu begins to laugh so hard that she rolls around 
            on the floor and tears stream down her cheeks:  'Ha ha ha, so you're a palm tree? Where is your 
            trunk, and where are your leaves? Ha ha ha, so you're not a young 
            girl any more! Ha ha ha!'  At that I sit up in bed, offended in my pride, and 
            answer with all the dignity at my command: 'Please take note I'm not 
            a young girl, but the representative of the Queen. I am the wife of 
            the Pharaoh, do you understand? And if you're going to make fun of 
            my exercises, I won't tell you anything more.'  At that Menu begins to cry. Covering my hands with 
            kisses, she says through her tears: 'Didn't I tell you it would be 
            dangerous to be initiated? Who knows but what they may really cast a 
            spell on you and turn you into a palm tree. You talk so strangely 
            now. Watch out, please watch out! It would be good if the Pharaoh 
            knew what's happening!' Drying her tears, Menu leaves my room with a 
            worried look on her face.  I remain alone with a very unpleasant feeling that I 
            should not have talked to Menu about my deepest, most sacred 
            experiences. The next day, Ptahhotep sends for me. I am to see him 
            in the evening. He sits at his accustomed place in his little 
            reception room. His glance is as deep as the sky is high. He knows 
            everything. 'Come here, my little daughter,' he says with a smile. I 
            step up to him confidently. He takes my hands in his, smiles and 
            asks, 'Do you know what your next task is to be?' 'Yes, Father, I 
            know,' I reply. 'And what is it?'  'To keep silence,' I reply, smiling back at him 
            confidently, despite my guilty feeling, because I know he does not 
            condemn me. He nods. We understand each other. I don't need to 
            apologize. He knows me better than I know myself, and he knows with 
            absolute certainty that I wasn't acting malevolently when I spoke to 
            Menu about sacred things far beyond her level of comprehension. I 
            look into Ptahhotep's eyes. He sees me with all my imperfections, 
            but he also sees my determination to learn to keep silence in the 
            future.  Then he gently strokes my hair. I bow and leave.  Oh! How often am I to stand before him and have to 
            confess that my tongue ran away from my brain ... that I had failed 
            again to be able to offer enough resistance to the basic urge for 
            communication that has been planted in every human breast.  But nevertheless in time I do learn to be on guard 
            against this power too. I learn to keep my urge for communication as 
            carefully and thoroughly under control as my favourite lion, and 
            through this constant self-observation, I gradually form the habit 
            of listening inwardly, whenever I want to say something, to be sure 
            I have authority to say it. Gradually I learn to keep my mouth shut 
            except when I really have something to say. And I come to recognize 
            two beings in my self: a personal ego which is often inclined to 
            chatter, without Control, purely for the sake of communicating 
            and attracting attention to my person —and in the background of 
            my consciousness a higher self which restrains my personal ego, 
            telling it when and what it is to speak or do, and when it is to 
            remain silent or passive. The important thing is to pay attention 
            and obey the orders of this higher self. Merely to hear its 
            commands is not enough; everybody does that!  During this period of time, Ima gives me further 
            exercises in concentration to do after the group exercises in the 
            temple are over.  We sit together in my favourite corner in the temple 
            garden and Ima explains: 'You know now from experience what 
            concentration is. But if you observe yourself during concentration, 
            you will notice that in doing it you go through three phases, 
            intellectual, emotional, and spiritual.  'All concentration begins with the intellectual 
            phase. You direct your thoughts to the object of your concentration 
            and consider what this object actually is. In this stage you are 
            using your intellect because you want to clarify your thoughts and 
            seek a completely satisfactory definition expressing fully and 
            clearly the object of your concentration. As soon as you have found 
            such a definition, your intellectual work is done, for you know
            now what this thing is. You don't need to reflect on it any 
            more, for when you know what something is, you don't
            cogitate about it any more. Thinking is the bridge between 
            ignorance and knowledge. When we know everything—like God—we 
            will have no further need for thinking. God is omniscient. 
            He himself is knowledge, and his knowledge is as perfect as a 
            circle. What should he think about when he knows every 
            thingl Only the person who is obliged to expand his knowledge 
            needs to think. This work of expanding knowledge consists of 
            thinking.  'When your knowledge concerning the object of your 
            concentration is complete, you make the transition from thinking 
            to feeling. This is the second phase of concentration. Your 
            consciousness projects outwardly through your nervous system all the 
            characteristics of the object of your concentration, impressing them 
            on your organs of sense; so you have the sensation of experiencing 
            them. With every nerve and every drop of your blood you feel the 
            object of your concentration and what it is like. When you have 
            thoroughly experienced the object of your concentration in terms of 
            thinking and feeling, you go on to the third phase, spiritual 
            concentration. This means that in your consciousness you 
            become identical with the object of concentration. You are no 
            longer thinking about it, or feeling what and how it is, you are 
            it! We call this a state of being. In this state you 
            don't need to think about this thing any more, nor to feel it, 
            because you have become it yourself. In this condition, all your 
            thoughts, all your feelings, all your words, all your deeds become 
            manifestations of the object of your concentration.  'You experienced this with the palm tree, but you 
            hadn't yet had any exercise in observing yourself during these three 
            phases. To take another example, let's say you're sitting on the 
            bank of a river and concentrating on the water. At first you reflect 
            on what water is. You recall that water is a liquid made through the 
            union of two gases. You know that it can be warm or cold, that if it 
            gets cold enough it turns into a solid, that it has colour and 
            numerous other properties. And you think along these lines until 
            your intellect has completely grasped what water is and means. 
            That is all intellectual concentration.  Then you get up and walk out into the water. Now you 
            feel what water is and what it is like. You feel through direct 
            sensation that water is liquid, that it flows about your body, and 
            you feel its temperature without measuring it. You can splash about 
            in the water, make little ripples or even big waves with your hands 
            and arms. That is concentration in terms of feeling.  In complete concentration, however, there comes the 
            moment when you cease to be a being separated from water, you merge 
            and coalesce with the water, you no longer have a human body—you 
            have become water. Now you no longer need to think about 
            water and its various properties. Neither do you need to feel 
            what water is and what it is like. On the contrary, you are 
            now water yourself. Complete concentration means becoming 
            identical with the object of concentration, being it! In the two 
            previous phases of concentration you are separated, whereas in this 
            third and last phase—the condition of being—you. experience 
            complete unity, then as a consequence, complete understanding and 
            complete recognition from within. Of course your body hasn't 
            turned into water, but in your consciousness you experience this 
            state.  'Watch the people around you. You'll notice some are 
            constantly talking about love and goodness, wearing sweet smiles of 
            smugness, and trying to show others on all possible occasions that 
            they are "loving" and "good". But only on the outside! They wear the 
            mask of love and goodness; but when it comes to deeds, they reveal 
            their selfishness—because they are selfishness.  'Another person may never talk about goodness and 
            never think that he wants to be "good"; yet everything he thinks, 
            says and does comes forth out of goodness, because he himself is
            goodness! A PERSON DOESN'T THINK ABOUT WHAT HE IS; NOR DOES HE 
            FEEL IT; SIMPLY BECAUSE HE IS WHAT HE IS! He doesn't need to speak 
            about it; everything he thinks, says and does is the expression of 
            what he is, the manifestation of his own being!  'Now comes the most difficult task of all: 
            concentrate on yourself. First reflect and consider 
            what you are, then feel what you are, and finally you must 
            be what you are!  'For you to have become conscious here on earth, you 
            have had to leave your true self and enter into your intellect and 
            feelings. So far you have only been able to think and feel
            what you are, but you have never yet been able to be what 
            you are! Observe the people around you and you will see that they 
            are not their real selves. On the contrary, they are always 
            identifying themselves with thoughts, feelings and roles they are 
            playing here on earth. They have "fallen out" of their real selves 
            and become pretenders, people living in a world of make-believe. 
            Only in the eyes of very small children can you still see the 
            sparkle, the light of real being. As its intellect awakens, 
            the child begins to identify itself with its outward person, getting 
            more and more removed from its divine, true self. And all the while 
            the person, as we think about him, is only a mask through which the 
            true self—the great invisible one—looks out at the 
            world. The person cannot be more than an instrument for the 
            manifestation of the self. But people get so attached to 
            their mask that they cannot free themselves from it any more. The 
            true self is king and master, the person is only his servant. 
            But the sons of men abandoned their self and, descending from 
            the throne, identified themselves with their mask, with their 
            person. They make a king out of the servant and separate themselves 
            from their true being. They force their higher self into 
            exile, into the unconscious. The intellect causes this 
            separation, and by means of concentration exercises and a purposeful 
            effort to become conscious and aware, the intellect can be an 
            instrument by which we get out of this separation and back to our 
            true self.  'In the past you have concentrated on various 
            things. From now on, your one and only task is to concentrate on 
            yourself, progressing through the three phases of concentration 
            until you achieve complete identification with your own true 
            self, until you really are your self. It is your 
            task to reach the state of being which can only be described, in the 
            first person, as "I am that I am". But watch out! It's not 
            enough for you to think what you are, nor to feel what 
            you are; you must be what you are in your own true inner self!
             'That is your concentration task until your 
            initiation.'  And so I enter the long period of my life in which I 
            devote myself to these two tasks: Learning to be my own true
            self, and learning to keep silence.  26
           
            THE TREE OF THE KNOWLEDGE OF GOOD AND EVIL When I have progressed to the point where I have 
            pretty well mastered the art of keeping silence, I stand before 
            Ptahhotep again one evening, and he asks me, 'What have you learned 
            during your struggles to keep silent? Have you only learned 
            the art of keeping silence?'  'No, Father, that was simply impossible. While I was 
            struggling with silence, I simultaneously had to struggle 
            with speech. To the same extent that I have mastered silence, 
            I have also mastered speech. This is because silence means 
            not talking, and talking means not keeping silent. 
            I wasn't able to separate these two things. I've discovered that 
            silence and speech are two different sides of the same unit, like 
            the two sides of a coin.'  'Right,' says Ptahhotep. Then he gets up and leads 
            me to one of the great white stone blocks of which the walls of the 
            room are made. Pointing to the smooth, white surface of the stone, 
            he asks, 'What do you see on this white surface?'  'Nothing,' I reply.  'And what could I draw on it?'  'Everything.'  'Now,' says Ptahhotep, This Nothing therefore 
            contains Everything. In this condition both together form a 
            perfect unity. Within this unity something can only become 
            recognizable if it becomes separate and distinct from unity.  'Now watch as I draw, with green paint, the form of 
            a leaf on this surface. The form of the leaf was already there on 
            this stone surface before I drew it, but you weren't able to 
            recognize it, because the positive form of the leaf and the 
            negative nature of the background were still at rest within each 
            other. They were completely identical. The form of the leaf was 
            not yet separated from the Everything that is contained in 
            this Nothing. When the leaf appeared on the wall, it became 
            separated from the Everything, and therefore recognizable.
             'And remember something very important: the fact 
            that this leaf appears in green colour means that it has left behind 
            in the Everything its form in the complementary colour, in 
            this case red, as its invisible, negative picture. 
            Whatever you see as you look about you is only recognizable because 
            it has separated itself from its complementary half and the latter 
            has remained behind in the invisible, unmanifested state.  'You can achieve knowledge only through 
            comparing the two sides, positive and negative, which have become 
            separated from each other. As long as these two sides are together, 
            resting hi each other, you can't perceive or recognize anything.  'Observe the visible world. It is only recognizable 
            because it has separated itself from the unity in which the 
            Nothing and the Everything are still at rest within each 
            other. In other words, it has separated itself from the absolute 
            unity we call God. The things in the world about us are only 
            recognizable because the positive appears separately from the 
            negative and we can compare the two together. There can be no 
            perception unless unity is split into two halves—one of them 
            manifested and the other, its reflection and complementary half, 
            unmanifested —so that both become recognizable through 
            comparison! Now follow me.'  Ptahhotep leads me into another room where he places 
            a little figurine on a large table before a white wall. Then he puts 
            two little lamps behind the figurine, one to the right and the other 
            to the left, in such a way that two shadows of the little statue 
            appear on the wall. Then Ptahhotep picks up a transparent red disc 
            and holds it in front of the lamp on the right. To my great surprise 
            I see the shadow to the right on the wall is red, while the 
            one to the left is green.  'How is that, Father of my Soul?' I ask in 
            amazement.  'Think for a moment and you will find the 
            explanation yourself,' says Ptahhotep.  I keep silent for a while and concentrate until I 
            experience the solution. Then I explain: 'The statuette keeps back 
            the red colour as the red light is projected towards the wall, and 
            allows only the complementary green colour to appear on the wall. 
            That's why the green shadow appears on the other side. On the 
            other hand, the statuette holds back all the light from the 
            other lamp, and so the shadow on this side of the wall appears to 
            have turned red.'  'Quite right,' says Ptahhotep. 'You see the two 
            complementary colours cannot exist without each other, any more than
            keeping silent can exist without talking. Whatever you 
            make manifest in the world of things about you, the complementary 
            opposite stays behind in the unmanifested state.  When you talk, the negative side of talking, 
            keeping silent, stays behind, unmanifested. And when you keep 
            silent, the positive side of keeping silent, talking, stays 
            unmanifested. When a mountain is formed, its complementary half, a 
            valley, must also be formed. How could a mountain be possible 
            without a valley, or a valley without a mountain? Nothing can 
            ever be manifested and made recognizable, unless its opposite—its 
            complementary half—is simultaneously present unmanifested! When 
            something positive is manifested, the negative remains unmanifested, 
            and vice versa, when something negative is manifested, the positive 
            is unmanifested. Wherever the one appears, its complementary half 
            must also be present even though in an unmanifested state. The 
            two are bound together for all time and eternity.  'And so you see the separation is really one in 
            appearance only, because the two complementary halves, even when 
            they are separated and have fallen out of the all-unity can
            never get away from each other. Inseparable divine unity
            therefore manifests itself always and everywhere; for even in 
            this seeming separation, it continues to be active everywhere as the
            ever-present attractive force between positive and negative. 
            Both positive and negative tend to return to their original state,
            divine unity. Even though something appears in the visible 
            world, it cannot split itself off permanently from divine unity; 
            sometime, sooner or later, it will unite with its complementary half 
            and return to divine unity. The inherent force dwelling in 
            everything that exists and drawing every created form back into the 
            original unity is what we call God.  'All creation—the visible world about us—is like a 
            tree. On the right side it bears positive-good fruit, and the left, 
            negative-bad fruit. But both sides belong to the same tree and come 
            from the same unity.  'Both good and evil have arisen only through 
            separation from unity which itself is neither good nor evil but 
            divine. Only through separation is it possible to achieve 
            recognition and knowledge. Consequently the recognizable world must 
            consist of good and evil. If this were not so, it would not be 
            recognizable and could not exist at all.  'The entire creation is the tree of the knowledge of 
            good and evil! But the creator—God—is not a half which 
            has fallen out of unity, become separated from it and consequently 
            recognizable; on the contrary, God is unity itself. He stands 
            above all created forms which have fallen out of unity. Right 
            within himself, he has perfect unity. He is the 
            Nothing out of which Everything arises and manifests 
            itself, but in him the nothing and everything 
            make up non-separated, divine unity.  'Creation always means a half of the whole ... the 
            half which has fallen out of unity and which has become recognizable 
            through comparisons, while its complementary half has remained 
            behind, unmanifested. That's why you can never find and never 
            recognize God—the creator—in the world of creation, simply 
            because God has no complementary half with which he could be 
            compared. There is absolutely no possibility of comparing 
            him, and so there is no possibility of recognizing him.—You 
            can only BE God!  'Listen, my child: There is only one eternal
            being—only one God. In everything alive there lives 
            this one single being, there lives this one single God. 
            God is the indivisible unity, he is present everywhere,
            he fills the entire universe. The whole universe lives 
            because God animates it with his own eternal being! Hence 
            God is like a tree of life giving its own being to the created, 
            recognizable world that has become separated from its complementary 
            half, in other words, giving life to the tree of the knowledge of 
            good and evil. This tree of the knowledge of good and evil—our 
            created world—is only alive because the tree of life—God— instills 
            his own life in its veins—lives in it!  'The material world is like a tree of death: The 
            tree of the knowledge of good and evil, and the God dwelling 
            within it is the tree of life living in everything that is created.
            God is one and only one. This one single God is the 
            self, the innermost being within all creatures. God is 
            everywhere present, and since two things can't occupy the same space 
            at the same time and nothing can displace God from any place 
            in the universe, only one and the same God can be present 
            everywhere as the self in every created form. God is 
            indivisible unity. All creatures, all plants, animals, man 
            himself, all are fruits on the tree of the knowledge of good and 
            evil; all are alive because the vital flow from the tree of life 
            streams through their veins, that is, because the tree of life 
            lives within them. And that means in you too, little 
            daughter!—Your body is also a fruit on the tree of death, on the 
            tree of the knowledge of good and evil, and has no life of its own. 
            But within you there lives the tree of life, because your self is
            also a little branch on God's great tree of life, and you 
            are only alive because God is living as your self 
            within you and your body, keeping your person alive.  'By virtue of having been born into your body, you 
            have become a recognizable being. You have separated your 
            consciousness from the great all and nothing—from God, from 
            your own true self. You have fallen out of the divine, 
            paradisiacal, original state—in which all possibilities of 
            manifestation including all plants, all animals and man himself, are 
            still within the all-embracing unity —into the world of many 
            forms and differentiations. You have become a manifestation, a 
            created form. Consequently everything you are here on the earthly 
            plane is only the recognizable half of unity, made up of good and 
            evil. And since your consciousness has been placed in your body, you 
            have awakened in this body, that is, your consciousness has become 
            identical with the body.  'To eat of something is to become identical with it; 
            for what you eat is what you will consist of, what you will be.
            Through identifying itself with your body, your consciousness 
            has—symbolically—eaten of the fruits of the tree of the knowledge of 
            good and evil and by the same token become subject to the kingdom of 
            death.  'But now listen to the good news: Your body is the 
            result of separation; it is only the visible half of your own true
            self. The other half has remained in the unmanifested, 
            unconscious part of your being. By uniting these two complementary 
            halves with each other, you can return to divine unity! It is 
            impossible to experience this unity physically, that is, to 
            make your invisible unconscious visible and physical also, 
            and unite the two halves together. For one consciousness 
            cannot animate two bodies. To try to experience unity in this 
            way would mean death. By virtue of the very fact that the body
            has become visible and recognizable because it has separated 
            itself from its complementary half, the reunion in this way would 
            have to involve the death of the body. Nevertheless you still can 
            experience, in the body, this divine reunion with your complementary 
            half: In a state of consciousness! You can expand your 
            consciousness until you make the unconscious part of you completely 
            conscious, until you consciously experience the unmanifested, 
            invisible half of yourself, and in this way achieve divine unity 
            in your consciousness. Even while your body remains in the 
            visible world of the created, you can merge your consciousness with 
            your own true self, out of which you have fallen, thus 
            forming the perfect unity. In this way, right here in this earthly 
            existence, you can experience bliss— experience God—be God. 
             'This striving for reunion is in everything that has 
            been created. Every creature seeks its complementary half in order 
            to re-unite with it. The positive-male forms seek the 
            negative-female forms and vice versa. This tendency on the part of 
            positive and negative force even makes up the basic structure of 
            matter. In actual fact, there couldn't be any matter at all 
            without this tendency; for this striving towards unity—towards 
            the state of being God—makes up the attractive power between 
            positive and negative forces, and the whole world is built on this 
            striving to attain the divine, primordial state. This striving 
            itself is the source of all power in the manifested world. Nature 
            uses it and, projected into the body, it is the basis of sexual 
            power.  'As long as a creature seeks its complementary half 
            outside itself, in the created, recognizable world, it will never 
            find unity, simply because its complementary half isn't outside 
            itself, manifested, separate from itself, but on the contrary, 
            unseparated from itself, in its own unmanifested part, in its 
            unconscious] No creature could exist if it did not have its 
            other half in the unmanifested. Take yourself for example, little 
            daughter. The opposite of everything you are and manifest in your 
            conscious part is contained in your unconscious part which 
            nevertheless belongs to you, and which you are just as much as you 
            are your conscious, manifested part. You don't find your 
            complementary part outside yourself—in a man of flesh and blood, for 
            example, but in the unconscious part of your true self. When you 
            unite in your consciousness two halves of yourself, you've found 
            your way back into the infinite all and nothing, you've 
            become identical with God again!  'Through this union which takes place in your 
            consciousness, the eternal longing of your manifested being ceases 
            because it has found its complementary half and merged into unity 
            with it; and for this reason the sexual desire of your body also 
            ceases once and for all. You become complete within yourself. Right 
            here in this physical existence, you experience the divine state: 
            Immortality, bliss—fulfilment! And inasmuch as the same one, 
            individual being lives in all creatures, you simultaneously 
            become identical with the true self of every creature when 
            you awaken within your own true self. You will achieve unity with 
            God and simultaneously unity with the entire universe. You will lift 
            your consciousness out of your body, out of your personal being, and 
            experience all-inclusive cosmic consciousness. You will feel 
            yourself as the "I"—the self— in every creature, in the entire 
            universe, in God. This means you will again be eating of 
            the fruit of the tree of life! Then you will have moved out of 
            the world of effects into the world of causes, out of the realm of 
            the transitory into the realm of the eternal, out of the created 
            into the creative, out of the realm of death into the realm of life. 
            In short, you will have achieved your resurrection in eternal 
            being. And that is initiation!'  Ptahhotep ceases speaking. But I see this divine 
            unity manifested in the impenetrable depths of his heavenly eyes. 
            Endless happiness, calm and peace radiate forth from his eyes into 
            my soul. In his glance I see the fulfilment of truth.  He blesses me and I leave.  27
           
            THE TWELVE SETS OF TWIN CHARACTERISTICS The next evening I find myself standing before 
            Ptahhotep again.  'The time has come,' says he, 'for you to study and 
            practise the twelve sets of opposites as your next exercise. In your 
            initiation you will be examined concerning them. So listen carefully 
            and make a point of remembering what I'm telling you now:  'Just as keeping silent and talking 
            are the two complementary manifestations of the same force, in the 
            same way there are twelve sets of opposites which you must learn to 
            control. From now on you will spend only your mornings in the temple 
            and then go back to the palace. And you must seize every opportunity 
            to be among people as much as possible, because it is far easier to 
            master each of these sets of opposites when you are in the temple 
            than it is in the palace. Here you only meet people like yourself, 
            neophytes, striving to attain divine unity, as well as priests and 
            priestesses already living in divine unity. But in the everyday 
            world you are subject to all kinds of temptations. You meet people 
            who are slaves of their bodies, and such people try to influence you 
            too. The danger of falling is much greater. If you can master all 
            the characteristics and properties applicable throughout the world, 
            you will also be able to pass the initiation examinations.  'These twelve sets of opposite characteristics are:
             keeping silent — talking  receptivity — resistance to influence  obeying — ruling  humility — self confidence  lightning-like speed — circumspection  to accept everything — to be able to differentiate
             ability to fight — peace  caution — courage  to possess nothing — to command everything  to have no ties — loyalty  contempt for death — regard for life  indifference — love  'The earth is now going through a long period in 
            which body-dominated and self-seeking people will gradually take 
            over the ruling power. But you already know that wherever negative 
            forces are manifest, positive forces must also be present, although 
            in the unmanifested state. During this dark period of the earth, the 
            Sons of God who manifest the divine laws of selflessness will 
            gradually abandon the earthly plane, withdrawing to the spiritual 
            plane of the unmanifested. Nevertheless, they will continue to work 
            in the human subconscious, as they actually will be the unconscious 
            of humanity and will manifest themselves in the souls of maturing 
            people as yearning for liberation and salvation. 'On earth, the 
            megalomania of certain individuals, together with the growing 
            dissatisfaction of the enslaved masses will lead to bitter and ever 
            bitterer struggles throughout thousands of years. Many millennia of 
            constant struggling and bickering and the supremacy of avarice, 
            vanity, envy, vengefulness, hate and other animal characteristics 
            would eradicate from the face of the earth everything that is good 
            and true and beautiful were it not for divine providence and a group 
            of spiritually united people—under the guidance of the Sons of God 
            working on the spiritual plane—who will save our secret knowledge 
            from sliding into oblivion. The earth—like every other planet—is 
            under the guidance of a high spiritual power, and this power 
            manifests itself through the Sons of God in a manner appropriate for 
            the people concerned. It is manifested through a group of initiated 
            people who through their development have become peers of the Sons 
            of God. They are all co-workers in the great divine plan of saving 
            the earth from darkness, isolation, and the rule of material and 
            diabolic forces. Every initiate takes part in this work, and as you 
            are to be initiated, this means you too.  'In order to be a useful co-worker in this great 
            plan, one must first master the whole scale of the sets of 
            opposites. And you too, for your initiation, will have to pass an 
            examination in them.  'Mastering these attributes means that you use them 
            at the right time and in the right place. The same 
            attribute that is divine at the right time and in the
            right place is satanically evil at the wrong time
            and in the wrong place. This is because God creates only what 
            is good, beautiful and true. There are no bad characteristics as 
            such, and no bad forces, but only wrongly used characteristics and 
            wrongly applied forces!  'You've already found out what it means to speak or 
            to keep silent at the right time and in the right place. To keep 
            silent is perfectly divine and brings blessings on all concerned, if 
            we do so where and when we should. But on the other 
            hand, if we keep silent in a place or at a time when we should speak 
            up— as for example when we might save a person from a great danger 
            with just a word—our keeping silence becomes satanic.  'And if we talk in the wrong place and at the wrong 
            time, the divine gift of speech is turned into satanic chatter and 
            gossip.  'In the next twin pair of opposites, receptivity is 
            divine if we are receptive and open to everything that is high and 
            beautiful, good and true, that is, if we are receptive to God's will 
            and let Him work in us. On the other hand, the receptivity, or 
            impressionability, is disastrous if it becomes a spineless lack of 
            character and capitulation to influence.  'Ability to resist influence means the 
            ability to put an unflinching resistance to all low influences. But 
            if we also put up resistance against higher forces, we immediately 
            turn our divine attribute of resistance to influence into a satanic 
            kind of self-isolation.  'It is the duty of every co-worker in the great 
            divine plan to give absolute obedience to God's will. The 
            latter can manifest itself directly through you or through other 
            people. You can recognize God's will when you thoroughly examine 
            everything that is asked of you to be sure that it is in agreement 
            with your innermost conviction. God speaks to us through our 
            innermost conviction, and we must give him absolute obedience. On 
            the contrary, to obey someone against our own conviction, purely for 
            reasons of cowardice, fear, material advantage, or merely wanting to 
            "be good"—that is for low, personal reasons, this is servility
            and is satanical.  'Ruling means giving ignorant and weak people 
            some of the ruler's own willpower. Universal love, uniting all the 
            forces active within the people, should lead the people towards a 
            general well-being, without infringing on their right of 
            self-determination. Any ruler who, without love, and for selfish 
            motives, imposes his will on others and violates their right of 
            self-determination makes the divine activity of ruling into 
            satanical tyranny.  'Humility is what we must feel towards the 
            divine, towards the higher self which animates us. You must 
            realize that all the good, beautiful, and true attributes belong to
            him, that your person is an instrument for manifesting 
            divinity, but by itself and without divinity it represents merely an 
            empty husk. You should recognize within yourself the same divinity, 
            the same eternal being which manifests itself throughout the 
            universe, and you must subject yourself humbly to this divinity. But 
            you must never subordinate yourself to earthly or sub-earthly powers 
            or bow before earthly forms; for this would mean turning divine 
            humility into weak, cowardly, satanic self-humiliation, and by doing 
            this you would violate the divinity which animates you with 
            its own eternal being.  'If you want to be a good servant within the divine 
            plan for salvation of the world, you must never forget that you do 
            not live and work on your own strength. All power comes from God, 
            and all powers you manifest come to you from your higher self—from 
            God. Constantly remember that your person as such is an imaginary 
            being. Your true being—the only, eternal reality within you—is 
            God! That's why self-confidence means having confidence in the
            God dwelling within your heart, but not in the phantom being 
            of your person as such. Divine self-confidence is indispensable 
            for every creative activity and represents an inner union with
            God. But when a person imagines his qualities and powers are 
            his own and not God's, he turns divine self-confidence into satanic 
            false pride and presumption.  'To be a co-worker within the great divine plan you 
            must also be able to make decisions with lightning-like speed. You 
            must learn, instantaneously, without hesitation, to choose the best 
            of a number of different possibilities. Situations can arise in 
            which only a moment's delay can mean missing the unique, 
            never-recurring opportunity. When you can act in a moment, with 
            complete concentration and with a presence of mind that stands above 
            and beyond all concept of time, your power to decide instantly is 
            divine. But acting quick as a flash without concentration and 
            presence of mind turns divine lightning-like speed into 
            satanic haste.  'And that's why you must also learn divine 
            circumspection. Before acting, you must control your temper and 
            with lots of patience allow the decision to ripen within you. In 
            order to recognize the will of God you must often allow yourself 
            time to reach the right decision. That's what it means to act with 
            prudence. But if you carry prudence and circumspection to the point 
            of never reaching any decision at all, you're turning divine 
            circumspection into satanic, doubting indecision.  'As a useful co-worker in the divine plan you must 
            learn to accept everything that fate brings you. Your worth is not 
            determined by external circumstances but by the degree in which you 
            manifest God. Worldly degradations or humiliations cannot 
            destroy, or even reduce, your inner values. By the same token, 
            praise or glorification cannot make them greater either. For this 
            reason, you must never be affected by the way ignorant people treat 
            you. You remain what you are whether people vilify you or glorify 
            you. Learn to be contented in any and all conditions and to accept 
            the circumstances fate gives you with complete imperturbability. 
            Whether your work within the great divine plan requires you to live 
            in abject poverty or to hold a high position and command a great 
            fortune, you must regard either of these merely as means to a 
            great end. Neither of them must change your inner attitude. 
            Learning to accept everything in this way is divine. On the 
            other hand you must always be able to decide when you, as a 
            representative of divine guidance, must defend yourself against 
            humiliation or calumny. In the same way, there are times when you 
            must be able to decide that it's the right thing to do to withdraw 
            modestly from glorification by the crowds and masses. To accept 
            everything must never be allowed to degenerate into apathetic 
            indifference or cowardly lack of character.  Always choose the best and don't be satisfied with 
            what's inferior. You must be able to differentiate and distinguish 
            what's beautiful from what's ugly, the good 
            from the bad, the true from the false, the 
            divine from the satanic. Without a completely developed 
            power to differentiate and distinguish, one can't be a useful 
            co-worker in the great plan.  'If you want to be useful, you must also be able 
            to fight with all your energy. With the sword of truth you must 
            be able to fight the shadow of error in order to help bring about 
            the victory of divinity on earth. But your noble and courageous 
            willingness to fight must never be allowed to degenerate into 
            stupid quarrelsomeness.  'And even though you must often fight bravely, you 
            must not forget that you have to fight with spiritual weapons in 
            order to bring peace to the earth. You must fight to restore 
            unity to what has been torn apart, to restore peace to those who are 
            fighting. But your love of peace must never be allowed to turn into 
            a cowardly or comfortable kind of not wanting to fight.  'In order to be a useful co-worker you also have to 
            learn caution, at the same time being able to decide the 
            right time and right place to use this divine gift. You can save 
            yourself and others from great dangers, harm and useless sacrifices 
            through the proper exercise of caution. But the divine gift
            of caution slips over into satanic cowardice when one doesn't 
            dare to do something because of fear or lack of self-confidence.  'You must possess unflinching courage, and 
            you must not fear any danger. You must stride forth courageously to 
            face any difficulty, valiantly fending off any attack against the 
            divine when the great goal you're working for requires it of you. 
            But divine courage must never be allowed to deteriorate into 
            daredevil recklessness.  'As a co-worker within the great plan you must also 
            understand what it means to possess nothing. Whether your task 
            demands abject poverty of you or gives you the greatest wealth, you 
            must always remember that nothing, absolutely nothing, ever or 
            anywhere really belongs to you. On the contrary, everything is God's 
            property, and from his property you receive something only for your 
            actual needs, corresponding to your task. Just as it's a matter 
            of indifference to a canal whether more or less water flows through 
            it, because the water doesn't belong to it, you too must regard 
            everything fate gives you as something that comes to you from 
            God, and something you must pass on. What you will have to live 
            on is something you don't need to worry about. You will always 
            receive as much as you need. And no matter how rich you might be, 
            you must always remember the fact that you really possess nothing. 
            But this divinely positive attitude must never slide down into 
            not caring about anything or contempt of things material. You 
            must never expect the people about you to maintain you without work 
            on your part!  'Matter too is a manifestation of God, and so you 
            must respect matter as something divine. But at the same time, you 
            must be master over it. You must master the art of being able to 
            acquire as many material things as you need for your earthly task. 
            And remember well that as long as you are on earth, you'll have to 
            be dealing with matter, not without it, and certainly 
            not against it. It's necessary for you to be able to acquire 
            and hold matter, to master it and use it wisely; for otherwise 
            you're completely at the mercy of earthly powers and, under their 
            control, unable to carry out your earthly task independently and 
            freely. But take care lest the divine ability to master matter 
            deteriorate into a selfish, satanic craving for possessions.  'As a co-worker in the great divine plan you can't 
            allow yourself to be attached to anyone. Learn to recognize the 
            divine, the earthly, and the demonic characteristics in everyone. 
            Don't love the person, but love the divine within the person, 
            tolerate the earthly, and go around the demonic. Whenever your task 
            demands it of you, you must be able to leave without delay the 
            person you love the most, because you must always remember that the 
            lovable characteristics in him are God, not the person himself.
            The person is only an instrument for the manifestation of 
            God. You can find and love the same manifestations in other 
            people too. Love God in everyone; then you will not be 
            attached to anyone. This not having ties must never be 
            allowed to turn into general indifference and apathy concerning the 
            people around you.  'You should be loyal, in life and in death, toward 
            the people in whom you have recognized God's manifestations. You 
            love your master and your coworkers in the great divine plan because 
            you have recognized God in them. You are loyal to God 
            in them, because you love their person only as an instrument of God. 
            In this way the esteem and loyalty you show towards your master and 
            co-workers can never turn into a cult of persons or personal 
            glorification.  'To play a useful role in the great divine plan, you 
            must be able to use your own person, like an obedient instrument, in 
            front of the public. You must be able, in front of groups of other 
            people, to animate your talents and abilities with your spiritual 
            forces, raise them to a climax of brilliance in such a way that you 
            manifest your spirit in the highest degree through your person, 
            through the posture of your body, through the movements of your 
            hands, through the glance of your eyes and through the persuasive 
            power of your oratory, all so that you can bring people under your 
            influence and carry them upward with you to a higher spiritual 
            level. In other words you must be able to appear before the public 
            without inhibitions and without being bashful. But the art of 
            "appearing in public" must never be allowed to awaken the devil of 
            vanity in you; it must never be allowed to degenerate into 
            self-complacency and the base desire to "show off" with your 
            God-given talents. When crowds of people enthusiastically cheer and 
            applaud you, you must constantly carry in your consciousness the 
            awareness that the people are not enthusiastic about your person 
            —which is only an empty garment—but about God who has manifested 
            himself through your earthly instrument.  'If in your application of the art of "appearing in 
            public" you avoid the beguiling temptations of the devil of vanity, 
            you won't be the least disturbed when, in fulfilling other tasks, it 
            becomes your duty to remain completely unknown and unnoticed by 
            other people. In such a case you must not display your talents, but 
            rather disappear in the crowd as it were, without wanting to stand 
            out or be noticed. However, this modest "remaining unnoticed" must 
            never be allowed to degenerate into personal self-underestimation or 
            self-destruction. In your heart you must always carry your worth as 
            a human being. 'If you want to be a useful co-worker in the great 
            divine plan, you must be able to achieve complete disregard for 
            death. You must have the unshakeable conviction that there is no 
            death at all. When your body has ceased to be usable, your 
            self casts it off just as you cast off a worn-out piece of 
            clothing. The self however is a branch on the tree of life, 
            therefore life itself, and life is immortal. When 
            you've become identical in your consciousness with life, you 
            won't shrink back in fear of death whenever your task brings you 
            into mortal danger. On the contrary, with complete equanimity and 
            absolute contempt for death, you will be able to face the greatest 
            danger. But never let contempt for death turn into disrespect 
            for life.  'You must appreciate life above everything 
            else. Life is God himself. The eternal being manifests 
            itself in everything that lives. You must never carelessly or 
            wantonly expose yourself to danger. Appreciate life in your 
            body too and live joyously. But the joy in living must never become 
            an end in itself and turn into sensuality.  'And last but not least you must be able to pass the 
            most difficult test of all: The test of love and cruel 
            love: Indifference. This last pair of twin characteristics makes 
            up an inseparable unit right here on the earthly plane. Whenever you 
            manifest one half of it, the other manifests itself automatically.
             'You must completely give up your personal 
            viewpoint, your personal inclinations and feelings, learning to 
            love everything and everyone without distinction or discrimination, 
            just as God himself loves everything and everyone! Just as the 
            sun shines—sends its loving radiations—with perfect impartiality on 
            the beautiful and the ugly, the good and the evil, the true and the 
            false, you must learn to love the beautiful and the ugly, the good 
            and the evil, the true and the false, without discrimination and 
            with perfect impartiality. The highest kind of love of all, divine 
            love, is the perfectly impartial love! It must be a matter of 
            complete indifference to you whether a thing or a person is 
            beautiful or ugly, good or bad, true or false, you must love them 
            all with the same love. You must learn that the beautiful wouldn't 
            even exist without the ugly. You must learn that the good wouldn't 
            even exist without the evil, nor the true without the false. And 
            that's why you must love them all equally. You must learn that the 
            beautiful and the ugly, the good and the evil, the true and the 
            false are only reflected pictures of the ineffable which we 
            for convenience' sake call God.  'When absolutely constant and completely impartial 
            love radiates from you to all creatures, your love will never again 
            be mixed with personal inclinations or antipathies. You will 
            consider everything from the standpoint of the whole, and when the 
            interests of the whole community are at variance with those of 
            individual persons, you will unhesitatingly defend the cause of the 
            group with ruthless disregard for the interests of individuals. But 
            this ruthlessness must always be rooted in universal, divine love; 
            it must never spring from personal antipathy.  'And you must also be able to manifest your 
            impersonal, cruelly impartial love for your fellow beings in those 
            cases when their soul can perhaps only be saved at the expense of 
            their earthly well-being, even when such people are very, very near 
            to you personally. You must even be able to look on dispassionately 
            when those nearest and dearest to you get themselves into great 
            danger, and if they don't react to ordinary measures, you must not 
            try to hold them back by spiritual force, hypnosis, or magic powers 
            when the salvation of their soul is at stake. It's better for a 
            person to suffer material or physical ruin, even death, than to lose 
            his soul. Under all circumstances you must endeavour to save his 
            soul. Just as God doesn't meddle in the affairs of men, but 
            rather leaves them their free will, you too must let your fellow 
            human beings apply their free will, and you must never compel them 
            to do anything by force. In your helpfulness, you must always 
            consider everything from the standpoint of spiritual well-being, not 
            from the standpoint of the earthly and physical. But this divinely 
            impartial love must never degenerate into indifference and apathy 
            and you must never refuse to help a person because of personal 
            antipathy when you can save him with earthly measures.  'These are the hardest tests of all because you must 
            give up your personal feelings, simply turning them off as it were. 
            Only when you have completely mastered the preceding eleven sets of 
            opposite characteristics will you be able to recognize the voice of 
            God so clearly as to be able to feel, even in the most difficult 
            cases, what you should do in perfect divine love, and what 
            you should not do!  'Then you will no longer be able to err, because you 
            will BE love itself! And love can only act in love. You will 
            only need to radiate your self, to be your self, and 
            the whole universe will be able to draw from your warmth, 
            from your light, and from your strength. Then you will 
            have become divine yourself, and your consciousness will have become 
            identical with God himself! You will have returned from out 
            of the world of the tree of the knowledge of good and evil, that is, 
            from out of the realm of the tree of death, where everything is 
            visible in the state of separation, into the realm of divine unity. 
            You will then be eating again of the fruit of the tree of life. And 
            of this fruit you will also give to eat to those who come after you 
            so that all may return to the unity of the immortal, eternal 
            life, to the eternal being, to God.'  Oh you representative of God! I shall never, 
            never forget your words. They have engraved themselves so deeply in 
            my soul that I have become identical with the meaning of these 
            words. They've even gone into my blood, into the marrow of my bones, 
            and I find myself a different person after this instruction from the 
            one I was before.  But my task is to make all this come true. 
             
             PHARAOH BEFORE AMON Pharaoh with the staff of life
             Cairo Museum  
             THE FOUR FACES OF BRAHMA  Angkor-Thom, Bayon, Cambodia  THE LIONS  The next day is a great festival.  As usual Menu dresses me, puts on my gilt sandals, 
            and then I go over into my reception room where the ladies of the 
            court and Roo-Kha, the Chancellor, are waiting with two jewel 
            bearers. Very ceremoniously Roo-Kha steps over to the jewel bearers 
            and opens the coffer. Then the senior lady of the court, my former 
            chief governess, takes out the magnificent golden collar, comes over 
            to me with much pomp and ceremony, and places the golden collar on 
            my shoulders. Then, just as ceremoniously, she fastens on my head 
            ornament with the golden serpent, and finally my bracelets and 
            anklets. I stand like a statue, motionless and dignified. Although I 
            behave myself with all befitting decorum, I'd really like to give 
            Roo-Kha's beard a healthy yank because he's looking at me in such a 
            saucy, impertinent way again.  Roo-Kha isn't really bad, and he too has some of the 
            blood of the Sons of God in his veins. He is very intelligent and 
            crafty, and although he too can see into people's hearts and minds, 
            he doesn't exploit this ability to an excessive extent. When he bows 
            before me, it's not the bowing of a Chancellor before his Queen. On 
            the contrary, he is bowing as a 'man' before my feminine beauty and 
            looking at me with a covetous eye. Impudent fellow! He knows all the 
            while that I can read his thoughts and all his feelings.  But then I think of Ptahhotep's words:  'In every living creature there is the striving 
            towards divine unity. The male seeks the female, and the female 
            seeks the male. That is the attraction between the two forms of 
            manifestation of creative forces ...'  In this light I can understand Roo-Kha too. This 
            power is working within him, and it's not his fault that he finds me 
            pleasing. That's the reason for his impertinence. If it weren't for 
            this force working within him he wouldn't bother about me. And in my 
            secret heart of hearts I'm really not angry at all that he admires 
            my beauty ...  After the dressing ceremonies, the ladies of the 
            court and Roo-Kha accompany me to the Pharaoh. How beautiful—how 
            very beautiful my father is in his festive robe! Just like a god 
            incarnate! Then we all leave the palace, going out to the waiting 
            chariots. Some building or other is going to be dedicated today with 
            an inaugural ceremony.  Father and I step into the golden chariot—the 
            chariot with the lions!— and father takes the reins from the 
            attendant's hands.  When I was still quite a little girl, father was 
            already taking me for rides in his chariot. I had to stand behind 
            him, and he explained to me how to keep my balance by elastic body 
            movements during the joggling, bumpy ride. I had to learn to keep my 
            entire body quite relaxed in order to be able instantly to follow 
            the movements of the chariot. When the floor beneath me was rocking 
            to and fro and bouncing up and down, I had to be able to stand on my 
            toes, keeping my feet, my knees and the rest of my body flexible and 
            quickly able to make the necessary counter-moves.  These chariot rides were always very funny, and at 
            first we had plenty of occasions to laugh at my awkwardness. At the 
            start, father let the lions walk slowly, gradually quickening their 
            pace to a trot, but the moment they began to run, the chariot threw 
            me back and forth and I was naturally afraid. Instead of keeping 
            myself relaxed, I grabbed frantically at father's hands, robe and 
            belt. Father laughed heartily, and with unending patience he showed 
            me again and again how to stand upright. Finally I learned how to 
            make the right corrective movements and was able to stand upright 
            without hanging on to father or the edge of the chariot.  It was wonderful to be able to stand as securely and 
            as apparently motionless as father while the chariot raced over the 
            ground! Often our rides were quite long. It was a thrilling feeling 
            to be speeding along behind the galloping lions. The lions also 
            enjoyed being able to get in a good run, and not only we—father and 
            I—but the lions too would laugh with joy. Through these chariot 
            rides my body became muscular, powerful and as resilient as if I had 
            practised wrestling every day. Every single muscle was used, forced 
            to coordinate and react instantly with every movement of the 
            chariot. It was a constant dance, although invisible, as it was the 
            floor underneath, not we ourselves that was really dancing on and 
            on.  When I was fifteen father taught me how to drive the 
            lions. What a wonderful feeling it was to have these magnificent, 
            gigantic animals in my power! They responded to the slightest 
            impulse of my will, so supremely sensitive that they immediately did 
            everything I wanted them to without my having to move the reins. But 
            father never let me drive them alone—not even my favourite lion, a 
            real personal pet to the point of being jealous—because the lions 
            were always highly independent and only initiates could control 
            them. I hope when I'm initiated I'll be allowed to drive the lions 
            alone!  Now en route to a public festival, father drives his 
            lions with all due dignity, and I stand beside him as his wife. I am 
            proud of father. He is still very young, strong and magnificently 
            beautiful. His body and his handsome face radiate tremendous power 
            and concentration, especially now when he is driving the lions. 
            Standing and balancing on his toes, his body absorbs every movement 
            of the chariot, and he seems to stand motionless, as securely as if 
            he were the sun god himself.  We reach our destination and the boring ceremonies 
            begin.  I don't like these public festivals. They are always 
            the same. Huge crowds, marching soldiers, people of rank!—And for a 
            time that seems interminable I have to sit still, practically 
            motionless, watching the ceremonies until everything is over. Then I 
            have to exchange friendly greetings with the people of rank, while 
            reading the many stupid and treacherous thoughts behind all the 
            humility and flattery they wear on their faces. How lucky that among 
            all the many hypocrites in the court, who seek only the satisfaction 
            of their vanity and desire for power, there are a few truly upright 
            and loyal co-workers for father and Ptahhotep. There's an officer, 
            for example, whose radiance is so bright it seems almost golden. 
            'Who is he?' I ask father in a whisper.  'His name is Thiss-Tha,' father whispers back. 'He 
            was recently made an officer, but he has such splendid qualities—as 
            you can see from his radiance— that I want to make him a commander.'
             The ceremonies are always the same, the only 
            difference being that we sometimes have to sit on the palace 
            terrace, sometimes on a great dais, and at other times on the temple 
            terrace. Sometimes the ceremonies are for the dedication of a new 
            building, sometimes to celebrate an expedition returning from barter 
            trade with neighbouring countries and bringing back the wares 
            obtained abroad. Then at other times we take part in a harvest 
            festival or various temple festivals, and these I don't like for the 
            simple reason that the great crowds haven't the slightest idea about 
            the meaning of the ceremony. Instead of worshipping God in the 
            various forms in which he manifests himself, as represented in 
            symbolic pictures, the ignorant masses worship the symbols 
            themselves.  But in time even the most boring ceremony is ended. 
            At last we can go home and be ourselves again.  No, I wouldn't like to be the Pharaoh! The affairs 
            of the country don't interest me at all. Legally I should be the 
            successor to the throne, but father never talks about this and pays 
            very little attention to preparing me for the tasks of a Pharaoh. I 
            know that Ptahhotep and father are able to raise themselves up above 
            the plane of time. They can see and experience the past and
            the future as present. I too am beginning to develop this 
            ability, and often I can see parts of the future, but whenever I'd 
            like to see my own future, only a dense mist appears before 
            my eyes, hiding everything. But father knows my future, and since he 
            is not yet treating me as a co-regent, I imagine I may never become 
            a Pharaoh. I have already had this presentiment on my own. It 
            doesn't worry me in any way as I'd rather be a priestess in the 
            temple. But curiously enough I don't see any pictures in the future 
            which would show me as a priestess in the temple either. I see only 
            mist ...  After such celebrations, I am always happy when I 
            can get back to the temple the next day. I always feel comfortable 
            in the pure spiritual atmosphere of the temple.  29
           
            TELEPATHIC EXERCISES One day Ptahhotep sends me a message saying I should 
            come to see him that evening. As I stand before him, he says: 
            'You've passed your preparatory tests so far quite successfully, and 
            now you may try to establish psychic contact with another person. 
            You will find you get better results with these exercises after 
            sundown. That's because the sun's rays have a stimulating effect on 
            those nerve centres and glands which serve the physical 
            manifestations of the spirit and thus tie the consciousness to 
            the material plane.  'The sun's rays have a contrary effect on spiritual 
            manifestations. After sunset, this effect ceases, the consciousness 
            can free itself from certain nerve centres and withdraw into the 
            spiritual plane. Living creatures go to sleep. Going to sleep means 
            that the consciousness withdraws from the body into the spirit. And 
            since most people are not able consciously to reach the 
            deeper levels of the spirit, they lose consciousness—they fall 
            asleep. With practice one can develop the resistance of his nerves 
            to such a degree that he can remain conscious even at the deepest 
            level. In this way the nerve centres and brain centres which are at 
            rest during the daytime become active, receiving and conducting the 
            vibrations of the spirit, the self. In this way you can 
            establish contact with someone at a distance, that is telepathic 
            contact. It's better for a beginner to practise after sunset so that 
            he doesn't have the effect of the sunshine working against him. 
            Later on he develops the ability to make a telepathic contact any 
            time.  'In this exercise, just as in every exercise in 
            concentration, you begin by fixing your entire attention on one 
            single thought. Concentrate your thoughts completely on the person 
            with whom you want to establish contact, allowing your imagination 
            to help along. With your eyes closed, you imagine the person you 
            want to reach, seeing him with your inward eye, his body, his face, 
            his eyes, and imagining you are he and he is you,
            until you actually get the feeling that his hands are your hands 
            and your body his, until you achieve complete identity with the 
            person you are trying to reach. When you've reached this point, 
            think the thought you want to transmit clearly and concentratedly. 
            Think it with intent awareness that you are the person 
            concerned and that this person in you is thinking this thought.
             'This exercise has three phases: first you practise
            in the presence of the per son whom you want to reach 
            telepathically, and during your practice the person concerned 
            tries to receive your thought.  'Later you repeat the same exercise at a distance
            and at a time agreed upon in advance, with both of you 
            knowing that the other is going to concentrate on him.  'Finally you will transmit a message through 
            telepathic contact without your partner's knowing about it in 
            advance. These three phases make up the positive half of 
            telepathic exercises. In this work you are the one who wants to send 
            a message. The negative half of the exercise consists in your 
            developing the ability to receive and understand telepathic 
            messages. This exercise too consists of three phases. At first 
            you make yourself receptive and "empty" in the presence of the 
            person from whom you want to receive a message, then alone at 
            a time agreed upon in advance such that you know who is 
            going to concentrate on you and when. Finally you must 
            be able to receive any telepathic message without knowing in 
            advance who is going to concentrate on you and when.  'In time you develop to such a point that you 
            respond immediately to every message from a distance, at any time 
            and from any person. No matter what you're doing, you'll feel that 
            someone is concentrating on you, and you will hear his voice within 
            you. Later on you will not only be able to hear the person's 
            voice; you will even be able to see the person you're in 
            contact with. His form, his face and especially his eyes will appear 
            before you just like a picture in a dream. When you reach this level 
            in your progress, you won't feel the fetters of matter—of your 
            body—in such an oppressive fashion, for by then the isolation you 
            felt by virtue of being imprisoned within your body will be greatly 
            reduced. You will be able to enjoy the freedom of the spirit while 
            you're still living in the body.  'When you want to create a telepathic connection, 
            you'll find you will succeed better at night. Then the consciousness 
            is not so strongly occupied with one's own thoughts. The person 
            concerned is less isolated. He is passive, and your telepathic 
            message will be better able to reach his nerve centres. Most 
            people's nerve centres are in such a latent state, so poorly 
            developed, that it takes a very powerful effort on your part for 
            them to be able to receive a message at all. When they're asleep, 
            you can get them to dream about you and pick up your message in 
            their dream. Practice will reveal all the laws of telepathy to you, 
            including how to know immediately whether someone is busy and how to 
            isolate yourself when you are busy concentrating on something. Only 
            beginners disturb each other!  'Every evening you are to practise these exercises 
            according to my instructions. And now let's do a bit of practice 
            right away. Seat yourself opposite me, close your eyes, and try to 
            communicate a thought to me.'  I sit down opposite Ptahhotep and concentrate on 
            him. I imagine that I am Ptahhotep, and I induce within myself 
            the feeling that my hands and feet, my entire body, are his hands, 
            his feet, his body. Then with utmost concentration I think this 
            thought: 'I, Ptahhotep, get up, step over and stroke the hair of 
            this young person (myself).' For Ptahhotep's hands radiate wonderful 
            strength, and I am always happy when he lays his hand upon my head.
             Almost instantly Ptahhotep stands up, lays his 
            blessed hand upon my head, and strokes my hair. So my concentration 
            was successful. Or was it? After all Ptahhotep can read my thoughts 
            even when I'm not trying to transmit a thought to him 
            telepathically.  'Good,' he says with a smile. 'I was able to read 
            your thought not simply because I can read your thoughts anyway, but 
            because you were really concentrating very well. Your lion would 
            have felt too what you wanted.'  'My lion, Father of my Soul? I can believe that. But 
            a person?'  'Patience, my child. In time everything is possible. 
            Now let's try it the other way around. I'll transmit a thought to 
            you. Make yourself empty and receptive.'  Ptahhotep sits down and I do as he asks. A moment 
            later I hear his voice from within me, as if coming out of my own 
            heart: 'As soon as you've achieved sufficient self control in 
            all the twin characteristics, it will be time for me to reveal the 
            last secrets to you before your initiation.'  I open my eyes and ask with joyous expectation, 
            'Does this mean I'm drawing near to my initiation?'  Ptahhotep smiles: 'Since you heard my message, you 
            are ready to receive it, except that you still need to perfect 
            yourself in self control.'  I jump up, throw my arms about his neck, and kiss 
            his cheeks with resounding smacks. Ptahhotep embraces me and says 
            with a loud laugh: 'You see, you see how you can't control yourself! 
            You haven't been able to resist the effect of spiritual unity. 
            You've experienced the union of our spirit, the sources of this 
            unity flowed into your body, and now your body wants to participate 
            in the joy of union. But don't forget that what is divine on the 
            spiritual level because it corresponds to the laws of the spirit 
            becomes satanic on the material level because it runs counter to the 
            laws of matter. Union in the spirit is possible, but union in the 
            body is not; two bodies cannot occupy the same space. Because of the 
            longing for unity, people try to unite their bodies, and therefore 
            slide down into sexuality. Nature exploits the longing for union, 
            the yearning for the long lost paradisiacal state in order to beget 
            new generations of people. The great disappointment is only that 
            sexuality cannot create union. What's impossible is simply 
            impossible. And all creatures in addition to being tired through the 
            drain on their energies, are sad after sexual intercourse, simply 
            because the soul remains unsatisfied. The longing for the 
            paradisiacal unity continues, and nature goes on using this 
            unfulfilled yearning to produce new generations of offspring. For 
            you it would be very, very desirable not to let the yearning for 
            union flow unhindered into your body. I am protected enough to 
            be able to resist your entrancing beauty, but you may meet younger, 
            inexperienced men who can't resist you when you throw your arms 
            around their neck! Naturally my advice is wasted,' says Ptahhotep 
            with a smile. 'What you really lack is experience. And it's this 
            lack of experience I can now thank for your vehement expressions of 
            love.'  'Father of my Soul,' I say, 'you're not angry at 
            me?'  Ptahhotep smiles: 'No, no, my little child, I'm not 
            angry at all. As long as you only throw your arms around my neck, 
            everything's all right. But be very, very cautious with other men! 
            The higher you rise in spirit, the more irresistible your radiations 
            become. You don't need to get nearly so close to a person for your 
            power of attraction to be effective. Be careful that you don't lead 
            men to their downfall.'  'Father,' I asked amazed, 'do you mean I'm not 
            spiritual enough? You know how successful I am in my exercises. And 
            Mentuptah is very satisfied with me too. I already know how to 
            control my body and my nerve centres to a very high degree. I've 
            passed all my preliminary tests.'  'Yes,' said Ptahhotep. 'Spiritually you are already 
            very awake and in control of your body. But at the same time you are 
            very free and lacking in caution on the physical plane. You are 
            neglecting to bolt this door, not because you are not able to, but 
            because you don't always want to. You're not protecting your body 
            sufficiently against the high frequencies of spiritual vibrations, 
            and that is a constant danger for your nerve centres. When your 
            spiritual forces enter your body, you conduct these high 
            frequencies, untransformed, into your lower nerve centres and this 
            means there's a danger of your higher, finer nerve centres being 
            burnt out and destroyed. That would be too bad for this fine 
            instrument. You have enough self-control when you want it, 
            but you often relax your grip on the reins out of pure enthusiasm. 
            Sometimes you simply don't want to exercise self-control, Be 
            on the lookout, dear child, and always alert!'  Oh Ptahhotep, my dear, dear master! How early you 
            saw what was unavoidably coming and how much you wanted to save me! 
            But the best advice can't change inexperience into experience, and 
            my inner lack of balance and self-control had to be brought back 
            into equilibrium through painful experience.  30
           
            THE FUTURE AND SUNRISE A long new period begins in my life. I examine my 
            every thought, my every word, my every deed. I reflect and watch to 
            see whether, at the right time and in the right place, I am really 
            giving expression to the divine, and not to the satanic. And in this 
            constant watchfulness, this continuous self-observation, I discover 
            how undisciplined and unbridled and sensual—in a word how personal—I 
            still am. How much longer is it going to take me to reach the point 
            where I don't allow myself to be overpowered by passions, where I no 
            longer identify myself with my external impressions, but always 
            remain master of all my physical, spiritual and mental forces?  During this period of my preparation for initiation 
            I spend only my mornings in the temple, coming back to the palace 
            after my physical and spiritual exercises. In the afternoon I take 
            part in public life. Excursions by ship and chariot alternate with 
            travel and inspection trips to various settlements.  But these excursions and the conversations centring 
            around them really bore me stiff. It isn't that I don't like 
            company, oh no! I enjoy very much being with people, but with people 
            who are my kin and who have something to say. But these people are 
            so different from us who have our lineage from the Sons of God. Of 
            course we too have human blood and our race too is no longer pure, 
            but we consciously live in the spirit and are not so materialistic 
            as the sons of men. It's almost as if they had completely forgotten 
            that they, in their selves, are free spirits and that their body is 
            only an instrument for the manifestation of their spirit.  These people are so identified with their body that
            they live in the illusion they are only body. When their body 
            needs food, they believe they want to eat, they are 
            hungry, and instead of taking in food under the watchful supervision 
            of the spirit, they act as if they themselves were eating, 
            rather than merely being observers and governors of their body.
            They eat just as greedily as animals. I watch them during 
            'feeding time' and often feel like turning my head away so as not to 
            see their beastly behaviour. I too let my body eat with good 
            appetite; I too supply my stomach and digestive organs with pure 
            forces, getting all the taste of the food I eat so that my body can 
            absorb all the precious forces in the food— but how could I identify 
            myself with this? My self can't be hungry, since the self is 
            not matter but the master of matter. It's true my consciousness 
            receives a message from the body to the effect that it needs 
            nourishment, and I'm aware of this message in the form of a feeling 
            of hunger. But the self in me neither eats nor drinks. How 
            could I forget even for a moment that these functions are only 
            necessary in order to maintain the body in health? The only thing my 
            self really has to do with all of this is to observe watchfully
            and control what enters the body and see to it that teeth 
            and tongue do their work properly.  I can never understand how people, after eating like 
            beasts, can say something like, 'My, but that tasted good to me!'
            To whom did it taste good? Don't such people know that it tasted 
            good to their palates? These poor people are such slaves of 
            their physical desires ... We simply don't understand each other. 
            But father and Ptahhotep say it's our duty to remain among them and 
            awaken higher desires and aims within them. And all the while father 
            knows that the people of rank within his court are mostly only 
            interested in how and where they can get a well-paid 
            position, so they can get rich as quickly as possible and satisfy 
            their hunger for power.  And another thing—these sons of men go hunting for 
            wild animals, using their intelligence to kill innocent animals—and 
            they're even proud about it! They should be ashamed! These people 
            are worse than the animals they hunt. Animals only kill because of 
            hunger! But people kill for passion's sake, because killing—war and 
            hunting give them pleasure. But father says that people are still 
            undeveloped and we mustn't judge them by our own standards.  Another thing—these people attach endless importance 
            to their family tree. When a person has one ancestor more from the 
            lineage of the Sons of God than someone else has, he mentions it as 
            often as possible, and shows contempt for others with less 
            brilliance in their ancestry. That's why they pay so much attention 
            to the family a daughter is descended from, and the family of the 
            young man she marries. How ridiculous! As if they didn't really know 
            that earthly life is only a journey between being born into the body 
            and leaving it at death, whereas the self is the same in 
            every living creature. Only the body can have a 'lineage'. The level 
            on which a person stands is determined only by the level of his own 
            intelligence. Often enough, a person with several ancestors from the 
            lineage of the Sons of God still has a lower degree of intelligence 
            than someone else with far fewer forefathers in the divine race.  When I'm among these people, I feel as if I were 
            among the dead. They seem to move, speak, eat, drink and carry out 
            functions of the living merely because natural forces are at work 
            within them. But where is the conscious spirit that controls and 
            guides these natural forces, not only in the body, but also outside 
            in the universe? They don't know they have the ability to guide 
            these creative forces. They're so blind they see only the 
            external form of people, and they haven't the faintest idea that 
            I can read their thoughts, their feelings, see their whole soul, 
            their inner being. They lie to my very face for the simple 
            reason that, not being able to read my thoughts, they believe 
            that I can't see theirs either, and that I don't know their 
            thoughts are very different from what they say. They don't realize 
            that a lie creates a kind of insulation around them and develops a 
            dark shadow, like smoke, in their radiation, and this dark blotch is 
            not only ugly, but even smells bad. My pet lions are quick to smell 
            the foul scent of these liars. Whenever one of them comes near, they 
            start to wrinkle their nose, then get up, give the person concerned 
            a contemptuous glance, and stalk off majestically. But with no such 
            easy way to defend myself, I have to keep on talking with such 
            people just as if I didn't clearly see their hypocrisy—and even 
            smell it!  It's much more pleasant to be alone with father. 
            He's had a charming house built for the two of us, in a shady garden 
            by the seashore. Whenever he has some free time, we go there by boat 
            on the Nile, taking only a minimum of servants. This gives us a 
            magnificent rest, coupled with deep enjoyment of the endless sea and 
            the peace of each other's company.  Father and I both love the sea—that great mother of 
            the earth—with childlike devotion. We're both of us so very happy in 
            our little house by the seashore, and our life there is closely 
            linked in many ways to the sea itself. Here we experience perfect 
            liberty, immortality, eternity ...  We take advantage of every opportunity to be close 
            to the sea. We go for walks together along the seashore. We go 
            looking for mussels together, and sometimes we take a little boat 
            and row out quite far, all by ourselves. There's an immensity about 
            the beauty of the sea when the air is calm and the water beneath us 
            is as smooth as a mirror. But there's something just as grand about 
            being out among all the waves when the wind's blowing them up high, 
            and we feel all the exhilaration of being hoisted skyward by the 
            crest of one wave, then sliding down into the trough of the next. We 
            strip off our clothes, jump into the cool water, and swim about our 
            boat.  Once, after such an invigorating swim, as we were 
            sitting on the beach, I asked father: 'How is it possible that 
            people can be so blind to spiritual truth? What's going to happen to 
            the world when the government gets into the hands of the sons of 
            men, as Ptahhotep once told me it would? I'm frightened even to 
            think of the consequences of the dominion's passing into the hands 
            of self-seeking people obsessed with a craving for power. I'm 
            beginning to be able to sense what's coming in the future. My 
            exercises in the temple are awakening my inner sight, and my powers 
            of clairvoyance are growing from day to day, but still I don't see 
            everything as clearly as Ptahhotep and you.'  For a long time father sits looking out over the 
            water. Finally he says: 'Yes, the earth must go through a very 
            difficult period for many thousands of years. As you already know, 
            the pure-blooded Sons of God all departed from this earthly plane 
            long ago. And their sons who have been born as a cross between the 
            two races but who still carry within themselves the possibility of 
            perfectly divine manifestation, are also gradually disappearing from 
            the face of the earth. 'In order for the higher powers to be 
            propagated through hereditary channels when the pure-blooded Sons of 
            God had already departed from the earth, their sons, who had 
            inherited their abilities from their fathers and who had achieved 
            initiation, again took daughters of men as their wives, and this 
            went on and on for generations until this intermarrying had 
            penetrated into all levels of life in both races. 'But as long as 
            the waves of creative force are moving in the direction of further 
            materialization, the earthly element always plays the dominant role 
            in heredity. For this reason, less and less descendants of the Sons 
            of God—with their original elongated cranial form and their capacity 
            for manifesting higher abilities—are being born on earth. 
            Nevertheless, in accordance with the laws of heredity, this 
            continual intermarrying has made it possible for a pure-blooded Son 
            of God to reincarnate himself at any time—even in the darkest, most 
            materialistic period in human development. For the time is coming 
            when only people with short heads will be born and will move into 
            positions of ruling power all over the earth, even here in Egypt! 
            They won't have the spiritual vision and wisdom of the present 
            dynasty that has come down from the higher race, and instead of 
            governing their people with selfless love, they will rule only with 
            the intellect, with blind, crude craving for power, and with 
            unmitigated selfishness.  'As you know, the continual intermarriages between 
            the Sons of God and the daughters of men have gradually led to the 
            development of a hybrid race which is passing on the inherited 
            characteristics of both races. There are numerous individuals who, 
            although they have human blood, still have the elongated cranial 
            form, and thus have inherited all the spiritual and psychic powers 
            of their paternal forebears. But according to the laws of heredity, 
            this continual intermarrying will result in more variations of 
            different individuals even in the same family, but less and less 
            individuals with inherited characteristics from the divine lineage. 
            Even today there are cases where, among several sons in a given 
            family, one is still quite divinely spiritual, another already quite 
            physically human, and a third can easily be a mixture of both. The 
            relationship between those with higher and those with lower 
            characteristics is shifting constantly towards those with the lower 
            characteristics. No wonder men orientated towards the physical very 
            often nurse a bitter hatred towards their brothers who have 
            inherited divinely spiritual characteristics. All too often, this 
            hatred leads to tragic clashes.  'Nevertheless, as a result of still further 
            intermarrying and in accordance with the laws of heredity, the high 
            knowledge of the initiates will penetrate deeper and deeper into the 
            people and wider and wider throughout the entire population. As ever 
            more variations and differentiations arise, the time will come when
            every human being will have the possibility of reaching the 
            highest degree of knowledge and initiation. This intermarrying, 
            going on for many thousands of years, will eventually obliterate the 
            differences we now feel to be so tremendous between the omniscient 
            members of the ruling family and the completely ignorant and 
            undeveloped masses. Thus in time, the people and their rulers will 
            become equal as people. In their pure form both of these two 
            races, the Sons of God and primitive man, will gradually disappear 
            completely, but there will always be some individual born on 
            different levels of development. In some of them the inherited 
            characteristics of their divine ancestors will be manifested to a 
            greater degree, while in others the primitive human characteristics 
            will be dominant.  'In this way everyone will have characteristics 
            inherited from both sides, and the races will be so thoroughly 
            blended that people can no longer be distinguished by racial 
            characteristics but only on the basis of traits of character and 
            abilities. Generally speaking, people with higher abilities will 
            have exactly the same cranial form as other people but still stand 
            out above the masses as great scientists or artists, philosophers or 
            mystics. Both the elongated head form of the Sons of God and the 
            short, ape-like head form of primitive man will have disappeared 
            completely. In the hybrid race the brain and nerve centres serving 
            for the manifestation of higher spiritual and psychic abilities will 
            be in an undeveloped, latent state for many thousands of years. 
            Accordingly, people's heads will be roundish in form. On the other 
            hand people in this hybrid race will develop extensively the brain 
            centres serving the intellect, and their future generations will 
            thus have high, arched foreheads.  'Just as the waves of spiritual force emanating from 
            the higher race will reach larger and larger numbers of people as a 
            result of this intermarrying until they reach people of the lowest 
            level and make it possible for them too to have knowledge, in the 
            same way worldly dominion will pass into the hands of people on 
            lower and lower levels. In their ignorance, of course, they will 
            first destroy the great divine cultures which the Sons of God have 
            built up in various parts of the earth. Only a few remnants and 
            ruins of the great buildings and monuments we have today will be 
            left as silent witnesses to tell of the knowledge, wisdom, goodness 
            and beauty that once reigned on earth. As time goes on people will 
            only know through their legends about the omnipotence and 
            omniscience of the great "white magicians" and "initiates"; but 
            since these people will be ignorant themselves, they'll go along for 
            thousands of years believing, in their pride and arrogance, that 
            these legends are only fairy tales.  'The continual hybridization process going on 
            between the two races has created a kind of "ladder of development" 
            on which even the lowest level of primitive man can climb upward. 
            Animal-like people themselves are nothing else but pure spirits 
            which have fallen far down into matter and which, having lost their 
            divine consciousness in matter, are no longer aware of their high 
            parentage. In order to give them the possibility of regaining 
            their consciousness on the highest plane, the Sons of God made the 
            great sacrifice of putting their strength into marriages with the 
            daughters of men. With these marriages, however, they've anchored 
            themselves in the material world and are obliged to go through the 
            whole developmental process up to the complete spiritualization of 
            the earth in the capacity of helpers, some of them in human 
            reincarnations and some of them in the bodiless spiritual state.  'The level of the ruling class will sink lower and 
            lower, and the dominant power will shift from one country to 
            another. Continual wars raging on earth will lead to ignorance, 
            poverty and misery.  'The last initiates will refuse to turn over to 
            these people the devices and equipment through which they control 
            the forces of nature and the tremendous creative forces that operate 
            in secret. Before they leave the earthly plane for thousands of 
            years they will destroy all their instruments. One of the last 
            initiates, who will come forth out of a different people from ours 
            but who will nevertheless grow up here in Egypt and receive 
            initiation, will salvage one such instrument, taking it with him out 
            of Egypt, and for a time the priests of his people will be able to 
            keep the secret. But the time will come when the last initiate will 
            have to leave the earth, and he will destroy the last instruments. 
            He will have to do it to keep the ignorant sons of men from 
            destroying each other, themselves and—through chain reactions—whole 
            Continents again, purely as a result of their passion for power and 
            possessions. The destruction which once overtook the home of the 
            Sons of God must never be repeated.  'After all the initiates' instruments are destroyed 
            and their high knowledge has passed from the earth, people will have 
            to till the soil with their own physical force, and they'll even 
            have to cut stones with their own hands, just as primitive man did! 
            They'll also have to suffer the tyranny of fellow human beings from 
            within their own race. However, since everything that manifests 
            itself on the earthly plane arises through forces originating in the 
            indivisible unity and striving for equilibrium, the tyranny of 
            self-seeking rulers will awaken people out of their unconscious 
            state. Through pain and suffering their attention will be guided to 
            higher, spiritual truth.  'Spiritual leaders of the earth must leave humanity 
            apparently alone because people are to discover divine truth in 
            themselves and in nature, standing on their own feet, using their 
            own will, independent of outside help. If this were not so they 
            would never have the opportunity of climbing up to the highest 
            level. But just as a good mother helps her child to learn to walk 
            alone so that it can develop independence, while all the time she 
            watches from a distance, ready to help it up again after a fall, in 
            the same way the spiritual powers guiding the earth are ready to 
            intervene whenever necessary to help humanity out of difficult 
            situations. They are active on the spiritual plane, guiding and 
            leading humanity from there. Whenever, instead of knowledge, 
            ignorance and error and superstition gain control on earth—whenever 
            spiritual darkness is so great that it threatens to get completely 
            out of hand, there will always be some of the Sons of God ready to 
            make the great sacrifice of descending to earth, being reborn in a 
            human body, and in this way bringing divine light and consolation to 
            humanity.  'Through the intermarriages between the divine race 
            and the human, the inheritable divine characteristics will be 
            propagated among the people. In this way it will always be possible 
            for a Son of God, through a pure woman, to receive a body with all 
            the organs he needs to manifest himself completely. In every epoch 
            throughout the development of the earth through many thousands of 
            years the Sons of God will incarnate themselves in order to teach 
            people the laws of the spirit, love and selflessness, and in order 
            to carry out the most varied tasks. Even though dominion will rest 
            in human hands all over the earth, there will still be some rulers 
            who will reign with wisdom and justice and build up high 
            civilizations on earth, or at least in parts of the earth. Others, 
            coming as scientists, artists and mystics, will bring humanity the
            highest art, music and literature. They will bring the world 
            new ideas and new discoveries in order to guide the earth's 
            development in new directions. For the most part, these Sons of God 
            will live a very lonely life, often in the most abj ect poverty and 
            abandoned by their fellows, for there will only be very few people 
            who can understand them. Nevertheless, their spiritual light will 
            reach out in ever-greater waves, into ever-wider circles. The names 
            of these spiritual giants will be known for thousands of years, and 
            people will study their works hi the highest schools of the sons of 
            men.  'Then, too, there will be reincarnated Sons of God 
            working secretly within humanity. They'll find places to live in the 
            high mountains, in caves, or in other remote regions where, 
            undisturbed in their retreats, they can send forth extremely high 
            forces into the atmosphere of the earth. People who have already 
            developed to such a point that they can receive these spiritual 
            waves will automatically establish spiritual links with these 
            Sons of God, and work together with them. Often they will not 
            even be aware of this spiritual link. On the contrary, for all 
            they'll know, they will merely be acting on the basis of their own 
            "inner conviction", not knowing that this "inner conviction" is 
            divine power transmitted from the Sons of God. In this way some 
            highly developed people will transmit and proclaim to all humanity 
            the teachings which the Sons of God will bring to earth from time to 
            time. Although the masses won't be able right away to understand 
            these high truths, they'll feel the love and power inherent within 
            them, and for this reason they'll believe in them. That is 
            how religions will come into being from the divine teachings 
            of the Sons of God.  'All the Sons of God have always brought and always 
            will bring the same truth into different parts of the earth, 
            but people will interpret it differently depending on the 
            characteristics of their race and their degree of development. 
            These different interpretations, as they get passed on to later 
            generations, will give rise to different religions all springing 
            from the same truths. One and the same Son of God will 
            reincarnate himself at different times and in different places of 
            the earth in order to proclaim the highest truth to humanity. And 
            from the same truth proclaimed by the same spirit, 
            people in different parts of the earth will develop different 
            religions. Because of such differences arising merely from human 
            ignorance, people will make war upon each other, trying to send each 
            other to hell "in the name of God".  'The degree of development reached by people in 
            different nations at any given time will vary greatly, and the 
            reincarnated Sons of God will consequently receive widely varying 
            kinds of treatment. In some countries, where people are most 
            interested in divine truth, the Sons of God will be recognized, 
            heard and honoured.  'But the waves of force keep radiating outward till 
            they reach their utmost material limits. There will also be times in 
            the darkest periods of earthly life, when materialism, hate, envy, 
            fear and terror reign, and in such times too the Sons of God will 
            have to return to earth and be very badly treated. Ignorant people 
            obsessed by a passion for power will torture and kill the Son of 
            God. Nevertheless he will go through with this sacrifice, thus 
            radiating tremendous spiritual force. The spirit in people will 
            awaken and vanquish the darkness in their soul. Little by little the 
            face of the earth will be completely changed.  'From the utmost material limits, the waves of 
            creative force will then flow back again, ushering in a new period 
            of upward development. People will have more and more opportunity to 
            co-operate with the Sons of God in the great divine plan for the 
            salvation of the earth, and as time goes on they will manifest more 
            and more spirituality. Then masses of individuals will be 
            reincarnated who once were incarnate in the divine race, but 
            who either could not pass their tests for initiation, and died 
            during initiation, or later fell after having become 
            initiates. They will again be conscious of the knowledge they once 
            had, and while people will still be killing each other in some parts 
            of the earth, there will be a constantly growing group of people 
            receiving and transmitting the radiations of the Sons of God, and 
            preparing the new life of the spirit.  'The people descended from the lower race will also 
            gradually climb to higher levels. At first they will only be able to 
            grasp with their intellect that they are capable of better things 
            and that they could live much more happily on earth without killing 
            and enslaving each other. The higher humanity climbs, the more 
            materialism and passion for possessions will lose their grip on 
            people's lives. Little by little the passion for conquest and power 
            will decline, and instead of using their strength to fight each 
            other, people will use their abilities to harness the forces of 
            nature. In this way they will discover step by step that they don't 
            need to earn their bread through dull, difficult drudgery, that they 
            don't need to water the earth with the sweat of their brow, and that 
            by activating their higher nerve centres they can command the forces 
            of nature. Thus the earth will gradually come back under the 
            dominion of higher waves of force, and people will not only be able 
            to understand with their intellect, but also to experience 
            and realize the highest divine truths. In this way high 
            civilizations will develop again.  'As long as a person identifies himself with 
            matter—with the earth—his consciousness is linked with the earth in 
            a state of identity: He is earth. Consequently, when his body 
            loses its usefulness and dies, he dies too, that is, his 
            consciousness ceases and falls into a latent state. That's what 
            people call  death.  'But the situation is just the opposite with a 
            spiritually re-awakened person who stands above matter during his 
            physical life. For him the fact of being born into a body is death, 
            whereas the death of the body means his awakening, resurrection, 
            life!  'When people cease to identify themselves with their 
            body—or to express the matter symbolically—when they cease to eat of 
            the fruits of the tree of the knowledge of good and evil, 
            manifesting only the right half of the tree of knowledge and 
            leaving the left half of the tree in the unmanifested state, they 
            will live in a paradisiacal state, in themselves and as children of 
            the earth. This is the stage of development humanity must reach.
             'It will be a long struggle until the earth reaches 
            this plane of existence, but spiritual forces gradually penetrate 
            even into the most isolated heart, and in the course of further 
            thousands of years the earth will again be transformed into the 
            promised land. Sometime, in the far distant future, the salvation of 
            the earth will be accomplished!'  Father stops talking and looks out over the sea for 
            a long time as if he had been reading the future there.  'Father,' I ask, 'will you and Ptahhotep take part 
            in this great work? Will you too be born again for tasks on earth 
            during the aeons and aeons to come? And how about me, father? What's 
            going to happen to me? I often see other people's future very 
            clearly, but when I try to see my own, there's only a curtain of 
            mist before my eyes, and I can't see into it or through it.'  Father shoots me a very strange glance at this 
            question. Then, putting his arm about my shoulders and drawing me 
            close, he gives me his answer: 'I'll be reincarnated a number of 
            times in earthly lives because, through my marriage with your 
            mother, I've put my roots down in the plane of matter, deeper than 
            would normally be appropriate for one of our spirit. But Ptahhotep 
            has never departed from his spirituality and never identified 
            himself with his body. When he gets through with his present task, 
            he'll not be born again for more than ten thousand years. Together 
            with a number of other Sons of God he will continue to guide the 
            development of the earth, working on the spiritual plane and 
            projecting his influence on earthly life from there.  'Many highly developed people will be in spiritual 
            contact with him and cooperate with him in the great divine plan for 
            the salvation of the earth. They must carry out the tasks that 
            Ptahhotep assigns them and quite independently. As soon as they have 
            carried out one task properly, they'll receive new ones and, 
            gradually, more and more difficult ones. Through many thousands of 
            years people who reach spiritual maturity will also receive 
            initiation. They won't be initiated in the pyramids as candidates 
            are now, but will simply be assigned tasks to accomplish as part of 
            their life and work, and these tasks will make up their initiation 
            tests. In this way they will gradually develop into full-fledged 
            co-workers with the Sons of God. And working with Ptahhotep there 
            will also be those fallen Sons of God who identified themselves to 
            an excessive extent with matter, burnt out their brain and nervous 
            centres by transmitting excessively powerful vibrations into them, 
            and consequently had to be born again on even lower levels of 
            matter.  'Only through the experiences to be gained through 
            several reincarnations can these fallen Sons of God climb back to 
            their original level of divinity. Through lots of pain and sorrow 
            they will have to awaken their higher brain and nerve centres within 
            their body on a lower level, and it will cost them great effort and 
            long practice to reactivate these organs and be able, once again, to 
            manifest spiritual and magical powers. They will never feel quite at 
            home among people, as their way of thinking will be quite different 
            from that of the mass of human beings around them, and they will 
            never be completely able to understand human earthly life and adapt 
            themselves to it. They will be strangers, travelling through life 
            alone and misunderstood, always regarded as somewhat queer. For the 
            most part, as I already told you, they will have the task of 
            teaching people science, art and literature, and bringing new ideas 
            to earth. By some people who understand them, they will be respected 
            and revered, while by others who are forced to recognize their high 
            gifts, they will be objects of envy and hate.  'Through long suffering and many sorrows these 
            fallen sons—and daughters —of God will be awakened from their 
            material dream, rediscover their relationship with their lost 
            brothers, and re-acquire their lost cosmic consciousness. 
            Then they too will work together with their brothers within the 
            great divine plan, and proclaim divine truths on earth.'  I ask father: 'You said that the Sons of God will 
            gradually disappear from the face of the earth and that the people, 
            even though not yet awakened on the spiritual plane and consequently 
            self-centred entirely in the physical plane, will get control and 
            dominion over the affairs of the world. In that case how will the 
            people be able to control the lions? These marvellous animals are so 
            extremely sensitive that they don't tolerate the selfish sons of men 
            in their vicinity, even now. On their animal level they are a 
            manifestation of the highest power—the sun power—and live and move 
            in harmony with the sun's vibrations. They respond to courage, 
            honesty, love and have such fine nerves that they simply can't 
            tolerate low-level radiations. Whenever anyone approaches them, they 
            know immediately whether he's coming towards them in a spirit of 
            love, or in a low attitude of fear and passion for power. That's why 
            they hate the selfish, power-hungry sons of men. If what you say is 
            going to happen how will lions ever be able to serve the sons of 
            men? I just can't imagine, Father.'  'Your imagination is absolutely right if it doesn't 
            show you a future picture of lions serving mankind. It's quite true 
            people won't be able to keep the friendship of these wonderful 
            animals. With lies and pretty words, selfish and ignorant people 
            can—and often will—deceive each other, but never the lions! Animals 
            pay no attention to appearances; they see only the truth, because 
            they themselves are true! Lions will cease to be domestic 
            animals, withdrawing into the wilderness, far away from people, and 
            living a wild life of their own.'  'But Father, what animals will people use to pull 
            their chariots? Oxen and asses are much too slow!'  Father smiles: 'There are places in the world, even 
            now, where a splendid animal related to the zebra and the donkey is 
            working in the service of the people. What's more, the time will 
            soon be at hand when this same animal will begin to be used in our 
            country in place of the lion. Remember our government means peace. 
            We keep order and prosperity throughout the country by means of 
            wisdom and love. So for the present, we have no reason to fight each 
            other. But when my day of governing is over, a ruler from a 
            different family will come and found a new dynasty. With a much 
            higher proportion of human blood in his veins, he will not be 
            satisfied merely to rule with wisdom, but will also set out to 
            conquer neighbouring countries. The time is coming when the power of 
            our country will no longer be based on knowledge and selfless love, 
            but on cold, crude, brute force—and the good, the true and the 
            beautiful will be shoved into the background. Then this zebra-like 
            animal will play a great role in the life of the world. It is an 
            obedient animal, and even if it isn't as strong as the lion, it has 
            the advantage of willingly participating with people in their wars, 
            something no other animal would do without becoming wild and 
            dangerous itself.  'But in the course of some more thousands of years 
            people will progress to the point of discovering how to make their 
            chariots go without animals. All the secrets of creation were known 
            to the high race of the Sons of God. They knew how to liberate their 
            vehicles from the gravitational force of the earth and guide them 
            with the power of thought. They left many sketches and drawings of 
            these vehicles which were able to fly because of their lack of 
            weight, and some of the Sons of God preserved these sketches on 
            specially treated palm leaves, taking them away to another part of 
            the earth when their original homeland was destroyed. Some initiates 
            are still guarding them there today, and they will continue to be 
            guarded for some six to eight thousand years to come. By that time 
            people will have discovered quite different methods for moving their 
            vehicles on the earth and in the air. To be sure, not with the power 
            of thought, and for this reason their systems of locomotion will not 
            be as certain and free of danger as those of the Sons of God. Still 
            later, people will discover all the secrets of the Sons of God, even 
            the last secrets of  life. Then this period of development will have gone 
            through a full cycle.'  'Father, now please tell me about my future.'  Once again father looks at me with such a strange, 
            sad glance. Then he draws me closer to himself, and with a voice 
            which clearly betrays his controlled sadness, he says: 'My dear 
            child, I have already talked about your future, but you just didn't 
            recognize it as your future. This together with the fact that 
            you can only see a curtain of mist when you try to see your future 
            is proof that the world self—God—does not want to show you 
            your future for good reasons. How could I go against the will of 
            God? Be satisfied that it's better for you not to know your future. 
            If you knew it, you couldn't carry out your present tasks and duties 
            properly. One thing I can tell you is that we'll both go through 
            these coming events together, although not in each other's 
            physical presence. From time to time we'll have to reincarnate 
            ourselves, but not simultaneously and not at the same place. There 
            will also be a time during which you will have to live and work on 
            earth while I'll be living in the world of spiritual energy, working 
            in the atmosphere of the earth in the same way as Ptahhotep and many 
            other Sons of God. But in your dreams you'll often meet us ... the 
            details are really not so important, because no matter what happens 
            in your future, through the unity of the higher self you'll always 
            be in touch with us.'  I put my arms about him and repeat contentedly: 
            'Yes, Father, I belong to you, and I know you'll never leave me.'
             'We'll never leave you!' father repeats slowly and 
            seriously.  When evening comes father and I sit out on our 
            terrace, enjoying the magnificent sunset over the sea. While the sun 
            sinks lower and lower in the west, father points to the broad 
            estuary of the river and says: 'You see far out there where the 
            waves of the sea are rolling in—some day—thousands of years from 
            now, there'll be solid land there covered with cities and houses and 
            all the comings and goings of people. The Nile is always sweeping a 
            lot of earth along with it, so the shore line is gradually moving 
            out further and further into the sea. Thousands of years ago there 
            was only water where we are now, and some thousands of years from 
            now there will be land right out to where you see that boat with its 
            sail to the wind. The face of the earth is not only changed by 
            catastrophe and upheavals, but also by the slow working of water.'
             While he is talking, the sun slowly goes down. The 
            sky is alight with all the colours of the rainbow, changing with 
            every moment. Then the sun disappears below the horizon, and soon 
            we're surrounded by pitch darkness. Only the stars shine like big 
            diamonds.  For a long time we stay out on the terrace, and I 
            tell father that I can now make telepathic contacts. Father wants to 
            try me out to see whether I have my higher brain centres under 
            control. He tries to communicate a thought to me through becoming 
            identical with me in spirit. Both of us are proud and pleased that I 
            am able to repeat aloud his silent messages. I have progressed to 
            the point—at least after sundown—of being able to make contact with 
            Ptahhotep too. I now concentrate on him, and his body, his 
            noble face, and especially his eyes rise up before my inward sight. 
            Then I hear his communications like an echo within myself. I hear 
            his familiar and dearly beloved voice as if it were my own inner 
            voice. Then the picture of him within me slowly fades, and I realize 
            that he is isolating himself from me. He is concentrating on 
            something else.  Suddenly I feel in the mood to try and contact Ima 
            too. As I concentrate on him for a few moments, a picture of him 
            appears in my consciousness. I see him, his angelically beautiful 
            face, and watch him smile and tell me without words that he 
            understands me and is very happy about my progress. Dear Ima! I 
            always feel his brotherly help and love within me.  Early the following morning we are out on the 
            terrace again; for sunrise, if anything, is even more beautiful than 
            sunset. It is still dark, and the sky is a deep blue, almost black. 
            Suddenly, almost without warning, the upper rim of the sun appears, 
            and with it a magnificent reddish purple colour, suffusing the whole 
            vault of the sky until all is aglow. This is followed by a gorgeous 
            interplay of colours, all kinds and shades and tints—from the 
            brightest flame-yellow all the way to deep dark blue. Seeing the 
            firmament alight with the handiwork of God fills my soul with 
            ineffable joy, and a feeling of infinite peace and well-being fills 
            my body with new vital force. How often I admire the sunrise from 
            the terrace of our little house! Pure joy and delight feed the very 
            depths of my soul. And my joy is all the greater because when we're 
            here father belongs to me alone. Here he is not the Pharaoh, only my 
            father, my best friend and companion.  31
           
            BO-GHAR AND THE STAFF OF LIFE One afternoon after a storm that has lasted for 
            several days, when the wind has abated but the waves are still 
            running high, father and I row out some distance from shore to enjoy 
            the waves that rock our little boat to and fro.  Suddenly I notice something being battered about by 
            the waves. It appears and disappears, rises up and sinks out of 
            sight again.  'Father,' I cry out. 'Look! What's that over there?'
             Father glances off to where I am pointing. 'Let's 
            row over there!' he answers and starts pulling with might and main. 
            As we approach, we can see that what we've spotted is probably the 
            wrecked hulk of a sailing vessel. We see broken planks still 
            clinging together, the snapped-off mast with its sail in shreds.  Then I spy a human form clinging to the wreckage.
             'Look, a child,' father shouts, starting to row even 
            faster! It seems as if we'll never get there, but finally we do. A 
            haggard boy of about ten years of age clings desperately to the 
            broken planks. He's already half dead, his legs hang down limply, 
            and the waves pound his body to and fro. His eyes are quite 
            expressionless and his hands, which seem to be glued to the planks, 
            are all that keep him from sliding off into the water.  Father tries to manoeuvre our boat quite close, but 
            the waves keep beating us back, until finally he is able to seize a 
            piece of wreckage and pull us up close. As he does so, I loosen the 
            child's cramped hands, then together we draw him into our boat. He 
            seems to be unconscious. Father starts to row for shore as fast as 
            possible. Our servants have noticed what has happened and set out in 
            several boats to meet us. Father carries the child into the house. 
            Then the servants hold up the boy by his feet so that his head is 
            hanging down. Then with powerful, rhythmic steady strokes father 
            squeezes the boy's abdomen and ribs together in order to force out 
            any water the boy may have swallowed. Finally father has the 
            servants lay out the boy on his own bed, then sends them all out.
             Now I witness something very strange: father goes to 
            a little casket which I have always seen in his room at home and 
            which he has always taken on his travels wherever he went. He takes 
            out a little staff resembling a cross with a circle on top f. He 
            holds the staff with this ring firmly in his hand and begins to make 
            passes with it over the boy's body, moving it in one direction after 
            another. I can see that father is concentrating very intently, 
            directing all his attention to the boy. First he holds the staff at 
            the top of the boy's head for a little while, then draws it slowly 
            over his face down to his heart, stopping there for a moment. Then 
            moving forward from the region of heart, father draws imaginary 
            lines over the boy's trunk to his genitals, then repeating the same 
            movements starting out from the top of his head, he moves the staff 
            along the boy's arms and out to his hands, then finally over his 
            legs and down to his feet.  Father has scarcely touched the boy's head with the 
            little staff when the child draws a deep breath. Then, as father 
            moves the staff over different parts of the boy's body, he goes on 
            breathing regularly, and his body twitches and quivers. Gradually he 
            comes to, and by the time father is making his last passes, the boy 
            suddenly opens his eyes, sits bolt upright, to all appearances in 
            perfect health. Then without warning, he falls to his knees before 
            father, flings his arms around father's legs, lays his forehead on 
            father's feet, and cries and sobs bitterly. Father helps him up, 
            takes him on to his lap and dries his tears with tender loving care.
             The boy speaks a language I can only understand 
            through spiritual contact.  My telepathic exercises have developed my finer 
            organs of sense to the point that I can understand the gist 
            of his story without having to understand his words. The boy tells 
            us that his father, who was a merchant in a distant land, set out to 
            bring a shipload of goods to Egypt in order to sell them there. He 
            took his wife and son along with him so they would be able to see 
            what Egypt was like. After several weeks of travel, they were 
            overtaken by a terrible storm. After days of struggle with the 
            raging elements, the ship broke up and sank. His mother and several 
            sailors disappeared in the waves right away, while he, his father 
            and some of the sailors clung to a few pieces of wreckage. Then he 
            saw his father, too, slip off into the water and go down. He clung 
            tightly to whatever he could lay his hands on ... and that was all 
            he could remember.  'Father,' I say when the child has finished his 
            story and begins to calm down, while I see in his spiritual 
            radiation the gaping emptiness of stark panic and desperation, 'the 
            boy doesn't belong to anybody now. Let me take him and have him 
            brought up and educated. Menu will teach him the language and 
            everything he needs to know as far as behaviour is concerned. He can 
            get schooling and training in the temple. You see what a pure soul 
            he has and how intelligent he is. I'll take him to the temple so he 
            can develop his abilities. We'll see how he develops there and what 
            he shows a talent for. Maybe he'll become a priest. Please let me 
            take care of him.'  'Good,' father answers. 'You may keep him. The fact 
            that you saw him and found him in the waves is a part of the 
            fate that has linked you and him together for aeons and ages. 
            According to the inner laws of fate, he belongs to y0u.'  While we are yet talking about him, the boy looks at 
            us. Then, as if he had understood, he falls to his knees before me, 
            throws his arms around my knees, and gives every indication of 
            gratitude and confidence. I take the boy's hand and turn him over to 
            a servant who gets him clothes and food. He eats with such a healthy 
            appetite that it's hard to imagine he was completely exhausted-only 
            a few minutes earlier. As soon as a bed is made up for him in a 
            corner of my room, he drops off to sleep instantly.  Father and I go out on to the terrace. The surface 
            of the sea is gradually quieting down, and we enjoy the play of 
            colours at sunset.  'Father,' I ask, 'what kind of force is there in 
            this little staff of yours? What was it made of and how? It affected 
            that boy like magic. He was half dead, yet after your treatment with 
            the staff, he was filled with new vital energy.'  After some moments' silence, father replies; 'Yes, 
            the youngster really was filled with new vital energy. The secret of 
            this staff is one of the secrets of initiation. We have to keep it 
            secret because the staff can not only transmit vital force, but also 
            can kill. If the secret of the staff were to fall into the hands of 
            ignorant and self-seeking people, they would immediately use it 
            wrongly.  The time is already very near at hand when you'll 
            receive your initiation, and you've learned to keep silence. That's 
            why I let you look on while I treated the boy with the staff. 
            Ptahhotep will give you a thorough explanation of the secret of the 
            staff, and after you're initiated he'll teach you how to use it too. 
            Tomorrow we'll go back to the city, and you will report to him 
            again. You've made great progress in self control. Your initiation 
            is near at hand. After your final instructions, you'll get it.'  I am silent with inward emotion. My initiation is 
            near at hand! The long years of preparatory exercises will at last 
            be over, and I am to be admitted into the secret sanctuary of the 
            temple. Initiated!  In silence—and in a deep spiritual stillness—father 
            and I watch the glorious, ever-changing drama of the sunset.  Our few happy days of freedom are over so soon! 
            Again, we are in the city, in the palace. I take the child—the poor 
            little bird that has lost its nest—into my chambers and tell Menu 
            what has happened. Menu's good, kindly heart goes out to the boy, 
            and she treats him as if he were her own child. He points to himself 
            and says, 'Bo-Ghar', and when we call him this, he rewards us with a 
            happy smile. He has a fine soul. His body is slender, full of life 
            and fire, resilient, limber and strong. He picks up everything 
            easily. He learns new words and expressions in our language after 
            hearing them only once.  In the evening I go to Ptahhotep for some more 
            instruction.  As I walk there with Menu along the route that has 
            become so familiar to me, I reflect that Ima no longer needs to wait 
            at the door to guide me to Ptahhotep's reception room. I know the 
            way—yes even my feet know the way to Ptahhotep. Yet at the temple 
            door, I see Ima's magnificent figure appear out of the darkness. His 
            pure radiance fills the air all around him. I cast a stolen glance 
            at his handsome body and check myself to see whether I could feel a 
            physical attraction for him. No! I could never love him physically! 
            I feel the loving tie that binds us is so deep it makes us 
            completely one. How could a person love and desire himself 
            physically? Ima too is descended from the race of the Sons of God; 
            he too has the elongated cranial form. He is pure, lofty, like an 
            angel—spirituality personified. No, he could never love me 
            physically, nor I him! Joyously I ask him, 'How did you know I was 
            coming? Did Ptahhotep perhaps send you to meet me?'  Ima smiles, 'Haven't you got used to the fact that a 
            spiritually-awakened person doesn't need external sources of 
            information in order to know what a kindred spirit is doing and 
            where he is? I concentrated on you in order to find out whether you 
            had already returned to the city with the Pharaoh, so I could 
            prepare your next tasks for you. As I did so I found you were on 
            your way here. Ptahhotep is expecting you. Come in. Tomorrow we'll 
            be working together again.'  Ima goes and I enter Ptahhotep's reception room.  Through my long exercises in self observation and 
            self control, and through my long efforts to master the twelve sets 
            of twin characteristics I have learned not to transmit my joy into 
            my body; so instead of throwing my arms about Ptahhotep's neck, I 
            radiate all my love and joy through nerve centres that carry my 
            consciousness—especially through my eyes.  I bow low before him.  He understands and sees my conscious control over my 
            expressions of love, that is, over the forces working within me. I 
            understand and see that he understands and sees ... and we 
            are united in spirit. Oh! This unity is a thousandfold greater 
            happiness than a physical embrace! I am blissfully happy in this 
            perfect unity and wait to learn what he has to tell me. For a 
            while, his eyes rest upon me, full of love and joy. His glance goes 
            through and through me, unhindered. Finally he says, 'The time has 
            come for you to learn the secret of the staff and the use of our 
            other instruments. Your father knew that you were ready to learn 
            these secrets; that's why he took the opportunity to show you the 
            life-giving aspect of the staff. From now on you are to come to me 
            each evening so that I can transmit the last secret revelations to 
            you.'  The next day I am in the temple early, and we are 
            all happy about seeing each other again. I love all the neophytes, 
            and the master of the neophyte school too—this noble, loving person 
            who never makes an unnecessary movement and never allows us to 
            indulge in any lost motion either. Through his methods we develop 
            wonderful control of the body. Through these exercises I have 
            learned to transmit creative force corresponding to my degree of 
            development—the power of my consciousness—into all the various parts 
            and organs of my body. This has made my body so conscious and so 
            vitalized that I can feel every part of it as distinctly as I can 
            the inside of my mouth.  Little by little I have learned, not only to feel 
            all my organs exactly, but also to control them consciously. For 
            example, I can now control my heart beat. To do this I have to 
            concentrate on a particular point in my body, namely the seat of the 
            force that compels me to inhale. When we exhale all the air in our 
            lungs and then don't inhale again, something forces us to 
            inhale—forces us until we absolutely must inhale again. 
            What it is that forces us to inhale is harder to discover than
            what it is not. Certainly it isn't the nose, which doesn't 
            actually breathe at all, but is merely an opening through which we 
            can breathe. It isn't our lungs either, for we can clearly feel they 
            were merely working instruments in the breathing process.  Finally we discover that a certain force, located in 
            the region of the heart, causes us to inhale and controls our 
            breathing. When I think myself into this point, I can speed up or 
            slow down my heart beat at will, through the power of imagination. 
            Similarly, I have learned, step by step, to bring all the organs of 
            my body under the control of my will. It's wonderful to have so much 
            control over the body. Mentuptah is very satisfied with my progress. 
            He nods and gives me a warm and friendly smile when he notices me 
            again among the neophytes this morning. After our group exercises, I 
            ask Ima: 'Ima, you've promised me a new concentration exercise.'  'Yes, listen,' says Ima. 'Up to now you've practised 
            your concentration exercises combined with slow, regular breathing 
            in which you have inhaled the air and then you have 
            exhaled it again. From now on when you sit down to your 
            concentration exercises, you ought to practise them differently. As 
            long as you inhale and exhale, you're identifying yourself 
            with your body. But the truth of the matter is that your body 
            is really doing the inhaling and exhaling, not you. The body 
            lives because the higher self—God—breathes his own breath 
            into it. We're all alive because our physical being inhales the 
            breath of God. You know ) that God is the self in
            you. Thus your body inhales your self— you—and that gives 
            the body life. As long as you believe that you are the one 
            that's breathing, you're identical in your consciousness with 
            your body instead of with yourself. On the other hand when you 
            experience in your consciousness that your body is j inhaling 
            yourself and then again in breathing out, giving your self freedom, 
            you can experience the marvellous transition out of the person—the 
            animated body you have been up to the present—into your true self.
             'From now on as you practise try to realize that not
            you are inhaling and exhaling, but you are being inhaled 
            and exhaled by your body. With every breath you'll have the 
            feeling, during inhaling, that you are filling your body with 
            life-giving power and your body is inhaling you; and in 
            exhaling, that you are withdrawing yourself from the body and 
            remaining separate from it within yourself until the next 
            breath. When you succeed in doing this, you'll experience something 
            similar to the death of the body when you withdraw yourself from it 
            and your body exhales you for the last time. Practise this a while 
            and tell me how you get on.'  As Ima is about to go, I ask him to stay a moment, 
            and I tell him how, with father's help, I found little Bo-Ghar and 
            saved him.  'Ima,' I tell him, 'I'd like to bring the boy to the 
            temple for his training and education. Would you be willing to spend 
            some time with him to see what he is particularly talented for?'  'Yes, indeed. I'll be glad to speak to Mentuptah, 
            and he will take him in. He can live in the temple and get his 
            training with the other children.'  'No, Ima,' I answer. 'I want to keep the boy with 
            me. He has something infinitely loving and pure about him. I'll 
            bring him to the temple every day and take him back in the evening. 
            I'll bring him along tomorrow.'  The next day Bo-Ghar comes to the temple with me. He 
            doesn't know where I'm taking him, because he doesn't yet understand 
            what we say to him, but he comes along anyway, obedient, with 
            touching confidence and a radiant face. He is happy to be able to 
            come along with Menu and me. I loved Bo-Ghar from the very moment I 
            first saw him half-drowned in the water. He is fond of me too, and 
            it's easy to see he is only really happy when he is allowed to sit 
            at my feet.  In the temple I take him through the long colonnade 
            into the school of neophytes where talented children are getting 
            their training. At first he doesn't want to let go of my hand. I 
            understand that he's afraid I want to leave him here. I embrace him 
            warmly and tell him it's perfectly all right for him to stay here, 
            for I'll come and take him back to the palace with me in the 
            evening. He doesn't understand my words and looks at me anxiously 
            with big questioning eyes. As he sees that I'm not taking leave of 
            him, he apparently quiets his fears somewhat and stays behind.  When evening comes and I go to get him, I find 
            Bo-Ghar is getting along famously with the other children. Making 
            ample use of hands and feet, he is telling them something while they 
            listen to his tale with the greatest interest, as if they understood 
            him. When Bo-Ghar sees me, his eyes light up joyously, he runs to 
            meet me, and throws his arms around my neck. I am delighted to see 
            that he feels already so much at home.  From this point on, every morning finds the three of 
            us going to the temple: Menu, Bo-Ghar and I. As the weeks and months 
            go by, little Bo-Ghar learns our language so well that he rapidly 
            gains ability and fluency in expressing himself.  He takes part in the early morning physical 
            exercises under the direction of Mentuptah. His body is alive to a 
            surprising degree and the conductivity of his nerves is 
            extraordinarily great. He does the exercises with tremendous 
            concentration, revealing a great and innate control over the body. 
            Ima loves him and devotes as much attention to him as possible. And 
            the lonely little lad who has lost his relatives takes to Ima like a 
            brother, with all his heart. He is grateful for every kind word. In 
            the temple the heads of the school have found out that Bo-Ghar shows 
            little inclination towards the sciences but lots of talent for 
            drawing and modelling. That's why Imhotep, the great artist, has 
            taken him into his studio as his youngest apprentice. Imhotep 
            predicts a great future for him.  Every evening Bo-Ghar waits at the temple gate for 
            me, and on the way back to the palace he tells me what's happened, 
            what he has learned and what he has done with the other children. If 
            Bo-Ghar hadn't found his way so deeply into Menu's good heart, she 
            would feel offended that he is allowed to talk to me on our way back 
            to the palace because I never used to allow her the same privilege. 
            When there were only the two of us, I made her keep silent so she 
            would not disturb my train of thought. But she seems to take it as a 
            matter of course that I allow him privileges I denied her.  32  PTAHHOTEP'S INSTRUCTION: THE SEVEN OCTAVES OF 
            VIBRATION AND THE ARK OF THE COVENANT  I stand before Ptahhotep and listen devoutly to his 
            words: Today, I shall explain to you the laws on which the staff's 
            miraculous effect is based. These are, of course, simple laws of 
            nature. God is everywhere present and the emanation of His 
            omnipresence is manifest in the visible, material world as natural 
            law. Therefore, nothing can happen outside natural laws. Yet these 
            laws differ from one stage of development to another.  'Different laws apply to the spiritual, the mental, 
            and the material world. And in the material world we find different 
            laws at work in one and the same form of matter, depending on the 
            magnitudes involved. For example, it is a law of nature for the 
            surface of a body of water at rest to be horizontal. But this law is 
            valid only within certain magnitudes. A drop of water in the calyx 
            of a flower has a spherical shape, and a microscopic being living in 
            this miniature world would come to the conclusion that water always 
            has a spherical shape. Why? Because the relation between the surface 
            tension of water and the power which forces water into the 
            horizontal is very different in a drop—that is, in a small 
            quantity—from what it is in a large body of water. And yet, the same 
            laws are at work.  'People know very little about the laws of nature, 
            with the exception of those they have experienced in daily life. 
            They have become accustomed to these and call them "laws of nature". 
            And having found names for them they believe they know the true 
            essence of the laws of nature. They accept these laws and their 
            effects as a matter of course. But when they are suddenly confronted 
            by some phenomenon they know nothing about, they immediately speak 
            of "miracles" or "magic".  'People do not realize that these forces are no less 
            laws of nature than those to which they have become accustomed and 
            think they know, even though they haven't the vaguest notion about 
            their true character. For man doesn't know why a plant will grow 
            from a seed or why a new being will evolve from an impregnated cell. 
            Neither do people know what "insemination" really means and why, 
            after insemination, the cell will divide and subdivide. They have no 
            idea why this subdividing process is repeated again and again, not 
            even stopping at birth, going on and on until a full-grown 
            individual has developed out of that one single first cell ... then 
            still going on until this chain reaction slows down by itself and 
            gradually gives way to a decline. But since people experience this 
            daily, they take it for granted and aren't the least bit surprised 
            at it. Still, this growth of a plant out of a seed, the birth of a 
            child, death, the different effects of the winds blowing from 
            different directions, and many other experiences of everyday life 
            are just as "miraculous" as the effect and the secret of this staff 
            and the other "miracles" and the "magic power" of the initiated.  'For you truly to understand the forces used by the 
            initiated and applied through this staff of life you will first have 
            to learn a number of things.  'When we spoke about the tree of knowledge of good 
            and evil you learned that everything which has taken on material 
            form is visible and perceivable Only because it has fallen out of 
            perfect unity and perfect equilibrium. But from this state of 
            disjunction, everything tends eternally to return to unison and 
            balance. "Equilibrium" means complete repose, motionlessness. On the 
            other hand, "to have become something"—that is, to have taken on 
            visible, tangible form—is identical with loss of balance and with 
            the constant urge to regain this equilibrium. It means incessant 
            unrest, with continual movement. Should this constant motion cease, 
            even for only a moment, all creation would suddenly be transformed 
            into spiritual energy, that is, materially destroyed.  'All energy, all the forces of the universe, are 
            movements which emanate from one point—their own centre—and radiate 
            in circular waves in all directions, manifesting themselves as 
            vibrations or oscillations. These manifestations of force cease only 
            when the forces that have got out of balance regain their primordial 
            state of equilibrium, the divine unity. Hence when we speak of the 
            "primordial state" we mean the state in which all material phenomena 
            have ceased to exist. In its true essence, matter, too, is motion, 
            and if this motion comes to a stop, matter must necessarily cease to 
            exist. As long as the three-dimensional, material world exists its 
            immutable law is that of unrest, of movement.  'The fact that the creative force manifests itself 
            on each and every level of innumerable possibilities means there are 
            countless different wave lengths, wave forms, and frequencies. And 
            as long as we are in the body, with its limited perceptive ability, 
            we can perceive only a certain number of these wave forms because 
            our organs of sense are limited. Whether some form of vibration 
            appears to us as "immaterial energy" or as solid "matter" depends 
            upon our own idea and the impression of something which is basically 
            nothing but "movement", "vibration", or "frequency".  'The shorter the waves in which a form of energy 
            manifests itself the less our consciousness records a sensation of 
            matter. To the vibrations that are transmitted directly to our 
            consciousness by our organs of sense we give names according to the 
            sensations we feel: matter, sound, electricity, heat, taste, smell, 
            light. The still higher, immaterial energies and radiations, 
            perceptible only by means of our brain and nerve centres, we call 
            thought waves, idea waves. Beyond them there are still higher, more 
            penetrating rays and frequencies, all the way up to the very 
            highest all-pervading frequencies of the divine-creative power: life 
            itself! We can only perceive these frequencies as a state of 
            consciousness.  'So, throughout the universe, countless varieties of 
            vibrations are at work, ranging from the shortest to the longest 
            wave length. Every form of creation, beginning with the celestial 
            bodies and ranging all the way down to the tiniest monocellular 
            creature—all the myriad manifestations of creation are the effects 
            of various forms of these rays. We live in these various rays 
            whether we know it or not; even more, these forms of energy have 
            built and formed us human beings and are constantly at work in 
            our body, our mind, and our entire being. The whole universe 
            consists of these various vibrations. The source of these creative 
            vibrations we call God.  'God himself stands above all manifestations of life 
            and rests in himself in absolute equilibrium without time and 
            without space. But he is constantly radiating himself out into 
            material forms in order to give these forms life. As God is 
            omnipresent and fills the entire universe, everything that is in the 
            universe is penetrated and filled by God. Nothing can exist without 
            being in God and without God's penetrating it, as God is everywhere 
            present and nothing can displace or dislodge him from his own 
            presence. Consequently, every point offers a possibility that God 
            may manifest himself through it, and everything that exists in our 
            perceptible world carries this point as its own centre within 
            itself. From this point, there began its first manifestation, its 
            creation, its fall from equilibrium.  'This aspect of God who creates the material world 
            and gives it life by penetrating it, that is, the actual life hi us 
            and in all creatures, we call the "higher self". Expressions 
            like "God", "creator", "universal self", "higher self" or the 
            "creative principle" all mean one and the same divinity 
            in its various aspects.  'The energies radiating from the centre are still 
            highly spiritual in the centre and of the highest frequencies. But 
            the farther out they radiate from the centre, the more material they 
            become ... until these radiating energies are gradually  changed into matter. In this way the radiating power 
            limits itself, and at the edge of manifestation farthest removed 
            from the centre it becomes a hard, material rind or crust. For this 
            reason, the picture—the "name"—of God who manifests himself in the 
            visible world is a circle, an inner circle of higher powers 
            surrounded by a hard, material rind or crust.  ![]()
 'Expressed in letters, the symbol is OM.  'All creatures, from the central suns down to 
            monocellular beings, are built according to this principle. Look at 
            a cross-section of our earth. In the centre, the mighty forces are 
            still in the evolutionary stage of the fire circle. Next come the 
            gaseous regions, then those of the molten or liquid circles, and the 
            outer-form is the rind of hard matter. But I want to tell you too 
            that another opposing force—centripetal force—is also active at the 
            same time, drawing all material  manifestations inward towards itself. And if hard 
            matter were not sufficiently resistant, all manifestations of life 
            would be drawn into their own centres and disappear. Even our earth, 
            with all the forms of life upon it, would suffer this fate. The 
            resistance of matter prevents this from happening, and only for this 
            reason is it possible at all for creation to exist and life to have 
            come forth here on this hard, material crust of the earth. Don't 
            forget the resistance of matter, because we shall talk about it 
            again.  'Here is another example to illustrate the inner 
            structure of material forms: a section through the spinal column of 
            any vertebrate shows the same construction, the extremely fine 
            substance of the marrow of the back bone carrying the creative power 
            of life, developed and protected by the hard crust of bone. Whatever 
            bone you cut—be it skull, vertebra or leg bone—you will find the 
            same cross section.  'If you cut the stem of a plant, you will come upon 
            the same pattern. Have you ever looked at trees after they have been 
            felled? The inner structure of the tree is exactly the same: 
            radiating from the centre are circles of vital energy, fed by the 
            finer matter of the tree's innermost substance. The annual rings 
            reflect the yearly radiation of life in the tree that takes place 
            very spring, surrounded and protected by the outer ring of hard 
            bark.  'Growth always starts from the centre and 
            radiates outward. The innermost source of all powers and 
            manifestations is God.  'This aspect of God, who is clothed in matter and 
            makes living beings out of created forms and which we call the 
            higher self (Logos) is what draws us back into our own 
            centre, since we have fallen from the divine unity, from the state 
            of paradise. It is the heavenly bridegroom for whom the human soul 
            longs. One should never mistake this divine self for the personal 
            "I" which hi itself has no true existence and is merely an imaginary 
            being.  'The vital source behind every form of 
            manifestation, be it a sun, planet, human being, animal, plant life 
            or inorganic matter is one and the same God, the same divine 
            self.  'Although the same God is everywhere present 
            in every creature, he is manifest in countless different variations, 
            because God reveals himself on every single level on which 
            manifestation is possible and the created forms manifested on these 
            various levels reveal only as much of God as each form can 
            consciously experience and bear of the divine creative force, 
            corresponding to its own level. To consciously experience force 
            means being this force and simultaneously radiating it hi all 
            directions, including into one's own body. For this reason, the body 
            too must have adequate power of resistance; otherwise the 
            radiations of the self would burn and destroy it.  'Hence the bodies of the various manifestations of 
            life are not made hi the same way. On the contrary the matter 
            composing them is of different degrees of resistance, corresponding 
            hi each case to the level of consciousness of the manifestation of 
            life concerned. You know that the chemical composition of matter 
            determines which vibrations a body can support. When a body is 
            subjected to a radiation in excess of its resistance, this harms its 
            entire nerve system, and can lead to a nervous breakdown and even to 
            mental derangement. When the number of vibrations of this force 
            exceeds the scope of an octave the force even becomes lethal. This 
            is why, when we want to initiate a person into a higher degree of 
            divine power, we must first prepare his body, subjecting it among 
            other things to a chemical process, in order that the difference 
            will not be more than one octave at the most. Otherwise he dies.  'In the material world there are four levels of 
            manifestation which we call matter, vegetable life, animal life, and 
            human life, depending on the outward appearance and the degree of 
            consciousness attained. Compared with the human being, we can hardly 
            speak at all of the "consciousness" of matter, and yet a crystal may 
            serve to show that matter too has a sort of consciousness. Each 
            level of manifestation of life is characterized by its own degree of 
            consciousness which is one octave removed from the next. Only man 
            has the power to manifest several degrees of consciousness, all the 
            way up to the divine level. If We keep in mind the 
            intervals—octaves—by which we classify levels of evolution, we find 
            that man, as a category, occupies four steps of the great ladder of 
            evolution reaching from earth up to heaven; furthermore we see that 
            each step corresponds to one octave on the scale of vibrations. Man 
            knows about these four steps or degrees and has given them names: 
            man characterized by his intellect; genius, characterized 
            by intuition; prophet, characterized by his wisdom and 
            universal love; and the last and highest degree, that of the God 
            man, characterized by his omniscience and omnipotence.  'Thus, in the material world, we find four 
            manifestations which together reveal seven octaves of vibration.  'Every creature emits the vibrations of which it is 
            made, that is, those which it consciously supports. 
            Matter, the very lowest degree of consciousness, manifests 
            itself only through contraction, cooling off, and hardening.  'The plant manifests itself on two levels; 
            the material level and the level of force—vegetative force—that 
            gives life to it. The plant manifests material vibrations 
            unconsciously; it carries its body like a dress, but its level of 
            consciousness is the vegetative level of force giving life to 
            matter. Force manifested on this level has three distinctive aspects 
            by which it can be recognized wherever it appears: the search for 
            food, the taking in of food, and the assimilation or digestion of 
            food.  'The animal manifests three forces, the 
            material, the vegetative and animal. It has a body, it seeks out its 
            food, eats and digests and is conscious on the animal level: it has 
            emotions, instincts, urges, feelings, sympathy, antipathy and 
            desires. The animal is conscious in the third developmental stage, 
            only one degree lower than man.  'The average man stands one octave of 
            vibrations higher: he is conscious on the mental level. He has 
            intellect and the ability to think. But at the same time he 
            manifests the three other levels. On the material, he has a body; on 
            the vegetative, he seeks out his food, eats it and digests it; on 
            the animal, he has emotions, drives, sympathy, antipathy and 
            desires. But his most outstanding characteristic is his intellect. 
            Man thinks consciously.  With the next degree of development, man makes a 
            great jump: he lifts his consciousness out of the world of 
            effects into the plane of causes. He draws on the divine 
            source of the causal plan and manifests this force that appears in 
            his consciousness as intuition. With the help of his intellect and 
            spiritual power* he is able to express his experiences on a higher 
            plane in words and transmit them to his fellow men. He can also 
            prove the existence of his intuition in other arts: without 
            dimensions, in music, as a composer; in two dimensions with lines 
            and colours, as a painter; in three dimensional forms as a sculptor 
            or as a dancer. People call the creative person a genius. He 
            manifests the five octaves of vibration of the material, vegetative 
            animal, mental and causal forces.  'The degree of consciousness of the next higher 
            octave of vibrations, in the language of human beings, is called 
            that of a prophet. The prophet manifests all the forces that 
            work on the previously mentioned planes of consciousness, but he is 
            also conscious on the next higher level too, the plane of divine 
            wisdom and universal love. We must be careful never to confuse this 
            universal love, which is manifested on the sixth plane and is a 
            completely spiritual power, with the "love" of the third, animal 
            plane which is the manifestation of animal instincts. This latter 
            "love" is a vibration operating three levels lower at the source of 
            which is the urge to propagate the species. Such "love" is desire 
            for possession and always only seeks the body. It forces a person to 
            come close to the loved one, and embrace, kiss, and hug him or 
            her—in a word—to possess.  'Whoever is subject to this kind of love is still 
            living in his consciousness in the condition of dividedness and 
            separation and seeks a complementary physical partner in order to 
            find satisfaction. This love always seeks to take, to have
            something, to possess. Love in the sixth plane of 
            manifestation, the love of the prophet, does not come from a 
            condition of division, but from the primordial condition of divine
            unity I Hence, this love is universal, always giving, 
            never taking, needs no supplement, no physical manifestation, but 
            always radiates from the consciousness of divine all-unity. 
            People who are conscious on this plane do not want to possess 
            anybody; they feel themselves one with the infinite all.  'The seventh and most perfect manifestation of 
            God is the completely conscious man: the God-man. All other forms of 
            revelation manifest only transformed vibrations, only part of God. A 
            God-man is a person who manifests God— his own divine 
            self—completely and perfectly through a perfect consciousness; one 
            who experiences and radiates the divine creative forces in their 
            primordial untransformed vibrations and frequencies. He is supremely 
            conscious; no part of him is unconscious.  'Only man has the ability to master and to radiate 
            all seven octaves of vibration, as the nervous centres corresponding 
            to the seven octaves of transformed and untransformed creative power 
            exist in his nervous system. On the other hand, he is only able to 
            radiate vibrations on the levels on which he has become conscious, 
            because until he becomes conscious on a given level, the 
            corresponding nerve centres remain in a latent condition. Thus the 
            average human being will radiate vibrations up to the fourth plane, 
            the genius up to the fifth, the prophet up to the sixth, and only 
            the God-man is able consciously to radiate all seven octaves and to 
            radiate the divine creative power, according to his own will, in its 
            untransformed form or to transform it, to change it, and transmit it 
            in lower (transformed) frequencies.  'Your father's staff that you have seen consists of 
            a material—a kind of brass —that has the power of transmitting the 
            radiation corresponding to every plane. It is so constructed 
            that, according to the will of the user, it can transmit 
            untransformed radiations, either diminished or amplified as desired 
            by the user.  'The staff can be a blessing or a curse. This 
            depends on who uses it. An initiated person is able to radiate, in 
            any desired degree, all forces of creation— from the highest divine 
            forces to the lowest ultra-material forces with this staff, because 
            within his own being he possesses all these forces and can 
            consciously transmit them to the staff. Out of the whole gamut of 
            these vibrations, the human being with his organs of sense, can 
            perceive only a part. Vibrations either above or below this part are 
            ones he can only experience as an emotional condition. Thus for 
            example, he experiences the very highest divine frequencies as 
            universal love. On the other hand, the very lowest frequencies, 
            those of ultra-matter, are lower than the frequencies which 
            our eyes and sensory nerves perceive as matter. As they are outside 
            our scale of sensory perception, we experience them in our emotions 
            as hate. An initiated person will always use the staff properly and 
            always radiate the force needed to create something good ... a 
            blessing. The ultra material vibration he will use when necessary as 
            an invisible, insulating, impenetrable protective wall. With the 
            staff the initiated can dominate all forces of nature, amplify them 
            or neutralize them.  'Every creature on earth possesses these powers, but 
            only hi a form corresponding to his degree of development. He 
            utilizes these powers too, but is not conscious of them. Or have you 
            ever seen a person who gave thought to how it is possible to raise 
            his feet or his arms? Or that he could—even though for only a short 
            time—remove his whole body from the earth ... by jumping? Lift your 
            arm and observe how you do it. Isn't it true that you contract your 
            muscles and they lift your arm? Every movement of your body is 
            brought about with a contraction of your muscles. But what contracts 
            your muscles? Think a minute, my daughter, what?'  'My will, Father.'  'Right. Your will. But if I ask you what your will 
            is, can you give me an answer?'  'Father, I have often observed what happens when I
            want something. But I have only been able to notice that when 
            I want something, I can send out a force and give this force 
            direction. For example, as you just said, if I want to raise my arm 
            from its relaxed hanging position—it hangs because the earth is 
            attracting it—then this force which flows out of me through my will 
            flows into my arm and forces my muscles to contract and through this 
            to raise my arm.'  'Very true,' says Ptahhotep, 'By virtue of the fact 
            that your will power has flowed into your arm and muscles, you have
            conquered the enormous gravitational power of the earth on 
            your arm. This is true when you jump too, but only for a short time, 
            because your will power is only greater than the earth's 
            gravitational pull for a short time. So you see time consumes your 
            will power transformed into physical power. Time does that! And 
            space? You've used your power to raise your arm, or your body, in 
            altitude, to remove it from the earth, hence to move it 
            further in space. Thus you see that your power is consumed by 
            two great factors: time and space. If you could 
            amplify your will power and store it within your body, you could 
            conquer the earth's gravitational pull for a longer time and remain 
            at a greater distance from the earth. You could glide through the 
            air I You can't do that now because you haven't yet developed 
            consciousness on this divine plane. The initiated, on the other 
            hand, who are conscious on the divine plane, can draw directly on 
            this infinite eternal source of power, without transforming it, and 
            when they wish, float through the air just as long as they direct 
            their will power against the gravitational pull of the earth.  'The initiated person knows all vibrations and 
            possesses consciously developed organs with which to use these 
            powers. You know, for example, the power of thought with which we 
            communicate telepathically. These powers too we control through a 
            corresponding higher organ of our brain. Human beings don't even 
            know they have such organs. The initiated is able to radiate the 
            very highest of all powers, the divine, creative power. This is the 
            power and radiation of life, of eternal being. The 
            entire universe is alive and continues to exist by virtue of this 
            power. To make conscious use of it lies only within the capabilities 
            of the God-man, the only creature that is, in his 
            consciousness, identical with God and radiates this power 
            from his God-consciousness, his cosmic all-consciousness. No other 
            creature could endure this power consciously.  'Every force has its materialization on earth, and 
            we therefore find that corresponding to all forces and vibrations 
            there is a form of matter that has the resistive strength to endure 
            it and transmit it, or even has the ability to store it and 
            subsequently radiate it during a given length of time. What people 
            call this matter is of no significance. Out of it are made the 
            bodies of creatures and forms of manifestation corresponding to the 
            various levels of consciousness. But this is true not only of the 
            matter corresponding to their own level of consciousness, but also 
            of the matter that conducts the vibrations below this specific plane 
            of consciousness concerned. The matter of plants, for example, 
            possesses a necessary resistive force for the vibrations of the 
            vegetative life force, and at the same time for the vibrations of 
            the matter, as the plant has a material body. The nerves and the 
            bodies of animals carry within themselves the animal power 
            corresponding to the animal level, and at the same time the 
            vibrations of the vegetative level an octave lower, as well as the 
            vibrations of the material plane a further octave lower.  'The nerves of the average human being, for example, 
            have sufficient resistance to carry the vibrations of the mental 
            plane as well as the transformed vibrations on each of the planes 
            below—animal, vegetative and material. With the mental energies he
            thinks and is conscious on this level; with the animal 
            energies he feels and experiences all emotional states; the 
            vegetative streams of force give life to his body, and finally his 
            body is built of material forces. And so it goes higher and higher 
            up to the God-man who consciously uses all his brain and nervous 
            centres and is able to direct the very highest vibrations of life, 
            which has its central seat in his spinal column, without 
            transforming them, into his nervous centres and into his body. The 
            material of his body possesses the resistance to carry the very 
            highest, divine force as well as—naturally enough— the transformed 
            vibration of the other six planes of manifestation.  'Thus the bodies of people in the various planes 
            of development, only appear to consist of the same matter. Actually 
            they are composed of different chemical elements whose resistance 
            always corresponds to the level of consciousness of the spirit 
            dwelling within.  'The fact that the body of the God-man is able not 
            only to bear the highest frequencies but also the transformed 
            vibrations of all other octaves, means that there must be a form of 
            matter with the resistive force necessary to withstand and to 
            conduct the divine-creative force as well as all the other 
            transformed frequencies of the lower octaves, without being 
            dematerialized. Hence, the sons of God, in their homeland, 
            invented a material, a kind of brass, of which they constructed 
            devices for storing or radiating, either amplified or diminished, 
            the very highest creative frequencies, either in their original or 
            in transformed manifestation. These devices are so constructed that 
            they keep the creative force in pure unchanged form. Consequently, 
            over a long period, they act as a source of divine power—like 
            life itself. Because the very highest of these devices which 
            carries and radiates the creative force represents a perfect 
            union—as perfect as a marriage—between the divine and the material 
            frequencies— between God and the earth—we call this 
            incredibly powerful conductor of force that is charged with the 
            frequency of the divine self the 'Ark of the covenant'.  'Now you know why we keep these devices so secret. 
            The God-man who has developed his highest abilities can use these 
            devices with impunity, as the ark of the covenant contains and 
            radiates the same force as he himself, the force which he himself 
            is. A person on a lower level, however, if he were merely to 
            touch the ark, would fall over dead momentarily as if struck by 
            lightning. The divine frequencies would instantly burn out his 
            nerves and he would suffer a "shock". The same thing happens when 
            this frequency is liberated from its state of isolation in the 
            spinal column and strikes one's nerves untransformed. The person 
            or animal or even a plant concerned dies immediately. People call 
            this kind of death "a stroke". They sense that some unknown power 
            has struck the person like lightning. This power is the river of 
            life itself which normally is isolated within the spinal column—or 
            within the innermost channel in the case of plants—and normally only 
            flows into the body in suitably transformed condition. This force 
            only breaks out in case of sickness and causes the "stroke".  'For the same reason uninitiated people cannot be 
            allowed in the vicinity of our devices. And even more! As these 
            devices radiate the most powerful energy, we must keep them 
            carefully hidden behind massive walls of rock providing the greatest 
            insulation. Life energy itself has a lethal effect when it strikes a 
            form of matter which doesn't have the necessary resistance. The 
            matter is dematerialized, dissolved.  'The ark and still other tools thus consist of a 
            material which—without being dematerialized—can be charged with the 
            divine-creative energy. The ark radiates untransformed creative 
            energy and has the effect of giving life or destroying it 
            depending on the dosage. This force has the same character of 
            vibration as that of the human will which is capable of conquering 
            everything, including the gravitational pull of the earth even 
            though for only a short time. The ark of the covenant radiates this 
            power magnified a thousand times. And just as the earth through its 
            gravitational pull affects matter and attracts it, we can work 
            against the gravitational pull of the earth in every form of matter 
            without exception and consequently overcome its weight and render it 
            weightless for a shorter or longer period of time. When necessary, 
            we can even do the opposite, i.e. work with the gravitational 
            pull of the earth and increase the weight of an object as much as we 
            want through the ultramaterial rays. In this way even the greatest 
            blocks of stone are rendered weightless for a period of time so that 
            the largest buildings you can think of can be built with the 
            greatest of ease, or the weight of the stones can be increased to 
            such an extent that they sink into the earth. For example, when we 
            want to dig a well, we don't have to dig out the earth. We simply 
            take a stone of suitable size and increase its weight so that it 
            sinks into the earth until it reaches the desired depth.  'With the help of the ark of the covenant, this 
            enormous source of power, we can also transform energies devoid of 
            matter, as for example, the rays of light, into matter. And, 
            inversely, we can dissolve this matter and convert it to energies 
            active during aeons of time.  'Look at this lamp. Just as the sun itself for 
            billions of years has been sending out rays, some of which are 
            converted to rays of light in our atmosphere through transformations 
            of energy, in the same way through the matter being dissolved 
            —dematerialized—in this lamp, energies are created which are 
            converted to rays of light in the air.  'This process could continue in this lamp for ages 
            and ages and consequently it would go on giving light for aeons of 
            time were it not written in the history of the earth that we shall 
            have to leave the earth for thousands of years and destroy all our 
            equipment. Were this not the case, the ignorant sons of men would 
            again cause unspeakable destruction.  'There will be a lot in the remains of our culture 
            which coming generations will not understand. For example, the way 
            we get such a mirror-smooth surface on even the hardest stones. The 
            joints between them fit so accurately there isn't even a crack the 
            size of the thickness of a hair between them. They will be greatly 
            puzzled at how our "slaves", working only "by hand", have been able 
            to cut stones so precisely. Because the sons of men make slaves of 
            their fellow-men, they will believe that we too have put slaves to 
            work. For thousands of years it won't dawn on them that we simply 
            dematerialize the superfluous stone on the surface and are thus able 
            to get hairline accuracy on the edges and faces of even the hardest 
            stones without the slightest human effort. We adjust our instruments 
            to the desired width and depth of the stone and everything beyond 
            the dimensions we want is merely dematerialized. This is very simple 
            as soon as you know the true nature of the different energies 
            including that of matter. But this knowledge is a blessing only in 
            the hands of a knowing person. He knows too that love means life,
            and hate means death. Only initiates of the highest 
            degree can be architects. As a matter of fact, to build with slaves 
            we wouldn't need to be initiates! We don't work with slaves but with 
            the forces of nature.  'Thanks to these instruments of ours we are able to 
            create every form of manifestation. The manifestation depends only 
            on how long and from what distance we put the creative energy to 
            work. The sons of men take it for granted they can come into the 
            temple with their sicknesses and we make them well again. 
            Sickness means that the vibrations of the body have got out of 
            harmony. We restore the inharmonious part of the body to its own 
            proper vibration and the person gets well. Every organ has its own 
            characteristic vibration. This means that every organ is as it is 
            because it has a certain characteristic vibration, and this 
            vibration is constantly acting within it and maintaining it. When 
            this vibration changes, the organ concerned becomes diseased.  'We can also regulate the weather on earth, making 
            clear blue sky or, when necessary, clouds and rain. The sons of men 
            see the lightning, hear the thunder of the pyramid and are happy 
            because they know this means the blessing of rain. They live in the 
            secure knowledge that the temple will take care of all their needs: 
            their health, the rain that blesses them, and even their spiritual 
            well-being.'  'Father of my Soul,' I now ask, 'how do you charge 
            this ark of the covenant with creative energy?'  Ptahhotep looks at me with a penetrating glance and 
            says:  'I can see you already know how we charge the ark of 
            the covenant. I already told you: there is only one source on 
            earth that is able to radiate this power and that is the God-man 
            himself. It is the duty of the high priest to charge the ark with 
            divine-creative power. He either drives his own high power directly 
            into the ark or he achieves the same result with the help of the 
            staff of life through converting an absolutely positive flow 
            of power flowing from his hand at a lower vibration, conducting it 
            through the staff and there converting it into divine-creative 
            power. For in his daily life, even the perfect God-man only radiates 
            creative power in a transformed state. Only when his spiritual 
            forces are concentrated and in his consciousness he is identical 
            with God, only then does the divine force radiate in its 
            primordial vibration. He must therefore be in a condition of cosmic 
            all-consciousness when he wants to radiate the creative force.  If the uninitiated sons of men were to see him in 
            this condition they would run away terrified as at such times the 
            God-man radiates such celestial, divine light that ordinary people 
            can't stand the sight of him. If uninitiated people were to touch an 
            initiate in this divine condition of being, they would momentarily 
            fall over dead, just as if they had touched the ark of the covenant.
             'Thus when an initiate radiates his rays of life for 
            healing purposes, he withdraws into a state of concentration such 
            that his radiation can be borne by people without harm; that is the 
            power he directs to the- appropriate nerve centres he raises up to 
            the level of creative power with the help of the staff. For the 
            staff is so constructed that it can not only conduct the rays but 
            also transmit them in a transformed state, amplified or diminished, 
            at will. Hence, an initiate doesn't need to enter the divine state 
            of being in order to conduct the highest radiation of life into the 
            ark of the covenant; on the contrary, he can enter a lower state of 
            concentration and then direct the power corresponding to this level 
            into the ark of the covenant, after raising it with the help of the 
            staff up to the level of creative energy. When the ark is charged in 
            this manner, it radiates for a long time this highest and strongest 
            energy, as a source of all other forces on earth.  'An initiate can produce and control even the most 
            varied frequencies with the staff, as the staff is an ark of the 
            covenant in miniature form, except for the fact that creative energy 
            is not stored in it as in the case of the ark of the covenant. With 
            the help of the staff, a human being could even convert his lower 
            powers into creative force if he could radiate in a pure, 
            positive and completely selfless manner power that is 
            several octaves lower. This is because the staff always radiates the 
            power that a human being puts into it. If a primitive and selfish 
            person were to get possession of the staff, he would transmit his 
            own negative radiations arising from his selfishness—possibly even 
            in amplified form—and thus cause sicknesses, epidemics, earthquakes 
            or even greater destruction as the necromancers and practitioners of 
            black magic once did in the home of the divine race.  'Do you understand now why the initiates keep their 
            science so secret from the uninitiated.'  'I understand, Father. And it is now quite clear to 
            me how my father revived the half-dead boy. In his state of high 
            concentration, father directed his radiation, in magnified state, 
            into the child. It worked like a miracle. The child was charged with 
            vital energy, and his exhaustion disappeared immediately. But, 
            Father of my Soul, what is going to happen when the sons of men take 
            over the government? Are you going to destroy the magic staff, as 
            father said, when he told me the initiates are going to destroy all 
            their instruments? What a shame that people won't be able to enjoy 
            the blessing of these powers!'  'My child,' says Ptahhotep, 'every creature lives 
            in conditions that are exactly adapted to its state of development.
            If we were to betray the secret of the staff to the sons of men, 
            they would immediately use it to do harm to each other and to 
            themselves. The sons of men aren't ready for this knowledge and 
            won't be for a long time to come. The staff we are now using will be 
            taken out of Egypt by the last initiate in possession of the secret 
            knowledge, along with the ark of the covenant. He will have no 
            possibility to build a pyramid. On the contrary, he will make a 
            small cover for the ark to insulate it as well as possible. He will 
            charge the ark to a much lesser degree and will cause it to be 
            carried during his migrations by means of long wooden poles as 
            handles. When this last initiate feels he is approaching death, he 
            will destroy his staff. For a time the ark will continue to radiate 
            the energy with which it has been charged, and the uninitiated will 
            continue to carry it about in various countries for a long time 
            until little by little they notice that it no longer has any power. 
            Then even the last remains of the ark will be destroyed.  'In times to come people will learn about the "magic 
            staff" and the "ark of the covenant" only through records of earlier 
            times. They will consider all this as a fairy tale and continue to 
            tell it from one generation to another. But they will still vaguely 
            remember that once there was an "ark of the covenant" in which there 
            dwelt the power of the living God. And they'll also remember there 
            was once a "magic staff" or as we call it a "staff of life" with 
            which the initiates, the "magicians", performed miracles. From 
            records from earlier times people will know or dimly sense that "the 
            staff" represented power over all forces of nature.  'In later times when people want to symbolize the 
            greatest power, they will place a staff—a sceptre—in their hand as a 
            token of power. In those times to come, however, their staff—their 
            sceptre—will only be an empty symbol of power. The true 
            power said force of the staff will no longer be known to them. 
            Only after thousands of years will a descendant from the tribe of 
            the Sons of God be reincarnated; he will discover these truths for 
            the people of his time and will make a new "magic staff". Until 
            then, however, for thousands of years, there will be a strange kind 
            of people who, either to entertain or to cheat, will call themselves 
            "magicians" and will pretend they are performing their magic tricks 
            with the help of a "magic wand". They will thus be imitating 
             what once actually existed.  'They will hold a "magic wand" in their hand and go 
            through the motions of drawing magic powers from this wand. They 
            will also use "magic words", imitating our magic formulas. But 
            people will only learn the true gigantic power of the word centuries 
            later when the fallen members of the divine race are 
            reincarnated—those who are now living here—and will 
            remember in their subconscious the truths which in that time 
            will represent ancient records.  'They will prove that their memories are correct. 
            The time will come when the sons of men rediscover and repossess all 
            knowledge, even the very highest. Even then, of course, this 
            knowledge will remain an unintelligible secret for the ignorant 
            masses, and in uninitiated hands these rediscovered truths will be a 
            curse. But after all, this is the path of mankind, through many 
            troubles and sorrows, which people make for themselves. Little by 
            little they will learn they must not play with divine power. They'll 
            come to know that these powers should be used in full seriousness 
            with dignity and dedication. For God gives mankind all, even 
            himself, as a blessing; only people, in their ignorance, make a 
            curse out of everything!'  'Father of my Soul,' I ask, 'you said that the 
            pyramids were made of thick blocks of stone in order to insulate the 
            equipment by means of which the penetrating frequencies are 
            radiated. But how then can you conduct the radiations to the 
            outside?'  'The thick walls of the pyramids all contain shafts 
            and tunnels through which we conduct out the force of the ark of the 
            covenant and the other supplementary equipment which radiates 
            energy. With the aid of these shafts and tunnels we also control 
            weather. The positive and negative tunnels are built in different 
            directions; when the positive and negative forces flow through them, 
            they cause clouds to form and bring about the desired rain. The 
            equalization of these tensions causes flashes of lightning 
            accompanied by great noise. That is why people hear thunder coming 
            from the pyramid. The other pyramids have been built for various 
            other installations.'  'What's going to happen to the pyramids when the 
            sons of men come into power in our country and the ark of the 
            covenant and all other instruments are destroyed? Will the pyramids 
            stand empty? And what's to become of the high priest and the other 
            priests and initiates?' I ask.  'All except for the largest pyramid where the ark of 
            the covenant is now kept and where initiation is given, the pyramids 
            won't remain empty. When all our instruments for the radiation of 
            divine creative energy are removed, the last initiated Pharaohs will 
            have themselves entombed in one of these pyramids. Their bodies, 
            permeated through and through by divinely creative force will 
            continue—as the force will not be consumed—to radiate the supreme 
            power just as the ark of the covenant does. Thus their bodies will 
            continue in secret to act as tremendous sources of power, protecting 
            this continent from evil influences. The radiation of well preserved 
            and holy bodies will help our country keep its power for thousands 
            of years. But in the course of time most of these tombs will be 
            destroyed by ignorant people.'  'And what's going to happen to the great pyramid, 
            Father?'  Ptahhotep looks off in the distance for a while as 
            if he were observing things there. Then his heavenly glance sweeps 
            back to me and he says: 'When the time has come for all secret 
            instruments to be destroyed, and when the priest and initiates still 
            serving in the temple at that time take their pilgrim's staff and 
            set out for far-away places, the high priest and his deputy will 
            close the rock entrance of the great pyramid from the inside so that 
            no son of man can find it. Then, after fulfilling their last duties, 
            they will dematerialize their own bodies in just the way you've 
            often seen the offering on the altar in the temple court 
            dematerialized. Just a flash, then a little white cloud that soon 
            disappears —not a trace of ash or anything else remains behind. Thus 
            the interior of the great pyramid will be closed off from human 
            sight for thousands of years. Nevertheless, our initiations will not 
            cease. Mature souls will continue to be initiated here—not 
            physically, of course, but on the higher spiritual plane. These 
            people will experience their initiation as a dream or a vision.'  Ptahhotep ceases speaking, and for a long time we 
            look into each other's eyes. I understand a lot that he doesn't want 
            to say ... but I still have another question: 'Father of my soul, is 
            there a special reason why all pyramids are built in the same form? 
            Why aren't they built in a cubic shape, for example, like other 
            buildings?'  Ptahhotep smiles: 'Not in cubic form? But the 
            pyramids are built in cubic form! But I'll have to explain 
            that to you next time. You've had enough today.'  I see that Ptahhotep has ended his instruction, but 
            I still remain. I'd like to have him show me the use of the staff 
            and the ark of the covenant. He looks at me with a smile and says: 
            'The time will come when you'll be permitted to know about the 
            construction of the ark of the covenant and the staff of life. That 
            will come after you've been initiated. But the use of these 
            instruments is restricted to those who've reached the seventh degree 
            after initiation through their own efforts. These secrets must not 
            come into dangerous hands. Be patient. Time exists only in our 
            thinking, but still everything takes time to mature.'  He blesses me, and I leave.  33  THE FORM OF THE PYRAMIDS: SATAN  Once again I stand before Ptahhotep in his 
            laboratory.  'I've already explained to you,' he says, 'that 
            behind all the manifestations of the visible world there is a 
            primordial force, a striving to return to the state of unity, and 
            this force is apparent as the attraction between the two 
            complementary halves, the positive and the negative. You are now 
            standing before me because the earth's gravitational force is 
            holding your body here. If it weren't for this force, you and 
            everything that is not rooted to the earth would have spun off into 
            space long ago. Even the whole gigantic body of the earth would have 
            broken apart long ago. The force which holds together the earth and 
            all the matter within its atmosphere doesn't belong to the earth 
            itself, but merely affects the earth operating outward from its 
            centre. If matter had no resistance and merely yielded to this 
            force, the tremendous mass of the earth and everything that's living 
            on it would disappear into its centre. But where would it go? Think 
            for a moment.  'Come closer, my child. I'll show you. If I put 
            various things on the top of this table, tie a string on to each, 
            draw the strings through the hole in the middle of the table top, 
            and then pull all the strings from below, all the objects are drawn 
            towards the centre of the table top; and all those that are smaller 
            than the hole disappear. Where do they go? Aren't they drawn towards 
            the point from which the force is acting? But where does the force 
            in the centre of the earth come from ... the force that draws 
            everything towards it? Can you answer that, my child?'  I reflect for a moment and answer: 'The earth is 
            recognizable. If everything that is recognizable is so only because 
            it has separated itself from the "all and nothingness", 
            leaving its complementary half behind in the unmanifested state, 
            then the earth too must have its complementary half in the 
            unmanifested state, and the force of gravitation it exerts on all 
            the creatures and objects living on it is the striving for 
            reunification between the earth and its unmanifested complementary 
            half which has been left behind in the void as its negative 
            reflection. The earth's gravitational pull thus draws all the earth 
            towards the void which stands beyond time and space, in order 
            to bring about this reunion. If the earth were to yield, all the 
            earth and everything on it would disappear into the centre, into the
            void. But that would be a return to the paradisiacal unity—to
            God—to bliss! Why can't that happen, Father?'  'My child,' answers Ptahhotep, 'the obstacle is 
            the resistance of matter! Without resistance no creation 
            is possible! It's the resistance of matter that keeps the earth and 
            all creation from disappearing and being annihilated. Everything 
            that has appeared in this recognizable world has fallen out of a 
            point in the universe, and this point has then become its own 
            centre. Through the fall it became matter. Now it can't return to 
            divine unity because its own resistance as matter doesn't let it. A 
            return to the paradisiacal divine unity—to God—is only possible 
            through the spiritualization of the matter, that is, through the 
            transformation of matter into spirit! But matter, all by itself, 
            could never become spirit without spiritual help. That's why one 
            aspect of God comes down into matter, clothes itself in 
            matter, assumes material characteristics, and animates it as the 
            self in order to make possible its spiritualization, its 
            salvation.  'The effect which this self in the centre of every 
            creature has constantly exerted on the innermost structure of matter 
            throughout aeons and aeons of time has led to the development of the 
            forms of life existing on each rung of the ladder of creation. Thus 
            each creature has come into being, from the simple protozoa up to 
            the highest manifestation.  'The highest creature on earth is man. It is his 
            task to carry out the completion of the spiritualization of the 
            earth, a task at which all living creatures are at work, each within 
            the limits of its own particular stage of development. And every 
            human being who transforms himself from a being identical with the 
            body into a being reawakened in spirit, a divine being— identifying 
            his consciousness with the divine self—has fulfilled his duty. 
            He has spiritualized a bit of the earth. He has advanced by one step 
            the salvation of the earth. Then he can co-operate as a helper in 
            the salvation of other beings.  'And now you know why you're standing here before 
            me. It's because the self of the earth, which at the same 
            time is our own self, loves the earth and all its creatures, 
            drawing the earth towards itself, into divine unity, just as a 
            bridegroom draws his bride to himself. This striving towards union, 
            characteristic of all love, expresses itself in everything—including 
            our bodies— as weight!  'This force which we call weight is at work in every 
            form of nature, and when we build we must reckon and work with
            this force, never against it. When we take proper account of it, 
            it helps us preserve our buildings for a long time. If we were to 
            try to build against the laws of these forces, all our structures 
            would collapse in practically no time at all.  'It's enough for you to understand that in the 
            pyramidal form the resultant of forces is the most favourable one 
            possible for the preservation of buildings for many thousands of 
            years against the ravages of nature.  'The pyramids—particularly the great pyramid—have 
            been built according to various mathematical and astronomical laws 
            in order to serve the people as clock and calendar. You will learn 
            these laws another time. Moreover, the fact that the lateral faces 
            stand at an angle of 51° to their base enables the pyramid to 
            reflect the sun's rays far out to sea and far into the desert. Thus 
            our pyramids also serve as lighthouses. All the laws on which they 
            are based, together with the history of those who have built them, 
            are inscribed on the ceramic tiles with which they are covered. When 
            the sons of men some day discover the secret of our writing, they 
            will be able for a long time to read right from the pyramids 
            themselves the knowledge and information I am giving you now, the 
            mathematical and astronomical laws we have applied, the secrets of 
            the pyramids and all our scientific knowledge. In the darkest ages 
            of the earth, however, these written records will also disappear, so 
            the sons of men will later have to discover all truth for 
            themselves.  'You must learn the law of the three-dimensional 
            world which is based on the law of the spirit and could not exist 
            without it.  'The first source of all truth and of all 
            manifestation is the eternal being— God. But God is in 
            the unmanifested state beyond time and space, and only his 
            manifestations appear as projections in the three-dimensional world. 
            Therefore in order to understand these laws correctly, we must begin 
            with God. In order to talk about God, however, we 
            always have to cope with the fact that God stands above the 
            recognizable world. For this reason every living creature can only 
            understand God to the extent to which it itself is able consciously 
            to experience, manifest and realize God; that is, to the extent to 
            which it itself can be God! In everything God is 
            living, and everything is living in God. Nevertheless, God
            in his own complete, perfect being can be understood only by one 
            who has himself become God—or who has never fallen out of 
            God. God can be understood only by God!  'The fact that even the most primitive man has a 
            concept of God shows that divine consciousness is dwelling 
            within him, even though only very dimly and to the lowest degree. On 
            the other hand, to become conscious in God, to understand God 
            completely, and to be God means to become completely one with 
            one's own divine self, with the God dwelling within. 
            That is easy to say but very hard to do! Because man has fallen out 
            of his divine consciousness, he can only imagine God in 
            accordance with his own personal power of understanding. How can he 
            know what the real, living divinity is like in its perfection 
            when his power of imagination only corresponds to the level he 
            personally stands on, separated as he is from unity, and having 
            fallen as he has from divinity? How can the finite understand the 
            infinite, the mortal the immortal, the temporal the eternal? ... How 
            can an imaginary being understand, experience and become identical 
            with the eternal, true being— God?  'And still man must reach him! His eternal 
            desire, his unquenchable longing helps him and propels him forward 
            in the direction of his divine self. Man's intellect—the 
            greatest but most dangerous gift he has received from God-builds a 
            bridge across the seemingly unconquerable chasm between that which 
            is personal and mortal and that which is impersonal and eternal. 
            Through man's intellect he succumbed to the temptation to fall out 
            of divine unity with his consciousness. But by the same token, his 
            intellect gives him the possibility of bringing back his 
            consciousness into full union with divinity. By means of his 
            intellect, man is able to understand truth, and when he has 
            understood, he will seek and keep on seeking and trying until he 
            some day succeeds in finding the only path to the realization of his
            self.  'Realization means being something. For as long as 
            we think about something or talk about it, we aren't being 
            it. You can think about a cat, or about a lion, but that doesn't 
            mean by any manner of means that you have achieved realization, that 
            you have become a cat or a lion. Likewise, you can think 
            about yourself without being your divine, creative self! 
            To think something is to be separated from it. For if you send out a 
            single thought, you—the thinker—are connected only by thinking with 
            the object of your thought. You are connected with it, but 
            not identical with it. You are not yet that which is in your 
            intellect. Your intellect belongs to you; it is a wonderful tool, a 
            mirror into which you can project everything and in which you can 
            recognize everything, but your intellect is not you! The intellect 
            is outside your self. Consequently what you can do with your 
            intellect is not you yourself, is not achievement of realization. 
            'When man seeks God outside himself, he can often be 
            "thinking" about God, he can be "praying" to God, he 
            can be "loving" God with his whole being, but all this 
            doesn't mean he has become identical with God. For man can 
            never find God by seeking outside himself!  'The creator in man is man's own self whose 
            last manifestation, farthest from his own centre, is his little "I", 
            his personal "I-consciousness". The personal "I" within him is the 
            image of God mirrored by matter—in the body. Thus when man seeks to 
            return to God and re-establish his identity with him he must 
            follow the same path with his consciousness: he must draw 
            his consciousness more and more from his own little personal 
            "I"—deeper and deeper into himself—turning to his own true self, to 
            his creator, until he consciously recognizes himself in Him. But 
            this doesn't mean that the creature—the person—recognizes itself in 
            this condition. As an imaginary being, it has no true existence and 
            cannot really achieve self-knowledge. On the contrary, the 
            creator recognizes himself in the created, in the person. This 
            is the only possibility for overcoming the state of 
            separation and bringing back the consciousness into the state of 
            unity: the individual stops thinking about himself and instead 
            becomes himself, recognizes himself. In this condition, the 
            recognizer, the recognized and the recognition are one and the same. 
            The self—the creator—recognizes its self in itself!  ![]()
 'Man can only experience God in this way. 
            This is resurrection! In this state  he recognizes that his own self has created 
            him and is constantly creating him, hence that his own self is
            his creator. He likewise realizes that the one and only self 
            is the creator of the entire universe! As a result of this 
            divine self-recognition he simultaneously experiences the creative 
            cosmic all-consciousness. At the same time as he achieves 
            self-recognition, he achieves recognition of everything, 
            omniscience!  'This divine state in which the creator 
            recognizes himself may also be expressed symbolically by 
            numbers: 'God in his state of resting within himself is 1 in 3 
            and 3 in 1, 1 and 3 are still an unseparated unity.  'In the field of geometry, the form of the 
            equilateral triangle Is the symbolic image of God in which the 
            recognizer, the recognized and the recognition are one and the same:
            1 in 3 and 3 in 1.  'Every form is the manifestation of the force that 
            has built it. Thus every form is the image of the creative force 
            that builds it and dwells within it. Divinity in its primordial 
            state of resting within itself, always manifests itself in 
            the form of a triangle. The triangle represents perfect harmony and 
            perfect equilibrium as its three corner points all lie exactly the 
            same distance from each other. On the other hand, when the aspect of
            God to which we refer as "resting within itself" moves out of 
            the dimensionless state, beyond time and space and into the three 
            dimensions, it becomes the creative aspect of God and 
            always manifests itself in the number 4. As long as the 
            numbers 1 and 3 form a unity in divinity, they 
            remain 3 in 1 and 1 in 3. But when they 
            emerge from the divine condition of unity, they separate, and 
            out of the "1 in 3" there emerges "1 and 3", and that 
            makes 4. The equilateral triangle contains, hidden within 
            itself, 4 smaller equilateral triangles.  ![]()
 'This law also contains the secret of the key number 
            of the three-dimensional world: the number 7.  'Now try to imagine how the first energy of 
            manifestation emerges out of the dimensionless state into the three 
            dimensions. Close your eyes and I'll project this truth into your 
            consciousness.'  I do as Ptahhotep tells me, closing my eyes and 
            turning my attention inward. All of a sudden I see a point, 
            and I hear Ptahhotep's voice:  'In order for a force to emerge from the 
            dimensionless state and manifest itself, it needs a point of 
            departure. A point is dimensionless, has not yet emerged from 
            unity, but is necessary for manifestation. Because a point consists 
            of only one single factor, it bears within itself the number of 
            unity, the number 1.  'When the force whose first manifestation was a 
            point emerges from the dimensionless state and is effective for a 
            period of time, the point moves and forms a line.'  With my inward eye I see how the point gradually 
            becomes a line, and I hear Ptahhotep's voice.  'The first dimension, length, is born. In its 
            essence, the line is endless and thus, as a first manifestation, 
            also represents the number 1. But in the world of 
            manifestations, the world where everything always has a beginning 
            and an end, a line is always bound to involve three factors, its 
            starting point, its end point, and the intervening space between the 
            two. Thus the line represents the number 3, the key number 
            for the 1-dimensional world.  'Now you must have noticed that there is no 
            possibility of manifesting or of finding the number 2 in a 
            unity. As a matter of fact after the first manifestation of the 
            point, which represents only 1 single factor, we immediately 
            jumped to three factors—without the number 2. When a point 
            moves, no matter how little, to form even the tiniest, shortest 
            line, we're already dealing with the 3 factors not 2. 
            A line in infinity of course, represents the number 1; 
            but when it has a beginning and an end, it automatically represents 
            the number 3.  'In order for the number 2 to arise, there 
            has to be a splitting of unity. The number 2 can only 
            be born when two units are set beside each other. But inasmuch as 
            nothing has any real existence outside unity, unity must project 
            a reflection outside itself. Thus there arises a fission, a 
            separation, which means the death of unity. That's why the word for 
            "doubt"—which represents a kind of cleavage within one's mind and 
            soul—is so closely related to the word for 2. This is true in 
            every language.  'Let us now watch how the second dimension arises 
            from the first. A line consists of a series of points. Assuming the 
            creative energy is active in each of these points with the same 
            force and for the same period of time, each of these points moves 
            outward from itself into the second dimension; each of them becomes 
            a line, and out of the totality of these lines a plane is created: 
            An equilateral rectangle.  ![]()
 'The second dimension—width—is born.  'The rectangle is four in one and 
            one in four and thus consists of five factors: the four
            manifested lines: Line of departure, terminal line, right and 
            left lateral lines, and the fifth factor: the non-manifested 
            area enclosed by these lines. And so the key number of the two 
            dimensional world is the number five. 'But creative forces 
            continue to work. The plane also consists of points, and if the same 
            force works outward from each of these points in the same direction 
            and for the same period of time, all these points move into the 
            third dimension, and a cube has been created from the plane.
             
             The third dimension is born—height. 'The cube is 
            six in one and one in six and it consists 
            of seven factors: the six manifested limiting planes 
            and the seventh, unmanifested factor, its cubic contents. The key 
            number of the three-dimensional world is the number seven. 
            'As you see, the basic form of matter is the cube. The various 
            crystals are built in conformity with this law, and in them you can 
            find either the cubic shape itself—as in the case of salt for 
            example—or the basic elements of the cube in various aspects and 
            variations. If we now investigate the characteristics of the cube, 
            you will also understand the laws of the variants.  
             'Starting from one of the corner points of the cube, 
            try to find a plane in which all three dimensions of the cube are 
            contained. If you merely cut straight through, you get a plane 
            containing only two dimensions of the cube. In order to find a plane 
            containing all three, we must begin at one corner and cut through 
            obliquely to the opposite corner points. Thus one corner of the cube 
            is cut off.  'If we continue in the same manner, we cut off all 
            four corners of the cube, and what's left in a very different shape: 
            a tetrahedron, the faces of which are bounded by four equilateral 
            triangles.  'So now you see that hidden within the cube in a 
            shape with quite different laws, for the shape consists, not of 
            rectangles, but of four triangles. If we were to flatten out these 
            four triangles into a plane, they would form a single, equilateral 
            triangle, the symbolic representation of God.  'Just like the equilateral triangle which makes up 
            its mantle, the tetrahedron is the very incarnation of harmony and 
            equilibrium. Since each of its corner points is equally distant from 
            each of the others, there is no strain or tension in a tetrahedron, 
            but rather a condition of rest in equilibrium. By way of contrast, 
            the corner points of the cube, just like those of the square, lie at 
            different distances from each other, and this means that both in the 
            square and the cube there is a condition of everlasting stress. The 
            matter in our three-dimensional world is built up in cubic form, but 
            hidden within itself it contains the form of the tetrahedron based 
            on divine equilibrium. Matter cannot exist without the divine 
            content.  'The whole three-dimensional world is built up on 
            this same law, quite Irrespective of whether the form concerned is 
            considered to be inanimate matter or a living creature. Whether a 
            given form is that of a plant, an animal or a human, the body of 
            each of these is subject to the laws of the three dimensional world. 
            Hidden and invisible within this body, however, is the higher, 
            divine self—life—eternal being! Only man is able to manifest 
            his higher self-—that is God—through his thoughts, 
            words and deeds, when he identifies his consciousness, not with his 
            body, but with its spiritual content, with his self. As long 
            as a person identifies himself only with his body, he is like an 
            opaque cube in that he reveals only the characteristics of 
            matter, crowding the divine creative principle into a latent, 
            unmanifested state. No one suspects that the tetrahedron —the divine 
            self—so different from the outward cubic shape, is dwelling within!
             'On the other hand a person who uses his body, his 
            thoughts, words and deeds only to manifest the divine 
            creative principle, while leaving the characteristics of his 
            physical existence—his person—in the unmanifested state— such a 
            person, to continue using the same figure of speech, is like a cut
            cube whose corners and inner content are turned outward so 
            that its inner triangles— the equilateral triangles of the divine 
            tetrahedron—are visible.  'Such a person uses the material, square shape only 
            as a secure base in the three-dimensional world, allowing his weight 
            to rest on this base.  'But the shape of the cut cube turned inside out is 
            the pyramid. Thus we see the pyramid is the symbolic form of the 
            God-man, who reveals his divine, selfless nature and completely 
            manifests God on earth. The salvation of the earth, the 
            spiritualization of matter is completed in the person of the 
            God-man. The divine self—the creator—is seated in 
            complete majesty on its throne and rules over matter, over the body.
             
             'By way of contrast, the symbolic representation of 
            materialistic man who uses his intellect for the service of his 
            material being is the cross—or a "T"— formed out of the four squares 
            making up the surface of the cube. On this cross, or "T" the secret, 
            indwelling, divine self is crucified.  
             'In such persons, divinity is robbed of its power. 
            It cannot manifest itself and is subject to the laws of the material 
            world. It is crucified on the two great beams of the 
            three-dimensional world—on time and space—and dies on this cross of 
            matter. Its death, however, is not final! Even in the consciousness 
            that has sunk down to the lowest level, the divine creative self
            sometime undergoes resurrection and saves the suffering human 
            being. Materialistic man, in his Ignorance through crucifying his 
            own higher self—God within himself— creates ceaseless 
            tortures and sufferings for himself; he becomes the criminal who is 
            also crucified beside the divine one. The pains awaken him; his 
            higher consciousness is aroused, and with the resurrection of his 
            divine self, he experiences his own salvation because 
            he recognizes himself in him!  The members of the divine race who fled to the far 
            corners of the earth carried these symbols with them wherever they 
            went, proclaiming to humanity the secret, hidden truth within them. 
            In every part of the earth people will find these symbols in stone, 
            in metal, or baked clay, in various sizes, large or small. Most 
            people will believe that they represent a person who has been 
            crucified, and only a few will recognize that the representation 
            symbolizes the divine creative principle crucified on the two beams 
            of time and space.  The pyramids will continue to stand for thousands of 
            years, proclaiming to humanity the highest truths which have been 
            built into them. People with eyes and ears will find and recognize 
            these elements of truth, even though they may not be able to fathom 
            all the mathematical and astronomical laws of the pyramids, and some 
            few highly developed persons will even be able to attain the truth 
            proclaimed. On the other hand, for primitive minds the pyramid will 
            always be a puzzle—just like the Sphinx—until they reach the point 
            of being able to solve their own puzzle.  'But now let's return to our consideration of the 
            cube! A few minutes ago you started at one corner of the cube and 
            cut it in such a way that a plane contained all three dimensions. In 
            this way you cut off a corner of the cube; then three more corners. 
            But by starting at the other corner points of the cube you could 
            make four more cuts and you would find the cube doesn't contain just 
            one tetrahedron, but two of them, one within the other, each an 
            exact reflection of the other. These two tetrahedrons represent the 
            innermost law of the recognizable world: the inseparable 
            relationship between the two complementary halves—the positive and 
            the negative—which, self-contained each within the other, form a 
            perfect equilibrium and sit, as creative spirits, on the right hand 
            and on the left hand of divinity. In creation they rule as two 
            opposite laws: the law of spirit and the law of matter.  
             'Spirit is life, matter is resistance. The law of 
            the spirit is radiation, giving, selflessness. The law of matter is 
            drawing inward, cooling off, paralysis.  'There is only one single creature that is able 
            consciously to combine the two laws: man. He is the connecting link 
            between the world of the spirit and that of matter. He is able to 
            live at one and the same time by the laws of both worlds. His 
            thoughts, words and deeds can be an act of giving, radiating 
            selflessness and universal love. On the other hand, his body belongs 
            to the material world and lives by the laws of matter. At its 
            right place and in its right time, every law is divine, but the 
            opposite is satanic.  'Without the resistance of matter creation would be 
            impossible. In unmanifested divinity all creative forces are 
            still at rest in unity, in complete repose and equilibrium, 
            representing merely potential, only power possibilities. 
            Creation begins in that one force separates itself from unity and 
            sets itself up opposite the creator as resistance. That is the 
            "first born son" of God, the spirit of resistance which the 
            father sends out to act throughout aeons and aeons of time as a 
            negative and opposite pole to himself, to bear the frequencies of 
            creation, and by resisting them make it possible for creation to 
            take place. This spirit of resistance is the opposite pole to the 
            manifesting aspect of God. By virtue of its centripetal, chilling 
            and coagulating characteristics, it is the cause of the creation of 
            matter.  Tick up a stone for example. The power that makes it 
            a stone and holds it together as matter is the very self-same law of 
            resistance tending to chill, harden and hold everything together. As 
            long as this law manifests itself in matter and as 
            matter, the law is operating in its place and consequently in a 
            divine manner. But inert matter becomes living matter when the 
            divine spirit, the self, clothes itself in matter and becomes 
            flesh. The self, life, penetrates the inert matter, and out 
            of the law of matter there arises a living spirit: the reflected 
            image which has only been able to become spirit by virtue of the 
            fact that God, as the self of the living creatures, 
            has breathed his own life into matter, is satan. Thus you can see 
            that satan is the law of matter come alive through the divine 
            spirit. Satan lies dead in matter, as its law, until with 
            its own life the divine spirit makes him come alive.  'Whenever man's consciousness identifies itself with 
            the law of matter so that his thinking, words and deeds, instead of 
            serving the divine law, serve the law of matter, man is bringing 
            satan to life, man is becoming satanic himself. Without man 
            satan cannot exist; for without the self of man, satan is 
            only an unconscious force, a necessary natural law of matter.  'Satan can come to life only in the consciousness of 
            a person who manifests the law of matter, the law of the flesh, in 
            his spirit; who identifies his consciousness with his person, with 
            his lower nature, with the drives and urges dwelling in his flesh, 
            with the urge of self-preservation and propagation of the species. 
            Such a person manifests the centripetal, coagulating power of matter
            as spiritual characteristics such as avarice, envy, vanity, 
            bardheartedness and selfishness. No living creature has ever met 
            satan by himself, for without man satan has no existence 
            at all. Without man satan is only the law of matter. We can meet 
            the living satan only in the human being; only in a human face can 
            we recognize satan as the expression of this face.  'When after the death of the body of such a person 
            the self separates itself, satan remains behind in the corpse 
            as the law of matter, lie became satan through the vitalizing power 
            of the self in the consciousness. But the consciousness of a 
            person who has identified himself with the law of matter and thus 
            become satanic himself dies with satan and becomes unconscious 
            after death. Satan draws him, his slave, into inert matter, into 
            the darkness, into loss of consciousness, into himself.  'On the other hand, the consciousness of a person 
            who has identified himself with the law of the divine spirit and 
            served this law remains awake and alert after the body has been put 
            off; liberated from its chains, freed of the isolation of matter, it 
            merges into eternal light, into God.  'The two tetrahedrons contained within each other 
            represent the two poles of creation in complete equilibrium. All 
            creation—the world of unrest and motion—is based on this divine 
            equilibrium. It is the inner law operating through all forms and 
            therefore in the crystallizations of matter also. As you've been 
            able to see for yourself, the primordial form of matter, the cube, 
            is built up around the divine tetrahedron. The triangles making up 
            the faces of the tetrahedron arc identical with the planes 
            connecting the corner points of the cube. Man too, in his inner 
            being, has a plane of contact with the divine self. And 
            that's why he can only find his own divine being within himself,  never by directing his attention towards the outside 
            world.  'When man directs his attention towards the outside 
            world, he is forced in accordance with divine law into more and more 
            spiritual prisons, until after many pains and tortures, he finds 
            divinity.  'But now let's examine the different kinds of forms 
            of crystals based on the shape of the cube.  Take six geometric forms which have the shape of a 
            house roof and a base area exactly equal to that of the face of the 
            cube, then place these six forms on the faces of this cube in such a 
            way that their different edges are adjacent to each other.  
             'In this way you form a geometric body which we call 
            a pentagonal dodecahedron consisting of twelve equilateral 
            pentagons. The pentagonal dodecahedron reveals further laws of the 
            long path of the consciousness. But now we want to look at the 
            result manifested by the last crystal form in this series: the 
            icosahedron made up of twenty equilateral triangles.  
             'Thus starting with the tetrahedron we can develop a 
            total of four regular crystal forms with equal areas: the 
            tetrahedron, the cube, the pentagonal dodecahedron and the 
            icosahedron.  'It is only possible to form regular crystal shapes 
            from triangles, rectangles and pentagons: from triangles, the 
            tetrahedron, the octahedron and the icosahedron: from squares only 
            the cube; from pentagons only the pentagonal dodecahedron.  'Except for the octahedron you are already 
            acquainted with all these geometrical bodies. You can construct an 
            octahedron by drawing three equally long lines, one in each of the 
            three dimensions—length, breadth and height— at an angle of 45° in 
            such a way that the middle of the three lines is identical. When you 
            join the endpoints of the three lines, you form the eight triangles 
            which go to make up the octahedron. Thus you see the octahedron 
            consists of two pyramids joined at their base, one standing 
            normally, the other upside down.  
             'And now pay very close attention. If we cut the 
            octahedron with planes at equal distances from each other and pass 
            through in each of the three dimensions, we create innumerable 
            little octahedrons. But these octahedrons do not fill the space 
            in the big octahedron. On the contrary, the spaces between the 
            little octahedrons form little tetrahedrons just as you observed in 
            the space within the cube. You can divide up the space in an 
            endless number of larger or smaller octahedrons, and the little 
            tetrahedrons in between will always be there. Thus you can see that 
            in every one of its points three-dimensional space is based on the 
            divine tetrahedron representing absolute harmony and absolute 
            equilibrium.  
             'In just the same manner all of visible creation 
            rests in every one of its points on the divinity which stands 
            above all manifestation, reposing  unmanifested Within itself. God is 
            omnipresent!  'But now let's come back to the various geometric 
            bodies contained within each other or superimposed on each other: 
            tetrahedron, cube, pentagonal dodecahedron and icosahedron. Here are 
            some further laws revealed by their relationships.  'If we take half the number of faces of each of the 
            geometric bodies we've talked about—the tetrahedron, cube, 
            pentagonal dodecahedron, and icosahedron, we get the numbers 2,3,6 
            and 10. If we multiply these numbers together, we get the number 
            360, the number of degrees in the circle. And if we add these 
            numbers together, we get 21, the number of possible connections 
            between the seven factors of the key number of the three-dimensional 
            world, the number 7!'  
             Ptahhotep stops speaking, and I stand before him in 
            silence and awe.  'Now you may go, my child,' says Ptahhotep, 'you've 
            had enough for today. Next time we'll talk about the four sides of 
            the pyramid. They contain further truths. If you want to attain 
            complete self-recognition, they're very important for you.'  I bow and leave.  
              
              And, looking, I saw a storm-wind coming out of the 
              north, a great cloud with flames of fire coming after one another, 
              and a bright light shining round about it and in the heart of it 
              was something coloured like electrum. 
              And in the heart of it were the forms of four 
              living beings. And this was what they were like; they had the form 
              of a man.  6. And every one had four faces, and every one of 
            them had four wings.  10. As for the form of their faces, they had the 
            face of a man, and the four of them had the face of a lion on the 
            right side, and the four of them had the face of an ox on the left 
            side, and the four of them had the face of an eagle.  12. Every one of them went straight forward; 
            wherever the spirit was to go they went; they went on without 
            turning.  
              
              And the living beings went out and came back as 
              quickly as a thunder-flame. 
              Now while I was looking at the four living beings, 
              I saw one wheel on the earth, by the side of the living beings, 
              for the four of them. 
              The form of the wheels and their work was like a 
              beryl; the four of them had the same form and design, and they 
              were like a wheel inside a wheel.  17. The four of them went straight forward without 
            turning to one side.  18. And I saw that they had edges, and their edges, 
            even of the four, were full of eyes round about.  20. Wherever the spirit was to go they went; and the 
            wheels were lifted up by their side: for the spirit of the living 
            beings was in the wheels.  22. And over the heads of the living beings 
            there was the form of an arch, looking like ice, stretched out over 
            their heads on high.  
              
              And on top of the arch which was over their heads 
              was the form of a king's seat, like a sapphire stone; and on the 
              form of the scat was the form of a man seated on it on high. 
              And I saw it coloured like electrum, with the look 
              of fire in it and round it, going up from what seemed to be the 
              middle of his body; and going down from what seemed to be the 
              middle of his body I saw what was like fire, and there was a 
              bright light shining round him. 
              Like the bow in the cloud on a day of rain, so was 
              the light shining round him. And this is what the glory of the 
              Lord was like. And when I saw it I went down on my face, and the 
              voice of one talking came to my ears. Ezekiel, I  34  THE FOUR FACES OF GOD  Again I stand before Ptahhotep.  'My child,' he begins, 'today you'll learn what the 
            four faces of God are.  'It will help you very, very much to recognize them
            in you. The four faces of God are in everything that has been 
            created. All of creation—including yourself —has been built 
            up on his four faces.  'Life in the visible world, beginning with the 
            gigantic central suns of the world systems and running all the way 
            down to the tiniest protozoa is merely a rotation around the 
            four faces and in the four faces of God.  'You know why we always represent divinity in its 
            primordial state of resting within itself as an equilateral 
            triangle. God in his three aspects is one in three and 
            three in one. But this condition—just like the equilateral 
            triangle—carries within itself the possibility of the number 
            four. When the three aspects of the basic number one 
            separate from each other—and this happens when they move from the 
            unmanifested into the manifested state— the "one in three" 
            becomes "one and three". In this way the number four 
            is born.  'Cast a glance at the equilateral triangle: in it 
            you see only one unit which has three sides, three aspects. 
            But it contains, hidden and unmanifested, the number four, 
            because the equilateral triangle can be divided up into four smaller 
            equilateral triangles.  'When the triangle moves out of the unmanifested 
            into the manifested state in the three dimensional world, a 
            tetrahedron is formed.  
             'As you have already seen, the first primordial form 
            of material manifestation—the cube—contains the tetrahedron hidden 
            and unmanifested within itself.  
             'The four triangles which make up the faces of the 
            tetrahedron are the areas of contact between the divine and the 
            material, as they are identical with the inner areas of the 
            truncated corners of the cube.  'When we turn the triangles of the tetrahedron 
            outward with the help of the corners of the cube, thus 
            manifesting the triangles of the tetrahedron, we produce the 
            four-sided shape of the pyramid whose four sides, at one and the 
            same time, are the four triangles of the tetrahedron turned 
            outward and the truncated corners of the cube turned outward.
             'The four sides of the pyramid symbolize the four 
            faces of God, each of which taken alone and by itself manifests the 
            three aspects of the first source, the divinity at rest within 
            itself and standing above all creation. The pyramid reveals a 
            living reality, the living law, in which God always and 
            absolutely manifests himself in the material world, and because he 
            does so he is indwelling in everything that has been created.  'From every point of the universe God 
            manifests himself four-fold. In each of the four directions of the 
            earth and the sky he radiates with a different effect. And because 
            these streams of force, which originate at one point and yet arc so 
            very different, all come forth from the paradisiacal unity, we can 
            speak of them figuratively as four great rivers springing up in the 
            centre of paradise, where the tree of life and the tree of the 
            knowledge of good and evil are rooted, and flowing out into the 
            external world in four different directions.  'You will find this four-fold manifestation in 
            everything that has been created, most noticeably in the four 
            characteristics of the great currents of air, the winds. Even the 
            dullest person knows that the winds coming from the four different 
            directions have completely different effects.  'The north wind is dry, cool, with a quieting and 
            paralysing effect. In many parts of the world it even makes water 
            hard as stone.  'The south wind always brings heat and has an 
            arousing, vitalizing effect.  'The east wind is cool, refreshing.  'The west wind brings warmth and dampness—in many 
            places rain. Its effect is fatiguing and soporific.  'This is something you already know, because every 
            child notices the different effects of the four major winds. But 
            have you ever thought about how this is possible? Have you ever 
            wondered how it comes about that currents of air can start at the 
            selfsame spot on the surface of the earth and have different effects 
            depending on the direction in which they flow? If, for 
            example, a wind arises right where we are now, where we feel the air 
            to be pleasant and mildly warm, and if it blows southward, it is 
            obviously coming from the north for people living in countries to 
            the south of us. It brings them cool weather and has a calming 
            effect on all living creatures. But when a wind starts up from where 
            we are and blows northward, it's a south wind for people 
            living to the north of us. It brings them warm weather and has a 
            stimulating effect on the organs of reproduction of all living 
            creatures. How is it possible for both a cold and a warm wind to 
            originate at one and the same point on the surface of the earth—a 
            tranquilizing and a stimulating wind—bringing dampness and rain to 
            people on one side and dry weather to people on the other? It all 
            depends on the direction in which the air is flowing.  'You see, that is the law of space we call 
            the four faces of God.  'The first face—the north face—is fiery and 
            has a vitalizing effect. That's why the south wind brings heat and 
            stimulates living creatures to conceive new life.  'The second—the west face—is airy and cool. 
            It makes everything movable, and that's why the east wind is 
            refreshing.  'The third face of God—his eastern face—is damp,
            wet and lukewarm. It brings heaviness, inertia, warmth, dampness 
            and precipitation, making all living creatures sleepy. Their 
            consciousness withdraws into their bodies.  'And lastly the fourth face—the south face of God—is 
            cold. It has a contracting, astringent, crystallizing, materializing 
            effect. It brings cold and calms the nerves.  'The first and most important manifestation of the 
            four faces of God is the fiery one, because the 
            effects of the other manifestations—the other faces— depend on this 
            one. The kind of fire determines whether the weather gets hot, warm, 
            cool or cold. That's why the fiery face of God is the father of 
            the others. As a result of its radiation, the various specific 
            states arise: the warm and dry together produce the gaseous airy
            condition: the cool and damp the aqueous', while the cold 
            produces the hard, earthly condition.  'You find this law operating everywhere here on 
            earth, in every tree, in every plant. Take any house, for example. 
            The south side which receives the currents from the north face of 
            God is warm and plants grow best on this side. The north side is 
            cold, the east side is dry and the west side is always damp. 
            Whenever we make rain in the pyramid, the precipitation hits all 
            buildings from the west.  'This fourfold aspect is not only to be found in the 
            major winds, but in everything that has been created. Look at the 
            trees. The northern side— exposed to the radiation from the cool 
            southern face of God—is always covered with moss. Have you ever 
            wondered why the human being has only one face,  and that towards the front? In the direction in 
            which we face we are fiery, giving, whereas when we turn our back on 
            something we are cool towards it, Our limbs, too, are all directed 
            forward, and we can radiate our willpower only in the direction in 
            which we are facing. And why do we sleep best when lying in a north 
            to south direction? Why do all animals lie down this way? Why are 
            even birds' nests and ant hills built in a north to south 
            direction,? Animals have no intellect to understand the reasons why, 
            but they feel the effect of quieting radiations coming from the 
            north and vitalizing currents from the south. Instinctively they 
            feel it's best for the circulation of their own current of life when 
            they build their nests in a north to south direction and when they 
            sleep this way.  'That's the secret of why a person who is seeking 
            connection with God and praying should face north or east, but 
            never south or west. In the north and in the east he can find 
            forces that lead him towards spiritualization, whereas in the south 
            and in the west he finds stimulation which leads his consciousness 
            to identify itself with his sensual instincts.  'The effects of God's fourfold radiation are always 
            the same throughout the entire universe. Every point in the 
            universe—and this includes of course every point on the face of the 
            earth—always receives exactly the same radiation from any given 
            direction. The four faces of God can never turn or shift. They 
            always Stand unchanged, immutable, facing in their original 
            direction.  'Wherever members of the divine race went, they 
            taught the sons of men this profound truth in various ways depending 
            on the characteristics of the people around them. Here where people 
            understand geometric forms and can grasp truth intellectually, we 
            expressed the truth about the four faces of God in the form of the 
            pyramid. But there are other races of people more inclined to grasp 
            divine truths as spiritual experiences. The members of our race who 
            fled to such countries have built gigantic figures of stone to 
            represent divinity in the form of a human figure sitting like 
            a triangle and having a head with four faces, one looking in each 
            direction.  'Both representations reveal the same fact: whenever 
            the divine creative principle leaves its timeless spaceless 
            condition in the unmanifested state to come out into the 
            three-dimensional world and become matter, it manifests itself—-even 
            while keeping its three aspects—in the number four. The 
            shape of the pyramid shows this clearly in that each of its four
            sides, standing on the square base, forms a triangle 
            representing the three aspects of God. Thus the pyramid manifests 
            four times three: the number twelve.  
             'And that brings us to another truth.  'As you can see from the symbolic representation in 
            the form of the pyramid, each of the four faces of God 
            contains the three divine aspects. This results in a twelve-fold 
            manifestation which is present at every point of the universe 
            and is acting in everything that exists, beginning with the 
            individual creatures living on the planets and running throughout 
            the planets to the suns and the systems of suns, throughout the 
            universe, just like little circles in larger ones and larger circles 
            in still larger ones, on and on to infinity. So if you understand 
            one of these circles, you will understand the inner structure of the 
            entire universe and of every single creature in it; for the 
            entire visible universe is based on this twelve-fold manifestation 
            of God,  'But before we go on, you must realise that 
            everything we human beings can perceive with our organs of sense 
            from our personal point of view—that is from the outside—is the 
            exact opposite of what exists in the divine state of being. 
            Everything you can see when looking at it from the outside—whether 
            from above or below, from front or back, from the right or the 
            left—turns into its exact opposite as soon as you stop looking at 
            it and start being it. When you look at something, 
            you're in a dualistic relationship to it. You, the observer, 
            and what you see are two different poles. But when you are 
            something, you're in a monistic condition, in divine unity. 
             'To show you an example, let's take a letter, say a 
            letter "E". In what direction does this letter run?'  'It runs from left to right, Father,' I answer.  'Good,' says Ptahhotep, 'now when I draw the same 
            letter on your breast so that you are this letter, you're in 
            a condition of unity with it, in a state of being with it. In what 
            direction is it running now?'  'From right to left, Father,' I answer.  'Yes, just the opposite. Come with me now and I'll 
            show you something more.' Ptahhotep leads me under two large 
            circular plates that hang from the ceiling and serve as lamps. They 
            both have the same twelve pictures but running in opposite sequence 
            and facing in opposite directions. On the first plate the pictures 
            all have their heads towards the centre, while on the second their 
            heads are all toward the circumference. And the sequence from right 
            to left on one is just the opposite of the sequence of the other.
             
             Ptahhotep leads me to the first circle and asks, 
            'When do you see the pictures in the circle right side up?'  'Always, from any point along the side, Father.'  Then Ptahhotep leads me to the second circle and 
            asks, 'How do you sec these pictures?'  'All of them have their heads down, just the 
            opposite of the pictures in the other circle, and they're all in the 
            opposite sequence,' I answer.  'Now try to find the spot from which you can see all 
            of these pictures right side up and in the right sequence.'  I look at the figures and as I want to see 
            them right—with their heads up— I involuntarily step over to a point 
            precisely under, and consequently precisely in the centre
            of the disc ... and all of a sudden all the figures seem to 
            change their positions! Now they're all standing right side up and 
            in the correct sequence. I turn around slowly, continuing to stand 
            in the centre ... Each and every one of the figures is right side 
            up. But when I move only a single step to the side, they're all the 
            wrong way round again! I step back into the centre. Consciously and 
            deeply moved, I experience the state of being ... I 
            understand what it means ... the excitement of the discovery almost 
            makes me dizzy.  Seeing how thrilled and moved I am, Ptahhotep 
            smiles. 'Do you understand now,' he asks, 'why the personal is 
            always the exact opposite of the divine? Do you understand 
            why human script runs from left to right while the divine runs 
            from right to left?'.  'Yes, Father of my Soul,' I stammer, trembling with 
            excitement. 'I do understand.'  Ptahhotep takes my hand in his—oh, how quickly the 
            mighty power of this blessed hand calms me—and leads me to a large 
            blackboard where I see various geometric figures.  'The earth,' he continues, 'receives the twelve-fold 
            radiation of force of the four faces of God from the direction of 
            various constellations of stars. Taken together, these 
            constellations surround us like a wheel. We call this huge wheel the 
            "zodiac".  'It's owing to the effect of the radiations of the 
            zodiac that the earth can exist at all. Their vibrations met in a 
            point in cosmic space, causing an interference in the waves of 
            energy and leading to condensation ... materialization. Little by 
            little our earth came into being through this process of 
            materialization. As the sun played a great role in this process, the 
            earth grew in the field of force of the sun and became its 
            satellite. It receives its life energy from the sun, but it also is 
            constantly receiving radiations from the zodiac and from its sister 
            planets of our solar system.  'Just like all the celestial bodies, the earth 
            represents the materialization of all these various radiations, and 
            that's why for each step of earthly creation there is a form of 
            materialization which primarily manifests the specific energy of the 
            great cosmic wheel appropriate for the form of materialization 
            concerned. That is to say that in rock formations, minerals, 
            plants, animals and human beings here on earth there are the 
            materialized radiations of each individual constellation of the 
            zodiac, as well as of each individual planet. The names of the signs 
            of the zodiac characterize the earthly forms that are the 
            materialized manifestations of the constellations concerned. When 
            you see a lion, for example, you should remember that on the animal 
            plane he is the materialized radiation of the particular zodiacal 
            sign we call "Leo" or "Lion". But at the same time 
            there are minerals, plants and people made up of the same energy, 
            but on the mineral, plant or human plane.  'Since the name of each individual sign of the 
            zodiac is also the name of the form created by the materialized 
            radiation from this zodiacal sign, this name is obviously the most 
            appropriate single word with which to characterize perfectly 
            the radiation from this constellation.  The four faces of God—that is the four cardinal 
            points—in the vault of stars, in the divine condition of being,
            are:  
             'Each face of God, each cardinal point of the vault 
            of heaven, contains within itself the three aspects of the 
            unmanifested divinity, and so the twelve signs of the 
            zodiac come into being:  
             'The three fiery aspects of the first face 
            of God, of the first group, are revealed in three constellations 
            called Aries, Leo and Sagittarius.  'The Lion is the first manifestation of 
            God and consequently the great father of the entire zodiac.
            That's why all three manifestations of the first face of God 
            have a fatherly, life-giving character.  'The Ram—Aries—radiates the fire of youth, 
            the procreative power of the young father who penetrates the bosom 
            of nature, awakens new life, and sets it in motion. The Ram 
            is the power of spring which in its effect is just as wild 
            and heedless, just as rammish as the ram itself.  'The Lion is the fire of the perfectly 
            developed, dignified and respectable man, the mature father who 
            radiates his creative power, his love and warmth towards all his 
            children as he brings them up in affectionate care. The Lion 
            is the power of summer.  The Centaur (Sagittarius) is a being that has 
            grown beyond its animal nature, overcome its physical desires and 
            aimed its consciousness towards the high goal.  
             The four faces of God in the divine state of 
            being.  Its radiation is the fire of the spirit, of the wise 
            and mellow father who goes on helping his mature children with his 
            spirituality, good thoughts and sage advice. The Centaur or
            Sagittarius is the spiritual fire of thought, the power of 
            age, of winter.  'The three aspects of the second group, of the 
            earthly-material face of God are: Taurus, Virgo 
            and Capricornus, or the Bull, the Virgin and 
            the Goat. All three manifestations of this face of God reveal 
            a motherly character.  'In the springtime the bull stands in a green 
            meadow, and all of nature is decked out in the beautiful clothing of 
            a bride on her wedding day, ready to receive all the procreative 
            power of her bridegroom. The radiation of the zodiacal sign of the
            Bull enables the earth to receive the fiery power of 
            life and let it take root. Thus the divine seed is able to 
            incarnate itself in an earthly body. The Bull radiation makes 
            it possible for the divine self, the creative principle, the
            logos, to become flesh. The Bull awakens the power of 
            conception in matter— in the female of the species—calling the 
            bride to readiness. The Bull represents that aspect of 
            incipient maternity in which the mother-to-be is ready to conceive.
             'Virgo—the Virgin—is the spotless queen of 
            heaven, the mother goddess of nature who has never been touched by a 
            male and yet is pregnant with myriad creatures that are born from 
            her divine body. The power of the sign of the Virgin is the 
            fertility of nature, and that's why she is shown holding in her hand 
            a spike of grain with five kernels. In the mystic world the 
            Virgin is the human soul which, purged of all earthly dross, has 
            become spotless and has received the divine seed from the spirit of
            God. Thus she is expecting the divine child in which both 
            principles—the divine and the material are blended 
            into perfect unity. Thus Virgo is the pregnant, expectant 
            aspect of maternity.  'The third aspect of the earthly face of God is 
            Capricorn, the Goat. Thin animal lives in the region of the 
            hardest matter on earth, stones, rocks and boulders. The 
            centripetal force of the law of matter causes matter to reach 
            the highest degree of hardness and consequently crystallise. 
            In the crystal, matter overcomes itself, losing its original 
            characteristic of opacity and becoming perfectly transparent. In the 
            crystal, matter reveals the original geometric forms of the creative 
            power. A child, too, is the solidified, crystallized form of the 
            divine creative power of life. Through the law of matter, through 
            the centripetal, compressive power of concentration, the 
            achievement of the divine self, the divine 
            child—consciousness—is born in the soul of man.  'As long as man identifies his consciousness with 
            his animal instincts, he is like a stable in which animals are 
            living. In this stable and surrounded by animals, the divine 
            child—the divine consciousness—must be born. This takes place 
            through the concentrating effect of the sign of Capricornus. 
            The only path which can lead man back to unity, back into the lost 
            paradise, is that of concentration. That's why the birth of the 
            divine child is celebrated in the month when the sun stands in the 
            sign of the Goat. The radiation of this centre of force helps 
            man fully to manifest and achieve the divine in and 
            through matter—in the body. Capricornus is the parturient 
            aspect of the maternal.  'The three aspects of the third group, the 
            vaporous face of God, are Gemini, Libra and 
            Aquarius, or the Twins, the Balance and the 
            Water Bearer. The vaporous combination state arising through 
            this radiation gives movement. That's why these three constellations 
            are favourable for the manifestation of forces which require free 
            and unhindered movement. They are spiritual in character.  'The sign of the Twins carries within itself 
            the two halves of the tree of the knowledge of good and evil. 
            Its radiation takes effect in two directions. It causes man to look 
            to the left and to the right in order to gather knowledge and 
            experience. It causes man's pathway through life to branch out like 
            the limbs of a tree. Man goes forth to seek knowledge on the most 
            devious paths that lead off in various directions. Seeking 
            experience, people want to see everything, hear everything, learn 
            everything. The radiated power of Gemini manifests itself as 
            the urge to learn.  'The radiation of the Libra constellation 
            forces everything into equilibrium. All the experiences man has 
            collected are laid in the scales of the balance and weighed. What's 
            valuable is kept; what's worthless is thrown away. The effect of the
            balance is one of harmony, developing man's powers of 
            discrimination, and bringing the two-sided forces of Gemini 
            into equilibrium. The sign of the Balance radiates the law of 
            equilibrium and justice into the three-dimensional world. It is the 
            manifestation of law-giving knowledge.  'The constellation Aquarius radiates the 
            knowledge that has been gathered under the sign of the Twins, 
            weighed in the Balance, found worthwhile and codified into 
            laws. The radiated energy of this sign brooks no let or hindrance 
            and knows no bounds. The Water Bearer gives, passes on 
            treasures to others, untiringly pours the water of life out of his 
            vessel, letting its waves flow on to the remotest worlds. These 
            waves are the all-vitalizing high-frequencies of the spirit. The 
            Water Bearer is the manifestation of the unhindered spirit freed 
            of all bonds.  'The three aspects of the fourth group, the aqueous 
            face of God, are: the Crab, the Eagle (Scorpion)
            and Fishes, or Cancer, Scorpio and Pisces. 
            The three manifestations of this face of God have an 
            emotional character which manifests itself in feelings.  'The Zodiacal sign Crab symbolizes the little 
            water of the hole in which the crab lives. After it has caught its 
            prey outside, it withdraws into its hole to digest it. The 
            consciousness which was directed towards the outside in order to 
            find spiritual nourishment withdraws to digest and transform its 
            prey—the impressions it has collected—into clarified and organized 
            experiences. The radiated power of the zodiacal sign of the Crab
            manifests itself as the introspective, self-analysing 
            consciousness of the truth-seeking individual.  'The sign of the Scorpion-Eagle represents 
            the great turning point when the crawling worm is transformed into a 
            high-flying eagle, redeemed, a being that has awakened and become 
            conscious in the divine self. The worm— Scorpion— must 
            kill itself in order to become an eagle. That's why this 
            constellation has a double name. In its unredeemed condition it is 
            called Scorpion after the animal that can kill itself with 
            its own sting; in its redeemed condition it is called Eagle, 
            symbolizing the free soul flying high above the material world like 
            the divine falcon Horus.  'The radiation of this constellation is the driving 
            force, the fire of life, which manifests itself in this form through 
            water—through the fluids of the body. This force enables the spirit 
            to clothe itself in matter in order to be born anew in the body. 
            This energy is the original serpent of temptation, enticing the 
            spirit into matter and causing its fall from paradisiacal unity. 
            When, however, instead of operating in the material plane, this 
            force is transformed and transmuted, becoming purely spiritual, 
            sexual desire is transformed into an uplifting force which helps the 
            fallen consciousness return into paradisiacal unity. Without this 
            force no consciousness that has fallen from unity can find its way 
            back into God! The water of this constellation is like a swamp 
            in which hidden fermentation is going on and over which, without 
            actually burning, little fiery will-of-the-wisps are dancing.  'The Fishes dwell in the endless ocean. 
            Although they sometimes come to the surface, they submerge again and 
            disappear in the immeasurable depths. The true nature of man is 
            similar to the ocean. His consciousness is on the surface, but by 
            far the greater and deeper part of him lies in the unconscious where 
            the reasons and the roots of his thoughts, words and deeds 
            originate.  'On the other hand, the person who has achieved 
            redemption and attained complete and perfect recognition of self, 
            whose consciousness has been initiated in his divine self and 
            achieved realization in his self, no longer has a 
            subconscious and a super-conscious. That is to say, there is no 
            longer a part of him that is unconscious. Figuratively speaking, he 
            swims, completely conscious, in the depths of the limitless ocean of 
            the divine all-consciousness. With the unredeemed person 
            recognizes—or often enough, does not recognize—as the "unconscious" 
            has become his home and element in which he is perfectly conscious. 
            The two manifestations of sex—the male and female—are as happy as 
            two carefree fish in the ocean of perfect harmony. The effect of the 
            sign of the Fishes is redemption, dissolving away the 
            personal in the impersonal, in the depth of the limitless self,
            in the divine and indivisible unity of all one being'. 
            The great work of redemption is completed by the radiation of this 
            power, the spiritualization of matter is achieved.  'You see, the three aspects of each triangle are 
            related; starting on the material plane, they progress upward in the 
            direction of spiritualization.  'But there's not only a relationship between the 
            three aspects of each of the, faces of God, the four 
            triangles are actually so related that their centres are identical. 
            In this way they make up the zodiacal circle of twelve revelations, 
            much that the various aspects of the four triangles form an 
            inter-related series of steps in development and progress. Then 
            there is still a third relationship between the individual 
            constellations, namely the one between opposite constellations, 
            each of which is a complementary half of the other.  'First, let's discuss the relationship of the steps 
            hi development.  'The series naturally begins with the constellations 
            of the Ram, as the beginning of all expressions of life—and 
            hence the beginning of springtime— lies in the Ram. But you 
            should take note of the fact that there are two "beginnings of 
            springtime", one absolute and one relative. Every 
            manifestation of life—including the earth and all the creatures 
            living on it—  carries within itself "the absolute beginning of 
            spring" or "springtime point". This absolute springtime point is 
            independent of the outside world. On the other hand, the relative 
            springtime point depends on the position of the stars at any given 
            moment. Thus because of the various movements of the earth, it 
            doesn't stay at the someplace but is constantly changing its 
            position. We'll go into all this more thoroughly later.  'The signs of the zodiac run in this sequence: 
            Ram, Bull, Twins, Crab, Lion, Virgin, Balance, Scorpion-Eagle, 
            Centaur, Goat, Water-bearer, Fishes.  'Everything that condenses into matter is manifested 
            on the material plane and runs hi its own lifetime through the full 
            circle of the zodiac. The life of the individual human being is one 
            great period that is divided up into smaller periods—childhood, 
            youth, maturity and senility; these in turn break down into still 
            smaller periods: years, seasons, months, weeks and lastly days.  'All the shorter periods of man's life too—days, 
            years and so on—also run through the full circle of the zodiac. His 
            birth corresponds to the Ram. Then one after the other, he 
            runs through all the signs of the zodiac, reaching maturity in the
            Lion and dying under the sign of the Fishes when he 
            disappears from the material plane. In just the same way our days 
            begin with our awakening from sleep and appearing in the world. The 
            day develops, reaches maturity and its culmination point at midday 
            and then starts to decline. After further changes we come to the 
            evening when we put away our bodies to rest and sleep, withdrawing 
            our consciousness into the self and falling asleep—just as we 
            do at the end of our earthly lives when we put away our bodies for 
            the last time. Every period has its beginning, development, 
            culmination, decline and dissolution.  'The individual signs of the Zodiac have the 
            following main characteristics:  'The Ram sees to it that something appears
            or is born in this world in the first place, and this is equally 
            true when the actual time of birth doesn't fall under the sign of 
            the Ram! That's because every birth, irrespective of the 
            outside world and of course irrespective of the various 
            constellations, carries within itself the power of the beginning, 
            and this power we call the Ram both outside in the vault of 
            the stars and inside each individual being. That's the absolute
            side of the Ram in every created form. And the 
            relationship is just the same with all the other constellations, 
            with all manifestations of life, and with all the aspects of the 
            four faces of God. There is always an inner, absolute 
            manifestation and an outer, relative manifestation.  'After birth, every new creature must get its roots 
            down wherever it is. This it does with the help of the Bull. 
            The new creature takes in food and assimilates it. This gives it a 
            material connecting link with the outer world and creates a line of 
            supply for its body.  'Under the influence of the sign of the Twins,
            the new creature begins to gather experience, and his pathways 
            begin to diverge, going into all kinds of ramifications like the 
            branches of a tree. The creature develops in different directions 
            and gains extensive knowledge.  'In the Crab it draws back into its home 
            again to digest its spiritual gains— the experiences it has 
            gathered. Its inner core begins to develop.  'Through the life-giving, fiery effect of the 
            Lion, the creature matures and gains dignity. It develops its 
            powers and abilities and fulfils its earthly duty of begetting a new 
            generation. It becomes father of a family.  'The Virgin brings the harvest. Man brings 
            the fruits of his labours into his barn. In the depths of his soul 
            the divine child—universal love—develops.  'In the Balance his deeds are weighed, the 
            positive and negative credited and debited against each other. His 
            attention is directed towards both sides, on the one hand the 
            worldly and on the other the spiritual. Within himself he brings 
            these two worlds into a perfect equilibrium, putting into effect, 
            the inner, divine law which stands above and beyond everything 
            that's relative.  'The sign of the Scorpion brings the 
            solstice, the great turning point. Man must spiritualize the divine 
            creative power which so far has manifested itself within him as a 
            driving instinct and urge. He must now utilize this divine creative 
            power in the service of others. This means he must completely 
            overcome his person. He experiences the mystic death of his person, 
            then resurrection and immortality in spirit. From now on he ceases 
            to serve materialism.  High up above the earth, in perfect spiritual 
            freedom, he flies like an eagle, like the sacred falcon 
            Horus.  Through the effect of the Centaur he becomes 
            a great teacher like the Centaur itself, a being which has 
            grown beyond the animal level, a being which now uses its animal 
            body only in order the sooner to reach the great goal it clearly 
            ices ahead. Its thoughts cut like lightning through the heavy clouds 
            of darkness and ignorance. It passes its experience on to the next 
            generation.  'In the sign of the Goat the divine 
            child—universal love—is born in man's heart. It becomes identical 
            with divine self and conscious in it. As the divine child 
            that has been born in his heart becomes visible, man becomes clear 
            as crystal. In his words and deeds, he reveals universal love.
             'In the Water-bearer the creature pours out 
            and scatters its treasures. It has become the shining, resplendent 
            child of God standing above and beyond sexuality. Radiating 
            itself, it is the source of the highest divinely spiritual power, 
            The process of transformation and de-materialization begins.  'In the sign of the Fishes the living 
            creature experiences a re-unification with its hidden complementary 
            half. This means, of course, that matter is disintegrated. The 
            creature returns to its heavenly home, to universal unity, to
            God. Its consciousness glides over into cosmic 
            consciousness, it casts off its body, and ends its earthly life.
             'That's the path that every individual follows, even 
            though he may not yet have reached the highest levels of 
            consciousness. The steps of development may be different, but the 
            circle of development is always the same.  'Now let's look at how the opposite signs of the 
            Zodiac supplement each other:  The powerful, impulsive strength of the Ram 
            is regulated by the Law of the Balance which tames the 
            Ram's blind forces and guides them into the right channels.  'The bridal power of the sign of the Bull 
            supplements and satisfies the instinctive procreative urge of the 
            Scorpion.  'The maternal power of the Crab, retiring to 
            the shelter of its own hearth and home, is the complementary "other 
            half" of the crystallizing, parturient radiation of the Goat. 
            The newly born child belongs to mother.  'The paternal radiation of the Lion finds its 
            "other half" in the childlike power of the Water-bearer. The 
            father supports, protects and educates the child.  'The youth in the sign of the Twins with his 
            eagerness to learn, receives the knowledge he is thirsting for from 
            the great teacher, Centaur.  'The heavenly Virgin, bearing the divine 
            child in her holy womb, receives nourishment from the mystic world 
            of the two Fishes.  'Now you understand the radiations of the four faces 
            of God in the varying effects of the different 
            constellations. But in order to understand the life of the universe 
            and the lives of the myriads of living creatures—including your own— 
            you need to know that the circle of revelation, with its twelve 
            centres of power, affects every point of the universe independently 
            of the constellations. And because the four faces of God can 
            never turn around, each constellation emits different radiations of 
            power in the various directions of the sky. Thus the radiation is 
            determined by the everlasting, never-changing direction of 
            the four faces.  'Let's take the constellation of the Lion for 
            example. In the direction of the south it emits the radiation 
            characteristic for the lion, while towards the opposite side, to the 
            north, it sends out the power of the Water-bearer, in a 
            westerly direction, that of the Eagle, towards the east, that 
            of the Bull, in the north-northwesterly direction, that of 
            the Virgin, towards west-north-west, that of the Balance,
            and so on, a different radiation in each direction.  'Now you understand that these radiations are not 
            dependent on displace of the group of stars, but rather on 
            the direction from which they come. Just like the wind has 
            different effects, depending only on the direction in which it 
            blows, not on the place in which it starts.  'And now here's another very important fact: because 
            everything manifests itself outwardly from its own centre, 
            and because the four faces of God radiate absolutely equally 
            and unchangeably from every point, everything— whether it's a 
            central sun, a sun, a planet, plant, animal, protozoon or human 
            being—is always in the centre of two wheels: in the centre of 
            the great cosmic wheel and— since this centre is identical 
            with the centre of the individual being concerned —also in the 
            centre of one's unmanifested being, one's own inner wheel. 
             'We receive the radiations of the great 
            cosmic wheel from the outside while those of our own wheel are 
            emitted from the inside.  'We are identical with the situation of the earth 
            which has fallen out of the divine being. The earth is not in a 
            central spot in the universe, but rather a satellite of the sun, 
            orbiting around the sun and rotating about its own axis. That's why 
            we see everything in the universe as the exact opposite of what it 
            is in reality, in the divine state of being. Seen from our position 
            on the earth, the whole vault of stars—with all its cosmic systems, 
            solar systems and planets— appears to rotate around us. But in 
            reality the opposite is happening. It's not the vault of stars 
            that's rotating around us, but rathei our earth that is orbiting 
            around the sun, our sun with our entire solar system moving in a 
            larger orbit around a cosmic sun, and the latter—with all of its 
            cosmic system—moving around a central sun, and so on in ever-greater 
            orbits and ever-greater cosmic systems, on and on into infinity.  'And even the life of celestial bodies in cosmic 
            systems is nothing other than movement and development in the great 
            cycles of the four faces of Go d, in the Zodiac. But just 
            remember that every manifestation, every created form, regardless of 
            where it is in the universe, carries within itself both the great 
            cosmic wheel and its own little wheel, irrespective of whether it's 
            a protozoon, a plant, an animal, a human being or celestial body.
            You'll consider this quite a matter of course when you 
            understand that every point of the universe radiates the same 
            twelve-fold manifestation of the four faces of God—without 
            these latter being able to change their position.  'The radiations of energy which we receive from the 
            great cosmic wheel come to us from the outside; that's why we see 
            the circle wrong side to, just like a mirrored reflection of the 
            divine condition of being (see illustration, page 244).  'Because the vault of stars, as seen from our 
            standpoint on the earth, is always in motion, there is a 
            corresponding change going on constantly in the composition of 
            radiations reaching the earth from all the countless stars moving 
            along their individual paths in the gigantic cosmic wheel. Every 
            created form— including every human being—has its own 
            individually composed structure of forces made up of the same 
            creative forces that radiate from the stars in the universe. At the 
            moment of birth the structure of forces in the individual's own 
            little zodiac wheel is identical with that of the forces in the 
            great cosmic zodiacal wheel. And this leads us to something else 
            that you should know, namely, that a living creature can be born 
            only when these two structures of forces coincide with each other 
            completely.  
             The position of the earth in the four faces of 
            God which can never turn around  'Until the end of his life on this earth, man is 
            constantly subjected to new impressions, new experiences and all 
            kinds of other influences. As he gathers experience, his own inner 
            constellation is modified to a great extent. Many forces are 
            developed, many others get pushed into the background, depending on 
            the individual's reactions to his deeds and his experiences. The 
            inner constellation a creature has at the moment of its death is 
            stamped indelibly upon its soul, and the latter cannot be 
            reincarnated until the vault of stars, in its constant movement, 
            comes into the same constellation. This is why some people are 
            reincarnated again after only a very short time while others may 
            even have to wait thousands of years until the stellar 
            constellations match those they carry in their souls.  'All the creatures that are being born into the 
            three-dimensional world every moment throughout all eternity ended 
            their previous incarnation under the same constellation as the one 
            which existed at the moment of their birth in this incarnation. 
            The death constellation in one incarnation and the birth 
            constellation in the next are always absolutely identical. On the 
            other hand, the birth constellation and the death constellation for 
            any given incarnation are never identical, because the individual 
            living creature concerned is changed through the experiences it has.
            But every creature—including man— carries within itself 
            the imprint of the constellation reigning at the moment of its 
            birth, and it carries this imprint through its entire life. This 
            constellation contains the creature's own individual wheel in which 
            its subsequent development and character changes are hidden.  'So if you want to know the inner birth 
            constellation of the forces that have built a living creature and 
            are working in its soul, in its body, in its entire being—and 
            consequently also in its fate—you have to figure out the 
            constellation the stars had at the moment of its birth.  'Because of the steady movement of the stars in the 
            sky, the relationships within the two wheels—the cosmic and the 
            individual—are constantly shifting. The centres of energy in the 
            cosmic wheel—the constellations, the fixed stars and the planets—and 
            the hidden centres of power of the individual wheel move away from 
            the identical patterns they had at the moment of birth. After a time 
            these patterns of power within these two wheels can approach each 
            other again. That's why in the life of each individual there are 
            favourable and harmonious relationships at certain times and 
            unfavourable disharmonious relationships at others. As a result, the 
            creatures concerned sometimes reveal harmonious-positive 
            characteristics and disharmonious-negative characteristics at other 
            times. And because fate is the mirrored reflection of character and 
            the result of the individual's deeds, its life takes favourable 
            turns sometimes and unfavourable ones at others.  'All forms of life are subject to these forces, 
            and only one creature has the possibility of ruling over all these 
            energies and forces at work throughout the universe, within its own 
            being and within its own destiny. This creature which has the 
            ability to control these forces at will is man. But he can control 
            them only when he is conscious of them, recognizes them in himself 
            and overcomes them!  'As long as man does not recognize these 
            forces in himself, he is just as much (it their mercy as all the 
            unconscious forms of life which are directly in contact with all 
            these creative forces and willy-nilly controlled by them. Only the 
            human being who has attained the ability of self-recognition is able 
            to rise in his consciousness above these forces. Instead of being at 
            their mercy in an unconscious way, he is able to control them or 
            transmit them in a transmuted and completely changed form. When man 
            is able to transmute the creative forces within himself, he is also 
            able to transmute the forces operating within his destiny: thus 
            controlling his own fate.  'Now you understand why it is necessary and 
            important to know about the twelve-fold radiation of power of the 
            four faces of God within yourself, and why it is essential to 
            learn to control it. When you realize that only your body and the 
            material part of your being is built up out of these forces, whereas 
            your divine self stands above them and is able to control them—you 
            yourself can regain control over these tremendous creative powers, 
            the same control you lost when you were born into the material 
            world. When you realize this, you can liberate your self 
            which in your body has been crucified on two great beams of the 
            material, three-dimensional world—time, and space. 
            Your self which has been repressed and forced into your 
            subconscious is liberated, resurrected from its apparent death and 
            reinstated on its throne. This mystery of life is symbolized by the 
            cross with the divine form crucified upon it, representing the 
            second aspect of God. The creative principle clothes itself 
            in matter and for aeons of time makes the supreme sacrifice of 
            taking upon itself the characteristics of the material world in 
            order to animate it and fulfil its great task of spiritualizing 
            matter by completely revealing the spirit in matter.'  35
           
            THE EPOCHS OF THE WORLD I stand before Him. He begins: 'The earth and 
            its inhabitants are not yet conscious of the forces which reach the 
            earth from out of the cosmos and maintain it. Consequently the 
            inhabitants of the earth aren't able to control these forces and 
            transform them at will. The earth receives these radiations from out 
            of the cosmos and is immersed and bathing in these waves of energy. 
            Everything that happens on earth is a direct reaction to the action 
            of these radiations ... a kind of resonance resulting from their 
            inter-action.  'The sun magnifies to a tremendous extent the 
            radiations of the particular constellation in which it stands at any 
            given moment as it radiates its force to the earth simultaneously 
            with the radiations of the constellations concerned. This fact 
            has a bearing on the way in which the four seasons have come into 
            being.  'The movements of the earth give us the impression 
            not only that the vault of stars is rotating about us, but also that 
            other movements are taking place. One of the most important 
            movements the earth makes is that its axis describes the surface of 
            a cone. Whereas one of the end points of the earth's axis remains 
            relatively fixed, the other describes a circle. Because of this 
            movement, the vernal point in the cosmic wheel is slowly displaced. 
            Seen  from the earth, it appears to be moving backward.
             'The time it takes for the axis of the earth to 
            complete one full conical movement—moving from the vernal point in 
            the zodiacal circle right round to its starting point 
            again—corresponds to 25,920 terrestrial years. We call this a cosmic 
            year. Divided by twelve, this number gives us a cosmic month, mainly 
            2,160 terrestrial years, the time it takes for the vernal point to 
            move through one zodiacal sign.  'The vibrations from the cosmos have such a great 
            effect on the earth that they even influence world history. The 
            leading ideas in religion, science and art are the result of the 
            radiation of the particular constellation in which the vernal point 
            is moving throughout the course of a cosmic month. The incarnated 
            spirits on earth—that is to say humanity—must always achieve a new 
            epoch by reaching a new milestone in human development and 
            establishing themselves in the ideas of the time.  'A nation is a group of spirits, the incarnation of 
            certain concentrations of energy. Each epoch brings to the earth a 
            different group of spirits, a different race, and when this race has 
            fulfilled its task of carrying out the new ideas and developing a 
            new civilization for the space of a cosmic month, it leaves the 
            earth in order to develop further on another planet. In every race, 
            of course, there are always individuals who don't quite "make the 
            grade" before the end of the epoch. These remain behind, like the 
            dregs in a drink, and must continue to develop on earth. That's the 
            reason why a nation experiences a sudden decline after achieving a 
            high point in civilization. The highly developed fathers of the 
            nation are followed by degenerate and weak-willed descendants, and 
            the nation which was once greatly esteemed gradually falls into 
            debility and disrepute. These descendants are the dross of the 
            nation which has reached the highest degree of earthly development, 
            become spiritualized, and departed from the earth.  'The material world has come into being because 
            interferences have occurred in the divine creative radiations 
            traversing cosmic space, and these interferences have caused 
            condensations, solidifications, materializations. If the celestial 
            bodies were to receive pure, untransformed vibrations of the divine 
            creative force, this would result in the immediate annihilation of 
            all matter. The fixed stars—the suns—are the great transformers 
            which convert the creative vibrations from all celestial bodies and 
            transmit them in wavelengths and frequencies that are tolerable for 
            the earth. The transformed rays reach us from the fixed stars which 
            form the constellations of the zodiac. Thus when we want to 
            represent the highest divine radiation of energy, we choose the 
            symbolic form of the constellation with the strongest effect on the 
            earth, and this is always the "epoch-making constellation" through 
            which the vernal point is moving at the time.  'We are now living in an epoch in which the vernal 
            point is moving into the constellation of the Bull. God (Ptah)
            reveals himself to us in the radiation of this constellation, 
            and that's why the divinity manifesting itself in the atmosphere of 
            the earth is represented in the form of a bull, in the form 
            of the divine bull Apis. The complementary constellation of
            Scorpion-Eagle is represented as I he temptress—a serpent 
            crawling upon the earth—or in the form of the divine falcon 
            Horus. You know that this energy, as long as it is earthly and 
            expresses itself on the low plane binding spirit to matter, is the 
            serpent luring man back Into further incarnations. On the other hand 
            when this force is spiritualized, It helps man to experience, while 
            still in the body, the highest degree of spirituality.  'We use the serpent standing erect as the 
            symbol of initiation, as the mistress of the tree of recognition and 
            knowledge. The initiate is a high-flying eagle who has 
            spiritualized the serpent—the power of the instinctive urge— and 
            manifests it as spiritual power through his intellect. The initiate 
            is thus an instrument of the divinity which reveals itself 
            through the zodiacal sign of the Bull. That's why in our 
            epoch these animals are regarded as "holy animals" throughout the 
            entire world. Now you understand why the initiates change their 
            representations of God to accord with the constellation in 
            which the vernal point falls at any given time. Above and behind all 
            these symbols, of course, there always stands the unmanifested First 
            Cause—divinity resting within itself.  'The constellation of the Bull belongs to the 
            threefold manifestation in which the face of God has an 
            earthly-material effect—contracting, drawing together and hardening. 
            This means that at the present time the forces that build up matter 
            and operate within it are the easiest and most immediately available 
            forces for the inhabitants of the earth to use. Our task is one 
            of conquering matter with matter, that means conquering 
            matter with the energies making up the essence of matter. We use 
            the frequencies of matter, these unseen and immeasurably powerful 
            forces—in other words, the spirit of matter—in order to 
            conquer matter itself. We charge the matter of the ark of the 
            covenant with the entire octave of these energies and thus control 
            the laws of matter—the forces of construction and destruction, 
            materialization and dematerialization—as well as the weight of 
            matter which we can either overcome or increase at will.  'In time our truths will come to flower. But then as 
            celestial movements and changes continue, the earth will gradually 
            move out of these regions in the cosmos in which certain specific 
            energies are working together to produce our present epoch. Little 
            by little certain of these energies will diminish, while new ones 
            come into the picture, and thus the total pattern of vibrations 
            affecting the earth will gradually shift. This means of course that 
            the people being born into life on the earth will be gradually 
            changing. The time will come when they won't understand our truths 
            any more. The symbols and words we use to express the mysteries of 
            the laws of creation will lose their content, becoming empty husks 
            for thousands of years. Mankind will have to learn through new tasks 
            and surmount new obstacles in their accomplishment.  'You already know what is going to happen when the 
            last high priest has initiated the last candidate worthy of our 
            knowledge. After giving this new initiate the ark of the covenant 
            and a staff of life, the last high priest will lock himself and his 
            assistant inside the great pyramid, block the entrance from the 
            inside with a stone fitting into the opening ... then the two of 
            them will dematerialize all our equipment and apparatus and lastly 
            themselves in order to save our secrets from falling into unworthy 
            hands. Meanwhile the last initiate, who will come forth out of a 
            nation destined to create a new epoch in the history of the earth, 
            will salvage the ark of the covenant and his staff of life and have 
            them carried out of this country. He will proclaim to his people the 
            ideas of the new epoch in which the vernal point will move through a 
            constellation of the Ram. The two complementary 
            constellations of the Ram and the Balance will exert 
            the strongest effect during that period.  'Come, my little daughter,' says Ptahhotep, 'Now 
            I'll lay my hand on your head and you will see pictures of times to 
            come.'  Ptahhotep leads me to a couch on which the 
            neophytes, under his guidance, practise the ability of moving their 
            consciousness freely throughout time, intentionally seeking out the 
            past and the future in order to experience them as the present.  Ptahhotep bids me lie down, and no sooner has he 
            laid his hand upon my brow than I get the well-known buzzing and 
            prickly feeling in my head. The very next moment I see pictures 
            which, in the symbolic language of dreams, shows me the 
            significance of events in the distant future.  I see the reception room of the Pharaoh—a strange 
            hall and an unknown Pharaoh who is not an initiate like my father 
            but who has a radiation of a very low degree. Before him are two 
            handsome, dignified men—two brothers with noble, magnificent 
            features. From their radiations I recognize that one is an initiate 
            while the other is only a quick-witted able speaker. The initiate is 
            silent while his brother uses his powers of oratory. He is trying to 
            convince the Pharaoh that he should free their people who are 
            working as slaves in the service of the Pharaoh and let them leave 
            the country under the guidance of these two men. The Pharaoh is hard 
            of heart and refuses. He demands a miracle. Then the brother who is 
            doing the talking takes his staff and casts it on to the ground In 
            front of the Pharaoh. Instantly the staff turns into a serpent 
            crawling over the ground. The Pharaoh calls his magicians to give 
            the men an answer. They too cast their staffs upon the ground and 
            these also turn into serpents. But the first serpent devours all the 
            serpents of the magicians.  I interpret the vision. The staff represents the 
            intellect, a powerful instrument. But when the intellect is bound to 
            the earth and made to serve purely material ends, it becomes a 
            serpent crawling on the ground, a wily temptress enticing man to 
            selfishness. The two noble brothers struggle unselfishly for their 
            people. In their hands guile turns into wisdom which destroys all 
            the selfish arguments of the cowardly magicians.  Now the vision changes. The godlessness and 
            selfishness of the Egyptians causes new plagues and afflictions of 
            growing severity. But still Pharaoh does not yield. He still refuses 
            to liberate the people from their bondage. Finally the gravest 
            scourge of all descends upon him. All the first-born of the people 
            and I heir animals, and even of Pharaoh's own household, are killed 
            by the angels of God in a single night. Only those who have eaten 
            of the flesh of the lamb and have written their names with lamb's 
            blood on their doorposts are not killed by the angels.  What does the symbol mean? In the new epoch just 
            coming, the complementary constellations of the Ram and the
            Balance will be dominant. During the lime when the effect of 
            the Ram constellation has not yet reached full strength, the 
            effect is that of a young ram, in other words a lamb. In 
            their blood, the people following this initiate have forces 
            corresponding to the radiation of the ram constellation. They 
            are the forerunners of the new epoch, the 'chosen people', able to 
            proclaim to humanity the old truths in a new form.  Those who have fulfilled their destiny in the old 
            epoch must now go. Their task is over. The angels of God call them 
            home.  Then I see a new vision. The mighty initiate leads 
            his people out of Egypt. And because the Ram is a fiery 
            sign, a pillar of fire moves ahead of him to show him the way. 
            He leads his people out of the spiritual darkness prevailing in 
            Egypt at the end of this epoch. But Pharaoh's heart hardens again. 
            He regrets that he has allowed these people to leave his country in 
            freedom. With his entire army, he starts out in hot pursuit of the 
            refugees. But the great initiate, in order to protect his people, 
            uses his staff of life. He directs against Pharaoh's army the 
            frequencies of ultra-matter which greatly intensify the earth's 
            gravitational force. Suddenly, Pharaoh with all his warriors, 
            chariots, and animals become as heavy as if rooted to the spot where 
            they stand. Their tremendously intensified weight pulls them 
            irresistibly down into the earth. And as all of this takes place on 
            the seashore, the great waves of the sea finally roll over Pharaoh 
            and his entire army.  I am amazed! Not about the effect of the staff of 
            life, but about the animals! I have seen such strange and remarkable 
            animals in Pharaoh's army. Some of them were pulling the warriors' 
            chariots, while others carried warriors on their backs. The animals 
            looked like zebras but were bigger and different in colour—brown, 
            white, grey and even black! I've never seen such animals! Could 
            these be the animals father once spoke about? Magnificent animals 
            they are too!  But the vision changes. The initiate wanders with 
            his people through the 'desert', in the always difficult 
            transitional period between two epochs. Two different ages are never 
            sharply separated from each other but rather flow into each other 
            gradually. Hence there is a transitional period in which the effects 
            of the two constellations—the old and the new—appear to be weakened 
            because of their mutual interference. The old ideas don't satisfy 
            the new generation any longer, while the old generations are unable 
            to accept and assimilate the new ideas. The greater portion of the 
            people turn back to their old, ossified ideas, that is, to the ideas 
            of the constellation of the Bull. But these ideas no longer 
            have the power of a full size bull. On the contrary, greatly 
            weakened, their strength is only that of a little bull, a calf. In 
            the symbolic language of dreams, spirit is always gold, and 
            so in my vision of the future I see the people of the initiate 
            dancing about a golden calf and worshipping it.  In the meantime the great initiate is 'on the 
            mountain' and speaking 'face to face with God'. He is in the 
            very highest state of consciousness, identical with God. He is the 
            bearer of the will of God. It is God's will that he proclaim the new 
            ideas to his people through two religious symbols, the sacrificial 
            lamb, symbol of the constellation of the Ram, and the two 
            tablets with God's ten commandments, symbol of the constellation of 
            the Balance.  The sacrificial lamb is the divine self 
            which, clothed in matter, allows itself to be crucified on the two 
            great beams of the three-dimensional world, time and 
            space, thus giving up its own life in order to save the earth 
            through spiritualizing it.  The two tablets of commandments, like the ones in 
            our temple, on the head of the sacred falcon Horus, symbol of 
            the divine self, the creative principle traversing space, stand as 
            symbols for the inner structure of the self manifesting 
            itself in the soul as moral laws.  For more than two thousand years these divine truths 
            will be the guiding ideas and the religious symbols of the people. 
            These divine truths will be the challenge of the new epoch.  When the initiate brings the finished tablets of 
            commandments and sees his people worshipping the golden calf, he 
            bursts out in such a fit of rage that he dashes the tablets to the 
            ground and smashes them in pieces while he asks God to punish 
            the disobedient people.  Then came venomous serpents, symbols of the 
            temptress, the snake, the driving force of the constellation 
            Scorpion. The serpents fall down out of the sky and bite the 
            people that have worshipped the golden calf. They suffer 
            terribly from the poisonous bites. The initiate takes pity on the 
            hapless people. In the middle of their camp he sets up two beams in 
            the form of a 'T' and he places a brass snake perpendicular to it,
            with its head up. This is the symbolic representation of the 
            tree of recognition and knowledge, the tree of the serpent. No 
            longer creeping along the ground, but with its head upward, the 
            serpent ceases to be the great temptress enticing people into the 
            body and becomes a symbol of the highest wisdom leading men back 
            into unity, to God. All the sick people who look upon this 
            brass serpent quickly become well again.  Interpreting the vision, I understand that people 
            who cannot or will not accept the ideas of the new era fall ill 
            spiritually. They no longer find their place among people and fall 
            into deep spiritual conflict. They can only be healed by being 
            guided back into the mid-point of their own being where the tree of 
            the serpent stands. When they look upon this tree—without eating 
            of its fruits— they recognize the divine truths without 
            exploiting them for their own selfish purposes, and they are healed. 
            Wisdom and selfless omniscience heal every disease of the soul.  The visions of the future go on. The great initiate 
            leads his people up to the threshold of the new epoch, up to the 
            borders of the promised land. Then he goes up into a mountain 
            and disappears. No one ever finds his body. I know that he has 
            dematerialized himself just like the last initiated high priests 
            have de-materialized themselves with their secret instruments and 
            apparatus in the great pyramid.  The chosen people who are called to proclaim and 
            carry out the ideas of the new epoch wander onward, guarding the 
            wisdom and the secret teaching of their great master. But little by 
            little the ark of the covenant loses its magical power, and there is 
            no initiate left to recharge it with his staff of life ...  A cosmic month goes by, and the axis of the earth 
            moves a twelfth of the way around the surface of its conic orbit. 
            Slowly the vernal point passes over into the sign of the Fishes.
            Once again people are unsettled. They can no longer find truth 
            in the worn out, conventionalized ideas of the previous age. They 
            resemble a herd of sheep without a shepherd. In this transitional 
            period an avatar—-a son of God—the great teacher of the 
            coming epoch, is born with the supreme task of revealing the 
            greatest mystery of creation by enabling God to walk 
            incarnate upon the earth.  This son of God is the earthly image of the 
            heavenly sacrificial lamb. Just as the divine cosmic self 
            sacrifices itself, taking upon itself the matter of the 
            three-dimensional world and the everlasting crucifixion of the two 
            great beams of time and space, in this same manner 
            this Son of God who manifests fully the divine self in 
            his human body, must accept the vengeance of the spirit of matter as 
            he undergoes death at the hands of ignorant people.  A person who in his consciousness identifies himself 
            with his body lies in inner darkness and resembles a stable with 
            animals—the animal-physical instincts—living in it. In this stable 
            and in this darkness—just as in the darkness of night—the divine 
            child is born, the consciousness of the self. Two kinds of 
            people recognize the divine child and bow low before him: The plain, 
            simple, unlettered and unlearned who do not yet know the doubting of 
            the intellect and who live in unison with nature, like shepherds for 
            example; and the knowing ones and initiates who have already 
            travelled the long path of the intellect, have overcome their 
            earlier propensity towards intellectual cleverness, and have learned 
            to look at things with their inner sight after the manner of the 
            wise men and mystics in the East.  The religious symbols of the new era are Fishes
            and the Virgin, the two complementary signs. The son 
            of God chooses his co-workers from other 'fishermen'. He 
            pays the tax he owes to the earth with a golden coin which he takes 
            from the mouth of a 'fish'. He draws forth for humanity the 
            nourishment of his teaching from these two complementary signs. But 
            his teachings are heard by people of varying degrees of development. 
            To those who have already awakened in spirit and have therefore 
            attained the fifth level—the spiritual plane—to these 'five 
            thousand' people he gives all his teachings, the two fishes 
            and the five loaves, the five grains of wheat on the ear in 
            the hand of the virgin in her symbolic representation. But 
            even these 'five thousand' people who are already awakened in spirit 
            cannot completely receive his highest ideas, not even in an entire 
            epoch! Of the nourishment he has given there remain twelve 
            baskets full of remnants. This means that humanity must learn the 
            mysteries of the self in each manifestation of the twelve signs of 
            the zodiac. In order to understand and attain these high truths, 
            humanity needs twelve epochs, twelve ages, that is a full cosmic 
            year—25,000 terrestrial years.  To all of those who have only been able to rise in 
            their consciousness up to the fourth plane—the 'four thousand' 
            people—the son of God does not distribute all the truths of 
            the two signs of the zodiac as nourishment but only 'some' fishes 
            and five loaves. But even this 'some' of his ideas is too much for 
            them to eat, and there remain seven baskets of remnants. 
            Materialistic people must first learn the mysteries of the seven 
            planes before they are ready for the cosmic truths of the self.
             The sign of the Fishes belongs to the aqueous 
            triangle. Hence in this epoch humanity must stand up to the 
            challenge of water. It must conquer water with 
            water. And before my astonished eyes I see a machine by means of 
            which people make use of the power of water transformed into steam. 
            And I see great ships— like cities!—crossing the sea with enormous 
            speed. They too are driven by the power of water transformed into 
            steam. Mankind passes the test: it conquers water with 
            water.  In medical science too water dominates the picture 
            as a therapeutic agent.  Everywhere I see bathing establishments, spas and 
            medicinal baths making use of water for all kinds of cures and 
            treatments: Salt water baths, marsh baths, hot and cold baths, 
            compresses, and many many other applications of water for the curing 
            of physical ills. People even take advantage of the healing power in 
            dew by walking about barefoot in the wet grass.  Then towards the end of this era when the vernal 
            point approaches the next constellation—that of the Water Bearer—people 
            make technical discoveries and inventions based on wave energies. 
            This is one of the early effects of the budding Water Bearer 
            era, an age of technical achievement. The radiation of the Water 
            Bearer constellation, which knows no limitations and sweeps all 
            obstacles out of its path, reveals itself in the ideas and social 
            concepts of humanity. At the end of the era of the Fishes, 
            these new energies cause great revolutions in the places where 
            people react most powerfully to them. I see thousands of people of 
            the ruling class sitting in prison, while a spirit with the 
            characteristics of the new coming era decapitates or otherwise kills 
            countless people of the upper class.  A vision from the time when the energies of the 
            Water Bearer are working with full power shows me that the great 
            teacher of this epoch abolishes all the boundaries between the three 
            dominant religions. With his own person he proves that the inner 
            core of all religions is one and the same truth, one and the same 
            God. The boundary between religion and science disappears too, 
            as people discover that everything, even matter, is a wave movement. 
            They learn that the only differences between manifestations of the 
            spirit and those of matter are differences of frequency, while in 
            its essence everything is only the manifestation of the one, 
            single, prime source of all forces, God. Everything is a 
            wave, just as the symbolic representation of the Water Bearer
            constellation shows: a supernal being pouring waves out of his 
            pitcher.  The spiritual movements on the earth show this 
            effect. Science discovers the 'wave' theory, and I see countless 
            inventions based on waves. I see pictures of people, landscapes and 
            objects—pictures made by the effect of light waves. I see different 
            kinds of devices which send out waves. Waves penetrate matter and 
            reveal its solidity. There are waves that show what elements are 
            present in the matter of the planets and fixed stars, electric 
            waves, waves of sound, light and smell. Medical science has stopped 
            giving treatments with water in favour of treatments based on 
            waves. All kinds of waves, from infra-red to ultra-violet, short 
            waves and still shorter waves, even more penetrating waves and 
            frequencies ... all in use by science!  The constellation of the Water Bearer belongs 
            to the airy face of God. And mankind conquers the air with 
            air, with energies won from matter in the airy state. I see 
            people moved onward from the steam engine to other machines operated 
            by gas. And then my astonished eyes follow huge locusts high up in 
            the air, made by human hands and carrying people in their bellies! 
            These machines are powered by gas: Air conquers air 
            ...  Through the complementary sign of the Lion 
            people again recognize the strongest manifestation of God on earth. 
            The sun, the great Ra, is again acknowledged as the prime 
            source of all manifestation of earthly energy. Once more people have 
            become sun worshippers, even though not in a religious sense. The 
            influence of the Lion shows itself in another plane too. The 
            effect of the Water Bearer is to abolish all boundaries, all 
            limitations. But the absence of boundaries without a concentrating 
            mid-point means mental disease, spiritual death. The boundlessness 
            of the Water Bearer would affect the unconscious masses as a 
            mental illness running throughout all humanity, causing anarchy and 
            chaos, and destroying everything. Through the complementary sign of 
            the Lion, however, dominion is concentrated in individual 
            persons—dictators —who group the people about themselves and guide 
            them.  In this epoch people discover traffic and 
            intercourse with other planets. Boundaries and obstacles disappear, 
            and with them the isolated state of the earth in cosmic space. And 
            as the boundaries between countries disappear too, all humanity is 
            governed from one centre. 'One stable, one shepherd.'  The eternal wheels roll on, and the earth moves into 
            a new epoch, under the sign of the Goat and its complementary 
            constellation, the Crab.  People direct their attention to the earth again, 
            noticing that although their knowledge may be very great, they still 
            know very little about their own marvellous mother, mother earth. In 
            this epoch they solve the problem of conquering earth. The 
            sign of the Goat belongs to the earthly face of God. 
            People design a special machine based on the same principle as that 
            of our ark of the covenant. With it, they control the weight of 
            matter. That is, they can overcome the earth's gravitational pull, 
            or through ultra-material radiations, they can vastly increase it. 
            People communicate with each other directly through the earth—in the 
            depths of the mountains—in short straight lines, instead of taking 
            the long way around the earth. This new machine of theirs radiates 
            an energy which dematerializes everything in front of it, thus 
            moving forward quickly, freely, without let or hindrance. At the 
            same time it spews out condensing and solidifying radiations behind 
            it restoring the matter of the earth to its original condition. 
            People have conquered matter with matter, with the energy of 
            ultra-matter. This enables them to penetrate into the depths of the 
            earth and harness for the service of mankind the enormous forces and 
            energies raging there like primordial volcanoes.  The combination of the two zodiacal signs of the 
            Goat and the Crab has a strong influence on the spiritual 
            life of mankind. The great teacher of this epoch reveals unto man 
            the mystery of the immeasurable sources of power hidden in the 
            depths of the human soul. Those who hold the key to these sources of 
            power possess abilities which the ignorant call 'supernatural'. All 
            over the earth I see public schools where even little children are 
            taught to attain these higher abilities through the kind of 
            exercises which only candidates for the priesthood are permitted to 
            practise in our temples. This high and wonderful knowledge spreads 
            into ever greater circles, reaching ever greater numbers of people.
             The visions suddenly pale as I come back to normal 
            consciousness. Still lying on the couch, I'm almost dizzy from the 
            tremendous experiences of the future. Ptahhotep stands in front of 
            me and helps me get up. He ends his instructions for today:  'As you see, my child, the inhabitants of the earth 
            receive their initiation in small groups and then in larger and 
            larger ones, all inter-related one with the other. A person can be 
            initiated individually within his own lifetime, and a 
            nation can receive initiation if it works its way up to the 
            highest level of development and fulfils its task here on earth. 
            Eventually the whole world will receive initiation by completing the 
            full circle of the four faces of God, experiencing step by 
            step all stages of initiation in a systematic development, and 
            finally achieving complete spiritualization—salvation from matter. 
            Measured according to earthly time standards, it will take ages and 
            ages for this development to be achieved. For countless times the 
            earth will have to go through the zodiacal circle, both in 
            terrestrial and cosmic years. I've shown you only the tiniest part 
            of this exceedingly long path of development. The history of mankind 
            on earth is not a matter of accident or happenstance. It's important 
            for you to know that every step of development takes place according 
            to divine providence, following a divine plan. A person can cover 
            this infinitely long way in a single lifetime if he concentrates his 
            will exclusively on this goal.'  As he gives me his benediction, Ptahhotep says, 
            'Come back again tomorrow; I have important things to tell you.'  36
           
            FINAL PREPARATIONS The next day I can hardly wait till evening to 
            report to Ptahhotep. On the other hand, I've made enough progress in 
            self-control for me not to let the reins slip out of my hand 
            regardless of any amount of pressure external things may be exerting 
            upon me. Fully conscious, I observe how external events affect my 
            nerve centres, and I simply refuse to let my nerves get stirred up 
            when I don't want them to. The moment their natural reaction begins, 
            I move in with my consciousness between them and the action they 
            have begun to take, and I consciously command my entire nervous 
            system to become as calm and cool as a piece of steel.  But now, after Ptahhotep has told me he has 
            something important to say, I can scarcely keep my heart from 
            beating faster every time I think about it, and I think about it 
            often.  Evening comes at last, and I walk through the long 
            colonnade to his little reception room. Fully composed, I stand 
            before him again.  Ptahhotep receives me as he always does. His noble 
            face radiates something indescribably exalted, and so I have no way 
            of knowing whether he has something special in mind.  'My little daughter,' he begins, 'you've progressed 
            to the point that the ability of your mind to control all the 
            natural forces in your body has been made completely conscious. From 
            now on, it depends on your own will whether you give expression to a 
            force or not. Neither in your mind nor in your soul nor in your body 
            are you any longer a slave of nature. But I must point out to you 
            that there still exists the possibility of your becoming a slave 
            again. If you consciously apply your will, nobody and nothing 
            can keep you from preserving your freedom ... or from allowing 
            yourself to be enslaved again by the forces arising from your own 
            self. It is God's will—and therefore a law—that every spirit has 
            complete freedom of will. No one may violate this freedom. That's 
            why you should never stop exercising constant self-control and 
            self-analysis.  'You are now ripe for initiation. But remember that 
            the omniscience and the omnipotence conferred upon you by initiation 
            includes commensurate responsibility. Carefully and thoughtfully, 
            you must now finally decide whether you want to be initiated and, 
            through initiation, take tremendous responsibility upon yourself.
             'Stay home for three days and practise complete 
            silence. If you are still determined to go through with initiation, 
            your father will accompany you here on the fourth day, the day of 
            the new moon, so that you can make your final preparations.'  I would like to tell Him that I am already 
            determined, but I notice that He is perfectly aware of my 
            determination. Nevertheless, the regulations must be observed, so I 
            bow again and leave.  I use the three days first and foremost to take 
            leave of everything to which I am personally attached. I know I'll 
            be a completely different person when I come home from the temple as 
            an initiate.  I wander about the garden again where once I walked 
            with my mother among the flowers. I seek out all the favourite spots 
            of my childhood where I used to play and later dreamed about life 
            and what it would be like. In all these places I stand for a time in 
            silence, taking leave of each tree and each flower, and 
            simultaneously taking leave of the little girl who once was so happy 
            here. Then I visit the gold-fishes in the great pond. I used to feed 
            them when I was so small I could hardly walk, and a slender, 
            delicate person dressed in white took me by the hand to keep me from 
            falling into the water. Today again, I feel this fine, white, 
            ethereal being near me. We are still closely attached, and I know 
            that according to the laws of incarnation, just as she, like a door 
            between the other world and this, helped me to be born, she will 
            help me on again from this world over into the next. At last I come 
            to the court of lions where I take leave of my favourite lions. 
            Until I am initiated, I am only permitted into the court in the 
            presence of the keeper. Today he accompanies me for the last time; 
            as an initiate I too will have power over all animals and will no 
            longer need his protection.  Only the lions used by the ruling family are kept 
            here. One of them is the magnificent animal that always sits beside 
            my father during his audiences as a symbol of his superhuman power. 
            Then there are the lions that pull our chariot, and finally my own 
            two animals, Shu-Ghaar and Shima. Both of them were sired by the 
            lion my father has with him in his audiences. They're both equally 
            intelligent, hypersensitive, wonderful examples of their race. Both 
            of them love me just as if I were a lioness rather than a woman. 
            Shu-Ghaar in particular is crazy about me and gets excited and 
            jealous whenever I stroke Shima. I have to watch out that his love 
            doesn't turn into blind and jealous rage. This would be dangerous! 
            As I enter the court, Shu-Ghaar runs over to meet me and pokes his 
            mighty head under my arm as an invitation for me to scratch his neck 
            and ears and stroke his mane, Then, as usual, he tries to lick my 
            face while I dodge as deftly as possible so as not to offend him and 
            make him angry. I hand him a piece of warm meat, and while he 
            devours it I get a moment to pat Shima and give him a piece of meat 
            too.  On the third and last day father and I go out before 
            sundown for a chariot ride with our lions. We race about with 
            tremendous pleasure. In accordance with Ptahhotep's instructions, I 
            am not allowed to speak, but even without this commandment, we 
            wouldn't be talking anyway. We understand each other without words. 
            Truth is like an invisible man. He can only make himself visible by 
            putting on clothes. If he puts on a lot of clothes that fit loosely, 
            we get only a very imperfect picture of him. The less he wears, the 
            thinner and tighter his clothing is, the more exact the impression 
            we get of him. But regardless of how well his clothing may reveal 
            his shape, it still covers him, and we see only the 
            clothing but never the invisible person himself.  It's exactly the same way with truth! The less
            words we use to express truth —that is, to cover it and make it 
            visible—the better we can recognize it. But by the mere fact of 
            expressing truth in words, covering it with words, we simultaneously 
            keep ourselves from seeing truth itself in its immediacy, its 
            nakedness, its true being. For people who cannot sec Into each 
            other's minds, words are the only means of communication they 
            possess. But they never see what the other is thinking and would 
            like to say ... only words about it. But we, father and I, see each 
            other! Why should we cover our thoughts and our souls with words? We 
            are here for each other and enjoy the unity of existence!
             The lions race ahead ... we ride in silence ... we 
            both know what these last days mean.  Early in the morning of the great day I take leave 
            of Menu and Bo-Ghar. Menu cries as hopelessly as if I were going to 
            my own funeral. She has baleful forebodings of something terrible to 
            come. There's simply no way I can console her. Little Bo-Ghar has no 
            idea what's happening, but he cries bitterly too because he sees me 
            going away and because Menu is crying. As I start to embrace him, he 
            throws himself on his knees before me and puts his arms about my 
            feet. From the very deepest depths of his soul, he cries out: 'O 
            Queen, my dear Queen, don't forget what I swear unto you now: Any 
            time, any place you are in danger, I'll save you! Even if I am at 
            the other end of the earth, I'll come to you! Remember, as God is my 
            witness, I'll save you!'  Dear little Bo-Ghar! He'll save me! But what from? 
            If Ptahhotep finds me prepared and ready for initiation, how could I 
            get into danger? And why is the boy saying that he would even come
            from the other end of the earth to save me? He's here with me 
            now; how could he possibly go so far away? But I can't think about 
            his words, for the time has come. I embrace them both, then walk 
            over to my father's chambers.  Father receives me with a sad and earnest 
            expression, and I see that he is withdrawn and deep within himself. 
            Does he too see something baleful and forbidding in my future? He 
            embraces me, lovingly places his right hand upon my head, and 
            blesses me. Then we go.  Ptahhotep awaits us in his little reception room. 
            Before we enter, Ima appears for a moment in the long colonnade. His 
            angelic face is beaming, his eyes smile at me with encouragement, 
            and then he's gone again. I know that his love too will be 
            accompanying me in the difficult challenging hours ahead. Father 
            takes me up to Ptahhotep. He takes my hand and puts it into 
            Ptahhotep's hand. Once again he gives me a loving look and then 
            leaves the room.  'My dear daughter,' says Ptahhotep, 'a great circle 
            of the law in which your destiny manifests itself in the world of 
            time and space is closing today. This circle—your earthly career—was 
            already determined and set the very moment you fell out of divine 
            unity for the first time, just as a boomerang, at the moment it's 
            thrown, has within itself the forces that determine the kind of 
            circle it will make, how high it will rise, how much time its flight 
            will consume, and when it will return to its starting point.  'Your present character and your destiny were built 
            up by the same forces. Both of them are the result of cause and 
            effect, actions and reactions, deeds and experiences through 
            countless lives in which the self has manifested itself 
            throughout ages and ages of time. All these actions and reactions, 
            deeds and experiences have crystallized out in your present person 
            and character. Your character determines your destiny and 
            consequently your future. The self radiates its creative 
            forces through the sieve of the character into the incarnation, and 
            through picture-making forces in the depths of the soul, these 
            energies create dream pictures. These latter project 
            themselves outwardly into the material world where they manifest 
            themselves as your "person" and your "destiny".  'The self radiates into every human being the 
            same creative forces. The fact that so many different dream pictures 
            and so many different persons and destinies arise from these same 
            creative forces is the result of the different influences to which 
            people have been exposed since their fall from paradisiacal unity.
             'Whether the future projections of the self 
            which have not yet materialized but are still waiting for 
            materialization in the depths of the soul—in the subconscious—become 
            "realities" on the material plane or whether they merely remain 
            "dream pictures" depends on the plane with which man identifies 
            his consciousness. A "dream" is also "reality", only in the 
            immaterial, picture-making energy world, while what happens on earth 
            and what people call "reality" is also only a "dream", a projection 
            of the self, the only difference being that it is a lower 
            projection, working into the material plane, and visualized into the 
            atmosphere of the earth. Destiny is thus an incarnated 
            projection of the future, a materialized dream.  'As long as a person allows the will of his self—the 
            will of God—to rule, what happens on the material plane, in 
            the so-called "reality", is what he himself consciously wants.
            Consequently he is also in control of his destiny. This is 
            because a person's self has the power to take those dreams of 
            his which are waiting in his subconscious for materialization and 
            transform them into spiritual energy. On the other hand, the moment 
            a person identifies himself with extraneous forces which are rising, 
            not from within his self, but from within his lower nature, 
            his body, and the moment he recognizes these forces as his own will, 
            what happens is no longer what he himself wants but what his 
            body wants, even though he may be fully convinced that this is his 
            "own" will. In this way he loses control over his destiny and is 
            completely at the mercy of the blind forces of fate. In this case, 
            the "dream pictures" and projections lying latent in his 
            subconscious unavoidably and with absolute certainty turn into 
            "real" events on the earthly plane.  "In your initiation, before you re-awaken out of 
            your physical consciousness into the divine 
            cosmic-self-consciousness, the energies which you have created 
            through your deeds and their reactions throughout ages and ages of 
            time and which are now waiting in your subconscious for the time of 
            their materialization—like seeds of future events—will appear in 
            your consciousness as dreams. You can't destroy them because they 
            come forth out of creative forces. But you can prevent these 
            energies from coming down and turning into reality on the level of 
            the material world. You can do this if you yourself, with your 
            consciousness, go down into the depths of your soul, where these 
            forces are hiding in a latent state, and if you awaken them to life 
            in your consciousness and experience these dreams yourself as full 
            reality, "To experience" means that you draw the forces that have 
            been sent out back into your consciousness and live them as states 
            of consciousness. In this way the inner tension within the forces is 
            dissolved away. The energies then fade away, lose their power, and 
            are destroyed.  'In your initiation you will experience your whole 
            future destiny as a series of different states of consciousness—as 
            dream pictures—without being conscious of either time or space. In 
            this way you will become liberated from your "person" and thus from 
            your own personal fate. You will continue to use your body as an 
            absolutely impersonal instrument of God. This is because every 
            initiate has the duty of continuing to work on earth in order to 
            help other people out of the fetters of matter, out of the fetters 
            of the body, out of the claws of blind fate, back into the divinely 
            spiritual state of unity. Everything and everyone that has fallen 
            into separation and into matter by virtue of becoming incarnated 
            must find its way back home to the lost paradise, back to the divine 
            state of unity.  'But when an initiate works in the opposite 
            direction, that is, when he uses his high spiritual energies to 
            create personal realities for himself by directing the supreme, 
            creative, all-penetrating forces from his divine consciousness into 
            his body, he falls lower than an ordinary person who does the very 
            same thing with his consciousness that has fallen out of the 
            paradisiacal unity. The ordinary person directs into matter only 
            the forces arising from his material being. He experiences physical 
            forces in his body, and for him this doesn't represent a fall. He 
            manifests forces on the level from which they come. Material 
            forces remain on the material level.  'The initiate, on the other hand, isn't just working 
            with physical forces, and when he directs his high spiritual 
            energies into the body, he falls from his high state and falls down 
            low. The higher the energy the lower he falls.  'That's why you have to remember that as an 
            initiate—it you want to become one—you can't do things that ordinary 
            people can do with "impunity", because as an initiate you radiate 
            and set in motion divine forces, not human ones. If you direct these 
            forces into your body, you burn out your nerve centres and plunge 
            into the lowest depths like a falling comet.  'Your preparatory exercises have developed you to 
            the point that you can understand these truths. So now, in full 
            consciousness, you can give me your answer. Have you the courage to 
            take upon yourself these laws, the danger and the great 
            responsibility; do you desire to receive initiation, or do you wish 
            rather to withdraw and live out your earthly life according to the 
            laws of human existence?'  For a time I keep silent. Then, earnest and 
            determined, I reply, 'Father of my Soul, throughout the years I've 
            been preparing I've had enough time to decide whether I wanted to 
            choose the temple or a worldly life. And during these last three 
            days I've concentrated again on this question and on nothing else. 
            My only longing is for the divine, primordial state. I am absolutely 
            determined. I beg you to initiate me!'  'So be it,' says Ptahhotep, 'and may God be with 
            you! Now follow me.'  He takes me to another wing of the temple where the 
            neophytes live. There he turns me over to a young priest, a chief 
            among the boarders, who is awaiting us. I have seen him before. 
            Turning to me Ptahhotep says, 'You will now prepare your body and 
            your soul for initiation. On the day when the moon reaches its 
            fullness, come to me at sundown.'  We both of us bow, and He departs.  The priest leads me to a cell where I spend the next 
            few days alone, devoting myself exclusively to my exercises. The 
            purpose of these exercises is to bring the purity of my thoughts, my 
            soul, blood and body up to as high a point as possible. Even during 
            the years when I was going to the neophyte school, I had to follow a 
            very strict dietary regimen, in order for the new cells constantly 
            being produced in the body to be chemically purer than those they 
            replaced, and in order for my body tissues to develop resistance 
            enough to be able to bear the highest vibrations. This is because 
            any chemical change in matter alters its resistance to the forces 
            conducted into it. Now the process reaches completion. I am 
            permitted to eat only certain special roots and herbs. I have to 
            chew them thoroughly, and I am permitted only to swallow the juice I 
            can chew out of them. These herbs and roots are so chosen that some 
            of them tend to strengthen and stimulate the organs of excretion, 
            while others have a similar effect on the heart and nerves, so that 
            my whole organism is not weakened.  As a result of this new dietary discipline, I feel 
            lighter and lighter with each passing day. Within a few days' time, 
            I even feel as if I didn't have a body at all. On the other hand, my 
            mental lucidity and ability to concentrate increase to a degree I 
            have never known before. In all my life I have never been able to 
            think so clearly ... never been able to perceive spiritual truth 
            with such pristine crystal clarity as now. By mere fasting alone, 
            without the use of strengthening herbs, one can also reach a high 
            degree of mental clarity. But the nerves can suffer damage in the 
            process. Although they become hypersensitive during fasting, they 
            are greatly weakened at the same time.  Through the use of these herbs, all the 
            disadvantages of fasting are eliminated.  One by one the days go by ... until the day of the 
            full moon comes. Withdrawn deeply inside myself, I go forth to 
            report to Ptahhotep. I enter just as the sun is disappearing below 
            the horizon.  'Follow me,' says Ptahhotep, and leads the way out.
             Ptahhotep takes me through the temple around the 
            sacrificial table and on over to the great stone wall. The gigantic 
            stone blocks fit together with hairline precision. Now I know why. 
            Ptahhotep steps over to the middle one which slowly swings outward, 
            revealing an opening in the wall. Beyond it lies a broad stone 
            staircase leading downward. We go down to the bottom of the steps, 
            then follow a long passageway. My sense of direction and a certain 
            feeling in my lungs tell me we are walking under the ground. 
            Surprisingly enough, however, there is no mould or mildew, and the 
            air is fresh and pure, with even a scent of ozone in it. At the end 
            of this subterranean passageway, we reach another staircase, leading 
            upward. After we've climbed it, Ptahhotep leads me through more 
            passageways, some wide, some narrow. We walk through rooms of 
            various sizes containing strange and incomprehensible apparatus, 
            then climb up more steps. Finally we enter a large room.  All these passageways and rooms—including this 
            one—are brightly illuminated just as if by daylight, yet nowhere can 
            I see a source of light. It seems as if the light were coming from 
            the stones themselves. The equpiment in this room is so mysterious 
            that it immediately captures my full attention. The room is 
            radiantly bright. I see a large, strange, prismatic something that 
            gives me the the impression it's made, not of solid matter, but of 
            light ... of some kind of concentrated, solidified light. This 
            concentrated light mass radiates ordinary light too. That's why the 
            room is so bright.  Once while I was visiting a potter, I had a chance 
            to look through the peephole in his fiery kiln. In it several clay 
            vessels were standing in a row, all glowing white with the heat and 
            all completely transparent. I could see them all, one right through 
            the other. They were all radiating light too. And this great 
            mysterious prismatic form is radiating light in just the same way. 
            Yes, light— but no heat!  But there are still other incomprehensible objects 
            in this room. They are made of such a strange material and in such 
            remarkable shapes that I can't begin to imagine what purpose they 
            could serve. But there's no time to study them, for I am completely 
            engrossed with the question of my initiation, how it will take place 
            and what I will experience.  Ptahhotep leads me into the farthest corner of the 
            room where I discover an empty stone sarcophagus. 'Up to now,' 
            remarks my guide and mentor, 'you've always heard what 
            initiation is, but you don't know how it takes place.  'During initiation, the candidate's body is 
            subjected to a higher frequency than that which corresponds to his 
            degree of consciousness. Thus he becomes conscious on this higher 
            level!  'Only a person prepared through long and strict 
            training can be initiated in this way into a higher power, into a 
            higher level of consciousness, without suffering harm. Only such a 
            person is able to control his body with the help of his intellect, 
            understanding and will-power, and to attune his nerves to higher 
            frequencies.  'As you already know, animals are not able to alter 
            either their mode of living or the condition under which they live. 
            That's why they are not able to bear higher frequencies than their 
            own. To take an example, if a monkey were subjected to a current of 
            the same frequency as man's, it would die within a few minutes of a 
            "stroke", undergoing unspeakable nervous cramps while dying.  'Man, however, can adapt himself, up to the range of 
            an octave, to different vibrations and bear these vibrations without 
            death. In this way, an average person, after adequate physical 
            preparation and training, could be subjected without damage to the 
            current of a genius, in other words, the current of the fifth 
            degree. He would feel a heavenly bliss. That's because every higher 
            vibration, so long as it's bearable, induces an exhilarating feeling 
            of happiness. Then, however, the vibration becomes a torture because 
            the nerves are unable to bear up under the excessive current. Lower 
            vibrations than those of the individual concerned induce dejection, 
            fear and dismay. If an average person, because of longing for the 
            blissful state once experienced, could later reach the state of 
            initiation into the fifth degree and reach it often through patient 
            and persistent practice, the nerves and cells of his body would 
            gradually become so inured and transformed that he could really 
            raise himself by one step upward and actually become a genius. He 
            would go on experiencing a steady flow of intuitive knowledge.  'The feeling of bliss connected with a higher state 
            of consciousness is known to every person who is gifted with 
            intuition, and everyone who drinks wine or uses other stimulants is 
            seeking the same blissful feeling associated with a greater flow of 
            current through the nerves. But the artificial stimulation is always 
            followed by a depression which throws the person farther down than 
            he was before.  'In the great initiation, all the currents of 
            force corresponding to the seven levels of consciousness are 
            conducted into the body, beginning with the lowest and moving 
            progressively upward to the very highest divine creative currents. 
            The candidate is initiated in all these forces and becomes 
            conscious on all levels. For a candidate to be ready to go 
            through this initiation and come out alive, his consciousness—and 
            with it his power of resistance—must previously have reached the 
            sixth level. For any creature whose consciousness had not attained 
            this plane, the act of initiation would certainly mean death.  'In this way, with the help of the current of force, 
            a candidate attains the seventh, divine degree which he never would 
            have been able to reach alone. No one can attain initiation on the 
            divine-creative plane through his own unaided efforts. Here he goes 
            through the great transition from his previous— negative-taking 
            attitude to a positive attitude of giving. Regardless of how much he 
            may strive to do so, no human being can go through this transition 
            alone and unaided, although many are able through their own efforts 
            to develop to the point where they are perfectly prepared for 
            initiation on the seventh plane. In such cases, the laying on of 
            hands is all that is needed to initiate them into the divine 
            cosmic-self-consciousness. Never again do such initiates fall out of 
            divine consciousness, as they have moved through the entire cycle of 
            total consciousness, acquiring all necessary experience as they did 
            so, and only the reunion of their two complementary halves, each of 
            which has become perfectly conscious—remains to be accomplished. 
            Only this last help has to be given from the outside. From then on 
            they live in a state of continual God-consciousness.  'Through Initiation in our temple, however, it's 
            possible for candidates to be initiated into the divine seventh 
            degree even though they may not have developed all the way up to the 
            seventh degree in readiness for it. As a prerequisite for such 
            initiation, they must have become conscious at least on the sixth 
            plane, and they must have adequately prepared their body. Through 
            this external aid of initiation, their path to the true self 
            is opened, and in the act of initiation, their consciousness is 
            linked up with the divine flow of power.  'These candidates are not able, after initiation, to 
            continue living in the divine state of consciousness, They fall back 
            to their previous state. But they remember the bliss they 
            experienced in initiation, and as their path to God has been opened 
            for them, they enjoy the possibility of attaining the seventh plane 
            of development faster and easier than by merely following the long 
            path of earthly experience and human development of consciousness. 
            Initiation hi the temple is thus able to bring back many more people 
            to the bliss of union with the divine self than would be possible 
            without this aid.  'On the other hand there is a danger that a person 
            initiated in this way, after his initiation and before he is able to 
            become a God-man through his own efforts may not be able to resist 
            earthly temptations and thus falls lower than in his first fall. 
            This danger does not exist for the uninitiated. If, without 
            initiation, a person completes his cycle of living along the long 
            path of mortals all the way to the end, to the great goal, 
            until he returns home to the Garden of Eden, there remains nothing 
            in experience, nothing unknown in him. He achieves the divine plane 
            after having gained experience on all levels, in this way gradually 
            effacing his person. To achieve this, however, it takes a living 
            creature an entire age of creation.  'It is God's will for the great initiation in the 
            temple to continue to be available to mankind for some time to come 
            in spite of this danger. Countless people have already been redeemed 
            in this way and brought back to God, and many more will be. 
            And the few who relapse after their initiation will reincarnate 
            themselves in later times when mankind is left to its own resources. 
            They will remember the great truths they experienced through their 
            initiation and will proclaim these-truths to their fellow men in 
            their words, writings and actions.  'The secret of the great initiation will be guarded 
            hi the temple for some time yet. But when more and more earth-minded 
            people come into power in times to come, we will close the 
            initiation pyramid with blocks of stone from the inside and will 
            dematerialize everything in the initiation chamber. The secret of 
            divine creative energy will not fall into uninitiated hands. 
            Thousands of years later when people break into the pyramids, they 
            will find nothing— absolutely nothing—not even human skeletons.  'There are many souls on earth today who fulfil the 
            prerequisites for the great initiation. It is our duty to initiate 
            all of these candidates if, despite our warning, they repeat 
            three times their wish to be initiated.  'In initiation the candidate becomes conscious on 
            every plane of creation. All unconscious portions of his soul become 
            conscious; he has no "subconscious" and no "superconscious". During 
            his initiation, the consciousness of the initiate becomes whole, 
            total all-consciousness. The circle which began with his 
            becoming conscious in matter—in the body—the moment he fell from 
            unity, is closed. The candidate consciously unites with his own 
            complementary half which previously was always present as an 
            unconscious portion of his soul, like a negative image, a strange 
            being, and which because of its power of attraction manifested 
            itself as longings, powerful urges and unrest in his body. The 
            consciousness returns to unity, and there is no longer a 
            complementary half, for the complementary half has also been made 
            conscious. This reunion we call "mystic marriage".  ' "Marriage" always means a union of positive and 
            negative. On earth, however, "marriage" means the vain attempt to 
            achieve union with another being in the body. But the mystic union 
            of the spirit takes place in the consciousness and brings 
            complete, never-ending fulfilment; for the union with one's own 
            complementary half means union with God. The circle is closed 
            again!  'The human body is so constructed that it contains a 
            special nerve centre for each octave of vibration, On the one hand, 
            these nerve centres are distributors, sending out through the 
            nervous system the vibrations they receive from higher centres. On 
            the other hand, they act as transformers when they pass on 
            vibrations to the next nerve centre below.  'In the ordinary human being, these transformers in 
            nerve centres work separately from his consciousness. That's why he 
            can't control them. The laws of nature control him without his 
            knowing what is taking place in his body and in his soul, in his 
            subconscious.  'In his initiation, the candidate must consciously 
            experience the high flow of current in all seven major nerve centres 
            and the powers corresponding to them. With his consciousness he 
            first descends to the lowest sphere of creation. He must experience 
            the forces ruling there and become master of them. This is his 
            first test. When he passes it successfully, he moves up one 
            degree into the second octave of vibration, recognizing and 
            experiencing it in order to master it. This is the second test.
            Then he climbs on into the third, fourth, fifth, sixth and 
            finally into the seventh octave of vibration. When he has passed all 
            these tests and succeeded in consciously remaining master in 
            all these spheres—then he has become an initiate.  'Consciousness is light, unconsciousness is 
            darkness. When we see light above us on earth, we say it's day.
            Thus each state of consciousness is a "day" of God; for in 
            each consciousness, from the lowest plane of matter up to the 
            God-man's consciousness of self, God recognizes himself on 
            the different levels. On all these "days"—on all the levels 
            of consciousness, there is activity, unrest, motion except on the 
            seventh "day" of God when there is no activity, no motion, no 
            work! On the seventh "day" creation ceases because on this 
            day there is complete unity and perfect equilibrium. Then God 
            rests within himself!  'When, after his initiation, an initiate succeeds in 
            becoming conscious again in the eternal being and experiences 
            this divine state again during his meditation, and when he succeeds 
            often enough in thus raising himself by his own power from his 
            normal sixth plane up to the seventh divine plane, in time he 
            consolidates his position definitively on this level of 
            consciousness, and the divine creative plane is the one he liven on 
            day in and day out. Then and then only does he become a God-man,
            Only a person who, in his consciousness, is peace and calm
            itself, so that everything he does, thinks and feels flows forth 
            naturally out of this divine state, manifesting God's will always 
            and under all circumstances, always radiating only positive giving 
            forces of divine love— only such a person is truly a Son of 
            God, a God-man, Ptah-Hotep!  'The God-man consciously manifests and controls all 
            seven levels of creation. But his consciousness identifies itself 
            only with the seventh, divine plane, not with the lower ones. He 
            knows them, masters them, uses them— but does not eat of 
            these fruits of the tree of knowledge of good and evil! He 
            consciously remains in God, in the paradisiacal state, He 
            unites within himself all seven planes in divine unity: he is 
            matter, has a body, is a plant: animates, nourishes and cares for 
            his body as for a good instrument; he is animal: he has instincts 
            and feelings; he is a man: he has intellect and the power of logical 
            thought; he is a genius: he has intuition and works out of the plane 
            of causes; he is a prophet: he stands above time and space, seeing 
            the future and the past, loving the entire universe with selfless, 
            all inclusive love, helping all creatures towards redemption from 
            the fetters of the world; and he is a God-man: he is omniscient and 
            omnipotent; he is what he is, the eternal  being, life itself, God!  'Initiates, as you can see, are not all of the same 
            degree. Most of them only reach the seventh degree after further 
            development. That's why there are different degrees in the 
            priesthood. The duties of a high priest can only be fulfilled by one 
            who has reached the seventh degree of the God-man with his own 
            power, no longer expecting and receiving the highest 
            divine power—the way the candidate expects and receives it during 
            his initiation. On the contrary) the high priest radiates and 
            gives out this highest divine power himself.  'Six of the seven degrees of consciousness receive 
            their creative vibrations, the power of life, from the seventh 
            degree, from God. Even the initiate who has been able to 
            reach the seventh divine degree only during his initiation, still 
            expects and receives the creative power of life from the seventh 
            degree, from God. Only God and those who have become 
            identical with God are truly and exclusively munificent in 
            their radiations.  'Matter, on the other hand, as a negative reflected 
            image of God, only receives.  'All beings on the other levels receive from above 
            and transmit to the levels below.  The plant has a vitalizing effect on matter, while 
            on the other hand it receives five-fold from the levels of 
            intelligence above it. The animal gives off two-fold to the levels 
            below it, while receiving three-fold from those above. Man gives 
            three-fold towards the levels below him and receives three-fold from 
            those above, as his consciousness stands in the middle of the seven 
            planes. As the consciousness of the genius is on the fifth plane, 
            the plane of causes, he radiates his creative powers out over the 
            four levels below, while he receives power only from the two 
            highest. The prophet—the initiate— transmits his beneficent 
            vibrations to the beings on the five lower levels of consciousness 
            and receives his power from the divine level. He still lives in a 
            dualistic relationship with God. Only a person, who has 
            attained perfect cosmic consciousness by his own efforts 
            emits positive radiation, and only positive, in all directions, 
            life-giving and munificent towards the entire universe. He lives in
            God, in monistic consciousness of self.  'You have already learned that giving—radiating—is 
            the law of God, of the spirit, while taking—contraction—is 
            the law of matter.  'Every frequency has a powerful and penetrating 
            effect on the levels below it, whereas it has no effect on those 
            above. If you take two people on different levels of development, 
            the person on the lower level, although he may be a "bad" person in 
            the view of people about him, can only harm the person on the higher 
            level through deeds, but never through his radiation, as his powers 
            have no effect on the levels above his. On the other hand, his 
            radiation, especially his "evil eye" can do harm on the levels below 
            his level of consciousness. An initiate, on the other hand, can 
            transmit his high magic power to every living being without 
            exception.  'During initiation, the divine creative power will 
            flow through your spinal column, reaching each of your seven major 
            nerve centres in turn, and you will experience this power as a state 
            of consciousness on each level. But remember very carefully what I'm 
            telling you now: When you become conscious in one octave and 
            vibration, you are in tune with this frequency, and its whole sphere 
            represents absolute "reality" for you. When you have passed the test 
            in one degree, you will waken in the next sphere and realize that 
            you were only dreaming on the level below. But if you don't pass the 
            test, that is, if you identify yourself with the events and don't 
            succeed in remaining master of them, all of these dream pictures 
            remain real for you, and you'll have to experience all of them to 
            the very end as real events in the world of time and space. That 
            would mean that your body would die here in this coffin and you 
            would have to go on dreaming your own dream pictures in countless 
            reincarnations, on the long path of mortal existence, for many 
            thousands of years while you gradually struggled upward from this 
            lower level to which you would have fallen.  'The difference between dream and reality is only 
            that what you accept on one level of consciousness as reality 
            immediately turns into a dream when you awaken on a higher level of 
            consciousness and realize that it wasn't reality at all, but merely 
            a projection of the self, in other words a dream. Every dream 
            is reality as long as you believe it to be real. The one and only 
            reality, the only objective reality there is, is the 
            self: God!  'When you pass all the tests, you experience all the 
            lives that you would have to experience as a fallen soul on earth. 
            Free of time and space, you experience them as dreams, awakening on 
            the next level of consciousness. Finally you awaken on the seventh 
            level, in the cosmic consciousness of the self. In this 
            divine state, you become one with the last unit highest and only 
            reality, with yourself, with God. This is no 
            longer an awakening, but a resurrection!  'Then you have been liberated from your 
            "person"—which also is only a projection—liberated from your 
            personal fate. You are redeemed. After that you will fulfil the 
            duties of a priestess in the temple. Then, if through further 
            practice you succeed in raising yourself up to the seventh level 
            through your own efforts, keeping yourself his level as a permanent 
            state of consciousness, you will have attained the divinity of a 
            God-person. Then you will be worthy to become a high priestess in 
            the temple.'  'Father of my Soul,' I ask Ptahhotep, 'you've told 
            me that it's possible for a person to fall from the higher 
            consciousness even after he has been initiated. You've also told me 
            that the initiate, when he identifies himself with his body and thus 
            channels his higher energies into his body, falls lower than an 
            ordinary person living in physical reality. Another thing you've 
            told me is that a candidate, during his initiation, experiences 
            his whole future destiny, just as it has been provided for from 
            the moment of his first fall all the way back up to his return home 
            into divine unity. So how is it possible for an initiate, who has 
            dreamed all the events and trials and temptations of his destiny and 
            who has, during his initiation, successfully passed all the tests 
            that might later cause him to fall again—how is it possible for such 
            an initiate to fall later in the three-dimensional world of time and 
            space? If he has seen his entire destiny all the way to the end as a 
            dream, why hasn't he also dreamed about his fall as part of his 
            future destiny?'  'When a boomerang is thrown out,' answers Ptahhotep, 
            'how it will fly and how long it will take to complete its circuit 
            are factors that are already known the moment it's thrown. So it 
            carries within itself its entire career as an immutable future fate. 
            It would be possible however, for an external force to catch it in 
            the middle of its orbit and bring it back to its starting point and 
            goal in shorter time and by a shorter path. The boomerang would thus 
            have returned home. But because it maintains its original form and 
            weight, it still carries within itself the possibility of being 
            thrown out again and making another circuit, because this 
            possibility is given by virtue of its form and weight.  'An initiate who has attained initiation by means of 
            external aid resembles this boomerang. He has dreamed his entire 
            future destiny out to the end, to his return into divine unity, but 
            he has experienced these conditions only in his consciousness.
            His person and his personal circumstances, which arise from his 
            character and fate, still remain in the material world. With his 
            initiation, he has not ended his present life, just as you, 
            after your initiation, will still be the daughter of the Pharaoh and 
            the representative of the Queen. And if an initiate has not gathered 
            all the necessary earthly experience before his initiation, if he 
            has not got acquainted with all the creative forces within himself 
            and learned to control them, he is to some extent still 
            inexperienced when he returns home into the divine state of 
            unity. This means that he is not yet completely liberated from 
            the personal composition of his powers and his personality is not 
            yet completely annihilated.  'During the intervening time until such an initiate 
            is able to reach the seventh degree by his own efforts and maintain 
            himself in it as a perpetual state of consciousness, he carries 
            within himself the possibility and the danger of falling again from 
            his high stale of consciousness and starting on a completely new 
            wheel of destiny. Because he has become conscious in the 
            divine creative power, however, even though with external aid, 
            this tremendous power throws him out again, and then he must go 
            through a much larger cycle than was the case after his first fall
            before he became conscious in the divine power. The black 
            magicians, for example, who destroyed the home of the sons of God 
            have fallen to the lowest plane of creation. They now lie as 
            mountains, rocks and stones on the earth and must work their way up 
            through ages and ages along the path of consciousness from inert 
            matter through the realms of plant and animal life, up to the human 
            level again. Some of them fell only as far as the plant or animal 
            level, while others fell only to one of the other levels of human 
            existence. The course a creature runs through in the material world 
            takes a definite amount of time, but individual creatures can 
            always run through the circle in a shorter time and reach their 
            goal thousands or even millions of years earlier. This, however, is 
            only possible for man. Only man, thanks to his conscious use of 
            intellect, can experience states of consciousness without 
            reference to time. Animals and plants are not able to do this. 
            Now you can understand why animals too must suffer! Like everything 
            else on earth, they are limited manifestations of consciousness of 
            fallen spirits that once lived on a high plane.  'In the initiation all the negative forces that were 
            made manifest in the fall from a higher level of consciousness are 
            offset by positive forces. The "debts" are thus paid. After you have 
            successfully passed your initiation, you'll enter a condition 
            without fate. As long as you manifest God's will, you will have 
            no person of your own and consequently no fate of your own. You will 
            be free of the law of action and reaction. But if you identify 
            yourself in your consciousness with your person, with your body, 
            you'll create a new wheel of fate for yourself and again be subject 
            to innumerable reincarnations.  'Now you know all the consequences of initiation. 
            And I'm asking you again one last time, do you have the courage to 
            go through with initiation?'  With perfect self-assurance, I answer, 'Yes!'  A tall, dignified man then enters the room. I know 
            him. He is a priest of the highest degree, a high priest too, 
            Ptahhotep's representative. He steps over towards us. Then Ptahhotep 
            motions to me to get into the sarcophagus and lie down in it.  I do as he commands.  As I lie in the sarcophagus, Ptahhotep casts a last 
            glance at me, full of infinite love, and then the two priests lift 
            the stone cover and lay it over me. In pitch darkness I lie there 
            enclosed in the stone coffin.  37
           
            THE INITIATION As usual, I watch what happens.  Nothing happens.  I lie in the stone coffin and peer into the 
            darkness.  Darkness? It's not really darkness, for in the 
            middle of my field of vision I observe a greenish phosphorescent 
            light. Around it points of light seem to flash up and then 
            disappear. I watch these points of light and try to guess where they 
            come from and where they are going.  Suddenly I notice that the points of light, when 
            they appear aren't as close together as they were. On the contrary, 
            right in the middle, where the greenish phosphorescent light was 
            before, there's an empty space that none of the points of light 
            approaches. They leave more and more space around this spot which, 
            because of the complete absence of light in it, is a pitch black 
            hole through which I peer into nothingness …  Then I notice two points of light that appear in 
            this total, dead darkness. Slowly they come closer and stare at me 
            like two eyes. I don't see the eyes; they have neither light nor 
            colour, and yet I'm obliged to see them. I know that two eyes 
            are staring at me. These two eyes do not belong to a body. They are 
            centres of force of streams of energy which take effect invisibly. 
            These dim, black energies attack the points of light. The points of 
            light are sucked up by this force, destroyed. A contour appears, 
            creating a boundary around this empty, dark hole that radiates this 
            invisible force. Before my horrified eyes, there gradually appears a 
            face, the eerie features of a monster, a silhouette that is only 
            recognizable because where it is there is absolute nothingness—a 
            negative image.  I know, I just know this disembodied monster is 
            Evil itself. I know it. I've seen its horrible grimaces 
            occasionally glowering through human faces as the expression 
            of those faces. Now the cause of that expression, the being 
            itself, without a human face, without a body, is here!  Or was it always present and I just didn't notice it 
            ...?  This bodiless face resembles the head of a goat. The 
            silhouette clearly shows the form of horns over a long, pinched face 
            that ends with a little goatee. Or perhaps, are all these shapes 
            only radiations of invisible forces?  The being's eyes, set so close together, have a 
            terrifying effect, like bottomless maelstroms that irresistibly pull 
            everything down, down, down to complete annihilation.  Through these two baleful eyes, the monster now 
            radiates all his fearful powers upon me and into me. These awful 
            eyes bore into me, and through me, through my entire being, 
            swallowing me irresistibly into themselves as if I were being sucked 
            into a gigantic maelstrom.  Absolute panic seizes my heart. I feel myself 
            turning limp and lifeless out of sheer terror. Coming closer and 
            closer, his horrible eyes get more and more penetrating. I can feel 
            how this satanic being—is it Satan himself?—is forcing me 
            into his power. The monster spreads out over me, swallows me, and in 
            a moment I feel I am no longer myself. I am It! I feel its 
            horrible features in my face, its immaterial body in my body, its 
            devilish streams of current flowing like blood in my veins. This 
            hellish, fiendish sensation turns my whole being cold and stiff. My 
            body curls up in horrible cramps.  And deep within me IT talks to me, without words, 
            through the power which produces words, through the meaning 
            of words: 'Now I've got you! Now you're in my power! Now you see you 
            haven't been able to crowd me out of your consciousness. In spite of 
            your efforts to do so, you belong to me anyway now! You and I are 
            one. There's nothing to separate us anymore. I am the "I" in you, 
            and you are the "I" in me. You are subject to my law of cooling, 
            contraction and solidification. Do you feel how your body is curling 
            up, how you're drawing your knees up all the way to your chest? 
            They're crossed now and your feet are pressed close to your body, as 
            close as if the soles of your feet were joined to your body. Your 
            arms are crossed in front of your breast. Your hands are curled up 
            into fists pressed against your body as tightly as if they were 
            joined to it. Now your head is dropping down on to your chest, 
            pushing itself close between your fists—closer—still closer! Just as 
            if you were in your mother's womb! That's right, and now you've 
            shrunk and shrivelled into just one piece. You're getting colder and 
            harder until you become a little oval piece of stone! A piece of 
            stone—rigid, hard and dead! But you still have your consciousness 
            and know that you're dead, that you've solidified into this 
            piece of stone, that you are this piece of stone; you're walled up 
            in it—dead for endless time ... for timeless eternity ...  'Look around and see the mountains reaching up to 
            the sky. Do you see all these rocks and stones and boulders? Don't 
            just look at them, look into them. Look into their 
            being. Can you see that all these stones are petrified but 
            conscious beings like yourself, exposed to burning sunshine, 
            raging storms and splitting frost? ... Every creature, every animal, 
            every human being walks on you and all these other stones. Spring 
            torrents drag you into wild waters, and you rub and scour each other 
            in these whirling rapids ... endless time ... timeless eternity ...'
             Horrified, I experience everything the evil one
            says. This is hell indeed. Alive and conscious, yet locked up 
            and immovable, grown into this tomb, with no possibility of giving 
            so much as a sign of life ... to be a heavy, dead stone! ... To 
            be?  No! I am not that! I am only 
            imprisoned, entombed in this stone, but I am not the stone.
            My self is not matter! I am the dimensionless self, a 
            spirit beyond any concept of time and space!  And with the inner strength of the spirit, just as I 
            learned to speak with it in my telepathic exercises, without body, 
            without mouth, speaking in spirit, I soundlessly scream at the 
            monster: 'No! I am not you, and you are not "I"! We are forever 
            separated in our beings, for you are death, and "I" am 
            life! We can never be identical with each other! You with your 
            law of contraction and solidification, you're the negative, the 
            reflected image—the caricature—of the eternal source of all life, 
            of divinity resting within itself! You're not a horrible 
            phantom. You're not a monster. You're not "the evil one". You 
            have no independent existence. The divine self created you 
            and goes on eternally creating you whenever it clothes itself in a 
            material envelope, in a body. You are the inner being of matter, you 
            are the law that maintains matter; so you have power over my 
            body, because you had to construct it on the command of my self
            when I was born into this material world and became a 
            person. But you have no power over me, over my creative self; 
            for you're nothing else but the law of matter come to life 
            through my spirit. Not I am you, but I am that I am and 
            you are also what I am! Your essence is contraction, and on the 
            spiritual plane, in consciousness, contraction manifests itself as
            fear. And you must disappear, because I don't fear! 
             The effect of my unspoken, soundless words is 
            terrifying! It gets pitch dark around me, and the mountains cave in 
            with a deafening thunderous roar. Rocks and boulders fall, the earth 
            opens, complete chaos rages about me ... only I stand firmly 
            on my feet in this cataclysm ...  As things become quiet again and I slowly return to 
            my senses, I realize I've just had a horrible dream. How good It is 
            to awaken from such a nightmare ...  My first sensation is one of extraordinary hunger 
            and thirst, but I don't want to waste time with eating and drinking, 
            for my goal is God. I want to get on as fast as possible.  I look about me. I am in a spacious room illuminated 
            by soft reddish light. Pleasant, well-mannered people offer me 
            tempting delicacies in beautiful dishes and heavenly drinks in 
            magnificent golden vessels. They try to persuade me to eat and drink 
            with them. I smile. The pleasures of the palate were never a 
            temptation for me. Why should I permit myself to be delayed by 
            hunger and thirst on my path to God?  I thank them for their friendly invitation and go 
            on. Singularly enough I no longer have any sensation of hunger or 
            thirst, but I still can't quite make out where I am and what's going 
            on around me. It is apparent, however, that everyone around me is in 
            constant, chaotic motion. Another one of my first impressions of 
            this place is the strange smell in the air ... the smell of 
            overheated human bodies ... not exactly unpleasant, but nevertheless 
            repugnant to me.  Little by little my eyes grow accustomed to the 
            subdued light. I am in some kind of an underground cave where great 
            numbers of men and women are lounging about pell-mell on sofas or 
            rocking and careening about, holding each other in tight embraces, 
            dancing together and making extremely odd movements. I watch them 
            with growing amazement. Are they drunk? Or mentally deranged? To be 
            sure I have seen animals during mating season when nature is 
            creating a new generation. But even when they are so keyed up that 
            their whole bodies tingle and tremble with passion, they never lose 
            their dignity ... they never carry on like these people here. And 
            the priestesses, too, who serve in the temple of love, fulfil their 
            duties with a noble attitude of spiritual dedication because they 
            know in doing so they are laying an offering upon the altar of 
            divine love. How can people fall so low that they debase the 
            supremely divine act of love and make it an end in itself? After 
            all, these are respected, reputable people—made in the image and 
            likeness of God!—and yet they act as if they've lost their reason. I 
            recognize some of them as people of rank, statesmen and ladies of 
            the court, but they don't see me. They have neither eyes nor ears 
            for anything or anyone beside themselves. The outside world has 
            ceased to exist for them. They're completely enclosed ... locked 
            up in their own imagination!  They talk with each other too, but it seems as if 
            these men and women have forgotten that speech is a spiritual 
            manifestation of man. They use speech to say the most impossible, 
            completely illogical things. For example, I hear one man, as he 
            dances with his partner in a tight embrace, ask her again and again, 
            'Are you mine?'  'Yes, darling, all yours!' the woman answers, and 
            they go on dancing. A little while later the same couple dances past 
            me and I hear the man, with his eyes half closed, asking the woman 
            again—perhaps for the hundredth time— 'Are you mine?'  'Yes, darling, I am,' the woman answers just as 
            untiringly. What's the matter with them? Isn't it enough to ask a 
            question once and get an answer. Why do they have to repeat it a 
            hundred times? And how senseless it is to ask a person such a 
            question! A person belongs only to himself. He is a free 
            being with an inalienable right of self determination. So how does 
            this man come to think he can. possess a woman? It's scarcely 
            possible to possess a lion. If even these regal animals don't give 
            up their independence, how can this man get the idea the woman 
            'belongs to him', and why is he asking her a hundred times? Is he 
            mentally ill? And perhaps the woman, who goes on answering his 
            nonsense, too? And perhaps all these other men and women who are 
            behaving in just as impossible a manner?  At this juncture a tall, broad-shouldered man steps 
            up to me. Seemingly he can read my thoughts, for he replies to my 
            inner questions: 'Beautiful lady, don't you know that this is love?'
             'Love? I certainly do know love! It is a beautiful, 
            noble sacrament when two living creatures love each other with 
            absolute devotion, but not with mere passionate desire for 
            possession! But in the hearts of these people I see no love! I see 
            only that they've lost their senses ... that passion, this fever 
            which dulls and deadens those finest, most sensitive nerve centres 
            created for transmitting spiritual revelations, holds them 
            completely in its power. These people should be saved and awakened 
            from their semi-conscious condition! I step up to a very young 
            woman, seize her arm and shout into her ear, 'Wake up! Don't let 
            your consciousness be dulled and darkened by passion! You are spirit 
            and not body! Don't allow your body to debase you! Don't let 
            yourself be dragged down lower than an animal. Wake up, do you hear? 
            Wake up and get out of here! Save yourself before it's too late!'
             The young woman peers at me as if through a 
            veil—like a sleepwalker. 'Leave me alone,' she says, 'I want to be 
            happy!' And with that she goes on dancing.  Oh how blind! How could she possibly hope to find 
            happiness through a physical embrace without spiritual content?
            Happiness is something one experiences in consciousness; 
            happiness is in the self. How could she possibly hope to find 
            happiness through mere trifling play of the body?  'Now just forget your intellect a while,' says the 
            man, 'you're not qualified to judge because you've never tried it. 
            Dance with me and you'll see for yourself.' So saying, he embraces 
            me and drags me out into the whirling mass of people, acting just as 
            foolishly as all the other people ...  I dance with him and observe myself with great 
            curiosity ... Will I too become as intoxicated, as carried away by 
            the close contact as these poor demented people about me? Hut the 
            only thing I notice is how extremely unpleasant I find the close 
            proximity of this man. His breath is hot, and I find it very 
            revolting for him to be breathing into my face and down my neck. 
            Exhaled air is used up air! Why should I be inhaling air he has 
            already used up? Then too, I find the odour of his body and his 
            perspiration most unpleasant. I want fresh air. I want to get away 
            from this repugnant place.  As I try to get away from him, the man suddenly 
            changes. In a trice he turns into a gigantic, fiery flaming spirit. 
            He no longer has a body. He is only a mighty flame, trying to force 
            me into subjection. He surrounds me, trying to force himself into my 
            mouth ... into my body. But the power I radiate, the power of my 
            clear and sober consciousness keeps him away. He cannot reach me. He 
            reacts by growing hotter, greater, more eager. He takes on 
            tremendous proportions, spreading throughout the whole room, 
            devouring all these passion-drunk people in his consuming fire. 
            Nobody is left ... Nothing more ... only a sea of flames, devouring 
            and consuming everything ...  But I stand untouched, unscathed, and I am that I 
            am!  Then I hear a thunderous voice from out of the 
            flames: 'You have won ... you have passed your test, but watch out! 
            You haven't won because you're stronger than I. You can't be 
            stronger, because I'm the fire of your own self. You just 
            didn't come alight because your purity and your lack of 
            experience stand between you and me. Your body and its senses 
            are still sleeping. That's what protected you. But watch out, we'll 
            meet again ... we'll meet again! ...' And with that 
            everything disappears—fire, room, smoke—everything ... and I find 
            myself alone again ...  'We'll meet again?' I repeat these last words. 'I'm 
            not afraid of you! Even if my body had burst into flaming passion, 
            this would not have touched my self. I stand above everything 
            physical ...'  But what was that? Didn't it sound like a scornful 
            laugh?  I look around to see where this voice may have come 
            from. So doing, I notice that I'm in a meadow as green as emerald, 
            and a strange form is approaching. It's the form of a handsome, 
            well-built man, half concealed by a veil of mist. I'd like to see 
            through the mist ... I'd like to see the splendid form it hides ... 
            I'd like to chase the mist away ... but I can't. But the man 
            interests me and so I ask, 'Who are you?'  Then the handsome man comes close, and with a voice 
            that makes a deep impression on me he whispers into my ear: 'O my 
            sweet beloved! I've been looking for you for a long, long time, for 
            an eternity, ever since we fell out of the Garden of Eden and became 
            separated from each other. At last I've found you I Come into my 
            arms! Come, lay your sweet little head upon my breast! Come and let 
            us unite in divine unity, let us merge our beings in heavenly bliss! 
            How wonderful that you haven't yielded to the animal urge of the 
            body! How glorious that you've kept yourself pure and untouched for 
            me! You belong to me and I belong to you. We supplement each other 
            completely! Do you feel the irresistible power of attraction that 
            links us and draws us closer and closer together? Come, let us unite 
            in love, you dearest of creatures, my one and only heavenly bride. I 
            love you!'  I hear his voice, I see his manly stride, I feel a 
            tremendous force radiating from him to me ... And yet he's strange. 
            I don't know him! How could he be my complementary half? No! One 
            never finds the complementary half outside oneself. Ptahhotep says 
            our complementary half is always behind the manifested form as a 
            mirrored image in the unmanifested state. No! No human being 
            can be my complementary half. And why is this man veiled in a dense 
            mist?  'I don't know who you are,' I answer him, 'but 
            whoever you are, you're mistaken! You're not my complementary 
            half. And you'll have to look elsewhere for yours if you think 
            you'll find it anywhere in the outside world. No one can find his 
            complementary half anywhere except within himself. In the world 
            around us it's only possible to find projected pictures similar 
            to one's true complementary half. But neither you nor I can 
            become complete by virtue of a picture, a projection. Only the 
            divine unity of the self can bring blissful happiness! I'll 
            find my complementary half within my self!'  'To find your complementary half within your 
            self,' says the handsome man, 'would mean that you, in your 
            consciousness, were already identical with the divine self. How do 
            you expect to experience the consequence before the cause. The 
            divine self is the paradisiacal state of unity through which you can 
            only return through becoming one with your complementary half. How 
            do you expect to achieve this without me, without your complementary 
            half? You're forgetting that you are half of a unit and I am the 
            other half.  'We are the living reflected images of each other, 
            and we belong together. You carry me about in your subconscious, 
            just as I carry you in mine, and even without wanting to we seek 
            each other with the irresistible attractive force that comes from 
            our belonging together in the paradisiacal state. Throughout ages 
            and ages of time, our fate brings us together again and again until 
            we make each other conscious within ourselves and experience each 
            other completely in body as well as in soul. Only in this divine 
            identity can we really be the total consciousness of the whole—of 
            the higher self! How do you expect to be able to return to 
            paradisiacal unity without me? How do you think you could escape 
            from facing the fact that we also belong to each other on the 
            earthly plane? How do you expect to get the experience you 
            absolutely need, without me?'  But I refuse to allow myself to be influenced. 'No 
            matter how much you try to convince me, I still don't want you! As 
            far as I'm concerned it's enough to know that you're present in the 
            unconscious part of my self, and I only want to get 
            acquainted with you within myself, but not in the outer world. Get 
            on your way and let me get on mine!'  At these words of mine, the handsome man recedes and 
            begins to evaporate like a morning mist in the sunshine. And from 
            farther and farther away his voice comes back to me - this voice 
            that has made such a deep impression on my heart: 'I'll go on 
            looking for you on the earthly plane ... looking ... looking ...' 
            His voice fades away in the distance, and suddenly all is quiet.  But there's still something I want to know, so I 
            shout after him, 'Why is there such a heavy mist about you, so heavy 
            it keeps me from seeing you face to face?'  From far away in the distance I hear a voice fading 
            out as if it were the echo of my own heart beat: 'The heavy mist is 
            covering your eyes, not me! It's your lack of experience ... 
            that's what's protecting you from me. It has helped you resist me. 
            But we'll meet again.,, meet again ...'  There's still a lot I'd like to ask and I run 
            towards the spot where he's disappeared. But I see him no more. 1 
            turn around to go back to the beautiful meadow, but I can't find the 
            way. There is a dense mist covering everything wherever I look. No 
            matter how hard I try, I just can't see through it. Yet I know I'm 
            no longer alone. I hear voices of people around me, and I know that 
            there is some kind of a relationship between these people and 
            myself. Various events follow each other in which I play an 
            important part. I hear voices speaking to me, and again and again I 
            recognize the voice that spoke to me from out of the misty figure 
            and made such a deep impression on me. I realize that this being, in 
            various different forms, belongs to me again and again, but how and 
            where? ... what are these voices all saying? And what am I 
            answering?  I can't quite fathom it. It's as if the mist were 
            covering my ears as well as my eyes. Now and again I see something, 
            but before I can recognize what it is, it disappears again in the 
            mist. Once I see a tower, and I know that someone is living within 
            it as a prisoner—he has the same voice as that of the misty figure— 
            and I hurry to try to smuggle in something to eat. I am the daughter 
            of the gatekeeper, and I have to watch out that no one notices me. 
            But an overpowering force draws me towards the prisoner. I know I 
            must help him ...  Then everything disappears again in the mists about 
            me. As' I try to get my bearings again, I suddenly see large, 
            coloured stone tiles just in front of my face. I wash and scrub them 
            until they're clean. Then again in the mist I hear a voice that 
            sounds like my own, asking over and over, 'Have you found my child?' 
            I get the impression that an old, decrepit body, which somehow or 
            other is related to myself, is very, very tired. Then this strange 
            feeling disappears, and suddenly—to my great joy—the mist disappears 
            too ...  Once again I am standing in the green meadow. Now 
            I'm ready to go on. The air is fresh. The sun is shining, but still 
            it's not unbearably hot. How strange! Never before have I noticed 
            that it wasn't hot at midday, and now there's even a gentle pleasant 
            breeze. There's something more that's strange too. As the mists 
            disappear and I see the ground below my feet again, I notice that my 
            feet as well as the ground they stand on arc much farther down
            than they ever have been before. That means I've grown much 
            taller! How peculiar! At my age a person doesn't grow any more. 
            So how is it possible for me to have grown taller? And what a 
            remarkable dress I have on! It's really funny! And where are my 
            sandals? And my hands? How very much they've changed! Everything is 
            so peculiar, as surprising as if I were not myself, as if I were 
            dreaming!  But my consciousness is clear. I'm awake. I'm not 
            dreaming! I look around. Not far away I see a forest, and as I 
            approach it, a house becomes visible among the trees. But what a 
            strange house! The place seems familiar to me, and yet I know that 
            I've never seen such trees in all my life, nor such a house. No! 
            These trees are not even remotely similar to our palms ...  The house stands on a hill, and as I go up the steps 
            through the forest leading to it, I know the house belongs to me. 
            But how? I've never seen such a house, and yet it is familiar to me. 
            It's not made of stone, and its roof is slanting instead of flat. As 
            I enter the house, I know every room is familiar so I walk straight 
            into 'my room'. As I step into the little room with its whitewashed 
            walls, I stop before the window for a few moments to enjoy the 
            magnificent view. I see that both the little house and the beautiful 
            green meadow are high up on a mountainside offering a view into the 
            wide plain below. At the foot of the mountain a broad river flows 
            majestically past with big ships navigating on its surface. 
            Singularly enough, they have no sails and no oars, yet move along 
            very fast, much faster than our ships. Another thing I don't 
            understand is why they all have a big, black pipe sticking up and 
            spewing out thick black smoke.  The sun has gone down, and twilight is spreading out 
            over the valley below me. Off in the distance where—I have a strange 
            feeling I have often looked out before—there are many little 
            villages, and between them and over them I see little flashes of 
            lightning. Again and again ... and after each flash there is a clap 
            of thunder, just the way the thunder booms out of the great pyramid. 
            I observe these flashes of light and this thundering for a while 
            until suddenly a shrill bell rings behind me. I turn to the little 
            apparatus that is emitting this ringing sound, lift up an odd-shaped 
            part of this apparatus and press part of it to my ear. All of this 
            seems just as much a matter of course as if I had been accustomed to 
            doing it for a long long time; yet I know precisely that I've never 
            seen such a thing in my life before. As I hold the little round 
            black part of this apparatus to my ear, I again hear the voice ... 
            the voice that spoke from out of the misty figure: 'I kiss your 
            hands, darling, how are you?'  'Thanks, fine,' I reply, 'but I'd like to come back 
            home. Could you perhaps come and fetch me tomorrow. The enemy is 
            already quite close. Every evening I see the hits. They're coming 
            closer and closer with frightening speed. I'd like to be home with 
            all of you.'  'All right,' answers the voice of the man again, 
            'I'll come tomorrow to get you. But wouldn't it be more sensible if 
            you were to stay in the forest? Here in the city we're getting 
            bombarded day and night, and it's getting worse.'  'No,' I answer, 'I want to be back home with all the 
            rest of you. I've taken care of the house and property here, but 
            when danger is near, I want to be with the rest of you. Please take 
            me home!'  'Good,' I hear again out of the apparatus. 'I can 
            see you have courage enough. Tomorrow afternoon I'll come and pick 
            you up. Get all your things packed before then. Goodbye, my darling. 
            I kiss you again and again. Good night.'  'I kiss you too. Good night.' I answer and put the 
            apparatus back where it was before.  Who was that? How do I come to hear his voice 
            speaking to me through an odd-shaped piece of apparatus? ... How 
            come I hear him with my physical ear instead of through an 
            inner link of spirit? A thought flashes through my brain: Is perhaps 
            everything I am experiencing now only a vision? Perhaps it's only a 
            dream? Only a test of my courage?  No, unfortunately it's not a dream -- however much I 
            might like to wake up out of this reality, just as I woke up before 
            out of a dream and found myself in the midst of a beautiful green 
            meadow. Yes, that was a dream, but now I'm wide awake and have to 
            deal with all kinds of things ... unavoidably. The air is heavy with 
            fear and terror ... so heavy people can hardly breathe. The enemy is 
            approaching from every side. If this goes on for a few days more the 
            city will be surrounded. And we keep hearing such unbelievably 
            horrible stories from the refugees who have succeeded in escaping 
            from the occupied areas. But we are in the hand of God, and I calm 
            my anxious heart and nerves with the thought that everything that 
            happens is for the good, because nothing can happen without God's 
            will. And God's will is always good—absolutely always!  I start to pack my things quickly.  The next afternoon, I look up at the window and see 
            our dog running down the mountainside like a streak of greased 
            lightning. That's how I know my husband is coming. A few minutes 
            later, they arrive, my husband and our dog. Our dog is so happy. He 
            jumps up to greet my husband again and again, up to shoulder height 
            out of pure enthusiasm and excitement. I run out to meet him too and 
            we embrace each other with tender affection. We've been living 
            together for nearly twenty years and are just as much in love as the 
            day we married.  My husband's bearing and manner, his voice and the 
            warm touch of his hand are all so reassuring. He is courage, safety, 
            dependability itself.  'I hope you're not afraid?' he asks me with a smile.
             'No,' I answer as I lace my arms around his muscular 
            back. 'God will be with us!' I snuggle up close to him for a 
            moment, leaning my head on his broad shoulder.  As we start to pack the luggage in the car, I stand 
            still for a moment. What kind of a car, carriage or chariot is this? 
            I suddenly remember that I'm accustomed to travelling in quite a 
            different kind, but then I smile again because this is one I know 
            very well too. Of course it's my husband's car, but how strange that 
            it runs by itself, with no lions harnessed up in front of it 
            ...  I stroke my forehead with my hand. Have I gone 
            completely mad? Lions! Lions in front of a motor car? And here in 
            this country? Yes indeed, there were some beautiful lions in the 
            zoo, but they were long ago put to death because of the bombings. It 
            would have been dangerous if one of the wild beasts had been freed 
            because of bomb damage to its cage. I can't understand where I get 
            ideas like these about lions and other impossible things ... the 
            pyramids of Egypt which I certainly only know from photographs! Have 
            I perhaps become a victim of too much excitement?  We drive home. I run into our apartment. Just as I 
            am about to open the door, it opens all by itself, and there, 
            beaming with joy—O how in the world did you get here?—is little 
            Bo-Ghar! But he isn't little any more. He's grown up, even though 
            quite young. He smiles as sweetly as ever, bows before me and kisses 
            my hand.  'How good, how very good to see you come home again, 
            my queen!' he says quietly.  But I stand there looking at him in sheer 
            astonishment: 'Bo-Ghar, you're here? How did you get here?' I ask.
             Now it's his turn to be surprised: 'But you know 
            that I've been living here for the last three years ... in your 
            house. Why do you ask?'  I just can't understand it ... he isn't exactly as 
            I've known him. He's already grown up, yet I know that he's really 
            still a child ... or should be still a child! But why? Since he's 
            come from his faraway homeland, I just don't know him. And even then 
            he was already a grown-up young man. Why do I have a strange feeling 
            that he's only a boy of ten or twelve? Why do I feel again as if I 
            were dreaming?  And here's my husband. The whole apartment is full 
            of flowers ... how sweet of him to welcome me home after all these 
            years of our being married, in the same sweet way he did during the 
            first few days of our honeymoon.  After supper we sit near a strange, fairly large 
            wooden box in which a human voice is speaking. The voice tells us 
            the latest news of the war, along with rules and regulations for us 
            to follow. How strange! ... this is another materialization of a 
            mental process, like the telepathic apparatus up there in the little 
            forest house. Ptahhotep, my dear master, also emits high energy 
            radiations through the atmosphere of the country every evening. All 
            the people, while they sleep, are aided and strengthened by his 
            powers and his love. But his radiations reach into the very depths 
            of people's beings, not just to the outer ears like the low 
            frequency vibrations coming from this odd little wooden box here.
             Then we all go to bed.  And in many of the nights that follow we are 
            suddenly awakened by a horrible sound: sirens howl throughout the 
            whole city! We jump out of bed, slip into our shoes, warm underwear, 
            a house-dress, a fur, a warm kerchief around our head ... we snatch 
            up the little suitcase with jewellery and money and the old album 
            with the symbolic mystic drawings. We rush downstairs, my husband 
            and I, down into the cellar. On the stairway we meet my younger 
            sister with her new-born babe-in-arms, her three-year-old boy and 
            two-yearold girl. Other doors open up into the stairway, and other 
            people come out— blanched and drawn and silent—to join us on our 
            downward march. As we reach the ground floor, a door opens and an 
            old man with snow-white hair and beard comes out. Those eyes! Where 
            have I seen these eyes before? And like a flash of lightning, I 
            suddenly see again the handsome figure of my father's general—the 
            one who made such a fine career for himself— Thiss-Tha! His 
            eyes! And how has he come here? And how old he is! And how do I come 
            to be whispering to him now, "Father dear, are you dressed warm 
            enough?' He smiles and gives me it reassuring wave of the hand: 
            'Yes, yes don't worry!' And we all go on to find our place in the 
            cellar.  The enemy comes closer and closer; the ring of steel 
            he's forged around our city gets tighter and tighter.  One afternoon the door opens and Ima walks in. How 
            does he come to be here? ... And dressed in this clothing? I embrace 
            him and ask, 'What kind of a suit is that?'  He looks at me with equal surprise, 'What a 
            question, Mother!' he says. 'What kind of a suit? Why Mother, you 
            act as if you were seeing me in it for the first time! An air force 
            uniform! But you've known that for a long time!'  I stand there just as confused as if I were about to 
            woken from another dream. Yes, of course, an air force uniform. And 
            he is my darling, my only child! And yet I know that he's Ima. Of 
            course I know him! Ima! Is he really my son? I can still see him 
            clearly in his priestly robe. He gave me lessons in 
            concentration. Even then his radiation was as strong and clean as 
            steel ... I know him ... but he doesn't know me and acts as if he 
            had never had anything to do with the temple. 'Mother,' he says, 'my 
            outfit is moving on to another place, because our planes can't 
            operate any more from this airfield. If we stayed here any longer, 
            we'd all be destroyed with our aircraft. We're moving on somewhere 
            into the countryside. I don't know when I'll see you again.'  My heart turns cold in panic. I've already got used 
            to knowing my son was in constant danger. When he went into the air 
            force, I felt as if I'd been struck dead. I walked around lifelessly 
            in the apartment, feeling as if I were dreaming a horrible dream. 
            How could that be reality? How could mothers really be sending their 
            sons, their healthy, young, vigorous sons out into this mass murder? 
            It's certainly only a bad dream in which people have become so 
            depraved and so degraded as to be killing each other with the most 
            gruesome weapons imaginable ... and killing off precisely the 
            healthiest, strongest, fittest young men ... young men who should be 
            begetting a new, strong, healthy generation of people. These young 
            men are the first to get killed simply because they are considered 
            'fit' for service. The weak and sickly ones stay home, and because 
            they do they are the very ones who can become fathers. The majority 
            of healthy young people are killed off in the fighting. This is the 
            fastest road to the complete degeneration of the entire human race. 
            And people have already sunk so low they don't even recognize this 
            fact! For no other reason than blind hate and fear of each other, 
            people kill off the best and healthiest generation!  Dream! Nightmare!  Then, little by little, my sense of reality came 
            back, and I turned my child over to God! Nothing can happen 
            without God's will, and whatever happens is good because God 
            wants it so. Compensation! Everything that happens is only a 
            searching and striving to return to equilibrium ... back to 
            paradise! These words of my dear master, Ptahhotep, and all the 
            other things He taught me in the great pyramid made such a 
            deep impression on me that this gave me courage to go on living, to 
            go on doing my daily duties, despite the terrible realization that 
            my child and millions of others were using each other as targets in 
            this mass butchery.  But now I knew that we would be separated when he 
            left the city, for the enemy had us almost completely surrounded. 
            And whether he or we would come out of this mass 
            murder alive, or whether we would see each other again in this 
            life—these were all just big question marks ...  And still I cannot, I must not feel pain, because I 
            am not permitted to link myself with anyone in such a way that my 
            happiness is dependent on him! In this young man whom I carried 
            under my heart in order that he might be born again, in this young 
            man who is now my son, I do not love the body. It is not his 
            physical manifestation I love, but God within him! His divine
            self has built up this body—just like the bodies of all 
            people, animals, plants and even inert matter—in order to be able to 
            express itself. So it's the manifestation of the impersonal divinity 
            I love in my son's person, in his beautiful body. All of creation is 
            the manifestation of the one and only God; so why should I 
            now tremble about the possibility of 'losing' this particular 
            manifestation of God? Why should I shudder at the thought of 
            not seeing it again? Perhaps because his flesh and his blood are 
            from my flesh and my blood? But my self and his self 
            are the same self—and not flesh and blood at all.  I must go into my own self and become fully 
            conscious in it; then I am identical with the self of my son—and at 
            the same time with the self of the entire universe and 
            so I cannot lose anything or anyone! It cannot make any difference 
            to me whether those who die are of my own flesh and blood or total 
            strangers, because the same self of God is changing one of 
            its many bodies whenever a living creature dies, whether it's the 
            body of my one and only child or someone I don't know at all. I 
            must completely conquer my flesh and blood which now feels such 
            terrible pain ... O God, give me the strength to pass this test! 
            Even though I haven't yet attained cosmic consciousness, give me 
            the strength to act as if I were living every moment in this divine 
            state of consciousness!  My knees tremble as I go to my son, embrace him and 
            say: 'My dear little boy, my one and only child, farewell! I put you 
            in God's hands ... He won't leave either you or us. Just 
            remember that everything passes away except true love. Even now we 
            love each other because we are one in God. This spiritual 
            unity—this true love—has brought us together here on earth. We can't 
            lose each other! We will find each other and meet again ... if not 
            in this life, then in the next, or in another form of life. Wherever 
            we may go, our love for each other will bring us together again. 
            Farewell, my darling. In difficult times to come hold on to this 
            invisible power that stands behind us and never leaves us. The power 
            we call God!'  Neither of us cries. We hold each other in a long, 
            warm, loving embrace. I kiss his smooth, young forehead. He holds me 
            to his heart, then leaves. I wave to him from the window. He waves 
            back, then disappears.  Tonight we celebrate Christmas. The cannons are 
            thundering continually, but still we make all the preparations we 
            can to celebrate the day as beautifully as possible. It doesn't 
            matter much to me, for in eternity there are no Christmases, no 
            holidays, and no weekdays. Every day is a holiday—a holy day— 
            because in God eternity is an everlasting, holy day. But my 
            husband likes to celebrate Christmas Eve. He is happy when he can 
            give me pleasant surprises, and he likes to be surprised himself. He 
            is already decorating the tree in the parlour, and Bo-Ghar is 
            helping him.  For the last several weeks, Bo-Ghar has been living 
            with us. Even if he wanted to go home evenings, he would not have 
            been able to do so recently because of the heavy bombings. He lives 
            in the room my son has vacated.  Several years ago Bo-Ghar left his homeland far away 
            in the Orient. He came to the West to teach people in this part of 
            the world the ancient science of his ancestors which enables people 
            to bring the body under the dominion of the spirit. After wartime 
            shortages made it impossible to obtain stone or bronze for 
            sculpturing purposes, my studio was empty and I turned it over to 
            Bo-Ghar as a room in which to give his lessons. From the beginning 
            of our acquaintanceship, he acted as if he were our own child, and 
            now he and my husband are decorating the Christmas tree in the 
            greatest of harmony.  I am with the cook trying to think up ways and means 
            to prepare a 'festive' menu with the food supplies we've succeeded 
            in obtaining with so much difficulty. Today we've been invited with 
            the whole family for Christmas Eve supper at father's, and tomorrow 
            we'll need to be able to serve a Christmas meal ourselves.  Then the door bell rings. My young cousin rushes in, 
            all white and shaken. 'Esther,' he says, 'the enemy has completely 
            surrounded the city, and their troops are making a surprise move. 
            They're not coming from the other side of the city where we expected 
            them, but straight in ... straight towards us ... I was in the city 
            with father and we telephoned mother. She told us the enemy troops 
            have already reached our villa. Their heavy tanks and men are moving 
            towards the centre of the city. Lucky thing the telephone lines 
            weren't cut. Enemy tanks and troops will probably be here any 
            minute. Get ready. Now I've got to run. Goodbye.' And with that he 
            goes.  I run to my husband to tell him the news, then on 
            through all the house spreading the alarm, so that my sisters, 
            brother, father, and the caretaker's family all know what we're up 
            against,  Our villa stands on a hillside. From our windows we 
            can see far down the street in the direction from which the enemy 
            troops are coming. Everything is quiet for the moment. My husband 
            says it may be hours before the enemy reaches our vicinity. So he 
            suggests we celebrate Christmas immediately, then go downstairs to 
            father's where we've been invited to join all the rest of the family 
            for supper. That way, we'll all be together at father's and can wait 
            and watch for further developments.  My husband lights the candles on the Christmas tree. 
            I think of my son who at this very moment may be obliged to take 
            part in an air raid. I commend him to God's care. We all shake 
            hands, exchange presents, leave everything lying where it happens to 
            be, and hurry down to father's flat.  'Children,' says father, 'let's eat quickly, for we 
            may soon have to take refuge in the cellar.'  We sit down. As has been the custom since my mother 
            died, her chair stands at one end of the table, empty, and a candle 
            is burning at her place. Thoughtfully, quietly and calmly we eat our 
            supper. We all feel that a solemn, sombre time is coming soon when 
            we will be face to face with our destiny. While supper is still in 
            progress, a bomb goes off with a mighty blast right near our 
            windows. We all look at each other.  'Let's go right on eating,' says father, 'maybe we 
            can finish supper.'  We eat as fast as possible, but the explosions come 
            closer and closer and get more and more frequent.  The door bell rings. Officers of the federal army 
            are standing in front of the door. 'We're going to set up our cannon 
            in the garden,' one of them says, 'and we're going to billet our 
            troops in your house. Give us the keys to all the flats in the 
            house.' My husband gets up to show the officers around. We hear a 
            particularly loud explosion. The whole house is shaken as if by an 
            earthquake.  A few minutes later my husband comes back. 'Father,' 
            he says, 'we'd better get down to the cellar. The garage has been 
            hit. Our central heating plant has been damaged. We've got to turn 
            it off immediately and drain out the water. Get below, all of you, 
            your lives aren't safe any more in the flat. The enemy troops must 
            be very near now. The officers are saying the enemy has already 
            reached the other side of the street. The fighting won't last long 
            but still we must expect to spend the next few days in the cellar.'
             Thoughtfully and with perfect calm, father says, 
            'Let the women and children all go below. I'm going to finish eating 
            my supper. Please bring the coffee.'  We know there is no arguing with father. My younger 
            sister gets up and takes her baby into her arms. I take her little 
            boy by the hand, and my other sister takes the little girl. Together 
            we go downstairs to the underground shelter. My brother, my husband 
            and Bo-Ghar stay with father for coffee.  The explosions keep getting louder and stronger. 
            Sitting in the cellar, we feel the house shaking in its foundations 
            every time. After a while, the heavy iron door opens, and the men 
            come in. Stepping over to me, my husband whispers in a low voice so 
            that no one else can hear, 'They're putting up cannon in our garden, 
            and they intend to defend our house to the very last. They refuse to 
            give up the city. Our house is in a key spot for them. If the enemy 
            troops take it, there will be no way to stop them from here right 
            down to the river. We can expect they'll fight to the very last man. 
            I only hope it won't last long. The city is completely surrounded, 
            and any further resistance will simply entail senseless destruction. 
            I'm going to get the janitor to help me bring down all our 
            mattresses so that we can get some sleep.' And with that he leaves.
             Even the longest night is followed by dawn, and so 
            this night conies to an end too. The iron door opens and closes 
            continually, as our menfolk come and go. Soldiers come in too 
            occasionally and try to warm up a little. Outside a blizzard is 
            raging and the thermometer stands at 15° below zero. It's cold in 
            our cellar too. We sit there in all the clothes we can put on 
            underneath our fur coats. There's no heat anywhere in the house now. 
            The soldiers are mere boys. Pale and trembling with cold and fright, 
            they get ordered out into battle with brutal unconcern by the older 
            officers. Poor children! They're not older than sixteen or eighteen 
            and have already been dragged away from home ... into this mass 
            murder!  We try to rest, but the little baby yells so loud 
            and long not one of us can sleep a wink.  The next morning my father comes in looking 
            surprisingly pale. 'Children,' he says, 'the water main has been 
            hit. Go easy on what you use. There isn't any more water in the 
            house.' With that he goes out. We hear the men outside talking about 
            the possibility of bringing in water from somewhere else. All the 
            water in the water pipes throughout the house is drained out into 
            basins and bath tubs. Down here in our air raid shelter, we have a 
            big wooden barrel full of water for fire-fighting purposes. Are we 
            going to have to drink this old, stale, smelly water? My younger 
            sister looks at me enquiringly. I know she's thinking about her 
            babe-in-arms! Ever since her husband disappeared, her own milk 
            ceased flowing. From that time on, her babe was fed cooked food. But 
            for that we have to have water! And the baby's bottle has to be 
            thoroughly washed between feeds. I try to calm her fears by 
            whispering, 'It's snowing, we'll melt snow to make water.' My 
            husband hears me and calls me out into the room outside the shelter. 
            'Do you realize how little water you can get out of snow? The 
            soldiers are taking all our water away. Unless we want to die of 
            thirst, we'll have to get water from somewhere. We could go a long 
            time without food, but without water the heart is affected. We have 
            to have water. There arc twenty-six adults in the house, and we 
            can't even cook beans if we don't have water. I'm going out to try 
            to find water somewhere in the neighbourhood,' he says, and leaves.
             A short while later he comes back and reports, 'The 
            houses all along the street haven't any water either. We'll have to 
            go with buckets and carry water from the next through street.'  'Please don't go,' I answer him, 'The machine-gun 
            fire is too terrible, and cannon and airplanes arc shooting 
            continually too. You might get hit. Stay here and wait.'  My husband smiles: 'Don't be a child. The First 
            World War wasn't fought with cap pistols, and I still came through 
            all right. God will not forsake us. Whatever is going to 
            happen will happen anyway.'  I embrace him and he disappears behind the cellar 
            door.  I go back into the shelter and sit down. And wait. 
            Quiet and cold—I wait. If it's God's will for my husband to come 
            back, no bullet will hit him. If not, then it had to be that 
            way.  'Things are never bad; it's how you think about 
            them.' I heard a voice in my heart. I tell myself that hundreds and 
            thousands, even millions of wives are sitting somewhere, just as I 
            am, praying for their husbands. These husbands are men like mine. 
            The fact that my person loves his person so deeply is a 
            manifestation of the self which is the same in every person. When 
            two people love each other it means they are experiencing the 
            unity of the self in their consciousness. They feel they belong 
            together because they are one in the self.  I quiet my trembling heart but it still goes on 
            trembling. 'Keep calm,' I tell it. 'Steady does it ... just beat 
            slowly and calmly. Now let's breathe slowly and deeply—still 
            deeper—and still deeper ... keep calm! We all of us have to put away 
            the body some day. A hundred years from now it won't matter a bit 
            who went first.  'Time and space are inventions of the 
            intellect. But the spirit, the self, stands above the 
            intellect, above all thoughts, above any concept of time and space. 
            Breathe calmly and regularly and think of nothing ... just be ...'
             I don't know how long I've been sitting there when 
            the door opens again, and there is my husband with ten quarts of 
            water. Water! Wonderful water 1 All of us, twenty-six people have 
            enough of it to last a day! I don't stand up, and I don't throw 
            myself about his neck. No, the great moments are always very 
            simple! No sobbing, no tears, and no big words. From where he 
            stands, portioning out the water, my husband glances over at me. Our 
            eyes meet and we understand each other perfectly. I think to myself, 
            reprieve! How long?  We sit in the cellar, in darkness. Outside the 
            thunderous fire continues unremittingly. The earth trembles beneath, 
            and we have to hold on to the bench below so that we are not thrown 
            bodily to the floor. Cannon and tanks put up a steady barrage of 
            fire. Airplanes roar past overhead. Bombs scream down  and burst! The barrage of fire goes on and on! How 
            long have we been sitting here in the cellar? By now I've lost all 
            feeling for time. There is no day or night in the cellar. It's 
            always dark. A dim little light is all we are allowed. We've  had no electricity for a long time, and we have to 
            husband our supply of oil. Whenever the barrage of fire stops for a 
            half hour, we step out into the other cellar room and have something 
            to eat. We are lucky to have laid in a supply of emergency rations. 
            But all too often we have to stop eating suddenly and rush back into 
            the shelter, for our house is now getting shot at from the other 
            side too. After every hit, we hear tiles and beams from the roof and 
            upper walls falling down on the ceiling above us. We never know 
            whether or not the next blast will cause the ceiling to cave in and 
            bury us all alive.  One day a deafening blast blows a huge hole in the 
            wall of the next room in the cellar. Fortunately, it's not in our 
            shelter. Later during a lull in the barrage of fire outside, my 
            husband goes out to see what's happened. A gigantic hole gapes in 
            the cellar wall. The bright sunshine streaming through it makes us 
            both blink. Tile and bricks lie all about us. Splinters of wood, 
            bits of glass ... everything covered by a heavy layer of dust ... 
            and on one end of a beam that sticks up out of the general mess and 
            confusion, a hen, also covered with a heavy layer of dust, stands 
            there on one leg, just as calmly as if nothing had happened. She's 
            one of father's chickens, the only one left. Poor animal! What an 
            awful opinion It must have of us human beings! A few days later the 
            cook's art has turned the hen into a delicious soup. While we're 
            eating it, we discover how badly injured it was. Its leg bone had 
            been shot through, and part of the leg was missing. That's why it 
            stood there on one leg. With what stoic patience and indifference it 
            bore up under its injury, not letting out so much as a squawk or a 
            cackle to tell how much it was suffering.  Hour after hour we go on sitting in the shelter. 
            Will the barrage of fire outside never stop? I hold my sister's 
            little boy on my lap. My body is cold with fright, for even though a 
            human being may face death with calm and quiet in his spirit, the 
            body revolts. We don't know whether we may be hit by a bomb, buried 
            alive, or die of thirst. The little boy begs me, 'Tell me a story, 
            Aunt Esther, tell me a story.' And I tell him stories by the hour to 
            keep him quiet. He holds a toy automobile in his hand, and it's my 
            job to wind it up again and again. While he plays, he sings a little 
            song. It sounds so familiar ... what's the name of it? Now I 
            remember. It's the song the little pig sings, 'Who's afraid of the 
            big bad wolf?' in one of Walt Disney's films ... Oh! how lucky I am 
            that it's dark here in the cellar. Nobody can see that I've lost 
            control of myself, and big soggy tears roll down over my cheeks. 
            God! Oh God! You are present with us here! Your sacred 
            message tells us all we mustn't be afraid! 'Aunt Esther, tell me 
            some more, tell me what happened then! Why have you stopped telling 
            the story?' asks little Peter. I hold the dear boy close to my heart 
            and go on with the story: 'And the little goat's mother came back 
            and ...'  After seemingly endless hours the barrage of fire 
            stops. Just as he's been doing day after day, my husband goes out to 
            get water. When he comes back, he waves to me. 'Esther,' he says all 
            shaken and in a voice trembling with emotion, 'I've just been 
            upstairs in our flat. The beautiful furniture you carved yourself, 
            and all your lovely sculptured figures are a total wreck. The floor 
            of one room is gone and so are the walls of the other rooms. We 
            haven't a home any more ...' And the poor dear boy drops his head on 
            my shoulder, crying and sobbing like a baby.  I embrace him in his heavy winter coat: 'Don't cry! 
            What really matters is that we're alive! We're still alive and 
            uninjured in the midst of all this destruction. I can always make 
            new figures. Don't worry about material things. Life stands over 
            everything!'  He tries hard to control himself: 'I loved all your 
            carvings ... the whole apartment ... so very very much! And now 
            everything's gone ... all gone ...'  'No matter, even this hell will come to an end some 
            day.' I lay my head for a moment on his broad shoulder. We embrace 
            each other tenderly, then go back into the dark shelter. This is no 
            time to be sentimental.  Bo-Ghar comes and whispers, 'What's happened? We 
            heard the roof and walls falling in up where your apartment is.' I 
            tell him what my husband has just told me. Bo-Ghar, the ever-calm, 
            ever-smiling, gets all excited: 'I'm going up there! I have to 
            salvage my slides and film on Yoga. My life's work will be ruined if 
            they're destroyed. I'm going up.'  'Bo-Ghar, you mustn't. Enemy sharpshooters will pick 
            you off in a minute. I won't let you go up.'  My brother hears our conversation. 'I'll go up there 
            with Bo-Ghar,' he says. 'I'll help him.' Together they leave the 
            cellar ... we wait anxiously. Minute after minute goes by ... a 
            quarter hour ... an hour ... we're still waiting.  Finally the door opens, and Bo-Ghar and my brother 
            come in, dusty and dirty but beaming with success. In their hands 
            they hold the precious boxes of slides and reels of film. My brother 
            tells us, 'The walls have all caved in, but the cupboard was still 
            standing in the corner on a little piece of floor. We had to get 
            over to the cupboard, but there wasn't any floor left to walk on. 
            Only an iron beam. And we had to watch out that the sharpshooters 
            across the street didn't see us. So both of us lay down and crawled 
            across the beam. Bo-Ghar dug out all the boxes from the cupboard and 
            handed them over to me, one after the other. Now we've got 
            everything!'  We're all of us happy that the two men have come 
            back to us. Bo-Ghar hides his treasures in a corner so no one can 
            find them. The very next moment we're blasted almost off our feet. A 
            deafening blast shakes what's left of the house. Another attack! We 
            hear the airplanes roar past overhead, bombs, mines, shells and 
            shrapnel of all sizes beat the ground and the walls around and over 
            us. The explosions come closer and closer, and after each of them we 
            hear tiles and bricks and rubble tumbling down overhead. The barrage 
            of fire is so continuous it sounds as if it might be some gigantic, 
            cosmic sewing machine. Any moment the next shell may burst through 
            the ceiling overhead, our last protection, and blow us all to 
            kingdom come. We sit there mute and cold in this horrible anxiety, 
            in deathly fright and fear of death. How long can the walls hold? 
            Then, a gigantic blast, so powerful the whole cellar floor dances 
            beneath us ... and my father's chambermaid suddenly starts to scream 
            with the nervous shock. The other women servants start screaming 
            too. I jump up and yell at the top of my lungs, 'Quiet! Quiet! 
            God is here! God is here!'  Explosion follows explosion, so loud they can hardly 
            hear my voice, but I keep on shouting. I just have to shout at the 
            top of my lungs, 'God is here! Let all of us, every one, think 
            only of God, nothing else, only of God! God be with us! God!—God!—God!' 
            And one by one the others join me as we repeat  together, 'God is here ... God ... God 
            ... God ...'  None of us knows how long this has gone on. Little 
            by little the pandemonium outside has lessened. The blasts have 
            become less frequent, and at last it's quiet outside. We can hear 
            soldiers dragging something heavy. I go out to have a look. On the 
            stairs arc bodies lying motionless. On the floor is blood. I 
            recognize several of the young soldiers. Only an hour ago they were 
            seeking warmth with us in the shelter, telling us about their homes 
            and families far away. Their poor parents! Waiting in vain for their 
            children to come home! My son! Where can the poor boy be now? In 
            what department of Hell?  Then we grab a bite to eat. We know we have to take 
            advantage of every moment of calm. We have to strengthen our bodies' 
            resistance ... as long as we have anything to eat ... two men go out 
            to get water ...  How long have we been sitting here in this shelter? 
            Weeks have gone by while we've been in this barrage of hellfire. My 
            husband reminisces: 'In Doberdo, in the First World War, we were 
            caught in a barrage of fire too. But every forty-eight hours we were 
            relieved. People thought a person's nerves couldn't stand any more 
            than that. I never dreamed I would one day be sitting through an 
            unending barrage, together with women and children, for several 
            weeks, and without any relief!'  We all sit there in furs and heavy winter coats. 
            None of us has been able to take off a stitch of clothing ever since 
            we came down to this dungeon. Little Peter is lying in my arms. With 
            one hand I hang on to the little suitcase containing money, my 
            jewellery, and a box of cakes by way of food supply for the 
            babe-in-arms in case we have to flee. We are all of us ready to 
            jump. The villa next to ours was burnt out with flame throwers. My 
            husband has given orders to everyone to be ready to flee at a 
            moment's notice. We don't know when the enemy may set fire to our 
            house and drive us out with flame throwers. But flee where? We 
            haven't the vaguest idea. Only out and away from here. Our neighbour 
            and his son were both picked off with sharpshooters while they were 
            trying to escape from their burning house. Only his wife came out 
            alive. She crawled and wriggled on her stomach all the way to the 
            fourth house down the street, where people took her in.  We wait in readiness, my younger sister with her 
            babe-in-arms ... my snowy haired father wrapped in his big black fur 
            coat, my elder sister's family, my brother, our servants—all 
            tense—all holding our most precious possessions-all ready to jump 
            and run.  Then for a little while it's quiet outside again. 
            We'd like to get some sleep. My nerves are burning and my head feels 
            ready to split. I close my eyes and try to withdraw my consciousness 
            and fall asleep. But then the baby starts to scream with its shrill 
            penetrating voice. My sister tries to quiet it, but it keeps on 
            crying and screaming without a moment's intermission. I take over 
            the child from my sister and try everything I can think of, but it 
            keeps on crying .., crying desperately. I hand the child back to my 
            sister, and it still goes on crying ... crying ...  In the darkness, Bo-Ghar stumbles over to my sister, 
            picks up the child, holds it gently in his arms and starts humming a 
            tune from his faraway homeland. It's a tune his countrymen use to 
            control snakes. The child quiets down instantly. As calm returns to 
            our cellar, we all of us fall asleep, sitting there just as we are. 
            Only Bo-Ghar is awake, holding the baby in his arms and humming his 
            exotic little tune.  More days go by—or are they weeks? We don't even 
            bother to ask any more. Behind a protective wall in the garden, my 
            husband scrapes together some snow, brings the pail downstairs and 
            shaves in the next room in the cellar. He refused to give up his 
            habits. All the other men have bushy beards. Only my husband and 
            Bo-Ghar keep on shaving day by day in the midst of this hell.  Then my husband sits down beside us. A new attack 
            begins and we endure the torture for hours on end. My sister brings 
            her baby's bottle and gives him his meal. Four times a day she goes 
            upstairs to her flat and cooks for her baby, despite the hail of 
            bullets flying around. After her child has had its fill, she comes 
            to me and asks, just as she asks every day, 'Do you think it's over 
            yet?'  'No,' I whisper back. 'I just feel it isn't over 
            yet'. A moment later a mini bursts directly over our head. Once 
            again we hear tiles and bricks and mortal and wood falling. The 
            shelter ceiling has held up under the blast. But how much longer? We 
            sit there quietly, and I ask God within me: 'Shall I get 
            ready to die? My horoscope says I'm going to die in the crash of a 
            building. Is it now? Am I going to die, or shall I go on fighting to 
            live?'  Then suddenly amidst the darkness I behold a vision: 
            a tiny little hill, and on it a candle, a tiny one like a Christmas 
            tree candle, burning with a tiny flame. Then before my very eyes, 
            the little hill begins to grow, turning into big hill covered with 
            emerald green grass. And the tiny candle grows into torch, burning 
            with a bright strong flame.  The vision disappears, but I know I am not going to 
            die yet. I'm going to have to be this torch. I'm going to have to 
            bring people light—light—light, light!  At night the baby cries incessantly until Bo-Ghar 
            picks it up and lulls it to sleep. While we're trying to sleep a 
            mine explodes near by, and afterwards I feel ice-cold air come into 
            our shelter. The men jump up to see what's happened.  'The cellar wall has caved in, leaving a gaping 
            hole. We all think of the coming attack. We wait. I whisper to my 
            younger sister, 'Now it's the end. In the morning our villa will be 
            taken.'  'Yes,' she answers, 'I think so too, or else we'll 
            all die.'  My husband whispers, 'It's seven weeks to the day 
            that we've been sitting here in the shelter ...'  Strangely enough, the enemy cannon have ceased 
            firing. No bombs are falling either. We hear only continuous machine 
            gun fire. Sitting next to me, my husband whispers into my ear, 'That 
            means the infantry is quite near us. They've stopped using field 
            guns in order not to hit their own troops. Enemy soldiers may walk 
            in any minute.'  In the afternoon I go out to see where father is. As 
            I step out of the shelter and look out through the door of the 
            house, I see foreign soldiers running towards us from the burnt-down 
            villa next door. 'Father, Father, and all the rest of you,' I scream 
            as I run back, 'the enemy is here!' We all rush back into the 
            shelter just as enemy soldiers lunge through the door, their rifles 
            at the ready.  Deathly silence! We and they look at each other for 
            a seemingly endless moment. It's as if time itself were standing 
            still ...  All the soldiers are dressed in broad white coats. 
            Outside everything is covered with snow. The soldiers look like 
            children playing in a Christmas pageant.  Then with a word we cannot understand, their leader 
            points to the women. We understand we must move to the right, and we 
            do so. Then with another incomprehensible word, he points to the 
            men, who all have to leave immediately with one of the soldiers. No 
            time for fond farewells! the men are gone, and we women remain alone 
            with the foreign soldiers. With their submachine guns in readiness, 
            they poke into every corner of the cellar, looking for any of our 
            troops who might be hiding there. One young soldier steps over to 
            the pram where the baby is sleeping. Even as he looks at it, tears 
            come into his eyes. With infinite tenderness, he says a strange word 
            in a foreign language. Nevertheless we understand: 'Little baby ...' 
            Then he looks at us and points in the direction of his homeland, 
            telling us hi sign language that he too has a 'little baby' at home 
            ...  I feel somewhat consoled as I note that these 
            soldiers are loving, kindhearted human beings too.  Now an officer comes, sits down on a chair, and 
            tells us in a European language: 'We won't harm you. We are storm 
            troops ... sons of people who now belong to an exterminated class. 
            But watch out, we have to go on. Behind us there'll come soldiers of 
            another kind. They're not like us. Watch out!'  Late in the afternoon the shooting begins again. But 
            now the fire is coming from our country's own soldiers. They want to 
            recapture our house. Again we sit still in the dark cellar and 
            listen to horrible fighting going on at close quarters in the street 
            outside. All of a sudden there is another deafening explosion, 
            followed by a stream of cold air coming in on us. The explosion has 
            blasted open the heavy iron shutter of the cellar window. Through 
            the open window bullets rain in on us like hailstones. We all jump 
            to one side, flattening ourselves against the walls but this way we 
            are unable to move. In this situation every one of our lives is in 
            danger. A single step can mean death. The heavy iron window shutter
            must be closed!  I look about me. All the women and children seek 
            refuge by flattening themselves against the wall near the window. 
            For the moment any one of us shows herself in front of the window, a 
            shower of bullets rains in upon us. This situation is untenable. The 
            shutter must be closed!  I feel a strange chill within me. My every nerve is 
            cold, frozen so cold I can't feel myself at all. 'Afraid?' I ask 
            myself. No! Who is there to be afraid within me when I feel as if I 
            didn't even exist? I only know that I am the one who must 
            close the iron shutter! Nevertheless I observe myself curiously. 
            What does it feel like to be in such a position? What does a person 
            experience? How does nature react within the human being when we 
            involuntarily have to be a hero ...?  Standing in one corner of the cellar is a heavy 
            walking stick with a curved handle. Lying flat on the floor, I crawl 
            slowly and cautiously over to the cane. Then, grasping its lower 
            end, I crawl back towards the window. While I am executing this 
            manoeuvre, a weird thought flashes through my head: The 
            candidates in the pyramid had to pass a test of 'defying death'! 
            Maybe I'm now passing this same test here in the shelter? Maybe this 
            is all only a dream during my initiation in the pyramid?  While I crawl back cautiously to the window, my 
            intellect replies: 'Yes, the candidates in the pyramid had it easy! 
            They knew they were only undergoing a test in their initiation. But 
            these bullets aren't dreams! They really kill! How many poor young 
            soldiers have already lost their lives right here!  Nevertheless the window shutter must be closed, 
            and for that very reason!'  Kneeling beneath the window and holding the cane in 
            readiness, I suddenly jump up and poke out my arm and the cane 
            through the window. Then, noting that the iron shutter has been 
            blasted wide open, I find I must extend my head and shoulder through 
            the window in order to reach the edge of the shutter with the cane's 
            curved handle. I have to reach out and stretch until I feel as if my 
            whole body were getting longer. Finally I have the shutter and draw 
            it slowly, surely, inward. Now my sisters jump up to help, pull the 
            heavy, iron shutter into place and bolt it firmly closed.  Well done! All very simple. No excitement, no 
            theatrics, no histrionics. And yet how strange! Up till now the 
            sharpshooters across the street poured a hail of fire into our 
            window at the slightest sign of life. And yet throughout my whole 
            manoeuvre to close the iron shutter, they didn't fire a single shot. 
            Maybe they were being prevented from shooting, or simply didn't want 
            to shoot, because they saw I was a woman? 'Aunt Esther,' begs little 
            Peter, 'tell me another story ...'  And so I go on telling stories by the hour ...  The next day we women had to flee from our 
            bombed-out house. The intervening night was one of indescribable 
            horror. I can hardly believe that such things can really happen. The 
            conquest of a country is like the meeting of male and female power
            in a violent marriage. One country conquers another, forces 
            its way into the body of the other. Blood flows. Individual 
            inhabitants die like the cells of the ravished body, and yet new 
            life comes forth from this meeting ... a new world, a new creation. 
            The meeting is cruel and violent, just as the creation of new life 
            always is. But nature only looks forward into the future, willingly 
            sacrificing countless individual cells and beings in order to reach 
            its goal of bringing forth new life. And new life does come forth, 
            both on the spiritual and on the material level, from the intimate 
            meeting of two countries, that of the conqueror and that of the 
            conquered. Out of the marriage of two countries, a new civilization 
            arises. The cells of the bodies of these two countries meet and 
            mingle, bringing forth children with some of the characteristics of 
            both races. Nature creates hybrid races and individuals who 
            represent a transition, softening and bridging over the hard 
            boundaries between races and nations.  It was my fate to learn this fact that night in the 
            air raid shelter of that bombed-out house. I was forced to look on 
            and see that the violent marriage of two nations is very cruel and 
            causes many individual tragedies. It was Ima who saved me 
            from the fate that overtook almost all the women in that house that 
            night. When one of the soldiers started to drag me from my seat in 
            the corner of the shelter, forcing me to follow him, I told him in a 
            pidgin version of his language: 'I—mother, son in war—you have 
            mother at home too, please go away ...'  In the half drunk eyes of the poor young man whose 
            body had been poisoned with 'storm pills' there flashed an 
            expression of understanding. I saw that he was forced to 
            think of his own mother. Then with a gesture of frustration and 
            rage, he pushed me back under the bench and stormed out of the 
            cellar.  The next morning we felt an inner command to flee 
            from the bombed-out house. We felt the guidance of a higher power. 
            For reasons beyond our comprehension, it saved us from the fate 
            awaiting all women—without exception—in the ruins of our house.  Everything happened as if in a chaotic dream.  After five weeks in darkness, we step out suddenly 
            into bright sunshine, so bright our eyes can hardly stand it. I cast 
            a backward glance at our big beautiful villa ... a pile of rubble 
            ... topped off by broken beams pointing their splintered ends 
            skyward! Then we run across the street, picking our way between 
            corpses and rubble, over to the steps. My sister carries her 
            babe-inarms. As I watch, I see her plunge down the steps in the deep 
            snow. I run to her side, help her up, then fall over myself with the 
            little boy I am holding by the hand. Under the snow are wire 
            obstacles! While we are trying to climb over with the children, an 
            elderly soldier of the enemy army lifts the little boy over the wire 
            barrier, then helps all the rest of us over, the women and the 
            children, one after the other. I am the last. We cannot talk to the 
            soldier. We wouldn't understand each other. But we look into each 
            other's eyes, and I give him a hearty handshake in sincere 
            appreciation. He reciprocates the handshake. Then we run on, 
            zig-zagging back and forth in search of cover from the mines which 
            are still exploding and from the bullets falling about us. The 
            children yell at the top of their lungs. The snow is too deep for 
            little Peter; so with all my might and main I drag him along 
            stretched out flat behind me because he isn't able to walk. From 
            time to time we stop under a terrace to catch our breath and to warm 
            the children's hands by blowing on them. Then we run on, scarcely 
            knowing which way we're going, driven onwards ... or led on ... by 
            an inner power.  And it's like a dream to be taken into a house at 
            long last where a good-natured officer of the enemy army protects us 
            from violence at the hands of his own comrades. As we get to be good 
            friends, he tells me, 'Mama, watch out! One good soldier, 
            ten bad soldiers! Not all the men in our army would give you 
            protection the way I'm doing. Watch out when I get orders to move 
            on!'  Yes, we know all enemy soldiers are not so humane! 
            We have the experiences of our first night behind us, and will never 
            forget them!  And the men have disappeared ... all except father 
            whom we have soon found again. Calmly, without excitement, paying no 
            attention to the cannonade going on around him, the old gentleman 
            walked through this scene of mass murder and while everyone else was 
            being robbed of everything he possessed—fur, coat, gloves, money, 
            watch, fountain pen, and everything else one can carry on his 
            person—my father arrived safe and sound in the home of an old friend 
            without a single soldier's having so much as touched him. His 
            powerful radiation even affected the enemy soldiers and kept them 
            away from him.  Then a few days later there is a knock on the door 
            of this strange room in a strange house where fourteen people, 
            soldiers, refugees and we women and children are living. A knock on 
            the door, and Bo-Ghar stands before us, in tattered clothes, with 
            bleeding feet, After all he has been through, it's a miracle he's 
            still alive. Neighbours told him the direction in which they saw us 
            flee. He has found us again ...  A few days later my brother comes back, also in 
            tatters. He too has had to travel several hundred kilometres. 
            Somewhere he found himself two shoes, both of them for the left 
            foot, and wears them both with his accustomed dignity. He's alive, 
            that's all that matters ...!  As the days go by I still have no news from my 
            husband. I can't seem to get the thought out of my head that I've 
            seen him one day, in a vision, lying helpless in the snow beside the 
            road ... What could have happened to him?  After long weeks of waiting in vain, I finally find 
            my husband, gravely injured, in the house of a good-hearted farmer. 
            My vision wasn't wrong ...  Weeks go by, months go by. We're hungry and don't 
            know where our next meal is coming from. But one day, at long last, 
            the war is over!  We try to make some rooms in the ruins of our house 
            inhabitable. Bo-Ghar and I work day and night to get something to 
            eat in this time of terrible famine. My husband is forced to lie 
            flat on his back for many long months until he recovers sufficiently 
            to be able to walk about cautiously with two canes. How fortunate I 
            am a sculptress! I do bricklaying, take doors out of the remnants of 
            walls, and move them to where we need them. We put together window 
            frames. Having no glass, we cover them with heavy wrapping paper. 
            Digging in the rubble with our ten finger nails, we bring out a few 
            usable pots and pans, plus some bent and beaten silverware.  Bo-Ghar and I manage to borrow a cart and use it to 
            bring home several hundredweight of coal, pulling all the way like 
            two strong horses. Downhill, we find it hard to keep the cart from 
            running away from us; uphill, it takes all our pushing and pulling 
            to get it up to the top where we reach a level street again and can 
            trot along lightly and gaily. Then we clean up the remnants of our 
            furniture, using miscellaneous odd bits to make new pieces.  We keep on hammering and nailing things together 
            until at last we are able to reopen our 'Yoga school' in the ruins 
            of our old home. Bo-Ghar gives lessons in the physical exercises he 
            learnt from Mentuptah, while I teach what I learned in Egypt from 
            Ptahhotep.  Months go by again, and little by little the problem 
            of finding food becomes somewhat less acute. Our pupils who have 
            relatives living in the country bring us an occasional handful of 
            flour, a few potatoes, eggs, and once in a while even a bit of 
            butter. But I still have no news from my son ...  Then one day, after a year and a half of waiting, 
            someone rings our doorbell. I open the door—and Ima stands before 
            me!  I would have thought that in such cases mother and 
            son would fall about each other's necks with loud cries and sobs. 
            But no! I look at him in surprise, then we embrace each other 
            quietly and earnestly. I draw a deep breath of relief. He is alive 
            and not crippled. Only a scar on his beautiful, high forehead shows 
            that he has been through an airplane crash.  But still I am deeply dismayed! I know Ima well 
            enough to know there is no room for him in this country where 
            vulgarity, brutality, stupidity and utter chaos are the order of the 
            day. And without jeopardizing life and limb excessively, a person 
            can experience such conditions only if he preserves his inner peace, 
            his perfect trust in God and—keeps silent! But Ima won't keep 
            silent! He doesn't understand that we're not in the temple now where 
            love and truth and unselfishness prevail and where everyone may 
            speak his opinion freely without risk of being misunderstood.  Ima won't be able to get along in this world. He 
            won't tolerate injustice, and he'll want to fight against the 
            infernal spirit prevailing here now! Apparently he has forgotten 
            who he is, and yet he has retained his highmindedness, honesty 
            and courage and expects the sons of men to display these same 
            virtues. He insists on believing in people, and he has 
            crowded off into the unconscious part of his being his indomitable 
            faith in God.  Poor Ima has to experience one disappointment after 
            another. Why does he repress his faith in God? Why does he refuse
            to believe in God? That's the reason why he's lost his 
            self-confidence! I can see that he must have experienced a serious 
            mental crack-up, but when and where? And why do I have the strange 
            and oppressing feeling that I have been the cause of this 
            mental rupture—a horrible disappointment—?  I know that somewhere, some time, he has lost his 
            faith because of me, but in vain I seek the reason. One thing 
            I know with absolute certainty is that it is up to me to lead 
            him back to God, and that's why he has become my son. I
            must awaken his self-confidence, which is identical with 
            confidence in God, and make him conscious again of this 
            confidence, because I was to blame for his having lost it. I 
            must realize that the deep love and confidence he has in me 
            is only a projection of the profound confidence in God he has in the 
            unconscious part of his soul. He must come to realize that he has to 
            learn to recognize and love God in every person. The person 
            is only an outer cover, a mask, through which God manifests 
            himself.  Ima must learn that what he loves in any 
            person, and what he finds good, beautiful and true in anyone is 
            God and not the person. And that applies to me too whom he 
            loves—I know it—more than anyone else here on earth. It's up tome to 
            lead this love in him back to God. He must come to realize that he 
            loves God in me too, and my person is only an instrument 
            through which God manifests himself in the form of maternal 
            love. Ima has yet to learn that in every person who loves him it is 
            really God who loves him and not the person. When he realizes these 
            things he will understand me and everyone else and even himself 
            better. Then he won't experience any more disappointments!  And there comes a night in which my one and only 
            child, the person I love most here on earth, is living in an 
            unheated room during an unusually cold winter when the thermometer 
            has been dragging along at 20° below zero for week after week. My 
            one and only child doesn't even have a warm blanket and has scarcely 
            anything to eat. I could easily provide a heated room for him, I 
            could give him food and everything else he needs. But I know I must 
            not! I know it's more important for him not to lose his soul than 
            his body! Out of love for him I must be cruel!  I kneel in the darkness in my bed and speak to my 
            God:' You be with him, oh God, and let him find 
            himself and you again. Let him find the way that leads to
            you, and let him never deviate from it! Awaken him, awaken 
            yourself in him, oh God, for you are also dwelling 
            in him and you must awaken in him so that he may awaken, for 
            my strength is inadequate. He must become conscious. Unless he does 
            so he's lost, and you know the one and only path for him to 
            follow in order to recognize you, oh Lord my God, in 
            himself. You know why he feels he has been forsaken by 
            everyone ... why he's convinced that even I have forsaken 
            him.  'He has to feel disappointed in everyone, he has to 
            give up hope in everyone in order to find you ... in order to 
            become conscious in you—conscious of himself! You know, oh 
            God that I don't see any other possibility of saving him. I 
            cannot and must not show my love for him any more. He must find 
            you by his own efforts. I am only a weak human being, my Lord, 
            but you are God, Love itself. You love him more 
            than I can love him. You, oh God, are always with him. 
            Love him now with your divine love ... now when I must be cruel!  'Take care of him and keep him from losing his 
            health during this present struggle of his ... while he's going 
            through this school. You know that he's sinning against his 
            health because he has no confidence in himself any more.. because in 
            his unconscious he would like to die ... to kill himself. Take care 
            of him, open his spiritual eyes and don't forsake him, don't 
            forsake him, don't forsake him ...'  And so I go on night after night ...  One night as I'm kneeling in my bed in the darkness 
            again, preparing to speak to God about my child, something 
            strange happens: To my great amazement, it begins to get light about 
            me. It gets lighter and lighter, and in the growing brightness I see 
            a remarkable landscape. A high mountain with a steep, stony, narrow 
            path leading up to it. I know this path leads to the goal— to 
            God. Without hesitating I start to follow it.  The path leads through friendly countryside, higher 
            and higher. I climb untiringly until the charming green landscape 
            lies behind me and I gradually reach the inhospitable region of the 
            high mountains.  The pathway gets ever steeper, narrower and stonier, 
            but I climb with astonishing ease, so light as if I were gliding.
             The inhabited territory lies behind me. My horizon 
            widens, and I see everything far below me. But there is no time to 
            look around, and I go on. After many curves, the narrow pathway ends 
            in front of a short stairway with seven steps. Each step is twice as 
            high as the one before.  Under a crystal blue sky I stand there all alone in 
            front of these seven steps and know that I must climb them.  With a deep sigh and with faith in the power the 
            Creator has given each of his children—the power which in my case 
            has miraculously gone on undiminished and even increased as I have 
            climbed this long path—I walk up to the steps.  The first step is low. I must conquer the weight 
            of my body in order to lift myself up on to it. I succeed 
            easily.  The second step is somewhat higher and awakens the 
            resistance of my body. I have long ago conquered the forces of 
            the body, and so this step too causes me no trouble.  The third is noticeably higher. In order to 
            conquer this one I have to conquer my feelings. As I become 
            master of my feelings, I am on the third step.  As I face the fourth step, which is surprisingly 
            high, thoughts of doubt overcome me; 'How will I be able to 
            climb it? Have I enough strength?' Then I realize that my doubts
            are weakening me, paralysing me. But doubt is a thought! So I 
            must conquer my thoughts in order to master doubt. Thanks to 
            my long training and my exercises in the temple, I know what I have 
            to do; I gather all the strength of my soul, I am absolute 
            faith in God, and think of absolutely nothing. And behold—as my 
            thoughts disappear, my doubts disappear too. And I am on the fourth 
            step.  Curiously, I feel I have grown much larger while I 
            have been climbing these steps. Each time I've gone up a step, I've 
            grown some more, and now I'm much much larger than I was at the 
            beginning. Now I face the fifth step which, even though I've grown a 
            great deal, is so high that I can only get up by using both hands 
            and both feet. As I pull myself up with great difficulty, I suddenly 
            find to my great surprise that I have no body any more. Everything 
            in me or about me that was material has disappeared, and I am 
            invisible spirit.  The sixth step is very, very high, and a new 
            difficulty awaits me. I have no body, no hands with which to hang on 
            and no feet with which to push myself up. How am I supposed to get 
            up there?  I look about me for some way to do it, and as I turn 
            around, I suddenly see the whole world spread out below me! Country 
            after country ... city after city looking like little toys ... and 
            houses with countless people living in them. Infinite love for them 
            all seizes me and I am pained to think of all the people who would 
            have to travel the long, laborious pathway of recognition ... of all 
            the innumerable people feeling their way forward in the darkness, 
            imprisoned in their own selfishness just as I was once ...  And, wonder of wonders!—the moment universal love
            floods my heart, I am raised up and find myself on the sixth 
            step.  Now I stand before the last and highest step of all. 
            It is just as high as I am. I long so much to get up there and this 
            wish fills my whole being. In vain. I just don't know what to do. I 
            have no hands, no feet nor muscular strength of body with which to 
            pull myself up. But I must get up there at any price. Up on top I'll 
            find God, and I am determined to see him face to face.  I stand, waiting, but nothing happens.  As I look around me, I find to my great surprise 
            that I'm not alone. At this very moment a being similar to myself 
            reaches the sixth step and begs me to help him up to the seventh. I 
            understand his tremendous desire, and— forgetting my own longing to 
            reach the seventh step—I try to help him reach his goal.  But the very moment I forget my own wish, I suddenly 
            find that I am up on top of the seventh step—I don't know 
            how—and my companion is no longer there. He has disappeared without 
            leaving a trace. He was an illusion who helped me forget my 
            last self-centred wish. As long as I wanted to raise up my own 
            person, I would never be able to conquer the step that was as 
            high as I myself.  I have arrived! Quicker than a flash of lightning I 
            see the form of a heavenly being woven of dazzling light. My 
            complementary half! His irresistible attraction draws me to him, 
            and—full of delight and fulfilment—I melt into complete union with 
            him in his heart. I realize that He was always I and I always He, 
            the dualistic projected image of my divine, true self. In 
            this dualistic state I always faced God as a being separate 
            from myself, and I felt Him as 'You'. Now in paradisiacal 
            unity, I feel that this invisible power I have so far always called
            'God' will become myself in the next moment. A disc 
            woven of fire begins to rotate about me. And in its immovable 
            axis—in my spinal column—my true self—I—am dwelling.  And I feel my spinal column burning like a white hot 
            bow, like a bridge made up of the current of life, radiating 
            brilliant light through seven centres of force—vitalizing my body.
             Then, beyond all concept of time, I simultaneously 
            see the endlessly long chain of the different forms of life in which 
            I have been incarnated throughout ages and aeons of time as I 
            travelled the long pathways of development from my first fall out of 
            paradisiacal unity up to the present moment. I see that my countless 
            lives have been, are, and will be inseparably linked with the lives 
            of the same spirits. From the events of past lives new relationships 
            emerge, new ties, new developments, all supplementing each other and 
            fitting together perfectly like the little stones in a big mosaic.
             I recognize the threads linking me with my 
            complementary half, with Ptahhotep, with Atothis, with Ima and 
            Bo-Ghar and many, many other people. I see clearly how these threads 
            have bound us all together for ages of time, how souls more advanced 
            than we are have helped us, how we have helped each other and those 
            less advanced in the great task of the spiritualization of the 
            earth, in developing our consciousness in matter, in the body. The 
            experiences we bring each other in all these lives help expand and 
            deepen the consciousness in the body, while the bodies we inhabit 
            get progressively more spiritual, more beautiful. The matter 
            composing our various forms of manifestation becomes ever more 
            elastic, more responsible to the will and the radiations of the 
            spirit, until finally the body becomes an obedient servant of the 
            self, no longer isolating or obscuring a single ray of light 
            from the spirit. I understand the secret of the pyramid, for now I 
            have become a pyramid myself, only using matter—the body—as a firm 
            footing, but constantly manifesting divinity!  Then everything about me, the earth, sky, the entire 
            universe—all merge in a single gigantic sea of fire. Huge flames 
            encompass me. For a moment I feel as if I, with the entire cosmos, 
            were being destroyed. Flashes of lightning crack and snap through my 
            veins, through my entire being, as the fire burns me. And then, 
            suddenly everything changes: the fire is no longer consuming me but
            I myself am this heavenly fire, penetrating everything, animating 
            everything, consuming everything! A flood of light surrounds me, 
            but this flood of light is arising within myself. I am the 
            source of this light and of everything else that is. The 
            earth has no effect on me any more. Its attraction which held me in 
            fetters ceases. I am floating in nothingness. My being has no 
            limitations any more. 7 am now the one who attracts 
            everything, but nothing ties me down any more— nothing 
            attracts me any more ...  I seek those whom I have loved, for I know they 
            couldn't be destroyed, but I seek them in vain, in the 
            nothingness about me. In the emptiness there is nothing but 
            myself, so I have to turn my attention inward.  Behold, even as I do so I realize that every one 
            and everything is living in me! The universe is in me, 
            for everything that is is living in me. Everything that is,
            I am. In everything that I love, I love myself. And 
            suddenly I realize that everything I have always believed I 
            didn't love was what I had not yet recognized within myself! 
            Now that I recognize myself perfectly, I love everything and
            every one equally, for I am one with them, I am 'I' 
            in everything, in all!  I am fulfilment, life—radiant, eternal, immortal 
            being ... there is no longer any struggle, any regret, any 
            suffering—no decay, no end, no death! In all that is born I—the 
            immortal—begin a new form of life, and in all that dies I—the 
            immortal—withdraw into myself, back into the eternal, 
            creative, divine self.  I realize that time and space exist 
            only on the periphery of the created world which is like a disc 
            rotating with dizzying speed. But I, within myself, am timeless, 
            spaceless eternity. And while I am resting within myself 
            my eternal being fills space and everything living in 
            it:  I AM THE ONLY REALITY, I AM LIFE, I AM THAT I AM!
             I rest within myself and feel infinite peace 
            ... but in this peace a call reaches me and compels me to return to 
            my deserted body. I turn the searchlight of my consciousness on to 
            it and recognize the voice speaking to my being, the well-known, 
            dearly beloved voice of my master Ptahhotep. He is calling me 
            back ...  And I step out of my heavenly self and put on 
            the garment of my personal 'ego' again. But I bring with me the 
            consciousness of who I am ...  I am a human being again, but in my heart I carry 
            the divine self that has become conscious in me—God—and from 
            now on this divine self will be acting through my person ... 
            and slowly I open my eyes.  My glance meets the deep blue, heavenly eyes of my 
            master Ptahhotep. His eyes radiate the same light, the same 
            love and the same peace I have just experienced during the blissful 
            state in my initiation ... the same light, the same love, and the 
            same peace I now carry in my own heart.  I can't bring my lips to utter a sound. I am still 
            unable to find the connection between myself and my body.  But I don't need to speak, for I know my master's 
            every thought and wish. We are in spiritual unity, in God. 
            All one!  He lays his right hand upon my heart, and gradually 
            I feel life returning to my body. I draw a deep breath, and the 
            renewed regenerated stream of life flows through my numb limbs. My 
            heart beats vigorously again. Gradually I regain control of my body.
             Ptahhotep and his deputy help me sit up and slowly 
            get out of the coffin. I stand insecurely on my feet. Ptahhotep and 
            the other high priest take me by the hands and lead me out of the 
            niche where the initiation coffin stands. Then I see that all the 
            initiates of the temple, priests and priestesses, are assembled in 
            the great hall where the Ark of the Covenant is kept. Expectantly 
            they are all waiting for me. And as I come out, led by the two high 
            priests, they greet me with the sacred word and secret greeting of 
            the initiates:  'OM' ...  In this circle of the resurrected, I stand there 
            like a new-born babe. I have the same body as before. And yet I am a 
            new being. I find myself in a new world: I no longer see everything 
            from the outside, but simultaneously the inner being, the core about 
            which the external form is built up, the centre for which the 
            external form merely serves as a manifestation.  I stand in the circle of the resurrected. My inner 
            being vibrates in the tone of the sacred word—the divine mantram. 
            And with the aid of this indescribable vibration, in this magic 
            tone, I experience in my own physical consciousness the divine 
            unity of the self with all these initiates and with the entire
            universe. They have all come, priests and priestesses, to 
            greet me after my resurrection and to express divine infinite love. 
            My father, Atothis, is here too, wearing the plain white robe of the 
            initiates. Then there is the soft-spoken master Mentuptah, and my 
            dear brother Ima. The moment I see his noble countenance, his eyes 
            light up with a smile, and I remember all my dream pictures, the 
            most difficult tests of the initiation, the test of renunciation— 
            giving up everything—and the test of cruel love! Ima, you dearly 
            beloved, do you know that in my initiation vision you were the 
            reason for my passing the most difficult test of all?  The majestic figure of an elderly priestess now 
            moves forward from the circle of initiates. She hands Ptahhotep a 
            robe, and together they invest me with my priestly clothing. Then 
            she hands Ptahhotep the headdress, the sign of initiates, and He
            sets the band of gold upon my head. In front, the circlet of 
            gold bears the head of a serpent, symbol of the procreative energy 
            of life, transformed and spiritualized. Now, at last, I can wear 
            this insignia, not only as a queen, but also as an initiate!  Now I am a priestess, in the lowest degree of the 
            priesthood. It's up to me to reach the higher degrees step by step 
            until I am worthy to be permitted to use the staff of life.  Ptahhotep steps over to my side, lays his hand upon 
            my head and blesses me. Then He takes me by the hand and 
            leads me to the initiates. First, of course, to the second high 
            priest. He too lays his hand upon me and blesses me. Then I step 
            before my dear father and feel him, through his hand, pouring out 
            all the love in his heart upon me. And so one by one, according to 
            their rank, I step before each of the initiates and receive his 
            blessing. At last I stand in front of Ima who received his 
            initiation shortly before me. He blesses me too, but I feel his hand 
            tremble ...  Then Ptahhotep leads me to the Ark of the Covenant. 
            I kneel before it. For the first time in my life I am permitted to 
            lay my hands upon it. In every drop of my blood I feel the fiery 
            power flowing out of the Ark of the Covenant into my body. I breathe 
            deeply—into my innermost being—and now with my consciousness awake,
            in my body, I experience the fulfilment of paradisiacal 
            unity—the omnipotence and omniscience in God ... I understand 
            and experience the meaning of being. Wherever I turn the 
            searchlight of my consciousness there is clarity and light. In 
            radiant brilliance the last and highest truths of life stand before 
            my eyes. I experience the absolute, omnipotence that comes through 
            the guidance of divine creative power in my self.  Ptahhotep again takes me by the hand and leads me 
            back through the rooms through which we came here ... back through 
            the passageways, through the stone door, back into the temple. The 
            initiates come after us. In the temple all the neophytes are 
            waiting, and it's my turn to officiate as priestess for the first 
            time. I stand before the altar with Ptahhotep, while all the 
            neophytes come, one after the other, to receive my blessing. Upon 
            each I place my right hand, and each accepts my blessing in deep 
            silence. Finally the children of the neophyte school approach, among 
            them my little adopted son, Bo-Ghar. He kneels before me, looks at 
            me devotedly, then bows his head and receives my blessing.  Oh Bo-Ghar, my little Bo-Ghar, what a strange role 
            you played in my initiation vision! ...  This ends my first priestly office in the temple. In 
            the little cell I used during my preparations for initiation, 
            Ptahhotep leaves me alone. After the prescribed time of complete 
            rest, I am again allowed to eat light foods and beverages.  For a long time I sit on my couch unable to shake 
            off the effect of the strange visions experienced during my 
            initiation. What horrible pictures! How lucky I am to wake up and 
            find these dreams are not real! How was it possible for me to carry 
            such pictures within myself and thus come to dream them? They just 
            can't be real! It's absolutely impossible for people to become so 
            depraved and degraded as to kill each other with such cruelty and 
            with such hellish instruments! The cellar, the horrible shelter of 
            my dream! And still I know the eternal law that a creature can only 
            imagine pictures which could actually exist in reality! Whatever 
            a person can imagine can materialize! If this were not so he 
            wouldn't be able to imagine it!  But these horrible pictures! These gigantic birds 
            piloted by the sons of men, flying overhead with a fearful roar, 
            often climbing so high one can't see them any more, and throwing 
            down evil eggs upon the earth! I saw with my own eyes how these eggs 
            destroyed everything within a wide radius of where they hit the 
            ground. With deafening blasts, they brought down whole houses ... 
            how was that possible?  And why should the sons of men put their intellect 
            in the service of fiendish senselessness?  And what strange apparatus I saw and used in my 
            initiation visions! I heard human voices speaking from tremendous 
            distances, and others heard my voice in the same way. How Ima would 
            laugh if I were to tell him that people could communicate over long 
            distances by means of such devices instead of using the much simpler 
            method of mental telepathy. He would surely want me to give him a 
            thorough explanation of the construction of such a device. And that 
            I couldn't do! Just as I couldn't give a description of the inner 
            construction of the staff of life or the Ark of the Covenant in a 
            way that would enable anyone to make such devices. Yet nevertheless 
            they do exist! And in the same way I know this telephone device can 
            exist! And Ima! You pure, true servant of God, in my 
            initiation dream you too had to pilot such a big iron bird! You and 
            all the handsome, healthy young men—you had to go out in great 
            numbers, as if bewitched, to kill others and allow yourself to be 
            killed ... how could you go along with this madness? How could you 
            obey such inhuman orders?  And who was the burning man who was 'my husband' in 
            my initiation dream? ... how close he was to my heart. He was my 
            best friend! And still he didn't know who I am, and I don't know who 
            he is.  And so I experience each individual picture of my 
            initiation dreams again. I recognize all the people who were my 
            parents, brothers and sisters, friends and enemies in my present 
            life here in Egypt. And often I really have to smile about the 
            curious relationships ...  Evening comes, and the day ends with a feast in 
            which all the priests, priestesses and neophytes take part. The 
            Pharaoh is present too, and since the relatives of the new initiate 
            are permitted to attend an initiation feast, my dear old Menu is 
            there with the rest of us! As I step into the garden, she runs 
            towards me as fast as her heavy body will carry her. Beaming with 
            joy, she embraces me and sobs with the relief of her pent-up 
            anxiety: 'Oh how good it is to see you alive again! Tell me, will 
            you still love me, now that you're a priestess, will you still love 
            me? Can I go on living with you?'  I stroke her dear old head and calm her fears: 
            'Menu, Menu, naturally I love you. Of course you can stay with me. 
            Now even greater love binds me to you.'  38
           
            AS A PRIESTESS The priestesses in the temple have different tasks 
            corresponding to their different abilities. Some teach the temple 
            dancers. Some help the restless souls of departed dead who wander 
            about aimlessly in the earth's atmosphere. In holy sleep, the 
            priestesses help them on their path towards further spiritual 
            development.  Without help they would stagnate for hundreds, 
            perhaps even thousands of years because, without organs of sense, 
            they have no opportunity to gather experience or to contact other 
            beings. They are introverted and find no path on which to progress. 
            The priestesses seek out these restless souls, penetrate their 
            beings with the power of love, and thanks to their inner identity 
            they irradiate their consciousness with ideas that help them find a 
            solution and a way out of their condition. These priestesses thus 
            perform a two-fold duty. They help wandering souls forward and 
            simultaneously purify the earth's atmosphere.  There are priestesses who work towards developing 
            healthier, more beautiful and more spiritual young people through 
            initiating them in the mysteries of physical love. They teach young 
            men to transmute their physical urge through the power of the spirit 
            and to aim for a higher spiritual union—a sacrament. They also teach 
            young men who are on the point of marrying about this sacred power, 
            so they can transmit this energy to their wives after marriage and 
            thus beget noble children.  Lastly, certain priestesses perform the same tasks 
            as the priests. They teach groups of neophytes, give instructions 
            for exercises in concentration, and receive people who need advice 
            regarding special problems. As soon as these priestesses reach an 
            advanced degree of priesthood, they are permitted to use the staff 
            of life in healing the sick. In this way a priestess can become a 
            high priestess. I have been assigned to this group.  I am truly delighted with my task! It's nothing less 
            than wonderful to observe the minds and souls of my pupils as they 
            develop step by step and manifest more and more of divinity. For me 
            it's like watching a bit of opaque material gradually become 
            transparent, allowing the divine creative principle to shine 
            through. Every day I experience this with my dear neophytes. I also 
            enjoy taking care of people who come to the temple seeking advice in 
            affairs of the spirit or matters of the body. I receive them in my 
            little cell, the same one Ima assigned to me when I first came to 
            the temple.  At such times people show me their 'other' face, the 
            face that nobody else sees ... a face they often do not know 
            themselves. I see this inner face in every creature, and it's very 
            instructive to hear about all the different events and experiences 
            that have shaped this inner countenance in accordance with the law 
            of action and reaction. Oh, if only everybody could see their own 
            and other people's inner countenances. They would never hate each 
            other, and they would never be afraid of each other! There are no 
            bad people! They often harm each other, doing evil things, even 
            cruel things, to others because they believe others are going to do 
            evil to them and they try to defend themselves in advance out of 
            pure fear. In this way they .give others a real reason to believe 
            they are acting with bad intentions.  But if one could only convince both parties to such 
            'evil actions' that neither is acting malevolently and that both are 
            merely afraid of each other, they would both breathe a sigh of 
            relief and shake hands. People are ignorant and blind. They don't 
            see each other, and this is the reason for all the enmity and 
            hostility on earth. There's nothing more beautiful than being able 
            to open blind eyes and watch the brilliant look of understanding and 
            knowledge begin to shine.  In addition to this work I am permitted to be 
            present when Ptahhotep or his deputy uses the staff of life to heal 
            the sick. In the early morning they arrive, coming by themselves or 
            with the aid of friends or relatives who bring them to the temple. 
            Ptahhotep then conducts new vital force into their sick bodies. I 
            often watch how the staff of life completely heals broken bones or 
            horrible wounds in just a few moments' time, leaving behind only a 
            thick spot in the bone or a tiny scar to show where the wound or the 
            break was. Just as two pieces of metal can be welded together into 
            one piece through heat, broken bones are mended by the staff of 
            life, and deep wounds in muscles, ligaments, blood vessels, nerves 
            and skin grow together again. With equal speed this staff of life 
            can heal the most serious inflammations of the lungs, kidneys or 
            other organs. Great indeed is the mercy and grace of God for 
            the gift he has made to mankind of this means for the recovery of 
            health.  Beside my work in the temple I continue to fulfil 
            the duties of the wife of the Pharaoh. Just as I used to do in the 
            past, I sit beside my father at festive receptions and other public 
            events. At such times I have plenty of opportunity to observe the 
            people of the court and all the others who attend these high feasts. 
            Sometimes we receive messengers and emissaries from strange 
            countries. They are quite different from these sons of men among us. 
            The colour of their skin, their physical stature and the shape of 
            their heads are all different, and they radiate different forces. 
            They sometimes bring us wonderful things as gifts, things that are 
            quite unknown in our country. Animals I have never seen before, 
            precious gems, cloth, beautifully painted pottery. Father has 
            arranged for artists to come from some of these far countries to 
            teach our young people of the temple. On the other hand, some of our 
            artists and wise men have travelled far abroad to teach our arts and 
            sciences. Father has told me that we will some day visit these great 
            countries.  Ever since my initiation I have also been permitted 
            to go for chariot rides alone with the lions. Through my initiation 
            I received the ability to guide my will-power into the nervous 
            centres of other living creatures, thus bringing them completely 
            under my power. I now control in my own body the activated nerve 
            centres which are still latent and undeveloped in the sons of men, 
            and I can send out penetrating radiations of will-power that other 
            such living creatures are turned into unconscious tools of my will.
             I never forget, however, that God's highest 
            gift to man is the right of self-determination, and I know this 
            right must never be infringed. That would be black magic! That's why 
            I never use my will-power against a person. Often enough it would be 
            so easy to help a person solve a difficult problem if I were merely 
            to fill him with my will! But this would mean that I would be taking 
            on the responsibility myself, and the solution of the problem would 
            be mine not his. In this way I would be robbing him of an 
            opportunity to pass a test. Every person must solve his own 
            problems, for only in this way can he gather experience, develop his 
            will power and widen the horizon of his consciousness.  Animals are directly subject to natural forces. They 
            automatically and instinctively carry out the will of nature and 
            possess no self-determination. So I can completely subject my lions 
            to my will. It's wonderful how these magnificent animals immediately 
            carry out my thoughts. They react to the slightest impulse of my 
            will, and I often have the feeling that they belong just as much to 
            my self as my hands and feet do. The same divine self 
            is the life of every living creature, and the 'love' animals feel is 
            nothing but the unconscious striving to achieve the unity of the 
            self on the lowest, physical plane of consciousness.  A child going through the phase of awakening 
            consciousness also tries involuntarily to achieve this same unity 
            and identity by putting into its mouth everything it can get its 
            little hands on. Animals have the same instinct. The unity and the 
            love between me and my lions is so great that they like to taKe my 
            hand or even my head between their jaws as if they were going to eat 
            me. Naturally they don't bite, and their play is not to be taken 
            seriously. I can understand that when they eat a gazelle for example
            they are only following out their instinctive striving for unity.
            The instinct for self-preservation has the same source as the 
            instinct for the preservation of the species: striving for the 
            divine state of unity.  That's why the manifestations of both instincts are 
            so close together and often overlap. Nature exploits this primordial 
            tendency towards unity in order to create progeny through the 
            instinct for procreation and propagation of the species and in order 
            to preserve the body through the satisfaction of hunger. This is the 
            reason why the meat lions get from their keepers never tastes as 
            good as the flesh they tear from the body of fresh-killed prey; for 
            in this latter act they are unconsciously experiencing a form of 
            union with the living—with life itself. With dead flesh they can 
            satisfy only their hunger but not their subconscious striving toward 
            union.  I get a great deal of pleasure out of spending time 
            with my lions. It's thrilling to observe how these majestic animals 
            manifest all the characteristics of the divine Ra—the 
            sun—transformed to the animal level. Little Bo-Ghar, too, shares my 
            pleasure in the lions, just as he is in harmony with me in 
            everything I do or say. How well I remember the endless patience my 
            father exhibited when he taught me how to stand up in a chariot 
            speeding over uneven ground. It's my turn now to teach the same 
            techniques to Bo-Ghar. He's very skilful, instinctively making the 
            right movements, and after a short time he is able to accompany me 
            even on long rides.  During quieter periods father and I withdraw to our 
            little holiday house on the seashore. Bo-Ghar comes with us, and the 
            three of us enjoy the pleasures of sun and sand and water. Father 
            too likes to spend time with the little boy, and we find it 
            thrilling to watch his pure soul develop like a magnificent flower. 
            Once, after watching Bo-Ghar for quite a while, father calls and 
            asks him to come over close. As soon as Bo-Ghar is near enough for 
            quiet conversation, father asks him, 'Well, Bo-Ghar, would you like 
            to work with me?'  Bo-Ghar prostrates himself before father, and with 
            his hands together as a sign of profoundest respect, he replies, 
            'Master, I'll devote my whole life to the task you give me in order 
            to be worthy of it.'  Father pats the boy's head. 'Stand up, Bo-Ghar,' he 
            says, 'you will work with us in the great task of redeeming the 
            earth. Just do what your teachers in the temple tell you, and one 
            day you will be a co-worker with us. Stand up ... you don't need to 
            throw yourself on the ground before me.'  Bo-Ghar can't contain his joy. And he jumps around 
            like a little monkey. Then he tries to be dignified like a grown-up 
            worthy of father's confidence. Finally he runs down to the seashore 
            to look for mussels. When I'm alone with father I ask him: 'Father, 
            now that I've been initiated, when I raise myself above the level of 
            time, I can look into the past and the future the same as you, but I 
            still can't recognize anything in my own future. Why is that? The 
            only importance I attach to the future is the development it will 
            bring me in my progress up to the last, highest, divine degree. But 
            please explain to me why I can see everybody else's future but my 
            own: I see only mist before my eyes when I turn my consciousness 
            towards my own future.'  Father looks at me, smiles and waits.  I smile back and answer him in thought. We 
            understand each other. His look tells me: 'What are you asking for? 
            If you don't see your future, it simply means that's the way it's 
            meant to be so you can fulfil your task properly. Don't bother about 
            it, but do everything to attain by your own efforts the highest 
            degree you reached with Ptahhotep's help during your initiation.'
             When our tasks call us back to the city, the days go 
            by as in the past, and I spend some of my time in the temple and 
            some in the palace. I love my work. It satisfies me completely. 
            Nevertheless, all day long I go about with the joyful anticipation 
            of being able to withdraw into myself—into God—when my day's duties 
            are over. Every time I turn inward with the determination to reach 
            the highest degree by my own efforts, and I actually do come nearer 
            and nearer to perfect fulfilment. Yet every time I return to my 
            personal consciousness, I get up disappointed. Once again I realize 
            I have failed to achieve the last and highest reality which I 
            experienced in my initiation and which burns in my memory like an 
            unquenchable flame. My only consolation in such moments is that of 
            looking forward to participating in vesper prayers and meditations 
            with Ptahhotep.  Ptahhotep, his deputy, the priests and 
            priestesses—initiates all—meet in the temple at sunset. We sit in a 
            circle, with Ptahhotep and his deputy sitting diametrically opposite 
            each other and thus forming two poles. All the rest of us form two 
            semicircles on either side. It takes us a while to free our 
            spiritual body from impurities which we have unavoidably absorbed 
            during our contacts with the sons of men. Then Ptahhotep extends his 
            blessed hands to his neighbours on either side. All the rest of us 
            join hands too, thus forming a circuit through which Ptahhotep and 
            his deputy conduct a current of the highest, supreme, divine degree 
            into our bodies. This helps us experience the supreme state of 
            divine unity. In this way our nerves develop resistance much faster 
            than they would if we were dependent only on our own energies. These 
            moments of bliss, experienced daily during our evening prayers, give 
            meaning and content to my whole life.  Oh God! Give me the strength to reach you 
            with my consciousness by my own efforts!  
             PHARAOH CHEPHREN  Cairo Museum  The Pharaoh is the image of God to whom the creative 
            principle, Horus, symbolized as a falcon, whispers Divine Truth. One 
            who is initiated hears its voice and obeys    
            WE WILL MEET AGAIN One day the court is making ready to celebrate a 
            great reception. Some time ago father sent his commander, Thiss-Tha, 
            together with many notables, a large number of troops, and ships 
            full of presents and goods for barter, as an emissary to a far 
            country. The ruler there received our dignitaries very cordially and 
            soon thereafter sent his own troops bearing presents and goods for 
            barter to our country. Today we are going to celebrate the arrival 
            of these foreign troops.  Menu decks me out in my most beautiful dress, and 
            with the usual ceremonies, Roo-Kha brings me the queen's jewels. 
            Then the two elders escort me to father, and we walk through the 
            long colonnades accompanied by the whole court. In this manner we 
            walk out in a column on to the terrace before the palace. In his 
            full dignity and great beauty, the Pharaoh takes his place on his 
            golden throne in the middle of the terrace. To his right is his 
            audience lion, while I take my seat to his left and a bit out in 
            front, almost at the edge of the terrace. The people of rank take 
            their proper places to our right and left according to their degree 
            and station.  Then the great reception begins. The troops of the 
            foreign power march up in a long festive procession. Their leader 
            and his retinue step up before the terrace and bow down before us 
            with outstretched arms. Then their leader makes a fine speech in our 
            language to tell us how eager his ruler is to reach a long-term 
            alliance with us. Then he calls his porters forward to bring us our 
            gifts.  I observe the changing scene from above and look at 
            the men in the leader's retinue. All of splendid physique, they wear 
            their ceremonial robes and military armour. The strangers are big, 
            strong, broad-shouldered and very muscular men. In our country only 
            the descendants of the race of the Sons of God are as tall and 
            strong as these strange soldiers, but much more slender, nimble and 
            resilient. Ptahhotep, father and some of the other descendants of 
            the Sons of God like Ima, Mentuptah, Imhotep and some priestesses 
            have beautiful and powerful bodies, but they are majestic, 
            dignified, full of spirituality. Less robust, they don't look so 
            much like splendid animals.  Never before in my life have I seen people like 
            these strangers. They don't please me at all! In our country I am 
            accustomed to seeing finely-chiselled facial features that reflect 
            spirituality, especially among the descendants of the race of the 
            Sons of God, and even among the hybrid race. These strangers have 
            irregular features that make them look like animals! Especially 
            their ears!  Our ears are small, narrow and finely-chiselled with 
            the lobe separate from the side of the neck. These strangers have 
            big, broad ears, their lobes joined to their necks like those of 
            monkeys. And what strikes us all as particularly strange is their 
            red hair! Their faces, hands, arms and feet are covered with an 
            abundance of hair, shining like golden threads in the sunshine. They 
            are self-assured, and when they talk or laugh they reveal rows of 
            beautiful, white, glistening, strong teeth. But this feature too 
            makes me think of animals! They radiate great strength, but not 
            spiritual strength. No! I don't like their looks!  I can see our guests from abroad find us just as 
            strange as we think they are. They don't like our looks either. I 
            see their eyes have not yet been opened to the spirit. They are 
            unable to appreciate, or even to perceive any fine, delicate, 
            spiritualized shapes. They see only the people of our country are 
            smaller than they. Reading their thoughts I can see they hold us in 
            contempt.  I am accustomed to seeing the fire of admiration 
            kindled in the eyes of men when, they look at me. These strangers 
            admire my robe and my jewels without noticing at all that I 
            am beautiful! I can see very well that they're curious about me, the 
            queen of this country, and they stare at me at every opportunity 
            without noticing that I am beautiful! Yes, I know I inherited my 
            mother's small stature, but a woman's beauty does not depend on her 
            size! But these men, these strange warriors from a far-off country 
            think a woman has to be big and fleshy to be beautiful. I observe 
            myself as I always do. Have feelings of vanity sprung up within me? 
            No! Far from it! I am merely displeased because they are so 
            ignorant, immature and crude, like people in the lowest class of the 
            sons of men in our country.  All these people are so lacking in culture and 
            polish, including their leaders and the people of rank accompanying 
            them. One of them is standing in front of the terrace, right in 
            front of me. He must be a high officer because he has come forward 
            in the closest proximity to their commander. Now he's standing 
            amidst a group of soldiers and staring at me incessantly. The 
            corners of his mouth show a disrespectful attitude. The way he acts 
            really doesn't befit a person of rank. How can a man stare at a 
            woman so impertinently? In all our court only Roo-Kha is as 
            impertinent as this fellow, and even he can't conceal his admiration 
            for my beauty. But this stranger merely stares insolently without 
            the slightest admiration! Nevertheless, I fight down any and all 
            feelings of vanity within myself. I watch out and keep myself under 
            constant control!  I turn away to watch the ceremonies again. 
            Fascinated by the military games these soldiers are playing, I must 
            admit they possess physical strength unknown in our country. Their 
            race is descended from a half-blooded Son of God who manifested his 
            father's high divine power in his blood, instead of his spirit, and 
            so became a giant. His descendants intermarried with primitive 
            people and developed a big-boned race with enormous muscular 
            strength. They're not nearly so agile and adroit as our warriors, 
            but they can perform feats of strength that would be beyond the 
            ability of our soldiers. During these military games I glance down 
            once in a while at the insolent foreigner in front of me. He is 
            still staring at me untiringly. Actually, it would be a truly 
            inspiring task to guide such an uncultured, red-headed stranger into 
            the mysteries of the spirit ... to help him step by step to open his 
            inner eyes ... to enable him to see the beauty of a woman's 
            spirituality instead of only her flesh.  For several days I am so preoccupied with our guests 
            from abroad that I have no time to go to the temple. Feasts and 
            ceremonies follow each other in rapid succession. Exhibitions, 
            excursions and banquets ... and at all of these events it is my duty 
            to take my place beside my father in officiating as host and 
            hostess. Menu is in her element, clothing me in ever more beautiful, 
            ever more magnificent robes. Bo-Ghar, however, is embittered and 
            saddened because I have no time for him. Roo-Kha comes frequently 
            with his jewel bearers to bring me new creations of the jeweller's 
            art.  I go through with all this because it's my duty to 
            do so. Nevertheless I look at my image in my great silver mirror 
            with eager curiosity, wondering what the foreigner from abroad will 
            have to say about my new robe or my new jewels. Especially when 
            father and I and all the court once dress up after the fashion of 
            our guests from abroad in order to show our friendly attitude 
            towards them. I really have to laugh to see how odd father looks in 
            this strange costume! And I? Won't our red-headed guests from abroad 
            find me beautiful even in these clothes?  For by this time I have got acquainted with him! 
            Father introduced me to his commander and all the ranking officers, 
            including 'him', and now I find myself in the company of these 
            emissaries from abroad every day. Their country's ruler, in 
            preparing for this expedition, selected only men who had succeeded 
            in learning our language in a very short time. Thus we are able to 
            converse very pleasantly with our guests and exchange ideas with 
            them. But I find myself ill at case in the presence of this 
            strange guest from abroad who stared at me so insolently throughout 
            all the reception ceremony. And my heart beats faster when I realize 
            he has exactly the same voice as the man who turned into a 
            flaming spirit in my initiation dream! How strange!  These strangers are peculiar people, lacking in 
            culture and learning but not stupid at all! They live very close to 
            nature, and even though they don't intellectually know the 
            inner, creative laws and the essence of things, they know a lot as a 
            result of their own direct experiences. It is remarkable to observe 
            how a truth, which we clearly see and know in our spirit through 
            inner contemplation, appears in these people as mere belief and 
            superstition!  When they don't know the source and cause of a 
            force, they imagine that it comes from an invisible being, and they 
            then give the name God to their own imaginings. And they 
            stubbornly insist on calling these imaginary, fairy-talc creatures 
            'gods'. They think they know everything better. When one tries to 
            tell them the truth and explain real facts to them, they merely 
            shake their head and laugh condescendingly. Of course I am not 
            permitted to tell them any of the secrets of the temple, but still I 
            have tried to explain to our foreign guest the forces which cause 
            lightning and thunder in a storm. I knew I wouldn't be permitted to 
            tell him how the high priest uses the Ark of the Covenant in the 
            pyramid to create lightning and rain ... the blessed rain that keeps 
            our country from becoming absolutely barren. But I did try to 
            explain to him that lightning comes from a meeting of two opposite 
            forces and that he can cause the same phenomenon himself by striking 
            two pieces of stone together.  At this he gave me a supercilious look, saying he 
            knew very well that lightning was the arrow of the 'chief god', and 
            that 'little demons' live in certain stones and become angry and 
            shoot out little flashes of lightning whenever they're disturbed. 
            When I tried to give him the true explanation of this phenomenon, I 
            found his mind closed up tight. In one sense it doesn't make any 
            difference whether we consider lightning to be the 'arrow of the 
            chief god' or the 'meeting of positive and negative forces'. But if 
            these people continue to believe in their superstitions and all 
            their various imaginary gods, they'll never learn to control the 
            forces of nature and always remain slaves of their superstition. 
            Anyway I have succeeded in getting our strange red-headed officer 
            guest interested enough in my explanations of various natural 
            phenomena so that he's always eager to hear more. He said he would 
            like to have me teach him; so he's going to come to the temple every 
            day, and I will initiate him into the lowest degree of knowledge.
             After sunset Menu helps me into my priestess robes. 
            Then, heavily veiled, we both walk over to the temple. A neophyte 
            has accompanied our officer guest to my little cell in the temple 
            wall where he is awaiting me. Menu stays behind in the temple court, 
            and I enter my cell. The stranger is already there! Standing there, 
            leaning against the wall of my cell, he greets me with his usual 
            smile of superiority. This smile annoys me! How does he dare to look 
            at me this way? He's not my superior in any respect. Just because 
            he's physically bigger and stronger, he ignorantly assumes himself 
            to be superior in every way. He doesn't have the faintest idea that 
            the power of mind stands over everything. But I'm going to show him! 
            With the power of my mind I'm going to conquer this insolent, 
            red-headed giant. Despite all his physical power he'll be 
            vanquished, and through my spiritual power I'll come out victorious!
             The stranger bows deeply, but I see clearly he's 
            doing it without conviction. Here in our country the people 
            practically worship me. They know I am an initiated priestess, a 
            servant of God. The stranger also knows I am a priestess in 
            the temple, but he doesn't know what 'initiation' means. He doesn't 
            know that our knowledge is not a system of beliefs based 
            merely on human imaginings, but rather the direct recognition of 
            truth ... divine omniscience! But I'll open his eyes! I'll 
            explain the mystery of man and the universe to him. I'll guide him 
            into the mystery of all creation.  'If you want to achieve true knowledge,' I tell him, 
            'you must first learn to know yourself. You have to know what you 
            yourself are. When you come to know yourself, you will discover 
            that all the truths of the universe are concealed within your own 
            being. Thus through this self-recognition you will get to know all 
            the secrets of the world. First solve the great puzzle of our  sphinx, that of man himself! You must recognize what 
            you are!'  The stranger looks at me attentively at first, but 
            then begins to smile. 'I'm supposed to learn what I am? I've known 
            that for a long time! Why is that supposed to be such a great 
            mystery? But it seems to me, oh queen, that you don't know 
            what I am, and so I am telling you: I am a man!' And with 
            that he lets out a hearty laugh, showing all his big white teeth. Oh 
            my! What a child he is! His laugh is so infectious that I can't help 
            laughing myself.  'I know very well that you're a man ...' I answer 
            him. But I can't even finish my sentence because the red haired 
            giant interrupts me impolitely: 'It seems to me, queen, that you not 
            only don't know I'm a man, but that you don't even know what a 
            man is. I'm not a priest and can't read people's thoughts the 
            way you can, but I know women, and I can see something you don't 
            know at all— or else you've forgotten it—and that is what you are! 
            You don't know you're a woman! How do you think you can try to teach 
            me the inner secrets of man and the universe if you don't even know 
            this simple fact that everybody else can see?'  'I know very well that I'm a woman,' I reply with 
            dignity. The stranger smiles insolently, but I continue undisturbed: 
            'The outer form is only the mantle of the inner being. When one 
            knows the inner being and when one is the inner being, he 
            uses the outer form only as an instrument but does not identify 
            himself with it! The body is only the robe of the self. 
            You wear clothing too, and yet you are not the clothing. In the very 
            same way you wear a body which can be either male or female, but 
            your self stands above the sexes and is neither man nor 
            woman. The self is the creator. The person, the physical, 
            material manifestation is only one half of the true being. The other 
            half has remained behind in the unconscious, unmanifested state. And 
            whether a manifestation is male or female depends merely on which 
            half has incarnated itself. When a person has made both halves of 
            his being conscious and experienced them consciously, he has become 
            identical with his self, and then he carries within himself 
            both the male and female principles in complete equilibrium.'  'But still his body is either male or female, isn't 
            it?' he asks.  'Yes, indeed,' I answer. 'The material phenomenon 
            can only be one-sided, for whenever the two sides merge into unity 
            there is nothing physical. The union of the two complementary 
            halves, the merging of the two sides would mean complete 
            annihilation of matter, complete dematerialization of the body. One 
            can only be androgynous in spirit.'  'Queen,' answers the guest from abroad, 'there's 
            only one thing in all your pretty words that I can really understand 
            quite clearly ... a point on which I'm in complete agreement with 
            your "secrets", namely that my physical manifestation, as you 
            express it so neatly, is only one half of a unit. In the past I have 
            often sought—and found—a complementary half, but I was never 
            annihilated in doing so! Perhaps because I never found the real 
            unity? But even if it were to mean annihilation I would go on 
            seeking my true, complementary half. I am a man, and my other 
            half can only be a woman who gives me complete and perfect 
            happiness. For such a woman I would gladly lay down my life!'  I feel in my body a warm rush of blood that reaches 
            my head. In the face of such a way of thinking I am completely 
            powerless. How can I explain to him that the earthly happiness he is 
            seeking in a woman is only transitory and unable to satisfy his 
            immortal soul?  We end our discussion for today. He must have time 
            to digest the new truths I have given him.  And there follow many evenings in which I do battle 
            with his ignorance. I am determined to help him make progress, and I 
            take all kinds of care to say the right words to him in order to fan 
            the divine spark into flame and awaken his higher self. When I wake 
            up in the morning he is already in my thoughts. I remember 
            everything we spoke about the previous evening and concentrate my 
            thinking throughout the day on the lesson I am going to give him in 
            the evening. Often during these days I race through the countryside 
            with my lions but now it's without Bo-Ghar. Bo-Ghar hangs his head 
            as he goes to his master Ima for lessons, Ima tries to console him 
            with all kinds of presents and everything else a boy's heart could 
            wish for. I'm sorry to see Bo-Ghar so sad, but I need time to be 
            alone with my own thoughts.  After one of my chariot rides, while I am taking 
            leave of my lions in the lions' court, I pat their heads and run my 
            fingers through their manes. As I'm doing this, it suddenly occurs 
            to me that our officer guest from abroad has exactly the same colour 
            hair as the lions! If I were to stroke his head, the same thick 
            locks of red hair would be slipping through my ringers! Oh, how I 
            love these lions!  That evening I tell our guest my observation about 
            his having the same colour hair as the lions.  'Queen,' he says, 'may I go for a chariot ride with 
            you sometime? If I could see that you could control real live lions 
            with your will-power, I'd begin to believe in your superhuman 
            powers!' And he laughs tauntingly.  'Where have you heard that I have superhuman 
            powers?'  'Everybody I talk to adores you like a goddess. 
            Everybody believes you're a supernal being. But I don't!'  I feel injured: 'What do you think about me?' I ask, 
            noticing with some annoyance that my heart is pounding while I await 
            his answer. In the very same moment, quick as a flash, Ptahhotep's 
            image pops up before my inward eye, with a warning expression on his 
            noble face.  'No! No! Leave me alone,' I answer the inward image. 
            'I'm in no danger!'  And outwardly I go on listening to what the stranger 
            says: 'So you want to know what I think about you? Why do you want 
            to hear that from me? If you're so high up above everything earthly 
            why should you be interested in what goes on in a poor earthly head 
            like mine? And after all, you can read people's thoughts, can't 
            you?'  'Yes, I can read your thoughts, but I want to see 
            whether you're being frank with me,' I answer. But as I do so I am 
            aware of an uneasy feeling. There's no time to try to find out what 
            this feeling means, because the stranger asks me again: 'So you want 
            to know whether I'm being frank with you? Why don't you ask yourself 
            first whether you're being frank with your self?'  I am speechless. I just don't know what to answer. 
            For years I've made a habit of self observation in order to seek out 
            the motives of all my thoughts and deeds. I am convinced I am frank 
            with myself and therefore frank with the rest of the world including 
            him. Nevertheless his words bring an embarrassing surprise. Could he 
            be right? Have I really lacked the courage frankly to face all my 
            thoughts and feelings? I resolve to examine myself even more 
            thoroughly, but in any case I'm going to concentrate all my efforts 
            in order not to be defeated in the struggle with him. I must come 
            out victorious. I mustn't allow an uncouth stranger to think I'm 
            weaker than he is! I mustn't allow him to think he stands above me!
             The next day we go for a chariot ride together. 
            Before we get in, the stranger stands beside the lions and holds out 
            his shaggy red head towards me. 'Want to try and see if my hair 
            really feels like the lions'? If they don't mind your stroking their 
            hair, I may be able to stand it too,' he says with a hearty laugh 
            that erupts from between two perfect rows of white teeth.  He really is a big child. He's not behaving this way 
            out of lack of respect, and I can't be angry at him. I have to laugh 
            too, and if the keeper of my lions were not standing near, I really 
            would feel like tousling his hair.  And so it goes, day after day. And the time quickly 
            draws near when the stranger will have to return to his homeland. In 
            many respects I could be satisfied. As a 'woman' I could even gloat 
            in triumph at the way his attitude has changed. He has put away his 
            superior airs and waits all day long every day for the evening to 
            come so that we can be together. I realize he never really felt 
            superior, and that his overbearing manner was actually a kind of 
            self-defence to save him from complete capitulation. He didn't want 
            to give up his masculine arrogance.  He admired me from the very first moment he saw me, 
            and my vanity, which first drove me to spend time in his company 
            could now be completely satisfied. And yet I am not 
            satisfied. On the contrary I am plagued by persistent anxiety. But 
            every time I analyse my feelings, this anxiety gives me the 
            reassurance that my interest for him is not coming from the feminine 
            instinct of my lower nature. For I am constantly watching and 
            checking on myself! Menu says I show all the unmistakable symptoms 
            of being in love and she's overjoyed that I am 'blooming' at last. 
            But she's wrong! She's in no position to judge because she considers 
            everything from her earthly standpoint. She can't begin to 
            understand that I cannot and must never fall in love ... and that 
            I'm not in love now!  How could I ever fall in love with this uncouth, 
            unkempt, red-headed giant? He's not my type. Physically, he seems 
            strange, even repulsive to me. In my moments of self-examination, I 
            have often asked myself whether I could want to have a child by him. 
            Heaven forbid! A child with such ears and such an ungainly, 
            raw-boned body? Never! In any case I know absolutely I would never 
            want to have a child by him! So I know I'm not in love. I only want 
            him to find God. I am keenly interested in each of my pupils, 
            and for this very reason I think of him so often and with such a 
            concentration of all my attention. But he hasn't found God 
            yet. In this point I haven't yet succeeded! That's why I feel so sad 
            and anxious when I realize he is soon going to have to leave our 
            country, and I may never see him again in this life ...  Then everything happens faster than a flash of 
            lightning ...  On our last evening together I go to the temple to 
            see him and take leave of him. As usual, he's leaning against the 
            wall. But now he doesn't try to seem so superior the way he did when 
            he waited here for me the first time. Now he doesn't even look at 
            me, but stands there staring off into space.  'What's the matter?' I ask him.  'I'm just trying to think what kind of sense it 
            makes for me to have been coming here to see you every evening. What 
            did you want of me, you beautiful queen with no heart? What use have 
            I had out of all the things you've told me if they've only served to 
            make me unhappy? You've talked on and on about my having to find 
            myself, but with every one of your words and deeds you've helped to 
            make me lose myself completely. I was a brave, courageous fighter, 
            afraid of no one, and now I've become a slave. The slave of a tiny 
            woman who hardly comes up to my shoulders! And now I'm afraid of the 
            future. How am I going to be able to live without you?'  A hot wave of joy floods through my being. I try to 
            imagine it's only my vanity. But I feel a shock! In the beginning I 
            really did want him to recognize my feminine beauty and power, and 
            as soon as I had achieved that I wanted to use my power over him to 
            help him on the inner path. I took all kinds of pains to awaken the
            self within him. But instead, he's fallen in love with me. I 
            didn't want to go that far! I don't want earthly love. I've wanted 
            to create with him a far higher unity, the unity of the self. 
            I wanted to lead him to God! But it's done no good at all for 
            me to bring forth the deepest truths from out of my inner being ... 
            He sees me only as a woman. He cannot or will not rise above the 
            sensual. He doesn't see me. He doesn't realize that he does 
            not love me. I don't really exist for him. He merely loves my 
            body, the outer cloak which is merely a manifestation of my true 
            self! How horrible! How debasing!  'Look,' I say, trembling, 'it hasn't made any sense 
            at all for you to come here to see me, because we just don't 
            understand each other. We just can't get together. I want to help 
            you rise to the spiritual plane, and you want to drag me down to the 
            level of the body. It hasn't made any sense at all to go through all 
            this trouble. Go back to your homeland in peace, and we'll never 
            meet again!'  At these words, the blood rushes to his head. His 
            face, his neck ... the whole man becomes dark red, so dark his hair 
            seems lighter than his skin. His eyes flash like glowing embers, and 
            with a shock I see his whole spiritual body turning into a powerful 
            flame. Then, without my having time to defend myself, he seizes my 
            arm, holding it as if in iron tongs, pulls me to his mighty breast, 
            embraces me, pushes my head backward, presses his mouth to my lips 
            with such force that I lose my breath. Then he kisses my face, my 
            neck and my lips again, and in between his burning kisses, he 
            whispers hoarsely: 'So you don't want to see me any more? But I 
            want to see you, and we'll meet again ... we'll meet again.'  As I saw his wild face coming close, I felt a wave 
            of deathly panic. I wanted to push him back and get away, but as he 
            locked me in his mighty arms and pressed his burning hot mouth upon 
            my lips, all my inner being caught his fire. I lost control over 
            myself, and without resistance I gave in to the overpowering feeling 
            of pleasure and delight that sprang up out of my fright and swept 
            through me. Now I realize I love him ... have loved him from the 
            first moment ... with all my body and soul ... with my whole being I 
            love him passionately and I always will!  The fire overwhelms me as if coming forth from a 
            gigantic volcano. Hot flames sweep through me ... devour me ... my 
            backbone feels like a bridge of glowing embers, holding seven 
            burning torches. But now I'm no longer in the immovable axis of my 
            spinal column, no longer in the midpoint from which my true self
            radiates the fire of life. On the contrary, my consciousness has 
            fallen into my burning body, and sparkling, crackling, flashes of 
            lightning race through my veins ... through my whole being. All my 
            nerves are aglow, all my thoughts blotted out. They're burning out 
            my consciousness ... annihilating me ... Then I black out and 
            everything disappears ...  Little by little I come to again ... slowly I open 
            my eyes ... see stone walls around me. I am lying on the floor of my 
            little cell.  I am alone ... surrounded by the silence of a tomb.
             I have no thoughts. I haven't anything I could think 
            about any more ...  Dejected and broken, I get up, cover my weary head 
            with my veil and leave the cell.  The long colonnade is dark and seemingly empty. 
            After a few steps I see a dark form leaning against the opposite 
            wall: Ima! He stands there as if made of stone, staring at me with 
            an indescribably wild look in his eyes. Even in the darkness I can 
            see it ... have to see it. He looks right into me ... right through 
            me. Then he turns and walks away softly in the opposite direction.
             Without a thought in my head I go back to the 
            palace. Menu, who had fallen asleep in a corner of the temple court, 
            accompanies me, as usual in silence, except for an occasional loud 
            yawn.  4O
           
            THE LION I lie on my knees before Ptahhotep.  I do not speak. He understands my unspoken words, 
            even when I am silent ...  'Father of my Soul, save me! Take this fire out of 
            my body, give me back my freedom! I cannot and will not go on living 
            this way ...  'I lost myself, I am destroyed, I no longer have any 
            control over myself, I can't think any more what I'm doing; my 
            thoughts control me and split my head apart.  'Help me, Father of my Soul, help me back to the 
            heavenly heights where spiritual clarity, purity and freedom reign. 
            Give me back my wings so that I may fly again with you on high like 
            the creative power of God, the divine hawk Horus, who flies through 
            the universe creating new worlds.  'Open up heaven for me again, Father of my Soul, let 
            me hear the music of the spheres again ... the music that now lives 
            on only in my memory, while within me there reigns only the silence 
            of the tomb because my ears are deaf.  'Open my spiritual eyes again, Father of my Soul, 
            for they are burned out; I see the light of heaven and the 
            brilliance of God only in my memory, while within me there is only 
            darkness as my inner eyes have become blind.  'Open for me the gate of my heavenly home where I 
            once possessed all the treasures of the spirit that now live only in 
            my memory, Father of my Soul, because I have fallen and have become 
            a poor earthly beggar.  'Open up again for me the happiness and the peace in 
            the divine unity of those who have found salvation, Father of my 
            Soul ... the unity which now is mine only in memory as I have fallen 
            into the wilderness, into the desert, haunted and plagued 
            unceasingly by the burning unrest of being torn in two.  'Lay your blessed hand upon my head and permit me to 
            be freed from the dungeon of time ... permit me to become again in 
            the eternal present the person I was ... the person I really am ... 
            the person I can no longer be in the elusive world of 
            appearances.  'Father of my Soul, save me, save my soul! Permit me 
            to hear your voice again, like the voice of God within me, for I no 
            longer hear your answers. I am blind and deaf, I have lost my 
            heavenly wings, I have become as one expelled, one driven out in 
            exile. Take me back, Father of my Soul, take me back into the unity 
            of the blessed, because I can't go on living this way! Save me, 
            Father of my Soul, save me, you man of God, do not leave me, do not 
            leave me ... do not leave me ...'  But I hear no answer.  I have lost everything. My intellect that has always 
            been there to help me onward is foggy; only hazy thoughts creep 
            through my mind like tired travellers.  On my bed in the palace I lie with one and only one 
            thought in my head: to die! I can't go on living, I won't go on 
            living! I am only the shadow of myself. Through the mists in my 
            mind, hazy faces rise up to harass me: Menu, crying hopelessly, and 
            Bo-Ghar ... the despairing eyes of Bo-Ghar ...  I want to die! ... To die!  I used to be master of my body and could leave it 
            intentionally at will. Now I try it—but without success! I cannot 
            leave my body. It's as if I were nailed into it, I can't leave it. 
            I've become a prisoner in the dungeon of matter.  I want to go to the Ark of the Covenant! It will 
            burn up my body just as its radiation burns up the dead sacrificial 
            animals in the temple ... so completely that not even a trace of ash 
            is left.  I put on my veil and hasten to the temple, through 
            the great hall, on to the door that opens into the underground 
            passage to the great pyramid. But I can't get through. Before the 
            stone door I run up against an invisible wall. It begins to dawn in 
            my hazy brain: the lowest frequency of the Ark of Covenant, ultra 
            matter! Materialized hate! Although completely invisible, it 
            protects the forbidden area better than the strongest wall. I try 
            again to break through the invisible barrier, but the unbelievably 
            hard wall of ultra matter stops me unmercifully.  There is no mercy for me ... no mercy ...  Slowly I go back through the long temple passage, 
            past my own little cell.  Without thinking, I go in and sit down on the stone 
            bench. I sink back into memories ... the room expands, from every 
            side I hear the echo of infinity, and within me pictures emerge: a 
            figure, wrapped in hazy fog, approaches ine ... I recognize it: the 
            hazy figure I saw in my vision when I was being initiated. It comes 
            quite close to me; then a flame spurts out of it, the whole figure 
            begins to burn and becomes a fiery being who irresistibly embraces 
            me, encircles me and penetrates me so that I too catch fire and 
            begin to burn. Then I hear his voice whispering to me: 'I told you 
            we would meet again. You belong to me, you will never again be free 
            of me, we will meet again ... in endless time and in timeless 
            infinity we will meet again, again ...' And the echo of his voice 
            goes on repeating thousands and thousands of times: 'meet again ... 
            meet again ... meet again ...'  'No!' I cry, 'I will not, I hate you!'  The figure of fire laughs: 'As long as you hate me, 
            you love me and I have power over you! You can't get free as easy as 
            that ... we will meet again,' the echo goes on calling ...  As I hear this voice echoing back thousands of times 
            from every direction in the empty room, so powerfully that the air 
            itself literally vibrates with it, I know the hazy figure of fire is 
            whispering and looking at me with voice and eyes I can no longer 
            resist. In all the endless lives I was able to remember in the 
            vision I had during my initiation, I was always seeking the same 
            voice and the same eyes in all the voices that spoke to me and in 
            all the eyes that looked at me and in all the countless men I met in 
            all those countless lives. In all these men I was seeking the 
            man whom I love with love eternal and with every drop of my blood, 
            the only man, 'my' man: the image and likeness of my complementary 
            half ...  Then another picture flashes upon my mind, the 
            picture of the man whom I do not love as my complementary half, but 
            as myself: Ima! I could not love him with earthly love 
            because I was always one with him in God. We are bound 
            together by the eternal love of heavenly unity. I will go to 
            him now, I will tell him everything, he will understand me! The 
            unity that binds me to him will lead me like a light in my further 
            travels; this unity will illuminate my darkened path so that I can 
            find my way back into the heavenly home I have lost, to God. 
             I rush madly out of my cell. I look for him in the 
            neophytes' school where he prepares candidates for initiation; I 
            look for him everywhere, peering into every room. But I find him 
            nowhere. Suddenly the young priest appears who helped me with my 
            last preparations before initiation.  'Are you looking for Ima?' he asks.  'Yes, where can I find him?'  'You won't find Ima here any more. He left the 
            temple in absolute desperation. He completely lost control of 
            himself, for his faith was not in God above everything, but 
            in a woman! He rushed away from here in a terrible state. 
            None of us could stop him. He said he'd rather live with negro 
            tribes than go on living here in the temple because the savages 
            would not disappoint him. "The savages do not lie; they don't 
            pretend to be different from what they really are!" were his last 
            words before he ran away. You'll never find Ima again.'  I stand stiff and silent with horror. Oh Ima! I have 
            brought misfortune and despair on you too! The hell within me 
            suddenly becomes a hundred times more horrible because of this news. 
            And still I know the young priest is wrong. I will find Ima 
            again! If not in this life, then in a future one! Everything 
            passes away; only true love never dies, and this wonderful love that 
            stands above and beyond all differences of sex, this love of 
            spiritual unity, will with absolute certainty lead us, Ima and me, 
            back together again!  I return to the palace knowing only one thing for 
            sure—that I must die. Even if I were not a priestess, even if 
            I were not initiated, I would not be able to go on living; but now 
            that I know I have pulled down my best friend into hell with me, my 
            mental torture becomes unbearable. All my thoughts and all my 
            feelings balk at the thought of going on living. I want to destroy 
            myself, and again and again I make a supreme effort to leave my 
            body.  But I can't! I can't die! I must go on carrying 
            within me the fire that's burning me up and destroying my nerves. I 
            can't flee from myself. When I lie down completely exhausted to seek 
            relief and rest a bit, I feel as if a mountain were weighing down 
            upon my breast. I can scarcely breathe. Before my closed eyes I see 
            blinding fire and flames, red flickering flames like the hair of the 
            strange man ... like the shabby mane of the lions ...  The lions!—Yes, the lions, I will go to them.  And I'll dress myself as if preparing for a chariot 
            ride.  The keeper lets me go to the lions, because he knows 
            that ever since my initiation my father has allowed me to go out 
            riding with the lions alone.  I go to my lions. They greet me with lowered head 
            and with wrinkled nostrils. They smell a strange scent about me; 
            they notice a strange and foreign emanation clinging to me. I go to 
            Shima and stroke his head. Shu-Ghar lets out a loud growl, slowly 
            drawing himself up ready to leap. Rage and jealousy blaze in his 
            eyes, and the instinct of self-preservation awakens within me. I 
            hurl my will against Shu-Gahr just as I used to guide him with my 
            willpower during our chariot rides. But with a shiver of horror I 
            realize I can't hurl my will any more. My will is lame and dead, and 
            the lion leaps. As I turn to run, in a flash I see three 
            horror-struck people running toward me: Thiss-Tha, Bo-Ghar and the 
            keeper. With all my might I run out of the court of lions. I feel 
            the hot breath of the lion upon my neck; I feel its muzzle touching 
            me ... and then a blow upon my head—but I keep on running; I see a 
            door through which I must run into an area where the lion will have 
            no more power over me; and in the door I see the fine, pale figure 
            of my mother! 'Mother!' I cry and run on breathless because I 
            know I'll be safe in her arms. Mother awaits me with her sweet smile 
            and with open arms. Making an extreme effort, I run to her ... and 
            fall in her arms. The lion disappears—I am saved ...  Then everything is dark and I know only one thing: I 
            am in the arms of my mother who helped me over the threshold. I feel 
            good ... I rest ... I revel in the love of my mother whom I haven't 
            seen for so long, I revel in the peace of love ...  Suddenly a great indefinable power draws my 
            consciousness in some direction and I awaken. I'm lying on a 
            sarcophagus and don't feel my body. My consciousness is hazy; I only 
            know that I want to get up but can't. Then I see Ptahhotep and his 
            deputy standing near me, and it is Ptahhotep who softly, gently 
            holds me back. I must remain prone. I am in my spiritual body which 
            is still connected by the magic thread to my material body of flesh 
            and blood and bone. My body lies embalmed in the sarcophagus, and 
            I'm lying on it, in the same position, in my spiritual body. 
            Ptahhotep and his deputy are near me; I see them in their spiritual 
            body ... see the glowing centres of power which their eyes have 
            built up in their material bodies and with which they look out into 
            the material world. Ptahhotep's two centres of power now emit a 
            bluish phosphorescent light upon me, into me, penetrating my entire 
            being, and sleep overcomes me.  The hall and the two high priests disappear. Again I 
            rest in my mother's arms. Now I realize I'm not resting in her arms, 
            but in two streams of power which once had built up her arms as well 
            as her whole body and radiated out of her body as love; these forces 
            are carrying me and filling my tortured soul with love, peace and a 
            feeling of security.  Suddenly an unpleasant sound yanks me out of this 
            ... a sharp report which my spiritual ears first perceive as a blow. 
            Seeking the cause, I notice it's a snapping sound as a slave driver 
            cracks his whip at regular intervals. He's doing it to keep slaves 
            in step as they pull my sarcophagus which slowly slides along on 
            rails like a sled. I must have just left the palace.  I want to jump up but I can't. I can't move my legs 
            at all. From my neck to the tips of my feet I am bound tightly. I 
            lie there as if I were chiselled out of a single block of stone, my 
            hands crossed over my breast, my legs stretched out straight, 
            parallel to each other. In this position I can only look upward and 
            forward. In the direction of my feet I see the shiny, sweaty backs 
            of men, bent over forward, as they pull me on with rhythmic steps. 
            Over their backs in the distance, I see a building of white stone, 
            in its side a dark black spot like an open door. With its glistening 
            white walls, the building contrasts sharply with the dark blue sky. 
            As the men pull me onward, it slowly comes nearer, and the dark spot 
            gets larger. I look up to the sky that is so dark blue it almost 
            seems black. Two big birds circle silently over me—Storks? Or 
            cranes?  Now the stone building is very near, and the dark 
            spot is very big ... yes ... it really is an opening. Oh, now I know 
            ... We're in the City of the Dead! I'm being hauled into a tomb! The 
            men step into the opening and disappear in the darkness ... Now the 
            black opening slides over my head ... And after the blinding 
            sunshine, the world around me is suddenly dark; everything 
            disappears ; absolute, inky darkness covers me! Unspeakable horror 
            grips me, and in my heart I suddenly call out to Ptahhotep: 'How 
            long? ... How long must I lie imprisoned here?' And now I clearly 
            hear his voice—the voice of Ptahhotep —telling me the inexorable, 
            immutable sentence: 'Three ... thousand ... years ...'  Monstrous horror, despair and fear seize me, holding 
            me as in a vice, and out of this fear there suddenly appears again 
            the monster that is the expression of the law of matter. I see his 
            deathly, satiric ugly face grinning at me, his trenchant glance 
            boring deep down into me and tying me to the mummy that once was 
            I.  Then the monster speaks to me: 'So now you are in my 
            power! You see, the highest and the lowest are always reflections of 
            each other. Perfection resting within itself and eternal rigidity
            are two sides of the same divinity. You wanted to become 
            conscious in the perfection resting within itself, and now 
            you have fallen into rigidity!  'Yes, the mortal remains of the initiates are 
            embalmed by the priests in the temple so that the divine power 
            radiated by their bodies can continue to be active, like a battery, 
            for a long time. Their spirit is free; in their consciousness they 
            aren't attached to the earth. But you have bound yourself to your 
            body. By carnal love, you guided the divine power within you into 
            your lower nerve centres and burned yourself up. In this way, your 
            consciousness together with your spiritual body are bound to your 
            material body: you are my prisoner forever! Whereas the spiritual 
            body of the initiate, through the act of embalming, is attached to 
            his mummy, his consciousness is in eternity. But you are 
            exiled in infinity!  'Eternity is the eternal present; infinity is the 
            eternal future which can never be reached and never becomes 
            present.  'Eternity never had a beginning and 
            thus will never have an end. Eternity is timeless present
            which has no past nor future. Infinity, however, means a 
            falling out of eternity into the future, without a present!
             'You wanted to take part in the spiritualization of 
            the earth. Now, spiritualize this little lump of earth that was your 
            body if you can! Ha, ha, ha!  The priestess is lying here, and her consciousness 
            isn't more than a piece of stone!  'Now you're undergoing the first test of the 
            initiation: in the condition of consciousness of matter with a 
            human consciousness! Just try to get free if you can! You're my 
            prisoner! You can't get away from me because you have become
            I. In your initiation you conquered me because 
            I had to recognize in the face of your divinely spiritual 
            consciousness that I would not exist without the self. 
            Thus I had to admit that I am you. But now it's the 
            other way round: You in your consciousness have become 
            matter. You have identified yourself with your body and are 
            nevertheless spirit like I am, namely, the spirit of matter. 
            Therefore, you have become I!  'You're my prisoner in infinity ... in darkness ... 
            imprisoned in this corpse which you were and which because of the 
            embalming can't decay to allow you to go free. It will be your 
            punishment to watch how this mummy—that now preserves your beauty 
            because of the embalming process—will gradually shrink and become 
            the image and likeness of me. You wanted to be immortal in the 
            spirit of eternity, and you have become imperishable in 
            this mummy into all infinity, into infinity, ... infinity ...'  I am powerless. I must listen. I lie there with my 
            spiritual body indissolubly bound to my mummy. In desperation, I 
            attempt to escape into unconsciousness, but I cannot! I must 
            lie there completely conscious, without having the vaguest idea 
            about time as it flows on past me.  Time! What are you, oh time! You exist only to the 
            extent that we human beings are unhappy! In happiness there is no 
            time: our consciousness stands still; the concept of time 
            disappears. Only when happiness is over do we suddenly realize that 
            while our consciousness was hovering tunelessly in the eternal 
            present, time was rushing onward. Time begins with our fall from 
            happiness, from paradise. But unhappiness too knows no time, for the 
            more unhappy we feel, the slower time goes by; minutes seem hours, 
            and in our moments of deepest despair, when sufferings and torture 
            are unbearable, every moment becomes an infinity; time freezes!
            Oh, how right Satan is! The highest and the lowest are as alike 
            as two twins, just like reality and its reflection, appearance. 
            Happiness is timeless eternity, and the opposite, 
            unhappiness, is endless time—infinity.  I lie there and have nothing, absolutely nothing, 
            with which to compare or measure time! Oh, tree of knowledge of good 
            and evil! Now I understand your truth that recognition is only 
            possible when we can compare!  How can I know how much time has passed when I can't 
            see the sun, this divine timepiece ... when I have no idea what kind 
            of an experience of time a day represents in this darkness? What is 
            there to show me time when nothing happens, when only solidified 
            darkness reigns around me? How can I know anything about time when I 
            no longer have a heart which once measured the rhythm of life in my 
            breast and now with its pulse could give me an idea of time? Have I 
            been lying here for a few minutes and does it already seem an 
            eternity? Or weeks ... years ... or centuries ... millennia? What is 
            a minute and what is a millennium? How could I possibly know the 
            difference?  The feeling of horror and fear refuses to leave me 
            for a single moment. I no longer have lungs with which to draw a 
            deep breath, with which to draw fresh power from the eternal source 
            ... with which to measure time by their breathing. I cannot look in 
            any direction for help for my tortured soul ... The tortures and 
            sufferings know no end ... no end ... no end ...    
            MIST AND RE-AWAKENING Time ran across the face of the great cosmic clock, 
            along the circumference of the gigantic wheel of creation ... ever 
            onward even though I had not the faintest idea it was passing ...
             It seemed to me I had been lying there for aeons and 
            aeons, stiff and rigid ... as if the tortures of hell would never 
            end ... when finally a moment did come in which I felt a force 
            approaching me ... a force greater and stronger than the bond which 
            held my consciousness to my mummy, and which, now completely dried 
            and shrivelled, had become the horrible image of the spirit of 
            matter. This new force was drawing me irresistibly in some 
            direction. After all the sufferings and tortures of hell I lost 
            consciousness.  Two people, related to me in their souls, united and 
            gave me the opportunity to inherit a body corresponding to the 
            nature and degree of my far-fallen consciousness.  Because I had fallen as a woman, I had to be born 
            again and again as a woman until I re-attained the level from which 
            I had fallen. I came into surroundings where I met only 
            semi-conscious people ... where my deeds and those of the people 
            around me were ruled by passions and animal instincts ... where I 
            found only brutality, crude selfishness and an absence of any kind 
            of love.  I lived several insignificant lives one after the 
            other, all in a hazy, semi-animal state of consciousness, and all of 
            them serving only to awaken my emotional life. Misery and incessant 
            work woke and polished my dulled and feelingless nerves. Men always 
            played a great role. Men from whose bodies the same passionate fire 
            of physical instincts always came forth to burn me. Again and again 
            I met the fiery eyes and the whispering voice of the spirit woven of 
            fire whom I had first met in my third trial. And again and again I 
            was forced to dance with the spirit in the cavern of sensuality and 
            passions where people turned the sacrament of procreation into a 
            self-seeking end in itself ... and I had to dance on with this 
            spirit until I could scarcely stand on my weary feet. I wanted to be 
            'happy' and I kept on seeking love ... kept on seeking the one and 
            only man whom I could have loved and who could have loved me, the 
            image of my complementary half. But I found only whipped-up 
            sensuality and heartless passions that never could have satisfied 
            me. I went on and on, seeking happiness again and again in the arms 
            of men, trying to find the one I loved ... the one with whom 
            I could experience true love ...  These lives were a series of never-ending 
            disappointments. Fate whipped and drove me onward, and my soul 
            suffered so many blows that the fires of my tortures burned through 
            the layer of indifference about my nerves and gradually awakened my 
            comatose consciousness. The incessant excitement enabled me to 
            develop my nervous system step by step and bring it upward by at 
            least one degree in each of these lives. Thus through my sufferings,
            eternal love enabled me to purify and refine my nerves and 
            increase their resistance again.  In each of these lives, however, there was within me 
            an incessant striving to find again those people whom I consciously 
            sought with every drop of my blood even though I could no longer 
            remember them ... people like myself! People with whom I would feel 
            'at home' ... people to whom I really belonged with every fibre of 
            my being: Ptahhotep, Atothis, Ima and Bo-Ghar ... but I didn't find 
            them! Now and again I believed I was meeting one or the other of 
            them. Love and memory flamed up within me, but then mists covered 
            the clear picture, and I lost them again. Sometimes I heard a 
            servant of God speak about a great teacher, a 'Son of God', 
            and I had a vague recollection of having once somewhere, somehow in 
            the dim past been close to this high being ... having heard his 
            teachings in living words, and within my poor benighted soul there 
            arose a force tending to draw me away to where such high beings are 
            'at home'. But these moments never lasted long; for fate always gave 
            me another shove forward, brutal blows drove back the dawning 
            memories, and I forgot everything again.  The physical and spiritual privations I was forced 
            to endure purified my limited senses until my nerves were again able 
            to support the highest vibrations of unselfish love. Then, 
            gradually, a heavenly ray of divine love began to shine through the 
            brute passions of physical instinct. And in my next life this 
            wonderful love banished forever the mists which had been clouding my 
            spiritual sight.  Then when I was born as the neglected servant child, 
            I was already carrying unselfish, divine love in my heart. But now 
            my higher brain and nerve centres had to be awakened in order for me 
            to be able to learn to express and use spiritual abilities. Again I 
            met the man with the fiery eyes and the well-known voice ... the man 
            who had once been the red-haired foreigner. On his own pathway 
            through numerous lives he had gone on developing himself. I loved 
            him, I had to love him in order to gather the last experiences of 
            love between man and woman. In my love for him, however, I conducted 
            only physical forces into the body and this did not represent a 
            fall. Finally our common fate brought us together again as beggars, 
            and the tremendous shock of remembering prodded my still dull spirit 
            into further activity. My spiritual eyes opened. But the shock was 
            so great that my body collapsed and I died the same instant.  In accordance with the law of heredity I was drawn, 
            a few centuries later, to two pure people filled with love whose 
            lives had been involved with mine for ages and ages.  And once again I opened my two human eyes in this 
            life on earth and looked at the world around me with all my previous 
            experience ...  The same frequencies of vibration build up the same 
            outward forms. And as I have, with my present spiritual 
            constellation in this life, again reached the level of the erstwhile 
            Pharaoh's daughter, I also resemble her outwardly. But as I have 
            become stronger in spirit and will-power, I have larger, stronger 
            bones than I had in that previous life in Egypt. On the other hand, 
            the shape, colour and appearance—the expression—of my eyes have 
            remained the same.  When I survey my whole present life back to the time 
            of my birth, everything is clear to me! During that previous life of 
            mine in Egypt I was conscious of my self, and now in my 
            re-awakened state in which I am again conscious of my self 
            memories come alive for me from that last significant life in which 
            my consciousness was on the same level.  My last experience from that life—the experience of 
            being imprisoned in a coffin—was my very last impression. The horror 
            I felt then impressed itself so deeply on my soul that it was the 
            first thing I remembered again in this life.  But even much earlier, during my childhood, 
            unconscious or semiconscious memories came back to me.  The terrible disappointment I experienced when I 
            began to realize that my 'father' was not the greatest man in the 
            country ... my conviction that my dearly beloved parents were not my 
            true parents—such were my first, semiconscious memories of my 
            earlier life.  The blobs of fat on my soup and my incessant search 
            for unity in my circle of friends—that was my longing for bliss in 
            the unity of the self—as I had come to experience it in the 
            temple.  The strange body postures I practised as a little 
            girl at home without ever having had the opportunity to see such 
            exercises, the postures our friend returning from the Far East 
            called 'Hatha Yoga exercises', these were memories of the exercises 
            I had practised in the temple with Mentuptah. This system of 
            exercises was part of the secret knowledge saved by 'Sons of God' 
            when they fled to India where it has been guarded and preserved by 
            great masters until our own times.  The horrible dream I had again and again for many 
            years, in which a lion was chasing me so close I could feel its hot 
            breath on my neck ... the dream that filled my childhood with fear 
            and terror was my first memory of my last impressions of that life 
            in Egypt ... the impressions of the death I died then.  And the 'giants', the 'titans', and the 'demigods', 
            who with their tremendous abilities stand far above the sons of men 
            and about whom father—my dear father of this present life—knows 
            nothing because he doesn't remember: Ptahhotep, Atothis ... Sons of 
            God ... where are you? ... Where are you?  And I cry out silently in my soul, the way I once 
            learned to do in the temple before my dearly beloved and highly 
            honoured master, the high priest Ptahhotep ... and turn my attention 
            inward to listen for an answer ...  At first I suddenly find myself in dark emptiness. 
            But I am fully conscious in this darkness and know that the 
            searchlight of consciousness is the greatest light, and the only 
            light capable of penetrating any darkness. And I set the light of my 
            consciousness to work at its task with even greater concentration!
             Where are you, you beings to whom I belong, 
            beings whom I resemble ... beings permeated through and through with 
            universal love, beings who understand me. You who have never left 
            me, who have never abandoned me, even in the time of my deepest 
            fall, where are you? Where are you?  Then in the darkness I begin to see a greenish 
            phosphorescent light. It becomes clearer and clearer as it appears 
            to come ever closer, and soon I see this light taking on the 
            magnificent shape of my dear master Ptahhotep. I realize that 
            my self is now projecting itself into the little room of our 
            forest house, in the person in which I experienced, in my vision 
            during my initiation,. the creative self which stands above 
            all created forms. In the time of the three-dimensional world only a 
            moment has passed. And in this moment I have seen all the phenomena 
            which have been latent in myself as possibilities of 
            manifestation and which have manifested themselves on the 
            material plane, from the lowest, unconscious step of matter up to 
            the highest step of the self manifested in matter.  Ptahhotep still stands before me, looking at me with 
            eyes full of heavenly love. This look ... the irresistible flow of 
            power which is this look melts away the last remaining mists 
            before my eyes and enables me to experience again as eternity,
            as timeless present, everything that exists in my present 
            consciousness as past ...  I look long and deeply into the eyes of my master, 
            into those two wellsprings of life, and with a feeling of infinite 
            joy I discover I understand his unspoken words. I have 
            re-acquired the ability of the spirit! We understand each other 
            again just as we once did in Egypt!  I feel like jumping up and throwing myself at his 
            breast, but He raises his right hand and holds me back. His 
            eyes tell me: 'Don't touch me! You know I'm not in the earthly plane 
            and you can see me only because you have adjusted your consciousness 
            to the spiritual vibrations in which I live and move and have my 
            being. If you wanted to touch me, you would force your consciousness 
            down to the level of your tactile nerves, down to the level of 
            matter, and my image would immediately disappear from your view. But 
            from now on you will be able to direct your consciousness to the 
            higher frequencies and find me just as you were able to do during 
            that former projection of your self which you call your 
            incarnation, or your life in Egypt.'  I stand still and very much in control of myself 
            because I don't want under any circumstances to lose this present 
            state in which I can perceive Ptahhotep with my spiritual eye. But 
            my soul is so full of joy I doubt whether my heart and nerves can 
            stand the strain. Once again Ptahhotep raises his right hand and 
            lets the flow of power stream into my heart. Instantly my heart 
            begins to beat normally again, and I am able to speak with him 
            without words.  'Father of my Soul, now I understand that my present 
            life is the resultant of all my deeds in previous lives. I 
            understand the relationships between people and events. But there 
            are still a few unanswered questions. I know, for example, that my 
            one and only child is Ima. And I also understand what it was he 
            wanted to forgive me for when he was sick, feverish and delirious as 
            a little boy. But how does he come to believe that he was once a 
            negro?'  Through Ptahhotep's gaze the answer appears as a 
            series of pictures. In Ima's soul a great tragedy occurred. The 
            moment he noticed what had occurred between the red-haired foreigner 
            and myself, he was terribly disappointed. Whipped onward by a 
            burning restlessness, he ran away from the temple, into the wilds of 
            Africa to the negro tribes. Suddenly I see a picture: Ima as I had 
            known him in Egypt, but now in a tropical region, surrounded by many 
            negroes. He radiates divine love among these primitive children of 
            men, and they feel and instinctively understand his love, just as 
            animals do. Ima teaches them, heals their sick, helps them in every 
            respect while the natives repay his love and care with childlike 
            worship. In his utter desperation he finally takes a negro woman to 
            wife and allows himself to be carried away by physical love. Little 
            by little his consciousness sinks deeper and deeper into the body, 
            and the daily struggle for existence in the jungle draws him farther 
            and farther into life on the human level. He dies with a 
            consciousness directed towards human problems and human worries, and 
            inasmuch as he had occupied himself with the dearly beloved members 
            of his negro tribe, identifying himself with them in his thoughts, 
            he was reincarnated in his next life as a negro in accordance with 
            the law of attraction. Into this next life he brought along the same 
            chaotic low consciousness into which he had sunk as a result of his 
            desperation and the extent to which he had been living on the level 
            of animal urges. Nevertheless, his intelligence radiated through his 
            physical body, and he became a well-liked and highly respected 
            member of his tribe. He also had a wife and children. In his 
            incarnation as a member of this negro tribe I can recognize him only 
            by the look of his eyes. I see him as he goes hunting in the jungle, 
            climbs trees to watch and wait for passing animals, then kills them 
            and takes them home. One day when he is hunting again in the jungle, 
            he is attacked by a tiger, struggles heroically, but finally is 
            killed. I see his wife, alarmed by his screams and the noise of the 
            terrible struggle, plunging into the jungle to help her husband ... 
            then the vision pales, and I perceive only Ima's condition after his 
            death. His incessant longing for me leads him unconsciously—in his 
            disembodied state—nearer and nearer to me. Both of us, Ima and I, 
            have come a long way since we were together in Egypt, but so far we 
            haven't been mature enough to be ready to find each other again.  Now we finally reach the level on which we can find 
            each other again without the danger of physical love. The will to 
            preserve the purity of our love at all cost and in the face of any 
            temptation, together with the law of physical heredity, caused Ima 
            to be born as my child. In this life he must also reacquire the 
            clear spiritual vision he once had. And since I was immediately to 
            blame for his having lost his faith, I have to be the one to lead 
            him back on the path to God. But it's not yet time for this. 
            He is still a child.  'Father of my Soul,' I ask Ptahhotep again, 'where 
            is Atothis, your brother and my father in Egypt? I long to 
            communicate with him again, and I'm also certain he has never 
            abandoned me.'  Instantly before my spiritual eyes there appears the 
            image of a splendid man, one who has been, in recent times, the 
            greatest teacher and expounder of the highest, profoundest truths. 
            I've read books published by his disciples on the basis of his 
            lectures. In reading these books I was deeply moved because every 
            sentence I read made me feel absolutely positive that I knew the man 
            who had made the statement, that I was in profound communication 
            with him, that I knew all his thoughts and that I belonged to him! I 
            knew I would never have a chance to meet him as he had died in a 
            far-off country when I was still a little girl.  Often I gazed long and intently at the picture of 
            this marvellous person who had possessed superhuman powers in every 
            respect. I felt positive that somewhere, somehow I had seen his eyes 
            before ... somewhere, somehow I had felt their heavenly gaze resting 
            upon me. I didn't know why I often ran to him in my dreams, ran so 
            fast my hair and my dress trailed out behind me in the wind, and why 
            I threw myself into his arms, on to his big broad chest, crying, 
            'Father!—Father!' for the sheer joy of seeing him again. Neither did 
            I know, when I had wakened why I had called him 'Father' in 
            my dream, nor why I had cried so much my pillow was wet ...  Ptahhotep smiles: 'Now do you remember?'  'Yes, Father of my Soul, now I remember. He once 
            told me when we were at the seashore in Egypt: "There'll be a time 
            when I'll be on earth while you are not living in a body, and there 
            will also be a time when you'll be living in a body on earth while I 
            am working only on the spiritual plane to do my share in the great 
            task of spiritualization ... "  'Where is he now, Father of my Soul? Where is he 
            now?'  And I understand Ptahhotep's spiritual answer: 'When 
            he was still on earth, he promised he wouldn't abandon his disciples 
            after his death. He promised he would go on with the great work of 
            initiating humanity in the ancient truths. You and Bo-Ghar are both 
            his—our—co-workers, even without your being conscious of it. Later 
            you will be conscious co-workers.'  'Bo-Ghar? Is he living on earth again? Where is he? 
            Do I already know him in this life? Have I perhaps met him without 
            recognizing him?'  'Wait,' answers Ptahhotep, 'he is living in a 
            far-off country where Atothis too was reincarnated. Remember he 
            promised to come to you from the other end of the world and save you 
            if you got into danger. He will come to you just at the right time.'
             'Danger, Father?' I ask, 'what kind of danger?'  'Do you remember what I told you in Egypt just 
            before your initiation: If you fall, you have to experience all your 
            initiation dreams in reality on earth, for dreams are nothing other 
            than realities in the non-material, vision-forming energy world of 
            mankind. And what you call "reality" is also only a "dream" ... only 
            a projection of the self which has been dreamed into the material 
            plane, Into the atmosphere of the earth. And all the tests you 
            failed to pass once, or even several times, come again and again in 
            your life so that you can again become an initiate, a useful 
            co-worker in the great plan. An old friend will help you through the 
            mystic door. The young priest who helped you prepare for your 
            initiation in Egypt is again living on earth. When the time comes he 
            will appear, to help you on your path to the goal.'  'And how did Thiss-Tha, Atothis' General, come to be 
            my dearly beloved father in this present life of mine?'  'It would take too long to tell you all the reasons 
            that played a role in this end result. But here are the main ones: 
            You know the greatest power in the human soul is longing. 
            Wherever a person's consciousness is drawn by his longing—that's 
            where he is reincarnated. When you were attacked by your lion back 
            in Egypt, three people who saw the attack wanted to save you: 
            ThissTha, Bo-Ghar and the lion-keeper. Bo-Ghar ran after you when he 
            noticed that you had left the palace, and in desperation he ran into 
            the court of lions to save you.  'At that moment Thiss-Tha was in the act of having 
            his lion harnessed. When he saw your lion turning on you, he ran 
            towards you to try to protect you. But the lion reached you first 
            and felled you with a terrible blow. By the time the three men were 
            able to free you from the lion's claws, your body was so injured 
            that resuscitation was impossible. Thiss-Tha picked up your 
            lacerated body in his arms and carried you into the palace while 
            Bo-Ghar tagged along crying bitterly.  'Thiss-Tha was an honest, upright man who loved the 
            Pharaoh and you faithfully and without any ulterior motives. As he 
            was carrying your dying body in his arms, his heart was wrung with 
            infinite pity ... he carried you like a poor little child, just as 
            if you had been his child. He felt for you as a father would feel 
            love and pity for his own daughter. Then your last experience in 
            that life was when you saw Thiss-Tha and ran to him seeking his 
            help. And these feelings you both had for each other were the 
            deepest reason for your having experienced in a later life the 
            relationship of father and child. But along with many other 
            incidental reasons, there is still one important reason why you 
            became his child; for you to be able to go through the initiation 
            again in this life you absolutely had to inherit highly developed 
            nerve and brain centres open and accessible to spiritual revelation.
             'If you could follow back the long chain of 
            successive generations descended from the Thiss-Tha who once lived 
            in Egypt, you'd see that the chain of live cells passed on from 
            generation to generation from the man who once was Thiss-Tha—your 
            present father—has been unbroken right down to the present! In other 
            words, the bodies of each of Thiss-Tha's children developed from a 
            living cell from Thiss-Tha's body, and the bodies of their children 
            each developed from a living cell. And so it went for generation 
            after generation until your present father's father and mother were 
            born and once more a living, fertilized cell was available as a 
            vehicle for the spirit that once was Thiss-Tha in order for him to 
            be reincarnated in the same hereditary chain.  'There are many deeper relationships between 
            children and parents—ones that go back to the earliest times—than 
            the present-day scientists studying these laws have even begun to 
            dream of. They see only the body. But over and above the physical, 
            there are laws of heredity reaching up into higher, spiritual 
            relationships, Like attracts like! Along with all the other 
            reasons involved, you could really only be born again as Thiss-Tha's 
            child because your characters are so very similar. There's a very 
            good reason why everybody notices the great similarity in character 
            between your father and you. But you don't resemble him because 
            you're his child; you have become his child because you were 
            similar to him! Naturally you also resemble him physically in 
            build, posture, bone structure and features of face. Forces that 
            are similar build up shapes that are similar!  'If you understand the hereditary change of living 
            cells, you also understand why your father has the same black hair 
            and eyes he had in that life long ago in Egypt. Colours and shapes 
            are also manifestations of the spirit! It was a distant descendant 
            of Thiss-Tha, a seaman who travelled to countries far away from 
            Egypt, who brought to this country the ability to hand down 
            physically these colours and shapes. Even after centuries have 
            passed, a long forgotten, long lost colour or shape can come out 
            again in the hereditary chain. That's why parents, even though both 
            of them may be light complexioned, can unexpectedly have a 
            dark-haired, dark-skinned child.  'The spirits themselves who are born into these 
            strangely incongruous bodies could tell how they come by such an 
            inheritance if they were conscious. In most cases, however, they 
            only come to understand their origin and their task in life at a 
            much later time. And it's good that this is so, for if a child 
            nowadays remembers its earlier life and talks about this to others, 
            people immediately consider it mentally deranged, or at best a 
            dreamer or liar.  'But you've had enough today, my child, now return 
            to your physical consciousness. After the great shock of 
            remembering, your nerves need complete rest in order not to become 
            ill.'  Little by little the vision of Ptahhotep pales. For 
            a few moments I still see the divine glance of his radiant eyes. 
            Then He disappears from my view, and once again all is 
            darkness around me. I turn the light of my consciousness on to the 
            question: Where am I?  As if in answer to my question, white walls appear 
            out of the darkness, then the contours of various objects. The 
            colours and shapes become stronger and clearer, until everything is 
            changed back and I realize I am in the little room of our forest 
            lodge.  Yes! I am in the little room of our forest lodge! 
            That is reality. But when I was initiated in Egypt and my body lay 
            in the stone coffin, when my consciousness experienced as dreams all 
            the lives which were slumbering in a latent state in my self, 
            those dreams were just as much realities for me as the present fact 
            that I am in our little forest lodge is a complete 'reality' for me.
            Who can tell me what is truth: Have I just been dreaming here, 
            here in the forest lodge, that I once lived thousands of years ago 
            in Egypt and was initiated there, or am I perhaps dreaming now, 
            during my initiation in the pyramid, that I am in our little forest 
            lodge, and is my whole life that I consider reality nothing but a 
            chain of dream pictures in my consciousness giving me the 
            opportunity to succeed in the face of one challenge after another?
            My son now—and Ima in Egypt? Which of them is reality? In the
             dreams I had during initiation I saw such chaotic, 
            horrible pictures that I can't really remember right. Nevertheless, 
            all these impossible things in my initiation dreams were complete 
            reality. I still see pictures from these dreams now. I saw Ima as a 
            grown-up in an air force uniform—then other pictures of us sitting 
            together with a lot of other people for seemingly endless lengths of 
            time in air-raid shelters, and I remember seeing foreign soldiers as 
            if we had been invaded ... then our house all in ruins ... then 
            other chaotic, quite senseless, impossible dreams. How horrible! 
            Probably I dreamed all these things because the newspapers are 
            always writing about the possibility of a second world war.  And so I try to put my thoughts in order ...  For a long tune I sit motionless in my room until my 
            housekeeper, a dear girl, comes in and asks:  'What shall I fix you for supper?'  'Nothing, thanks, Betty. I want to go straight to 
            bed. I'm a little bit tired today,' I reply.  'Yes! That comes from thinking so much. You really 
            should stop all this reading and thinking. I do hope you won't be 
            sick, you look so pale.'  She pulls back the covers on my bed, says good night 
            and leaves.  And as I prepare for a good night's rest, I realize 
            my master Ptahhotep was right when he told me in my vision 
            that my nerves need complete rest. They really do.  42
           
            ROO-KHA AND THE TWELVE PILLS All that happened next came so fast that it seems 
            like a dream in my memory. I began to pass on to the people around 
            me the truth that I had learned from Ptahhotep in the temple. More 
            and more people came to my lectures, like thirsty wanderers in the 
            wilderness, seeking to draw living waters and to quench their thirst 
            with the deep secrets of initiation into the divine self. 
            From that time on my work has been the same: I stand at the 
            beginning of an infinitely long pathway, while at the other end 
            there stands the radiant form woven of light—the creative cosmic 
            self—awaiting each and every traveller with open arms. I stand 
            there and point the way to the countless sheep who seek the light
            and wander on side by side, slowly forward ... ever onward 
            towards the form of light ... just the way I had seen it all in my 
            vision in the Dolomites. Outside in the three-dimensional world my
            Karma— which had created my character and my fate— ran onward 
            according to the laws of time and space. I was alone with my task, 
            without a guide from whom I might have received advice, just like 
            everyone has to be alone who wants to develop into an independent, 
            resourceful, reliable co-worker in the great plan. Only at rare 
            intervals, when I had reached a great turning point in my life, did 
            I again receive help and directions from the higher powers which 
            guide the course of the earth. Even then I still had to solve all my 
            problems. As the years went by, however, things happened now and 
            again to remind me of my experiences in Egypt.  Once when I was in a far country for the first time 
            to take part in a big international conference I met someone I had 
            known in Egypt. After my arrival I entered a room in which a number 
            of the convention participants had already gathered. I was really 
            thinking of anything else but memories from my life in Egypt, but in 
            this room I saw a man whom I recognized instantly, and for sheer 
            surprise my heart began to beat faster. It was Roo-Kha! The man 
            stood up, and although I refrained from expressing surprise by even 
            so much as a twitch of a muscle, he showed his surprise as he looked 
            at me. Then he bowed and introduced himself: 'Ewalt Klimke.' We 
            shook hands. We stood there for a moment in silence, then he said 
            with much embarrassment: 'Strange! Who are you really? I have the 
            oddest feeling ... just as if I should bow before you with 
            outstretched arms, right down to the floor! Very strange!' He looked 
            at me enquiringly: 'Why do I have this odd feeling?'  I answered: 'You were finance minister in the 
            government of my father in Egypt,' and smiled. Those around us 
            laughed heartily. They thought I was joking. But Mr. Ewalt Klimke 
            didn't laugh. He kept on looking at me in a quizzical, embarrassed 
            way, and all throughout the convention which lasted for several days 
            he always called me 'Queen'. Again and again as he looked at me so 
            searchingly, he would mutter, 'Strange ... very strange!' And in all 
            our meetings during the convention we talked together like two old 
            friends.  Another event of about the same period in my life 
            stands out very sharply in my memory: one autumn evening I went to 
            bed as usual. I was dreaming something quite inconsequential when 
            all of a sudden I seemed to be surrounded by bright light. Then in 
            my dream an automobile came speeding up and stopped right in front 
            of me. Two men, dressed in white and looking like doctors, got out. 
            One of them stepped up to me, pulled a spoon-like instrument out of 
            his pocket and used it to scoop my defective eye out of its socket. 
            The other man pulled out a little phial, opened it and took out a 
            big, round white disc that looked like a pill. Holding the pill up 
            close for me to see, he said: 'Don't be afraid. I'm now going to 
            insert this disc in your eye socket. Twelve of these must be 
            consumed and then you'll get your eye back. So don't be frightened 
            at the idea that you will now apparently be blind in this eye.' Then 
            he inserted the pill in my empty eye socket, closed my eyelid and 
            bandaged my right eye with a white cloth.  I awoke early in the morning and wanted to get up. 
            Then I noticed that I couldn't see a thing with my defective right 
            eye. It was just as if a board had been placed in front of it. I ran 
            to a mirror to look at my eye. With my other eye which was still 
            good, I could see that the pupil of my right eye had turned grey in 
            colour and was completely opaque. I knew it was a cataract. For 
            several years one had been developing slowly in my right eye, but 
            its progress was slow and unnoticeable, and even yesterday I could 
            still see pretty clearly. It was completely invisible from the 
            outside. And yet, now in the space of only one night, the lens in my 
            right eye had crystallized into a cataract!  'Don't be afraid ...' My dream visitor's voice 
            echoed in my memory. No, I won't be afraid! I'll just have to begin 
            again a series of pilgrimages from one professor to another, and 
            sooner or later one of them will operate on my eye. Long ago I 
            learned that it doesn't do any good to be afraid, but what is the 
            meaning of these white pills? ... And what is meant by the idea that 
            twelve of them are going to have to be used up in order for me to 
            get my sight back again. How can that be?  I went to various famous professors. In their 
            unanimous opinion, my right eye was operable immediately, but they 
            all said there was a danger I would always have to wear dark glasses 
            afterwards. This was because they were going to have to cut out a 
            bit of the iris which would give the pupil the shape of a keyhole, 
            and because I was already thirty-five years old they thought my eye 
            would not be able to stand the exposure to more light through the 
            enlarged pupil. So they advised me to wait with the operation, and I 
            followed their advice. I kept on working but I couldn't get used to 
            working with one blind eye. The cataract bothered me greatly.  Summer came, and as usual we went to spend our 
            holidays at our family villa on the lake. There I met a Catholic 
            bishop who told me I should certainly go to Vienna and have my eye 
            examined by a world-famous professor whom he personally knew. 'He 
            uses different techniques from other doctors,' said the bishop. 'Go 
            to him and ask him for his advice. I am a servant of God, and 
            perhaps God is giving you this advice through my mouth.' By this 
            time I had heard so much advice about my eye that I was nearly 
            immune. But the bishop's words 'Perhaps God is giving you this 
            advice through my mouth' made a deep impression on me.  When autumn came, my father accompanied me to the 
            professor in Vienna. He recommended an immediate operation: 'You 
            should get this ugly, bothersome cataract out of your eye as fast as 
            possible. Without any doubt, it's psychologically bad for you not 
            to.'  'Won't my eye suffer greatly from the fact that 
            you're going to have to cut out a bit of the iris?' I asked.  He looked at me long and searchingly, then tested my 
            reflexes and began to talk about my sculpturing work, asking all 
            kinds of things that had no connection with my eye. Then he suddenly 
            said: 'I won't cut out any of the iris. You can be assured your eye 
            won't be sensitive to light.'  'In that case, let's get the operation over as fast 
            as possible,' I answered.  A week later I was in the sanatorium, preparing for 
            the operation which was to take place the following day.  It was a glorious autumn evening, and before going 
            to bed, I stepped over to the window to look out over the beautiful 
            city below. As I drew the curtain to one side to look out of the 
            window, I saw the great round white disc of the full moon climbing 
            slowly into the sky to the east. Instantly I recognized the great 
            white pill the doctor had given me in my dream. It was a full 
            moon! The doctor had told me: 'Twelve will have to be used up 
            ...' With my heart pounding in excitement, I started counting the 
            time that had elapsed since that odd dream. Sure enough—twelve full 
            moons had gone since that time! I knew the operation would give me 
            back the sight of my eye!  The next morning I lay on the operating table, and 
            in an amazingly short time the operation was over. A light flashed 
            in my blinded eye, and a moment later I saw a hand in front of it. 
            'What do you see?' I heard the professor ask.  'Your blessed hand, professor,' I answered, and a 
            moment later both of my eyes were bandaged. As I was being wheeled 
            out of the operating room, I heard doors opening and closing and the 
            soft voice of my father: 'How was it, Esther?'  'Good, Father,' I answered, 'I can see again ...'
             The eye operation brought me many very interesting 
            experiences, the most revealing of which was learning something more 
            about those vibrations we call 'light': namely, that these 
            vibrations are only 'light' for our eyes, and healthy eyes at that. 
            In other respects light is a tremendous force, big enough to kill a 
            person, or even stronger beings. It all depends on the 
            relationship between the skin sensitivity of a living creature and 
            the intensity of the light. This is what happened: A few hours 
            after the operation the professor came in and said:  'Don't be alarmed when I take off the bandage from 
            your eye. I have to see how it reacts to the light of a burning 
            candle.'  I thought, 'Why should I be alarmed?' The doctor 
            took off the bandage and said, 'Now please open your eye.'  I was expecting to see a burning candle when I 
            opened my eye. Instead, I saw only darkness, but I felt a terrible 
            blow on my newly operated eye. Jerking my head back, I closed my eye 
            again. I couldn't understand what had happened. My doctor laughed 
            reassuringly: 'Didn't I tell you not to be alarmed? The retina of 
            your eye is so sensitive right now that it doesn't pick up light 
            rays as light, but reacts as if it were being hit a sharp blow. Just 
            go on resting. I'll come back in a few hours to examine your eye 
            again. So far everything's going just fine,' he said and left.  I remained alone in my darkness, with plenty of time 
            to think, What is light? How is it the same light I perceive with my 
            healthy eye as the flickering flame of a candle can cause me as much 
            pain as if I were being hit by a fist? I didn't see any 'light' at 
            all, but I did feel the wallop so strong it knocked my head back. 
            From this I was forced to conclude that if there were beings whose 
            skin had the same sensitivity to light as the retina of my freshly 
            operated eye, they could be struck from a great distance, perhaps 
            even killed, by turning the light of a searchlight on them.  Conversely, it is certainly conceivable that there 
            could be some kind of light— for simplicity's sake we can call it 
            'ultra light'—that is so much stronger in its effect than the 
            'light' we are accustomed to seeing with our human eyes, that, 
            depending on the sensitivity of our skin, it could strike us down in 
            the same way ordinary light would affect a being with a skin as 
            sensitive as the retina of my freshly operated eye.  I realized that everything is relative, a question 
            of the relationship existing between an operating force and the 
            resistance it meets. This fitted in with the realization that there 
            can be infinitely varied kinds of life existing on the different 
            planets and heavenly bodies throughout the universe. A creature 
            similar to man living on Uranus or Neptune, because of the much 
            greater distance between those planets and the sun as compared to 
            the distance between the earth and the sun, might conceivably have a 
            skin as infinitely sensitive to light as my freshly operated eye; 
            and if such a being on one of these distant planets were to 'see' in 
            sunlight in the same way we see here on earth, his eyes would 
            certainly have to be immeasurably more sensitive to light than ours 
            are. But do we need to go so far away? The myriad creatures living 
            in the depths of the ocean have such eyes—and capabilities we cannot 
            even begin to understand—because we simply couldn't begin to exist 
            in such dense darkness.  In this vein I went on meditating on the unlimited 
            possibilities of worlds without end and of the different forms of 
            life they can contain. And the more I thought on these things, the 
            more my heart filled with deep humility in the face of the power of 
            the eternal being we call God ...  This eye operation brought me another very 
            interesting and valuable experience. Through it I learned that 
            the eyes take in light not only for themselves but for the entire 
            body, just as the lungs do with air and oxygen. Light is force! 
             On the third day after my operation, the professor 
            came in with the nurse, and said, 'Now it's time for you to get up 
            and come over and sit in this armchair. Just put on your slippers, 
            and the nurse and I will help you.'  I was offended: 'Doctor,' I said, 'I'm not sick! And 
            lying in bed for three days certainly hasn't made me so weak I can't 
            sit up and move about myself. You don't need to help me'  'Good,' the doctor said, 'Go ahead and get up by 
            yourself—if you can.' I started to get out of bed. But I was in for 
            a big surprise! My feet and legs were so weak, so powerless, that I 
            would have sunk to the floor if strong hands had not seized me from 
            both sides and held me up. My legs hung down like two limp rags and 
            my back was just as limp and powerless. So, quite the opposite of 
            what I expected, I was really glad for help in getting out of bed 
            and over into the armchair. How was this?  Then I heard the professor laugh: 'You see you 
            couldn't get up alone? It's just because you were in complete 
            darkness for three days. When a person is suddenly shut off from 
            light, he loses strength so fast he soon can't stand up alone any 
            more. You'll shortly be able to open your eyes again, and when you 
            do you'll find your strength returning quickly. One of our greatest 
            problems during the war was how to help blinded soldiers, not so 
            much because of their mental condition, but because of the complete 
            debility which always and unavoidably accompanied their sudden 
            blindness. The human soul is so wonderfully fashioned that a person 
            always finds ways and means to survive even such a tremendous 
            catastrophe as sudden blindness, and he can even go on and discover 
            new joys in life or new aspects of old pleasures. But our greatest 
            problems arose from the fact that these poor young men weren't even 
            able to stand on their own feet for a long time. It was not possible 
            for us to give them back the blessing of light. But thank God for 
            the elasticity and resiliency of the body; in time a blind person's 
            skin takes over the whole job of providing light throughout his 
            body. The problem of blindness is always most acute right after it 
            hits its victim, simply because of the weakness caused by the sudden 
            absence of light.'  I was silent. Ever since my eye had become diseased 
            I had begun to understand the significance of blindness much, much 
            better than one ever could when he has two healthy eyes. Now, 
            through my own experience, I came to understand the Biblical 
            passage:  'The light of the body is the eye; if then your eye 
            is true, all your body will be full of light. But if your eye is 
            evil, all your body will be dark. If then the light which is in you 
            is dark, how dark it will be!' (Matthew 6:22,23).  And my heart bled the more at the thought that 
            mankind isn't even satisfied with the blindness which occurs in 
            nature. Quite the contrary, he goes out himself to wage wars in 
            which countless otherwise healthy people are blinded,  maimed and crippled! When will humanity be mature 
            enough to refuse to obey the tyranny of politicians who 
            unconscionably sign declarations of war?  Two weeks later the professor took me into a dark 
            room to examine both my eyes. With a very strong lens before the eye 
            he had operated on I was able to read everything he put before me, 
            even to the tiniest letters. Then to my amazement, this dignified 
            old professor jumped up, seized me with both hands and hoisted me 
            high above his head. He was such a charming old fellow that I really 
            couldn't understand what had got into him and why he was acting so 
            strangely. As he gently set me back on the floor, his face was 
            beaming as he said: 'The technique I used on operating on your eye 
            has so far only be used for children and young people up to the age 
            of twenty. Beyond that age there's a danger of inflammation of the 
            iris, leading to total loss of vision in the eye. As you may 
            remember, in our first consultation, I observed you closely, noting 
            your extraordinary vitality and resilience. Your reflexes, too, were 
            quite good, and as I always do, I followed my intuition. With the 
            courage of my convictions, I operated on you as if you were still a 
            child. So now you know why I'm so happy. The operation was a 
            complete success. Your tissues were still young enough to come 
            through this difficult operation in splendid form. So now you can go 
            home with two healthy eyes—and with my heartiest congratulations!'
             I thanked him for his kindness, and we took leave of 
            each other. As I travelled homeward, I reflected on the twelve 
            'pills' which had to be consumed before light would return to my 
            blinded eye. And now it had.  43
           
            THE YOUNG PRIEST APPEARS Several years went by in which my husband and I 
            lived pleasantly and happily, our love for each other unchanged. I 
            continued my work as a sculptress, with lots of assignments, and in 
            my free time more and more people came to me for psychological 
            consultations. Several times a week I gave lectures on 
            self-recognition and understanding, based on the secret knowledge 
            Ptahhotep had given me in Egypt. And whenever I felt like resting 
            from my exertions, there was always my beloved piano.  Every day I practised spiritual yoga and even 
            attained the ability to go into deep trances, but the last, highest 
            door on my pathway remained closed and locked before me. Having 
            attained a certain degree of spiritual development, I found the 
            pathway towards the complete realization of my self was 
            blocked by an obstacle like a wall I couldn't break through with my 
            consciousness. Every year I spent several months living alone in our 
            forest lodge and practising yoga. The young fruit trees I had 
            planted years before were now big, strong, well developed trees—and 
            still I practised with unabated diligence; yet the guardians of the 
            secret gateway refused me admission ...  It was autumn once again, and I left our little 
            house in the forest to spend a day in the city celebrating my 
            father's seventieth birthday with the whole family, our relatives 
            and our many friends.  The following morning as I was preparing to start 
            the trip back to the forest lodge, our telephone rang. An elderly 
            friend asked me what I was doing that afternoon. I told her I was 
            free.  'The famous writer with whom I studied in India 
            under Maharishi has arrived and is staying at my house. If you're 
            interested, come around this afternoon and you can talk with him,' 
            my friend said.  That afternoon I rang my friend's front doorbell. 
            Stepping into the parlour, I caught my first glimpse of the man who 
            had attained world renown through his books about yoga and the great 
            yogis in India. At my first glimpse, I was taken aback. There, in 
            front of me, sat—the young priest who had helped me with my last 
            preparations for my initiation in my long-ago life in Egypt!  We exchanged a few comments in which I mentioned 
            that I had read his books and that I had been practising yoga for a 
            long time but still was unable to reach the highest goal. Other 
            guests dropped in and we were all soon involved in a general 
            conversation which lasted far into the evening. There was no further 
            opportunity to talk with him alone. In leaving I thought, 'So 
            nothing happened ...' Secretly I had hoped the famous 'white yogi' 
            would help me ahead on my mystic pathway.  The next morning my friend rang me up again to tell 
            me the writer wanted to speak to me alone. 'If you have time, come 
            around again this afternoon,' she invited me.  Entering her parlour I found the famous writer 
            sitting in the lotus posture on the sofa. As I too sat down he asked 
            me, 'What do you wish of me?'  'I have no wishes,' I replied. 'I'm living quite 
            contentedly in absolute inner peace.'  'Then why have you come to me? What do you expect of 
            me?'  'I want reality,' I said.  After a moment's silence the writer looked at me and 
            asked, 'And your absolute inner peace—isn't that reality?'  'Yes, indeed, it is reality, but I'm looking for 
            more. I feel like Moses who saw the promised land but never got 
            there. I believe I can see it too, but I'd like to get in. I'm not 
            satisfied just seeing it from the outside and seeing what's inside; 
            I want to get in myself.'  He smiled. 'Yes,' he said, 'you're standing hi front 
            of the great door with your hand already on the door knob. It's 
            extremely rare that anyone can progress up to the point you've 
            reached all alone and without the help of a master. You have 
            probably been initiated in some previous life, and now you only need 
            to make the last step through the gate that separates you from the 
            great goal.'  I looked at the yogi. Doesn't he remember he was a 
            priest in ancient Egypt and knew me there?—I thought. Or is it just 
            that he would prefer not to talk about it? From his impenetrable 
            gaze I couldn't tell.  'I know that already,' I answered, 'and I want to 
            get through the door even if I have to break it down with my fist.'
             'And do you believe I can help you?' he asked.  'If I am ready for it, yes, you can certainly help 
            me.'  'And if you're ready for it, you believe I can help 
            you?' he asked again.  'Yes,' I answered firmly.  Then, as if waiting for this reply, he pointed to 
            the chair opposite from where he was sitting and said, 'Sit down 
            over there, close your eyes and think yourself intently into your 
            heart.'  I did as he said, closed my eyes and concentrated 
            intently on my heart. Then with my eyes closed, I saw a strong 
            yellow current of bright light flowing out of the yogi's solar 
            plexus encompassing me like a circle, then encircling him again like 
            a big figure eight.  Simultaneously I felt I was coming in my 
            concentration to the point I had so often been able to attain in the 
            past without being able to go forward. And now I felt a great power, 
            foreign to myself, reaching into my consciousness and carrying me 
            forward, as if through a door, into an infinite depth beyond ...  Every concept of time disappeared, and I hadn't the 
            faintest idea how much time had passed when I heard the voice of the 
            white yogi again: 'Now you may open your eyes.'  In doing so, I realized how far away I had been from 
            earthly physical consciousness. I didn't feel like talking because 
            it seemed superfluous to say anything at all.  'I have set up a contact between your personal self 
            and the overself,' the writer said, 'because you're ready for it. 
            From now on, whenever you have a question, concentrate on me, and 
            you'll get your answer the same day.'  'On your person or on the higher self?'  He smiled and said nothing. I understood perfectly. 
            It was completely useless to waste a single word talking about the 
            'person'.  From that day on I found myself one of a group of 
            people meeting at my friend's house and meditating under the 
            leadership of the yogi.  A few weeks later he left us to continue his 
            travels. Once again I was alone and found myself living outwardly 
            just as I had before.  About a half a year later I was sitting with a 
            number of friends, listening to one of the group talking about black 
            magic. He said black magicians chose a few disciples whom they use 
            as blind tools to carry out their will without resistance. These 
            disciples are possessed by the black magician, lose their 
            independence completely, and are finally destroyed.  The next morning as I remembered these words, I 
            began to wonder whether I had been lacking in caution in my meeting 
            with the famous 'white yogi'. I was still convinced that he was a 
            'white magician' if we wanted to call him anything, but I had 
            nevertheless put myself completely in his hands with a blissfully 
            innocent trust. Was he after all a black magician?—or really a white 
            one? How can I know? How can anyone know whether he's dealing with a 
            'white' or with a 'black' magician? This question really bothered me 
            ...  That afternoon we were visiting one of my husband's 
            old school friends. While we were chatting, he told us how that very 
            day he had been leafing through the pages of an old book, and how in 
            doing so he had come across a highly interesting chapter about the 
            difference between white and black magicians:  'The white magician, when he wants to help one of 
            his pupils onward, binds the pupil to himself in the form of an 
            eight. In this way, he leaves his pupil his full independence,
            because both teacher and pupil form the mid-points, each of his 
            own individual circle. On the contrary, the black magician takes 
            away his pupil's independence by taking him into a circle with 
            himself in such a way that the black magician is in the centre 
            of the circle and the pupil just inside the circumference in the 
            same way a satellite's orbit forms a ring around the sun.'  I listened to this story with the keenest 
            excitement. Our friend didn't have the vaguest idea he was giving me 
            an answer I was seeking. I had not mentioned the matter to anyone. 
            And yet I got my answer the very day my question came up!  The higher self—God—always finds a human 
            mouth when he has a message for us. For the self there is no 
            such thing as an obstacle.  44  IMA AND BO-GHAR  Then the great war came.  Both of the men who belonged to me put on uniforms. 
            My husband was mobilized for service in one of the largest 
            government industrial plants to come under military control. He had 
            to carry the heavy responsibilities of a commander.  One day we were sitting together at table. The door 
            opened and in walked our son—in an air force uniform.  I felt as if the earth had disappeared beneath our 
            feet and I were falling into an abyss. Within our circle of friends 
            every one of the fine young men who had gone into the air force had 
            very soon after been carried into the cemetery. Strangely enough, 
            the moment he walked in wearing his air force uniform, I had the odd 
            feeling I had already seen him in such a uniform. But there was no 
            time to puzzle over when and where I could have seen 
            him—I was simply horrified at the thought he had gone into the air 
            force. The countries we were fighting against had much better 
            aircraft than ours. They had shot down our very best boys—for 
            only the very best were able to pass the exacting physical and 
            mental entrance exams—like so many toy balloons. At the very moment 
            I was working on a big composition for a tombstone for a young flyer 
            killed in action, one of my son's boyhood chums. And there I was 
            looking at my very own son in an air force uniform.  'How did you come by this uniform?' I asked him.  'Government issue,' he answered proudly, 'I've 
            passed the entrance exams for the air force.'  'We thought we'd arranged for you to get into the 
            engineers corps. How come you're in the air force now? No young man 
            can get into the air force without his parents' consent.'  'Mother, with the war on, they've done away with the 
            requirement of parental consent—as you can see for yourself.'  I was speechless. There was nothing I could do. And 
            there came days when I wandered around in our apartment like a 
            sleepwalker, talking to God. My power over my child was at an 
            end. I had to turn him over to God, and I did so consciously. 
            I was forced to realize that God loves my son more—must love 
            him more for the simple reason that he is God—than I, 
            an imperfect human being, have it in my power to love him.  No matter what might happen, I told myself, it was 
            certainly for the best, even if it might seem like a catastrophe to 
            me in my human- shortsightedness.  I was forced to act on the strength of my faith 
            in the reality of God! I couldn't allow my heart to tremble, and 
            I had to control my nerves with absolute calm, because I was forced 
            to consider the fate of my one and only child from the standpoint of 
            the great divine plan, beyond time and space, instead from my 
            little human standpoint. And considering it this way I was also 
            forced to act accordingly. Other mothers were praying day and night 
            for their sons. How could I have done that? God doesn't allow 
            himself to be persuaded by humans, and according to the law of 
            character and destiny I knew that whatever happened to my son—no 
            matter what—was certain to be the very best experience for the 
            development of his consciousness. Yes, God loves him! Even 
            more than I do! —this realization gave me the strength to go on 
            living.  As the war dragged on life became a kind of 
            uninterrupted waiting for the end of this mass murder. Outwardly 
            things went on pretty much as they had before. We worked, and we 
            went to concerts, operas, theatrical performances and to social 
            gatherings among our friends, but all of this seemed to flow past 
            us, for at the back of all these external events in our lives, there 
            was always the same incessant waiting ... waiting for the end of the 
            war.  A few years went by in this way, and with increasing 
            clarity I could see with my inward eye the gigantic military 
            steam-roller closing in on us from the east.  One day a friend rang me up to say she wanted to 
            introduce me to a very interesting person. He was an Indian, a 
            genuine yogi, she added. Often before that she had wanted to 
            introduce me to 'genuine yogis', but I had always found them out 
            very quickly to be perfectly ordinary and average people. Despite 
            all these experiences, she continued to act as if she were convinced 
            that every Indian must somehow be a very highly developed yogi. 
            Reason enough why I wasn't exactly excited about her new 
            'discovery'. Refusing to take no for an answer, she insisted on 
            coming to see me. And she did come, and told me a long story about 
            having seen a picture of a young Indian yogi in the newspaper, 
            having looked for him all over town without success, until by a very 
            remarkable 'coincidence' she had discovered that the Indian she was 
            seeking in vain all over the city with more than a million 
            inhabitants, was living in another part of the very same building 
            she was lodged in herself! It was a huge, modern block of flats; so 
            it was no wonder the tenants didn't all know each other.  After listening to her patiently for a while, I 
            tried to cut her long, long story short: 'And now, what do you want 
            of me?'  'You just must meet him,' she said. 'Let me 
            bring him here and introduce him to you. He never goes out, 
            preferring to live a very retiring life. But when I told him about 
            your weekly lectures on yoga philosophy, he immediately expressed 
            his willingness to come and see you. Look at some of these 
            photographs of him.'  With only casual interest I took the photographs she 
            held out to me, glanced at them—and caught my breath: Bo-Ghar! With 
            my heart beating excitedly, I looked at all the pictures. Not the 
            faintest doubt! I recognized the look of these big black eyes. The 
            unbelievable purity and the childlike expression of the entire 
            face—it was he! But he wasn't a little boy any more, as I had known 
            him and carried the remembrance of him deep in my soul. Now he was a 
            grown-up young man.  'Helen,' I said to my friend, 'tomorrow evening I 
            have time. You may bring him.'  The next day Helen came with Bo-Ghar. We drank tea 
            and chatted about all kinds of things, but all the time we did so my 
            inward eye was seeing pictures of a great palace made with huge 
            stone blocks, with a room in it—my room— with magnificent furniture 
            inlaid with gold, a low couch covered with beautiful skins of 
            animals, and on these skins a human form sitting, with legs, arms, 
            hands and shoulders I can see—only the head I don't see because I 
            am this human form, sitting on the animal skins, and at my feet 
            a child, a sweet vivacious child who now looks at me with the eyes 
            of this young man from India.  And why does he call me 'queen'?  I ask him.  'Because you are a queen,' he replies with 
            conviction.  'Yes! You're right!' my husband says. 'She certainly 
            can give orders, especially to me!' With that he laughs heartily, 
            and we all join in.  My son enters, sees the Indian guest and stands 
            stiff and rigid out of sheer surprise. Then he pulls himself 
            together and I introduce him. Both he and Bo-Ghar look at each other 
            long and searchingly. I succeed in bridging over the momentary 
            embarrassment by offering my son a cup of tea. He sits down and 
            joins us but is quite unable to take his eyes off the young Indian.
             That's how Bo-Ghar first came to us. In a very short 
            time he had captured the hearts of every one in the family. My 
            parents and my brother and sister took him in as if he were a new 
            brother among us. He opened his yoga school and since he didn't know 
            our language, he asked me to give a weekly lecture on yoga for his 
            pupils. Thus we began our work together.  The war dragged on. In the winter we all went on 
            with our work as we had before, and in the summer we moved into our 
            little house in the forest. Bo-Ghar came with us, living in the 
            forest according to the laws of yoga he had learned from his master.
             My son, by this time, had one plane crash behind 
            him. Miraculously he had survived it with only a concussion of the 
            brain. In due time he was well again with only a scar on his high 
            good-looking forehead to remind him of his mishap.  One hot summer day, when the great steam-roller from 
            the east was already near our borders, my dear, wonderful mother 
            suddenly fell to the floor. When we tried to help her up again, she 
            said very clearly, 'Stroke—it's a stroke ...'  Then she lay in bed for a long time, struggling 
            painfully to bring forth one word after another as she told us she 
            felt one side of her body was already dead.  'And do you know,' she added, 'it's so interesting 
            to be half here and half on the other side already. I still see each 
            of you half from the outside and half as if from within. And I can 
            also see your future destiny. As soon as I'm better I'll tell you 
            all about it. Right now it's very difficult to talk.'  She was already living very close to the world of 
            the spirit. Whenever any one of her friends, at home in some part of 
            the city, spoke about her, she would say to us, 'Now my friend Mrs X 
            is here with me, and this is what she's saying ...'  And mother would tell us exactly, word for word, 
            what her friend was saying in the same moment several miles away, as 
            could later be proved in minute detail. And it also often happened 
            that mother was sitting in her flat talking to her nurse and I was 
            up on the second floor talking about her with my husband. Then she 
            would say to her nurse, 'My daughter Esther is now here and this is 
            what she's saying about me ...' And she would repeat word for word 
            what I was saying about her in another part of the house and well 
            out of her hearing.  One day her nurse called me to come immediately. 
            Mother had suffered a second stroke.  I rushed downstairs. Mother lay there, still and 
            pale as death, unable to say a thing. With her right hand she 
            pointed at her tongue, giving me to understand she couldn't move it 
            any more.  She lay there thus for several hours, without being 
            able to speak. Suddenly the door opened and Bo-Ghar came in. With 
            her poor, twisted, half paralysed face, mother looked at Bo-Ghar, 
            her eyes beaming with joy. Bo-Ghar sat down beside her and enclosed 
            her wrist in his hand. After a couple of minutes mother opened her 
            mouth and said very slowly, syllable by syllable, but quite clearly: 
            'From Bo-Ghar's hand a force is flowing into me, and this force has 
            now reached the part of my head where I feel pressure that prevents 
            me from speaking. Thanks to this force that's flowing into me from 
            Bo-Ghar's hand, the pressure has abated and I can talk again.' Then 
            she went on to tell us a number of important things, all part of her 
            last wish.  Bo-Ghar went away after a while, and for an hour and 
            a half mother was still able to talk. Then all at once she said:  'Now the force our dear Bo-Ghar caused to flow into 
            me is ebbing away. It's getting harder and harder to talk and use my 
            tongue. The connection between me and my body is dissolving. God
            be with us ...' These were her last words.  And two days later her coffin was carried out of the 
            house. Her place at the head of our family table was empty. From 
            then on we marked it with a burning candle when we gathered round.
             45
           
            THE CHALLENGES ARE REPEATED It was the last winter before the end of the war.
             Our gardener who had taken care of our orchard had 
            long since been called up for military service. The orchard was 
            forsaken, and I moved into our little forest house to save whatever 
            I could. One night I was awakened by a horrible noise. Sirens! In 
            the city!  I jumped out of bed. From the dining-room I could 
            see the city in the distance. Dozens and dozens of airplanes roared 
            over my head in the darkness. The air trembled with the noise of 
            their engines. Suddenly a hellish drama began to be enacted in the 
            air over the city as row after row of airplanes dropped their bombs 
            into the masses of humanity living below. The sky came alight with 
            the bursting of bombs and the fires they started throughout the 
            city. The noise became deafening as, added to the roar of the 
            engines and the bursting of bombs, the city's anti-aircraft cannon 
            began picking out targets overhead as best they could. Seen from the 
            distance, their fire looked like tiny red lanterns climbing up into 
            the sky. From time to time I could see what looked like a huge 
            burning torch plunging downward, and I knew that somewhere a mother 
            would be waiting in vain for her son to come home ...  This breathtaking show of fireworks continued for 
            about an hour and a half. It seemed to me I had been standing at my 
            window for an eternity of time. Down there in front of me, where 
            this interplay of lightning and thunder meant death and destruction 
            for thousands of people, all my dear ones were living. All except my 
            son who at that very moment could perhaps be flying through the air 
            as a target for other poor young men flying in much better aircraft, 
            forced to shoot at him against all their human instincts, just as he 
            was being forced to shoot at them.  All at once I felt a force from a near-by tree 
            calling for my attention. Looking towards the tree, I saw two green 
            eyes staring at me. An owl! It sat there as immovable as a statue. 
            Never before had I seen an owl in this whole area. How did it come 
            here? Almost unconsciously I spoke to it in spirit: 'You dear bird, 
            it's not your fault that superstitious people think of you as a 
            harbinger of death. Still, do you perhaps want to tell me that all 
            my dear ones  down there in the city are no longer living on this 
            earth?'  Immediately the owl danced a bit closer to me on the 
            branch, suddenly spread his wings and flew off into the forest.  Instantly I knew that a great power which controls 
            and guides everything was telling me, through the disappearance of 
            the 'death bird', that all my dear ones were still alive ...  Yes all my dear ones! But all the thousands 
            of people who were killed that night in the city, and all the others 
            who have been killed during this terrible war—each such person was 
            somebody's dear one! Why have these people had to die? Why do people 
            kill each other senselessly? The hellish drama was repeated night 
            after night. In the summertime several of us moved into our little 
            house in the forest. Bo-Ghar came with us. During the nights of 
            terror we all stood together at the window, watching the bombardment 
            of the city below. Shortly after the sirens gave the all-clear 
            signal, my husband would telephone with the reassuring news that he 
            and the others with him in our city house were all safe and sound 
            ... When autumn came I stayed behind alone in our forest house, 
            continuing my work in the orchard and garden. Each evening I was 
            able to observe how much closer to us the enemy artillery—oh, these 
            poor young men who are forced into being our 'enemies'—had moved up 
            during the course of the day.  One evening I decided I was going back to the city. 
            Come what might, I was determined to go through at the side of my 
            loved ones the difficult hours of siege and bombardment that lay 
            ahead.  Then my telephone rang. How strange! I suddenly felt 
            positive I had already experienced this same situation some time 
            before! I knew in advance that my husband was just now going to call 
            me, and I knew word for word what we were going to say to each 
            other. And all the while I felt as if I were dreaming.  And this same strange feeling was to continue 
            throughout all the difficult days to come, until the days turned 
            into weeks, the weeks into months and the months into years! Again 
            and again I found I knew exactly what was going to happen. The next 
            moment, just as if I had already experienced all these terrible 
            things. Everything was simply repeated—I knew it!—but I couldn't 
            understand where and how I could have experienced these situations 
            before.  After I had returned to the city and the sirens 
            howling in the night forced me to join all the others in the house 
            in a pell-mell flight into the cellar, and as we sat there, all of 
            us calm, passive, earnest and worried about what was going to happen 
            next—all the while I knew that somehow, somewhere I had experienced 
            all this before. And so it was to be with me throughout all the 
            nights, the horrible nights of bombardments and air raids.  I experienced this feeling of re-living past events 
            even more strongly one day in late autumn when the door opened and 
            my son came in. Why was I surprised to see him in an air force 
            uniform? Yes! I still remembered him as Ima, the young priest in 
            Egypt, and I also knew all the relationships that linked us 
            together. But in my memory of him in Egypt he wore quite different 
            clothing. How do I come to feel that even in my life in Egypt I 
            already saw him in this air force uniform? Why do I have the feeling 
            that everything I experience is not 'reality', that I'm merely 
            dreaming all these pictures, and that I'm experiencing these 
            dreams in my initiation sleep in the great pyramid?  I clearly remember all the relationships of my life 
            in Egypt, but no matter how hard I try, I cannot remember the events 
            nor my initiation dreams.  How strange? How can one remember that one 
            doesn't remember? If I can't remember something, then I cannot 
            know that it has existed. But I know I experienced my whole future 
            destiny in visions during my initiation in the pyramid, and that 
            these visions—or dream pictures—were the occasion for my passing 
            various tests and meeting certain challenges. It's true my master 
            Ptahhotep warned me that if I were to fall after my initiation, all 
            the tests I had to go through during my initiation would be repeated 
            on the earthly plane! Yes! Continually I have the certain feeling 
            that these events are repeating themselves!  For a number of years I made a habit of writing down 
            every morning, as I was waking up, the dreams I had had during the 
            night. I had not reviewed these records for a whole year. Now I 
            began to read them. And to my great surprise I found that most of 
            these dreams I had recorded were dreams I had of events to come, 
            events which I actually experienced later, sometimes as much as six 
            months or a year later. In the meantime I had completely forgotten 
            the dreams themselves, and if I had not been able to see and 
            recognize my own handwriting, I would not have believed that I 
            had dreamed these dreams and recorded them. How was it possible that 
            when these things actually happened I couldn't remember any more 
            that I dreamt them in advance, and in many cases even in amazingly 
            accurate detail? I found this discovery to be literally amazing! 
            What kind of a force is there within us that knows our future in 
            advance with such precision and tells us about it beforehand? And 
            what kind of imperfect creatures are we who understand so little 
            about the language of dreams that we can't remember having dreamed 
            in advance about a certain event or situation, even when the dream 
            is repeating itself on the earthly plane in our outward life? Truly 
            we don't deserve the care and attention this force bestows upon us 
            as, with infinite patience, it reveals new truth and knowledge to us 
            ...  How could I explain remembering from an earlier life 
            in Egypt that I had seen my son in an air force uniform and that 
            when he came in I knew exactly he was going to take leave of me 
            because his unit was going to be transferred to an airfield less 
            exposed to enemy bombing than the one near our city? As he spoke and 
            as I answered I knew within me that I had experienced all this once 
            before ... again I had the feeling I was only dreaming ...  I didn't dare tell anyone of this experience. I was 
            afraid that even my son— Ima himself—would believe my mind had 
            suffered from all the excitement. It seemed much better to keep 
            silent about the whole matter.  And so we lived through the siege of our city. For 
            seven weeks we sat in our cellar, enduring incessant bombings. After 
            the house above us had been bombed and shelled into a heap of 
            rubble, we were forced to flee. Our destiny tossed us about like a 
            leaf in the wind, and after many trials and tribulations we began to 
            rebuild our lives. We were all reduced to the state of beggars. My 
            husband had been seriously injured, and it was a long time before he 
            could work again. By dint of days and nights of effort with no more 
            equipment than primitive man had in the first primaeval jungle, 
            Bo-Ghar and I fashioned a new home out of the ruins of our family 
            house, and in it we re-opened our Yoga school ...  Months went by as we worked hard and long. Those 
            were times when we learned what hunger is. Week by week we gradually 
            wasted away, shrinking from human beings of flesh and blood to 
            living skeletons covered with skin. Even good friends would fail to 
            recognize each other when they met by chance on the street. Fear—a 
            baleful new fear—spread throughout the population, augmenting the 
            feelings of fright already present in thousands of tortured souls: 
            What will we eat tomorrow? How long will we be able to go on working 
            so hard without even once getting enough to eat? How long can we go 
            on like this and still maintain our health?  Our country's fertile soil had brought forth plenty 
            of everything we needed, but we were forced to look on while 
            countless freight trains snaked their way through the countryside, 
            carrying off our rich harvest to another country ... Then after long 
            and difficult months, even the famine began to abate. More and more 
            frequently we got something nourishing to eat, and gradually we 
            began to put on weight. Once again, good friends and acquaintances 
            failed to recognize each other on the street. We had all got 
            accustomed to seeing each other so thin and emaciated, and every so 
            often in passing someone on the street, the thought would flash 
            across our mind that this well-fed person bore a striking 
            resemblance to some very thin friend. Both of us would have the same 
            thought, then turn around, recognize each other, and break out in 
            peals of laughter at the happy reunion ... But months went by before 
            we became really re-acquainted with all our friends ... 
            re-accustomed to their normal dimensions.  I still had the feeling that I had already 
            experienced all of this! It was a feeling that stayed with me 
            wherever I went and whatever I did. It was not that I could foretell 
            the future. On the contrary, it was merely the persistent feeling 
            that everything had already happened just that same way once before. 
            And not being able to foresee the future, I did not know what had 
            become of my son. Since the time he suddenly took leave of us he had 
            not been heard of.  A year and a half later our doorbell rang. I opened 
            the door, and who should I see before me but my son! And once again 
            I had that strange feeling known by psychologists as the 'deja 
            vu'. I knew it was a repetition. All these events were 
            repetitions! But how could that be? And one night everything became 
            clear!  Once when I was forced to pass the test of 'cruel 
            love' towards the person I love most dearly here on earth, my son, I 
            kneeled in my bed in the dark of the night and talked about him with
            God, asking Him to show my son the way he should go. I 
            followed the pathway which, within us, leads to God, 
            withdrawing my consciousness from my outer person into my inner 
            being. Finally I fell into a trance and suddenly found myself in 
            front of the seven steps I have told about earlier.  And I jump up, from one to the next, easily, 
            happily, and joyously ... I know the way ... I remember ... Oh God! 
            ... I remember! All these events I've been experiencing as 'reality' 
            in my life on the material, earthly plane are things I experienced 
            several thousand years ago in my initiation in the pyramid. At that 
            time all these events were lying in the depths of my soul as 
            unconscious, still latent energies, still pure cause. This is 
            because everything that happens here on earth is the materialization 
            of a complete, accomplished cause waiting on the spiritual 
            plane for materialization. When one achieves the ability consciously
            to reach the depths of the self where those energies are 
            awaiting their realization, one experiences cause 
            simultaneously with the effect—the future—as a complete and 
            perfect present! And the present, our life, everything that 
            happens to us is merely an opportunity to meet the tests and trials 
            and challenges of initiation. An opportunity to relax the tensions 
            and dissolve away the stresses we have stored up within ourselves, 
            for aeons and aeons of time, by our thoughts and words and deeds ... 
            the tensions and stresses that are the cause of our destiny, our 
            future. To the extent that we are able to become conscious of these 
            tensions and overcome them, we free our human consciousness which is 
            tied down by these energies and limited because it is tied down, and 
            we identify our consciousness with the true divine self waiting 
            behind every personal feeling of ego ... we identify ourselves with 
            God ... and that is  INITIATION!  46
           
            CONCLUSION After the experience of that night I knew the 
            tensions and stresses had been erased from my soul ... everything 
            personal would have to be discarded. I had overcome myself! There 
            was nothing more within me to bind me to my 'person'. Everything 
            personal had to disappear.  It began with a very strange feeling which followed 
            me wherever I went— at home or outdoors—that I wasn't really 
            'there'. Not there? But where? I really didn't know! But I suddenly 
            became aware of the fact that my self was never where my 
            person, my body, was located. On the contrary, my self projected 
            itself out of spacelessness into my person, and now my self 
            was beginning to project itself somewhere else than where my 
            physical being was. But where? Into another country!  I knew I was going to go away, that I was going to 
            have to go away! Whenever the spirit, the cause, ceases to be 
            present, the appearance, the effect, must follow it wherever it is 
            projected by the cause. There it can go on living. Otherwise, the 
            appearance would disappear, that is, die. But how am I supposed to 
            leave this country? No one can get a passport!  The time for my departure had not yet come. Other 
            events had to take place first.  One night I awakened quite suddenly. I saw my father 
            standing before me, taking leave of me with a smile on his dear 
            sweet face. I understood: It was time for him to go ... I wanted to 
            jump up and ask him why he wanted to go away and where he was going, 
            but he disappeared, and I realized that I was just awakening.  Father was eighty years old, but hale and hearty in 
            body and mind. With ever fresh and undiminished energy he was still 
            going on with his very responsible government job. Nevertheless I 
            knew his spirit had come to me to take leave. His time had run out 
            on the great cosmic clock, and he was going to leave his body 
            behind.  The next day he was already in the hospital, and all 
            the rest of us gathered round to say goodbye. He either could not or 
            would not speak. With long, deep and tender glances he looked each 
            of us in the eye in turn. Then he closed his eyes and didn't open 
            them any more. And we accompanied the second coffin out of our 
            family. My son tried everything he could to get work. In vain. He 
            kept on trying, again and again, but always in vain. Finally he came 
            to the realization that there was no room for him any more in our 
            country. And the day came when he took his guitar—a dear old 
            travelling companion he had never neglected even in the grimmest 
            days of the war—and went away in search of a country where a free 
            man who wanted to work could find a home. Again we took leave of 
            each other, not knowing whether we would meet again in this life. 
            But in the depths of my self I knew I would see him again. I 
            knew we would still be working together in God's garden .,. 
             Then came the last act.  Bo-Ghar had just given a public lecture. As usual 
            the audience was so big the police had to keep order.  After the lecture, he found himself surrounded by 
            people plying him with questions, begging for autographs, and 
            refusing to let him go home. While all this was going on, my husband 
            and I were standing a bit apart from the crowd, waiting. Suddenly an 
            officer of the secret police appeared and asked to speak with me. 
            When we had stepped to one side, he said, 'I practise yoga, and my 
            whole family with me, so I know it's a wonderful system. 
            Nevertheless, both you and the Indian are dangerous, because so many 
            people listen to you and do as you say. The party doesn't like that. 
            So now you're going to have to decide either to work with the 
            party and for it, or to get out of the country. We'll let you 
            both go without hindrance. But if you refuse to go, we'll be forced 
            to take other measures. Think over this proposition my superiors 
            have asked me to bring you, and act accordingly. I'll come back to 
            hear your decision.'  Bo-Ghar could have left the country freely with his 
            passport. But I was obliged to seek permission and apply for an 
            entry permit to another country. Soon I was involved in an endless 
            chase for an exit permit and for entry permits ... Finally I was 
            forced to realize that it was an absolute impossibility for me to 
            get a passport. I was shunted back and forth from one office to 
            another until at long last I received a final and definite refusal. 
            But that meant the secret police would soon be having recourse to 
            'other methods'. And we all knew what that meant. Many of our 
            friends had already disappeared for good and all, while others, 
            after suffering horrible tortures in prison, had been released, 
            broken in mind and body, only to die a miserable death shortly 
            thereafter.  Then Bo-Ghar said to my husband, 'The only 
            possibility of saving your wife is for you to divorce her and let me 
            take her out of the country as my wife. In this way she'll have the 
            same passport as mine, and we can leave the country legally. And 
            you'll come later.'  My husband seized Bo-Ghar's hand but was unable to 
            say a word. Big tears of gratitude welled up in his tortured eyes 
            ...  So the day came when I took leave of all the people 
            near and dear to me, and set out into the unknown world, to make my 
            home wherever God should lead us.  Bo-Ghar kept his word: He came from the other end 
            of the world to save me!  We found Ima again, and together we are travelling 
            on in the footsteps of the Titans who have shown us the pathway to 
            initiation, to redemption, to the lost paradise ...  And when I seek those whom I love, I turn the 
            searchlight of my consciousness inward, for everything and everyone 
            is living within me!  The self—at one and the same time the self
            of all living creatures, and therefore my self—knows no 
            bounds; so the entire universe is within me, and my self
            fills all the universe. Everything that is—I am! In 
            everything I love, I love my self, for the only things we 
            think we don't love are what we haven't yet come to recognize
            within ourselves!  THE SELF IS LIFE AND THE ONLY REALITY, AND 
            WHOEVER IS INITIATED INTO THE SELF—AND IN THIS WA Y HAS COME TO KNOW 
            HIMSELF COMPLETELY—LOVES EVERYTHING AND EVERYONE EQUALLY, FOR HE IS 
            ONE WITH THEM. 
           
 |